United States
Environmental Protection
Agency
Office of
Environmental Processes
and Effects Research
Washington DC 20460
EPA600JS- 79-010
September 1979
Research and Development
Resources and
Pollution Control

-------
                                          EPA 600/5-79-010
                                          September 1979
            RESOURCES AND POLLUTION CONTROL


                        Demonstration

                             of a

                   Comprehensive Assessment
                     Contracts  68-01-2816
                               68-01-2825
                               68-01-2826
                               68-01-2828
                        Project Officer

                        Roger D. Shull
       Office of Environmental Processes and Effects Research
               Office of Research and Development
              U.S. Environmental Protection Agency
                    Washington, D. C. 20460
OFFICE OF ENVIRONMENTAL PROCESSES AND EFFECTS RESEARCH
           OFFICE OF RESEARCH AND DEVELOPMENT
          U.S. ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION AGENCY
                   WASHINGTON, D. C. 20*60

-------
                         DISCLAIMER
This report has been reviewed by the Office of Research  and
Development   U.S.   Environmental  Protection  Agency, • and
approved for publication.  Approval does  not  signify  that
the  contents  necessarily reflect the views and policies of
the U.S.  Environmental Protection Agency, nor does  mention
of trade names or commercial products constitute endorsement
or recommendation for use.
                              ii

-------
                           FOREWORD
The purpose of this project was to develop and demonstrate a
methodology  for  simultaneously projecting future pollution
control costs for all economic activities subject to Federal
regulations, which utilized consistent assumptions  relating
to official Federal projections of the state of the Nation's
economy.   To  assure valid simulation of the impacts of the
regulations, the projection model was developed with a scale
of sectoral detail that aliowed analysis of  each  industry-
specific  effluent  or  emission regulation in effect at the
time (nearly 400 sectors).  Further, the  secondary  effects
of  pollution  control  expenditures  on  the  economy  were
simulated.

The body of this report  demonstrates  the  utility  of  the
methodology for the intended analyses.  However, eVen though
computerized,  the system and associated editorial resources
were  not  capable  (within  reasonable  cost  and  manpower
constraints)  of  producing  a comprehensive report that, at
any point, was current with  all  regulations.   During  the
analysis,  text  drafting,  and review periods, a continuous
stream of administrative, judicial and  legislative  actions
occurred,   which   significantly   affected   the  original
underlying regulatory and control options which were used to
structure the study.  In addition, as time progressed,  more
detailed  economic  studies of particular industries in many
instances led to more  precise  estimates  than  there  were
available  during  the original data collection phase of the
report.

Repeated attempts to update various  sections  in  order  to
accommodate  new  data  and  legislative  action resulted in
publication  postponements,  and  the  flow  of   regulatory
changes has not subsided.  Consequently, it became necessary
to impose a cutoff date on the incorporation of new data, in
order   to  release  the  report  so  that  its  significant
contribution to analytical methodology could be made public.

Therefore,  the  reader  is  put  on  notice  that  in  many
instances  the  cost estimates in this report do not reflect
the most current data available.  The report makes available
to the public the state-of-the-art methodology for producing
such estimates and gives an  indication  of  the  best  cost
estimates as they were made at one point in time.
                             iii

-------
                                ABSTRACT








     The purpose of this project was to develop and demonstrate a methodology for



simultaneously projecting future pollution control costs for ail economic activities



subject to Federal regulations, which utilized consistent assumptions relating to official



Federal projections of the state of the Nation's economy.  To assure valid simulation



of the  impacts of the regulations, the projection model was developed with a scale



of sectoral detail that allowed analysis of each industry-specific effluent or





emission regulation in effect at the time (nearly ^00 sectors).  Further,  the



secondary effects of pollution control expenditures on the economy were simulated.



This report demonstrates the utility of the methodology for the intended analyses.
                                          IV

-------
                       UNCERTAINTIES
Whenever a new estimate of national pollution control  costs
is  produced, there is a natural tendency to compare it with
related estimates developed by other parties.  Such  efforts
frequently show considerable discrepencies between estimates
for ostensibly the same cost categories.  Such discrepencies
are,  in  fact,  to  be  expected, due to the vast number of
conditions which must be specified to assure that  even  the
category of cost analysis is identical between two different
estimates.

Probably   the   most   difficult  problem  in  preparing  a
comprehensive assessment of this nature, in this  particular
period  of  the  national environmental programs, is keeping
the cost estimates  current  with  respect  to  the  rapidly
changing  regulation  situation.   Keeping the economic data
base  current  in  the  face  of  the  frequent  changes  in
regulations due to legislative, administrative, and  judicial
decisions  is both expensive and time-consuming.  Because of
resource constraints, the data in this report are consistent
with regulations existing in early 1976.  Thus, any  economic
studies of the impact of regulations proposed,  promulgated,
remanded,  or  suspended after early 1976 may be at  variance
with  values  presented  herein,  with  the   exception   of
automotive emission control costs which have been revised to
reflect  the  Clean  Air Act Amendments of 1977.  Changes in
regulatory  emission  or  effluent  requirements  frequently
result  in  little  or no change in cost estimates,  however,
since the changes usually relate to expected performance  of
accepted categories of technology rather than changes  in the
technology itself.

For each industrial category, assumptions must be made as to
what  types  of  technology  will  be  generally  applied to
achieve the effluent or  emission  requirements.   Estimates
must then be made for the variation of capital and operation
and  maintenance  costs  with  respect  to  age,  size,  and
location of the many plants within the industrial  category.
This area is probably the greatest source of disagreement in
the field of pollution control cost estimating.

Economic  variables  are  another  cause  of  discrepancies;
dollar value deflators, interest rates, equipment lifetimes,
wage rates,  energy  and  material  costs,  economic  growth
rates,  capital  availability, and other  factors must  all be
estimated and  projected  into  the   future  to  produce  an
estimate of pollution control costs over  a period of years.
                              V

-------
The  level of detail of data and calculations may also cause
variability in estimates  for  the  same  category.   Agency
resources  do  not  permit  exhaustive investigations of all
plants  in  any  particular  industrial  category.    Hence,
estimates  must be made by extrapolating from a small set of
data obtained from "typical" facilities.  For example,  most
estimates  of industrial control expenditures in this report
are based on only two to four plant size categories.  For  a
few  important  industrial  categories  where  this  general
estimation   procedure    was    considered    insufficient,
significant  resources  were  expended  on  special detailed
environmental cost analyses.  Results of these studies  were
sometimes  at  variance with the more approximate estimates,
as discussed in Sections Two and Three.

In addition, the particular purpose of the estimates may not
be exactly the same.  The estimates in this report represent
the expenditures which would probably  be  incurred  if  all
parties  met  the  regulations  on schedule by installing an
assumed  particular  type  of  equipment.    The   resulting
forecasts  are thus unrealistic to the extent that polluting
activities fail to meet all requirements on schedule.

The Bureau of Economic Analysis (BEA) of the  Department  of
Commerce conducts periodic surveys of industries to estimate
actual  pollution control expenditures.  These BEA estimates
are nearly twice as high as those reported  herein  in  some
industrial   categories   and   less  than  one-fifth  these
estimates in others.  These differences can be attributed to
variations in industry category definition, slower or faster
equipment installation schedules,  different  judgements  of
the   amount   of   industrial   expenditures   for  process
modification which can be properly attributed  to  pollution
reduction,  and  the  probable  statistical  errors in BEA's
industrial questionnaire sampling  process.   Chapter  3  in
Section  1  discusses  the impact that process modifications
can  have  on  pollution  reduction  and  the   difficulties
involved in apportioning costs between pollution control and
production cost accounts.

The closest parallel to the estimates in this report are the
estimates  for  the cost of water pollution control recently
prepared by the National Commission on Water  Quality.   The
Commission's    estimates    involve   the   same   effluent
limitations, and many of the same economic  assumptions  and
industrial  category  definitions.   Some  of the  industrial
category cost estimates compare very closely, but  there  are
still   categories   which   differ   significantly.   These
differences are attributed primarily to  (1) uncertainties in
plant inventories in those industries characterized by large
numbers of small plants,   (2)  differences  in  professional
                              VI

-------
judgement  on  what  process would most likely be applied to
achieve the required effluent quality,  (3)  differences  in
industrial  growth  rates  and  plant  size  trends over the
decade, and (4)  different  assumptions  about  the  current
status  of  pollution control in the industries (capital-in-
pi ace,).

To summarize, variations in estimates of national activities
of this level of complexity are to be expected, but detailed
examination of  the  data  and  calculation  procedures  can
usually explain the reasons for the variations.  The general
economic  assumptions  used  in  this  report are explicitly
stated in Sections One and Four of the report, and  industry
descriptions  and pollution control process descriptions are
described in considerable detail in Sections Two and Three.
                             VII

-------
                     TABLE OF CONTENTS
Section
           FOREWORD
           ABSTRACT
           UNCERTAINTIES
           ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS
           SECTION I—OVERVIEW

           Chapter 1—Introduction                                      1-1
                 Problem Overview                                       1-2
                 Assumptions                                            1-4
                    Economic Assumptions                                1-4
                    Energy Assumptions                                  1-4
                    Air Compliance Assumptions                          1-6
                    Water Compliance Assumptions                        1-7
              Pollution Control Costs:  Definitions  and
              Calculation Methods                                       1-10
                 Direct Costs                                           1-10
                    Investment Costs                                    1-10
                    Operation and Maintenance Costs                     1-iO
                    Total Annual Costs                                  1-11
                    Costing Methodology                                1-11
                    Government Program  Expenditure                      1-13
                       Air Program Costs                                1-14
                       Water Program Costs                             1-14
                 Indirect Costs                                         1-15
              Comprehensive Assessment                                  1-15
              Alternative Futures                                       1-16

            Chapter 2—The Benefits of Pollution control
            Programs                                                     1-19
              Definition of Benefits                                    1-19
              Physical  and Economic Damage Functions                   1-21
              Population at Risk                                        1-26
              Problems  of Measurement                                   1-34

            Chapter  3—Pollution  Control Cost Reduction
            Through  Process  Change                                       1-37
               Introduction                                              1-^37
               Impact  of Process  Change  Upon the Cost of  a
               Clean Environment                                         1-37
               Effect  of Environmental  Standards on the
               Rate  of Process Change                                    1-38
               Types of  Process Change                                   1-41
                            vni

-------
Section
                 Materials Changes
                 Process Modifications
              Costing Methodology
                 Costing at the Unit Level
                 End-of-Pipe Costs
                    Allocation of Reference costs
                    Waste Reduction and Revised Abatement Costs
              Economic and Environmental Motivations for
              Process Change and the Allocation of Cost Effects
              Costing at the Industry Level
              industry Survey
              Representative industry Evaluations
                 Copper
                    Process Changes
                    Industry Effects
                 Aluminum
                    Process Changes
                    Industry-wide Cost Reduciton
                 Pulp and Paper Industry
                    Process Changes
                    Industry-wide Cost Reduction
                 Petroleum Refining
                    Process Changes
                    Industry-wide Cost Effects
                 Inorganic Chemicals
                    Sodium Chloride
                    Sodium Carbonate
                    Titanium Dioxide
                    Chlorine
                    Industry-wide Cost Reduction
                 Generalizations
                    Range of Pollution Control Savings
                    Variations Within Process Change Types
                       Materials Changes
                       Process Modifications
                       Process Substitutions
                 Summary
                                     J-X

-------
Section                                                                Page

  II       SECTION II—THE ECONOMICS OF AIR POLLUTION CONTROL

           Chapter 1—Summary                                          2-1
              Government Expenditures                                  2-5
              Transportation Expenditures                              2-7
              Industrial Expenditures                                  2-8
              Comparison of Cost Estimates to the Last
              Cost of Clean Air Report                                 2-11
           Chapter 1—Benefits of Controlling Air Pollution            2-16
              Health Damages                                           2-16
                 Nature and Effects of Air Pollution
                 Damage to Health                                      2-16
                 Survey of Source Studies                              2-17
              Aesthetic Damages                                        2-22
                 Nature and Effects of Air Pollution
                 Damage to Aesthetics  '                                2-22
                 Survey of Source Studies                              2-23
              vegetation Damages                                       2-25
                 Nature and Effects of Air Pollution
                 Damage to vegetation                                  2-25
                 Survey of Source Studies                              2-26
              Materials Damages                                        2-30
                 Nature and Effects of Air Pollution
                 Damage to Materials                                   2-30
                 Survey of Source Studies                              2-30
              More Elusive Damages                                     2-33
            Chapter  3—The  Costs  of  Controlling Air pollution           2-40
               Introduction                                             2-40
               Government Expenditures for Air Pollution Control         2-41
                  Program Costs                                         2-41
                  Federal Program Costs                                 2-43
                  Expenditures by Other Federal Agencies                2-46
               Control of Emissions  from Stationary Sources             2-46
                  Classifications of Industrial Sources                 2-47
                  Costs  Related to Required Reduction in Air
                  Emissions                                             2-51
                  Reductions in Emissions Prior to the Clean
                  Air  Act                                                2-52
                  Reductions in Air  Emissions Required by the
                  Clean  Air Act                                         2-52
                  Coal Cleaning Industry                                2-62
                  Coal Gasification  Industry                            2-68
                  Natural Gas industry                                  2-73
                  Feed Mills Industry                                   2-76
                  Kraft  Pulp Industry                                   2-79

-------
Section                                                                Page

                 Neutral Sulfite Semichemical Paper industry           2-86
                 Printing Industry                                     2-89
                 Chlor-Alkalai Mercury Cells Industry                  2-92
                 Nitric Acid industry                                  2-96
                 Paint Manufacturing industry                          2-99
                 Phosphate Fertilizer Industry                         2-102
                 Non-Fertilizer Phosphorus Industry                    2-107
                 Sulfuric Acid Industry                                2-111
                 Petrochemicals Industry                               2-114
                 Petroleum Industry                                    2-120
                 Ferroalloy Industry                                   2-130
                 iron and Steel Industries                             2-133
                 iron Foundries Industry                               2-143
                 Steel Foundries industry                              2-145
                 Primary Aluminum Industry                             2-148
                 Secondary Aluminum Industry                           2-152
                 Primary Copper Industry                               2-155
                 Secondary Brass and Bronze industry                   2-160
                 Primary Lead Industry                                 2-163
                 Secondary Lead Industry                               2-166
                 Primary Zinc Industry                                 2-169
                 Secondary Zinc Industry                               2-173
                 Asbestos Industry                                     2-177
                 Asphalt Concrete Processing Industry                  2-180
                 Cement Industry                                       2-184
                 Lime industry                                         2-188
                 Structural Clay Products Industry                     2-191
                 Surface Coatings Industry                             2-194
                 Steam Electric Power Plants                           2-199
                 Solid Waste Disposal                                  2-211
                    Municipal Incinerators                             2-211
                    On-Site Incinerators (Commercial and
                    industrial)                                        2-212
                    Open Burning and Dumps                             2-213
                 Sewage Sludge Industry                                2-217
                 Grain Handling Industry                               2-220
                 Dry Cleaning Industry                                 2-224
                 Industrial and Commercial Heating                     2-227
           Chapter 4—Mobile Source Pollution Control
              Mobile Source Emission Controls                          2-233
                 Introduction                                          2-233
                 Review of Recent Factors Affecting, Mobile Sources     2-233
                 Light-Duty Vehicle Controls                           2-234
                    Emission Standards                                 2-234
                    Passenger Cars                                     2-238
                    Fuel Consumption Penalties                         2-243
                    Light-Duty Trucks                                  2-246

-------
Section
                    Fuel Cost Increases                                2-246
                    Aggregate National costs for Light-Duty
                    vehicle Emissions Controls                         2-247
                 Heavy-Duty vehicle Controls                           2-254
                    Emission Standards                                 2-254
                    Heavy-Duty Gasoline Engine Controls                2-255
                    Heavy-Duty Diesel Engine Controls                  2-258
                 Aircraft Emission Controls                            2-258
                 Di-scussion of Unregulated Mobile Source Emission      2-261
                 Transportation Control Plans                          2-266
                    Summary                                            2-266
                    Introduction                                       2-267
                    Overall Strategies.                                 2-270
                    Measures that Reduce Emissions  Per Vehicle  Miles   2-270
                        inspection and Maintenance Programs             2-270
                        Retrofit Control Programs                       2-274
                        Service Station Vapor Controls                  2-276
                    Measures that Reduce Total Vehicle Miles
                    Travelled                                          2-279
                        The Need for VMT Reductions                     2-279
                        Strategies to Reduce VMT                        2-282
                        Transportation Control  Measures to Reduce VMT   2-286
                        Additional VMT Reduction Measures               2-289
                        Costs -of Transportation Control Plans           2-289
                        inspection and Maintenance Programs             2-292
                        Retrofit Programs                               2-296
                        Service Station Vapor Controls                  2-298
                        Summary Costs                                   2-299
                        Cdst of implementing Measures tht Reduce VMT   2-303
   III       SECTION III-—THE ECONOMICS OF WATER POLLUTION CONTROL
            Chapter 1—Summary                                          3-1
            Chapter 2—The Benefits of Controlling Water
            Pollution                                                   3-11
               Health Damages                                           3-13
                  Nature and Effects of Water Pollution
                  Damage to Health                                      3-13
                  Survey of Source Studies                              3-13
               Outdoor Recreation Damages                               3-13
                  Nature and Effects of Water-pollution
                  Damages to Recreation                                 3-13
                  Survey of Source Studies                              3-14
               Aesthetic' and Ecological Damages                         3-16
                              Xll

-------
Section                                                                Page

                 Nature and Effects of Water Pollution Damages
                 on Aesthetic and Ecological values                    3-16
                 Survey of Source Studies                              3-16
              Production Damages                                       3-17
                 Nature and Effects of Water Pollution
                 Damage to Production                                  3-17
                 Survey fo Source Studies                              3-18
              Property value Damages                                   3-20
                 Nature and Effects of Water Pollution Damages
                 as Reflected in Property Values                       3-20
                 Survey of Source Studies                              3-20
           Chapter 3—The Costs of Controlling Water Pollution
              Introduction                                             3-27
                 Scope                                                 3-27
                 Assumptions                                           3-28
                    Federal Compliance Assumptions                     3-28
                    Wastewater Treatment Systems                       3-33
                    Stages of Treatment      •                          3-37
                    Nonpoint Source water Pollution Control            3-38
              Government Expenditures for Water Pollution Control      3-39
                 Program Costs                                         3-39
                    Federal Program Costs                              3-41
                       Assistance Programs                             3-41
                       Regulatory Programs                             3-42
                    State Program Costs                                3-45
                       State Role                                      3-45
                       Aggregate State Program Expenditures            3-46
                    Expenditures by Other Federal Agencies             3-46
              Municipal control Costs                                  3-47
                 Introduction                                          3-47
                    Defining and Measuring Need                        3-47
                    Defining Cost                                      3-48
                    Status of Public Sewerage                          3-49
                 Needs Survey Summary                                  3-54
                    Categories of Need                                 3-54
                    Results of the Survey                              3-55
                    Projected National Survey                          3-57
                    Time Phasing and Annualization of Costs            3-62
              Industrial Con.trol Costs                                 3-63
                 Introduction                                          3-63
                 Methodology                                           3-63
                    Cost Concepts                                      3-63
                    Modeling an Industry                               3-64
              Industry Cost Summaries                                  3-65
                 Feedlots Industry                                     3-68
                 Beet Sugar industry                                   3-75
                 Cane Sugar Refining Industry                          3-81
                                     X1J.1

-------
Section
                 Dairy Processing industry                             3-86
                 Fruits and vegetables Industry                        3-92
                 Grain Milling Industry                                3-98
                 Meat Processing Industry                              3-105
                 Seafood Processing Industry                           3-112
                 Leather Tanning and Finishing Industry                3-120
                 Textiles Industry  .                                   3-126
                 Builders Paper and Roofing Felt Industry              3-133
                 Pulp~, Paper, and Paperboard Industry                  3-140
                 Plywood, Hardboard.and Wood Preserving Industry       3-150
                 inorganic Chemicals Industry                          3-156
                 Fertilizer Chemicals Industry                         3-172
                 Organic Chemicals  Industry                            3-180
                 Phosphate Manufacturing Industry                      3-191
                 Plastics and Synthetics Industry                      3-199
                 Petroleum Refining Industry                           3-205
                 Rubber Processing  industry                            3-213
                 Ferroalloy Industry                                   3-223
                 Iron and Steel Industry                               3-228
                 Bauxite-Refining Industry                             3-239
                 Primary Aluminum Smelting industry                    3-244
                 Secondary Aluminum Smelting industry                  3-251
                 Primary Copper Industry                               3-254
                 Primary Lead Industry                                 3-264
                 Primary Zinc Industry                                 3-269
                 Asbestos Manufacturing Industry                       3-274
                 Cement -Industry                                       3-281
                 Insulation Fiberglass Industry                        3-286
                 Flat Glass industry                                   3-291
                 Pressed and Blown  Glass Industry                      3-297
                 Electroplating                                        3-303
                 Steam Electric Power Industry                         3-310
                 Soap and Detergent Industry                           3-317
   IV       SECTION  IV—A  COMPREHENSIVE ASSESSMENT  OF  POLLUTION
            CONTROL:  IMPACT MEASUREMENT UNDER  ALTERNATIVE  FUTURES
            Chapter  1—impact  Estimation  Using  the  Strategic
            Environmental  Assessment  System (SEAS)                       4-2

            Chapter  2—Scenario Assumptions                             4-4

            Chapter  3—Macro-Analysis Results                            4-8
               The Reference Scenario                                   4-10
               Comparison  of the Reference  and  Reference  Abatement
               Scenarios                                                 4-20
                             xiv

-------
Section
              Comparative Analysis for the Low Productivity
              Scenarios                                                4-32
              Comparative Analysis for the Energy Conservation
              Scenarios                                                4-49

           Chapter 4—Sectoral Analyses Results                        4-66
              Estimating the Reduction in Air Residual Generation      4-66
              Estimating the -Reduciton in Water Residual Generation    4-78
              Estimating the Cost of Pollution Control                 4-86
              Industry Investment                                      4-90

           Chapter 5-Estimating Pollution Control Costs                4-100
              Comparison of SEAS Investment Estimates for
              Air Pollution with Estimates of BEA                      4-100
              Estimating Significant Environmental Control Costs       4-101
                 Estimating Air and Water Costs for
                 industrial Sectors                                    4-102
                 Estimating Air Costs for Mobil Sources                4-102
                 Estimating Water Costs for Municipal Treatment        4-103
                 Estimating Air and Water Abatement Costs to
                 Government                                            4-104
                 Estimating Pollution Control Cost Impacts             4-105
                    Capital and O&M Impacts                            4-106
                    Employment impacts                                 4-109
                    Energy Impacts                                     4-112
                    Ranking of Sectors by Degree of Economic Change    4-113
                 The Dynamic Nature of Total Pollution Control
                 Expenditures                                          4-120
  Appendix A  THE SEAS SYSTEM
                                                         A-l

The Interindustry Economic Forecasting Mode (iNFORDM)    A-4
The Sector Disaggregation Model (INSIDE)                 A-7
The Abatement Cost and Feedback Model-(ABATE)            A-8
The Relative Commodity Price Mode (PRICES)               A-12
The Industrial Environmental Residuals Model
(RESGEN)                                                 A-13
The Transportation Models (PTRANS and FTRANS)            A-15
The Energy Use Model (ENERGY)                            A-16
The Stocks Reserves and Prices Model (STOCKS)            A-16
The Solid Waste and Recycling Model (SOLRECYC)           A-16
The Summary Report Generators (POSTCOMP,
INFRPT, and CLEANSUM)                                    A-17
  Appendix B  SCENARIO ASSUMPTIONS
                                                         B-l
                                     XV

-------
Section                                                                Page
              Reference Scenario                                       B-l
              Reference Abatement Scenario                             B-5
              Low Productivity Scenarios                               B-7
              Energy Conservation Scenarios                            B-8
  Appendix C  IMPACT OF INCREASED FEDERAL GRANTS FOR MUNICIPAL
              WASTEWATER TREATMENT                                     C-l
  Appendix D  ESTIMATING THE COST FOR INDUSTRIES TO CONTROL POLLUTION

              Cost Estimation Methodology                              D-l
              Industrial Segments:  Model Plants, Unit Costs and
              Growth                                                   D-2
                               xvi

-------
Section                                                                Page

                      ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS

Preparation of this combined air and water pollution control
cost analysis was an extensive  effort  made  possible  only
through  coordination  of  the  hard  work of many different
dedicated individuals.  The final product is the  result  of
expert   analysts  in  EPA  and  the  private  sector.   EPA
personnel and contractor personnel responsible  for  various
aspects of the report are listed below:


OVERALL REPORT MANAGEMENT,
INTEGRATION, AND REVIEW

  EPA:  Peter House, Roger Don Shull
  Control Data Corporation:  Rafael Ubico, Michael  Kranias,
     Cheryl    Herrin,   Thomas   Germack,   Bradford   Wing
     Consultants:  Matthew Barrett (Analytic Products Inc.),
     Lyman  Clark  (CONSAD  Corporation),  Jeffrey  Krischer
     (Johns Hopkins University)
WATER POLLUTION CONTROL
COST ANALYSIS

  EPA:  Donald H. Lewis, Richard K. Schaefer
  CONSAD Corporation:  Donald  McCartney,   Samuel   Hadeed,
     Forrest Arnold, William Carlson
     Consultants:  Richard Ralph Luken (Private Consultant)
  vanderbilt University:  Andrew Edwards
AIR POLLUTION CONTROL
COST ANALYSIS

  EPA:  Philip D. Patterson, Willard Smith, Tom Alexander
  Battelle Columbus Laboratories:  Philip  R.  Beltz,  Gabor
     Kovacs, Ted Thomas
COMPREHENSIVE ECONOMIC
ANALYSIS

  EPA:  Peter  House,  Edward  Williams,  Philip  Patterson,
     Samuel Ratick, Richard K. Schaefer, Richard H. Ball
  Control Data Corporation:  Rafael  Ubico,  Cheryl  Herrin,
     Kenneth Thompson, B. Scott Miller, Bradford Wing
  International  Research  and Technology Corporation:  Marc
     Narkus-Kramer, Richard Meyer
                                  xvn

-------
Section

  CONSAD Corporation:  Ronald Adonolfi


PROCESS CHAHGE ANALYSIS

  EPA:  Michael Hay
  International Research and Technology Corporation; James
     Saxton, Richard Meyer, Thomas Jones, Robert Cape 11
POLLUTION CONTROL BENEFIT
ANALYSIS

  EPA:  Fred Abel, Thomas Waddell, Dennis P. Tihansky
  Enviro-Control, Incorporated: Alex   Hershaft,     Theodore
     Heintz, Jr., Gerald Horak
POPULATION-AT-RISK STUDY

  EPA:  Fred Abel, Thomas Waddell
  Enviro-Control, incorporated:  Steve   Takacs,   G.   Bradford
      Shea
PRODOCTIOH COMPOSITIOS

   Control Data  Corporation:   Cathy   Blank,   Donna   Cloutier,
      Linda Luehrs,  Donna Selby,  Dav  Davisson
                             XVlil

-------
                        Section One

                          OVERVIEW
Chapter 1
This report begins with an overview section which presents a
discussion of those issues common to the study of  both  air
and  water pollution control.  The next two sections present
the  costs  of  pollution  control  for   air   and   water,
respectively,  together  with  estimates of the reduction in
environmental  pollution  effected  by  the  controls.   The
fourth  and  final  section  presents  an  analysis  of  the
economic impacts and tradeoffs associated with these  costs.
Particular  emphasis  is  placed  on  illustrating how these
impacts and tradeoffs might change under alternative sets of
assumptions  about  future  economic  activity  and   energy
conservation policies.

Included  in the overview (Section one) is a presentation of
the basic assumptions and  general  approach  taken  in  the
development  of  control  costs  and  in the analysis of the
consequent impacts of these costs.  This is  followed  by  a
discussion  of  the  concept  of  benefits as applied to the
economic  analysis  of  pollution  control.   Finallyf   the
economic advantages of controlling pollution through process
changes  are  presented.   Five major industries are used as
examples in  this  analysis:   Copper,  Aluminum,  Pulp  and
Paper, Petroleum Refining, and Inorganic Chemicals.

Both  Sections  Two  and  Three  begin  with a brief summary
followed by a discussion of the estimated types  of  damages
resulting  from  pollution.   In  Section  Two,  the cost of
controlling  air  pollution  is  presented   in   terms   of
government   program   expenditures,  industry  and  utility
control costs, and transportation  control  costs.   Section
Three,  on  the  cost  of  controlling water pollution, also
includes a presentation of government program  expenditures,
followed by municipal and industrial cost estimates.

A  comparative analysis approach is taken in Section Four to
examine the  relative  impact  of  pollution  control  under
alternative   futures   or   scenarios.   included  in  this
presentation is an  examination  of  the  gains  and  losses
experienced  by consumers and by individual industries which
spend and/or receive funds for pollution abatement.
                            1-1

-------
Wherever possible, the national pollution  abatement  costs,
the  economic  impacts  and  tradeoffs,  and  the associated
environmental.changes that have been estimated and presented
in this report  are  those  that  would  not  have  occurred
without  Federal  legislation.   Specifically, it is assumed
that,, in  the  absence  of  the  two  laws,  the  amount  of
pollution  discharged  per unit of production (or per person
for sewage, or per mile for vehicles)  would  have  remained
the same as in 1971.  A pre-legislation baseline, defined in
terms  of  1971 pollution control technology levels, is thus
established,  and  all  costs;   impacts,   tradeoffs,   and
environmental  changes are measured as.differences from that
baseline.
Problem Overview

Both the comprehensive assessment of pollution   control   and
also the industry-by-industry estimates of  pollution  control
expenditures  and  pollution  reduction are presented at  the
national   level.   Although  more   detailed  information   is
provided   in  some   instances,  this .information  is  presented
primarily   to   enhance   an  understanding   of    the    basis
established for the  national aggregated estimates.

Estimating  the   control   costs  and  the  quantities   of
pollutants produced  on a national   basis   is  a   complicated
process.    Not  only are there a  large number  of  pollution
sources, but each source could  emit a  number  -of pollutants
that   can   be   controlled separately  or  Jointly by  several
alternative control  technologies.   Conversely, each specific
pollutant   can  be   traced  to  a   considerable   number   of
different   sources.    The   costs   of   control  are most
conveniently estimated by source,  even   though they will
usually  cover  more than one pollutant  for each source.   On
the other  hand, levels of pollution are more  easily examined
by pollutant;  these   levels  are  estimated  by   aggregating
emissions  by pollutant across all sources  of  that pollutant.

A  general overview of the  relationships among   sample
sources, pollutants, effects,  and   control  technologies   is
presented   in   Table  1. Discussions  of  these, relationships
are found  for  each  industry  affected   by   Federal  pollution
control   legislation  in  Sections   Two   and   Three  of this
report.
                             1-2

-------
                                            Table 1.
                       Overview of  Sample Pollution Control  Relationships
                  Medium

                  A1r
i
u>
Source

Automobi1es
                             Industry
                                Sulfuric  Acid
                                Petroleum
Pollutant

NOx,  HC,  CO
                             Electric  Uti1ities    SOx
                                                  Particulates
                     SOx
                     HC
                                                                       Effects
                  Control  Technology
Smog,  Lung Damage   Engine Modification,
                  Catalysts

Respiratory Problems  Scrubbers,  Fuel
                  Swi tching

Soiling,  Reduced   Electrostatic
Visibility        Precipitators,  Filters
                     Respiratory Problems  Absorption
                     Smog              Floating Roof Tanks
                  Water       Municipal  Sewers
                             Indus try
                     BOD

                     Suspended Sol Ids

                     Pathogens

                     BOD

                     Suspended Sol Ids

                     Dissolved Solids

                     Acids

                     Toxics
                     Dissolved Oxygen   Oxidation,  Adsorption

                     Materials,  F1sh Damage Sedimentation,  Filtration

                     Infection         Disinfection

                     Dissolved Oxygen   Oxidation,  Adsorption

                     Materials,  Fish Damage Sedimentation,  Filtration

                     Materials Damage   Ion Exchange

                     Materials Damage   Neutralization

                     Poisoning         Adsorption

-------
Assumptions

The  Federal  pollution   control   legislation   ultimately
requires  industries,  consumers  (transportation vehicles),
and municipalities to lessen or completely  eliminate  their
discharges  of  pollutants  into the nation's atmosphere and
waterways.  Hence, these pollution contributors must spend a
portion of their money  resources  for  pollution  abatement
regardless  of the state of the economy.  However, pollution
control expenditures are not independent of the state of the
economy because the level of economic activity  affects  the
level  of  production,  which  in turn affects the amount of
pollution   generated   by   industries,   consumers,    and
municipalities.   Consequently,  the  forecasts of pollution
control expenditures are based on corresponding forecasts of
national economic activity.

Forecasts of pollution control  expenditures  must  also  be
based upon explicit assumptions about the rate of compliance
with  pollution control legislation.  The assumed timetables
for installing pollution abatement equipment are given iater
In this Introduction as part of the  compliance  assumptions
for' this  report.   All  cost  estimates  presented in this
report are expressed in 1975 dollars unless otherwise noted.
In addition, annual costs apply  to  calendar  years  unless
specified differently.
ECONOMIC ASSUMPTIONS

A  consistent   set  of  economic  assumptions  is  the  basis  for
the  cost   estimates  presented   in   this   report.     These
assumptions were  used to produce a "Reference Case"  forecast
of  the  U.S.   economy   and   are  summarized in Table  2.   An
alternative set of  economic   assumptions  is  presented   in
Section  Four;  the  pollution  control   cost  and  pollutant
discharge   estimates  corresponding   to    this    alternative
scenario   enable  us to  evaluate  possible variations  from  the
Reference  Case  estimates introduced   by   different   economic
assumptions.
 ENERGY ASSUMPTIONS

 The  energy assumptions for Reference Case pollution control
 forecasts are taken from the Federal  Energy Administration's
 "Business as Usual" scenario in the  November  1974  Project
 Independence Report where the import  price for oil is $7 per
 barrel; they are summarized in Table  3.
                             1-4

-------
                          Table 2.
            Reference Case Economic Assumptions
Economic
Assumption

Population-Series £
Projections
(Millions of People)

Labor Force
(Millions of People)
Labor Productivity
Gross National Product
(Trillions of
1975 Dollars)
Forecast Time Period
Unemployment Rate in
1985 (Full Employment
Economy)

Nominal Interest Rates
Federal Expenditures in
1980 and 1985 Excluding
Transfers and Pollution
Control Programs.
(Millions of 1975
Dollars)

Federal Expenditures
for Pollution control
Government
Agency

Bureau of the
Census
Bureau of Labor
Statistics
Bureau of Labor
Statistics

Council of
Economic Advisors
(1975-1980) .Bureau of
Labor Statistics
(1980^-1985)
EPA
Bureau of Labor
Statistics
Office of Manage-
ment and Budget

Department of
Commerce, Bureau
of Economic
Analysis
EPA
 Values

 1975-213.9
 1980-224.1
 1985-235.7

 1975- 93.8
 1980-101.8
 1985-107.7

 Varies by
 industry

 1975-1.47
 1976-1.57
 1977-1.69
 1978-1.81
 1979-1.85
 1980-1.99
 1985-2.40

 1/1/76 -
 12/31/85

    4.5%
 Public-10%
 Private-10%

1980-1156,400
1985-1173,400
                            1-5

-------
                          Table 3.
          United States Total Gross consumption of
       Energy Resources (in Trillions of Btu's/Year)
    (Business-as-Usual Without Conservation^7/Bbl Oil)
  Fuel              1972        1977        1980        1985
Coal               12,495      16,854      18,074      19,888
Petroleum          32,966      37,813      41,595      47,918
Natural Gas        23,125      21,558      22,934      23,947
Nuclear Power         576       2,830       4,842      12,509
Other               2,946       3,543       4,014       4,797

TOTALS             72,108      82,598      91,459      109,059

Source: Project Independence Report. Federal
        Energy Administration, Appendix Al, p.37,
        November 1974.
AIR COMPLIANCE ASSUMPTIONS

EPA regulations and Federal  legislation  related  to  the  Clean
Air  Act  of  1970  apply  different  levels  and  modes of  air
pollution  controls  to  these   specific  pollution  source
categories:   mobile   sources    (transportation vehicles),
existing stationary sources  of  air  pollution,  new stationary
sources  of   air  pollution, and  sources    of   hazardous
pollutants.   The  Clean  Air   Act  and   the  cost  estimates
presented in  this report are based  on   the  principle  that
pollutant  emissions will be brought  under whatever level of
control is necessary to achieve national primary ambient  air
quality standards.  However, for  many   different   reasons,
many   industries  have not  met the July 1,  1975, compliance
date   originally  set   for   existing   stationary   sources.
Similarly,  the original dates  and  standards established  for
transportation vehicles have been  changed.   The   specific
assumptions for each source  category  are described  below:

   1.  Mobile    Sources    (Transportation    Vehicles).     The
emissions   standards  .and  the compliance, schedule which must
 be met by  mobile  sources are presented   in  Section  Two  of
 this   report   (see  Mobile   Sources and  State  Transportation
Control  Flans).   The assumed compliance   dates  reflect  the
 delayed    implementation    of    standards   for    reduced
 hydrocarbons, carbon monoxide,  and  nitrogen  oxide  emissions
                             1-6

-------
from  light-duty  vehicles as proposed in 1977 amendments to
the Clean Air Act passed by both houses of Congress.

  2. Stationary Sources (Existing).  Stationary  sources  of
air  pollution (industrial plants, electric utilities) which
existed at the time of passage of  the  Clean  Air  Act  are
regulated  by  approved  State implementation Plans (SIP's).
The standards assumed for each industry  and  for  utilities
are  given  in  the industry summaries in Section Two of the
report.  Most SIP'S require compliance by July 1, 1975,  but
achievement of this goal would imply a peaking of investment
which  did  not  occur  in 1974 and 1975. -Hence, except for
sulfur dioxide control by electric utilities,  all  existing
stationary  sources  are  assumed  to  be moving toward full
compliance at an extended expenditure rate, as given in  the
Summary  for  Section  Two.  A compliance date of January 1,
1981, i-s assumed for sulfur dioxide from utilities.

  3. Stationary Sources (HewK  New sources of air pollution
include new industrial plants built since the passage of the
Clean Air Act and  also  existing  plants  which  have  made
certain  modifications  in  their facilities.  These sources
are assumed  to  comply  with  EPA  New  source  Performance
Standards  (NSPS)  except  where such standards have not yet
been developed or where SIP standards  are  more  stringent.
In  these  latter two cases, SIP standards are assumed.  New
pollution sources are assumed to be in compliance with these
standards when they go into operation.  The exact  standards
being  assumed  are  given  in  the  appropriate sections in
Section Two.
WATER "COMPLIANCE ASSUMPTIONS

Unlike the Clean Air Act, the 1972 Amendments to the Federal
Water  Pollution  Control   Act   prescribe   full   Federal
regulation of water pollutant sources, except as redelegated
to  specified  states,  in addition to setting ambient water
quality standards to be met by 1983, the Act  specifies  the
levels  of  control  technology to be utilized by industrial
and municipal pollution sources by July 1, 1977 and by  July
1,' 1983.  EPA has defined these technologies for most major
industrial  pollution   sources   in   effluent   guidelines
documents.   it  enforces the act through permit programs in
40 states, the remaining 10 having been delegated  authority
for  state  enforcement.   The provisions of the act and the
compliance assumptions for this report are enumerated below.
                            1-7

-------
1. Industrial Sources.

   a. industries discharging pollutants into the  Nation's
      waters  in  1972  will  adopt  the  best practicable
      pollution control technology  (BPT)  by  January  1,
      1978,  and  the  best  available technology {BAT) by
      January 1, 1984.  These dates have been pushed  back
      six  months from those specified in the act to allow
      the analysis  for  this  report  to  be  done  on  a
      calendar year basis.

   b. Industries for which BFT and BAT are not defined  in
      EPA   guidelines   are   assumed  to  adopt  control
      technologies similar to those of related  industries
      covered   by   the   guidelines.   Specific  control
      technology   assumptions   for    water    polluting
      industries  investigated by this report are provided
      in Section Three.

   c. Industries   discharging   their   wastewater   into
      municipal  treatment  plants must  (and it is assumed
      they do) pretreat their effluents so that industrial
      pollutants do not interfere with plant operation and
      do not pass through the  treatment  process  without
      adequate treatment.  Pretreatment technology must«be
      operating  by  January  1,  1978.   Pretreatment  is
      assumed to be unnecessary for those  industries  for
      which   pretreatment   guidelines   have   not  been
      prepared.

   d. All  new sources  of water pollution   (usually  plants
      constructed  since  1974) are assumed to comply with
      EPA  NSPS guidelines.

 2. Municipal Sources.

   Compliance with the Federal Water Pollution Control Act
   by   all   publicly   owned  sewage  treatment  plants  in
   existence on  July I,   1977,  would  require  them to
   achieve a secondary treatment level  for  all  effluents
   or   more stringent treatment  where required by water
   quality standards.  Because of  the   difficulty  facing
   the  municipalities in  raising capital and limitations
   in Federal construction  grants, treatment plants cannot
   be built at  a  fast  enough rate  to   assure  compliance
   with  the Act.    instead, it is assumed in this report
   that new plants  will- only  be  built  as  rapidly  as
   permitted by Federal appropriations  and state and  local
   matching funds, which  are proposed as shown in Table 4.
   These   capital  outlays   represent actual expenditures,
   which  lag behind  the   schedule  of   construction   grant
                           1-8

-------
     awards  to municipalities.  Section Three discusses the
     relationship between these appropriated funds  and  the
     expenditures  which  would  be necessary to comply with
     the act.

     These economic, energy, and compliance assumptions  and
     other  less  quantifiable  policy variables are further
     discussed in Section Four.
                          Table 4.
         Direct Capital outlays for Construction of
           Publicly Owned Sewage Treatment Plants
                 (Federal, State, & Local)
           (In Millions of Appropriated Dollars)
                    Fiscal Year          Calendar Year

1975                   2,773                3,201
1976                   3,628                4,499
Transition*            1,280
1977                   5,623                5,927
1978                   6,837                6,517
1979                   5,558                4,877
1980                   2,833                2,377
1981                   1,010                  907
1982                     598                  511
1983                     251                  251
1984                     251                  251
1985                     251                  251
* This "transition period" represents the months of
  July through September 1976; all subsequent Fiscal
  Years will run from October 1 through September 30
  of the following year.
  3'. Elimination of Discharge.

     Although Elimination Of Discharge (EOD) is specified as
     the goal of the Water Pollution Control Act,  it is  not
     currently  required  by  regulations  except   for those
     industries where BAT is the same as EOD.  consequently,
     EOD is not  assumed  for  the  pollution  control  cost
     estimates appearing in this report.
                            1-9

-------
                  POLLUTION CONTROL COSTS:
            DEFINITIONS AND CALCULATION METHODS
The  various  costs  presented  in this report are described
below, and the general approach used to  estimate  costs  in
each  of  three  major  categories  is discussed.  The three
categories   are   direct    costs,    government    program
expenditures, and indirect costs.
Direct Costs

The  expenditures  associated  with  acquiring,  owning, and
operating the buildings  and  equipment  needed  to  control
pollution  are  direct  costs.   These  costs  are  directly
incurred  by  industries  and   municipalities   to   reduce
pollutant  levels;  they include investment  costs, operation
and maintenance costs, and the costs incurred to borrow  the
necessary capital funds.
INVESTMENT COSTS

These  costs   include all expenditures  for  pollution  control
equipment  and associated  modifications   or   additions   to
buildings.    They   are  the   actual   cash   outlays  used   to
purchase and  install the  equipment   and  to   construct   the
buildings  or  building  changes.    In  the  case of  municipal
treatment plants,  the cost of building  the  whole plant  is an
investment cost for pollution control.  These  costs  do  not
include  those charges  made  by  a lending  institution  for
borrowing the money, nor  do   they  take  into  account   the
income tax writeoff benefits  which accrue to  an industry  due
to  depreciation.
 OPERATION AND MAINTENANCE
 (O&M)  COSTS

 The  annual  costs of operating and maintaining the pollution
 control  equipment and plant include expenditures for:

   1.  Materials used by the equipment (e.g.,  chemicals)

   2.  Labor for maintenance and repairs

   3.  Energy

   4.  Materials for repairs
                            1-10

-------
  5. Overhead

  6. Monitoring (labor)

  7, Byproduct credits.


TOTAL ANNUAL COSTS

Total annual costs are those costs  incurred  each  year   by
industry   or  government  (municipalities)  in  owning  and
operating pollution control equipment and plants.  They  are
the  sum  of  the  O&M costs for the year and the annualized
capital costs for the year.  Note  that  annualized  capital
costs  are  not  the  same as the investment costs discussed
above.  Annualized capital costs are derived  by  amortizing
the  initial  investment  over the life -of the facility, and
can be thought of as the annual amount needed to  repay  the
IQSUJ with interest over a specific time period.


COSTING METHODOLOGY

The  direct  costs  of  air  and water pollution control are
reported separately for each  source  and  source  category.
For   air ,  pollution,  the  major  source  categories  are:
(4.) stationary.; sources,   comprising   industries,   power
utilities,   and  space  heating;  and  (2) mobile  sources,
najD^Jy, automobiles, trucks, and aircraft.  The major source
categories for water pollution are: (1) point sources, which
include municipalities,  industries,  power  utilities,  and
runoff- from,  urban  areas;  and (2) nonpoint sources, which
include runoff from  mining  and  drilling  operations,  and
agricultual   crop  production  activities.   Because  urban
runoff and nonpoint-source pollution control is a  far  more
complex problem and an established regulatory procedure such
as  effluent permits is not yet developed, control costs for
these sources could-not be reliably  estimated,  and  hence,
are not reported in this document.

The  details  of  .calculating  costs  differ among the major
source categories.   in  general,  the  procedure  for  each
source is:

  1. Examine the regulations to determine  the  emission  or
     effluent standards, to be met.

  2. Select  from   the   alternative   technologies   those
     pollution   control  methods  that  are  likely  to  be
     employed.
                           1-11

-------
  3.  Estimate  the  cost  of   using  .these   methods   for
     representative units (plants, vehicles, etc.).

  4.  Multiply these unit estimates by the  total  number  of
     such  sources  in  the  nation  that are anticipated to
     require control in the  appropriate  year.   Thus,  for
     automobile emission controls, the cost of an individual
     control  system  is  multiplied  by the total number of
     automobiles estimated to be  sold  in  the  appropriate
     year with that system.

This . procedure,  which  is  more complicated for industrial
sources, is outlined below and is discussed more  thoroughly
in Section Four of this report:

  1.-Total industry production capacity  is  inventoried  or
     estimated.

  2. unique production processes within the  industry  which
     emit  differing  levels  of  pollutants  and/or require
     different control techniques are identified.

  3. For each production process, the  applicable  abatement
     control  technologies are identified and the percentage
     of plants using each technology is specified.

  4. For each control technology  associated  with  a  given
     production  process,  the percentages of plants covered
     by different state implementation plans  are  estimated
     (for air control cost calculations only).

  5. usually from one to three typical plant sizes for  each
     given  implementation  plan,  control  technology,  and
     production process combination within the  industry  are
     defined.   (This combination  is hereafter referred to as
     an industry segment.)

  6. The -capacity  for   the  industry  segment   is  allocated
     among  the  plant  sizes, and capital and  O&M costs are
     developed  for a typical  plant  of  each   size  in  -the
     segment, depending on  the standard it must meet.  'tThis
     depends  in • part  on  whether  it is a new or existing
     plant.)

  7. The-costs  are.applied  to all plants of  the   same  size
     within  the   segment;  then costs for  the different size
     classes are summed  to  obtain  total  capital  and  O&M
     costs   for  the segment.  This is done for each segment
     of   each   production   process  within   the   industry.
     Control    costs    for  the   industry  are  obtained  by
                            1-12

-------
     totalling all the capital and O&M  costs  computed   for
     the industry's segments.

The  costs  associated with building and operating municipal
wastewater treatment plants for  this  report  are  directly
related  to  the  Federal  appropriations and state matching
funds available to build new plants rather  than  costs   for
fully  meeting regulations as in the industrial case.  These
full costs have, however,  been  estimated  in  six  "Needs"
categories.   These categories relate to the Municipal Needs
Survey (Final Report to the Congress,  "Cost  Estimates   for
Construction    of   Publicly-Owned   Wastewater   Treatment
Facilities", February 1977}, which was conducted by  EPA  to
determine  the  physical facilities needed by municipalities
to adequately handle their sewage  treatment  problems;   the
categories are:

  •  Category I     -  Secondary treatment required.

  *.  Category II    -  More stringent treatment required
                       by water quality.

  •  Category IIIA  -  Correction of sewer
                       infiltration/inflow.
              IIIB  -  Major sewer rehabilitation.

  •  Category IVA   -  Collector sewers.
              IVB   -  Interceptor sewers.

  P  Category V     -  correction of combined sewer
                       overflows.

  •  Category VI    -  Treatment and/or control of
                       stormwaters.
Government Program Expenditure

Program costs which are incurred by governmental agencies in
carrying   out   pollution   control   legislation   include
expenditures  for planning, administration, enforcement, and
research grants.  These costs  are  incurred  at  all  three
1-evels  of government: Federal, state, and local.  The costs
of  constructing,   operating,   and   maintaining   control
equipment  owned by these governments are direct costs, and,
as such, are included in the air  and  water  program  costs
discussions in .Sections Two and Three, respectively.
                           1-13

-------
AIR PROGRAM COSTS

Government program costs for air pollution control have been
estimated separately for Federal and non-Federal programs.

Federal  programs  involve  two types of  funds: grant  funds,
which are passed on to state and local governments; and   in-
house  funds,  which  are expended by a Federal agency or by
its contractors.  Estimates of projected  grant  expenditures
are obtained from the relevant agencies,  primarily from EPA,
which  accounts  for  the  vast majority  of grant funds,  and
from the Appalachian Regional Commission  and  the  Department
of  Transportation, which account for most of the remainder.
Estimates of projected in-house expenditures  are based upon
Fiscal Year 1976 outlays.

The basic procedure used for estimating program expenditures
by  state  and  local governments makes use of available data
for 15  representative  states.   The  estimated  ratios  of
expenditures    for   various   functional  areas,  such  as
enforcement and engineering, are  first   derived  for  these
states and are  then applied to all other  states based  on  the
similarity  of  industrialization, geography,  population,  arid
general air pollution control policies.

In  general,  sources  of  data  for  projecting  government
program  costs   for air pollution abatement beyond  1979 were
not  available.    instead,  extrapolations  were  made  from
baseline  data  on  the basis of several reports  that provided
forecasts of  future  government  expenditures  for   specific
program components.
 WATER PROGRAM COSTS

 The  major  assumptions underlying the 10-year water program
 projections are:

   1. Future  year  estimates  are  a  continuation  of   the
      estimated Fiscal Year 1978 program level.

   2. NO new major legislative amendments will be made to the
      Federal Water Pollution Control Act.

 As with the air program expenditures, Federal water  program
 expenditures   are  divided  into  two  general  categories:
 Assistance Programs, which administer  Federal  grants;  and
 Regulatory   Programs,   which  include  all  other  Federal
 administration and enforcement expenditures.
                            1-14

-------
The  10-year  state  program  expenditure  projections   are
derived  from  the requirements under the 1972 Amendments of
the states to issue permits, review construction grants, and
monitor compliance.  Permit costs  are  developed  for  each
major  category  of  activity.   State  agencies  perform  a
variety of additional activities over and above those needed
to comply with Federal requirements;  the  expenditures  for
these  activities are not included here.  In addition, there
is no provision for program expenditures for nonpoint-source
control activities.
indirect Costs

indirect  costs  are  those   experienced   by   government,
business,  or  consumers  as  a result of having to bear the
direct costs of pollution  control.   The  added  industrial
costs  for pollution control must either be passed on to the
consumer in the form of increased prices or be  absorbed  by
industry  in reduced profits.  Where investment requirements
are high and profits are already low, some  marginal  plants
might  find  it impossible to continue operation in the face
of pollution  control  requirements.   The  resulting  plant
closures may thus result in local unemployment problems.

This  report  examines  some  of  the indirect macroeconomic
effects of pollution control at the national  level.   Thus,
Section  Four  presents an analysis of the impact of control
costs on aggregate production,  investment,  employment  and
other national accounts.

EPA's  Office  of  Planning and Evaluation conducts detailed
economic impact analyses for some major  industries:   e.g.,
Steel,  Electric  Utilities,  Nonferrous  Metals,  Petroleum
Refining,  Chemicals,  and  Pulp-and-Paper.   These  studies
cover  the  effects  of  current  and  proposed emission and
effluent   standards   on   prices,   profits,   production,
productivity,   plant  closures,  and  employment  for  each
industry, at both national and regional levels.
                  COMPREHENSIVE ASSESSMENT
The primary reason for assessing the  costs,  benefits,  and
impacts  of  air  and water pollution control resulting from
Federal legislation and regulations in the same report is to
make possible analysis of  total  impacts  on  the  economy,
including   changes  in  the  interrelationships  among  the
various  elements  and  sectors  of  the  economy.   Another
                           1-15

-------
consequence  of  the  combined  report  is the capability of
estimating the total pollution control costs  for  a  single
industry and their likely impact on that industry.  For  this
report,  a  comprehensive,  impact  estimation  and analysis
system has been used to examine the comprehensive  impacts of
"pollution control, at both  national  and  industry   levels.
This  system,  the Strategic Environmental Assessment System
(SEAS), is summarized in'Section Four.

Alternative  scenarios  are  run  with  SEAS  to   study  the
relative   consequences   of  meeting  Federally   legislated
controls under alternative assumptions about  the future.   A
comparative   analysis  procedure,  which  builds  upon  the
Reference Case forecasts described previously, is  then   used
to  assess  the results.  Sdenario assumptions, scenario run
results, and comparisons among scenarios  are presented in
Section Four.

As  noted  earlier,  pollution  control  expenditures  are not
independent of the state of  the    economy-.   Similarly,  the
impact   of   these   expenditures   on   the economy,  the
environment, and energy consumption depend  on  the   initial
assumptions  made  about  the  future in each  of these areas.
Hence, the objective  in  this  report  is  not  to   predict
exactly  what  the impacts of pollution control will  be  over
the next 10 years,  but  rather   to  conditionally  forecast
their   relative   magnitude   and  interrelationships.   The
analysis focuses on how impacts vary  as  basic  assumptions
about   future  economic  'activity  and  energy  policy  are
differentially changed.

The comparative analysis  scheme used to assess the  economic
and   environmental  impacts  of   pollution  control   in  this
report  takes  into account   that   various  experts  may   hold
differing  views about  future  U.S. economic growth,  economic
composition,  and  energy   consumption.   By  exploring  the
impacts  of   a  range  of   reasonable  assumptions about the
future, one  is able,  by   this   approach,  to  determine  how
sensitive  the  economy,  the  environment, and energy budgets
are  to alternative actions.
                     ALTERNATIVE FUTURES
 Assumptions for several alternative futures or scenarios are
 defined in Section Four of  this  report.   These  scenarios
 provide  the  basis  for  the  comprehensive  assessment  of
 pollution control impacts on the economy and the environment
 also presented in Section Four.  Although one  forecast  has
                            1-16

-------
been termed the Reference Case,  it  should  not  necessarily be
interpreted  as  a  prediction of the  most realistic  future.
Rather, it is the benchmark or reference against   which   the
comparative  analysis  was  conducted.   Assumptions  for  the
Reference case are essentially those enumerated  earlier   in
this  introduction.   They describe a  high productivity/high
growth-oriented economy where full  employment  is reached   in
the early 1980's.

Other  alternative  scenarios considered in Section Four  are
briefly described below.

  1. The LOW Productivity Scenarios.   These   scenarios   are
based  on time series projections of labor productivity from
1952 to 1971 made by the developers of  the INFORUM   input-
output  model  of  the economy used in SEAS.   They reflect  a
slowing  down  of  productivity  because   of   shifts   toward
service  industries  in  the  pattern  of   final demand,  and
because of a slowing down of the productivity  increase rates
in other industries.   GNP  estimates  which   correspond   to
these  assumptions  are shown in Table 5 compared with those
for the Reference Case.
                          Table 5.
      Comparison of GNP Estimates for Low Productivity
                and Reference Case Scenarios
                (In Trillions of 1975 Dollars)

                       LOW Productivity  Reference Case
                             GNP               GNP

        1975                 1.53              1.47
        1977                 1.65              1.69
        1980                 1.84              1.99
        1983                 1.99              2.23
        1985                 2.08              2.40
  2. The Energy  conservation  Scenarios.   These  scenarios
comprise  a  variation of the Reference Case in which energy
consumption  is  reduced   through   selected   conservation
measures.     It    is   based   on   the   Federal   Energy
Administration's   "Business-as-Usual   with   Conservation"
scenario  where  the  import price of oil is $11 per barrel.
(See Appendix Al, page  46  of  the  November  1974  Project
Independence Report.) The energy usage composition projected
by  Project  Independence  is not exactly matched because of
                           1-17

-------
differences   in   energy   demand   resulting   from    the
redistribution of monetary savings to consumers.

Two  scenarios are run and analyzed for each set of economic
and energy-related assumptions.  The first scenario in  each
case  is  used to develop a set of forecasts on the economy,
industry output, environmental residuals, and energy budgets
given no increase in pollution control beyond  that  present
in  1971.  The same parameters are then forecast in a second
scenario, with  pollution  controls,  costs,  and  equipment
punchases  superimposed on the original economic assumptions
as necessary  to  comply  with  Federal  legislation.   This
procedure results in six major scenarios:
                          Without                 With
                       Abatement Costs       Abatement Costs

Reference Case         Scenario 1            Scenario 2
Low Productivity       Scenario 3            Scenario 4
Energy Conservation    Scenario 5            Scenario 6
The   scenarios  are  then paired  for a comparative analysis of
relative  impacts  and   tradeoffs  in  the   following  manner:
 (1,2)   (1,3)   (1,5)   (2,4)   (2,6)   (3,4)  (5,6).  A subset of
Scenario  2, which assumes a  continuing appropriation   of  $7
billion a year  for  municipal sewage treatment  facilities, is
also   compared  with Scenarios 1 and 2.  In addition to these
analyses, which are presented in Section  Four,  Section One
 includes   a study of  the cost savings resulting from process
 change as compared  with Scenario 2 control costs.
                            1-18

-------
Chapter 2
The Benefits of
Pollution Control Programs
Pollution  control  legislation  has  traditionally   favored
rigid   standards,   either  to  control  the  discharge  of
pollutants into air and water or to maintain ambient  quality
levels.  While it was not possible to base such  legislation
on  an analytical estimation of the full benefits that would
result, its  enactment  reflected  the  judgement  that  the
overall benefits to society were great enough to justify the
necessary  costs.   Federal  legislation also recognized the
need for more elaborate and more accurate assessment  of  the
costs   and  benefits  of  such  programs,  both  for their
implementation and for future  consideration  of  additional
legislation.

The  purposes  of  such an assessment transcend the emphasis
often given to the techniques for quantifying  benefits  and
their  numerical results, important though they may be.  The
purpose of cost-benefit analysis is to provide the  type  of
information  on  the  value  of  public investments that the
market system provides on the value of private  investments.
However,  public investments usually have many objectives in
addition to those easily  measured  in  dollars  and  cents.
Still,  the  process of logical and systematic scrutiny that
is inherent in the accepted methods of cost-benefit analysis
can contribute greatly to society's ability to  improve  its
well-being   by  allocating  more  efficiently  its   limited
resources.

Thus, a major purpose of this  discussion  of  the  national
benefits   of   air  and  water  pollution  control   is  the
achievement of a more precise understanding of  the   nature,
sources,  and  approximate magnitude of such benefits.  Such
an  understanding,  when  shared  by  legislators,    program
managers,  and the public, may well be of greater value than
the numerical results themselves.
                   DEFINITION OF BENEFITS
Benefits of controlling air and water pollution derive  from
the  reduction of damages caused by air and water pollution.
The measurement of benefits is performed  in  terms  of  the
damages  that  would otherwise be incurred.  A basic concept
in benefit evaluation is willingness to pay,  which  can  be
defined  as  the  highest  price  that  individuals would be
                           1-19

-------
willing to pay to obtain the improvement  in  air  or  water
quality  resulting  from  a given pollution control program.
Benefits are evaluated whenever possible in  monetary  terms
because  it  provides  a  common measure of all the types of
benefits and  costs.   The  corresponding  economic  damages
result  in  o ut-o f-pocXet  losses  caused  by increasing the
costs of using air and water, by decreasing the level of use
of the resource, and by  increasing  costs  of  avoiding  or
repairing the effects of pollution.

Many types of benefits are not amenable to quantification in
monetary  terms because of their nature and the state of the
art of available measurement methods.  This is the case with
"psychic" damages, so labeled because  they  relate  to  the
pleasure  or  displeasure associated with the use of the air
and water  in  our  environment.   Psychic  damages  include
decrease  or  loss  of pleasure from the use of air or water
that has become polluted, and the  increased  experience  of
displeasure/  pain,  and  anxiety,  as well as the so-called
option, preservation, and vicarious  values  experienced  by
non-users.

Option  values  arise  because  people are willing to pay to
ensure the availability of clean air and water, even if they
are uncertain when  or  how  they  would  actually  use  it.
Preservation  values arise in a similar fashion, when people
are willing to pay  for the preservation of a resource,  even
when  they are certain that they will never use it directly.
Both  preservation  and   option   values   are   frequently
associated  with  a unique environmental resource, for which
no  substitute  exists.   Preservation  value  can  also  be
associated with risk aversion, in which a value is placed on
the   reduction   in  the  probability  of  the  loss  of  an
environmental resource through extinction of  a  species  or
collapse of an ecological system.

Finally,  the  term  vicarious satisfaction has been used to
describe the motivation of people who are willing to pay  to
provide  benefits   for their  fellow  citizens rather than  for
themselves, and bequest value describes the similar  benefit
derived  by individuals preserving an environmental resource
for  future generations.  Although all these  psychic  values
and   the  corresponding  damages  caused  by  pollution  are
currently not easily measured, they  apparently account  for  a
significant portion of the total value of pollution  control
to  society.

In    general,   estimation    of    benefits   resulting   from
alternative pollution  control programs  calls  for  four steps:
                            1-20

-------
  •  Estimate  the  amounts  of   pollutants   produced   by
     projected economic activity.

  ••  Estimate the remaining discharge of pollutants  to  the
     environment   after  imposition  of  specified  control
     measures.

  •  Estimate the ambient air or water quality that  results
     from  the  diffusion  and assimilation of pollutants by
     the environment.

  •  Estimate the nature and magnitude of resultant  reduced
     damages and the corresponding benefits.

The  first  two  steps  involve the projection of a suitable
economic scenario and evaluation of  the  cost-effectiveness
of   various   administrative  and  technological  pollution
controls.  The third step requires the use of complex models
of the diffusion and assimilation  of  specific  pollutants.
The  last  step relies on the development and interpretation
of  dose-effect  factors  or  damage  functions,  which  are
discussed in the next section.

Finally  to the extent that they were developed for specific
cases, estimates must  eventually  be  aggregated  over  the
pollutant/effect  combinations, geographic regions, and time
periods of interest.
                   PHYSICAL AND ECONOMIC
                      DAMAGE FUNCTIONS
A damage  function  is  the  quantitative  expression  of  a
relationship between exposure to specific pollutants and the
type  and  extent  of  the  associated  effect  on  a target
population.  Exposure is  typically  measured  in  terms  of
ambient  concentration levels and their duration, and it may
be expressed as "dosage"  or  "dose".   The  former  is  the
integral  of  the function defining the relationship between
time and  ambient  level  to  which  the  subject  has  been
exposed.   Dose,  on the other hand, represents that portion
of the dosage that has been instrumental  in  producing  the
observed  effect  (e.g.,  the  amount of pollutants actually
inhaled in the case of health effects of air pollution') .-

The effect can become manifest in a number of ways  and  can
be  expressed  in either physical and biological or economic
terms.   If  the  effect  is  physical  or  biological,  the
resultant  relationship is known as a physical or biological
                           1-21

-------
damage function, or a dose-effect function.   On  the  other
hand,  an  economic damage function is expressed in monetary
terms.   Economic  damage  functions  can  be  developed  by
assigning  dollar  values  to  the  effects of a physical or
biological damage function,  or  by  direct  correlation  of
economic   damages   with   ambient   pollutant  levels.   A
representative  economic  damage   function,   showing   the
benefits   corresponding   to   a   given   improvement   in
environmental quality, is presented in Figure 1.
                            1-22

-------
                        Figure 1.
                     Damage Function
O
o
LU
O

I
                                                  DAMAGE FUNCTION
  THRESHOLD
 WITH
CONTROL
PROGRAM
WITHOUT
CONTROL
PROGRAM
CONCENTRATION OF
POLLUTANT IN THE
AMBIENT ENVIRONMENT
                         1-23

-------
The S-shaped damage function is rather characteristic of the
relationships  between  pollutant  exposure  and   resultant
effect.  The lower portion of the curve suggests that, up to
certain pollutant ambient values, known as threshold levels,
there,'are  no  measurable  damages, while the upper portion
indicates that there is a saturation level (e.g.,  death  of
the  target  population),  beyond  which increased pollutant
levels do not produce  additional  damages.   Between  these
segments  is  a range where damages are roughly proportional
to the concentration of pollutants.

in  reporting  a  damage  function,  one  must  specify  the
pollutant,  the  dose  rate,  the  effect,  and  the  target
population, or the population at risk.  Dose  rate,  or  the
rate  at which ambient concentration varies with time, has a
major influence on the nature and severity of the  resultant
effect.  Long-term exposure to relatively low concentrations
of  air  pollutants  may result in manifestations of chronic
disease, characterized by extended duration of  development,
delayed  detection, and long prevalence.  On the other hand,
short-term  exposure to high concentration levels may produce
acute symptoms characterized by  quick  response  and  ready
detection.   Characterization  of  the population at risk is
considered  in more detail in subsequent paragraphs  of   this
discussion.

The   two principal techniques  for analyzing the relationship
between exposure and effect indices  necessary to construct a
damage  function are known   as  multivariate  regression  and
nonparametric or distribution-free estimation.  Multivariate
regression   is  b,y  far  the   favored  technique  because it
provides a  rapid indication of   the  degree  of  association
between   a   large  number  of  independent  and  dependent
variables   and  is   readily   programmable   for   computer
operation.   However,  its validity  is heavily contingent  on a
fairly precise  a  priori  definition  of  the relationship
between each independent   and  dependent   variable,   and on
precise measurement   of   the   independent variables.   Thus,
this   technique   is   especially  vulnerable   to    the    poor
precision   in  measurement  and  reporting  of air pollution
 levels for  a given   segment of  population.   Nonparametric
estimating   is   free   of  these assumptions,  but  it calls for
 laborious  data reduction for   each  of   the   many  pairs of
 independent and  dependent  variables, and  expert  judgement to
 guide  each  step  of  the  process.   Moreover, this technique
 requires  sufficient  data for  each   independent   variable to
 isolate  and  remove  the   influence  of   likely interfering
 factors.
                            1-24

-------
The data required  to  construct  damage  functions  can  be
obtained by the following approaches:

  •  Epidemiological or field studies and observations
  •  lexicological or laboratory investigations
  •  Market studies
  •  Delphi method
  »  Public opinion surveys
  *  Legislative decisions
  •  Litigation surveys.

The first two approaches  are  attuned  to  physical  damage
functions,  while  the  remaining  ones  are directed toward
derivation of economic relationships.

The first approach involves the comparative  examination  of
the  effects  of  pollutants on large segments of population
exposed to different levels of pollution in order to  deduce
the  nature  and  magnitude  of  the  likely  effect.  Field
studies and observations  represent  the  same  approach  to
assessment of effects on animals, vegetation, and materials,
and  they are characterized by similar analytical techniques
and  concerns.   lexicological  studies  involve  deliberate
administration  of  controlled doses of pollutants to animal
subjects, followed by observation of the resulting  effects.
Laboratory  studies  represent essentially the same approach
for  determining  effects  of  pollutants  on   plants   and
materials.

Two  considerations  need  to be noted about epidemiological
and field studies.  First, it is very important to remove or
control the influence of factors other than  pollution  that
may  be  responsible for the different effects observed.  In
the case of  health  effects,  for  example,  these  include
physiological,  genetic,  and  other  characteristics of the
population under observation, such as age, sex, race, family
medical history, occupational exposure, medical care,  state
of health, and nutrition.  When these characteristics cannot
be  factored  out,  it  is  frequently  assumed  that -their
distribution is  sufficiently  uniform  in  the  populations
under  observation  that  the basic results are not affected
significantly.  Secondly, epidemiological and field  studies
and  observations  can  only indicate an association between
exposure to pollution and the observed  effect,  though  the
impact  of  an  association can be strengthened'considerably
through evidence  of  consistency  and  specificity  of  the
relationship.  A causal relationship can be demonstrated, or
made  plausible  by toxicological and laboratory studies, or
by the construction of a plausible connective mechanism.
                           1-25

-------
Market studies, such as those investigating  differences  in
property  value  or  income,  employ  prices  or wages as an
indication of the values affected by  pollution,  and  their
usefulness has been demonstrated in a number of cases.  This
approach  is heavily dependent on the investigator's ability
to identify and isolate the many other factors  that  affect
the  value  of  property,  or other indicators used,  in the
Delphi method, the knowledge of a diverse group  of  experts
is  pooled  for  the  task of quantifying variables that are
either intangible or shrouded in uncertainty.   This  method
provides   an   efficient  way  to  obtain  subjective,  but
informed,  judgements.   Thus,  in  a  recent  project,  the
California   Air   Resources  Board  under  EPA  sponsorship
constructed a number of  dose-response   functions  based  on
expert opinions submitted by a group of  clinicians and other
health effects researchers.

Surveys  of  public  opinion  focus  on  estimating indivudal
preferences   and   demands.    such   surveys   have   been
particularly  helpful  in  understanding how attitudes about
pollution  are   formed   and   affected   by   changes   in
environmental  quality.  They can also provide an indication
of what people may be willing  to  pay   for enhancement  of
environmental  quality,  or  perhaps,  what their preference
might be   for  the  reduced  risk  of  experiencing  certain
adverse    effects.   Surveys  of  legislative  decisions  or
litigation awards can also provide   some  insight  into   the
perceived  value of pollution abatement.
                      POPULATION AT RISK
 in  the past,  it was customary to assess the severity of air
 pollution in terms of point-source emissions, and later,  in
 terms of ambient concentrations.   These indicators reflected
 the  progression  in  the  state   of  the  art  from  visual
 assessment of smoke plumes to increasing availability of air
 quality monitoring stations and associated  data  processing
 capabilities.     However,   the  real  significance  of  air
 pollution lies in its physical, economic, and social  impact
 on the affected population.

 Beyond  this,   characterization of the population at risk in
 terms of its potential susceptibility to various  levels  of
 air  pollution can provide useful indications for allocation
 of resources and setting  of  priorities  in  air  pollution
 abatement.  For example, a higher clean-up priority could be
 assigned  to  an area containing a large population of older
 people or those exposed to high occupational pollution  than
                            1-26

-------
to  another  area  with  a  smaller population of relatively
healthy people not otherwise exposed to harmful  pollutants.
This  procedure  can  be  refined further through control of
specific pollutants.

Since the importance of  characterizing  the  population  at
risk  to various levels of air pollutants became recognized,
there  have  been  several  attempts  to   obtain   such   a
characterization  through  crude  regional  estimates.   The
first comprehensive, national assessment was  only  recently
completed.  The major assumptions and findings of this study
are summarized here.

The  specific  objective of the population at risk study was
to calculate the number of people  in  selected  demographic
and  socioeconomic classes who are exposed to various levels
of several air pollutants.  This  was  accomplished  in  six
steps:

     Select air quality indices
     Select population indices
     Select air quality and population coverage units
     Obtain and process air quality data
     Obtain and process census data
     Calculate population at risk.

The pollutants selected were total  suspended  particulates,
sulfur  dioxide,  nitrogen  dioxide,  carbon  monoxide,  and
photochemical  oxidants.   The  air  quality  indices   were
expressed in terms of the relationships of pollutant ambient
levels  to  their  corresponding short-and long-term primary
standards.   They  were  divided  into  four  classes:  0-75
percent,  75-100  percent,  100-125  percent,  and above 125
percent of the corresponding primary standard,  in the  case
of  short-term  standards,  the 90th and 99th percent!les of
the observed values were found to be more useful  indicators
than the maximum values.

Human susceptibility and resultant response to toxicological
and physical stress produced by air pollutants is determined
somewhat  by  certain  intrinsic  traits, such as age, race,
sex, and general  health,  as  well  as  by  such  extrinsic
characteristics  as  employment,  income, educational level,
and  general  environmental  conditions.    The   population
classes selected for the study are listed below:
                           1-27

-------
     •   Age:                           *  Employment:

        - Under 19 years                 - Manufacturing
        - 20-64 years                    - Other
        - 65 years and over

     •   Race:                         •  Family income:

        - White                          - Under $5,000
        - Black                          - $5,000-$24,999
        - Other                          - $25,000 and
                                            over
Although  population information from the U.S. Bureau of the
Census is available for  the  entire  country,  air  quality
data,  stored  in  EPA's  Rational Aerometric Data Bank, are
not.  The gaps occur in the form of specific pollutants, the
short-term  or  long-term  values,  or   missing   stations.
Consequently,   this   study   dealt   with   241   standard
metropolitan statistical areas  (SMSAs),  which  cover  68.6
percent  of the population and 11.0 percent of the land area
of the United States.  Pollutant  ambient  levels  in  these
areas    were   derived   by   plotting   isopleths   (equal
concentration  contours)  between  air  quality   monitoring
stations  and by superimposing this display over maps of the
SMSAs.  The year of coverage for air quality data was  1973,
though the population information was based on the 1970 U.S.
census.

Finally,  the  population  at  risk was computed within each
pollutant and population class,  and  aggregated  to  state,
regional, and national levels.  The results are displayed in
tables   of   population  versus  air  quality  classes  for
different  combinations   of   pollutants   and   geographic
locations.    The   national   aggregations   for  all  five
pollutants are presented in Tables 1 through 5.

The  study concluded that the exposure of the U.S. population
surveyed to  short-term  particulate,  short  and  long-term
sulfur  dioxide,  and  short-term carbon monoxide levels was
within  the  respective  permissible  primary  air   quality
standards.   On  the other hand, significant portions of the
population surveyed  were  exposed  to  excessive  long-term
particulate   (31  percent),  long-term  nitrogen dioxide (24
percent), and short-term oxidant  (58 percent) levels.
                            1-28

-------
to
                 Arm United State*

                 AUPeUutofc  Tottl8u.pendedP.rtloul.te*
                                 Bbort Term - 80th poroonUU of 24 boar 461
106
188
18
114
47
2



U
52
1


18.1%
168
Long Term
<60
U,668
28,414
4,442
47,54*
4,817
664



i,m
10,644
864


26.2%
61,766
61-76
10,611
16,664
8.874
26,108
4.661
127



Mtt
6.017
4N


25.1%
80,188
78-86
7.064
8,186
l.WO
11,761
t,806
286



iU
1.116
186


87.8%
17.0S4
81-120
4,646
6,661
1,186
16,866
1,882
266



tat
1.187
141


26.8%
18,687
>1«
1,768
4,606
676
6,441
608
1H



JM
1.644
111


M.«%
7.486
                                                                                                                                                                         I
                                                                                                                                                                         c
                                                                                                                                                                         1-1
                                                                                                                                                                         Si
                                                                                                                                                                         ft
                                                                                                                                                                         !->•
                                                                                                                                                                         §
                                                                                                                                                                      r»  (u
                                                                                                                                                                      a  n
    £ N
 —- o  ft- Oi
-   S)
 o *-* or
 O    •<  H
 on     PJ
    c w  er


 M  » H-
 0)  D O  I-
 O  O> <9  •
                                                                                                                                                                   •^     y
                                                                                                                                                                      ^  0
                                                                                                                                                                      n
                                                                                                                                                                      0)
                                                                                                                                                                         I
                                                                                                                                                                          0)
                                                                                                                                                                          o
                                                                                                                                                                          rt-
                                                                                                                                                                          W

-------
                                                                                                                                                                                            3
                                                                                                                                                                                           •o
                 Area: United States


                 Air Pollutant! Sulfur Dfoxlda


                 Air Quality ladexi Short Term - 90th paroeoUla of 24 hour daU

                                  Long Term - Annual arlthmotlo mean
    §
u>
o
Population
CfaaraoterUttce
A. General
A(Bi 0-1*
20-6*
85 and over
BMWI White
Negro
All other
B. Ecooomlo
Annual family Inoomei
(thousand* of familial)
SO-S4.999
$8,000-«24.99»
$26, 000 and ever
C. Labor Force
Percentage la
fYftttpfrfa^^iy^My
D. Total Population
Air Quality L*v«l Cluieo - flg/n*
Short To rm
< 280

49,289
70,412
12,174
113,073
18.032
1,768



6,4(7
26,648
1,932


26.4%
131,880
281-366

62
93
19
161
IS
1



«
97
a


43,0%
174
aee-420

a
s
i
a
3
0



1
1
0


14.5%

>420

















Long Term
<«0

37,403
63,634
8.887
83.921
13,133
1,760



4.067
16,394
1.664


28.2%
99,884
61-80

399
6M
118
828
146
10



43
206
14


23.7%
1,083
81-100

W7
Sl«
28
383
15
t



13
80
t


M.»
410
>100

1
I
6
3
C
0



0
0
•


28.9%
2
                                                                                                                                                                                        W  rt
                                                                                                                                                                                        X  (D

                                                                                                                                                                                        0)  N
                                                                                                                                                                                    **•*  O  fD
                                                                                                                                                                                    H^  O*  Qj
O "<  H
       0)
to  w  tr
c  o  *~*
•-•  o  n
                                                                                                                                                                                    01  c
                                                                                                                                                                                        g
                                                                                                                                                                                               to
                                                                                                                                                                                           A)
                                                                                                                                                                                           3
                                                                                                                                                                                           CX


                                                                                                                                                                                           5?
                                                                                                                                                                                           a
                                                                                                                                                                                           O
                                                                                                                                                                                           R
                                                                                                                                                                                           01

-------
Area:  United States

Air Pollutant: Carbon Moacslifa

Air Quality Index: Start Term - 99th porcentlle o£ raM hour data
I
 t-J
 at
 rf
 H-
 o

 o
Population
6baracterUtic3
A» Ceaaral'
Ago: 0-18
20-64
85 and over
B»ce: White
Negro
All other
8. Economic
AnousI family tacoma:
(thousands ol families)
$0-§4,8PS
$5,000-^24,999
$25,000 and over
C. Lsbor Forco
S££
D. Total Popohmo*

Air Quality Level Clasaes - jjg/ms
<30

S7.35«
54,304
9,217
86,844
12,457
1,766



4,&36
19,788
1,610

24.7%
iW.SOT
41-46

246
420
88
606
127
21



33
149
IS

13.8%

41-SO

242
467
88
509
163
46



42
137
6

26.0%
748
>61

m
S&2
60
4BS
4T
44



IS
«4
S

«.n
KS
                                                                                                                                                                      W n-
                                                                                                                                                                      X (0
                                                                                                                                                                      18  N
                                                                                                                                                                  — .  
-------
                                                                                                                                                                      I
                                                                                                                                                                      (->
                                                                                                                                                                      01
Are»: United Kate*

AIT Pollutant: OMdaata

Air Quality ladext Short Tons - 99th peroeoUlo al ooo hoar data
PopuJntlaQ
ChtnctertiUoa
A, OenainU
' Af«: 0-19
20-44
68 nod over
B»o»! White
Negro
Alt ether
B. Eeotiomlc
Aamul family Incomes
(thooModa.of famiUea)
JO-W.998
$5, 000-134, M9
M5.000 «ad onr
C. Labor Foroa
Percentaga la
wflmtff ^*JM rime
ft Total Fopulattoo

Air XM

10,726
14,306
2,424
25.008
2.88i
MO



1,073
8,818
421


31.3%
M.4S5
    §

    n


    I
    s>
W  O
                                                                                                                                                                   OJ  H-
                                                                                                                                                                   m  N
                                                                                                                                                                   a, m
                                                                                                                                                               o  o  er
                                                                                                                                                               o     *<  »-3
                                                                                                                                                               O  SB      0)
                                                                                                                                                                   H-  w  tr
                                                                                                                                                              W  rt  O  >-•

                                                                                                                                                               1  O  H-
                                                                                                                                                               CO vQ  O  *•
                                                                                                                                                               o  o  ^  *
                                                                                                                                                               330
                                                                                                                                                               (JO     Q
                                                                                                                                                                   X  H-
                                                                                                                                                                   Cu
                                                                                                                                                                      Cb
                                                                                                                                                                      s
                                                                                                                                                                      I
                                                                                                                                                                      >1
                                                                                                                                                                      I
                                                                                                                                                                      o
                                                                                                                                                                      0)

-------
                                                                                                                                                           6)
                  Area; United State*


                  Air Mutants Nitrogen Dltuddo


                  Air QualitT Indezi Ixng Tirm - Annuml arithmetic mean
I
to
      H-
      O
      D


      O


      B)
      n
      a>
      o
Populattoe
CbanotoriaUoa
A. Generri
Age: 0-19
20-64
65 and over
Raoei White
Negro
Ail other
B. Economic
Annual family income:
(thousands of famlltea)
|0-»4,999
J5, 000-424. 899
$2S, 000 and over
C. Labor Force
Percentage in
nuufacturlnf
D. ToUl Populaden
Air Quality Level Claw* - pe/m3
<80

«,»68
9,034.
1,421
15,024
1,195
604



*SS
1.303
M6


13.1%
16,723
81-100

1,687
3,'4TO
472
3,948
666
24



193
905
63


30.1%
4,«3»
101-126

2,223
3,374
5S4
5,364
577
310



243
1,100
104


26.9%
«,151
>1»

220
4«0
90
536
US
52



35
139
21


27.0%
no
   W
   x
  .»a

   o
                                                                                                                                                           

                                                                                                                                                            a
                                                                                                                                                      o
                                                                                                                                                            5
                                                                                                                                                            1
                                                                                                                                                            ft)

                                                                                                                                                            •§-
                                                                                                                                                             o
                                                                                                                                                             tn

-------
                  PROBLEMS OF MEASUREMENT
Assessment of benefits of pollution control is  beset  by  a
number  of major difficulties that have a profound effect on
the accuracy and reliability of the benefit estimates.  Some
of these difficulties can be largely overcome with  the  aid
of available ancillary information, while others require the
expenditure of much additional effort.  Still others must be
dealt  with  by  indirect  estimation  and  other  imprecise
techniques.  The more important problem areas may be  listed
as follows:

  •  Collection of reliable ambient quality data
  •  Selection of exposure  indices  and  identification  of
     synergistic effects
  •  Selection of representative populations
  •  Measurement of effects
  *  Establishment of causal relationships
  *  Presentation of non-quantifiable  information
  *  Regional, demography and temporal extrapolation
  •  Consistent classification of  damages
  •  Double-counting and omission  of damages
  •  Assessment of damage reductions.

Collection of  sufficient air and water ambient  quality  data
requires   a very  large  number of measuring stations and  a
commitment to  measurement and data handling well  in  excess
of   the present  level,  because the problem  concerns numerous
point  and  nonpoint   sources  of  pollutants  discharging   at
irregular   intervals  into air and water.   Consequently,  the
available   data  seldom reflect   hourly,   or   even   diurnal
variations that  may  be  important.

Collection  of  useful   data  on   damages   and   their proper
attribution  to  exposure  to  specific  levels  of   various
pollutants  suffers   from  several  handicaps*    One  is  the
problem of selecting the proper   exposure   index  for   each
pollutant  in terms of  level, duration, and  presence of other
pollutants,  or  influence of meteorological  and hydrological
 factors.   Another  is the need  to  select  sample  populations
 that  are  representative of  the population  at  large  in  terms
of  susceptibility  to detectable  levels of   damage.    In   the
 case  of   health effects,  this  involves segregation  based on
 demographic and  socioeconomic  makeup of  the   population  at
 risk.

 A  third  difficulty lies in  measuring the resultant  effects.
 This is  especially  problematic   in  the  case  of   psychic
 damages,   such  as those associated  with health, recreation,
 aesthetics, option,  and preservation values.    Such  damages
                            1-34

-------
are  not  adequately  assigned  costs  by  the market system
because they are aspects of environmental  use that  are  not
owned  privately  or  exchanged.   Thus,   estimation  of the
corresponding benefits  requires  development  of  proxy  or
surrogate measures.

The  fourth and most formidable problem involves identifying
and documenting a causal relationship between exposure to  a
given  dose and production of a specific effect and deriving
the corresponding damage function.  The existing  literature
contains  estimates  for  only  a few discrete points on the
many damage functions of  interest.   In   order  to  produce
national  benefit  estimates,  it is frequently necessary to
make major assumptions about the shape of  the  damage  curve
on the basis of these few points.

Most  studies leading to the evaluation of damages resulting
from exposure  to  various  pollutants  address  a  specific
geographic  area,  population, and time frame.  Extension to
the national level and a more  recent  time  frame  requires
extrapolations   of  ambient  levels,  population  at  risk,
personal income, and increases in costs of resultant damages
due to inflation.  The classification of damages, for  which
the data are collected, is often dictated  by availability of
sources and analytical expediency, rather  than a uniform and
self-consistent  framework.  Consequently, different studies
evaluate damages that are not necessarily additive  or  even
comparable,  and  any  effort  to reconcile or aggregate the
results of such  studies  must  apply  careful  interpretive
techniques  to prevent gross overlaps or omissions of damage
estimates.   Moreover,  in   aggregating   such   fractional
results,  it  i's  not  currently  possible  to  reflect  the
potential impacts of changes in one pollutant or one  region
on  the  damages  caused  by  other  pollutants  or in other
regions, nor has it been possible to reflect the  impact  of
the  general adjustments the economy would make to pollution
control programs and the resulting reduction in damages.

Finally, with effective abatement, the estimate of  benefits
associated  with  a  given level of pollution control can be
expressed  in  terms  of  the  corresponding  reduction   of
damages.   This  step, in turn, requires the definition of a
quantitative  relationship  between  reduced  emissions  and
resultant  ambient levels, as well as between these improved
ambient  levels  and  reduced   damages.     Development   of
pollutant  transport  and  dispersion  models describing  the
first set of relationships has been only  partly  successful
because  of  the many ill-defined variables involved.   Thus,
it is commonly  assumed  that  the  fractional  decrease   in
ambient levels is essentially proportional to the fractional
reduction  of emissions.   The second set of relationships is
                           1-35

-------
defined by the damage functions discussed earlier.  The unit
damages obtained from a damage curve are converted to  total
damages  through  multiplication  by  the number of units at
risk and the cost-per-unit damage, as appropriate.

Thus, assessment of benefits associated with a  given  level
of  pollution  control is still most assuredly an art, which
permits divergent interpretation of available data that  may
lead to widely differing results.  For this reason, although
certain studies on air and water pollution damages are cited
in   Sections  Two  and  Three,  national  aggregate  damage
estimates are not presented in this report.
                            1-36

-------
Chapter 3
Pollution control Cost Reduction
Through Process Change
                        .INTRODUCTION
Opportunities for air and  water  abatement  cost  reduction
through  process  change  were identified for 40 industries.
Five industries were examined in detail:  copper,  Aluminum,
Pulp  and  Paper, Petroleum, and Inorganic Chemicals,  using
Reference case abatement costs developed in sections Two and
Three as a baseline,  the  extent  of  reduction  achievable
through  specific process change candidates in each industry
was determined.  The relative savings in accumulated capital
expenditures through 1985 in the five industries  are:  14.5
percent,  9.6  percent,  10.1 percent, 12.0 percent, and 2.5
percent.  The analogous savings in annualized costs for 1985
are: 35.0 percent, 11.0 percent, 28.5 percent, 24.0 percent,
and 25.0 percent,  when these savings are assessed in  terms
of  their  applicability  to  opportunities  in the other 35
industries, the total capital and annualized cost reductions
for all 40 industries relative to Reference  Case  abatement
costs  are  estimated  to be (in percentage reductions): 1.2
percent and 9.9 percent.
Impact of Process Change Upon
the Cost of A Clean Environment

Pollution  control  legislation  and   associated   effluent
guidelines  require  that industry attain specific levels of
pollutant control.  The mechanism for achieving these levels
is left to the discretion  of  each  industry.   The  simple
approach  is  to  add  treatment steps to the process at the
points of  waste  emission,  which  are  termed  end-of-pipe
control.   The costs associated with these end-of-pipe (EOP)
steps furnish an economic motive for waste-reduction process
changes.  If a net abatement cost reduction can be  achieved
through  process  change  relative  to  that  process  or  a
competing  process  employing  end-of-pipe   treatment,   an
incentive  for  process  change  exists.   This  concept  is
evidenced in the generic types of process change in the more
advanced standards (BAT, BPT, NSPS).  For  example,  process
changes   designed  to  reduce  water  requirements,  permit
greater water reuse,  and  minimize  leaks  and  spills  are
included in the compliance strategies recommended in the EPA
effluent   guideline   development  documents;  considerable
evidence  exists  to  indicate  such  potential.   Exemplary
                           1-37

-------
plants   in  many  industries  do  operate  at  much  higher
efficiencies than  the  corresponding  typical  plants,  and
plant modernizations have been able to substantially improve
abatement   efficiency   at  a  reasonable  cost.   In  this
discussion, emphasis  is  placed  upon  assessing  the  cost
reductions  achievable  through  process  changes other than
those included in the Reference Case of Section Four.

A number of important distinctions must be made.  There  are
important  differences between what can be achieved in a new
plant  as  compared  with  the  upgrading  of  an   existing
facility.   In  some instances, it is less costly to abandon
an existing facility and build a  new  one  than  it  is   to
convert  the  older  facility.   in  such a case, nearly all
capital  associated  with  the  abandoned  plant   must    be
forfeited.   When  conversion  of  the  existing facility  is
reasonable, the capability to do so may be  unevenly  spread
across  the  industry.   The  larger firms have both greater
technological capability and  financial  reserves  than  the
smaller    firms.    Thus,  even  a  technologically-feasible
retrofit   process  change  may  have  considerable  economic
impact.

Such  economic  considerations  are  well  Known.   They are
restated here to emphasize   their  importance   in  assessing
process change as  a method of reducing end-of-pipe treatment
requirements.  A final general comment of this  type pertains
to  tax considerations.  If a tax benefit is granted EOF-type
investment and not those related to process change, there  is
an  incentive  to pursue the former course.

This  discussion   identifies the type of savings  that may  be
achieved through process change.   The  estimates  made  are
intended   to  be   indicative rather  than  exact; i.e.,  the
analysis objective is  to establish reasonable  bounds  between
which the  impact of process  change can  be  evaluated.    The
reference   cases   for  comparison  are  the   industry   costs
established in  Sections Two  and  Three of  this   report.    The
measure  of  the economic  benefit  from  the process  change  is
the extent to which the pollution  control   savings  relative
to  the  Reference  Case   exceed  the   costs  incurred  in  the
process  change.   The  industry-wide  savings   are  derived   by
 identifying   the   extent  of   industry  acceptance   of   the
designated process change.
 Effect of Environmental Standards
 on the Rate of Process Change

 in considering the effect of  environmental  regulations  on
 industry's   acceptance   of  process  change,  it  must  be
                            1-38

-------
remembered that this relationship  takes  place  within  the
framework  of industry's overall investment decisions.  Most
industries have a tacitly expressed, minimum acceptable rate
of return.  Below this level, investment is not believed  to
enhance   a   company's   financial   position,   and  other
considerations, such as liquidity, may predominate.  Whether
or not  sufficiently  lucrative  opportunities  exist  often
depends  on  the  investment  climate,  which in turn may be
heavily  influenced  by  interest  rates,   current   market
behavior,  etc.  Even under favorable investment conditions,
corporations have limited capital resources.   Consequently,
they  must  select  among  investment  options,  seeking the
opportunity most likely to bring a high, reliable return  on
venture capital.

Comparison  of  investment opportunities is conducted on the
basis of comparative profitability.  A piece  of  equipment,
like a furnace, will process a given product throughput over
a  specified  lifetime.  The value of this production, based
on projected prices, is compared against the capital outlays
required to build and operate the unit; ancillary costs  and
benefits  must  be included in this comparison.  An existing
furnace has an established set of operating  specifications:
energy  requirements,  recovery  efficiency,  etc.   If  the
challenging process can reduce energy needs,  the  operating
savings  that  result  are  included  in  the  profitability
comparison.

In addition,  an  attempt  should  be  made  to  assess  the
"venture  risk"  involved in the investment; an example is a
shoe manufacturer's investment in a line of ski boots.   The
investor  understands that an unseasonally warm winter might
cut his sales prospects in half.  This estimate of  risk  is
taken  into  account  in  determining  the desirable rate of
return.  Venture risk similarly applies to the  introduction
of  new  processes,  where  the  firm  takes a risk that the
process will not live up to expectations.

In a highly competitive market, the  costs  associated  with
end-of-pipe  control  may  be so high that firms cannot pass
them on as higher  prices  without  losing  competitiveness.
These   plants   must  either  develop  alternative  control
strategies that can be implemented at an acceptable level of
cost, or  close  their  doors.   In  these  cases,  in-plant
controls can truly be said to be environmentally inspired.

However,   environmental  regulations  can  also  indirectly
affect investment decisions by altering the profitability of
certain options.  Existing facilities will  have  additional
capital  and  operating  costs  associated  with end-of-pipe
treatment  of   its   wastes,   assuming   compliance   with
                            1-39

-------
environmental   standards.   in-plant  changes  that  reduce
treatment costs will be treated like any  other  benefit  in
profitability calculations.

Abatement  costs  can  affect  the process trends that would
have   developed   in   the   absence    of    environmental
considerations  in  a  variety of ways.  The additional cost
can tip the scales in favor of a project that  was  formerly
less  profitable.  Alternatively, it can further improve  the
profitability   of   an   already    preferred    investment
opportunity,  thereby accelerating its rate of acceptance by
the industry.  It is important to realize that in both these
events the environmental regulations are only one of  several
motivating factors; the abatement savings  are  not   usually
sufficient to justify investment unless other advantages  are
gained  as well.  This fact becomes relevant when allocating
the portion of cost savings attributed to the  environmental
regulations.

On  the other hand, environmental investments do involve  one
special   circumstance    that   vitally   increases    their
importance.  Traditional  decisions on an investment,  such as
capacity  expansion,  offer  a firm three choices: expansion
using  proven  technology,  expansion  using  a  challenging
process,  or  no  expansion.  By law, abatement decisions do
not permit the third path of inaction to be taken; either an
alternative abatement strategy must be found, or the  present
plant  abated  through  end-of-pipe  methods.   Furthermore,
expenditures  on  equipment with the sole function of  control
yield  no direct  economic  return  to  the    corporations.
Consequently,  firms may  be receptive to strategies that  can
attain abatement  objectives while in some way improving   the
processing efficiency of  the plant.

Before   proceeding,  two   cases  should  be   noted   in which
environmental regulations do  not  affect   general   process
trends.    The   first   case is  where  little  difference exists
between  the  abatement  costs  for  the  two  processes.    If  a
relatively  new   process   is only marginally 'more profitable
after  'subtracting   venture  risk   than    the   established
 technology,   most  companies'  will  retain  the proven  profit-
maker.   This is  important in  the present  discussion   because
 the'time frame  in which alternatives  to EOF treatment can be
 undertaken  is   very  short.    In  the  second case,  a process
 that has to pay  much higher  abatement  costs may remain  more
 profitable than  its competitor,  'in this  case,  the  "dirtier"
 process   will  continue  to  be substituted  for  the  "cleaner"
 process.  This   process  change   will   have  the  effect  of
 increasing total industry abatement'costs.
                            1-40

-------
Types of Process Change

A  survey  was  conducted  within 29 polluting industries to
identify  those  process  changes  that   have   significant
pollution treatment implications.  Three major categories of
process   change   were  found:  material  changes,  process
modification, and process substitutions .  An additional  and
important  type  of change exists that, while not associated
with a specific process, affects the control costs for  each
process.     These   are   plant-wide   changes,   such   as
housekeeping, coordinated water usage by a set of  processes
to  achieve  a  net  reduction  in water usage, etc.  in the
following discussion, plant-wide changes  are  addressed  in
terms of their effect on individual processes.
MATERIAL CHANGES

Material  changes include modifying the nature or quality of
raw materials employed or adjusting  the  specifications  of
the  product produced.  For example, use of natural Trona as
a source of sodium carbonate obviates the  large  quantities
of  waste  generated  by  Solvay process synthesis of sodium
carbonate from salt and limestone.  Likewise, use of  rutile
rather  than  ilmenite in the production of titanium dioxide
significantly  reduces  waste  quantities.    Alternatively,
synthetic   rutile  can  be  generated  by  pretreatment  of
ilmenite.  Recycled or secondary material  inputs  are  also
important.    For   example,  increased  aluminum  recycling
circumvents the waste produced  during  bauxite  processing.
An   example  of  a  product  specification  change  is  the
incorporation of a portion of process waste sludge in  paper
products not requiring high brightness.

Often,  material  changes  are made on the basis of economic
considerations .related  to  materials  availability.    For
example,  domestic  bauxite is of lower quality than bauxite
imported from Jamaica, Surinam,  or  Australia;  hence,  the
majority  of bauxite consumed in the United States each year
is imported.  However, if the countries of origin  are  able
to   establish   a   higher   bauxite  price,  the  domestic
alternative will appear more desirable.  Such  a  change  in
material  input  will  affect  the  nature  and increase the
quantity of wastes generated.  Another  example  relates  to
the use of rutile in titanium dioxide production, as already
discussed.   Rutile, possessing a higher titania content, is
predominantly,   imported   from   Australia,   while   large
quantities  of  ilmenitejore exist in the United States.  An
adjustment could be made in the event rutile  became  either
hard  to  obtain or highly priced.  Again, the nature of the
waste stream would change.
                           1-41

-------
Crude oil quality also varies with its point  of  geographic
origin.   For  example,  Middle Eastern crudes have a higher
sulfur content than  domestic  crudes,  and  the  percentage
usage  of the former is increasing.  Meanwhile, restrictions
on the sulfur content of fuel oil for consumer  use  require
that  the  refinery,  which  is  now dealing with additional
sulfur in its  primary  raw  materials,  reduce  the  sulfur
content  in  its  final  product.   This  change  in product
specifications directly affects  the  amount  of  processing
required, and, hence, the pollution-control related costs.

Environmental  considerations  are  only  one of the factors
impinging  upon  the  selection  of   raw   material    type.
Nevertheless,  the  nature  of the raw material utilized  can
have a direct effect upon the costs of pollution abatement.
PROCESS MODIFICATIONS

Three  types of  process modification were  identified:  revised
process operation,  byproduct  recovery,  and   process-specific
waste  treatment.

   1. Revised   Process  Operation.   This   category  includes
     those  process modifications  made   in  an   effort   to
     improve  process economics.   The  principal attribute   is
     that   in some  way the  efficency  of the central  reaction
     is improved, i.e.,  greater  quantities   of the   desired
     products   and   lower   quantities   of  pollution  are
     generated per  unit  of   input material.   This   may   be
     accomplished by changing the temperature or  pressure of
     the  reaction, extending  or  shortening the residence
     time,  improving reactant  mixing,   introducing   a more
     stable   catalyst,    increasing    recycle   quantities,
     reducing water  use,   or  invoking  real-time  computer
     control.  In some cases, optimal process operation when
     pollution  control   is  required  will differ from that
     when such control  is  not required.  Usually, a   complex
      linear  programming  scheme  is required to balance  the
     many  factors   involved  in  identifying  the   optimal
      performance,    and    this   determination  is  strongly
      affected by the character of the  input  materials,   as
      previously discussed.  ,

   2. Byproduct Recovery.  The recovery of a salable  material
      from the process waste stream is an obvious  and  often
      mentioned  method  of simultaneously reducing the waste
      load and at least partially compensating for the  costs
     .involved.   However,  the opportunity to profitably sell
      such recovered  materials  is  sometimes  elusive.   An
      extreme  example  is  the  recovery  of  sulfur and its
                            1-42

-------
     various   compounds   as   pollution   control.     The
     marketplace may be unable to accommodate the quantities
     of  sulfur  to be made available.  Hence, extraction of
     sulfur from the air and water waste stream could merely
     serve to transform the  sulfur  into  a  more  readily-
     controlled  solid  waste.   Attempts  are  underway  to
     expand the market for sulfur compounds  by  identifying
     new applications, but there may be limits to the amount
     of market expansion possible.

     In  many  cases,  recovered  material  can  be  put  to
     profitable use.  Frequently, the application is an  in-
     plant  use  of  the  recovered  material  to  perform a
     function that previously required  a  purchased  input/
     (e.g., heat and fiber reuse in the paper industry).  In
     addition,   industrial   complexes   are  beginning  to
     cooperate in using each other's waste  streams  when  a
     desired attribute is present.

  3. Process-Specific Treatment.  This process  modification
     is  the  treatment of process waste prior to merging it
     with the waste streams of other processes  for  end-of-
     pipe  treatment.   In  general,  the process waste must
     have some specific attribute that necessitates a unique
     treatment  step;  otherwise,  the  economies  of  scale
     associated with end-of-pipe treatment prevail.

Process Substitution. Process substitution is differentiated
from  process  modification  in that a fundamental change is
made to the central reaction step.  For example, going  from
the   mercury   cell  to  the  diaphragm  cell  in  chlorine
production and from  the  open-hearth  to  the  basic-oxygen
furnace  in - steel production are process substitutions.  For
comparison, changing the reaction conditions, enlarging  the
reactor,  or  adding ancillary process equipment are process
modifications.

Process substitutions are  an  extremely  important  process
change  category  in  terms  of  their effect upon pollution
control  requirements.   A  recent  study  of  solid   waste
generation^  showed  that for 17 of the 34 largest producers
of process solid waste among industrial chemicals, a process
substitution was underway or had already  taken  place.   in
each  case, the amount of solid waste generated was reduced.
As process efficiencies are improved, the yield of the  main
product   goes  up  and  the  quantity  of  waste  generated
correspondingly  goes  down.   In  addition,  the  remaining
wastes  tended  to  be  easier  to  treat.   Usually, wastes
associated with the raw materials  can  be  segregated  with
comparative  ease.   The  ones produced during the principal
                           1-43

-------
reaction, however, are generally closely associated with the
main product, and hence, are more difficult to separate.
                    COSTING METHODOLOGY
The industry Survey analysis, which appears   later   in   this
discussion,  disclosed  a number of promising process change
opportunities.   These  opportunities  were   evaluated    to
determine  the  extent  to which such process changes can  be
expected to reduce pollution control costs relative  to  the
Reference  Case,  primarily  an end-of-pipe approach.  To  do
this,  five  representative  industries  were  selected   that
together  illustrate  the  various  modes of process change.
Specific  process  change  candidates,  ranging    from   the
modification  of  a single processing step to replacement  of
an entire process, were examined.  "For each challenging  and
defending  process,- total unit costs  (process +  end-of-pipe)
were calculated.  The capital  requirements   and  annualized
costs  of  the  changed  operation  were compared  with costs
developed for the Reference case discussed in Section Four.
 Costing  at  the Unit  Level

 A new process may be related  to existing  operations  in  one
 of three ways:

   1.  It  can be basically interchangeable  with  part  of  the
      existing  plant,   with  potential  for both retrofit and
      new plant   applications.    (Examples:   Continuous  and
      batch   digesters,  oxygen   paper  processes,   flash and
      reverberatory furnaces.>

   2.  It   can be  basically   incompatible   with    in-place
      facilities    and  represent  an  alternative  for  new
      capacity only.   (Examples: Hydrometallurgy, dry forming
      of  paper.)

   3.  It  can be  basically additive in nature,  with  no  unit
      serving a   comparable  function in  the present process
      scheme.  (Examples!   Byproduct  recovery  units,  spill
      containment systems.)

 Each  of  these   relationships calls for  a different type of
 comparison  of  basic process costs.  Table 1 diagrammatically
 represents   the   basis  for  comparison  in  each   of  these
 situations.
                            1-44

-------
                          Table 1.
             Nature of Process Cost Comparisons
                                   Relevant Cost Parameters

                                Old         vs.      New
                                Process              Process

                 Retrofit       O&M                  Capital,
                 Application                         O&M
1.  inter-
    changeable   New plant      Capital,             Capital,
    Processes    Application    O&M                  O&M

2.  Alternative                 Capital,             Capital,
    Processes                   O&M                  O&M

3.  Additive                    None                 Capital,
    Processes                                        O&M
Values  for  capital,  operation  and  maintenance  (O&M) and
annualized costs were obtained  from  available  engineering
cost estimates.  Capital costs represent the installed costs
of  process equipment; this figure includes actual  component
costs  plus  expenditures  for   engineering   plans,   site
preparation,   and   construction   of  necessary   auxiliary
facilities.  Startup costs and penalties for plant  shut-down
time have not been included, because these values tend to be
very plant specific.  The operation and maintenance category
includes:  materials,  taxes  and  insurance,   direct   and
indirect  labor,  and  maintenance.  "Annualized  costs  are
defined as O&M costs plus depreciation on capital investment
(calculated at 10 percent of the unpaid principal  per  year
and  'normalized  over  the capital lifetime).  All  costs are
developed  for  specific  plant  configurations,  or   model
plants.   Where  competing units exhibit different  economies
of scale, more than one model size was used.

Sources  of  process  cost  estimates   included   technical
journals>  EPA economic impact studies, and other government
publications, such as Bureau of Mines Information Circulars.
The available materials frequently had to be converted to  a
form  applicable  to  cost comparison at the unit level.  In
some eases,  simplifying  assumptions  were  employed.  • For
example:
                           1-45

-------
    Operation   and   maintenance   figures    are   frequently
    available only at  the plant  level.  In these  instances,
    allocations  between  processes  were  constructed on the
    basis  of    information    contained   in   the   source
    literature.   In  the  copper industry,  for  example,
    operating costs  were provided for  a  typical   smelter.2
    For   some   of the operating expense  items,  such as
    electric power,  chemicals, etc.,  the  significant  in-
    plant  users  were delineated; costs  could therefore be
    attributed  to those specific  sources.   For   materials
    where  detailed   information was not  available, and for
    general  expenditures  (labor  costs,  maintenance),  costs
    were  distributed   according  to  the fraction of total
    capital  investment represented by each unit process.

    For   some   units,   estimates  of   capital   and   O&M
    requirements  are  simply   not  available.    This  is
    particularly  true   for   old     defending     process
    technologies, like the open-hearth steel furnace, where
    the  last new unit  of  its type was built many  years ago.
    Cost   estimates   for   these processes  were  related
    directly  to  estimates   obtained   for   challenging
    processes.    The  comparison  between hydrotreating and
     drying and  sweetening,  included  in  the  representative
     industry evaluation of  petroleum refining, is a case in
    point.   Operating  costs for drying and sweetening can
     be expected to be lower   than  those  attributed  to  a
     hydrotreating   unit,    due   to   the  large  hydrogen
     requirements of  the latter process.  Where  operational
     differences  could be clearly indicated in this manner,
     costs  were  estimated   in   accordance   with   these
     deviations;   otherwise,  costs   were  presumed  to  be
     roughly comparable.
End-of-Pipe Costs

The Reference Case for abatement costs is the set  of  costs
provided  for  each  industrial  sector  in Sections Two and
Three of this report.  These estimates  were  developed  for
current and projected plant inventories using treatment cost
curves  which  are  contained in Reference 3.  This material
was  supplemented   by   information   obtained   from   EPA
development  documents,  technical  and  trade journals, and
other recent studies on the costs of pollution control.   To
make  this data base responsive to the specific needs of the
process change investigation, methods had to be devised  for
the allocation of Reference Case costs between specific unit
processes,  and  the  translation  of  waste load reductions
possible through process change into a revised  estimate  of
end-of-pipe costs.
                           1-46

-------
ALLOCATION OF REFERENCE CASE COSTS

Much  of the information concerning abatement costs has been
developed only at the plant  level,  while  process  changes
frequently  affect a single phase of the production process.
Where this dichotomy exists, some technique for apportioning
treatment costs  among  the  processes  within  a  plant   is
necessary.   The  demands on this allocation method increase
with the complexity of the control problem.

In the  simplest  case,  each  piece  of  pollution  control
equipment in the treatment scheme can be associated with the
abatement  of  a  particular pollutant generated at a single
source within the plant; e.g., a  baghouse  for  control  of
particulates  from process A, and a wet scrubber for control
of sulfur oxide from process B.  In this instance, the  only
information required for cost allocation is the breakdown of
total  abatement  costs  into  the expenditures required for
each control component.

More often, however, a pollutant is generated at a number of
sources within a plant,  in the  case  of  copper  smelting,
sulfur  oxide off-gases, are produced in various proportions
during  each  of  the  major  processing  steps   (roasting,
furnacing,  or  conversion}.  Some, or all, of these streams
may be combined and sent to the same treatment sequence.  If
a control device handles wastes from several plant  sources,
some  portion  of  the  related  costs  of control should be
assigned to each of these process sources on  the  basis  of
the  fraction  of  total pollutant loading each contributes.
To  calculate  these  fractions,  emissions   factors   that
establish  a general ratio between pollution and output must
be obtained for each relevant process.  These factors,  when
multiplied  by  the  model  plant  unit capacity, provide an
estimate of plant waste loads.   If  roasting  is  found  to
contribute 55 percent of plant sulfur oxides, it is presumed
that  it  can  be  assigned 55 percent of the reference case
costs incurred in controlling that waste stream by means  of
a  scrubber,  acid  plant,  etc.   This  assumed  one-to-one
correspondence is not entirely accurate,  due  to  the  fact
that   wastes  classified  in  the  same  general  pollutant
category  (TSS,  particulates)  can  have   widely-divergent
strengths and treatabilities.  Nonetheless, the relationship
is  a  generally  accepted  rule  of  thumb  which  has been
employed in other recent abatement cost studies.*

In a single plant, many different types  of  pollutants  are
generated,  and  must  be  controlled  by the same abatement
facilities,  ideally, some portion of the total costs should
be allocated to  each  of  the  pollutants  removed  by  the
treatment system.  Formulas of this type have been developed
                           1-47

-------
 for  the   inorganic   and  organic, .chemicals  industry.s There
 were serious  limitations, however,   in  the   application,  of
 this    type   of   analysis   to   the   representative  industry
 examples..  Detailed  breakdowns  of model  plant waste loads  to
 the subprocess level are only available-for  a limited  number
 of pollutants.   Similarly,, .references., on waste  reductions
 resulting    from  process   changes  often   confined   their
 discussion to one or two major  parameters.   Consequently,  it
 was frequently necessary to designate one pollutant  as  the
 dominant   concern of  industry abatement standards.  In the
 petroleum  industry,  for example, BOD removal  was  concluded
 to  be  the  compelling force behind BPT  standards; costs for
 installation  of  the  required biological-  treatment -systems
 were    therefore .allocated between  the various  in-plant
 sources of that  pollutant.
 WASTE REDUCTIONS AND REVISED
 ABATEMENT .COSTS

 The relationship between the reduction .in vaste load and the
 reduction in treatment costs  is  not. proportional.   A  10
 percent  diminution  of plant wastes might result in a 5, 8,
 or  even  12  percent  savings  on   control   expenditures,
.depending  on  factors like the economies of scale involved,
 the degree to which control systems are modular,, etc.   Two
 approaches  were  utilized  to  determine the cost reduction
 associated with a given level  of  waste  reduction.   Where
 information estimating this relationship was provided in the
 literature,  this material was employed.  An example of<.this
 type of information is .the , study  by  McGovern*.  on  waste
 reduction  in  the  petroleum  industry.   In the absence of
 specific analysis, end-of-pipe cost savings were measured by
 moving down the treatment cost curves7 to  a  facility  size
 consistent  with  the  waste  load  reduction achieved.  The
 difference between this revised  value  and  Reference  case
 costs  represents  the  savings.  After the revised level of
 end-of-rpipe expenditures is determined, allocation of  these
 costs among unit processes is again undertaken in the manner
 outlined above.

 The .example  of  substituting  hydrotreating for drying.and
 sweetening can be used  as  an  illustration, of  these  two
 procedures.   A  model plant configuration was chosen" which
 included drying and sweetening,  using BOD  a%  a,, surrogate
 indicator,  the  contribution  of. this process to the tptal
.refinery waste burden was 45  percent.   This,  fraction  was
, then  applied  to  the estimated  total  for planet end-qf,-pipe
 expenditures, to determine, the costs attributable to.r dry,in9
 and  sweetening.   For  the. same  planjt,.  waste  .loads, were
 recalculated,  utilizing  ,  lower   polluting  . hydro.tre.ating
                            1-48

-------
processes  in place of drying and sweetening.  The resulting
reduction in waste  (42  percent)  was  converted  into  its
equivalent  effect  on end-of-pipe costs  (23 percent), using
materials generated by the McGovern study.   The  percentage
of  new  total BOD coining from hydrotreating was calculated,
with this fraction applied to the revised cost estimate.
Economic and Environmental
Motivations for Process Change
and the Allocation of Cost Effects

In addition to indicating the substitution potential of  new
processing  concepts  and the pollution control cost savings
resulting  from  their   implementation,   the   unit   cost
comparisons  can  serve as a basis for speculation about the
motivating force behind a process change decision.  In  some
cases,  e.g.,  spill  containment  in  the  paper  industry,
process changes are adopted that provide no economic  return
on investment, the only benefit being a reduction in end-of-
pipe  costs.   changes  of this type can truly be said to be
environmentally  inspired.    Therefore,   the   costs   for
installing  and  operating  the containment system should be
charged to pollution control.   conversely,  some  concepts,
liKe  the  Bayer-Alcoa  aluminum  process,  have  processing
advantages that are  sufficient  to  insure  their  adoption
before  end-of-pipe  savings  are  taken  into  account.  An
approximate line of demarcation beyond which process changes
are  economically  motivated  is   an   industry's   minimum
acceptable  rate of return.  Since pollution control savings
are incidental to the  decision  maker  in  cases  providing
greater  rates  of  return, it is inappropriate to attribute
these costs to pollution control.

In between these two clear cases  lies  a  substantial  gray
area.  Recovery and sale of byproduct H2S and NH3 in a large
petroleum refinery* results in a return of about 3.6 percent
a year; this profit margin would not in itself be sufficient
to  justify  the  investment.   However,  when environmental
savings are included and the  revised  treatment  system  is
contrasted  with  a  pure  end-of-pipe approach, the process
becomes very desirable,  it would be logical to charge  only
part of the process change costs to pollution control.

This  concept,  although  important to recognize, can not be
accurately implemented given the present data base.  Minimum
acceptable rates of return vary by several percentage points
among companies in  the  same  industry.   A  more  detailed
analysis   of   industry  is  required  to  delineate  these
variances.  Similarly, there is a degree  of  inaccuracy  in
the  estimations  of  process  cost  effects.  Even a slight
                           1-49

-------
error can negate the  accuracy  of  a  carefully-constructed
allocation  algorithm.   Since  only  a  few  of the changes
examined in the representative industry studies lay in  this
gray  area,  none  of  the  savings  in  basic process costs
stemming from process change were included in the  estimates
of  control  cost  reductions.   It  should  be  emphasized,
however, that the resulting estimates  represent  the  lower
boundary of possible savings.
Costing at the Industry Level

Even  though  a particular process change may be shown to be
economically profitable on  the  basis  of  the  unit  level
comparison, the opportunities for its application may not be
fully  exploited.  It is necessary to establish the industry
context into which process change variables  are  introduced
because  certain characteristics of the industry environment
will constrain or encourage adoption of new  process  ideas.
Table  2  presents a partial representative list of elements
in the contextual  picture  that  were  examined  for  their
possible  influence  on  the  rate  of  penetration.   These
limiting factors can be physical or financial, and  not  all
of  these factors are applicable to each industry considered
in the representative evaluations.
                            1-50

-------
                          Table 2.
      Some Factors' Affecting Process.Change Potential
     Factor Considered

1.-   Industry-growth rate

2.    Rate of plant obsolescence/
     replacement
3.   Availability of Input materials
     (Ex.- - higher grade ores, low
     sulfur fuels, rutlle)

4,   Availability of markets for
     recovered byproducts.

5.   Industry attitude toward process
     change
     S1re distribution of plants
7.   In-place end-of-pipe
     abatement facilities
8.   Availability of capital
Reason for Consideration

Taken together, these estimations measure the amount of
new capacity being built.  If the process change being
considered is an option for new plants only, the
possibilities for penetration are highly control fed by
these variables.

External (outside-tfie Industry) market conditions
frequently constrain -the ability of the industry to
employ particular options.  This 1s especially true
of raw material changes'and byproduct recovery-,
and sale.
The historical receptiveness of the Industry to new
process Ideas 1s a general Indicator of the time
frame required for the Industry to'implement new
methods on a  large scale.

The profitability of process change is frequently
linked to economies'of scale,

For a plant with an already Installed treatment sys-tem
capable of meeting environmental standards, the utility
of instalMng process change measures designed :to,, reduce
waste load is greatly diminished.

If a particular process change 'requ'lres a large initial
capital investment, its applleation may be restricted to
those firms with higher profit margins and favorable
liquidity position.

-------
Because the possibilities  for  process  substitution  in  a
given  industry are dependent on the complex interactions of
several variables,  a  scenario  approach  was  utilized  to
indicate the range of possible results.  Two basic scenarios
were  defined:  a  maximum,  and  a  best-guess  estimate of
process change penetration.  In the aluminum  industry/  for
example,  the best-guess market share for the Alcoa smelting
process in 1985 is 8 percent of primary  aluminum  capacity;
if maximum penetration is assumed, the share increases to 12
percent.   The  difference  between  these  scenarios is the
assumption of price or other constraints on the availability
of bauxite and energy inputs.  In some  cases,  the  maximum
and best-guess penetrations are equivalent.

For each alternative, pollution control costs as modified by
process  change  were  calculated  and  compared against the
Reference  Case  estimates.   To  aggregate  costs  to   the
industry  level,  a size distribution of existing and future
plants was estimated.  The cost studies in Sections Two  and
Three of this report assign existing facilities in the plant
inventory to various size classes.  For future growth, plant
capacities   were   developed   from  information  on  known
expansion plans and extrapolation of recent size trends.
                       INDUSTRY  SURVEY
 This  section  summarizes  the results of an  industry  survey  to
 identify    those   process    change   opportunities   having
 implications   for  pollution   control  costs.   Each industry
 considered  in the  cost studies of  Sections Two and  Three   in
 this   report   were  assessed  to determine  the  answers to two
 questions:  Is the  industry a  significant contributor to air
 and water pollution,  and are  there opportunities  for process
 change that   can  reduce the  total cost of  abatement?   By
 comparing estimates  of current industry effluent  levels with
 corresponding  national   totals,  a   general   measure   of
 significance  was developed.   If an industry contributed more
 than  1 percent of  the national total  for any major  pollutant
 parameter,   it was  considered to  be  a significant  polluter.
 In the case of air emissions, this analysis was supplemented
 by comparing  industry abatement costs  to  total  abatement
 expenditures.  Additionally,  sectors  were  judged  significant
 if   they    were   responsible  for highly  toxic  emissions
 (mercury,   asbestos, etc.)    that pose   special  abatement
 problems.

 If  the  answer  to  the  first questions was affirmative, the
 industry  was  further   investigated   for    process   change
                            1-52

-------
potential.    Trade   journals   and  other  magazines,. EPA
development documents, previous Cost of Clean Air and  water
reports,  and  other  reports  on  the subject of industrial
pollution control formed the  base  from  which  the  survey
results  were  developed.  A process change was considered a
viable,alternative only if it had at least  been  tested  at
the pilot plant level.

The  results  of  the  industry  survey  are  summarized  in
Table 3,  with  additional  information  provided   in   the
industry  profiles.10 All process changes discussed in these
profiles have been  classified  according  to  the . type  of
process  change involved, the media affected, and whether or
not the change was included as part of  the  Reference  Case
abatement strategy.
                           1-53

-------
                          Table 3.
                 Summary of Survey  Results
                                         Pollution Reduction
                       Significant       Potential Through
Industry Category      Polluter?*        Process Change?

Fossil Fuels Group

  Coal Cleaning           	                  	3
  Natural Gas
    Processing            	                  	
  Petroleum Refining      A,W                    W
  Steam Electric
    Power                 A,w                  A

Foods Group

  Feedlots                  W                    W
  Meat Products
    Processing              W                    W
  Dairy Products
    Processing              W                    W
  Seafood Processing        W                  No
  Canned & Frozen
    Fruits and
    vegetables              W                    W
  Feed Mills              A                    No
  Grain Handling          A                    No
  Beet Sugar                W                  No
  Cane Sugar                W                  No
  Fertilizer/
    Phosphates            	                  	

 Construction  Materials
  Group

  Cement                  A                    No
  Lime                    	                  	
  Asphalt                 A                    No
  Asbestos                A,WZ                No
   Insulation
     Fiberglass           	                   	
                            1-54

-------
                    Table 3. (continued)
                 Summary of Survey Results
Industry Category
Significant
Polluter?*
Pollution Reduction
Potential Through
Process Change?
Metals Group

  Aluminum
  Copper
  Iron and Steel
  Lead
  Zinc
  Other Non-
    Ferrous Metals
  Electroplating

Chemicals Group

  Inorganic
    Chemicals
  Organic
    Chemicals
  Miscellaneous
    Chemicals
  Plastics &
    Synthetics

consumer Product
 Inputs Group

  Timber Products
    Processing
  Pulp & Paper
    Mills
  Builders Paper
    and Board
    Mills
  Textiles
  Soaps and
    Detergents
  Leather Tanning
   A,W
   A
   A,W
   A*
     W
     W
     W
   A,W
     W
      A,W
      A/W
      NO
                        NO
                          W
      NO
      NO
        W
        W
                        NO
                           1-55

-------
                    Table 3. (Continued)
                 Summary of Survey Results
                                      Pollution Reduction
                    Significant       Potential Through
Industry Category   Polluter?*        Process Change?

Consumer Product
 Inputs Group (con't)

  Glass                	                  	
  Rubber               	                  	

Consumer and
 Government Services
 Group

  Dry Cleaning         A                    A
  Municipal
    Solid Waste
    Disposal           A                    A
    Sewage Systems     	                  	

Key:  A-Air; W-Water.

^Sectors are listed  if they either pay more than  1% of  total
national  abatement  expenditures11, or generate more  than  1%
of  the  national  total of  particulates,   hydrocarbons,   S02,
NOX, BOD, COD, TSS,  or oils and greases.12

^Sectors generating  highly toxic  emissions.

'Sectors  found   to  be   nonsignificant   polluters  were not
investigated further.
 For several  reasons,  process ideas now being considered will
 not exert the same degree of influence  over  an  industry's
 future   planning.   Some  processes,   though  promising  in
 theory,   may   encounter   operational   difficulties   that
 substantially    reduce   currently   anticipated   economic
 benefits; other changes may be restricted in application  to
 plants  of a certain  type, size,  or age.  Therefore, twenty-
 two "candidates" for  further study were  selected  from  the
 initial    list   of  opportunities  as  best  prospects  for
 implementation within the time frame and at  a  level  where
 they  could  seriously  influence the abatement cost outlook
                            1-56

-------
for an industry.  These changes are categories  by  type  of
process change and by industrial sector in Table 4.
                           1-57

-------
r
Wl
oo
                                Table 4,  Sheet 1  of  3.
               Process Change Opportunities by Industry and Type Change
                                 A.  Materials Changes
Industry

Municipal
  Refuse
  Disposal

Paper
             IndustM'al'
              Chemicals
                                 Raw Materials

                           Old Process     New Process
              Salt/Lime
                 Ilmenlte
Trona
   Rut lie
                                                     Pretreatment      Product Specification

                                            Old Process    New Process  Old Process  New Process
                                         High Bright- Lower
                                         ness    Brightness
               Ilmenlte
Synthetic
   Rutlle
            Paints
              Solvent Base
                                          Powder Base
            Petroleum
              Refining

            Iron and
              Steel

            Copper

            Alum)num
            Electric
              Ut1litles

            Dry Cleaning

            Paper
              Sulflde Ores   Oxide Ores
                          Bauxite
                          High Grade
                          Bauxite
                             Recycled
                             Aluminum
                             Low Grade
                             Bauxite
                                            Re-l eased
                                            Fines
                    Disposal
                                            Stack  Gas
                                               Scrubb1ng
         Sawdust  for  Pulping
         Fiber/Chen/Heat
                                                                      Downstream  Low Sulfur
                                                                      Control   Fuel  Oil
                              Pellet
                              Agglomeration
                              Fuel  Desulfur-
                                 Izatlon
  Batch Digesting  Continuous Digesting

-------
I
Ul
vo
                                   Table 4. Sheet 2 of 3.
                  Process Change Opportunities by Industry and Type Change
                                  B.  Process Modifications
Indus-try

Municipal Refuse
  Disposal

Industrial
  Chemicals

Paints

Petroleum
  Refining
                Iron and
                  Steel

                Copper
                Aluminum

                Electroplating

                Electric
                  Utilities

                Dry Cleaning

                Textiles
                Fruits &
                  Vegetables
                                       Byproduct Recovery

                                    Old Process       New Process
                                    0 Isposa1
                    Disposal
                                    Disposal
                    Disposal
Sulfur/NH3
                                      SulfuMc Add
Chem1cals Recyci1ng
Recovery of grease
from wool scour1ng/PVA
Rec1amat1 on/Latex
Recovery

Solids Recovery
                        Revised Process Operations

                        Old Process   New Process
Barometric Con- Surface Condensers
densers In Vac.
Distillation
                        Reverberatory  Flash/Electric
                        Furnace    Furnace/Hydrometal-
                                  lurgy
                                                                        Counterflow Washing
Once Through  Water Recycle

-------
                                        Table 4,  Sheet 3 of 3.
                       Process Change Opportunities by Industry and Type Change
                                       C.  Process Substitutions
I
C\
O
                     Industry

                     Municipal  Refuse
                     Disposal

                     Paper
                     Industrial
                     Chemicals
                     Paints

                     Petroleum Refining


                     Iron  and
                     Steel

                     Copper

                     A1um1num


                     Electroplating

                     Electric
                     UtllItles

                     Dry Cleaning

                     Textlles

                     Fruits & Vegetables
Old Process

Incineration


Kraft Process
Wet Forming

C1!2: Mercury Gel 1
Na2CQ3: Solvay Process
T102: Sulfate Process

Solvent Suspension

Catalytic Cracking
Open-Hearth/E1ectr1c-Arc
Blast Furnace
Hal 1 Process
Bayer-Hal 1 Process
Petroleum Solvents
Mechanical Peeling
New Process

Landf11ls/M1nef11 Is


Dry Forming
Diaphragm Cell Trona Process,
Chloride Process
Electrostatic Suspension

Hydrotreat1ng
Hydrocracklng

Basic-Oxygen Furnace,
Direct Reduction
Alcoa Process,
Monochlorlde Process
Synthetic Solvents
Dry Caustic Peeling

-------
At  this  point,  five industries were  selected  for  in-depth
study: Copper, Aluminum, Pulp and paper, Petroleum Refining,
and  inorganic  Chemicals.   These  industries   were  chosen
because  they  were  industries  in which two or  more process
changes are concurrently being considered,  and collectively,
they contained examples of all the major   types   of  process
change.   Additionally,  it  was  felt  that the  data base of
process change information in these areas  was rich enough to
permit  detailed  analysis.   Short   summaries   of   these
representative evaluations are provided below.
            REPRESENTATIVE INDUSTRY EVALUATIONS

Copper

The main environmental problem  facing  the copper  industry  is
the  control  of   sulfur  dioxide  contained  in the off-gases
from  reverberatory   furnaces   used  in   primary   smelting
operations.  Because  of the very weak  concentration  of  these
gases  {usually  less than  1  percent  sulfur   dioxide   by
volume),  they  cannot  be   treated   effectively    through
conversion  into   sulfuric acid.   The  costs  of abatement are
consequently  very substantial;   expenditures  on    control
measures  in  a   recent" year,  for  example, represented  22
percent of total  capital investment,53  As   a  result,  U.S.
producers   have   greatly   increased  their  interest   in
processing innovations that have the potential to reduce the
•industry's  control   burden.    Research  efforts  have  been
directed  in  support of  three   main process alternatives:
flash furnaces, electric  furnaces,  and hydrometallurgical
smelting.   The   first  American commercial  scale example  of
each technology has either been installed within  the past   5
years or is currently under construction.


PROCESS CHANGES

Flash  smelting is a  commercially  proven technology  that has
been employed extensively in Europe and  Japan  for   over   a
decade.;   Off-gases   from  the  furnace attain sulfur dioxide
concentrations of 10-14.percent and can  be easily handled  by
an  acid  plant.  * By combining   treatment  of   all   plant
emissions  in a single facility, a 1,500-ton of concentrates
per  day  smelter can  achieve an  estimated  11    percent
reduction  in  capital  requirements,  and   a  27.2   percent
reduction in the   annualized  costs  of  pollution   control.
Although  process costs  for the  flash  furnace are  somewhat
higher  due  to   additional  slag  processing  requirements,
overall  unit  costs  figure  to   be 10-20 percent less than
                            1-61

-------
those estimated for a reverberatory  furnace  of  comparable
size.   On this basis, it is projected that up to 50 percent
of new pyrometallurgical capacity requirements  in  1975-80,
and  75  percent  in  1981-85,  will  be  supplied  by flash
smelters.   if  recently  proposed  new  source  performance
standards**   are   promulgated  which  would  specify  more
stringent and much more  costly  controls  on  reverberatory
furnaces,   the  rate  of  penetration  by  the  challenging
technology will be further accelerated.

Electric  furnaces  claim  a  dual  advantage   over   their
reverberatory counterparts; they increase the sulfur dioxide
concentration  of  off-gases by eliminating combustion gases
within the  furnace,  and  they  exhibit  a  higher  thermal
efficiency.   Two  existing  U.S. smelters have already made
the  switch to this technology as  part  of  their  abatement
strategy.   The  smelting  site must be close to a source of
cheap electric power  if the process is  to  be  economically
competitive.    This  fact  alone  will  seriously  restrict
application of this technology in some  of  the  remote  and
arid Western mining  areas,  in addition, industry spokesmen
have frequently  expressed  doubts19  abopt  the  operating
reliability  of electric furnaces,  consequently, the option
is   viewed  as  a  less  preferred  alternative,  with   its
substitution  possibilities  limited to areas where the cost
of power is low enough to override other concerns.

Two  hydrometallurgical smelting techniques, the Arbiter  and
Cy-Met   processes,  are  in  advanced stages of development.
Major questions affecting  evaluation  of   the  substitution
potential  of  these concepts concern the time frame in which
successful scale-up can  occur,   and  the   extent  to  which
current   process  cost   estimates will accurately represent
commercial  scale  results.    If  the  operating   economics
achieved  during  pilot  plant operations can be maintained,
hydrometallurgy can reduce annual process costs by up  to   25
percent;   in   addition,    pollution   control   costs  are
practically  zero, requiring  only  some   form of   storage   or
disposal  for   the   sulfate   solid  waste which  is produced.
Even after successful scale-up,   substitution  will  proceed
slowly,   hydrometallurgy  will   constitute  no  more   than 4
percent  total  primary capacity by 1980, and  12   percent   by
 1985.

 in  addition to these basic  process  changes,  it  is necessary
 to assess the  market  opportunities  for  sale of  the byproduct
 sulfuric acid  generated  during   the   control  process.    If
 there  are  profitable  opportunities   present,   some  of  the
 estimated  costs   of   pollution  control   can  be  defrayed;
 contrarily,    if    no  opportunities   exist,   the  costs   of
 neutralization and  disposal  of  the   byproduct   should   be
                            1-62

-------
counted as an additional abatement expense.  Competition  for
markets  will  be  very  strong,  and smelter acids  face  one
major disadvantage by being far from  their  primary users.
However, smelters can take advantage of opportunities within
the  industry-  to  use  H2SO4 as a leaching agent to extract
copper from oxide ores and mine tailings•»«  they  can  also
Increase their marketability by selling acid at a price well
below  the  going  market  rate.  Based on these parameters,
four  possible  price/market  opportunity   scenarios   were
examined.   In  the combination of circumstances deemed most
likely to occur, it was  assumed  that  12  of  the  primary
smelters with acid plants will be able to sell their acid at
an  average  price  well  below  market  rate,  resulting in
revenue of over $30 million per year.
INDUSTRY EFFECTS

The  percentage  reduction  in   pollution   control   costs
resulting   from   implementation  of  the  process  changes
discussed above is summarized in Table 5.  The bulk  of  the
savings  attained  through  1980  is the result of byproduct
acid sales- the major increase in savings estimated for 1985
is  attributable  to  greater  application  of   flash   and
hydrometallurgical smelting technologies.
                          Table 5.
               Copper industry Abatement Cost
              Reduction Through Process Change
                       Percentage Change from Reference
                       Case Abatement Costs (with
                       Process Change)*

                       1980              1985

Cumulative Investment   -8.0%            -18.1%
(from 1972)

Annual Costs           -15.6%            -26.5%

* From Scenario 2 - air control costs only.
                           1-63

-------
Aluminum

The  two  pollutants  of  primary  concern  to  the aluminum
industry are red mud  from  the  refining  of  bauxite,   and
fluorides  from  the  reduction of alumina to aluminum.   Red
mud is usually impounded in an evaporation pond,.and   it   is
thus  possible  to  achieve  zero  discharge.*7  Fluoride is
associated with the Hall reduction process and is  about   70
percent controlled to date.  Existing  facilities may  have to
install  expensive  secondary, roof scrubbers to achieve  the
proposed standards of 90 percent capture.

A new source performance standard of 95.5 percent  removal is
achievable by the Alcoa Dry Scrubbing  Process.1* Other types
of cells will require expensive secondary scrubbers.    Thus,
pollution  control  factors  are  prompting consideration of
alternative technologies.
PROCESS CHANGES

Three process  substitutions  may have an effect on  pollution
control   costs  in   the   aluminum industry.   The most direct
factor would be  an  increase  in the capacity to recycle scrap
aluminum.   Substitution  of the Bayer-Alcoa»» process for the
Bayer-Hall  would decrease the unit pollution  control  costs
from primary   smelting   by   73  percent.    Non-electrolytic
processes,  like  the Monochloride20  process  would  probably
increase   the   unit cost of  pollution control by 13 percent.
Such-a  technology might  be considered in the future  because
of energy and  bauxite constraints.
 INDUSTRY-WOE COST REDUCTION

 The penetration of new technologies is related to the growth
 rate  of  the  industry,  which  in  turn  is related to the
 industry's  pollution  control   cost.    The   absence   of
 constraints on raw material availability or pollution1, output
 tends  to  preserve  the  present  technology.   Moderately-
 constrained growth, tends to encourage the search  for  less-
 costly alternatives.  However, for purposes of comparison, a
 7  percent  growth  scenario  with  moderate'  penetration-of
 recycling and the Bayer-Alcoa process is .presented here.

 She costs resulting from a  Bayer-JHall/Bayerr-ALcoa/recycling
 mix  of  77  percent/1  percent/22  percent '.-in  1980 and-68
 percent/ 8 percent/24 percent mix in ;i985*.are-shown .iir-Table
 6; note the lover capital and'annuallzed  operating  figures
 for  the process change case.  The-large Increase'in savings
                            1-64

-------
is due to the increased coverage of recycling and the Bayer-
Alcoa orocess.
Alcoa process
                          Table 6.
     Aluminum Industry Abatement Cost Reduction Through
                       Process Change
                       Percentage Change from Reference
                       Case Abatement costs  (vith
                       Process Change)*

                       1980              1985

Cumulative Investment  (-1.8%)           (-9.6%)
(from 1972)

Annual Costs           (-9.0%)           (-9.0%)

» From Scenario 2 - air and water control costs.
Pulp and Paper industry

The paper industry discharged 2.47 billion gallons of  water
in 1972, even though it was recycled over three times during
processing."  About  60  percent  of that water was used in
direct process contact, higher  than  any  other  industrial
activity.   This  leads  to a discharge of about 2.2 million
tons per year each of BOD and  of  suspended  solids.2*  The
industry  spent  30  percent  of its capital investment, the
largest percentage of  any  manufacturing  industry,  in  an
effort to meet pollution control standards.2'
PROCESS CHANGES

The  pulp  and  paper  industry  has  several short-term and
several   long-term   water   pollution   control    savings
opportunities  through  process  change.   In the short-term
(1975-1980),    process    modifications     and     product
specifications   changes  can  have  a  significant  effect.
process modifications designed to  contain,  spills,  recover
fiber,   process  chemical  and  energy  have  some  savings
involved.  They range from a 20 percent savings per ton to a
65 percent savings per ton where applicable.** The increased
use of lower brightness papers can result in  a  67  percent
saving   in  pollution  control  costs  where  applicable.25
                           1-65

-------
Unfortunately, the applicability of these changes is limited
to moderately old plants and the industrial  tissue  market,
so that the overall savings potential is decreased.

The  long-term   (1980-1985)  process substitutions of oxygen
processes and dry forming,  appear  to  have  a  substantial
effect  on  the  cost of pollution control.2*, 27 xhe use of
oxygen for bleachingt waste treatment,  and  process  liquor
recovery  result  in a 53 percent savings in water pollution
control  costs.   Dry  forming  of  paper   eliminates  water
pollution  control  costs  where  applicable.  These process
substitutions appear to have a wide range of  applicability,
but are limited  to new capacity implementation.
INDUSTRY-WIDE COST REDUCTION

If   it   is  assumed that  30 percent  existing  capacity and  all
of  the  new  capacity  before 1980 will  take  advantage   of   the
near-term savings, and that 50 percent  of  new  capacity after
1980 will take  advantage of the long-term  savings, the paper
industry can   achieve water  pollution  control  costs savings
as  shown in Table  7.
                           Table  7.
       Abatement  Cost  Reduction Through Process Change
        Pulp and  Paper Industry,  Water  Pollution Costs
                        Percentage Change from Reference
                        Case Abatement  Costs (with
                        Process Change)1

                        1980              1985

 Cumulative Investment  (-7.4%)           (-14.4%)
 (from 1972)

 Annualized Cost       (-17.6%)           (-27.4%)

 >• From Scenario 2 - water control costs only.
 Petroleum Refining

 The  petroleum  industry  has  made  a  number  of  in-plant
 improvements  in the past designed to improve water effluent
                            1-66

-------
characteristics and increase water reuse and  recycle   rates.
These efforts have been  fruitful, with  the water reuse ratio
in  the  industry  almost  doubling   in 'the   last  20  years;
nonetheless, refineries  face substantial future outlays  for
pollution   control   systems.    in-plant  process changes
designed to minimize end-of-pipe treatment requirements  are
likely  to be a major part of the overall abatement strategy
selected.
PROCESS CHANGES

Many proposed changes affect operations  at   the  subprocess
level, and can achieve substantial reductions  in plant waste
loadings  for  a  fairly  small  initial capital outlay.  An
example of this type of process modification  is the recovery
of phenols produced during catalytic cracking.   Removal  of
•this  pollutant  can reduce total plant BOD by 7 percent and
end of pipe costs by 5  percent.   Additionally,  there  are
economic  advantages  arising from the recovery of free oils
entrained in the wastewaters; from the cracker.  Analysis  of
the  effects  of  installing  such  a  unit   in  three model
refinery configurations*», z»  indicates  that this  change
could  be profitable for a group of refineries comprising 65
percent of current total capacity.

Recovery of byproduct sulphur and ammonia from refinery sour
waters has been  a  widely  practiced  technique  in  recent
years,  and is recommended in the EPA Development Document3*
as part of BPT abatement strategy.  Analysis  in this section
Of the study focused on estimation  of  the   cost-offsetting
benefits  achievable  through  sales of recovered materials.
Available  process  cost  data  on  typical   stripping   and
recovery  facilities3*  demonstrates a potential for returns
on investment of up to 20 percent per  year,   provided  that
alj  byproduct can be sold.  For both sulphur  and ammonia, a
detailed analysis** was made of market  conditions;  and  an
assessment  given of the competitive opportunities available
to  refinery  producers.   Results  of  this   investigation
indicated that sales of the ammonia and sulphur generated at
current  production  levels could translate into revenues of
$62 and $50 million,  respectively,  provided  that  maximum
sour water recovery was practiced using dual stage stripping
techniques.   in addition, maximum processing  resulted in 45
percent reductions in typical refinery BOD loadings, with  a
corresponding pollution control savings of 25  percent.

Greater  use  of hydrocracking has often been  suggested as a
way to reduce air and  water  pollution  problems  resulting
from  catalytic cracking operations.  Although hydrocracking
units offer greater operational  flexibility   and  increased
                           1-67

-------
product  yields  in addition to reducing pollution problems,
industry adoption of the process since  its  development  in
the  1960's  has  been very cautious.  The major obstacle to
implementation has been the higher costs associated with the
challenging processes- this gap has recently widened due  to
sharp increases in hydrocracking input prices.  As a result,
a  great  deal of effort has been funneled into modification
and   improvement   of   the   defending   process.    Major
developments  include  use  of  new catalysts requiring less
frequent  regeneration,  and  the  installation  of   carbon
monoxide waste heat boilers.  These recent events indicate a
resurgence  of  expansion  to  catalytic  cracking,  with  a
resulting increase in end-of-pipe requirements and costs.

The use  of  hydroprocessing  techniques  has  been  rapidly
increasing  over the past decade, growing at an average of 8
percent per year.   The  addition  of  hydro-desulfurization
steps  to  refinery  operations  reduces the waste burden of
sulphur,  nitrogen,   and   metals   requiring   end-of-pipe
treatment,  and  concentrates  these  constitutents  in sour
water streams which can be readily processed  for  byproduct
recovery.    In   other  areas  of  refinery,  hydrotreating
processing can replace older, dirtier  processes  like  acid
treating,  or  drying  and sweetening.  Although the impetus
for greater use of the processes is still strong, there  are
definite limitations on further extension of these processes
in. refineries  which  have already exhausted their in-plant
hydrogen surplus, since hydrogen production  facilities  are
an  expensive  capital  cost  item.33 Further penetration by
this process is likely to occur at a slower rate.
 INDUSTRY-WIDE COST EFFECTS

 It was  very difficult  to quantify the  pollution cost  savings
 possible in the petroleum refining sector.   If  all   process
 changes  discussed  in  this  chapter   were implemented in a
 specific refinery, waste load reductions of up to 60  percent
 could be achieved.  There are many  limitations  restricting
 the  substitution  possibilities which exist;  and, given the
 diverse structure of the industry, it  was hard to determine
 the   number  of  plants that  were  actually  constrained.
 Nonetheless, it is  believed  that  these  various  concepts
 could  be introduced at a level  sufficient  to  reduce  average-
 waste loadings of BOD by 20 percent.   This  corresponds  to
 about  12  percent  reduction in end-of-pipe capital  and O&M
 costs.   Additional revenue  is added from byproduct recovery.
 Percentage estimates are summarized in Table 8.
                            1-68

-------
                          Table 8.
    Petroleum Refining Abatement Cost Reduction Through
                       Process Change
                       Percentage Change from Reference Case
                       Abatement   Costs     (with    Process
                       Change)*

                       1980              1985

Cumulative Investment (-12.0%)           (-12.0%)       (from
1972)

Annual Costs           (37.3%)           (-33.4%)

1 From Scenario 2 - water control costs only.
Inorganic Chemicals

Chemical and allied products rank first in industrial  water
consumption,  with  inorganics accounting for over one-fifth
of this use.3* The vast majority  (72.3  percent)  of  water
intake by inorganic chemicals is for cooling, with only 11.1
percent  used  as  process  water.  The principal wastes are
inorganic salts including chlorides,  sulfates,  carbonates,
etc;  other  significant  wastes  include  ore  tailings and
metals, such as chromium, mercury,  lead and  iron.  In  EPA's
evaluation   of   water-borne   pollution    from   25  major
inorganics, over 99 percent of the  waste load was attributed
to five products: sodium  chloride  (38.3  percent),  sodium
carbonate   (35.6  percent), titanium dioxide  (17.1 percent),
and  the  coproducts   chlorine/    sodium    hydroxide   (8.5
percent).3s Each of these large waste products was evaluated
for process change potential.
SODIUM CHLORIDE

Sodium  chloride waste is usually deep-welled or stored, and
does not pose a difficult water pollution problem.
SODIUM CARBONATE

There are two manufacturing processes for  sodium  carbonate
(or  soda ash).  The older solvay process synthesizes sodium
                           1-69

-------
carbonate from salt and limestone, with ammonia serving as a
chemical  intermediary.   Approximately  1.5  kilograms   of
dissolved   solid  wastes  are  generated  per  kilogram  of
product.5* The dissolved solids are about two-thirds calcium
chloride, with the remainder  mainly  unreacted  salt.   The
solids  have  slight market value and are usually discharged
into surrounding  water  bodies.   In  contrast,  the  newer
process  utilizes  natural ore, called Trona, or lake brines
containing  burkeite.    Neither   of   these   alternatives
generates  a troublesome waste, since ore tailings and brine
wastes can be returned to the mine or lake.

The Solvay process has  been  steadily  losing  ground.   No
Solvay plants have been built since 1935.  From 1960 to 1972
Solvay  plan  participation  in soda ash production declined
from 85 percent to 58 percent.  The one advantage still held
by the Solvay plants is geographic location.  The Trona  and
lake   brine   deposits   are   concetrated   in  Wyoming  and
California, whereas market concentrations lie in  the  East.
As  a result, the natural ores  have only gradually displaced
the Solvay plants; pollution control requirements promise to
speed   this   displacement.    Partially    due   to    such
considerations,  two   Solvay  plants closed  between 1972 and
1974, further reducing process  participation to 46  percent.
The  extent of Solvay  process participation  is the principal
factor determining the  aggregate  water  pollution  control
cost  for  sodium  carbonate  production.    The  anticipated
closing of two of the  smaller plants by 1977 will cut  Solvay
capacity  by one-quarter,  and reduce  abatement  capital  and
annualized  costs  by  28 percent  (BPT and BAT costs are the
same  for  this product).

Another  important consideration  is  whether  to  recover   a
portion   of   the  waste  calcium chloride  for byproduct  sale.
Assuming  there  is a  sufficient  market, recovery and  sale  of
20  percent   of   the   calcium   chloride   would  lead  to an  81
percent  reduction  in  annualized costs, but would necessitate
a 206 percent  increase in capital  requirements.
 TITANIUM DIOXIDE

 There is competition both among processes and raw  materials
 for  the production of titanium dioxide.  The older, sulfate
 process utilizes a more  abundant,  less  pure  ore,  called
 ilmenite.   Until  recently,  the newer chloride process has
 been restricted to the use of the purer rutile  ore.   Since
 the  reserve  of the latter is quite limited, 20 to 25 years
 at present consumption rates, raw material costs have played
 a large role in process selection.  In spite of  the  rutile
 constraint,  process efficiencies achieved with the chloride
                            1-70

-------
process have enabled it to increase its production share  to
46 percent since its introduction in the mid-1950's.  No new
sulfate plants have been built since 1956.

Recent  sharp  increases  in rutile and chlorine prices have
tended to slow the encroachment  of  the  chloride  process.
However,  environmental  considerations  are  lending  a new
competitive edge  to  the  chloride  process.   The  sulfate
process  generates  4  to  5  times  the amount of waste per
kilogram as compared with only 1.2 times  for  the  chloride
process.",  =»*  A  significant  aspect of the difference in
waste load is the  use  of  a  purer  raw  material  by  the
chloride   process.   The  sulfate  waste  is  mainly  spent
sulfuric acid and ferrous  sulfate  (copperas).   The  waste
from  the  chloride  process  is  primarily ferric chloride.
Abatement capital requirements for the chloride process  are
only  56  percent  of those for the sulfate process for BPT,
and 65 percent for BAT.  Similarly, annualized costs for the
chloride process are 40 percent of  those  for  the  sulfate
process for BPT, and 59 percent for BAT.3*

Byproduct  recovery  is an important aspect of the pollution
control opportunities for titanium dioxide.  Ferric chloride
from the chloride process is  already  being  recovered  and
sold   for  water  treatment  by  some  companies,  and  can
alternatively be converted to chlorine for recycling and  to
iron  oxide for sale,  sulfate process waste acid can either
be recovered and recycled or converted to gypsum,  and  then
sold.   Acid  recovery  and  recycle  in the sulfate process
alone enables a 22.4 percent reduction in the total titanium
dioxide  accumulated  capital  expenditures  for   abatement
through  1985,  and  a  23.2 percent reduction in annualized
abatement costs in 1985.
CHLORINE

Environmental  considerations  have  acted   to  reverse   an
ongoing   shift  among  process  alternatives   for  chlorine
production.    worldwide   usage   of   the   mercury   cell
electrolysis process  for chlorine substantially exceeds that
of  the  competing diaphragm cell; in the United States, the
latter has always been predominant.   Nevertheless,  mercury
cell  participation in U.S. chlorine manufacture had been on
the rise, increasing  from 4.3 percent of production in  1946
to  28.6  percent in  1968.  At that point, concern regarding
mercury emissions to  the environment surfaced.  Since  then,
some  existing  plants  have converted  from  mercury cells to
diaphragm cells, and  little new  mercury  cell  capacity  is
being  added.   By  1973,  mercury  cell  participation  had
declined to 24.6.*o
                            1-71

-------
The wastes from the mercury and diaphragm cells are similar:
brine  impurities,  unreacted  salt,  weak  caustic,   waste
sulfuric  acid, sodium hydrochlorate and sodium bicarbonate.
However, the mercury cell  waste  also  contains  a  limited
quantity  of  mercury.   The  need for strict control of the
mercury   content   causes   significant   abatement    cost
differences  between the two cell-types.  The diaphragm cell
abatement capital requirements for BPT and BAT are  only  13
percent  and  36.4  percent,  respectively, of those for the
mercury  cell.   Likewise,  the  annualized   capital   cost
comparison  is  25.7  percent  and  44.9 percent  for BPT and
BAT.41 As a result, the ongoing shift from the mercury cell,
if no new mercury cell plants are  built,  will   reduce  the
accumulated   capital  expenditures  through  1985  by  16.4
percent, relative to the Reference Case, and 1985 annualized
costs for pollution control by 12.8 percent.  It  should  be
noted that a great deal of developmental work is  underway to
bring mercury cell control costs into line with those of the
diaphragm cell.
INDUSTRY-WIDE COST REDUCTION

The    industry-wide    implications  of   the  process   change
opportunities for  the  four   chemicals,   sodium   carbonate,
titanium   dioxide,   and   chlorine/caustic,   are presented  in
Table  9.   The four chemicals account  for more  than half  the
abatement   capital   and  annualized  cost  requirements  for the
entire industry.  Presuming  other  chemicals  have  similar
process change  opportunities,  a  38.1  percent reduction  in
abatement  annualized costs in  1980  can   be  achieved   and   a
25.0  percent  reduction in   1985.   A  slight (2.5 percent)
reduction  can be made in cumulative capital  expenditures.
                            1-72

-------
                          Table 9.
        inorganic Chemicals Abatement Cost Reduction
                   Through Process Change
                       Percentage Change from Reference
                       Case Abatement costs (with
                       Process Change)1

                       1980              1985

Cumulative investment   (0%)            ! (-2.5%)
(from 1972)

Annual Costs           (-38.1%)         (-25.0%)


* From Scenario 2 - water control costs only.
                      GENERALIZATIONS

Range of Pollution
Control Savings

The range  of  pollution  control  savings  through  process
modifications  varies  among  industry and category types of
process change.  This variation is to  be  expected  if   one
considers  the  specific  implementation limits on any given
process  change.    Financial,   technical,   and   physical
constraints  to  process  change  vary  considerably between
industries and within each  industry.   The  highly-specific
nature  of  process  changes  and  the  varied nature of  the
industrial climate  in  vhich  they  are  imbedded  inhibits
generalization.

Substantial   savings   have   been   demonstrated   in   the
representative  industry  studies.    These   savings   vary
considerably from industry to industry as shown in Table  10.
On  the  capital  side,  they  range  from  a savings of  2.5
percent in  inorganics  to  14.5  percent  in  copper.    The
annualized savings are somewhat larger than capital savings,
ranging  from  11  percent  in  the  aluminum industry to 30
percent in the petroleum industry.  The  advantages,  accrued
through  process  change  within the representative industry
studies may serve as an indication of the range of potential
savings in a similar situation in another industry.   it   is
worthwhile  to  emphasize  the  approximative  nature of  the
following  generalizations-  they  are  made  to  facilitate
                           1-73

-------
estimation  of  the  overall  effects of process change, and
they do not represent precise assessments of  the  situation
in a given industry.
                            1-74

-------
                         Table 1O.
       Abatement Cost Impact of Process Change - 1985
(% Change from Reference Case:  Cumulative Capital/Annualized Cost)
Process Industry
Change (Media)
* Materials Change
Raw Materials

Product Specification

• Process
Modification
Revised Operations

Byproduct
Recovery

« Process Substi-
tution








Copper Aluminum
(Air) (Air/Water)
-3.2/-3,3
Recycl 1ng

__

0/-21.8

_

Sulfurlc
Add

-14.5/-13.1 -6.3/-J.7

Hydro- Alcoa
metal lurgy/
flash
furnace/
electric
furnace
Monochlo-
rlde
Pulp & Paper
(Water)
-0.1/-O.3
__

Reduced
brightness
-5.0/-21 .5

Spill
Containment
Fiber/Chem/Heat


-5.O/-7.O

Oxygen
processing




Dry Forming

Petroleum Inorganics
(Water) (Water)
-2.2/-2.1
Trona (Na2C03)
Rut lie (T1O2)
__

-7.0/-25.0 -M3.9/-9.9

Phenol
Recycle
Sulfur/Ammon Calcium chloride
(Na2C03)
Sulfurlc add (T102)
-5.O/-5.0 -14.2/-13.O

Hydrotreatlng Chloride process
(T102)




Hydrocrack 1 ng Diaphragm Cell (<

Industry Totals'
-14.5/-34.9 -9.5/-11.0  -10.1/-28.8
-12.0/-30.O  -2.5/-25.0
  Mean 9.72/25,9

-------
                        Section Two

           THE ECONOMICS OF AIR POLLUTION CONTROL
Chapter 1
Summary
The purpose of setting the ambient  and  emission  standards
associated  with  the  Clean  Air  Act  Amendments  of  1970
(henceforth referred to as the Clean Air Act) is to  protect
human  health  and  reduce  or  prevent  the  other  damages
associated with polluted air.  To  accomplish  these  goals,
the  emissions  released  to the environment must be reduced
far below their 1971 levels.

The  estimated  net  emissions  of  the  five  criteria  air
pollutants  in  1971,  1975,  and 1985 are shown in Table 1.
Also shown in the table  are  the  control  efficiencies  by
pollutant  for the three years.  Note that particulates were
controlled to a large extent even in 1971; quite often these
controls existed for  economic  reasons.   That  is,  plants
recovered  economically-valuable  metals  and materials from
the particulate wastes.
                            2-1

-------
                          Table 1.
             National Trend In Emission Levels
Sources and Pollutants
Net Emissions'
(Millions MT)
                             1971

Al 1  Sources

  Participates               31.6
  Sulfur Oxides              3O.O
  Nitrogen Oxides            16.3
  Hydrocarbons               14.3
  Carbon Monoxide            71.2

Industrial & Electrical
  Generation

  Partlculates               31.0
  Sulfur Oxides              29.3
  Nitrogen Oxides             7.8
  Hydrocarbons                5.2
  Carbon Monoxide            1O.4
                                         1975
         16.8
         22.8
         17.6
         10.5
         55. 1
         16. 1
         22.3
          9.3
          4.2
          7.O
                                                     19BS
 5.9
18.6
29.5
 7.O
28.7
 4.8
17.7
14.2
 3.5
 6.5
                     Control'
                     Efficiency (%)

               1971        1975        1985
64.9        85.0        95.6
25.4        51.9        71.2
   O         1.4         3.O
                        55.0
 9.9        16.8        20.0
65.5        85.7        96.2
25.8        59.4        72.O
 0.2         3.6         5.7
36.3        53.5        70.9
43.O        66.1        76.2
  Emissions after control  devices have been Installed.
  Percent of unabated emissions that are eliminated by  the control  devices.

-------
In order to bring about these reductions in  air  emissions,
businesses  and  consumers must make expenditures to install
pollution control devices, institute process  changes  switch
fuels,  and operate and maintain these devices.   Governments
must allocate expenditures to regulate and monitor pollution
sources, control their own emissions, and perform research.

Table 2 shows  the  estimated  total  expenditures  for  air
pollution  control brought about by the Clean Air Act during
the 1971-85 period.  Detailed information on   standards  and
compliance schedule assumptions are presented throughout the
remainder of this section of the report.
                          Table 2.
      Accumulated Estimated Air pollution Expenditures


                         (In Billions of 1975 Dollars)

                          1971-1985         1976-1985

                          Total             Total
                          Costs             Costs

industries                143.1             134.3
Transportation*            93.1              75.7
Government                  5.1               5.1

Totals                    236.6             215.1

Note:   Government costs for the period 1971-1975 were
        not estimates.

» Mainly the costs for automobile emission controls that
  are paid for directly by the car owners.
The  pattern  that expenditures will take during the 1971-85
period depends not only on  regulations,   but  also  on  the
pattern  of  compliance by businesses,  automobile users, and
local  governments.   If  compliance  with  present  Federal
regulations is assumed, the time path of  expenditures during
the 1971-85 period is shown by the Legislated Timing line in
Figure  1-  note  the  peaking of investment expenditures in
1975.
                            2-3

-------
                      Figure 1.
Air Pollution Abatement investment Costs by Industrial
        Sources other than Electric Utilities
                          2-4

-------
Surveys by the Bureau of Economic Analysis in the Department
of Commerce do not  indicate  such  high  past' and  planned
investment  on  the  part  of  businesses during the 1971-75
period.   Therefore,   some   more   extended   pattern   of
expenditures   will  probably  occur.   The  timing  of  air
pollution expenditures made by  EPA  and  CEQ  in  the  1975
report  entitled  The  Economic Impact ojE Pollution Control;
Macroeconomic and Industry Report's March 1975, prepared  by
Chase  Econometric  Associates,   Inc.,  is  assumed for this
report.  The dark lines on Figure 1 show the  more  probable
expenditure pattern.
                  GOVERNMENT EXPENDITURES
The  air  pollution  abatement expenditures related to P. L.
91-604 made by governments at all levels are shown in  Table
3.   Federal  expenditures include those for state and local
program assistance, research,  abatement  control,  manpower
development,   and   control   of   pollution  from  Federal
facilities.  The future estimates for expenditures by  state
and  local  governments  include  the  functional  .areas  of
enforcement, engineering services, technical  services,  and
management.
                            2-5

-------
                          Table 3.
       Government Spending for Air Pollution Control,
                          1976-85.

               (In Billions of 1975 Dollars)

year    EPA      Other Federal     State Local    Total

1976    112         186               120         418
1976T    28          46                30         104
1977    147         209               140         496
1978    152         209               140         501
1979    152         209               150         510
1980    152         209               150         510
1981    152         209               150         510
1982    152         209               150         510
1983    152         209               150         510
1984    152         209               150         510
1985    152         209               150         510

                                                5,089
                             2-6

-------
                TRANSPORTATION EXPENDITURES
Two   major  types  of  transportation  control  costs  were
estimated:

  •  Costs needed to meet Federal  emissions  standards  for
     autos, trucks, and aircraft.

  •  Costs that residents of  certain  cities  must  pay  to
     finance   programs  that  will  reduce  transportation-
     generated  emissions   to   achieve   Federal   ambient
     standards.

In this report, the former costs are mobile source costs arid
the  latter are treated as Transportation Control Plan (TCPV
costs.  Table 4 shows these costs in summary fashion for the
appropriate years.  As is evident from the  table,  the  TCP
costs  are  very  small  in comparison with the total mobile
source controls.   The  interrelationship  between  the  two
control  strategies is complex; as emissions from individual
vehicles  are  reduced,   the   relative   impact   of   the
transportation controls is also reduced.
                            2-7

-------
                          fable 4.
               Transportation Control Costs1

               (In Billions of 1975 Dollars)
           Mobile Source Costs     TCP
Year investment  O&M      Total    Costs
1968-85
Totals 51.77

1976-85
Totals 45.42
             37.55
89.32
3.76
                                         Total  Yearly
                                         Costs
1968
1969
1970
1971
1972
1973
1974
1975
1976
1977
1978
1979
1980
1981
1982
1983
1984
1985
0.09
0.09
0.49
0.58
0.55
1.48
1.08
1.99
2.68
2.81
2.50
2.71
4.19
6.12
6.07
6.12
6.22
6.00
0.48
0.80
0.86
1.20
1.51
1.98
2.42
1.78
1.19
1.53
1.81
2.04
2.50
2.77
3.15
3.44
3.79
4.30
0.57
0.89
1.35
1.78
2.06
3.46
3.50
3.77
3,87
4.34
4.31
4.75
6.69
8.89
9.22
9.56
10.01
10.30
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
0.34
0.44
0.32
0.34
0.35
0.37
0.40
0.39
0.40
0.41
0.57
0.89
1.35
1.78
2,06
3.46
3.50
3.77
4.21
4.78
4.63
5.09
7.04
9.26
9.62
9.95
10.41
10.71
93.08
             26.52    71.94     3.76    75.7

Interest was not applied to investment.
                  INDUSTRIAL EXPENDITURES
Costs    for   industries  to  comply  with  Federal  emission
standards   (for  new  plants  or  facilities  in  specially-
designated   industries) and State Implementation Plans  (SIP)
required  to meet  Federal  ambient  air   standards   were
estimated   for over 40 separate industries, such as Iron and
Steel  manufacture,  Petroleum  Refining,  and  Kraft   Paper
production.   Table  5  shows the estimated expenditures for
aggregations of these industrial sectors.
                            2-8

-------
                                 Table 5.
              Industrial Air Pollution Control Expenditures
                      (In Millions of 1975 Dollars)
vo
Industry

Coal Cleaning
Coal Gasification
Natural Gas Processing
Feed Mills
Kraft Pulp Mil Is
NSSC Mills
Printing
Chlor-Alkali Mercury Cell
Nitric Acid
Paint Manufacture
Phosphate Fertilizer
Nonferti1izer Phosphate
SulfuMc Acid
Petrochemicals
Petroleum1
Ferroalloy
Iron & Steel'
Iron Foundaries
Steel Foundaries
Primary Aluminum
Secondary Aluminum
Primary Copper
Secondary Brass & Bronze
Primary Lead
Secondary Lead
Primary Zinc
Secondary Z1nc
Asbestos
Asphalt Concrete
Investment

   27.84
  12O.32
  149.12
2.O27.08
2,342.13
  313.44
   44. O3
   23.21
   8O.23
   34.47
  175. 14
   1O. 6O
  721.9O
   48.51
                                         339.28

                                         509.66
                                         269.23
                                       2.504.64
                                          35.64
                                       1.21O.84
                                          21 .67
                                          47. 5O
                                           6.33
                                          64.49
                                           2.52
                                         768.42
                                         664. 19
                                                      1971-85
                                                                     Accumulated Expenditures
Annual ized
Capital



2,
3,







1,






3,

2,





1 ,
1 ,
33
68
2O9
737
542
431
€8
48
119
59
212
16
2OO
55

598

867
538
110
48
1O3
29
80
8
145
3
669
181
.82
. 19
.73
. 18
.82
.00
.71
.60
.79
.99
.04
.22
.52
.33

.49

. 16
.46
.06
.23
. 1 1
.70
.05
.77
.36
.15
.03
.97
O&M
15
53
279
1,058
4,253
581
57
56
180
77
358
6
718
472

154

1,732
45
4, 185
55
1.3O9
48
45
.15
124
7
48
2.O29
.90
.05
.06
.76.
.08
. 12
,67
.38
.31
.95
.47
.07
.77
.84

.22

.07
.33
.23
. 16
. 19
.33
. 19
. 16
. 13
.30
.85
. 12
Investment
13
12O
51
941
1 ,313
13O
21
12
37
11
97
5.
247.
25
1 ,33O.
117.
3.30O,
188.
18.
699
11 .
378.
6.
13.
4.
42.
1 .
3.
161 ,
.56
.32
.38
.70
.41
. 1O
.51
.09
. 16
.88
.40
.66
.89
.90
.00
. 14
.OO
.48
.72
.06
83
.67
.29
.56
.57
SO
.32
.35
.49
                                                                                                   1976-85
Annua 1
ized
Capi tal
3O.
68.
18O.
2,411.
3,117.
367.
6O.
42.
1O5.
51.
188.
14.
1.O36.
48.
3.O25.
519.
13,250.
749.
428.
2,734.
49.
1 ,817.
25.
68.
8.
137.
2.
1,287.
1.O11 .
13
19
1O
26
88
73
14
38
54
73
31
47
32
93
OO
O2
00
OS
26
7O
26
81
58
78
29
7O
78
7O
30

O&M
14. 07
53.05
242.84
936.91
3.8O1 .29
517.44
51 .22
49^.85
162. 15
67.64
323 . 69
5.42
636.97
422. 8O
3.250.0O
135.25
3.870.0O
1.5O9.O1
4O.34
3.552.O3
49.26
1 . 136.63
41 .94
38.48
13.33
1O7.62
6.41
39. 18
1 ,771 .61

-------
                          Table 5.
       Industrial A1r Pollution Control  Expenditures
               (In Millions of 1975 Dollars)
 I    Industry                        Investment
1-1
O
     Cement                             940.18
     Lime Manufacture                  330.01
     Clay Construction Products         80.85
     Surface  Coatings                  514.40
     Steam Electric Power  Plants'
     Solid Waste Disposal             1,948.38
     Sewage Sludge Incineration        185.30
     Gram Handling                  2,978.52
     Dry  Cleaning                      242.65
     Commercial  Heating              3,756.23
     Industrial  Heating             11,012.19

     Totals
                                               1971-85
Accumulated Expenditures
Annual ized
Capital
1 ,




3.

3,

4.
14.
287
474
148,
870,

046,
228.
269.
346.
148.
924.
.97
.83
.65
. 16

.92
6O
14
39
98
53
1


3

4



7
5
O&M
,363
111
194
,228

,658
153
397

,556
,446
.63
.59
.49
.31

.43
.42
.49
O
.87
.88
Investment
328.
110.
. 17.
217.
18, 16O.
634.
111,
1 , 205 .
8O.
1,737,
5.0O6,
94
27
63
72
00
68
4O
35
44
49
32
                                                                           36.917.OO
                                                                                                 1976-85
Annual Ized
Capital
1



24
2

2

3
13
,130
405
126
742
,65O
,602
204.
,962,
3O2.
,637.
, 124.
.48
,24
.73
.17
.00
. 15
.30
.16
.74
.61
39
1


2
18
4



6
4
O&M
,2O5
98
157
.890,
,700
,098,
141 ,
354.

,647.
. 85O.
.45
.S3
.57
.89
.OO
.26
.86
58
O
.87
12
                                82,725.00   61.9OO.OO
1  Figures based upon detailed independent  studies of  tnese  industries which were recently completed  for EPA by  various
  consultants,  as  described  In the  Industry  summaries.

-------
              COMPARISON OF COST ESTIMATES TO
             THE LAST COST OF CLEAN AIR REPORT
For those industries  analyzed  in  both  reports,  Table  6
presents  a  comparison  of  cost  estimates,  in  as nearly
comparable terms as possible.  The last Cost  of  Clean  Air
Report  (COCA)  stated  costs in fiscal years, whereas, this
report deals with years on a calendar basis.  The  estimates
from  COCA  were  inflated  to 1975 dollars in this listing.
Several more industries have been included  in  this  study,
and are therefore not listed in Table 6.
                           2-11

-------
                          Table 6.
              Cost of Air Pollution Abatement
                 (Millions of 1975 Dollars)
                       COCA (FY71-FY79)     SEAS (1972-1979)
                      Investment   O&M     Investment   O&M
Aluminum
  Primary
  Secondary

Asbestos

Coal Cleaning

Copper-Primary

Dry Cleaning

Feed Mills

Grain Handling

Lead
  Primary
  Secondary

Lime Manufacture

Natural Gas
Processing

Nitric Acid

Phosphate Fertilizer

Portland Cement

Pulp & Paper
  Kraft
  NSSC

Sewage Sludge
Incineration

Sulfuric Acid

zinc
  Primary
  Secondary
278.9
256.6
22.3
13.6
18.9
589.2
172.8
652.4
182.0
45.8
32.8
13.0
73.2
108.0
42.5
23.2
532.8
312.8
280.8
32.0
75.2
488.6
41.4
38.9
2.5
280.5
276.6
3.9
2.8
1.8
75.6
-
38.8
24.0
4.2
2.9
1.3
7.0
20.0
10.4
8.2
95.8
69.2
58.8
10.4
8.7
51.5
4.0
3.5
0.5
2,070.3
2,040.2
30.1
15.0
27.3
1,177.5
130.3
1,804.4
2,134.6
46.7
42.1
4.6
320.0
135.1
66.4
8.8
883.8
2,800.4
2,540.5
259.9
212.8
686.9
56.4
54.2
2.2
1,063.8
1,052.8
11.0
11.6
3.5
278.2
-
222.5
85.7
12.5
9.4
3.1
24.1
62.2
34.9
1.2
293.6
988.9
869.9
118.9
25.9
150.3
29.2
27.7
1.5
                           2-12

-------
As can be noted, many of the cost figures are higher  in  this
report,  as  compared  to the last cost of Glean Air  Report.
Several  factors  account  for  this  fact.    The    costing
parameters  for investment and 0&M were inflated from a  base
year to 1975 using factors on an industry-by-industry basis.
when these were used in the SEAS  model,  resultant   figures
were often higher than would have been the case using a  data
base  similar  to  the  one  used  for the COCA report.  The
growth factors  generated  by  the  SEAS  model  were often
different  than  that  assumed by COCA, and the time  phasing
pattern of investments was adjusted in SEAS  to  be   uniform
across the air abatement industries.

Another  factor  accounting for differences in the estimates
is due to the inclusion of feedback  effects  of  abatement-
related purchases to the sectors that produce and sell those
goods  in  the  national economic forecasting model of SEAS.
These feedbacks include direct impacts  on  the  demand  for
abatement equipment and materials from supplying industries,
as well as on abatement-related employment for operation and
maintenance   activities   in   the  industries  making  the
expenditures.  A discussion of this methodology is  included
in Section 4.

Aluminum  figures are higher because of revised judgments of
industry  capacity  and  control  technology   requirements,
combined with the SEAS generated growth forecasts.  Asbestos
investment figures are within the +30 percent assumed on the
cost   functions.    Model  plant  definition  and  industry
forecasts played an important  role  in  the  Coal  cleaning
differences in coal figures.  The O&M figures assume  a rapid
increase  in power requirements with size.  Copper estimates
are different due to the fact  that  previous  coot   figures
were  developed  on  a plant-by-plant basis, while SEAS uses
model plants.  This combined with the fact that SEAS  assumes
all growth in the industry has associated pollution   control
costs   yielded  higher  results.   There  was  also  a  re-
definition in the parts of the industry studied.

Dry Cleaning forecasts from SEAS assumed  55  percent  using
synthetic solvents and the rest utilizing petroleum solvents
for existing plants.  New plants use only synthetic solvents
with  adsorption  units.   Several other costing assumptions
affected the forecast.  Feed  Mills  figures  are  different
largely  due to growth assumptions of SEAS, as well as plant
size distribution parameters.  Cost curves were developed on
an industry-wide basis.

Grain Handling costs were based  upon  several  assumptions,
since  precise  estimates  of investment and operating costs
                           2-13

-------
cannot.-yet be- made;, due  to  lack  of  data.   Capital  cost
carves  were-derived from estimated-throughputs of 1 million
and 15->million bushe-ls. per*-year.  The total capital cost  is
the  sum  o-f • the- weighted  capital  costs-for the existing
fabric   filters,   replacement   of   the   cyclones,   and
installation on the plants with no controlsi

The  overall "Lead  investment costs are very close for both
studies.  Howevery the breakout  of  primary  and  secondary
lead  costs  is different.  This is largely due to different
assumptions on growth patterns.

Lime
-------
Cost  data  for  Sewage  Sludge  Incineration  forecasts was
updated  from  the  last  COCA   report,   and,   as   such,
substantially   revised.    Assumptions   concerning  growth
patterns of the industry also affected forecasts.

pollution  control  expenditures  for  the   Sulfuric   Acid
industry are higher in this study, due to the growth pattern
of demand for sulfuric acid,  fhis may not actually increase
the  size  of the industry, as SEAS would assume, because of
byproduct recovery from other industries.  The future growth
pattern of this industry is uncertain.

The zinc industry forecasts for the two  reports  are  based
upon different segments of the industry, as well as the fact
that SEAS includes expansion costs in its estimate.
                           2-15

-------
Chapter 2
Benefits of Controlling Air Pollution
Contemporary    damage    estimates   are   based   on   the
interpretation of the results of numerous studies of varying
scope, methodology, and data  quality.   Dose-response  data
are  most  available for effects of sulfur oxides, oxidants,
and particulates in the damage categories  of  human  health
and  vegetation.   Because  of  the  high  cost of obtaining
statistically valid data on  actual  environmental  damages,
much  of current pollution effects information is based upon
extrapolation   of   data   from    controlled    laboratory
experiments.

In  combining  estimates  from different classes of damages,
care must  be  taken  to  minimize  duplicate  counts.   For
example,  studies of the differences in residential property
values associated with differences in air pollution  reflect
primarily  the  aesthetic  and  soiling  effects rather than
health, materials, and vegetation effects.  This approach  is
based  on  the  argument  that  the  aesthetic  effects  are
experienced   directly  in  everyday  life,  whereas  health
effects are mostly long-term, and are not distinguishable  by
the general population from other causes of illness.
                       HEALTH DAMAGES

Nature and Effects of Air
Pollution Damage  to Health

The major air pollutants that have   been   linked  to  health
damages  are suspended particulates, sulfur oxides, nitrogen
oxides, oxidants, and carbon monoxide.  The effects of  these
pollutants are  increased morbidity  (incidence  and prevalence
of disease) and mortality.  The  specific  diseases that  have
been   associated   with   air    pollution are  bronchitis,
emphysema, asthma, respiratory   infections,  heart  disease,
cancer  of the  respiratory and digestive  tracts, and  chronic
nephritis.  The  quantitative  relationships   between  these
diseases  and air pollutants have been  explored in a  variety
of studies; other studies have examined the link between air
pollution and measures of illness  or   discomfort,  such   as
absenteeism,    emergency   ward   visits,   and   automobile
accidents.

The most widely-cited studies of the health effects from air
pollution were  performed by Lave and Seskin  (1970, 1973) and
by EPA's Community  Health  and   Environmental Surveillance
                            2-16

-------
System   (CHESS).   Lave and Seslcin analyzed  the  relationship
between  mortality  (in  total and  in 14 disease  categories),  a
variety  of socioeconomic variables, and  several   indices  of
suspended  particulates  and  sulfates   in   the   air.   Their
findings indicate  that at  least '9 percent of the 1960   death
rate  was  attributable  to  particulates and  sul fates.'  The
strongest effects  were on  bronchitis and lung  cancer.

The CHESS studies  (1974)  gathered  data  on  a number  of
communities   chosen   to   control  socio-economic  variables
related  to disease.  A variety of  indicators  of  illnesses
were  examined  for  their  relationship  to  the  pollution
composite of sulfur dioxide, suspended sulfates,  and   total
suspended  particulates.   The   morbidity measures chosen as
most significant were: asthma attacks,  restricted  activity
days,  and  physician  visits  resulting  from  acute   lower
respiratory disease- prevalence  of chronic   bronchitis;  and
aggravation of cardiopulmonary symptoms in the elderly.

In  a  recent  study,  Sprey and Takacs  (1974) indicated the
likelihood that the health effects of air pollution may turn
out to be greater  than expected  from previous  studies.   In
this  study,  a  greater  range  of  specific  pollutants and
health effects was examined.  Strong correlations were  found
between nitrogen dioxide and mortality from  arteribsclerotic
and hypertensive heart disease,  cancer of the  lung,  larynx,
and  esophagus,  and  nephritis.  In addition, sulfates were
found to be associated with arteriosclerotic   heart  disease
and  cancer  of the respiratory  and gastrointestinal tracts.
These results suggest  that the fraction of   the  death  rate
associated with air pollution may be as high as  15 percent.
Survey of Source Studies

The  majority  of  health studies center around damages from
particulates and  sulfur  oxides.   Recently,  oxidants  and
carbon  monoxide  have  been receiving increasing attention,
but the data base is still very  small  for-  most  important
effects.  Very little work has been done on nitrogen dioxide
because  of  the  difficulties in isolating the pollutant in
ambient  situations   and   problems   in   defining   valid
measurement"  techniques.   The  more  important  studies are
listed in Table 1.
                           2-17

-------
             Table 1.
Summary of Health Effects Studies
Study
CHESS
Lave and Seskln
'J0 Buechley
00 Finklea et al .

Bates
Gardner
Hazucha
Zelac et al .
Shoettlln & Landau
CARB
Aronow and IsbelT
Horwath et al ,
Beard and Wertheiro
Hexter & Goldsmith
Shy et al .
Publ Icat 1on
Date
1974

1973
1975
1973
1971
1973
1971
1961
1975
1973
1971
1967
1971
197O
Location
5 Areas
117 SMSAs
New York-N.J.
Based on
various
studies
Laboratory
Laboratory
Laboratory
Laboratory
Los Angeles

Laboratory
Laboratory
Laboratory
Los Angeles
Chattanooga
Pol lutants
Measured
Sulfur dioxide.
sul fates
Partlculates,
su! fates
Sulfur dioxide
Sul fates
Ozone
Ozone
Ozone
Ozone
Oxidants
Oxldants
Carbon monoxide
Carbon monoxide
Carbon monoxide
Carbon monoxide
Nitrogen d1ox1d<
                                                       Effects

                                                       Increased incidence of  chronic
                                                       and acute respiratory disease

                                                       Mortality
                                                       Mortality

                                                       Mortality and various morbidity
                                                       measures
                                                       Changes  in lung  function

                                                       Stability  changes  in  alveolar
                                                       macrophages
                                                       Chromosomal  changes

                                                       Aggravation  of asthma

                                                       Changes  1n respiratory
                                                       function and susceptibility

                                                       Earlier onset of angina pain
                                                      Time discrimination
                                                      deterioration

                                                      Mortality

                                                      Increased Incidence of
                                                      respiratory disease

-------
A recent survey of health damage studies was accomplished by
the National Academy of Sciences and the National Academy of
Engineering  (1974)  in  their  report,  Air   Quality   and
Automobile   Emission  Control  (1974),  which  concentrates
largely on effects of carbon monoxide, with other pollutants
treated in slightly  less  detail.   Neuberger  and  Radford
(1974)  cite  more  than  100  references  on both human and
animal   experiments   for   seven   pollutants,   including
formaldehyde and benzo-pyrene, in the context of identifying
threshold levels for health effects.  Source descriptions of
the older literature may be found in the NATO reports (1971,
1972,   1973),   which   detail   both   toxicological   and
epidemiological  effects  grouped  by  specific  pollutants.
Waddell  (1974)  has  reviewed  a  number  of primary source
studies in the process of deriving one chapter  to  economic
costs  of  diseases based on statistics from the U.S. Public
Health Service, and various reports and  studies.   Selected
source  studies on health effects are summarized below as an
indication of the large resource literature that exists.

The effects of sulfur  oxides  and  particulates  are  often
difficult   to   separate   due  to  collinearity  of  their
concentrations.  The basic work on a national scale has been
provided by the CHESS program.  Recently  published  results
(EPA,  May 1974) provide data from five study areas selected
across the United States; they were: the  Salt  Lake  Basin,
Rocky  Mountains,  Chicago-Northwest  Indiana, New York, and
Cincinnati.  The basic study concentration was on acute  and
chronic  respiratory  disease  including asthma aggravation,
but some correlations  with  cardiopulmonary  symptoms  were
found in New York.

The  published  CHESS  studies were carried out between 1967
and 1971.  in some cases, data from  as  early  as  1940  on
population    exposure   of   pollutant   measurement   were
extrapolated.  Current monitoring data  were  obtained  from
pollutant-specific   air  quality  sensors  placed  in  each
community.   Each  study  involved  comparisons  of  several
communities within a geographic area.  The major conclusions
supported    the    correlation    of    suspended   sulfate
concentrations with both increased incidence of  asthma  ana
aggravation  of  cardiopulmonary  disease.   However, recent
reviews of statistical validity of CHESS  experimental  data
indicate  that these results are highly speculative.  (House
Subcommittee on the Environment and the Atmosphere, 1976)

A recent study by Finklea et. al_. (1975) has formulated "best
Judgment"  dose-effect  functions  for  suspended  sulfates.
Damage  functions  were  derived  from  various  studies  on
mortality, aggravation of heart  and  lung  disease  in  the
elderly,   aggravation   of   asthma,   excess  acute  lower
                           2-19

-------
respiratory  disease  in  children,   and   excess   chronic
respiratory  disease.   All except mortality showed positive
responses below 15 micrograms per  cubic  meter  (ug/m3)  of
sulfate  concentration;  the threshold for mortality effects
determined by the study  is  approximately  25  ug/m3.   The
suspended  sulfate  concentrations  are  related  to  sulfur
dioxide concentrations by a linear equation ,  such  that  in
the   case   of  morbidity,  320  ug/m3  of  sulfur  dioxide
corresponds to a 25 ug/m3 sulfate level.  Thus, effects  are
shown  to  occur  here even below the primary 24-hour sulfur
dioxide standard of 365
Another investigation of air pollution effects  in  a  large
number  of  areafe  has  been  performed  by  Lave and Seskin
(1973).   The  relationship  between  mortality  rates   and
pollutant  concentrations  was  investigated for 117 standard
metropolitan statistical areas.  Correlations  with  various
socioeconomic  indices  were  investigated  by  multivariate
regression analysis, and sulfate   levels  were  isolated  as
having  a  significant association with mortality rates.  It
was determined that a 10 percent reduction in the  level  of
suspended   particulates   and  swl fates  would  reduce  the
mortality rate by 0.9 percent.

Buechley  (1973)  has  investigated  relationships   between
sulfur  dioxide  and  mortality in  the New York-New Jersey
Metropolitan   area.    The   study   utilizes   statistical
techniques  and  regression analysis to investigate residual
mortality after  elimination  of   meteorological  and  other
covariates.   Records over the  period from 1960 to 1964 were
correlated with  11  levels of sulfur  dioxide  concentration,
indicating  that  a change in 24-hour levels between 140 and
500 ug/m3 corresponds to a change  in residual  mortality  in
excess of 3 percent.

Results  of   a   study  on  outpatient  medical  costs in the
Portland, Oregon,   standard  metropolitan  statistical  area
 (SMSA)  have  been  presented by Jaksch and Stoevener  (1974).
The study utilized  records  and surveys  developed  by  the
Kaiser-Permanente   Medical  Care   Program to investigate the
impact of suspended particulate concentration from 60 to  80
ug/m3 would  result  in only a 3.5  cent  increase in expense
per medical visit  for respiratory  diseases.  Recommendations
 for future  study include  the   determination  of  impact  of
pollutants  on the  number of medical  contacts.

The    National    Academy   of   Sciences  report  summarizes
 investigations  of  acute and chronic  respiratory   illness  in
high   oxidant  atmospheres,  mostly   in   California,  or  in
 laboratory  experiments.  The  report  lists  aggravation  of
 asthma,   decreased  cardiopulmonary   reserve,    increased
                            2-20

-------
susceptibility to acute  respiratory  disease,  decrease  in
pulmonary  function,  as well as changes in cell physiology,
as   being   prime   documented   effects    of    oxidants.
lexicological  studies  with  rabbits  (Gardner,  1972) have
shown  that  the  stability  of  cells  that  prevent   lung
infection    (alveolar    macrophages)    is    reduced   at
concentrations of 196 ug/m3 (0.10 parts per million-ppm)  for
2.5 hours.  Experiments with hamsters (Zelac et  al.,  1971)
have  shown  mutagenic  changes  (chromosome breaks  in white
blood cells) when exposed to 392  ug/m*  (0.20  ppm)  for  5
hours.   Studies  with humans (Bates e_t al. 1973, Hazucha e_t
al.  1973)  have  shown  significant  changes  in  pulmonary
function  upon  exposure  to  1,470 ug/m3 (0.75 ppm) and  725
ug/m3 (0.37  ppm)  for  2  hours.   Asthma  attack   rate  in
asthmatics has been found to increase significantly  at daily
peak   oxidant   concentrations  of  490  ug/m3  (0.25  ppm)
(Shoettlin and Landau 1961).  These studies and  others  are
listed as being on indicative, but incomplete, data  base  for
photochemical  oxidant  effects  on  health.   The   need  for
further investigation  in  both  the  formulation  of  dose-
response  relationships  and  the  validity  of  the present
standards  in  the  light  of  new  evidence  was    strongly
recommended by the panel.

Current  studies  in  health damages are being pursued under
the auspices of EPA's Office of Research and Development  to
estimate  the  health  costs  associated with air pollution.
One of these studies recently completed  by  the  California
Air Resources Board (1975) has estimated "rough order" dose-
effect  functions compiled by an expert panel using  a Delphi
approach.   The  panel  generally   agreed   that    patients
suffering   from  viral  or  bacterial  illness  would  have
enhanced susceptibility  to  oxidant-induced  abnormalities.
It  was  deduced that 90 percent of the infected individuals
would experience increased dyspnea at 1,560 ug/m* (0.80 ppm)
and increased cough at 1,176 ug/m3 (0.60 ppm).  Ten  percent
of  this  population  would be incapacitated by superimposed
bacterial pneumonia (influenza) or acute respiratory failure
(viral bronchitis) following exposure to 1,176  ug/m3  (0.60
ppm) of oxidant.

Carbon  monoxide  is the principal pollutant reviewed in  the
National Academy  of  Sciences   (NAS)  report.   Effects  on
symptoms  of  cardiovascular  disease,  behavioral vigilance
effects, and effects during pregnancy are presented  . as   the
major  categories.  In an experiment in the Los Angeles area
(Aronow and Isbell 1973), a reduction  in  the  time before
onset  of  pain  from  patients  with  angina  pectoris   was
observed after breathing carbon monoxide  at  56  ug/m3   (50
ppm)  for  2  hours.   In  psychological experiments testing
response to environmental  stimuli,  some  indications  show
                           2-2J

-------
that  reduction  in  vigilance  and response can occur after
exposures of 56 ug/ms (50 ppm)  for  1.5  hours  (Beard  and
Weftheisn  1967).   The. investigations into effects of carbon
monoxide exposure on the developing fetus  in  women  during
pregnancy  have  been  primarily carried out on animals, and
the results are not clearly extrapolatable- to humans.

Hexter and Goldsmith (1971) have carried  out  a  regression
analysis  of  daily mortality data in Los Angeles County for
the period 1962-65; they considered  temperature  variations
and  other  cyclic  factors as covariates to carbon monoxide
concentration.    The   study   indicates   a    significant
correlation of carbon monoxide with mortality, and concludes
that  the  estimated contribution of carbon monoxide between
concentrations of 23 ug/m3 (20.2 ppm) and 8 ug/m* (7.3  ppm)
is 11 deaths per day, other factors being equal.

Nitrogen  dioxide has been primarily associated with chronic
and acute respiratory disease.  The NAS study cites the work
of Shy  et  al.  (1970)  in  Chattanooga  which  tied  acute
bronchitis  rates  in  infants  with   differential nitrogen
dioxide exposure.   Relative  incidence  of  bronchitis  was
observed  to vary as much as 58 percent between low and high
exposures.  Questions about the validity of nitrogen dioxide
measurement  methods  and  the  presence  of  an   influenza
epidemic  have  thrown  some  doubt  on  the validity of the
conclusions; the NAS panel recommends further investigations
in this area.
                     AESTHETIC DAMAGES

Nature  and  Effects  of Air
Pollution Damage  to Aesthetics

Air  pollution  reduces the   pleasantness   of   peoples'   daily
experiences and  it can   also  cause unpleasant experiences
that lead to psychic damages.  Opinion   surveys  have   shown
that the   most noted aesthetic  effects  of air pollution  are
material soiling  and   deterioration,  irritation  of   eyes,
nose,   and   throat, malodors, and  reduced visibility.   These
effects are primarily related to the  aesthetic  aspects   of
experience   rather   than   to direct  physical,  health,   or
economic damages.  There  is an   area  of overlap,   howevert
between aesthetic   damages and  materials damages  because of
the  aesthetic  losses from  soiling  and deterioration.

The   primary   pollutant    responsible   for   soiling   is
particulates.   Irritation  of   eyes,  nose,  and  throat is
caused  primarily  by   photochemical   oxidants.     Hydrogen
                            2-22

-------
sulfide, produced by anaerobic decomposition of wastes, is a
frequent  cause  of  malodor.   Reduced visibility is caused
primarily by particulates and nitrogen dioxide.
Survey of Source Studies

A summary of the property value studies of primary  interest
in . developing  national estimates of the aesthetic benefits
of air pollution control is shown in Table 2.  These studies
employed multiple regression techniques using a  variety  of
pollution   level   measures,  other  variables  influencing
property values, and property  values.   All  study  results
confirmed  the hypothesis that pollution and property values
are  inversely  related,  and   they   found   statistically
significant coefficients expressing the relationships.
                           2-23

-------
                          Table 2.
             Summary of Property Value Studies
Investigator     Date

Ridker-Henning   1967

zerbe            1969


Anderson-Crocker 1970
Crocker
Peckham
Spore
NAS and NAE
Kelson
1971
1970
1972
1974
         Location

         St.  Louis

         Toronto
         Hamilton

         St.  Louis


         Kansas City
Washington,
D.C.

Chicago
Philadelphia


Pittsburgh


Boston and
Los;Angeles
1975     Washington,
         D.C.
 » A measure of  SO3  deposition,  probably
  particulate  levels.
 Pollution Measure

 Sulfationi

 Sulfation
 Sulfation

 Sulfation and
 suspended particulate

 Sulfation and
 suspended particulate

 Sulfation and
 suspended particulate

 Sulfur dioxide and
 suspended particulate

 Sulfation and
 suspended particulate

 Sulfation and
 dustfall

 Nitrogen oxides and
 particulates

 Oxidants


also indicative of
 The   study  of  air  quality  and  automobile  emission  control  by
 the National Academies  of  Sciences  and  Engineering  provides
 a  more  recent estimate of the air- pollution  damages related
 to automobiles.  This study employed  a  general  equilibrium
 model  of the  property  market  for  business, residential, and
 agricultural land   use.    Using data  on Los   Angeles  and
Boston,   the   study  estimated  the
automobile  emissions  to be  in . the
billion,  annually.
                    national  damages  from
                    range  of  $1.5  to  $5
                            2-24

-------
The  bidding game study of pollutioh control benefits at the
Four Corners power  plant  added  a  new  dimension  to  the
estimation  of  aesthetic  benefits.   A  questionnaire  was
administered to local residents and tourists  after  showing
them  three  sets  of  photographs,  each  set  showing  the
aesthetic aspects of different levels of pollution.  Bidding
games, using realistic payment mechanisms, were designed  to
determine  the  maximum  amounts  that  households  would be
willing to pay for improvements shown  in  the  photographs.
The  payment  mechanisms  included  sales taxes, electricity
bills, monthly payments, user  fees/  and  compensation  for
environmental damages (Randall 1974).
                     VEGETATION DAMAGES

The Nature and Effects of Air
pollution Damage to Vegetation

Until  recently,  studies of the effects of air pollution on
vegetation were limited primarily to leaf damage  caused  by
acute  exposures in areas adjoining urban centers.  However,
recent work has begun to  change  this  picture,  indicating
that  vegetation  damage  is likely to be far more extensive
than had been expected.

Measurements of air pollution in rural areas in many  states
have  shown  the  presence  of  hazardous  concentrations of
oxidants over large areas; this condition appears to be  the
result  of  the processes of transport and chemical reaction
within plumes carried from urban areas.  Fluorides, nitrogen
dioxide, and sulfur dioxide, with its resultant  acid  rain,
have also been found to have impacts on rural vegetation.

In  addition,  a number of experimental techniques have been
developed to determine the impact of specific pollutants  on
plant  growth.   Studies  using  these techniques have shown
that chronic exposure to ozone affects  the  yield  of  many
crops  to  a  far greater extend than that indicated by leaf
damage from acute exposures.  Experimental work still in the
exploratory stage suggests that oxidants, such as ozone, may
destroy chlorophyll and cause reductions  in  plant  growth,
which  are not manifested by visible injury,  conversely, it
appears that acute exposure can cause  leaf  damage1 without
having a substantial effect on long-term plant growth.

A   series  of  Swedish  studies  have  indicated  that  the
potential effects of sulfur dioxide on vegetation extend far
beyond the emission sources and the affected  vegetation  in
the  immediate  area  that is exposed to contact with sulfur
                           2-25

-------
dioxide laden air.  It appears that sulfur dioxide  that  is
not washed out of the air by rainfall can be transported for
distances  up  to  600  miles  and it is exposed to chemical
reactions that produce sulfuric  acid  mist  or  acid  rain.
Although  acid  rain is known to affect vegetation directly,
greater  damage  results  in  areas  where  the  soils  lack
sufficient  alkalinity to provide a buffer against the acid.
The leaching  of  nutrients  by  such  acids  reduces  plant
growth.
Survey of Source Studies

Damage  studies  have  been  performed  on a wide variety of
agronomic   crops,   citrus   trees,   lumber   trees,   and
ornamentals.   The  largest segment of these studies relates
to  damage  from  oxidants  and  sulfur  dioxide,   although
nitrogen oxides and fluorides have also been implicated; the
more important studies are listed in Table 3.
                           2-26

-------
              Table 3,
Summary of Vegetation Damage Studies
Study
Benedict et al .
Heck et al .
Jj Heck and Brandt
Botkin et al .
Costonis and Sinclair
Mi 1 ler
Thompson et al .
Davis
H11 1 et al .

Temple
McCune
Date
1973
1966
1974
1971
1969
1973
1972
1972
1974

1972
1969
Locat ion

Laboratory
Laboratory
Laboratory
New York
Cal ifornia
Riverside
Her ford, Arizona
Utah and
New Mexico
Laboratory
Various studies
Pollutants Mea

Ozone
Ozone
Ozone
Ozone
Ozone
Ozone
Sulfur dioxide
Sulfur dioxide
nitrogen dioxii
Sulfur dioxide
Fluorides
                                                                   Effects
                                                                   Increased damage
                                                                   index

                                                                   5%  injury and
                                                                   threshold levels

                                                                   Reduction of
                                                                   photosynthes1s

                                                                   Induced needle
                                                                   blight
                                                                   Yield reduction in
                                                                   ci trus

                                                                   Yield reduction in
                                                                   soybeans

                                                                   Foliar injury
                                                                   FolIar injury

                                                                   Foliar injury and
                                                                   yield reduction in
                                                                   various species

-------
Quantitative   relationships   between   air  pollution  and
vegetation damage, have been developed in only a few studies.
The NATO criteria .documents (November 1971,  February  1973,
and  1974)  for  these pollutants contain overall reviews of
the literature, as does  the  chapter  by  HecX  and  Brandt
(1974)  in Stern's air pollution volumes.  Jacobson and Hill
(1974) contains several hundred primary  source  references,
although  damage  functions  are not specifically addressed.
The National Academy of Sciences (1974) publication  is  the
most  complete  source on  fluorides.  A recent study for the
Environmental  Protection   Agency   (Benedict   1973)   has
attempted   to   circumvent  physical  damage  functions  by
relating source emissions  directly to economic losses;  this
method  is suspect, especially for oxidants, as indicated by
the recently discovered, high rural oxidant levels shown  in
the 1973 EPA Trends Report.

Heck and co-workers  (1966) have provided a number of studies
quantifying   ozone  damages  to  various  species.   in  an
investigation of damages to one variety each of tobacco  and
pinto  beans,  dose-effect functions  of a sigmoidal nature
were derived.  For pinto beans, the injury index for 1  hour
of  exposure  to  ozone rose from zero to 90 percent at 0.60
ppm  concentration.   Chronic  effects  of  ozone  are  also
documented  by  the  data  as  changing  by approximately 15
percent between exposure times of I hour and 4 hours.   This
percentage  held  true  at both high ozone levels and levels
near the primary standard  of 0.08 ppm.  The chronic  effects
on tobacco showed more than a 20 percent variation in injury
between  1  hour  and 4 hours of exposure.  Heck developed  a
number  of  useful  visual display  techniques  for  damage
functions,   illustrating   both   synergistic   effects  of
pollutants and acute versus chronic effects.  He used three-
dimensional graphs to simultaneously demonstrate  variations
in  pollutant  concentration,  exposure  time> and resulting
damage.

Heck and Brandt  (NATO 1974) have shown oxidant damage at the
5 percent level for over 100  plant  species  on  a  scatter
diagram.   Damage  envelopes  are drawn at the 5 percent and
threshold levels for  concentrations  ranging  from  0-2,160
ug/m3  (0-1.1  ppm)  and   with time exposures from zero to  8
hours.  This ef;fort  is useful in providing ranges of damages
for a  large number of unrelated higher plant- species.

A number ,of studies  are available on damages to  species  of
pine   trees.   Botkin, et  al.  (1971), Costonis and Sinclair,
(1969),  and  Miller.  (1973)  have,  investigated  pine  tree
damages.  The study  by Miller is perhaps the most impressive
due  to  the high damage and death .rates' found for Ponderosa
Pine over a. 2-year study period.   All  of   the  trees  were
                            2-28

-------
found  to  be   injured   to  some  degree,  and  8.1  percent  died
during the study.  Ambient   oxidant   readings   in   the   area
exceeded  196  ug/ma  {0.10 ppm)  for more  than an  average  of  8
hours per day.

Thompson  and   co-workers   (1972)  have   performed    several
studies of oxidant effects  on citrus  tree yields- both ozone
and peroxyacyl  nitrates  have been investigated.  Thompson e£
al.   (1972)  quantified  differences  in  leaf drop,  fruit set
and drops, and  fruit  weight per  tree   on  navel   oranges.
Variance  analysis   was  then  performed  on  the   data, and
confidence levels given  for each value.   Addition of ambient
ozone to carbon-filtered air was observed to   reduce fruit
yield by 35 percent.

Sulfur dioxide  effects on soybeans have  been investigated by
Davis  (1972).   A   three-year   study was  conducted on 485
soybean plots.   Sulfur dioxide  fumigations were  carried  out
at two growth  stages  the first  two years and at  seven stages
during  the last year.   Good correlations were found between
leaf area destroyed  and  reduction of   yield.   while sulfur
oxide  exposure is   not directly related to yield  loss, the
•study is important in indicating a   possible   general   link
between leaf loss and yield loss resulting from  'sulfur oxide
exposures.

Hill  ej: al. (1974)'  have carried out  one of  the  most massive
studies based  on the  number of  species involved.   About 80
native  desert   species  in  Utah  and New  Mexico were examined
for  sulfur  and nitrogen   dioxide   effects   under  field
conditions.    Fumigation levels ranged  from  1,430 ug/mj
(O.Sppni)  to   25,600  ug/rn*   (10    ppm)   sulfur    dioxide
concentration;   most  species '  for  which data  was complete
showed a marked injury   increase at   either  6  or  10  ppm
concentration.   While   these   are  much  higher than normal
ambient levels, the  study was intended to simulate  effects
in a power plant plume.

Four  ornamental species, Chinese elm, Norway  maple, ginkgo,
and  pin  oak,   were  fumigated  with sulfur    dioxide   in
controlled  environmental   chambers by Temple  (1972). Three
dimensional' dose-response curves similar to  those   of   Heck
were constructed for  each species.  Damages  to foliage of up
to  95  percent were found at  concentrations  of1 11 ug/m* (4
ppm) after 6 hours of exposure.  This study  fails to provide
data near ambient urban  levels of 365 ug/m*  (0.14   ppm) or
less, but a•small amount of damage was observed  at  715 ug/m'
(Oi25 ppm) over time  periods of  30 days.

The  effects   of other  pollutants are  not  well documented.
Mccune (1969)  has  done  research  on fluorides,   but   this
                            2-29

-------
pollutant  is  not  widespread in ambient air.  Participates
have been found to show slight effects due to limitation  of
photosynthesis.   Nitrogen  oxides  and carbon monoxide have
shown no appreciable effects  in the few  studies  that  have
been performed.
                     MATERIALS DAMAGES

The Nature and Effects of Air
Pollution Damage to Materials

A wide variety of air pollutants  cause  damages  to materials.
Sulfur   dioxide  corrodes   metals,   particulary  galvanized
steel;  it  also  attacks   cotton textiles,  finishes    and
coatings,  paints, building  stone, electrical and electronic
equipment, paper, and leather.   -Ozone   has  been   shown   to
shorten  the  life  of   rubber  products,  dyes, and paints.
Nitrogen oxides  also  cause  fading  of  dyes  and paints.
Particulates cause deterioration  and  soiling of stone,  clay,
and   glass  structures and  products.  These damaging effects
are experienced by society  in  a number   of ways.   In  many
cases,  avoidance  costs are additional because research  and
development has been needed  to develop   new  materials  more
resistant  to  attack by air pollution.  These  new  materials
are sometimes more expensive than those more susceptible   to
damage.   Society  also  bears  the   costs of  cleaning  and
repairs, including the replacement of failed or deteriorated
components and structures.   In some cases, the  failure  of  a
material can cause damages.
 Survey of  Source  Studies

 Best  documentation   for  damage  to  materials  covers  the
 effects  of sulfur dioxide,   ozone,   and  nitrogen  dioxide.
 Particulates   have   been shown to have effects on soiling of
 paints and building  materials.  Surveys of  physical  damage
 functions   may be found  in Yocom and McCaldin (1968} and the
 NATO  criteria  documents  for  particu-lates  (1971),  sulfur
 dioxide   (1971),  and photochemical oxidants (1974).   Much of
 the recent work in both  ambient air  and  controlled   chamber
 studies  has   been   pursued  at  EPAs National Environmental
 Research Center in Triangle Park, N.C.   Economic  estimates
 based on   physical   damage studies  have been made by Salmon
 (1970),  Gillette  (1974), Haynie (1974), and Waddell   (1974).
 The major  damage  studies are summarized in Table 4.
                            2-30

-------
                          Table 4.
            Summary of Materials Damage Studies
Study

Upham

Haynie and
  Upham
Date

1965

1970
Pollutants Measured

Sulfur dioxide

Sulfur dioxide
Beloin and    1973
  Haynie

Booz Allen  .  1970
  and Hamilton

Michelson and 1967
  Tourin

Upham         1974
  et al.
         Particulates
         Particulates
         Particulates
         Nitrogen dioxide
Effects

Metal corrosion

zinc corrosion
due to sulfur
dioxide and
humidity

Soiling


Soiling


Paint Soiling
                        Textile dye
                        fading
The  most  comprehensive  survey of economic losses incurred
from air pollution damage to materials is the work of Salmon
(1970).  Thirty-two categories of materials were  the  basis
for calculating a total economic loss of $3.8 billion due to
air  pollution.   The  pollutants,  in  decreasing  order of
economic importance, were found to be sulfur oxides,  ozone,
nitrogen  oxides,  carbon dioxide and particulates.  Waddell
has used parts of this study, combined with in-depth studies
on specific categories, to arrive at  an  estimate  for  the
cost of materials losses in 1970,

Haynie  (1974)  has  assessed  economic  damages  to metals,
paints,  elastomers,  electrical  contacts  and   electronic
components  at  $2.7. billion  per year.  The percentages of
total economic loss and  available  reference  material  are
given   for •  metals,   paints,  textiles,  elastomers,  and
plastics.  Each area is also rated as to  whether  there  is
strong  or  weak  evidence  of  damage  or  only a suspected
relationship, i This approach clearly defines areas requiring
further investigation.

Economic damage due to sulfur dioxide has been estimated  by
Gillette   (1974), both on a national and regional basis; the
                           2-31

-------
estimate shows  significant  reductions  in  sulfur  dioxide
levels nationwide between 1968 and 1972.  These calculations
were  carried out for various SMSAs using the air quality at
the center of the city as representative of the entire SMSA.
Reductions of damages due to sulfur dioxide were  calculated
to decrease from $900 million to $75 million over the 5-year
period.   This  loss  was  determined  to  occur mostly  from
corrosion of painted or unpainted surfaces.

Physical damage studies  pertaining  to  materials  are  not
available  on  a  comprehensive basis, but studies that  have
been  done  on  specific  materials   are   usually   better
quantified  than  studies on health or vegetation damage due
to  the  lack  of  biological  complications.   The  studies
presented  below are representative of the backup data which
support the economic damage functions.

Metal  corrosion  is  the  most   economically   significant
category.   A number of studies have been completed on metal
corrosion  caused  by  sulfur  dioxide.   One ' of  the   most
illustrative  for widespread geographic  interpretation was  a
study by Upham  (1965) on  metal  corrosion  in  eight  major
cities,  values of corrosional weight loss between levels of
0.02  and  0.14 ppm annual sulfur dioxide concentration  vary
from 4 to 12 grams, respectively.  Except for one city,  the
data   very   nearly  fits  a  straight  line  dose-response
function.  Corrosion of zinc has been investigated by Haynie
and Upham (1970); sulfur dioxide and relative humidity   were
determined  to act synergistically in the corrosion process.
Significant reductions in  useful  lifespan  were  predicted
even at sulfur dioxide concentrations as low as 130 ug/m'.

Good   correlation  of  soiling  of  painted  and  unpainted
surfaces with particulate concentration  has  been  found by
Beloin and Haynie  (1973) for a variety of substances.  Dose-
effect  functions  were developed by regression analysis and
particulates were  found to account for up to 92  percent of
the  variability  of  reflectance  for   certain  substances.
Whether or not this physical change can  be linked to changes
in maintenance frequency is not yet clear.  Studies by   Booz
Allen   and   Hamilton   (1970)  in  the Philadelphia   area
demonstrated no correlation with  particulate  concentration
between  50  and   150  ug/ms, vhile a study by Michelson and
Tourin  (1967) showed more than four times as much repainting
was done in areas with 250 ug/m^ concentration than in areas
with 50 ug/ms concentration.  However,   the  transgeographic
nature of the study leaves these results open to question.

Nitrogen   dioxide  has  been  only  tentatively  linked to
significant materials damage.  A recent  study  by  Upham e_t
al.   (for  EPA) has indicated that certain cellulosic fibers
                            2-32

-------
may  be  affected  by  nitrogen  dioxide.   Controlled  test
chambers  were employed to investigate both nitrogen dioxide
and relative  humidity  effects.   correlation  of  nitrogen
dioxide  concentration with dye fading was found, as well as
evidence  of  a  synergism  with  relative  -humidity.   This
correlation  is  supported  somewhat  by  the  cost study of
Salvin, which linked sulfur and nitrogen oxides and acids to
changes in textile fibers and dyes.
                    MORE ELUSIVE DAMAGES
As pointed out on repeated occasions, the current  state-of-
the-art   in   benefit   assessment  does  not  permit  full
estimation of all the damages associated with air pollution.
For example, in assessing the damages to human  health,  the
costs  of  lost  leisure  time  and  psychic  costs  are not
adequately reflected in estimates of the  economic  cost  of
illness.   In  other  cases, the effects themselves have not
yet been adequately defined, as in the case with the risk of
large-scale ecological  disruptions.   With  some  types  of
damage,  both  the  effects  and  the  damage  values  elude
adequate definition.  Additional damage categories that have
been excluded from the discussion presented above include:

  •  unquantified health effects
  •  Animal health
  •  Natural environment.
                           2-33

-------
Bibliography

Anderson,  Einar,  et  al.,  "Effect  of  Low-Level   Carbon
  Monoxide   Exposure   on  Onset  and  Duration  of  Angina
  Pectoris.  A Study in Ten  Patients  with   ischemic  Heart
  Disease/1 Annals internal Medicine. 79(1}:  pp. 46-50, July
  1973.

Anderson,  R.  J.  and  CrocKer,  T.D.,   "Air Pollution and
  Housings Some Findings," Purdue University,  1970.

Aronow, w. S. and isbell,  M. w., "Carbon  Monoxide Effect  on
  Exercise-Induced   Angina   Pectoris,"   Annals   Internal
  Medicine. 79: pp. 392-395, 1973.

Bates, D. and Hazucha, M., "The Short Term Effects of  ozone
  on  the  Human Lung," in: Proceedings Conference on Health
  Effects  of  Air  pollutants,  U.S.  Government   Printing
  Office, 1973,

Beard,  R.  R.  and  Wertheim, G. A., "Behavioral Impairment
  Associated with Small Doses of Carbon Monoxide,"  American
  Journal Public Health,  57: pp. 2012-2022,  1967.

Beloin,  Norman J. and Haynie, Fred H., "Soiling of Building
  Materials," U.S. Environmental Protection  Agency,  January
  1973.

Benedict,  H.  M., et al., "Assessment of Economic Impact of
  Air Pollution on Vegetation in the United   States  -  1969
  and  1971," Stanford Research  Institute, July 1973.

Booz  Allen & Hamilton Inc.,  "Study to Determine Residential
  Soiling  costs  of  Particulate   Air   Pollution,"   U.S.
  Department of Health, Education and Welfare, 1970.

BotKin,   D. B., et al.,  "ozone  Suppression  of white Pine Net
  Photosynthesis," journal  Air  Pollution   Control  Assoc.,
  21(12): pp.  778-780, December 1971.

Brewer,   w.   J.   and Ferry,  G.,  "Effects  of  Air Pollution  in
  the  San joaquin  Valley,"  California  Agriculture,  June
  1974.

Buechley,  R.  W.,  et al..  "S02 Levels and Perturbations  in
  Mortality,"  Archives Environmental Health,  27:  pp.   134-
  137,  September  1973.

California  Air   Resources  Board,  Human  Health Damages  from
  Mobile   Sources    Air   Pollution.   U.S.   Environmental
                            2-34

-------
  Protection   Agency,   Washington  Environmental  Research
  Center, work in progress.

Costonis, A. C. and Sinclair, W. A., "Ozone Injury to  Pinus
  Strobus,"  Journal  Air  Pollution Control Assoc., 19(11):
  pp. 867-871, November 1969.

Crocker, T.  D.,  "urban  Air  Pollution  Damage  Functions:
  Theory  and  Measurement,"  U.S.  Environmental Protection
  Agency, 1971.

Davis, Charles R., "Sulfur Dioxide Fumigation  of  Soybeans:
  Effect  on  Yield,"  Journal Air Pollution Control Assoc.,
  22: pp. 778-780, December 1972.

Environmental Protection  Agency,  "Health  consequences  of
  Sulfur   Oxides:  A  Report  from  CHESS,  1970-71,"  U.S.
  Government Printing Office, May 1974.

Finklea, et  al.,   "Health  Effects  of  Increasing  Sulfur
  Oxides   Emissions,"   Draft  Report,  U.S.  Environmental
  Protection Agency, March 1975.

Gardner, O. E., Environmental Influences on Living  Alveolar
  Macrophages, University of Cincinnati, 1971.

Gillette, Donald G., "Sulfur Dioxide Standards and Materials
  Damage," U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, 1974.

Goldsmith,  j.  G.,  "Effects  of  Air  Pollution  on  Human
  Health," In: Air Pollution,. Stern, A. C. (ed.)  2nd  ed.,
  Vol. 1, New York, Academic Press, 1968.

Goldsmith, J. R. and Nadel, J. A., "Experimental Exposure of
  Human  Subjects  to  Ozone," Journal Air Pollution Control
  Assoc.. 19(5): pp. 329-330, May 1969.

Haynie,  Fred  H.,  "The   Economics   of   Clean   Air   in
  Perspective,"  Materials  Performance.  13(4):  pp. 33-38,
  April  1974.

Haynie,  F. H. and upham,  J,  B.,  "Effects  of  Atmospheric
  Sulfur Dioxide  on  the  Corrosion  of  line,"  Materials
  Protection and Performance, 9(8): pp. 35-40, 1970.

Hazucha, M., e_t al. f_ Effects of_ Ozone and Sulfur Dioxide  on
  Pulmonary Function in Man, McGill University, 1973.

Heck,  W. W. and Brandt, C. S., "Impact of Air Pollutants on
  vegetation: Crops, Forests, Native,"  In:  Air  Pollution,
                           2-35

-------
  Stern,  A. C. and Steigerwald, B. J.,  (eds.,), vol. 1, New
  York, Academic Press, 1974.

Heck, w. W., et al.f "Ozone: Non-Linear Relation of Dose and
  injury  in  Plants,"  Science.  151(3710):  pp,   577-578,
  February 4., 1966.

Heggestad,  H.  E.,  "Photochemical  Air Pollution Injury to
  Potatoes in the Atlantic coastal states," American  Potato
  journal. 50, 1973.

Hexter,  A.  C.  and  J.  R.  Goldsmith,  "Carbon  Monoxide:
  Association of community Air  Pollution  with  Mortality,"
  Science. 172: pp. 265-266, April 1971.

Hill,   C.   A.,  et  al.,   "Sensitivity  of  Native  Desert
  vegetation to S02 and to SO2 and  N02  Combined,"  Journal
  Air Pollution Control Assoc., 24(2): pp. 153-157, February
  1974.

Horvath, S. M. et al.^ "Carbon Monoxide and Human Vigilance.
  A  Deleterious  Effect  of  Present Urban Concentrations,"
  Archives Environmental Health. 2.3: pp. 343-347, 1971.

Howell, Robert, Unpublished  study  on  soybean  yields  and
  ambient  ozone  exposure,  U.S. Department of Agriculture,
  College Park, Maryland, 1973-1974.

House subcommittee on the Environment  and  the  Atmosphere,
  Committee   on   Science   and  Technology,  "House . Panel
  Criticizes EPA's CHESS Study,"  Press  conference  on  the
  CHESS Report, November 24, 1976.

JaXsch, 3. S. and Stoevener, H. H., Outpatient Medical Costs
  Related  to  Air  pollution  in the Portland, Oregon Areaf
  U.S.  Environmental Protection Agency, 1974.

Jacobson, J. S. and Hill, A. Clyde, Editors, Recognition  of_
  Air  Pollution injury to Vegetation,. Air Pollution control
  Association, Pittsburgh, Pa., 1970.

Lave, L. B., and Seskin, E. P.,  "Air  Pollution  and  .Human
  Health," Science,. 169(3947): pp. 723-733, August 1970.

Lave,  L.  B.  and  Seskin,  E.  P.,  "An  Analysis, of  the
  Association Between U.S.  Mortality  and  Air  Pollution,"
  Journal  American Statistical Assoc. . 68(342: pp. 284-290,
  June 1973.
                           2-36

-------
Mccune, D. C., "Fluoride Criteria for Vegetation Reflect the
  Diversity of the Plant Kingdom," Environmental Science and
  Technology, 3(8): pp. 727-735, August 1969.

Michelson, I. and Tourin, B., "Report on Study  of  Validity
  of  Extension  of Economic Effects of Air Pollution Damage
  froin Upper Ohio River Valley to  Washington,  D.C.  Area/'
  Environmental  Health  and  Safety  Research  Association,
  August 1967.

Miller, P. L., "OKidant-Induced Community Change in a  Mixed
  Conifer Forest," in: Air; Pollution Damage to Vegetation by
  J.  A.  Naegele,  American  Chemical  Society, Washington,
  D.C., 1973.

Mueller, W. J. and SticKney, P. B., "A Survey  and  Economic
  Assessment of the Effects of Air Pollution on Elastomers,"
  U.S.   Department  of Health, Education, and Welfare, June
  1970.

National  Academy  of  Sciences,  and  National  Academy  of
  Engineering,  Air Quality and Automobile Emission Controlr
  U.S. Government Printing Office, 1974.

Nelson, J. P.,  "Effects  of  Mobile-Source  Air  and  Noise
  "Pollution on Residential Property Values," U.S. Department
  of Transportation, 1975.

Neuberger, J. S. and Radford, E. P., "Review of Human Health
  Criteria  for  Ambient Air Quality Standards in Maryland,"
  Johns Hopkins university, August 1974.

North Atlantic Treaty Organization, Air Quality Criteria for
  Particulate Matter, November 1971.

North Atlantic Treaty Organization, Air Quality Criteria for
  Sulfur Oxides. November 1971.

North Atlantic  Treaty Organization,  Air  Quality  Criteria
  for Carbon Monoxide. 1972.

North Atlantic Treaty Organization, Air Quality Criteria for
  Nitrogen Oxides, June 1973.

North Atlantic Treaty Organization, Air Quality Criteria for
  Photochemical  Oxidants and Related Hydrocarbons. February
  1974.

Pearlman, M. E.,  et  al.,  "Chronic  Oxidant  Exposure  and
  Epidemic  Influenza,"  Environmental Research. 4: pp. 129-
  140,.April 1971.
                           2-37

-------
Peckham, B. W.,  "Air  Pollution  and  Residential  Property
  Values   in  Philadelphia,"  U.S.  Department  of  Health,
  Education, and welfare, 1970.

Randall, Allen,  et  al.,,  "Benefits  of  Abating  Aesthetic
  Environmental  Damage,"  New  Mexico State University, May
  1974.

Ridker, R. G., Economic costs of Air Pollutionf Frederick A.
  Praeger, New York, 1967.

Ridker,  R.  G.  and  Kenning,  J.,  "The  Determinants   of
  Residential  Property values with Special Reference to Air
  Pollution," Review of Economics and  Statistics.  49:  pp.
  246-257, 1967.

Rice,  Dorothy  P.,  "Estimating  the Cost of Illness," U.S.
  Department of Health, Education, and Welfare, May 1966.

Salmon, R. L., "Systems  Analysis  of  the  Effects  of  Air
  Pollution   on  Materials,"  U.S.  Department  of  Health,
  Education, and Welfare, 1970.

Salvin, V.  S.,  "Survey  and  Economic  Assessment  of  the
  Effects of Air Pollution on Textile Fibers and Dyes," U.S.
  Department of Health, Education and Welfare, June 1970.

Schloettlin,  C.  E.  and  Landau,  E.,  "Air  Pollution and
  Asthmatic Attacks in the Los Angeles Area," Public  Health
  Reports. 76: pp. 548-548,  1961.

Shy,  C.,  e_t al., "The Chattanooga School Study: Effects of
  Community  Exposure   to   Nitrogen   Dioxide.    Methods,
  Description   of   Pollutant   Exposure,  and  Results  of
  ventilatory  Function  Testing,"  Journal  Air   Pollution
  Control Assoc., 20(8):539-545, August 1970.

Shy,  C.,  et. al., "The Chattanooga School Study: Effects of
  Community Exposure to Nitrogen Dioxide. II.  Incidence  of
  Acute  Respiratory Illness," Journal Air Pollution control
  Assoc., 20(9): pp. 582-588, September 1970.

Spence, J. W. and Haynie, F. H., "Paint Technology  and  Air
  Pollution:   A   Survey  and  Economic  Assessment,"  U.S.
  Environmental Protection Agency, February 1972.

Spore, R. L., Property value Differentials as a  Measure  o_f
  the  Economic  Costs  o£ Air Pollution, Pennsylvania State
  University, 1972.
                            2-38

-------
Sprey, P. and Takacs, I., Enviro Control,  Inc.,  "Study  of
  Trends  in  National  Air  Pollution and Related Effects",
  U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, December 1974.

Temple, Patrick J. "Dose Response of Urban Trees  to  Sulfur
  Dioxide," Journal Air Pollution Control Assoc., 22(4): pp.
  271-274, April 1972.

Thompson, C. R., e_t al., "Effects of Ambient Levels of Ozone
  on  Navel  Oranges," Environmental Science and Technologyf
  6: pp. 1013-1016, November 1972.

Uphasn, 3. B., et al.. "Fading of Selected Drapery Fabrics by
  Air Pollutants,"  U.S.  Environmental  Protection  Agency,
  1974.

Upham,  J.  B., Journal Air Pollution Control Aesoc.. 15: p.
  265, 1965.

waddell, T. E., The Economic Damages of_ Air Pollution,  U.S.
  Environmental Protection Agency, May 1974.

walker,  3.  T.  and  Barlow,  J. C., "Response of Indicator
  Plants to Ozone Levels in Georgia," Phytopathology. 74(8),
  August, 1974.

Yocom, John  E.  and  McCaldin,  Roy  O.,  "Effects  of  Air
  Pollution   on   Materials   and  the  Economy/1  In:  Air
  Pollution. Stern, A. C.  (ed.) 2nd ed., Vol. 1, New  York,
  Academic Press, 1968.

Zelac,  R.  E.,  et al./ "Ozone as a Mutagen", Environmental
  Research, 4: pp. 262-282, 1971.

Zerbe, R. 0., "The  Economics  of  Air  Pollution:  A  Cost-
  Benefit  Approach,"  Ontario . Department of Public Health,
  1969.
                           2-39

-------
Chapter 3
The Costs of Controlling Air Pollution
                      1. INTRODUCTION
This 1975 estimation of the  total  incremental  costs  that
will  be  required  to  meet the provisions set forth by the
Clean Air Act is significantly different from the  estimates
presented  in  the  1974  Cost  g_f  Clean Air Report for the
following reasons:

  1. Costs for more industries have been included, providing
     a broader base than previous reports.

  2. Compliance dates for some standards are different.

  3. More  detailed  analysis  has  been  performed  on  the
     Transportation Control Plans costs.

All  major  industrial pollutant sources which were included
in the 1974 report  are  reevaluated  in  this  report.   In
addition,  costs  have  been  estimated  for  the  following
industrial sources which have been added to make this report
more comprehensive:

  1. Clay construction products
  2. Coal gasification plants
  3. Paint manufacturers
  4. Printing establishments
  5. Surface coatings facilities
  6. Petrochemical industry
  7. Honfertilizer phosphate reduction products
  8. Building and industrial incinerators.

This report  assumes  that  the  compliance  date  for  some
scrubber  installations  in the electric utility plant's will
be extended to as late as July  1,  1980.   This  assumption
will  postpone  some  of  the investment cost for as much as
five years, and it will  also  reduce  the  annual  cost  of
operating   pollution   control   equipment   and  the  cash
requirements of the electric utilities sector to some extent
during the period 1975-80.

Air pollution control costs passed on to the  purchasers  of
light-duty  motor  vehicles  have been calculated based upon
statutory  emission   control   requirements   and   related
regulations.  The reduction in new car sales during the 1975
model  year,  and  futur-e  estimates  of  reduced  car sales
                           2-40

-------
resulted  in  lower  control  costs  than  were   previously
estimated  because control costs are calculated on the basis
of new car sales.

Estimates of the costs associated with State  Transportation
Control  Plans  were  made  on a more detailed basis in this
report and exceed the $2 billion estimate  reported  in  the
1974 cost report.
              2.  GOVERNMENT EXPENDITURES FOR
                   AIR POLLUTION CONTROL
The  Clean  Air  Amendments  of  1970  (P.L.  91-604) impose
somewhat different  requirements  on  governmental  agencies
than  on others affected by the legislation.  Although there
will be some expenditures for abatement  of  pollution  from
government  owned  facilities,  the  principal  purposes  of
expenditures in the  government  sector  are  for  research,
monitoring,  administration,  and  enforcement.  Research is
mainly supported by Federal funds,  while  state  and  local
funds, supplemented by Federal grants, are used primarily to
implement,  operate, and maintain monitoring and enforcement
programs.

Detailed analyses are not presented  here,  since  the  main
purpose of this effort is to determine the magnitude of this
category  of  expenditures  relative  to  other expenditures
estimated in the report.  The discussion concentrates on two
basic categories: program costs and  costs  for  controlling
pollution at Federal facilities.
Program Costs

Table  2-1  shows projected governmental expenditures broken
down by EPA and subfederal categories.   A  stable  rate  of
expenditure after FY 1978 is anticipated due to governmental
revenue constraints and competing social needs.
                           2-41

-------
                         Table 2-1
Projected Local, State and Federal A1r Quality Program Costs
                                                     (By Fiscal  Years in Millions of Dollars)
to
1
EPA1
State & Local
Total
Tran-
1976 sition'
78
156
224
19
39
58
1977
9O
193
283
1978
94
21O
3O4
1979
94
21O
3O4
1980
94
210
3O4
1981
94
21O
3O4
1982
94
21O
3O4
1983
94
21O
304
1984
94
21O
3O4
1985
94
210
3O4
Total
939
2O68
3007
1  Excluding grants to state,  interstate,  and local  governments which are included in that category.
'  July 1.  1976 through September 3O,  1976 for converting Federal  fiscal  year to October i-September 3O,

-------
Federal Program Costs

The  Clean  Air  Act  authorizes  a  national program of air
pollution research, regulation, and enforcement  activities.
Under the Act, primary responsibility for the prevention and
control   of  air  pollution  rests  with  State  and  local
governments, with the program directed at the Federal  level
by  EPA.   EPA's role is to conduct research and development
programs, set  national  environmental  goals,  ensure  that
adequate  standards  and regulations are established to meet
these goals, provide assistance to the  States,  and  ensure
that the standards and regulations are effectively enforced.

The  environmental  standards  are  the National Ambient Air
Quality Standards (NAAQS).  These standards  set  forth  the
allowable  concentration  in  air of pollutants which affect
human health and  public  welfare.   The  health  and  other
effects  of  pollutants are delineated in criteria documents
which are the basis for the standards.  National Ambient Air
Quality  Standards  have  been  set  for   total   suspended
particulates,   sulfur  dioxide,  nitrogen  dioxide,  carbon
monoxide, photochemical  oxidants,  and  hydrocarbons.   Two
types  of  standards  are  set: primary standards to protect
human health and secondary standards to protect  the  public
welfare   (prevention   of   damage  to  property,  animals,
vegetation, crops, visibility, etc.).  Controlling emissions
to meet standards is handled  through  two  major  types  of
activities:  (1) States carry out State implementation plans
(SIPs>  which  control  pollution  primarily  by  preceiving
specific  emission  limitations or control actions for types
of polluters and (2) EPA controls emissions from  new  motor
vehicles and selected stationary sources.

Program  emphasis  will continue to be on the attainment and
maintenance of the National Ambient Air  Quality  Standards.
Because  the  implementation of control actions is basically
the responsibility of the State and  local  governments,  it
will    be    required   that   they   take   on   increased
responsibilities for air pollution control if the  standards
are  to  be  attained,  particularly  if  automotive-related
pollutants are to be controlled.  The  State  control  plans
incorporate controls for automotive related pollutants since
reductions achieved as a result of the Federal motor vehicle
control  program  are not sufficient to attain the standards
for such pollutants in  many  areas.   The  Federal  program
places  primary  emphasis  on  increasing  State  and  local
control agencies' ability to control air pollution.

In order to attain the standards, efforts are to concentrate
on the implementation of State implementation  plans,  their
reassessment, and revision if indicated.  For maintenance of
                           2-43

-------
 the   standards/  many SIPS  will  have to be revised to include
 the  controls  required to assure that the  ambient  air quality
'standards  are not  violated in the future.  The  governors   of
 45   States have  been  formally  notified  by  EPA Regional
 Administrators that   the  SlPs   for  their  states  must   be
 revised  in   order  to  attain  and maintain the NAAQS.  Plan
 revisions  are necessary in 31 States for  particulate matter;
 12 States  for sulfur dioxide; 22 States for carbon monoxide;
 29 States  for  photochemical   oxidants;  and 3  States   for
 nitrogen dioxide.

 The   nature   and  magnitude  of the problems associated with
 attainment and maintenance of  the  NAAQS  varies  with   the
 specific pollutant involved.   Federal  programs  will be aimed
 at   the  formulation of methodologies  for developing control
 strategies and the development  of control systems as well  as
 to the support of  State and local programs.  Maintenance   of
 the   standards  in the long term will  also be facilitated  by
 Federal programs that lead to the minimization  of  emissions
 from new sources (i.e., new motor vehicle emission standards
 and  standards of performance for new stationary sources)  and
 the   assurance  of  continued  low emissions performance  for
 these sources during their useful lives.

 Program expenditures by the Agency are expected   to remain
 level for the next  several years,  with the states gradually
 assuming greater responsibility for  implementation  of   the
 various  provisions  of the Act.   Table 2-2 shows  projections
 for  the three major  appropriations  categories.
                           2-44

-------
                                 Table 2-2.
           Projection of Federal Program Expenditures by Category
to
                                                             (By Fiscal  Years In Millions of Dollars)
        Abatement and
          Control '

        Enforcement

        Research and
          Development

        Total

        1  Includes grants to state, Interstate, and local  government.
        4  duly 1, 1976 through September 3O, 1976, for converting Federal  fiscal  year to October 1,  through September 3O.
Trans-
1976 ition'
63
13
36
1 12
16
3
9
28
1977
89
14
44
147
1978
94
18
40
152
1979 198O
a4 94
18 18
4O 4O
152 152
1981
94
18
40
152
1982
94
18
4O
152
1983
94
18
4O
152
1984
94
18
4O
152
1985
94
18
4O
152
Total
92O
174
4O9
1 ,5O3

-------
Expenditures by Other Federal Agencies

The following information is  excerpted  and  adapted  from:
Office  of  Management and Budget, "Special Analyses: Budget
of the United States Government", USGPO 1976.

Although  covering  a  wide  range  of  activities,  Federal
environmental   programs   are  classified  in  three  broad
categories: pollution control and abatement;  understanding,
describing and predicting the environment, and environmental
protection  and  enhancement activities.  It is difficult to
attribute non-EPA Federal expenditures to specific pollution
control legislation in many cases, but an  approximation  of
P.L. 91-604 related expenditures is given by the air quality
expenditures   in   the   Pollution  Control  and  Abatement
category.  Principal activities  in  this  category  include
actions   necessary   to   reduce   pollution  from  Federal
facilities; the establishment and enforcement of  standards;
research   and   development;   and  the  identification  of
pollutants, their sources, and their impact on health.  Non-
EPA air quality expenditures by the  Federal  government  in
FY1976,  the  transition  quarter and FY1977 are 186, 46 and
209 million dollars, respectively.

Since Federal spending is strongly influenced by policy  and
competing social needs, forecasting is always problematical.
The  best  estimate currently is that such expenditures will
remain stable over the next several years, with  only  minor
growth  or  decline.   If  non-EPA  Federal  outlays in this
category were to be held constant at the FY1977 level, total
decade expenditures would  be  about  2.1  billion  dollars.
While  this  is  a  large amount on an absolute basis, it is
relatively small compared to total expenses  in  the  nation
for P.L. 91-604.
      3.  CONTROL OF EMISSIONS FROM STATIONARY  SOURCES
For  the  purposes  of  this  report, stationary sources are
considered  to  include  industrial  sources,   utilities,  and
industrial/commercial  heating  and  incineration  which are
treated as  industries.  Dry cleaning  establishments,  paint
shops,  and other small scale activities  are  also considered
as industries.

Service stations are  considered   under   the   Mobile   source
section   because  they  are  controlled   for  vapor emissions
under  Transportation Control Plans.
                            2-46

-------
Classification of Industrial Sources

In  order  to  calculate  air   pollution   control   costs,
industries are represented by- "segments" and "model plants".

A "segment" is all or a portion of an industry that has:  (1)
the  same  production  process,  (2)  the same air pollution
control technology,  and  (3)  the  same  pollution  control
standard.   For  example,  the Kraft Paper Industry is dealt
with for purposes of air pollution control costs in terms of
10 different segments.  These segments are defined in  Table
3-1.
                            2-47

-------
                         Table 3-1.
          Kraft Paper Industry Segment Definitions
Process

1.   Power Boiler


2.   Boiler
3.   Recovery
     Furnace
4.   Recovery
     Furnace
5.   Recovery
     Furnace
6.   Recovery
     Furnace
7.   Smelting  Tank
 8.    Lime  Kiln
 9.    Stock  Washer
 10.   Evaporator
Control
Technology

Electrostatic
precipitators

Double Alkali
Scrubber

Electrostatic
Precipitators
                       Venturi Scrubber
Recovery
Furnace Replace-
ment

BLO
Orifice  Scrubber
Venturi  Scrubber
 Incinerate  in
 Recovery  Furnace
 Incinerate  in
 Lime  Kiln
Pollution
Standard

Federal
Particulates

Federal Sulfur
Dioxide

Washington/
Oregon Parti-
culates

Washington/
Oregon Parti-
culates

Washington/
Oregon Total
Reduced Sulfur

Washington/
Oregon Total
Reduced Sulfur

Washington/
Oregon Parti-
culates

Washington/
Oregon Parti-
culates

Washington/
Oregon Total
Reduced Sulfur

Washington/
Oregon Total
Reduced Sulfur
                            2-48

-------
"Model  plants"  are  the building blocks of a segment; that
is, a segment capacity for  production  is  comprised  of  a
number  of  model  plants  that  are  classified  as  either
"existing" or "new" (new facilities  are  those  constructed
after the date when the New Source Performance Standards are
in  effect  for  that industry).  For example, Segment 7 for
Kraft Paper (Smelting Tanks) has  three  model  plant  sizes
(454,  907,  and  1,361 units of production per day).  There
are existing facilities in all three sizes, but  during  the
1975-85  period,  new facilities are -expected to be built in
only the middle size class.  Table 3-2 lists the  industries
for  which  air costs are calculated, the number of segments
for  those   industries,   and   the   Standard   Industrial
Classification  (SIC) industry code as defined by the Office
of Management and Budget (OMB).
                           2-49

-------
                         Table 3-2.
           Segments for Industrial Cost Analysis
Name

Steelmaking
Steel Foundries
Ferroalloy
Steel-Coke
Steel-Scintering
Solid Waste Disposal
Sludge Incineration
NSSC Paper
Primary Zinc
Primary Lead
Secondary Zinc
Secondary Aluminum
industrial Heating
Commercial Heating
Crude Oil Storage
Gasoline Storage
Jet Fuel Storage
Refining
Petroleum Cost Cracking
Primary Aluminum
Natural Gas
Coal Cleaning
iron Foundries
Dry Cleaning
Grain Handling
Feed Mills
Asphalt
Cement
Sulfuric Acid
Nitric Acid
Phosphate Fertilizer
Kraft Paper
Lime
Primary Copper
Secondary Lead
Secondary Brass
Asbestos
Clay Construction Products

Coal Gasification
Petrochemicals
Existing
Segments
22
1
5
3
7
6
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
3
2
1
5
3
1
1
2
4
2
1
4
10
3
3
1
2
6
3

2
7
SIC (1972
Definition)
331 (pt)
3324.5
3313
331 (pt)
331 (pt)
4953
4953
2611272
33331
33321
33414
33417.8
N/A
N/A
29 IX
29 IX
291X
29 IX
291X
33347
1321
1211 (pt), 12136
3321.2
7215.6
5153
2047.8
29510
3241
28193
2873
2874
2611231.35.39.43
3274
33311
33412
3362
3292
1452.3.4.5.6.7.8.9;
3295
N/A
2869
                            2-50

-------
                   Table 3.2. (Continued)
           Segments for Industrial Cost Analysis
Name
Existing
Segments
SJC (1972
Definition)
Nonfertilizer Phosphate         3
Mercury Cell Chlor Alkali       2
Commercial and Industrial       2
  Building Incineration
Surface Coatings                4
Paint Manufacture               2
Painting                        1
            2819
            2812
            N/A

            3711.12.13.14.15;
            3631.32.33.34.3479.
            7531.35
            2851
            2751.52.53.54;
            2711.21.31
The  cost  of  controlling  air  pollution  from  industrial
sources is estimated for model plants.  All existing and new
capacity  is  expressed  in  terms of the model plants.  For
example, the smallest model plant in  Segment  7  for  Kraft
Paper  has to spend $54,000 for capital equipment to control
particulates.  In summary, this model plant is defined by:

  •  Industry - Kraft
  •  Production process - Smelt Tank
  •  Control technology - Orifice Scrubber
  •  Pollution standard - Washington-Oregon Particulates
  •  Model plant capacity - 454 Units
  •  Type of facility - Existing.
Costs Related to Required
Reduction in Air Emissions

The control costs that industries incur  are  directly,  but
usually  not linearly, related to the amount of reduction in
the emissions required.  Since the purpose of  this  section
is  to  estimate the control costs resulting from provisions
of the Clean Air Act, it is  necessary  to  factor  out  the
levels  of  control  that existed in industries prior to the
Clean Air Act.  Controls could have existed  prior  to  1971
because it was economically worthwhile to recover byproducts
or  because  there  were  prior emission regulations (either
self-imposed or government-generated).
                           2-51

-------
REDUCTIONS IN EMISSIONS PRIOR
tO THE CLEAN AIR ACT

Byproduct Recovery. In some  industries,  it  is  common  to
control  particulate  or sulfur oxides emissions in order to
recover materials in these gases that have  economic  value.
Where this was common practice prior to  1971, the associated
control  costs  are  not  calculated  in  this report,  some
byproduct recovery values are, however,  calculated  in  this
report.   such  values are calculated when the controls were
prompted by State Implementation Plans (SIP) that  responded
to   requirements  of  the  Clean  Air   Act.   For  example,
petroleum storage tanks are controlled by  SIP'S  to  reduce
the  hydrocarbon emissions,  in most cases, the value of the
fuel recovered  by  the  control  devices  placed  on  these
storage  tanXs  is  greater  than  the   cost  of the control
devices.  Thus, the control saves industry money rather than
causing a net cost to the industry.

Average Industrial Controls Prior to the Clean Air  Act.  An
attempt  has  been  made  to  estimate   the average level of
control in  each  industry  prior  to  the  date  that  each
industry  was  impacted  by  the provisions of the Clean Air
Act.  For new facilities in a specific industry built during
the late 1970's and early 1980's, it is  assumed  that  they
will have installed pollution equipment  equal to the average
practice   that   existed   prior  to  the  Clean  Air  Act.
Therefore, costs are estimated for the incremental amount of
pollution equipment needed  to  meet  the  current  emission
standards.
REDUCTIONS IS AIR EMISSIONS REQUIRED
BY THE CLEAN AIR ACT

The  Clean  Air  Act  affects pollution control  through:  (1)
ambient standards for six pollutants   tparticulates,  sulfur
oxides  (SOX),  nitrogen  oxides   (tlOx),  hydrocarbons  
-------
meteorology,  terrain,  etc.   State  Implementation   Plans
control  pollution  from industrial sources based upon local
conditions.   For  example,  Oregon  and  Washington   place
stringent  controls  on  existing  Kraft pulp mills, whereas
many states have no existing Kraft pulp mills, and therefore
no  present  controls.   For  some   industries,   such   as
Steelmaking,   some  states  have  more  stringent  emission
controls than others,  in fact, in this report, steel  mills
are   classified   into   four  categories  based  upon  the
stringency of various state air emission controls.

Effectively, the SIP'S translate  the  Federal  ambient  air
standards  into sets of emission standards for particulates,
sulfur  oxide,  nitrogen  oxide,  hydrocarbon,  and   carbon
monoxide.

Some  of  these  types  of  state differences in controlling
existing facilities are taken into account in  this  report.
with  regard  to  new  plants,  there  is  much  less  state
differentiation because there is a set of  Federal  controls
for  new  facilities called New Source Performance Standards
(NSPS).

Hew Source Performance  Standards.  New  Source  Performance
Standards  have  been  promulgated for only a portion of the
industries that will eventually be covered; Table 3-3  shows
the industries that are presently covered under NSPS and the
associated  emission  factors.   The sources for the data in
this table are references 1 through 7 which are contained in
the listing at the end of Table 3-3.  Industries  for  which
NSPS  are  not  yet promulgated are assumed to have the same
cost functions as these subject to SIP regulations.
                           2-53

-------
                         Table 3-3.
        New Source Performance Standards Regulations
Source
 1 .
     Steam Electric
     Generators
7 .
     Municipal
     Incinerators

     Portland Cement
     Plants
     Nitric Acid
     Plants

     Sulfuric Acid
     Plants
Asphalt Concrete
Plants

Petroleum
Ref ineries
(FCC Catalyst
Regenerat ion)
(Process Gas
Burning)
                  Pollutant

                  Part iculates
                  S02  (1iquid fossi1
                     fuel )
                  S02  (sol id fossi1
                     fuel )
                  NOx  (gaseous fuel)
                  NOx  (1iquid fuel)
                  NOx  (solid fuel)
                  Particulates
                     (kiIns)
                  Particulates
                     (clinker coolers)

                  NOx
S02


Acid Mist

Part iculates


Part iculates

CO

H2S
Emission Standard1

O.2  lb/10' Btu heat Input (O.36 g/1Os cal)
O,8  lb/10" Btu heat input (1.* g/1Os cal)

1.2  lb/10* Btu heat input (2.1 g/1O8 cal)

0.2  lb/10' Btu heat input (0.36 g/1O' cal)
0.3  lb/10' Btu heat input (0.54 g/1O« cal)
O.7  lb/108 Btu heat Input (1.26 g/1O8 cal)

0,10 grain/SCF dry flue gas (chngd to 12% C02)
1.9  Ib/T (O.95 Kg/MT)

O.30 Ib/T of dry feed (O.15 Kg/MT

O.1O Ib/T of dry feed (O.O5 Kg/MT


3.O  Ib/T of acid, avg over 2 hrs.  (1.5 Kg/MT)


4.0  Ib/T of acid (1OO%) (2 Kg/MT)
O.15 Ib/T (O.O75 Kg/MT)

7O mg/Nm3


5O mg/Nm3

O.05O volume %

230 mg/Nm' of fuel gas
                                                                     Suitable
                                                                     Control  Technology

                                                                     Electrostatic Precipitator
                                                                     Scrubber (lime slurry)  or
                                                                        low-sulfur fuel switch
                                                                     Scrubber (llrae slurry)  or
                                                                        low-sulfur fuel switch
                                                                     Combustion Modifications
                                                                     Combustion Modifications
                                                                     Combustion Modifications

                                                                     Electrostatic Precipitator
                                                                     or Venturi Scrubber

                                                                     Baghouse

                                                                     Baghouse
                                                                                       Catalytic NOx Decomposition
                                                                                          Systems

                                                                                       Dual  Absorption Plant or
                                                                                          Sodium Sufite/Bi-sulfite
                                                                                          Scrubber
Fabric Filter or
Venturi Scrubber

Electrostatic Precipitator

Electrostatic Precipitator

Electrostatic Precipitator

-------
                        Table 3-3.  (Continued)
             New Source Performance Standards Regulations
to
I
ut
u*
     8.    Hydrocarbon
          Vessels
          (Storage Tank)

     9.    Secondary Lead
          (Reverberatory
          Furnace)

     10,   Brass  and
          Bronze Ingot
          (Furnace)

     11.   Iron and Steel
          (BOF)
     12.   Sewage Sludge
          Incineration

     13.   FerroalToy
          (Electric
          Submerged
          Arc Furnace)
     14.   Iron and Steel
          (Electric Arc
          Furnace)
     15.   Primary
             Primary
               Potroom
   Hydrocarbons


   Participates


   Particulates



   Particulates




   Particulates



   Particulates



   CO

   Particulates
Inorganic Fluorides
   Visible Emissions
(part iculates,
fluor ides)
Require Floating Roof Tank


50 mg/Nm3


50 mg/Nm3



50 mg/Nm3




7O mg/Nm1



O.99 Ib/MW-hr (O.45 kg/«W-hr)z

O.51 Ib/MW-hr (0.23 kg/MW-hr)3

2O% CO by volume

O.OO52 gr/dry scf (12 mg/dry scm)
5% opacity (but there are many  exceptions)
2 ib/ton (1 kg/MT)  of  aluminum produced
   from both Potroom and Bake Plant
 Floating Roof  Tank
 Fabric  Filter  or  Scrubber
 Fabric  Filter
Open-Hood  Scrubber or
    Electrostatic Precipi-
    tator or Closed-Hood
    Scrubber

Venturi Scrubber
Baghouse

Electrostatic Precipitators
Scrubber
Afterburner

Direct shell evacuation
   (DSE) with either building
   evacuation or canopy
   hoods. Or, DSE with
   canopy hoods and natural
   ventilation through the
   open roof.
Wet gas scrubber in series
      with an electrostatic
   precipitator or fabric
   filters using alumina
   absorbant

-------
                            Table 3-3. (Continued)
                 New Source Performance Standards Regulations
              Anode Bake
              Plant
                    Inorganic Fluorides
                    Vlsjble Emissions
                    (partIculates.
                    f)uor i des)
                                                Wet scrubber in conjunction
                                                   with a wet electrostatic
                                                   precipltator or clean
                                                   residua) fluoride-bearing
                                                   cryolite from anode
                                                   remnants before recyclIng
w
o\
16.   Phosphate
     Fertilizer
     Plants
        Vet  Pro-
        cess Phos-
        phoric Acid
        Plants
        Supei—
        phosphoric
        Acid Plants
        Diammoni um
        Phosphate
        Plants
                 Triple
                 Superphos-
                 phate

                 Granular
                 Triple
                 Supei—
                 phosphate
                 Storage
                             Inorganic Fluorides
                             Inorganic Fluorides
                             Inorganic Fluorides
                    Visible Emissions
                    (particulates,
                    fluorides)
                    Inorganic Fluorides
                    Visible Emissions
                    Inorganic  Fluorides
                             Visible Emissions
O.O2O Ib/ton (1O g/MT) of equivalent P205 feed
O.O1O Ib/.ton (5.O g/MT) of eqvlnt P205 feed
O.OSO Ib/to.n (30 g/MT) of equivalent P2.05 feed
2O% opacity
O.2O Ib/ton (1OO g/MT) of eqvlnt P205 feed
20% opacity
5.OX1O-" 1b/hr/tn (O.25 g/hr/MT) of equivalent
P205
                                            2O%  opacity
Cross-flow  spray  packed
   scrubber
Cross-flow  spray  packed
    scrubber

'Cross-flow  spray  packed
    scrubber
Cross-flow  spray  packed
   scrubber
Cross-flow  spray  packed
   Scrubber
         17.  Coal Cleaning
              Fad 1 ities
                 Wet Clean-
                 ing Systems
                 Dry Clean-
                 ing Systems
                    PartIculates
                    Particulates
O.O31 grain/dry scf (O.06 mg/dry SCM)

O.O18 grain/dry scf (O.O29 mg/dry SCM)
High  efficiency,  venturi
    type  wet  scrubbers
Fabric filters
           Not to exceed the amount given.
           When producing silicon metal,  ferrosi1 icon,  calcium silicon,  or silico-manganese zirconium.
           When producing high carbon ferrochrome,  charge chrome,  standard ferromanganese,  silico  manganese,  calcium
           carbide,  ferrochrome silicone,  ferromanganese silicon,  or  silvery  iron.

-------
References for fable 3-3.

1.   Background  Information   for   Proposed  'New   Source
     Performance Standards:  Steam Generators/ Incinerators,
     Portland  Cement  Plants,  Nitric Acid Plants:, Sulfuric
     Acid Plants.   U.S. -Environmental  Protection  Agency,
     Research Triangle Park, North Caroline.  APTD-0711,  50
     p., August 1971.

2.   Background  Information   for   Proposed   New   Source
     Performance   Standards:   Asphalt   Concrete   Plants,
     Petroleum Refineries, Storage vessels,  Secondary  Lead
     Smelters   and   Refineries,   Brass  or  Bronze  Ingot
     Production  Plants,  Iron  and  Steel  Plants,   Sewage
     Treatment   Plants.    U.S.   Environmental  Protection
     Agency, Research Triangle Park,(North Carolina.   APTD-
     1352a.  61 p., June 1973.

3.   Background information for  Standards  of  Performance:
     Primary Aluminum industry volume 1: Proposed Standards.
     U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Research Triangle
     Park,  North  Carolina.  450/2-r74-020a.  99 p., October
     1974.

4.   Background Information for  Standards  of  Performance:
     Electric  Arc  Furnaces in the Steel Industry volume 1:
     Proposed  Standards.   U.S.  Environmental   Protection
     Agency, Research Triangle Park, North Carolina. : 450/2-
     74-017a.  155p., October 1974.

5.   Background Information for  Standards  of  Performance:
     Electric  Submerged  Arc  Furnaces  for  Production  of
     Ferroalloys  volume  1:   Proposed   Standards.   -.U.S.
     Environmental   Protection  Agency,  Research  Triangle
     Park, North Carolina.  450/2-74-018a.  147 p.,  October
     1974.

6.   Background Information for  Standards  of  Performance:
     Phosphate   Fertilizer   Industry  volume  1:  Proposed
     Standards.   U.S.  Environmental   Protection   Agency,
     Research Triangle  Park, North Carolina.  450/2-74-019a.
     119 p., October 1974.

7,   Background Information for  Standards  of  Performance:
     Coal  Preparation  Plants volume 1: Proposed Standards.
     U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Research Triangle
     Park, North Carolina.  450/2-74-021a.  40  p.',  October
     1974.
                            2-57

-------
Hazardous  Air Substances. The costs of control (as measured
by either the cumulative investment over a  ten-year  period
or   the  annual  costs)  are  relatively  small  for  those
industries controlling hazardous substances in comparison to
the control costs  for  other  industries.   The  industries
affected by hazardous substances regulations to date are:

  •  Chlor-Alkali and Primary Mercury for mercury emissions

  •  The Asbestos industry and construction  and  demolition
     operations for asbestos emissions

  •  Primary Beryllium for beryllium emissions.

Methods  for  Controlling  Air  Emissions  from   Stationary
Sources.  The most common pollutants that industrial sources
have to control are particulates and sulfur oxides.  Of   the
thirty-nine  industries evaluated in this report, twenty-two
must control for particulates  and  nine  must  control   for
sulfur oxides.

  1. Particulate  Control  Devices.   In   simplest    terms,
particulates   are   controlled   by    using   electrostatic
precipitators  (ESP), scrubbers, or  filters.    The  scrubbers
are  usually  a  wet process that generates a  water  effluent
problem in the water medium.  ESP and   filters  are  usually
dry processes  insofar as  the extraction of particulates  from
the  air is concerned,  but plants often choose  to dispose of
the extracted particulates via a water  stream,  when this is
done, a water problem is  also  created.   Several  of   these
intermedia impacts are  dealt with in this report.

Plants  often  put  several control devices  in series  or use
various types  of control   devices   within the category  of
scrubber.   For  example,  a segment of the  Primary  Aluminum
industry employs a primary collector  (hoods   and   ducts),  a
wet  ESP,  and   spray tower  (scrubber)  in series.  Different
segments of the  Kraft pulp mill   industry   employ   cyclonic
scrubbers,  Venturi   scrubbers,  and orifice  scrubbers.   The
individual industry descriptions will   explain the   control
techniques   assumed  in   each  case.   These  examples  are
provided here  to highlight the  intermedia   problem   and  to
place   the  control devices  into  some  common categories that
are easy  to understand.

Electrostatic  precipitators  are   employed  for  particulates
that  can  be   ionized   and   separated  from a gas stream by
electrical means.   Scrubbers  usually  employ  water to  "wash"
particles  out   of  a  gas  stream.   Filters are used to remove
particles  that can   be   trapped   as  the   gas  stream  moves
through  a fabric media.   Filters  are  gaining in  application
                            2-58

-------
because the new fiberglass filters can be employed  at  very
high temperatures (up to 550°F).

There are a group of miscellaneous control devices that also
can  be  used  for  particulate  reductions.   These include
afterburners, hoods,  and  building  evacuation  (where  the
building   is  sealed  tight  and  workspace  emissions  are
collected at vented locations).

  2. Sulfur Oxide Control Devices. The most  common  control
devices for sulfur oxides are scrubbers, absorbers, and acid
plants.  The scrubbers are of the amine, lime, limestone, or
lime/limestone   type.   Often  an  acid  plant  (a  control
technique that recovers sulfuric acid from the  sulfur  gas)
such as a Claus plant is used in conjunction with a scrubber
to  obtain  a  valuable  byproduct  that can be sold.  Claus
recovery plants must themselves be controlled with  a  tail-
gas treatment facility.

  3. Nitrogen Oxide Control Devices. The only  industry  for
which  nitrogen  oxide controls are explicitly considered in
this report is the Nitric Acid industry.  Nitric acid plants
reduce  nitrogen  oxide  emissions  by  employing  catalytic
reduction  devices.   In  this method of control, the gas is
treated with  a  catalytic  reduction  technique  that  uses
natural  gas,  ammonia,  or  hydrogen.   Use  of natural gas
dominates because of its lower  costs  and  proven  ability.
However, the increasing shortages of natural gas could alter
its use in the future.

  4. Hydrocarbon Control Devices. Petroleum,  Dry  Cleaning,
Paint   Manufacture,  Surface  coatings,  and  Printing  are
industries  that   must   control   hydrocarbon   emissions.
Petroleum  storage controls tend to be handled by installing
floating roofs on the storage tanks; this is almost always a
profitable  byproduct  recovery   process.    Dry   cleaning
emissions  will  be  reduced  by switching material reports,
Printing   emissions   are   reduced   by   using    thermal
incinerators.

  5. Carbon  Monoxide  control  Devices.   Carbon   monoxide
emission  controls  are  considered  only  for the Petroleum
Industry.  Carbon monoxide is burned along with hydrocarbons
to  form less noxious gases.  This  burning  takes  place  in
waste-heat boilers, and the energy generated in this burning
is  often  used  to  economic advantage by the industry.  In
some existing refineries, the additional steam generated  by
these boilers cannot be used, but new plants can be designed
to  take  advantage  of  this  means of reducing their total
energy requirement.
                           2-59

-------
  6. Pretreatment Options. Quite often, it is very efficient
to reduce.the emissions from a plant by  changing  fuels  or
making some.kind of process change.  Two cases where this is
often  practiced are the Steam Electric Power Plants and Dry
Cleaning.  As the summaries for these two  industries  show,
assumptions  are made about the amount of fuel switching and
solvent fluid used, respectively.

Industrial  Descriptions  and  Assumptions.   The   industry
summaries  and  assumptions  are  presented  in the sequence
listed in Table 3-4, and they describe each source in  terms
of   the   industry   characteristics,   emissions,  control
technology, and costs of control.
                           2-60

-------
                    Table 3-4.
   industrial Sector Coverage for Air Pollution
      Control Analysis of Stationary Sources
Sequence    industry
   1        Coal Cleaning
   1        Coal Gassification
   3        Natural Gas Processing
   4        Feed Mills
   5        Kraft Pulp Mills
   6        NSSC Pulp Mills
   7        Printing
   B        Mercury Cell Chlor-Alkali
   9        Nitric Acid
  10        .Paint Manufacture
  11        Phosphate Fertilizer
  12        Nonfertilizer Phosphate
  13        SuIfuric Acid
  14        Petrochemicals
  15        Petroleum
  16        Ferroalloy
  17        iron and Steel
  18        Iron Foundries
  19        Steel Foundries
  20        Primary Aluminum
  21        Secondary Aluminum
  22        Primary Copper
  23        Secondary Brass and Bronze
  24        Primary Lead
  25        Secondary Lead
  26        Primary Zinc
  27        Secondary Zinc
  28        Asbestos
  29        Asphalt Concrete
  30        Cement
  31        Lime Manufacture
  32        Clay Construction Products
  33        Surface Coatings
  34        Steam Electric Power Plants
  35        Solid Waste Disposal
  36        Sewage Sludge Incineration
  37        Grain Milling
  38        Dry Cleaning
  39        industrial and Commercial Heating
                      2-61

-------
COAL CLEANING INDUSTRY

Production Characteristics and Capacities, in 1972, which  is
the last year that Bureau of Mines data was  available,  the
total  production  of  bituminous  and  lignite  coal in the
United States vas about 540 million metric tons.  The annual
production rate has gone both up and down in  recent  years,
but  the  net  change  from  1968 to 1972 was an increase  of
about 9 percent.  The 1972 production came from 4,879 mines.
About 51 percent of the  production  came  from  underground
mines, 46 percent from strip mines, and 3 percent from  auger
mines.   The  trend  over recent years has been toward  fewer
mines and toward & greater dependence on strip mining.   The
number  of  underground  mines  has been decreasing,  largely
because of the strict regulations  of  the   1969  Coal  Mine
Health and Safety Act.

In  the  mining  of  coal, various inert materials  and  other
impurities, such as pyritic sulfur, are recovered along with
the coal.  If these  materials  are  present  in  sufficient
quantity,  they  must  be  removed  by  coal cleaning.  This
cleaning process increases the heating value of the coal and
reduces the amount of pollutants emitted when  the  coal   is
burned.

In  strip  mining  where  the  coal seams are uncovered, the
amount of impurities in the coal is relatively low, and only
about 32 percent of the coal mined in  this   manner  requires
cleaning.   In  underground  mining, the cutting and  loading
methods used  lead to somewhat greater  amounts of impurities,
and about 67  percent  of  the  coal  mined   in  this  manner
requires  cleaning.   Overall,  about  49 percent of the coal
mined in this country is  mechanically  cleaned.    In  1972,
about  355  million  metric   tons  of  raw  coal were cleaned,
yielding about  266 million metric  tons of  cleaned coal. The
amount of coal  cleaning showed a net decrease  of   about   20
percent   from  1968  to  1972;  this  decrease  resulted from the
increased   use  of   strip  mining    (which   requires   less
cleaning),    and   the    increased   shipments  to  electric
utilities,  who usually  do not  require  cleaning.   However,
the   amount   of  coal   cleaning  increased  by about  8  percent
between  1971  and  1972.

Mechanical  coal cleaning  involves  methods  similar   to  those
used   in  the  ore-dressing  industries.   About  96  percent  of
coal   cleaning  is   done   by   wet-processing  methods,   with
pneumatic or  air  cleaning  methods  being  used for  the  other 4
percent.  The dust  abatement  regulations of the Occupational
Health  and  Safety Act  will  eventually  cause a  phasing out  of
pneumatic  cleaning over the  next  few years.
                            2-62

-------
About  18  percent  of  the  coal  which  is cleaned by wet-
processing methods is thermally-dried before  being  loaded.
Drying  is  done  to  avoid freezing problems, to facilitate
handling, to improve quality, or to decrease  transportation
costs.   In  1972,  there  were 112 thermal drying plants in
this country which processed about 48 million metric tons of
coal.  This represents an increase of about 11 percent  from
the previous year.  During the same year the total number of
coal  cleaning  plants  decreased  from  411 to 408, but the
number of coal cleaning plants with_  driers  increased  from
103  to 112.  In such drying plants, a significant source of
pollution is the particulate emissions from the driers.   To
meet  the  new regulations on particulate emissions, venturi
scrubbers (or the equivalent) must be installed.

The present turmoil in the related areas  of  energy  supply
and  environmental protection makes the prediction of future
growth trendfe in the coal industry  rather  uncertain.   The
basic  factor inhibiting the rapid growth of coal production
is the high sulfur content of most readily-available Eastern
coals.  The Western portion of the nation has large reserves
of low sulfur coal but the high cost  of  transporting  this
coal  to  the  Midwestern  and Eastern markets has, at least
until recently, precluded large scale use  of  this  source.
The  alternative  to  the use of low sulfur coal is flue gas
desulfurization  technology,  and  an  intensive  effort  is
currently  being  directed in this area.  If the regulations
on sulfur dioxide emissions from electrical power plants are
adhered to and flue gas desulfurization technology  lags,  a
slowing  in  the  growth  rate of coal could result.  On the
other hand,  restrictions  on  imports  of  petroleum  could
accelerate the demand for coal.

Emission  Sources  and  Pollutants. The emissions of primary
concern from  coal  cleaning  plants  are  the  particulates
resulting   from  drying  operations.   The  available  data
indicate that in 1971, only 1 percent  of  the  coal  drying
capacity  was  equipped  with devices capable of removing at
least 99 percent of the particulate matter in  the  effluent
gas.   Another  87 percent of the capacity was equipped with
low-energy cyclones which remove only about  90  percent  of
the   particulate   matter.    in  order  to  meet  the  new
regulations, these cyclones will have to  be  replaced  with
the high-energy venturi scrubbers.

The  uncontrolled  emission  levels were calculated from the
emission factors for  coal  driers.   The  emission  factors
given  by  the  EPA  are  5.9  kilograms of particulates per
metric ton of coal dried''for fluidized bed  driers  and  2.3
kilogram  per metric ton for flash driers.  Since the Bureau
of Mines data 'indicate that 64 percent of  the  coal  driers
                           2-63

-------
are  fluidized  bed  units  and the rest are various designs
which should have  emissions  similar  to  flash  driers,  a
weighted   average   emission  factor  of  4.6  kilogram  of
particulates per metric ton of dried coal was calculated.

The emissions at the 1972 control  level  are  based  on  90
percent   particulate   removal   for   87  percent  of  the
throughput, and  99.5  percent  particulate  removal  for  1
percent of the throughput,  in the state-by-state breakdown,
this  value  has  little meaning for the states with a small
number of plants because  in  these  cases,  the  extent  of
control  may  vary  considerably  from  the national average
values used in the calculations.

The "allowable" emissions are the values that apply  if  all
throughput  existing  before January 1, 1974, just meets the
appropriate  State  Implementation  Plan  level,   and   all
throughput  added after that date just meets the Federal New
Source standard.  The calculation of the allowable emissions
for the plants existing in 1972 is detailed in Table  3-1-1.
These  emissions  were  adjusted to 1974 by adding 4 percent
per year, which is equivalent to assuming that the growth in
throughput over these two years occurred through new  plants
having  the  same  size distribution as the existing plants.
Again, this could be considerably in error for  some  states
but should be quite good for the national total.
                            2-64

-------
                        Table 3-1-1.

   Coal Cleaning industry Allowable Particulate Emissions

                         1972 Data
State
No.
of
Plants
Average Drying
Rate
Allowable Particulate
Emission
                          1,000
                          metric
                          ton/yr
                 kkg/hr
                  kg/hr/
                  plant
Alabama
Colorado
Illinois
Indiana
Kentucky
North Dakota
Ohio
Pennsylvania
Utah
Virginia
West Virginia

Totals
  1
  1
  9
  1
 15
  2
  4
 13
  2
 10
 54

112
,137
294
722
,213
256
.74
289
388
327
408
448
129.8
33.6
82.6
138.5
29.1
8.6
33.1
44.5
37.2
46.8
51.3
16.4
13.4
23.2
23.2
18.2
8.7
18.2
-
-
21.0
21.03
               Total
               metric
               ton/yr

               158
               130
             2,018
               224
             2,628
               168
               701
               675*
               5802
             2,028
            10,951

            20,261
  0.2 grains/,03 cubic meter gas
  85% control
  Assumed, since no general regulation was included in SIP.
Control  Technology and Costs. In most cases, the technology
used for removing this particulate matter  will  be  venturi
scrubbers.   if  other  technology  is  used for some of the
driers, its cost should be comparable to the cost of venturi
scrubbers,  so  that  a  cost  analysis  based  on   venturi
scrubbers should be valid.

A  report  by  the  Industrial Gas Cleaning institute (IGCI)
gives some cost information on venturi  scrubbers  for  coal
driers.   This information and some- calculations based on it
are summarized in Table 3-1-2.  Annualized control costs and
industry operating data are detailed in Table 3-1-3.
                           2-65

-------
                                 Table 3-1-2.
                    Coal Cleaning Industry Unit Cost Data
                               on Wet Scrubbers
                              (In 1973 Dollars)
NJ
         Coal Drying Capacity (MT/Hr)
         Gas Flow Rate (mVroln)'
         Participate Removal (%)
                  Typical
                  Plant 1

                  227
                5,378
                   99.64
                     Typical
                     Plant 2

                     68O
                  16,134
                      99.64
         Operating Cost Components:
           Opera 11ng 1abor
           Maintenance materials
           Power

           Process water

         Total O&M Costs
                                         No. Units
ias hr/yr

2.45x10'
  kwh/yr
                  Cost (1,OOO $/yr)
                                                        Low
                       Med i urn
High
         No. Units
Cost ( LOCO $/yr)
                                                                                                  Low
                                                                                                          Medium
         Basis:  Industrial Gas Cleaning Institute report on Contract No.  68-O2-O3O1  for EPA,  9/3O/72.
                 Values for two units given were averaged.

         1  At 19O*F and 14.16 psla.
         '  Escalated from 1971 to 1973 using CE Plant  Cost  Index (=  132.2  in 1971;  144.1 in June 1973)
               High
O.63
2.39
12.26

2.55
17.83
O.88
2.66'
26.93

4.24
34.71
1 .25
2.93
49.OO

5.94
59. 12
125 hr/yr

8. 13x1O'
kwh/yr
193x10' 1/yr

O.63
6.47
4O.65

7.64
55.39
O.88
7. 19'
89. 5O

12.73
1 10.3O
1 .25
7.91
162.7

17.83
189.69

-------
0\
-j
                                        Table 3-1-3.
                            Coal Cleaning Industry Data Summary
                ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                                      1975
                                                                  198O
                  Capacity (1.OOO MT/Hr)              5,650.6     7,218.5
                  Annual Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-85 « 2.77%
                                                              1985

                                                              7,399.9
PROCESS CHARACTERISTICS

Model 1
Model 2
Model 3
Model 1 (new plants)
Model 2
Model 3
 Model  Plant Sizes
 (MT/Hr)

 31 .94
 54 .51
1O1.22
 31 .94
 54.51
1O1.22
                EMISSIONS (1.0OOMT/Yr)

                  1971 Controls:

                     Particulates

                  Legislated Controls:

                     Part iculates

                CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

                  Investment

                  Total Annual
                     Capital
                     O&M
                                      1975
                                      56. 4O
                                      24.93
                                       4.71

                                       2.52
                                       1 .68
                                       O.84
Pollutants Controlled

   Particulates
   Particulates
   Particulates
   Particulates
   Particulates
   Particulates
                                                  1980
                                                  70.21
                                                   1 .67
                       O. 12

                       4 .69
                       3.22
                       1 .47
                                                              1985
                                                              73.34
                                                               1 .75
                0.26

                4.78
                3.27
                1 .51
                                                                                          Control Technology
Venturi
Venturi
Venturi
Venturi
Venturi
Venturi

1971-85
                                                                                                  Scrubber
                                                                                                  Scrubber
                                                                                                  Scrubber
                                                                                                  Scrubber
                                                                                                  Scrubber
                                                                                                  Scrubber
                                                                                         1976-85
27.84

49.72
33.82
15.9O
13.56

44.2O
3O. 13
14.07

-------
COAL GASIFICATION INDUSTRY

Production Characteristics and Capacities. One of  the  most
pressing  aspects  of the current national energy problem is
the present and projected shortage of  natural  gas.   As  a
result  of  this shortage, a considerable number of projects
are underway involving the manufacture of synthetic  natural
gas  (SNG)  from the heavier, more plentiful energy sources.
Although SNG could be  made  from  several  energy  sources,
including  coal,  coXe,  and  petroleum residuum, all of the
present commercial plans are based on coal.

For some industrial applications, fuel  gases  that  have  a
heating  value  which  is  considerably  less  than  that of
natural gas  or  SNG  can  be  used.   Whereas  the  primary
constituent   of   natural   gas  is  methane,  the  primary
combustible components of the "low Btu" gases  are  hydrogen
and  carbon  monoxide (see Figure 3-2-1).  Coal gasification
processes involve the reaction of coal with steam and oxygen
to produce synthetic natural gas.   Low  Btu  gases  can  be
produced by substituting air for oxygen as a reactant.
                            2-68

-------
                  Figure 3-2-1.
Simplified Flow Diagram of Coal Gasification
                 COAL
ASH.4-
              GASIFICAT10N
                    RAW
                    GAS
                SULFUR
                REMOVAL
                  CO
                 SHIFT
                 CO
               REMOVAL
              METHANATION
                 T
                                   STEAM
                                   AIR OR 02
                                SULFUR-
                              SULFUR-*.
OXIDIZES -
 CLAUS
 PLANT
                                                    TAIL
                                                    GAS
                                                 TAIL
                                                 GAS
                                              TREATMENT
                                                                   AIR
LOW BTU GAS
                 SNG                         CLEAN TAIL GAS

NOTE: IN SOME VERSIONS, HjS AND C02 ARE REMOVED TOGETHER AFTER THE CO SHIFT.
                       2-69

-------
Production  of  both  .SNG and low Btu gas are expected to be.
rather extensive,  by  1985,  even  though commercial  scale,
operations  do not currently exist.  However, projections of,
the amounts of synthetic-:-.fuel gases which.-will  be  produced.
at  a  given  time in the future are subject to considerable,.
uncertainty because of the general  turjnoil  in  the  energy.
situation.    .Most   plants  that  are  expected  to  be  in
commercial operation by  1985 are  already  in  the  planning
stages,  and  initial plants are expected to be in operation
during the period 1977-78.
A total of 23 plants are expected to   be  producing   SNG   by
1985;  plant  capacities will  range  from  2.4  to 9.12  million
SCM/d.  About 46  low Btu production plants  are  expected   to
be   in  operation  by   1985f   with  the   average   plant size
equivalent to approximately 5.47 million  SCM/d.
Emission   Sources   and   Pollutants.   Coal   contains   varying
amounts    of   sulfur   (from   less  than   1   to  7  percent).
Essentially all  sulfur  contained in  coal  is  converted   into
gaseous   species (i.e.  H2S)  during the gasification  process.
These  gases can  be  removed   by  a   two-step  process  which
involves   (1)  the  concentration  of H2S   through  an  amine
scrubbing process and  (2)  the  conversion   of  the   H2S  to
elemental sulfur   via   a  Claus sulfur recovery plant.   The
Glaus  sulfur  recovery process is currently  widely  practiced
by   petroleum   refiners    and   natural    gas  processers.
Approximately 95 percent of  the sulfur in  coal is  removable
by   Claus plants.  However, the remaining  5 percent escapes
from the  Claus unit (tail  gas)  in the form  of various sulfur
oxides (mostly sulfur dioxide)  and must be   controlled   with
tail  gas scrubbing   to  reduce sulfur dioxide  emissions to
acceptable levels.

The  emissions of sulfur oxides  from  the   Claus  plants   were
calculated by assuming  that  all the  sulfur  in coal goes into
the  gas   and 95 percent  of this sulfur  is recovered by the
Claus   plant.    The  emission  factors  without    tail    gas
treatment,  in  metric   tons of  sulfur  dioxide per billion
standard  cubic  meters   of  gas,  are 88.41  for   synthetic
natural   gas   and 6.60  for low-Btu gas.   The installation of
tail gas  treatment  facilities is assumed   to  reduce  sulfur
dioxide emissions by  90 percent.

Control Technology  and  Costs. It  is  assumed that the cost of
bulk  sulfur  removal  from  a  coal gasification plant  is  not a
cost associated  with the Clean  Air Act Amendments  of   1970
                            2-70

-------
but   is  a  standard  practice  partially  induced  by  the
byproduct value of elemental sulfur.  In other  words,  even
before  the  1970  Amendments were passed, coal gasification
would have had a Claus plant for bulK sulfur  removal.   The
additional  facility  which is attributable to the Clean Air
Act is the tail gas treatment plant.  Since  this  situation
is  analogous to that for natural gas plants, the investment
and operating costs  for  tail  gas  treatment  plants  were
developed based upon the analyses for petroleum refining and
natural gas processing.

Since  a  Claus  plant normally recovers about 95 percent of
the sulfur fed to it and the  tail  gas  treatment  facility
recovers  about  90  percent, the combined recovery for both
units operating together is about 99.5 percent.  The  credit
for   the  additional  sulfur  recovered  by  the  tail  gas
treatment plant is calculated by assuming a price of $10-$15
per ton of sulfur.  Recent  market  analyses  indicate  that
this may be an optimistic assumption.

investment  and  annual  operating and maintenance costs for
selected model-sized coal  gasification  plants,  and  total
industry  costs  for  controlling sulfur dioxide from plants
expected to come on stream between 1977 and 1985  are  given
in Table 3-2-1.
                           2-71

-------
                        Table 3-2-1.
          Coal Gasification Industry Data Summary
ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                      1975
                                                  1980
  Capacity (MT/Day)                      0       604.4
  Annual Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-85 = 22,6%
                                 1985

                              1 ,386.3
                                                                          1971-85
                                                                                         1976-85
PROCESS CHARACTERISTICS

  SNG

  Low BTU Gas Plants
Model Plant Sizes
(1O- SCM/Day)

70,210,247

11.2
EMISSIONS (I.OOO MT/Yr)

  1971 Controls:

     Sulfur Oxides

  Legislated Controls:

     Sulfur Oxides

CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

  Investment

  Total Annual
     Capital
     O&M
         1975
Pollutants Controlled

Sulfur Oxides

Sulfur Oxides
                     1980
                      1 ,49B
                      1 .542
                     14.84

                      8.40
                      3.58
                      4.82
                                 1985
                                  4.315
                                  4.456
         11 .22

         26.26
         15.82
         10.44
   Control  Technology

   Claus Plant;  Tail Gas
      Treatment
   Claus Plant;  Tall Gas
      Treaxment
                                             1971-85
                                                            1976-85
120.32

121.24
 68. 19
 53. OS
12O.32

121.24
 68. 19
 53.05

-------
NATURAL GAS INDUSTRY

Introduction Characteristics and Capacities. The natural gas
industry   may  be  viewed  as  having  two  major  sectors:
production and  transmission/distribution.   The  production
sector  is  dominated  by large firms, but a large number of
smaller firms do contribute a sizable  share  of  the  total
output.  The transportation/distribution sector is primarily
organized  as  public  utility companies which operate under
Federal and/or state regulations.  Although many gas utility
companies are now  integrating  back  into  production,  the
basic structure of the industry remains as described here.

As of January 1, 1974, the 763 natural gas processing plants
in  the  United  States had a total capacity of 2.11 billion
cubic meters per day.  The actual production rate  of  these
plants  in  1973 was 1.57 billion cubic meters per day.  For
each of the last two years, the natural gas production  rate
has  decreased  slightly.   The rate of change in production
rate since 1967 has been at an  increase  of  only  about  4
percent  per  year.   Most projections of natural gas supply
assume little or no increase over the next several years.

The production of petroleum (crude  oil)  is  almost  always
associated  vith the production of substantial quantities of
natural gas.  The distinction between "oil wells"  and  "gas
wells"  is an arbitrary one based on the ratio of oil-to-gas
produced.  Natural gas is primarily methane, but the raw gas
contains varying amounts of heavier hydrocarbons  and  other
gases,   such  as  carbon  dioxide,  nitrogen,  helium,  and
hydrogen sulfide.  In order  to  obtain  a  natural  gas  of
pipeline quality, much of these undesired components must be
removed.    The   heavier   hydrocarbons,   which   can   be
conveniently condensed, are combined with the  liquid  (oil)
production  and  sent  to refineries for further processing;
the remaining gas is normally purified at the well site.

Emission Sources and Pollutants.  Hydrogen  sulfide  is  the
impurity  of  concern  from  an  air  pollution  standpoint.
Because of the corrosive, poisonous, and odorous  nature  of
hydrogen  sulfide,  only  very  low concentrations of it are
permitted in  the  natural  gas  product.   Approximately  5
percent  of  the  natural  gas produced in the United States
requires some form of treatment to remove hydrogen  sulfide.
The  hydrogen sulfide content of natural raw gas varies from
trace quantities to over 50 percent by volume.

Although removal of the hydrogen sulfide from natural gas is
universally practiced, recovery of the corresponding  sulfur
in  elemental form to avoid air pollution is not universally
practiced.  In many of the larger operations,  Glaus  plants
                           2-73

-------
have been installed for this purpose, but in many plants the
hydrogen sulfide is merely incinerated and flared, resulting
in emissions of sulfur oxides.

For  the  natural  gas  plants  which have Claus plants, the
source of the sulfur oxides emitted  is the Claus plant  tail
gas.   The  amount  of  this emission corresponds to about 6
percent of the sulfur fed to the Claus plant,  as  estimated
from  the  capacities  of  the  Claus plants associated with
natural gas plants.  For the natural gas plants which do not
have Claus plants, the sources of the sulfur oxides  emitted
are  the  flares   in which the hydrogen sulfide removed from
the gas is burned.   The  only  available  estimate  of  the
emission from such plants which was  made by EPA in 1972, was
852,000 metric tons of sulfur dioxide per year.

Control   Technology   and  Costs.   Because  of  the  severe
limitations on the hydrogen sulfide  content of pipeline gas,
all natural gas processing plants that handle the  sour  gas
already have the amine scrubbing facilities or equivalent  to
remove  it  from   the  raw  gas.   The  technology needed  to
prevent hydrogen sulfide  from causing air pollution consists
of:

   •  A Claus sulfur plant in which the hydrogen  sulfide   is
     converted to  elemental sulfur.

   •  Treatment facilities to remove  sulfur dioxide from  the
     Claus plant tail gas.

The  investment and operating costs  for these processes were
discussed  in the section  on refinery fuel gas   burning;  the
credit    for   the byproduct   sulfur  obtained  with  these
processes was  also discussed  in  that section.

In 1973/  there were 84  Claus   plants  in  the  natural  gas
processing   industry.   These   plants  had   a   total   sulfur
capacity  of  6,249 metric  tons  per  day,  and   an   actual
production   rate   of  2,443   metric   tons  per  day.   The gas
throughput  associated  with   this-  sulfur  recovery   was   36
million  cubic  meters per  day, or only about  2 percent  of the
total  natural  gas  production.

Annualized   control  costs  and  industry  quality  data are
detailed  in Table  3-3-1.
                            2-74

-------
^J
Ul
                                         Table 3-3-1.
                         Natural Gas Processing Industry Data Summary
                 ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                                       1975
                                                                   1980
                   Capacity (1.OOO MT/Yr)              2,606.8     2,736.3
                   Annual Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-85 = 1.72%
                                                              1985

                                                              2,949.3
PROCESS CHARACTERISTICS

Model 1
Model 2
Model 3
Model 4
Model 5
Model 6
Model Plant Sizes
(MT/Day)

   5.88
  34.31
 272.81
   5.88
  34.31
 272.81
                 EMISSIONS (1.OOO MT/Yr)

                   1971 Controls:

                      Sulfur Oxides

                   Legislated Controls:

                      Sulfur Oxides

                 CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

                   Investment

                   Total Annual
                      Capital
                      O&M
                                      1975
                                   1.348.37
                                     414.83
                                      27.03

                                      29. 16
                                      12.86
                                      16. 3O
                                                                      Pollutants Controlled   Control Technology
                                                                      Sulfur Dioxide
                                                                      Sulfur Dioxide
                                                                      Sulfur Dioxide
                                                                      Sulfur Dioxide
                                                                      Sulfur Dioxide
                                                                      Sulfur Dioxide
                                                   198O
                  1 ,468.41
                                                   6.47
                      4.53

                     43.09
                     18.35
                     24.74
                                                              1985
1.536.OO
                                                               6.92
    2.21

   46.59
   19.61
   26.98
                  Scrubber
                  Scrubber
                  Scrubber
                  Scrubber and Claus-Unit
                  Scrubber and Claus Unit
                  Scrubber and Claus Unit
                                                                           1971-85
                                                                                          1976-85
149.67

488.79
209.73
279.O6
 51 .38

422.94
180.1O
242.84

-------
FEED MILLS INDUSTRY

Production Characteristics and Capacities. Feed  manufacture
is   the   process   of   converting  the  grain  and  other
constituents into the form, size, and consistency desired in
the finished feed.  Feed  milling  involves  the  receiving,
conditioning   
-------
  Mill                                         'Participates
  Operations                                   Generated(%)
  Rail unloading                                     25
  Collectors for product recovery dust control       21
  Truck unloading                                    15
  Truck loading (bulk loadout)                       11
  Bucket elevator leg vents                           5
  Bin vents                                           5
  Scale vents                                         3
  Grinding system (feeder, spills)                    4
  incinerator (Waste paper)                           2
  Small boiler (oil)                                  1
  Rail car loading (bulk loadout)                     1
  Miscellaneous (conveying spouts, pellet
     mills, feeder lines')                             7

     Total Feed Mill Dust Emission                  100
Unloading  of  bulk incredients is generally acknowledged to
be one of the most troublesome dust sources in  feed  mills.
Centrifugal  collectors  used  for product recovery and dust
control represent the second largest emission source.

Factors  affecting  emission  rates  from   the   ingredient
receiving  area of a feed mill include the type of grain and
other ingredients handled, the methods used  to  unload  the
ingredient, and the configuration of the receiving pits.

Control  Technology  and  Costs.  It  is estimated that 88.1
percent of the volume handled  in  pellet-cooler  operations
and  56  percent of the volume handled in griding operations
have some type of  emission  control,  largely  the  use  of
cyclones.   In  receiving, transfer, and storage operations,
roughly one-third of  the  total  volume  is  controlled  by
either cyclones or fabric filters, while shipping has only a
few installations that have installed controls.

Table   3-4-2  shows  the  estimated  sales,  capacity,  and
emissions for the feed mills industry up to the  year  1985.
The table also shows the costs of controls on an annualized,
investment and cash requirements basis.
                           2-77

-------
-»J
00
                  ACTIVITY  LEVEL
          Table 3-4-2.
Feed Mills Industry Data Summary

                        1975
                                    198O
                    Capacity (Million MT/Yr)            143.99      166.14
                    Annual  Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-85 = 3,5O%
               1985

              193.1O
                  PROCESS  CHARACTERISTICS

                    Feed Mills

                  EMISSIONS  (1.OOO MT/Yr)

                    1971 Controls:

                       Partlculates

                    Legislated Controls:

                       Partlculates

                  CONTROL  COSTS  (Million  1975  $)

                    Investment

                    Total  Annual
                       Capital
                       O&M
               Model  Plant Sizes
               (MT/Day)
               4O.90.14O
                        1975
                     1.O24.48
                       423.55
                       395.54

                       2O4.O4
                       149.34
                        54.71
      Pollutants Generated

      P~art1culates
                                    198O
1,192.54
   24.54
   81 .76

  342.73
  247.99
   94.74
                                                1985
1,353.32
                                                27.87
   38. 13

  382.88
  273.15
  109.73
                  Control Technology

                  Fabric Filter
                                                            1971-85
                                          1976-85
2,077.58

3,795.93
2,737. 18
1,058.76
  941.70

3,348.18
2.411.26
  936.91

-------
KRAFT PULP INDUSTRY

Production  Characteristics  and  Capacities. The Kraft pulp
industry process mill size distributions are shown in  Table
3-5-1.   Control  cost  estimates  are  based  on the "model
plant" range size of 454, 907, and 1,361 ADMT/day.
                        Table 3-5-1
             Kraft Pulp Mill Size Distributions
Range of Mill
Capacities
(ADMT/day)

   0.770
 771-1088
1089-2359

K umber
of
Mills
Total
Cap. of
Mills in
Size Range
SADMT/day)

Average
Mill
Capacity
(ADMT/day)

Model
Mill
Capacity
(ADMT/day)
71
29
25
31,809
24,675
33,736
 448.0
 850.9
1349.4
 454
 907
1361
Sources:  Publishing Co., Inc.  "Lockwood's Directory of the
Paper and Allied Trades",  97th  Edition,  New  York,  1973;
Paper  Processing,  August,  1974,  p.36;  Pulp  and  Paper,
"Profiles of the North American Pulp  and  Paper  industry",
June 30, 1974, p.27.
Conventional  kraft pulping processes are highly alkaline in
nature and utilize sodium hydroxide and  sodium  sulfide  as
cooking   chemicals.    One   modification   used   for  the
preparation of highly  purified,  or  high-alpha  cellulose,
pulp  utilizes an acid hydrolysis of the wood chips prior to
the alkaline cook; this is the prehydrolysis kraft  process.
Kraft processes enjoy the advantages of being applicable for
nearly  all species of wood and of having an effective means
of recovery of spent cooking  chemicals  for  reuse  in  the
process.

Kraft  pulping,  in  simplified  terms,  consists  of  seven
separate processes, as shown in Figure 3-5-1.  The digesting
liquor  in  this  process  flow  is  a  solution  of  sodium
hydroxide  and  sodium  sulfide.   The  spent  liquor (black
liquor) is concentrated, then sodium  sulfate  is  added  to
make  up  for chemical losses, and the liquor is burned in a
recovery furnace, producing a smelt of sodium carbonate  and
sodium  sulfide.   The  smelt  is dissolved in water to form
                           2-79

-------
green liquor, to which is added  quicklime  to  convert  the
sodium    carbonate   back   to   sodium   hydroxide/   thus
reconstituting the cooking  liquor.   The  spent  lime  cake
(calcium  carbonate)  is recalcined in a rotary lime kiln to
produce quicklime (calcium  oxide)  for  recausticizing  the
green liquor.
                            2-80,

-------
            Figure.3-5-1.
Kraft Pulp Mills Production  Processes
                                           POLLUTANTS
                          2-81

-------
Included  in  the  uses  of kraft pulp are the production of
linerboard, solid-fiber board, high-strength bags,  wrapping
paper, high-grade white paper, and food-packaging materials.

Emission  sources  and  Pollutants. Main emission .sources in
the kraft process  are  the  recovery  furnace,  lime  kiln,
smelting  dissolving tank, and the power boilers.  The Kraft
pulping economics depend upon reclamation of chemicals   from
the  recovery  furnace and lime kiln.  Hence, emissions  from
these  processes  are  controlled  to  minimize  losses   of
chemicals.

Participates  and gases are emitted from the various sources
of kraft process.  Numerous variables affect the quality and
quantity of emission from each source of the  kraft  pulping
process.   There  are  several  sources  of emissions in the
process and the applicable control technology and attainable
efficiencies of the control methods depend on  the  quantity
and  quality  of  emissions.  The gaseous emissions occur in
varying mixtures, and are mainly  hydrogen  sulfide,  methyl
mercaptan,  dimethyl  sulfide,  dimethyl disulfide, and  some
sulfur dioxide.  The sulfur compounds are generally referred
to as reduced sulfur compounds.  These  compounds  are   very
odorous,   being detectable at a concentration of a few parts
per billion.  The particulate emissions are  largely  sodium
sulfate, calcium compounds, and fly ash.

The  rates of  uncontrolled  and  controlled  emissions of
particulate,  total reduced sulfur  (TRS), and sulfur  dioxide
from  various  sources  of  kraft pulping processing in  1974
were as shown in Table 3-5-2.
                            2-82

-------
                        Table 3-5-2.
           Rates of Emissions from Kraft Process

                        Uncontrolled
Process

Digester
washer
Multiple Effect
  Evaporator
Recovery Furnace
Smelt Tank
Lime Kiln
Power Boiler*
Participates
{kg/ADMT)

   0.0
   0.0

   0.0
  60.0
   7.8
  34.0
  35.3
TRS
(kg/ADMT)

   0.72
   0.05

   0.18
   2.95
   0.05
   0.22
   0.0
Sulfur Dioxide
(Kg/ADMT)

   Trace
   Trace

   Trace
    1.2
   Trace
   Trace
   19.7
Totals
 137.1
   4.17
   20.9
                         Controlled
Digester            0.0
washer              0.0
Multiple Effect
  Evaporator        0.0
Recovery Furnace    2.00
Smelt Tank          0.25
Lime Kiln           0.50
Power Boiler        2.47
                  Trace
                  Trace

                  Trace
                  0.25
                  Trace
                  Trace
                  0.0
               Trace
               Trace

               Trace
                1.2
               Trace
               Trace
               10.5
Totals
   5.22
   0.25
   11.7
» Fuel requirement - 3.09 x  10T  Btu/ADMT.   Coal  provides
35%,  oil  27%,  gas  26%,  and bark/wood 12% of the energy.
Heating values * coal 13,000 Btu/lb,  oil  150,000  Btu/ft*,
and  bark/wood 4,500 Btu/f3.  Sulfur content * coal 1.9% and
oil 1.8%.  Ash content » coal 8.1% and bark/wood 2.9%.
                           2-83

-------
The process weight-emission limitation concept is considered
unapplicable to chemical pulping because the nature and size
range of particulates, as well as the characteristics of the
processes,  are  vastly  different.    Provisions   of   the
Washington  and  Oregon Regulations applicable to pulp mills
are used  in "this  report.   The  regulations  include  the
following control provisions:

  1. Total reduced sulfur  (TRS) compounds from the  recovery
     furnace:  No  more  than 1 kg/ADMT  (1972} reduced to no
     more than 0.25 kg/ADMT by 1975.

  2. Noncondensible gases  from the  digesters  and  multiple
     effect  evaporators:  Collected  and burned in the lime
     kiln or proven equivalent.

  3. Particulates from the recovery furnace: Ho more than  2
     kg/ADMT.

  4. Particulates from the  lime  kiln:  Mo  more  than  0.5
     kg/ADMT.

  5. Particulates  from  smelt  tank:  No  more  than   0.25
     kg/ADMT.

  6. Emissions from   power  boiler  will  meet  the  Federal
     emission standard.

Control  Technology   and Costs. The cost estimates for kraft
pulping take into account  the  costs  associated  with  each
constituent  process.   The mill size categories, emissions,
and control  technologies that have  been  assumed  for  each
process  are shown in Table 3-5-3.  This table also presents
the total annual emissions and costs estimated for the kraft
pulping industry in 1975,  1980,  and  1985.   The  estimated
costs of air pollution control are significantly higher than
previous  estimates   because  the  costs  to control TRS and
sulfur dioxide were not estimated earlier.
                            2-84

-------
to
to
            ACTIVITY  LEVEL
                                    Table 3-5-3.
                          Kraft  Pulp Industry Data  Summary

                                                  1975
                                                  198O
              Capacity  (1.0OO ADMT/Yr)             84,920      108,87O
              Annual  Growth Rate  Over  the  Period  1976-85  =  S.O6%
            1985

           128,67O
              (These are sequential  processes;  that  Is,  a  unit  of  pulp must go  through each of  these  processes
              to be manufactured.)
PROCESS CHARACTERISTICS

  Digester
  Stock Washer

  Evaporator
  Recovery Furnace
  Smelt Tank
  Lime K1ln
  Power Boiler
            EMISSIONS  (1.OOO MT/Yr)

              1971  Controls:
                                         Model  Plant  Sizes
                                         (ADMT/day)

                                         454;9O7;1,361
                                      1975
Pollutant Controlled

TRS
TRS

TRS
TRS, Particulates
Particulates
Partlculates
Particulates,  Sulfur
   Dioxide
                                                  198O
            1985
Control Technology

Incinerate in Lime Kiln
Incinerate in Recovery
   Furnace
Incinerate in Lime K1ln
ESP & Venturi Scrubber
Orifice Scrubber
Venturi Scrubber
ESP & Double Alkal1
   Scrubber
1971-85
1976-85
Particulates
Sulfur Oxides
Legislated Controls:
Particulates
Sulfur Oxides
CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)
Investment
Total Annual
Capital
O&M
518
35

263
35.

420.
394,
187.
2O6.
.53
.43

.23
,8O

.12
.36
.47
89
715
48

122
48

85
718
328
39O.
. 19
.87

.01
.84

.72
.72
.66
.06
842.
57.

143.
57.

48.
821 .
361 .
459.
.62
.58

.74
54

62
18
37
81




2,842.13 1,313.41
7,795.90 6,919.16
3,542.82 3,117.88
4, 253. OS 3, SO 1.29

-------
NEUTRAL SULFITE SEMICHEMICAL PAPER INDUSTRY

Production  Characteristics   and   Capacities.   The   size
distribution  of  neutral  sulfite  semichemical  (NSSCi pulp
mills is classified into three size ranges; 0-181,  182-363,
and  364-635  air-dried metric tons (ADMT) of air-dried pulp
per day.  The number of plants in each size r«ange and  their
capacities are:
Capacity                        Average           Model Mill
Range        NO.   Capacity     Mill Capacity     Capacity
(ADMT/day)   Mills  (ADMT/day)    (ADMT/day)        .(ADMT/day)

  0 - 181     23     2,488          108                113
182 - 363     24     5,455          227                277
364 - 635       8     3,376          422                454
Source's:   Paper Processing, August  1974- p.36;  Hendrickson,
           E.R., Roberson,  J.E.,  and  Koogler,  J.E.,  "Control
           of Atmospheric   Emissions   in  the  Wood   Pulping
           Industry",   PB-190352, Environmental  Engineering,
           Inc. and  J.E. Sirrine  Company, March  15,  1970.
 Semichemical  pulps  are  produced  by  digesting   with  reduced
 amounts   of   chemicals,   followed  by mechanical treatment  to
 complete   the  fiber    separation,     The    most   prevalent
 semichemical    pulping    process   is  the   neutral  sulfite
 semichemical  process.   In this process,  sodium  sulfite  in
 combination   with  sodium  bicarbonate,  or ammonium sulfite
 buffered   with  ammonium  hydroxide,  are   used  as  cooking
 chemicals.   These cooks are slightly alkaline  in contrast  to
 the   highly   alkaline kraft,  and highly or  moderately acidic
 sulfite cooks.  The semichemical pulping processes are  used
 for   production  of high  yield pulps ranging from 60 to  85
 percent of dry wood weight charged to the  digestion  vessel,
 and    can include   kraft  and   sulfite processes  suitably
 modified  to   reduce pulping  action  in  order  to  produce
 higher-than-normal  yield pulps.

 Semichemical    pulps   are   used    in  the  preparation  of
 corrugating   medium,  coarse  wrapping  paper,   linerboard,
 hardboard, and roofing  felt,  as  well as fine grades of paper
 and  other products.
                            2-86

-------
Emission    Sources    and   Pollutants.   Discussions   and
calculations of air emissions  from  the  NSSC  process  are
limited to participate and sulfur dioxide.  The used  cooking
liquors  are  discharged to sewers or  in some cases they are
evaporated and cross-recovered with an adjacent  Xraft  mill
or  treated  in  a fluidized-bed system.  In this  study, the
fluidized-bed  combustion  was  assumed   for   the   liquor
treatment.
Control  Technology  and  Costs.  This  report  assumed  that
particulate emissions  from the recovery   furnace  and  power
boilers  burning  coal  and  bark/wood,   and  sulfur dioxide
emission from power boilers burning high  sulfur coal and oil
were subject to control.  To meet the particulate  emissions
standard  from recovery furnaces, a control efficiency of  at
least 90 percent is required  for  the  control  system.   A
sodium-based,  double  alkali  system  was  assumed  for the
control of sulfur dioxide from coal and   oil  burning  power
boilers.
Control methods  for new plants were selected as  follows:
Process                   Pollutant         Control Methods

Recovery Furnace          Particulate       Electrostatic
                                            Precipitator

Power Boiler              Particulate       Electrostatic
                          Sulfur Dioxide    Precipitator
                                            Double alkali
All new plants were assumed  to  be  in the 364  to 635 ADMT/day
capacity range.

Table  3-6-1 shows the estimated future capacity and process
'characteristics  of  NSSC    pulp   mills.     The   emissions
statistics  are  also shown,  along  with annual  investment and
cost estimates.

The costs estimated in this   report  are   nearly   ten   times
those  reported  earlier   since previous  estimates did not
include the cost of controlling sulfur oxides.
                            2-87

-------
I
00
00
                                           Table 3-6-1.
                     Neutral Sulflte Sem1chemlca1  Paper Industry Data Summary
                   ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                                         1975
                                                  198O
                     Capacity (Million ADMT/Yr)          4.O6        5.19
                     Annual  Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-85 = 4.93%
                                 1985

                                 6.O9
PROCESS CHARACTERISTICS

Boiler
Model Plant Size
(10OO ADMT/year)

38, SO, 150
Pollutants Controlled

Particulates,  Sulfur
   Dioxide
Control Technology

ESP, Double Alkal1
Recovery Furnaces 38, 8O, 150
i
EMISSIONS (1.OOO MT/Yr) 1975
1971 Controls:
Part iculates
Sulfur Oxides
Legislated Controls:
Part Iculates
Sulfur Oxides
CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)
Investment
Total Annual
Capital
O&M

21 ,
2.

9.
2.

8.
54 .
24.
29.

6O
12

17
15

45
33
57
76
Particulates ESP
198O 1985 1971-85

29
2

0.
2.

14.
91 .
37.
53.

.77
.93

.98
.94

78
42
94
48

34
3

1.
3.

8.
105.
44.
6O.

.86
.43

, 14
.43

88 313.49
53 1 ,O12. 11
57 431.OO
96 581 . 12
1976-!





13O. 10
885. 17
367.73
517.44

-------
PRINTING INDUSTRY

Production Characteristics and Capacities. Six  major  types
of  printing  establishments were considered in this report:
book  printing  and  publishing;  commercial   printing   by
letterpress,-   commercial   printing   by  lithography;  and
commercial printing by gravure.   Newspapers  were  excluded
because  inks  containing  little, if any, volatile solvents
are employed.  Nearly 27,000 establishments comprise the six
groups,- 80 percent of these are small, employing fewer  than
20 people.

Estimates of air pollution abatement costs were based on the
application  of  controls  (thermal  incinerators! by the 50
largest establishments in each of the first five categories.
Perodical and book plants accounted for about 70 percent  of
the  annual  volume of ink consumed, which amounted to about
18 million kilograms per year or  181.6  kilo-kilograms  per
plant annually.

Both  commercial  letterpress  and  lithography  represent a
large number of smaller  establishments,  about  13,000  and
8,000   facilities,  respectively.   While  the  50  largest
establishments in each of the categories  comprise  only  40
percent and 25 percent of the annual volume of ink consumed,
respectively,  they  tend  to  use web-processing techniques
exclusively, which are a primary contributer to  hydrocarbon
emissions,  virtually all volatile components (approximately
40  percent  by weight) of the ink are driven off during the
drying or curing stage of the web printing process.

All commercial gravure printers also use  the  web  printing
methods.  There were 127 establishments in 1972 representing
about 114 million kilograms of ink usage.

In  summary,  cost  estimates  were  derived on the basis of
applying controls to 327 establishments corresponding to  an
average  plant  size  of 499 metric tons of ink consumed per
year.

Emission Sources  and  Pollutants.  Atmospheric  hydrocarbon
emissions  associated  with printing are attributable to the
volatile organic components of the  various  types  of  inks
employed.  The volatile content ranges from about 40 percent
(heat-set  letterpress,  lithographic,  and  screen  process
inks) to more than 60 percent for flexographic and  gravure.
The  percentage  of  the  volatile  content  released to the
atmosphere can vary widely in the absence of controls.   For
purposes  of  this  report,  full  volatilization is assumed
without  control.    On   this   basis,   an   average-sized
establishment that consumes approximately 499 metric tons of
                           2-89

-------
ink   annually  will  generate  about  204  metric  tons  of
hydrocarbon emissions per year.

Control Technology and  Costs.  Suitable  controls  (thermal
incinerators)  provide  about 95 percent removal efficiency.
Thermal incineration  with  heat  exchange  units  could  be
employed  to  achieve desired levels of hydrocarbon emission
control.   Although  carbon  absorption  techniques  present
advantages   because   of   the   possibility   of   solvent
regeneration,  they  are  difficult  to  apply  to  printing
because   inks  often  consist  of  a  mixture  of  volatile
solvents, making subsequent separation steps necessary.

Capital and annual  operating  and  maintenance  costs  were
estimated  on  the basis of applying a control unit designed
to  handle  approximately  109  kilograms   of   hydrocarbon
emissions  per  hour  (or  about  227 metric tons per year).
Installation and equipment, including  heat  exchanger,  are
approximately  $70,000 for such a unit,  operating costs are
about  $16,000  per  year.   Annualized  control  costs  and
industry operating statistics are detailed in Table 3-7-1.
                           2-90

-------
ACTIVITY LEVEL
                        Table 3-7-1.
               Printing Industry Data Summary

                                      1975
                                                  198O
  Capacity (1,OOO MT/Yr)              177.42      223.39
  Annual Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-85 = 5.12%
                                 1985

                                 264.15
PROCESS CHARACTERISTICS

  Commercial Printing -
     Letterpress and
     L i thography
Model Plant Sizes
(Metric Tons)

550
EMISSIONS d.OOO MT/Yr)

  1971 Controls:

     Hydrocarbons

  Legislated Controls:

     Hydrocarbons

CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

  Investment

  Total Annual
     Capital
     O&M
         1975
         99.36
        1OO.11
          5. 15

          6.60
          3.67
          2.94
   Pollutants Controlled

   Hydrocarbons
                     1980
                    137.23
                    136.30
 2.72

11 .74
 6.4O
 5.34
                                 1985
                                161.91
                                  8.08
 O.94

13.47
 7.17
 6.31
               Control  Technology

               Thermal  Incinerators
                                             1971-85
                                                            1976-85
 44. O3

126.39
 G8.71
 57.67
 21.51

111.36
 6O. 14
 51 .22

-------
CHLOR-ALKALI MERCURY CELLS INDUSTRY

Production   Characteristics   and  Capacities.  High-purity
caustic soda and chlorine are coproducts in the electrolytic
process which  uses  flowing  mercury  metals  as  a  moving
cathode.   The  caustic  soda product finds major markets in
those chemical manufacturing  operations  where  high-purity
and freedom from sodium chloride and metal impurities are in
demand.   Of the two basic processes, e.g., mercury cell and
diaphragm  cell  for  producing  chlorine,  only   the   one
employing  the  mercury  cell 'results in mercury emissions.
Chlorine is produced almost entirely by the electrolysis  of
fused   chlorides  for  aqueous  solutions  of  alkali-metal
chlorides.   Chlorine  is  produced  at  the  anode,   while
hydrogen  and potassium hydroxide or sodium hydroxide derive
from processes taking  place  at  the  cathode.   Anode  and
cathode  products must be separated, such as in a cell which
employs liquid mercury metal as an intermediate cathode.

The use of the mercury cell in the United States  has  grown
from  5  percent of the total installed chlorine capacity in
1946 toward  a  maximum  of  28  percent  of  the  installed
chlorine  capacity  through  1968.   The  1974  capacity was
estimated at 7,863 metric tons of chlorine  per  day  at  31
plants.  However, since then, the number of operating plants
has  been decreasing.  The size distribution of these plants
is given below:
  Number of
  Plants

     5
    10
     8
     5
     3

    31
Capacity Range
(Chlorine Production)
Metric Tons/Day
   0
90.8
 182
 273
 455
90.7
181
272
454
580
Emission Sources  and Pollutants. The major sources of direct
emissions of mercury to  the atmosphere  are the  hydrogen  by-
product  stream,  end-box  ventilation  system,  and cell-room
ventilation  air.   The  minimum  .known  treatment  of   the
byproduct  hydrogen  gas that  leaves the  decomposer consists
of cooling the  stream to 110°F followed by  partial  removal
of  the resulting mercury mist.  For hydrogen saturated with
                            2-92

-------
mercury vapor at this temperature/ the daily vapor  loss  is
estimated  to be 3,4 kg of mercury vapor per 100 metric tons
of chlorine produced.  The entrainment of condensed  mercury
in  the hydrogen stream vill result in additional emissions.
The estimated uncontrolled emission  of  mercury  vapor  and
mercury  mist,  after  minimum  treatment  has  occurred, is
estimated to be up to 25 kg per 100 metric tons of  chlorine
produced.

Mercury  vapor  and mercury compounds are collected from the
end-boxes, the mercury pumps, and  the  end-box  ventilation
system.   Preliminary  results  of  source  testing  by  EPA
indicate that the mercury emissions  from  an  untreated  or
inadequately treated end-box ventilation system range from 1
to 8 kg per 100 metric tons of chlorine produced.

In   addition  to  cooling  the  cell  room,  the  cell-room
ventilation system provides a means of  reducing  the  cell-
room  mercury-vapor  concentration to vithin the recommended
Threshold Limit value (TLV) for human  exposure  to  mercury
vapor.  On the basis of data obtained from operating plants,
it  has been estimated that mercury emissions from the cell-
room ventilation system vary from 0.2 to 2.5 kg per day  per
100  metric  tons  of  daily  chlorine  capacity, assuming a
concentration equal to the TLV of 50  micrograms  per  cubic
meter of ventilation air.

The  Environmental  Protection  Agency  has  estimated  that
uncontrolled emissions from the production  of  chlorine  in
mercury  cells  averages  approximately 20 kg of mercury per
100 metric tons of chlorine produced.

Control Technology and Costs. Control technologies and  cost
estimates  are  based  on the consideration that the maximum
daily mercury emission from any single site shall not exceed
2,300 grams; this  assumption  is  in  compliance  with  the
National  Emissions  Standards  for Hazardous Air Pollutants
promulgated by EPA.  Control techniques  applicable  to  the
hydrogen  gas  stream  include:  cooling,  condensation, and
demisting; depleted brine scrubbing- hypochlorite scrubbing-
absorption on molecular sieve;  and  adsorption  on  treated
activated carbon.

With   appropriate   modification,  the  control  techniques
applicable  to  the  end-box  ventilation   stream   include
cooling,   condensing,   and   demisting;   depleted   brine
scrubbing; and hypochlorite scrubbing.  It  is  judged  that
the molecular-sieve adsorption system will become applicable
in  the  near  future to the end-box ventilation-gas stream.
This control  technique  will  permit  compliance  with  the
hazardous emission standard.
                           2-93

-------
Mercury  vapor  from  the  cell-room  ventilation air can be
minimized  by   strict   adherence   to   recommended   good
housekeeping  and  operating  procedures.   No other control
technique is commercially tested at this time.  All  mercury
emissions  could be eliminated by the conversion of mercury-
cell plants to the use of diaphragm  cells  plus  a  special
caustic   soda  purification  system.   Such  conversion  is
presently judged to be an unacceptable  alternative  due  to
the  very high estimated cost.  Control costs were estimated
on a plant-by-plant basis.  Investment per plant ranges from
$123,000 to just over $1.3 million,  depending  on  capacity
and operating characteristics.  Annualized control costs and
industry statistics are detailed in Table 3-8-1.
                           2-94

-------
                                          Table 3-8-1
                        Chlor-Alkali  Mercury Cell Industry Data Summary
to
\0
                  ACTIVITY  LEVEL
                                                        1975
                                                                    198O
Capacity (MT/Day)                  7,447       7,986
Annual Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-85 =  1.59%
            1985

           7,489
                  PROCESS  CHARACTERISTICS

                    Mercury Cell  Electrolysis  232

                  EMISSIONS (MT/Yr)

                    1971 Controls:

                       Mercury Gases 8> Mists

                    Legislated Controls:

                       Mercury Gases 8> Mists

                  CONTROL  COSTS (Million  1.975 $)

                    Investment

                    Total  Annual
                       Capital
                       O&M
                           Model Plant Sizes
                           (MT/Day)
                                     1975
                                     1O.58
                                     5.30
                                     4.79

                                     5.52
                                     2.63
                                     2.89
                                                Gases & Mists
                                                 1980
                                                 12.7O
                                                  1 .74
 O.42

1O.OS
 4.57
 5.48
introl led
i
I985
1 .85
1 .63
O
9.75
4.6O
5. 15
Control Technology
Scrubbing
1971-85 1976-i
28.26 12.O9
1O4.98 92.23
48. 6O 42.38
56.38 49.85

-------
NITRIC ACID INDUSTRY

Production  characteristics  and  Capacities. Nitric acid is
used in the manufacture of ammonium nitrate and in  numerous
other  chemical  processes.  Ammonium nitrate, which is used
as both a fertilizer and in explosives, accounts  for  about
80  percent  of the nitric acid consumption.  Nitric acid is
produced by oxidation of ammonia, followed by absorption  of
the  reaction products in dilute acid solution.  Most nitric
acid plants in the United States are designed to manufacture
acid with a concentration of 55 to  65  percent,  which  may
subsequently be dehydrated to produce 99 percent acid.

At  the  beginning  of  1974,  46  privately-owned companies
operated 76 nitric acid plants in the contiguous 48  states,
in addition to seven plants operated for the U.S. Government
by   five  companies.   These  government-owned  plants  are
included in cost  estimates  as  part  of  the  nitric  acid
industry  by  inflating  the  private  costs  by 10 percent.
Nearly all nitric acid produced in the United States is  for
domestic consumption.

Emissions  sources  and  Pollutants.  Nitrogen  oxides,  the
primary pollutants of concern in the  production  of  nitric
acid, are emitted in the tail gas from the absorption tower.
Numerous  variations  on  the  basic  nitric acid production
process affect both the  emissions  and  the  difficulty  of
control.  Two of the more important variables are the amount
of  excess  oxygen  present  in the absorption tower and the
pressure under which the absorption  tower  operates.   Many
plants practice partial pollution abatement (decolorization^
in  accordance  with  local regulatory agencies.  Under this
practice, the highly visible reddish-brown nitrogen  dioxide
is  reduced  to  colorless  nitric  oxide.  Although visible
emissions are reduced, the practice does nothing to  prevent
emission of nitrogen oxides to the atmosphere.

Emissions  from  nitric acid plants consist of the oxides of
nitrogen in  concentrations  of  about  3,000  ppm  nitrogen
dioxide  and nitric oxide, and minute amounts of nitric acid
mist.  Emissions from nitric acid plants  are  typically  in
the  order  of  22  kg nitrogen oxides per metric ton of 100
percent acid produced.

Control  Technology  and  Costs.  Catalytic  reduction  with
natural gas is a feasible and proven control technology used
in  nitric  acid  plants both here and abroad.  The absorber
tail gas is mixed with 38 percent  excess  natural  gas  and
passed  over  a  platinum  or palladium catalyst.  Catalytic
reduction with ammonia or  hydrogen  has  the  advantage  of
being  selective  in the sense that only the nitrogen oxides
                           2-96

-------
are reduced,   in  addition  to higher  costs,   reduction   with
ammonia  requires close   temperature control to prevent the
reformation of nitrogen oxides  at  higher  temperatures or the
formation   of    explosive   ammonium   nitrate   at    lower
.temperatures.

Table  3-9-1   shows   the estimated future  sales, capacities,
and outputs for the nitric acid  industry.  Also shown in the
table are  the  reductions in nitrogen oxide emissions for the
selected   years,   and  the  three  major   cost   categories;
annualized, investment, and cost requirements.
                           2-97

-------
                                     Table 3-9-1.
                          Nitric Add Industry Data Summary
             ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                                   1975
                                                               198O
to
vo
00
Capacity (1,OOO MT/Oay)           25.17       34.09
Annual Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-85 = 5.11%
           1985

         4O.79
                                                                                       1971-85
                                                                                       1976-85
             PROCESS CHARACTERISTICS

             Ammonia Oxidation
                           Model Plant Sizes
                           (LOCO MT/Day)
                           141 .2;361. 1;571.7;
                              940.0
             EMISSIONS  (1.OOO MT/Yr)

               1971  Controls:

                  Nitrogen  Oxides

               Legislated Controls:

                  Nitrogen  Oxides

             CONTROL COSTS  (Million  1975  $)

               Investment

               Total  Annual
                  Capital
                  O&M
                                    1975
                                    143.17
                                     65.04
                                     16.OO

                                     15. 15
                                      6.64
                                      8.51
  Pollutants Controlled

  Nitrogen Oxides
                                                198O
                                                193.02
15.04
 4.53

27.59
10.92
16.67
                                                            1985
           232.18
18/12
 2.33

32.48
12.37
2O. 11
                 Control Technology

                 Catalytic Reduction
                       1971-85
 8O.28

3OO.1O
119.79
180.31
                                                                                       1976-85
 37.76

27O.61
107.OO
163.61

-------
PAINT MANUFACTURING INDUSTRY

Production Characteristics and Capacities. The manufacturing
of  paints  involves the mixing or dispersion of pigments in
oil, resin, resin solution or  latex  at  room  temperature.
Mixing  is  then  followed  by  the  addition  of  specified
proportions of organic  solvents  or  water  to  obtain  the
desired viscosity.

In   1972,  there  were  1,556  plants  manufacturing  paint
products in the United States.  Production  is  not  divided
evenly,   with   approximately  30  percent  of  the  plants
accounting for nearly 90 percent of production.

The average-sized plant  accounts  for  about  6.06  million
liters  per  year  or  roughly  22,740  liters per day.  The
balance  of  the  plants  were  omitted   from  control  cost
considerations  because  they  collectively account for only
about 379 million liters per year, or about 7 percent of the
daily  production  of  the  average  plant  in  the   larger
category.

Current  trends  in  the industry should  decrease the future
hydrocarbon   emission   levels   associated   with    paint
manufacturing.   These include the use of water-based paints
and new  application  techniques  such  as  powder  coating.
These  developments  will continue to have a negative impact
on the  demand  for  organic  solvent-based  paints-  it  is
estimated  that water-based paints currently represent about
25 percent of total production volume.

Emission Sources and Pollutants. Air pollutants  from  paint
manufacturing  are  hydrocarbons  originating  from  organic
solvents and particulates from paint  pigments.   About  908
grams  of particulates are emitted per metric ton of pigment
dispersed.  Hydrocarbon emission estimates  assume  that  75
percent of the 1975 volume of paint was solvent based.

Control   Technology   and  Costs.  Control  of  hydrocarbon
emissions from paint production can be accomplished by these
methods: flame  combustion,  thermal  combustion,  catalytic
combustion,  and  absorption.  Thermal combustion (with heat
exchange) is considered the most feasible method of control;
equipment incorporating heat  exchange  devices  was  chosen
because  of  current  anticipated  future fuel shortages and
assumed  removal  efficiences  of  95  percent.    Catalytic
combustion units, while highly promising  from the standpoint
of  lower  fuel  requirements (but higher initial investment
costs),  still   present   technical   operating   problems.
Baghouses  (fabric  filters)  are  suitable  for  control of
                           2-99

-------
particulate emissions  from  pigments;  particulate  removal
efficiences of more than 95 percent are readily achieved.

Estimates  for  air pollution control for the total industry
were based on assumed compliance by plants  averaging  about
7.58 million liters of paint production per year, fewer than
500 plants of this capacity were assumed to be in operation.
Future  cost predictions are complicated by the emergence of
technological trends away  from  the  use  of  solvent-based
paints.   Annualized control costs and production statistics
are detailed in Table 3-10-1.
                           2-100

-------
to
(-•
o
                                      Table 3-1O-1.
                        Paint Manufacturing Industry Data Summary
               ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                                      1975
                                                                  198O
                 Capacity (Million Liters/Day)        11.05        11.32
                 Annual Growth Rate Over the Period  1976-85 =  1 . 3O%
                                 1985

                                 1 1 .56
               PROCESS CHARACTERISTICS

               Paint Production
               Paint Production
Model Plant Sizes
(Liters/Day)
22,740
22,740
               EMISSIONS (1.OOO MT/Yr)

                 1971 Controls:

                    Hydrocarbons

                 Legislated Controls:

                    Hydrocarbons

               CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

                 Investment

                 Total Annual
                    Capi tal
                    O&M
         1975
        9O8.48
        931 .94
          6.81

          8. 29
          3.68
          4.61
   Pollutants Controlled

   Hydrocarbons
   Hydrocarbons
                     1980
                  1 . 1O4.O6
                  1 , 1 13.98
 1 .35

12.33
 5.33
 6.99
                                 1985
         1 , 150.33
         1 ,152.62
12.75
 5.60
 7. 14
                  Control  Technology

                  Thermal  Incinerator
                  Scrubber
                                             1971-85
                                                            1976-85
 34. 4O

137.94
 59.99
 77.95
 1 1 .78

119.36
 51 .73
 67.64

-------
PHOSPHATE FERTILIZER INDUSTRY

Production Characteristics and  Capacities.  The  major  end
products  of  the phosphate fertilizer industry are ammonium
phosphates, triple  superphosphate,  normal  superphosphate,
and   granular   mixed  fertilizers.   Phosphoric  acid  and
superphosphoric acid are intermediate products.

All  phosphate  fertilizers  are   processed   from   ground
phosphate  rock treated with sulfuric acid to produce either
normal superphosphate or  wet-process  phosphoric  acid.   A
phosphoric  acid  intermediate  may  then  be  reacted  with
ammonia to produce diammononium phosphate and other ammonium
phosphates,  or  reacted  with  ground  phosphate  rock   to
manufacture  triple  superphosphate.   Superphosphoric acid,
produced by dehydration of wet-process phosphoric  acid,  is
used  in  preparing  some mixed fertilizers.  Granular mixed
fertilizers are made from either  normal  superphosphate  or
triple  superphosphate,  with  ammonia  and  potash.   Bulk-
blended mixed fertilizers  are  manufactured  by  physically
mixing  particles  of other fertilizer components and liquid
mixed fertilizers.  Bulk blends and liquids  are  not  major
sources   of   air  pollution  and  are  not  considered  in
estimating the industry abatement cost.

The phosphate fertilizer  industry  is  characterized  by  a
number  of  large,  modern efficient plants located near the
source  of  raw  materials.   in   general,   these   plants
manufacture  the  more  concentrated  forms  of  fertilizer,
diammonium phosphate (DAP) and triple superphosphate  (TSP}.
These industries are particularly concentrated in Florida.

Smaller plants, located near the retail markets, manufacture
the  less  concentrated  forms:  granulated mixed fertilizer
(NPK) and normal superphosphate  (NSP).   The  smaller  NSP,
NPK,  and  bulk-blend  plants  are  located  in  the farming
states.  At the beginning of 1973, there were 33 DAP plants,
13  TSP  plants,  45  NSP  plants,  and   344   ammoniation-
granulation  (NPK)  plants.   in addition, about 5,000 bulk-
blending plants were operating in 1973.

Due to the  seasonal  demand  for  fertilizer,  many  plants
manufacturing  NSP  and  NPK  operate  only a portion of the
year,  in contrast, those plants manufacturing DPA  and  TSP
generally operate year-round.

Emission  Sources  and  Pollutants. Emissions from phosphate
fertilizer processing plants are mainly  fluorides  (in  the
form  of  hydrogen  fluoride  and silicon tetrafluoride) and
particulates.  Fluorides are generated in the  processes  of
                           2-102

-------
acidulation   of   phosphate  rock  which  contains  calcium
fluoride.

In the phosphate fertilizer industry, participate  emissions
of  significance  originate  from:  phosphate rock grinding.
calcination,  drying,   and   transfer   processes,   triple
superphosphate  manufacture/  ammonium phosphate production/
normal superphosphate manufacture; and NPK bulk-blending and
granulation plants.

In phosphate  rock  processing,  particulate  emissions  are
issued  from the calcination, drying, grinding, and transfer
processes.  The emission factors  for  these  processes  are
7.5, 10, and 1 kg per metric ton of rock., respectively.

In  granular  triple  superphosphate production, particulate
emissions may originate from  a  number  of  points  in  the
process.   Most  of  the  particulates  are given off in the
drying and product-classification  processes.   The  off-gas
from the reactor (in which phosphate rock is acidulated with
phosphoric  acid)  and  the  blunger  (in  which the reactor
effluent is mixed with recycled product fines to  produce  a
paste)  may  account  for  a  considerable percentage of the
total particulates emitted.

Particulate emissions from diammonium phosphate  manufacture
originate  mainly from the granulator and the dryer,  it has
been  estimated  that  the   total   emissions   amount   to
approximately  20  kg  per  metric  ton of product from both
sources.

Emissions from the manufacture of run-of-pile normal  super-
phosphate  originate from both the acidulation and "denning"
processes.  Although the emission factors  for  particulates
are not known, they are estimated to be in the order of 5 kg
per metric ton.

The  NPK  or  granulation  plants  manufacture  a variety of
products.  Many different  emission  factors  probably  will
apply  for  this  class  of fertilizer plant.  In fixing the
emission factors, these plants  are  assumed  to  employ  an
ammoniation-granulation  process similar to that used in the
DAP process, or approximately  20  kg  of  particulates  per
metric ton of product.

The emission factors for particulates are high in the triple
superphosphate,  diammonium  phosphate, and NPK plants.  The
bulk of these emissions in all  three  processes  originates
from  the  granulation  process.  There is a strong economic
incentive to  reduce  these  emissions  since  they  contain
valuable  products  and  in  many  cases are associated with
                           2-103

-------
ammonia  vapors  (from  the  ammoniation   process),   whose
recovery is an economic necessity.

Control  Technology and Costs. Most of the phosphate rock of
higher available phosphorus pentoxide content is ground  and
beneficiated to enhance its reactivity and to eliminate some
of  the  impurities.   The  particulate  emissions  from the
grinding  and  screening  operations  may   be   effectively
controlled  by  employing  baghouses  in  which  the dust is
deposited on mechanically-cleaned fabric filters.  The dust-
laden gas from the rock-drying (and perhaps  defluorination)
operations may first pass through a cyclone and then through
a  wet scrubber (such as a venturi).  The efficiency of this
combination should be better than 99 percent.

Particulate and fluoride emissions from phosphate fertilizer
plants traditionally have been removed  from  waste  gaseous
streams  by wet scrubbing,  while efforts have been directed
at removing fluorides, up to 99 percent of the  particulates
are   simultaneously  removed.   wet  scrubbers  of  varying
efficiencies have been used for this  double  purpose.   The
fluoride  and  particulate-laden  scrubber  water is usually
disposed of in a gypsum pond.

For control  of  particulate  emissions  from  granular  TSP
plants,  various wet scrubbers will be provided for a number
of gaseous waste streams.  The effluent  from  the  reactor-
granulator  will be scrubbed in two stages.  The first stage
will be  a  cyclone  and  the  second  a  cross-flow  packed
scrubber.   The  gases  from  the  drier  and cooler will be
scrubbed in venturi-type packed scrubbers.  Waste gases from
storage of the granular product are usually  scrubbed  in  a
cyclone scrubber, although some plants use packed scrubbers.
The  scrubbing liquid used in all scrubbers will be recycled
pond water except for the  first-stage  scrubbing  of  gases
from the reactor granulator, where weak phosphoric acid will
be used and recycled to the reactor.

In  DAP plants, control of particulates will be achieved for
gaseous streams originating from the reactor granulator, the
drier,  and  the  cooler,  together  with  combined  gaseous
streams  ventilating  such  solids-processing  equipment  as
elevators, screens, and loading  and  unloading.   Two-stage
scrubbing  will  be employed for each of the streams listed.
The first stage will consist  of  a  cyclone  scrubber;  the
scrubbing  medium  will  be  diluted (30 percent) phosphoric
acid for purposes of recovering  ammonia  and  the  product.
Most  of the particulate matter will be removed in the first
stage, and the balance will be removed in the  second  stage
consisting of a cross-flow packed scrubber in which recycled
pond water is used as the scrubbing medium.
                           2-104

-------
It is assumed that only run-of-pile normal superphosphate is
produced in NSP plants.  A cyclone scrubber will be employed
in removing particulates in gaseous streams originating  from
the reactor-pugmill, den, and curing operations.

An   ammoniation-granulation  process  is  assumed  for  NPK
plants.   Cyclones  will  be  installed  ahead  of   primary
scrubbers.  The primary scrubber (typically employing dilute
phosphoric  acid  as  a  scrubbing  medium) i,s considered an
integral part of the process  in  which  valuable  reactants
(ammonia) and the product are recovered.

Cross-flow  scrubbers  have been used in estimating costs of
controlling emissions of both  particulates  and  fluorides.
Most  of  the control technologies described above have  been
applied for more than a decade.  Wet  scrubbers  of  varying
efficiencies  have  been  integral  parts  of many phosphate
fertilizer  processes.   The  collection  of  waste  gaseous
streams  and  the  removal  of fluorine compounds from these
streams has long been practiced to protect  the  health  and
safety   of  process  operating  personnel.   Collection  of
particulate materials from those waste  gaseous  streams  is
dictated by economic necessity because valuable products are
involved.

Table 3-11-1 shows the estimated future sales and capacities
for  phosphate fertilizers.  The table also shows the number
of model plant sizes used to calculate costs  for  the   four
fertilizer  types.   The  emissions are reduced dramatically
below levels  that  would  have  been  achieved  for  purely
economic recovery purposes.  The control costs are shown for
investment  and cash requirements, as well as for annualized
expenditures over the next decade.
                           2-105

-------
o
o\
                                        Table 3-11-1,
                          Phosphate Fertilizer Industry Data Summary
                 ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                                       1975
                                                  1980
                   Capacity (1.OOO MT/Yr)              37.23       46-17
                   Annual Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-85 = 4,66%
               1985

               55.83
PROCESS CHARACTERISTICS

  Type of Phosphate:
     NSP

     NPK
     TSP

     DAP
                                           Model Plant Size
                                           (MT/Yr)
                                           62.7;99.O;132.O;165.0;
                                              198.O;231.5
                                           45
                                           7O;12O;297.5;46O;67O;
                                              93O
                                           54; 155;248;378;513;
                                              7OO;900
   Pollutants  Controlled


   Particulates

   Particulates
   Particulates

   PartIculates
                 EMISSIONS (1.00O MT/Yr)

                   1971 Controls:

                      Particulates

                   Legislated Controls:

                      Particulates

                 CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

                   Investment

                   Total Annual
                      Capi tal
                      O&M
                                      1975
                                   1,1O4.67
                                     630.79
                                      23.51

                                      25.56
                                      1O.22
                                      15.34
   198O
1.428.56
                                                   2.O3
   12.23

   51.86
   19.12
   32.74
                                                              1985
1,773.89
                                                               3.49
    6.67

   65.38
   23.04
   42.34
                  Control  Technology
                  Wet  Scrubber

                  Wet  Scrubber
                  Wet  Scrubber

                  Wet  Scrubber
               1971-85
                                                                                         1976-85
175.14

57O.50
212.O4
358.47
 97.4O

512.OO
188.31
323.69

-------
NON-FERTILIZER PHOSPHORUS INDUSTRY

Production Characteristics and Capacities.  In  1973,  there
were  21  plants  engaged  in  the  production  of elemental
phosphorus,  defluorinated  phosphates  (DFP),  and  calcium
phosphates  (Dical),   The combined capacity of these plants
is approximately 4,808 metric tons per day  or  1.6  million
metric  tons per year (P205 equivalent) in 1973.  Ten plants
produce elemental phosphorus and account for over 60 percent
of the total capacity involved in  the  production  of  non-
fertilizer  phosphates.   A  summary  of  model  plant  size
distributions and  capacities  for  the  three  products,  is
provided in Table 3-12-1.
                       Table 3-12-1.
             Non-Fertilizer Phosphates Industry
                Plant Capacity Distribution
Phosphate
  reduction
                 Plant
                 Capacity
                 (P205,   No.
                 MT/day)  Plants
Defluorinated
  phosphate
 54
217
649
 31
 93
125
386
 3
 4
 3

10

 1
 1
 1
 1
Total
Capacity
(P205,
MT/day)

   162
   867
 1,948
                                    2,977
    31
    93
   125
   386
                                Percent
                            Group  Industry
  5
 29
 66

100

  5
 15
 20
 60
  3
 18
 41

 62

nil
  2
  3
  8
                                      635
                             100
Calcium
  phosphate
 54
200
580
 4
 2
 1
   216
   400
   580
 18
 33
 48
  5
  8
 12
                                    1,196
                             100
                             25
  Totals
         21
         4,808
                    100
                           2-107

-------
The   production  of  industrial  phosphorus  and  phosphate
containing animal feeds begins with thermal and/or  chemical
processing  of phosphate rock.  Phosphates that are suitable
as  additives  to  feeds  may   result   from   the   direct
defluorination   of   phosphate   rock,   clefluorination  of
phosphoric acid from wet process acid, or defluorination  of
furnace  acid,  e.g.,  acid  made  from elemental phosphorus
produced  by  thermal  reduction  of  phosphate  rock.   The
production   of   feed-grade  phosphates  by  conversion  of
elemental phosphorus is expected to decline because  of  the
energy  requirements  of  the thermal reduction of phosphate
rock.   Decreased  production  by  this  process   will   be
compensated  for  by  increased  production from wet process
acids, so the overall production  of  feed-grade  phosphates
will  increase at an annual rate of approximately 4 percent.
Current production is estimated to be about  90  percent  of
capacity.

Emission  Sources and Pollutants. Atmospheric emissions from
the manufacture of defluorinated  phosphates  are  primarily
fluorides  and  particulates.   Currently,  only Florida has
established  controls  for   fluoride   emissions;   it   is
anticipated  that  Federal and state regulations for control
of fluoride emissions will be promulgated  shortly,  and  so
control  costs  for  this  pollutant  are  included  in  the
analysis for this industry.

Gaseous fluorides are released  during  the  thermal  and/or
chemical reduction of phosphate rock with the major point of
emissions  in  feed preparation.  Emission factors may be as
high as 33 kilograms fluorine per metric ton  of  phosphorus
processed.

A   summary   of   estimated  fluoride  emissions  from  the
production of defluorinated phosphates is  presented  below;
control efficiencies of 95 percent are assumed.
                           2-108

-------
                       Present Controls  Further Controls
                       (metric tons/yr)      (metric tons/yr)
1975
  Phosphate reduction     430               25
  Defluorinated
     phosphate          2,560              158
  Calcium phosphate        40                2

1985
  Phosphate reduction     260               15
  Defluorinated
     phosphate          3,910              242
  Calcium phosphate        50                3
Control  Technology  and  Costs. Control of fluorides can be
accomplished by the use of wet  scrubbers.   These  devices,
which could include liquid ejector venturi scrubbers, liquid
impingement control systems, and spray towers, also serve to
control  particulate  emissions  to  levels of 95 percent or
more.

For DFP and Dical plants, control costs are  comparable  for
similar  sized  plants  but almost four times as high as for
phosphate reduction  plants  of  similar  size.   The  lower
control  costs  associated  with animal feed production from
furnace acid is due to the relatively  lower  percentage  of
fluorides  contained  in  the  phosphoric acid obtained from
thermal reduction of rock.   Annualized  control  costs  and
industry operating statistics are detailed in Table 3-12-2.
                           2-109

-------
I-1
a
                                         Table 3-12-2.
                        Non-Fertilizer Phosphorus Industry Data Summary
                  ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                                        1975
                                                                    1980
                    Capacity (MT/Oay)                  5.980.O     6,529.0
                    Annual Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-85 = 3.50%
                                                              1985

                                                             8,023.0
PROCESS CHARACTERISTICS

  Deflourinated Phosphate
  Phosphate Reduction
  Calcium Phosphate

EMISSIONS (MT/Yr)

  1971 Controls:

     Particulates

  Legislated Controls:

     PartIculates

CONTROL COSTS (Million $)

  Investment

  Total Annual
     Capital
     O&M
Model Plant Sizes

See Table 3-12-1.



         1975



         34.54



         28.07



          1.68

          t . 1O
          O.80
          O.30
                                                                    Pollutants Controlled   Control  Technology
                                                                    Part iculates
                                                                    Particulates
                                                                    Particulates

                                                                    1980
1985
                                                                    47.84
                                                                    32.45
                                                                     O.58

                                                                     2.O7
                                                                     1.52
                                                                     O.55
                                                                                58.69
                                                                                39 .91
 0.28

 2.39
 1.73
 0-66
            Wet Scrubber
            Wet Scrubber
            Wet Scrubber

            1971-85
1O. SO

22.29
16.22
 G.O7
                           1976-85
 5.66

19.88
14.47
 5.42

-------
SULFUR1C ACID INDUSTRY

production Characteristics and Capacities. About half of the
sulfuric  acid  produced in the United States is used in the
manufacture of phosphate fertilizers; the rest  is  used  in
myriad  industrial  applications ranging from steel pickling
to detergent manufacturing.

Sulfuric acid is manufactured by chemical companies  and  by
companies  primarily  engaged in smelting nonferrous metals;
both sources compete for the same buyers.  Nevertheless, the
manufacturing of sulfuric acid by the  smelter  industry  is
primarily  a byproduct resulting from the control efforts to
reduce sulfur  dioxide  emissions  to  the  atmosphere,  and
secondarily,  as  an attempt to generate additional revenue.
For the purposes of this report, smelter acid is  considered
to  be part of the smelter industry rather than the sulfuric
acid industry.

The  major  products  of  the  sulfuric  acid  industry  are
concentrated  sulfuric acid (93 to 99 percent) and oleum.  A
few sulfuric acid  plants  associated  with  the  fertilizer
industry   produce   less-concentrated   grades   of   acid.
Essentially, all sulfuric  acid  in  the  United  States  is
currently  produced  by  the  contact process, less than 0.4
percent is being produced by the older chamber process.

In sulfur-burning  plants,  sulfuric  acid  is  produced  by
burning  elemental  sulfur  with  dry  air  in  a furnace to
produce  sulfur  dioxide.   The  latter   is   catalytically
converted to sulfur trioxide.  The hot converter effluent is
cooled  and  introduced  to  an  absorption  tower where the
sulfur trioxide is absorbed in a sulfuric acid  solution  to
form more sulfuric acid by its reaction with water.

Some  plants  (including  spent-acid  plants and smelter-jas
plants) operate on  the  same  principle  as  sulfur-burring
plants,  except that the sulfur dioxide is obtained from the
combustion of  spent  acid  and  hydrogen  sulfide  or  from
smelter off-gas.  In these plants, the sulfur-bearing gas is
dried   with   sulfuric   acid  and  cleaned  (subjected  to
particulate and mist removal process) before introduction to
the acid plant.

Of the known 183 sulfuric acid plants operating in 1973, 167
were contact process plants  and  16  were  chamber  process
plants.   Of  the  25.5  million metric tons of new sulfuric
acid produced, 25.3 million metric tons were made in contact
process plants.  This volume  production  included  sulfuric
acid  produced  by the sulfuric acid industry (as defined in
this report) and by  the  smelter  industry.   In  1974,  58
                           2-111

-------
companies  operated  sulfur-burning  or  wet-process contact
acid plants in 134  locations,  and  16  companies  operated
smelter  acid  plants  in  23  locations.  In addition, five
companies  operated  small  chamber-acid  plants   in   five
locations.

Emissions  Sources  and  Pollutants. Emissions from sulfuric
acid plants consist of sulfur  dioxide  gases  and  sulfuric
acid   mist.    These   pollutants  evolve  from  incomplete
conversion of sulfur  dioxide  to  sulfur  trioxide  in  the
converter,   and   from  the  formation  of  a  stable  mist
consisting of minute particles of sulfuric acid that  resist
absorption in the acid absorber.

Controlled  Technolocy  and  Costs.  The controlled emission
factors for existing facilities for FY 1976 are as specified
by the SIP'S; new source values were  assumed  to  apply  to
both existing and new facilities in FY 1980.

In   sulfuric  acid  plants  using  the  two-stage  or  dual
absorption control process, the  gas  from  the  first  acid
absorber  is  initially heated (sometimes removing the mist)
and then sent through a  single-stage  converter  where  the
sulfur  dioxide  is  converted  to sulfur trioxide.  The gas
from the converter  is  then  sent  to  an  absorber  and  a
demister before release to the atmosphere*

Dual   adsorption   has   reliably   met  EPA  standards  of
performance for new and modified sources in applications  of
two  types  of  sulfuric acid plants (sulfur-burning and wet
gas) of  all  sizes.   In  addition  to  controlling  sulfur
dioxide  emissions,  the  dual  absorption method offers the
added advantage of not requiring new operational  skills  on
the  part  of acid plant operators.  This control technology
has been used in computing the sulfur dioxide control  costs
for all new and existing sulfuric acid plants.

Table   3-13-1  shows  that  capacity  is  increasing,  at  a
substantial rate for this industry,  with  associated  costs
reflecting  this  trend.   This  may  cause  the costs to be
overstated due  to  the  rapid  increase  in  sulfuric  acid
recovered  in the control of sulfur oxides from smelters and
utility plants.  The control costs are also shown for  total
annualized expenditures, investment and cash requirements.
                           2-112

-------
I
I—"
I-4
OJ
                       Table 3-13-1.
            Sulfur1c Acid Industry Data Summary
ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                      1975
                                                  1980
  Capacity (1,OOO MT/Day)             94.2        127.1
  Annual Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-8S = 5.4O%
                                 1985

                                 152.8
PROCESS CHARACTERISTICS

  Sulfur Burning

  Wet Gas


EMISSIONS (1.0OO MT/Yr)

  1971 Controls:

     Sulfur Oxides
     Other Gases & Mists

  Legislated Controls:

     Sulfur Oxides
     Other Gases & Mists

CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

  Investment

  Total Annual
     Capital
     O&M
Model Plant Sizes
(MT/Day)

297:665;1.814
         1975
   Pollutants Controlled

   Sulfur  Oxide & Add
      Mist
   Sulfur  Oxide & Add
      Mist
               Control  Technology

               Dual  Absorption

               Dual  Absorption
1980
1985
                                                                                            1971-85
                                                            1976-85
711 ,
22.
337,
1 1 ,
148
1O9.
72.
36.
.36
.92
58
,35
,94
93
,98
,95
982
31
99
4
12
175
1O7
67
.04
.65
.03
.27
. 17
.51
.62
.88
1 , 18O.
38.
119.
5.
5.
181 .
111.
7O.
74
O5
44
14
76 721. 9O
SO 1.919.29
18 1.2O0.52
32 718.77


247.89
1 .673.29
1 . 036 . 32
636.97

-------
PETROCHEMICALS INDUSTRY

Production Characteristics and Capacities. In estimating air
emission  control  costs  associated  with the petrochemical
industry, the production of the following major large volume
petrochemicals was considered:

  •  Formaldehyde
  •  Acrylonitrile
  •  Ethylene dichloride
  •  Ethylene oxide
  »  phthalic anhydride.

A major air pollution problem in the petrochemical  industry
is the emission of hydrocarbons and carbon monoxide via off-
gases  produced  in oxidation processes.  The petrochemicals
involved in this problem include not only  oxygen-containing
compounds,  such  as  oxides, aldehydes, and anhydrides, but
also compounds in which oxygen serves an  intermediate  role
in   the  synthesis,  such  as  acrylonitrile  and  ethylene
dichloride.  In a typical process  of  this  type,  the  raw
material,  air  (sometimes  oxygen},  and  sometimes a third
reactant are fed  into  a  vapor-phase  catalytic  oxidation
reactor.   The  reactor  effluent gases go to an absorber in
which the desired product is scrubbed out.  The off-gas from
this absorber, which is vented to the  atmosphere,  contains
mostly  nitrogen  and carbon dioxide, but smaller amounts of
carbon  monoxide  and  unconverted  hydrocarbons  are   also
present.

  Formaldehyde.  Formaldehyde is synthesized by oxidation of
methanol with air  and  sold  as  an  aqueous  solution  (37
percent  by  weight).  Two different processes are used, one
based on a metal oxide catalyst and one based  on  a  silver
catalyst;  about  77  percent  of  the domestic formaldehyde
production uses the silver process and the other 23  percent
uses the metal oxide process.

Production  in  1974, as estimated from data for the first 8
months of the year, was about 2.8 billion  kilograms  of  37
percent  formaldehyde.  Growth is due primarily to increased
demand for urea-formaldehyde and phenolformaldehyde  resins,
which consume about half of all the formaldehyde produced.

  Acrylonitrile.  Ammoxidation of propylene, the most widely
practiced method for producing  acrylonitrile,  consists  of
the catalytic oxidation of ammonia with air.  Typically, the
gaseous products from the oxidation chamber are passed to an
absorber  where the acrylonitrile is collected.  The off-gas
from the absorber is normally vented to  the  atmosphere,  a
process which is largely uncontrolled at present.
                            2-114

-------
Production  in  1974,  as  estimated from data  for the  first
eight months of the year, was about 681  million  Kilograms.
Growth  is  due  primarily  to  increased demand for acrylic
fibers, which consume about half of  all  the   acrylonitrile
produced, and for plastics, which consume another 15 percent
of total production.

  Ethylene  Bichloride   (EDO.  Ethylene  dichloride  can be
produced by two alternative processes,  direct  chlorination
or  oxychlorination.   While  half of the U.S.  production of
EDC is by direct chlorination, the process results  in  only
10  percent  of  the  volume  of  atmospheric emissions that
result from the oxychlorination  process  and,  hence,  only
oxychlorination is considered here.

Production  in  1974,  as  estimated from data  for the  first
eight months of the year, was about 3.5  billion  kilograms.
The  use  of  the oxychlorination process should continue to
account for about 48 percent of  the  total  production,  or
about 2.8 billion kilograms in 1985.

  Ethylene  Oxide. In recent years, the dominant process for
manufacturing ethylene oxide has become the direct oxidation
of ethylene.  There are  four  processes  used   for  ethylene
oxide  manufacture  by direct oxidation and all use a silver
catalyst.  Only two of the plants oxidize with  dioxide,  the
others  use  air.  The plants which oxidize with dioxide are
similar except that  usually  only  a  primary  reactor  and
absorber  are  used.   Compared to the plants which use air,
the plants which use dioxide produce much less  absorber  gas
but much more carbon dioxide rich purge gas.

  Phthalic  Anhydride. Phthalic anhydride is produced by the
oxidation  of  either  o-xylene  or  naphthalene;  about  55
percent of the phthalic  anhydride is produced from o-xylene.
This  process  is  expected  to  gain an increasing share of
industrial production because oxylene is less expensive than
naphthalene.

A number of processes are available for  producing  phthaiir
anhydride.   Most  of  the  naphthalene-based   processes ;;• -.
fluidized-bed reactors,  whereas all  xylene-based  procc-t-.t-cs
use tubular fixed-bed reactors.  Except for the reactorb and
the catalyst handling facilities required for the fluidized-
bed  units, the processes based on the two raw  materials a^e
quite similar.  In both  cases, the  reactor  effluent   gas-s
are  used  to generate steam in a waste heat boiler and thon
go to a seperation system in which the phthalic anhydride is
condensed out as solid   crystals.   The  condenser  effluent
gases  are  ultimately vented to the atmosphere, although in
most plants they are first water-scrubbed or incinerated.
                           2-115

-------
Emission  Sources  and  Pollutants.  Atmospheric   emissions
arising   from  petrochemical  production  result  from  the
venting of off-gases  from  the  absorber.   The  chief  air
pollutants    are    hydrocarbons   and   carbon   monoxide.
Corresponding emission factors for  these  pollutants  as  a
function of production volume are given in Table 3-14-1.
                          2-116

-------
to
I
       Table 3-14-1.
  Petrochemicals Industry
Calculated Emission Factors

       (No Controls)
               Petrochemical

               Formaldehyde  (37%)
               Acryloni tr1le
               Ethlene dlchlorlde
               Ethylene oxide
               Pthallc anhydride
       Waste Gas Streams

       Absorber vent
       Absorber vent
       Absorber vent
       Absorber vent + C02^ purge
       Absorber vent
Kilograms Emitted Per 1O* Kilograms of Product

  CO           Hydrocarbons      SOx {as SO2)
   3.33
  74,19
   3.31
   O.
  73.76
 5.28
83.52
12 .94
50. 15
19.50
                                                                         2.29

-------
Control   Technology and  Costs.  The control  technology judged
to  be most  feasible for  control of  hydrocarbon  and   carbon
monoxide  emissions  from  the  manufacture of  petrochemicals is
thermal   incineration   (often   referred to  as  afterburners).
Thermal incinerators were  considered in place   of  catalytic
incinerators    because   of    the   latter's higher  initial
investment  costs  and requirement  for   catalyst  replacement
costs.  The investment  for thermal incinerators was based on
a   compilation  of   costs  by  the  Midwest Research  institute
(MRI), which considered  the  purchased   cost   of  a  thermal
incinerator plus   the   heat exchanger  in which the effluent
gases heat  up the influent gases.   These costs were inflated
to  mid-1973 using the Chemical  Engineering  Plant  Cost   index
and  were   found  to compare   closely  with investment data
provided  in a recent  report  by  Houdry  on   acrylonitrile.
Annual  costs   were  calculated  from utility (fuel and power)
requirements, annual maintenance,  and operating  labor.

The distribution of  plant  size  categories,  number of plants,
capacity and percent of  industry   capacity represented   by
model size, and the  unit investment  and annual operating  and
maintenance  costs  are  given   in   Table   3-14-3   for  each
petrochemical  production   process   covered.    Annualized
industry  costs  for  air  pollution abatement in the period
1976-85 are also provided  in Table  3-14-2.
                          2-118

-------
                       Table 3-14-2.
            Petrochemicals Industry Data Summary
ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                      1975
                                                  198O
  Capacity (Million Kg/Yr)          4,111,700   5.361.1OO
  Annual Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-85 = 5.83%
                                 1985

                               6.S98.9OO
PROCESS CHARACTERISTICS

  Formaldehyde-Si Ix/er
     Process
  Formaldehyde-Metal
     Oxide Process
  Phthalic Anhydride

  Aery1 on1tr1le

  Ethylene Oxide - O2_
  Ethylene Oxide - Air
  Ethylene O1chloride
EMISSIONS (1,000 MT/Yr)

  1971 Controls:

     Hydrocarbons
     Carbon Monoxide

  Legislated Controls:

     Hydrocarbons
     Carbon Monoxide

CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

  Investment

  Total Annual
     Capital
     O&M
Model Plant Sizes
(1/2 MT/Yr)

34.2;89.2;149.6;
492.2
43.5;9O,O;123.8

38.6;87.9;128.8

178:270

21O.3
71.2;3O3.8;733.3
177,5:425;695


         1975
Pollutants Controlled

Hydrocarbon; Carbon
   Monoxide
Hydrocarbon; Carbon
   Monox1de
Hydrocarbon: Carbon
   Monox1de
Hydrocarbon; Carbon
   Monox ide
Hydrocarbon
Hydrocarbon
Hydrocarbon; Carbon
   Monox1de
Control Technology

Afterburners

Afterburners

Afterburners

Afterburners

Afterburners
Afterburners
Afterburners
                     198O
                                 1985
                                             1971-85
                                                            1976-85
410.
171
182.
79
3
25.
2,
22
.83
,28
.25
. 11
.85
,58
.67
.90
621 .
273.
31
14.
2.
49.
5.
44.
, 17
,58
.24
,83
,OO
.85
.29
56
713.
316,
37.
17,
1 .
57.
5,
51 .
,65
, 9O
.27
, 14
, O4 48.51
2O 528.17
89 55.33
31 472.84


25. 9O
471 .73
48.93
422.81

-------
 PETROLEUM INDUSTRY

 Production Characteristics  and  Capacities.  The  petroleum
 industry  can  be  divided into the following four operating
 areas:

   Exploration and production, which includes the search  for
 new oil supplies, the drilling of oil fields, removal of oil
 from the ground,  and pretreatment at the well site.

   Refining,   which  includes  the  operations  necessary  to
 convert  the  crude  oil   into  salable  products  such   as
 gasoline,   jet  fuel,  kerosene,  distillate and residual fuel
 oils,  lubricants, asphalt,  specialty products, and  chemical
 raw materials such as  ethylene and benzene.

   Transportation,  which   involves the  movement  of crude oil
 to the  refinery and refined  products to market areas.

   Marketing,  which involves  the  distrubution and sale  of the
 finished products.

 Integration  and diversification  prevail  within the industry*
 Most of  the  firms involved in  refining  are also  involved  in
 production and/or marketing.   All  the large  and  medium  sized
 firms   are   involved   in  the  manufacture of  petrochemicals.
 Some firms are involved in the production aspects  of  energy
 sources  other  than   crude  oil,  i.e.,  coal  or  Canadian tar
 sands.

As of January 1,  1974, the  247  refineries   in  the  United
States  had  a  total  crude  oil  capacity  of  14.2 million
barrels per day.  A distribution of these refineries by  size
and percent of total capacity is as follows:
                           2-120

-------
Capacity
Range
(1,000 bbl No.
Cal day)   Refineries
Up to 5
5 to 10
10 to 15
15 to 25
25 to 50
50 to 75
75 to 100
100 to 200
Over 200
46
30
21
21
45
23
20
26
15
Totals
247
            Total
            Capacity
            (1,000 bbl
            Cal day)
                          144
                          236
                          274
                          437
                        1,645
                        1,444
                        1,831
                        3,657
                        4,550
14,216
               Total
               Industry
               Capacity(%)
                            1.
                            1.
                            1.
                            3.
   .01
   .66
   .92
   .07
 11.57
 10.15
 12.88
 25.72
 32.02

100.00
 Average
 Capacity
(1,000 bbl
 Cal day)

   3
   8
  13
  21
  37
  63
  92
 141
 303
During the period from 1970 to 1974, total crude  processing
capacity increased by 2.1 million barrels per day, despite a
drop in the number of refineries from 262 to 247, indicating
a  gradual  trend  toward larger plants.  Although there are
about 130 firms which operate refineries, over 80 percent of
the total capacity is controlled by  17  major  firms;  each
firm controls crude processing capacity in excess of 200,000
barrels  per  day.   A  breakdown  of capacity and number of
plants operated by these firms is as follows:
                           2-121

-------
Company

Exxon
Shell
Texaco
Amoco
Standard (CA)
Mobil
Gulf
ARCO
Union Oil
Sun Oil
Phillips
Sohio/BP
Ashland
Continental
Marathon
Cities
Amer. Petrofina
No.
Refineries

    5
    8
   12
   10
   12
    3
    8
    6
    4
    5
    6
    4
    7
    7
    3
    1
    4
Subtotal            110

Remaining Firms     137

                    247
Crude Capacity
(1000 bbl/cal day)

       1,252
       1,109
       1,083
       1,065
         984
         932
         861
         790
         487
         484
         404
         384
         358
         349
         314
         268
         200

      11,324

       2,892
                   14,216
Crude
Capacity (%)

     8.8
     6.9
     6.6
     6.1
     5.6
     3.4
     3.4
     2.8
     2.7
     2.5
     2.5
     2.2
     1.9
     1.4

    79.7

    20.3

   100.0
The intensity of  the energy  shortage  resulted  in  the  largest
absolute capacity  increase   since  1967,   and the   largest
percentage   increase in at least  a  decade.   The increase was
6.2 percent,  compared  with  2.3   -   4.3   percent  for  the
preceding 3  years.

Very  few new refineries have been built  in  the last 5 years,-
the   growth  has  occurred primarily through the expansion of
existing facilities.  This is in  part due to  difficulty  in
securing  approval   for  new  sites.   A survey  of refinery
construction plans in  August   of  1973   showed "definite
projects"   for  1974-77 totaling  1.13  million barrels  per day
(all  expansions)  and projects "under  study" totaling  about
0.9 million  barrels per day  (mostly new  refineries).

Turning  now to  the aspects of  the petroleum  industry which
are of particular importance in  air pollution  abatement, the
capacity of  fluid bed catalytic  cracking is expected  to grow
at the same  rate   as  total   refinery capacity,   i.e.,  4.2
percent per  year.
                            2-122

-------
it  is  estimated  that   the  247  domestic refineries produce
about 70 million cubic meters per day  of  refinery  gases.
The  present Claus plant  capacity for recovering sulfur  from
these gases is about  8,300 metric tons per day.

Emission Sources and  Pollutants.  The three major sources  of
air  pollution  in  the   petroleum industry covered in  this
report are  regeneration   of  catalysts  used  in  catalytic
cracking,  burning  of  fuel  gases  from  various   refinery
process operations in order to  recover the fuel values,  and
handling  and  storage of volatile  petroleum products and
crude oils.  A consolidated view  of the type and  extent  of
the  emissions  from  refining  and  related  operations, is
presented below.

  Catalytic  Cracking. Catalyst   regeneration  during   the
operation of catalytic cracking units has been identified as
a  major  source  of carbon monoxide, unburned hydrocarbons
and, in the case of the  fluid bed units which dominate   this
process,  particulate  emissions. The coXe deposited on the
catalyst during the cracking  operation must  be  continually
removed  to  permit  the  catalyst to maintain high activity.
In a fluid  bed  catalytic cracker,  the  catalyst   bed  is
continuously  circulated  between  the reactor, where  the  coke
is deposited on the catalyst, and the regenerator, where  it
is burned off with air.   The  amount of coke deposited on the
catalyst  per  unit  of   feedstock is  a  function   of  the
feedstock and operating conditions.

  Fuel Gas Burning. Currently,  amine  scrubbing  units  are
widely  used  to  remove   hydrogen sulfide from the  fuel gas
generated  within  refineries.    The  hydrogen  sulfide   is
thermally  stripped  from  the  scrubbing liquor and then is
either sent to a sulfur  recovery plant   (usually   a.  Claus
plant)  or  is burned to sulfur dioxide, which is emitted to
the  atmosphere through a flare.  In 1973, about  70   percent
of   the  sulfur  which  went   into fuel gas was recovered as
elemental sulfur, the other 30  percent was emitted as sulfur
dioxide.

  Petroleum Storage. The most  significant  contribution to
total  hydrocarbon  losses  in   the  petroleum  industry is
associated  with  the  necessary    use   of   vast    storage
facilities.   The  National Petroleum Council has shown  that
the  entire industry maintains a total storage capacity of at
least  two barrels for each barrel of actual inventory.   This
is   the  minimum  amount  necessary  to  insure   continuous
refinery  operations  and to provide  for seasonal variations
in product demands.  The magnitude of hydrocarbon  emissions
from  storage  tanks  depends  on many  factors including the
physical properties of the material being  stored,   climatic
                           2-123

-------
.and   meteorological   conditions,  and  the  size, color, and
 condition of the tank.

 control  Technology and Costs. Control technology  and  costs
 for   the  three  major  emission  sources  in  the petroleum
 industry are outlined in the following paragraphs.

   Catalytic Cracking. , The  removal  of  participate  matter
 (catalyst   fines)   from   the   regenerator   gas  can  be
 accomplished     with     high-efficiency      electrostatic
 precipitators.    Although  some reduction in carbon monoxide
 and  unburned hydrocarbons can be achieved by increasing  the
 regeneration  temperature,  essentially  complete removal of
 these species will require  carbon  monoxide  boilers.   The
 additional  combustion  which  occurs in the carbon monoxide
 boiler generates substantial quantities of heat,  which  the
 boiler  recovers  as  steam;  the  value of this steam helps
 offset the cost of the equipment.  Equipment for controlling
 emission  of  particulate  matter,  carbon   monoxide,   and
 hydrocarbons is commercially available and is already in use
 in some  catalytic cracking units.

 In  1971,  about  29 percent of the fluid catalytic cracking
 capacity was equipped with electrostatic  precipitators  and
 about 69 percent was equipped with carbon monoxide boilers.
 These boilers are often economically justified by the  steam
 which they generate, especially for large catalytic cracking
 units.   increasing   energy costs are making carbon monoxide
 boilers  more attractive for this reason,  in  some  existing
 refineries,  the  additional steam generated by the addition
 of  a carbon  monoxide  boiler  cannot  be  used,  but  new
 refineries  can  be  designed to take advantage of this means
 of reducing their total energy requirement.

 The   catalyst   fines   collected   by   the   electrostatic
 precipitator  must be disposed of as solid waste.  Costs for
 this phase of disposal  were  calculated  using  the  average
 particulate  emission  factor  for  fluid  cat crackers (110
 kg/1000  bbl fresh feed), a  precipitator  efficiency  of  93
 percent, and an operating factor of 0.913 {8,000 hr/yr).

 Annualized  control   costs  and control data are detailed in
 Table 3-15-1.

   Fuel  Gas  Burning.  The   control   technology   involves
 installing   additional  amine  scrubbing  facilities  where
 required, installing Claus  plants  on  the  30  percent  of
 capacity now without them, and installing tail-gas treatment
 facilities  on  all the  Claus plants.  The tail-gas treatment
 facilities increase  the overall sulfur recovery  from  about
 95 to 99.8 percent.
                            2-124

-------
The amine solution used in the scrubbing operation cannot be
regenerated  and  reused indefinitely.  Complex sulfur salts
are formed which must be purged from the system,  and  fresh
solution  must be' added to replace the amine thus lost.  TWO
methods 'are used  commercially:  one  involves  continuously
withdrawing a purge stream, and the other involves using the
solution  for a period of time and then completely replacing
it.  For analyzing salt disposal costs, an equivalent  daily
purge  rate  relationship of 1.74 pounds per day amine purge
per long ton per day sulfur recovery was used.

The credit for the sulfur recovered in these processes is an
important economic consideration and is  also  difficult  to
define.   In  the  coming  years, the reduction of allowable
sulfur emissions from refineries, power plants,  etc.,  plus
the  increasing  sulfur  content  of the crude oil processed
will  combine  to  cause  a  very  large  increase  in   the
production  of sulfur.  This will probably depress the price
of  sulfur,  but  the  extent  of  depression  is  open   to
considerable  speculation.   The  price  level  used in this
study was: $15 per metric ton.

Annualized control costs and control data  are  detailed  in
Table 3-15-1.

  Hydrocarbon   Storage.   The   EPA  new  source  pollution
regulations require that  petroleum  products  having  vapor
pressures  of  78 to 570 milliliters of mercury be stored in
floating roof tanks or their equivalent.  There  is  also  a
requirement  for  products  with vapor pressure greater than
570  milliliters  of  mercury,  but  this  will   cause   no
additional  expense  since the control methods are presently
used for these products.  Thus,  this  report  is  concerned
only with the storage of crude oil, jet fuel, and gasoline.

The typical industry practice  (1968) involved a distribution
of 75 percent floating-roof and 25 percent fixed-roof tanks-
this distribution is felt to be applicable for crude oil and
jet  fuel.   For  gasoline,  the  economics  of  evaporation
control have led to a  distribution  more  liKe  90  percent
floating-roof  and 10 percent  fixed-roof.  Thus, the cost of
meeting the new regulations is the  difference  between  the
cost  of  using  100  percent  floating-roof tanks for these
products and the cost of using the above distributions.

The tank costs were based on quotations obtained in  October
of  1974 from representative vendors.  These quotations were
for a typical Midwestern location.  The following items were
added to the basic tank cost:
                           2-125

-------
                     Item                  Tank  Cost  (%'

           Excavation and dike               25
           Foundation                        6
           Electrical grounding              3
           Piping, etc.                      10
           Painting                          3

           Total                             47
These percentages vere  taken   from  a  report  by  the  MSA
Research Corporation; no land cost was included.  Quotations
were  obtained  for both fixed-roof and floating-roof tanks.
The difference between these two is  then  the  differential
cost  applicable to new tanks.  Since the desired time basis
for this study is mid-1973, these costs were  adjusted  back
to   that   time  using  the  Nelson  refinery  cost  index.
Quotations were also obtained for converting existing fixed-
roof tanks to  floating-roof  by  retrofitting  an  internal
floating  cover.   This  is the conversion method which will
evidently be used, since it costs only about half as much as
removing the fixed roof and replacing  it  with  a  floating
roof.
                           2-126

-------
The  most  recent  analysis  of  costs  for  this sector was
provided to the Environmental Protection Agency by SobotKa &
Co., Inc. (S&C)1.  This analysis was conducted  in  somewhat
greater  depth  than,  and  subsequent  to  the general data
gathering efforts associated  with  the  SEAS  uniform  cost
calculation procedure, and is considered to be more precise.
However,    time    and   resource   constraints   prevented
incorporating these costs into the scenario  analyses  using
the  SEAS model procedure.  The S&C estimates are as follows
(in million 1975 dollars):

  Incremental Investment     (1975-1983)   1,280
                             (1974-1977)     740

Estimates from the earlier SEAS  calculation  are  presented
below,  with  projected pollutant discharges associated with
these costs. . SEAS forecasts an  investment  costs  of  $783
million  for 1975-1983.  This assumes that 46 percent of the
required pollution control equipment was installed by  1975.
The  total  cost  of  meeting the standard over 1972-1979 is
$1,223 million.  Thus, the assumed time pattern  of  capital
expenditures  of  the . two  studies greatly affects the cost
comparisons for a particular span of years.

The  S&C  study  developed  its  cost  data  for  two   main
categories—large  and  small  plants.   The  data  for both
groups was based upon  a  representative  sample,  and  then
extrapolated for the whole group.  SEAS used the model plant
concept,  with several different model plants for three main
categories:  catalytic  cracking,  fuel  gas  burning,   and
petroleum storage.  These assumptions are listed in Table 3-
15-1 and process characteristics.
  "Economic Impact of EPA's Regulations on the Petroleum
  Refining industry", Sobotka & Co., Inc., April, 1976.
                           2-127

-------
                                        Table  3-15-1.
                               Petroleum  Industry Data Summary
                 ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                                        1975
                                                198O
                                                                               1985
N>
00
Capaci ty
   Storage - Million Bbl/Day     783,02O     931.73O     1.140.4OO
   Catalytic Cracking 101
      Bbl/Day)                 2,778,313   3,325.4OO     3.97S.9OO
   Refining - MT/Yr Revised        4,282       5,126         6,128
Annual Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-85   Storage 4.18%
                                             Catalytic Cracking 3.99%
                                             Refining 3.99%
                 PROCESS CHARACTERISTICS

                   Gasoline Storage
                   Crude Oil Storage
                   Jet Fuel Storage
                   Catalytic Cracking
                   Refining (1.OOO Bbl/Day)
EMISSIONS (1.OOO MT/Yr)

  1971 Controls:

     Partlculates
     Sulfur Oxides
     Hydrocarbons
     Carbon Monoxide
                           Model Plant Sizes
                           (Mil 1 ion Bbl/Day)

                                 56
                                 80
                                 56
                           1.6, 9.6,  30
                           5,  10,  31,  67,
                           93.  211
                                                       1975
                                                       98.32
                                                    2,542.34
                                                      933.45
                                                    2.7O2.98
Pollutants Controlled   Control Technology
Hydrocarbons
Hydrocarbons
Hydrocarbons
Part iculates.
Carbon Monoxide
Hydrocarbons
Sulfur Oxides
Hydrocarbons
Carbon Monoxide
                                                                          Floating
                                                                          Floating
                                                                          Floating
                                                                          ESP
Roof
Roof
Roof
                                                                                           Tail Gas Treatment
                                                                   1980
                                               124.78
                                             3,226.72
                                             1,178. 14
                                             3,430.61
                                                                               1985
           147.38
         3,811 . 17
         1.424.74
         4.O51.98
                                                                                           1971-85
                                                                                                           1976-85

-------
                 Table 3-15-1. (Continued)
              Petroleum Industry Data Summary

  Legislated Controls:

     Partlculates                     42.64       18.12        2.15
     Sulfur Oxides                 1,328.85      472.02      560.93
     Hydrocarbons                    576,OG      353.69      421.85
     Carbon Monoxide               1,217.28      142.94       52.27
                 Table 3-15-1. (Continued)
              Petroleum Industry Data Summary

CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)        1975        198O        1985        1971-85        1976-85

Catalytic Cracking:

  Investment                          55.66       20.38       13.39      581.9O         275.42

  Total Annual                        49.42       83.37       94.32      934.7O         815.66
     Capital                          4O.30       68.24       76.54      763.41         664.77
     O&M                               9.12       15.13       17.77      171.29         150,89

Fuel Gas Burning:

  Investment                          49,36       18,41        8,86      515,03         223.50

  Total Annual                        90.35      143.46       158.10     1,619.70       1,407.23
     Capital                          37.54       61.01        67.71      686.16        593.32
     O&M                              52.81       82.45        9O.38      933.53        813.91

Storage:

  Investment                          46.60       19.00        11.88      361.O9         186.86

  Total Annual                        18.48       31.60        38.31      357.28         314.93
     Capital                          18.48       31.60        38.31      357.28         314.93
     O&M                                  0000              O

-------
FERROALLOY INDUSTRY

Production  characteristics  and  Capacities. In  1972, there
were 26  companies  operating  an  estimated  44   ferroalloy
plants.   The  industry  is  composed  of  steel   companies,
chemical and mineral companies having access  to   particular
alloying  elements, and specialist producers of ferroalloys.
Five  companies  use  the  metallothermic  process to  make
specialty   ferroalloys   containing  molybdenum,  tungsten,
vanadium, columbium or titanium.  Six companies are involved
in making ferrophosphorus.  The remaining companies use  the
submerged-arc  electric furnace to produce about  one-half of
the ferromanganese and virtually all  of  the  silicon-  and
chromium-containing ferroalloys used in steelmaking.

Alloying  elements  required for making different steels are
often added in the form of ferroalloys  which  contain  iron
and  at  least one other element.  The ferroalloys are named
according to  the  major  alloying  element:  ferromanganese
contains   manganese  as  the  additive,-  ferrochromesilicon
contains both chromium and silicon.  Some additives in which
the iron content is very small (such as silicomanganese  and
silicon-chrome-manganese}    are    also    considered    as
ferroalloys.

Ferroalloys are made by  three  methods  with  submerged-arc
electric furnaces producing most of the output.   Three types
of  furnaces  are  adapted  to the three production methods:
open furnaces, semicovered furnaces,  and  sealed furnaces.
Metalothermic reduction furnace production has been included
with   electric   furnace   production  in  the   absence  of
sufficient information on number, location,  emissions,  and
air-pollution-control  methods.   Two domestic producers use
blast  furnaces for making  ferromanganese  and  occasionally
ferrosilicon.

Emission  Sources  and Pollutants. Particulate emissions are
generated during the  handling  of  the  ores,  fluxes,  and
reductants   used   in   the   production   of  ferroalloys.
Particulate and gaseous emissions are  continuously   evolved
during   smelting   operations.    Fuming  occurs when  the
ferroalloy is poured, the amount varying with the particular
ferroalloy.  Submerged-arc electric furnaces of the open  or
open-hood  type  are  required  because  of the formation of
crusts with certain ferroalloys- these crusts must be broken
mechanically.  With semicovered or low-hood type   submerged-
arc   furnaces,  the   charge   is  fed  to the furnace  through
openings around the electrodes,  in open-hood furnaces,  the
collection  hood   is  raised  sufficiently to provide room for
charging   between  the  hood   and  the  charging   floor;  in
semicovered   furnaces,  the   hood  is  lower and water-cooled.
                            2-130

-------
Open and semicovered furnaces produce greater emissions than
sealed furnaces, which are used to  prevent  the  escape  of
emissions and to minimize the influx of air.

Metallic  silicon  and  aluminum are very strong deoxidizers
which are used under high-temperature conditions  to  reduce
the  mineral  oxides of molybdenum, titanium, zirconium, and
similar metals in metalothermic reduction furnaces.

In  blast  furnace  smelting  operations,  particulates  and
gaseous emissions are carried out of the furnace in the same
off-gas stream.

Control   Technology  and  Costs.  Baghouses,  electrostatic
precipitators  (ESP), and high-energy scrubbers are all  used
to  control  emissions from submerged-arc electric furnaces.
Fumes evolving  from the casting of ferromanganese  in  blast
furnace operations must also be controlled by baghouses.

A   total  of 155  ferroalloy  furnaces were used in developing
the model furnaces used to produce cost estimates/  however,
only    56  furnaces  could  be  identified   as  to  specific
ferroalloy produced and the  furnace electric power  rating.
The distribution  for  these  56  furnaces  was  assumed  to
represent  the   size  distribution   for  all the   existing
furnaces.  Emissions  from  ferroalloy furnaces are related  to
the furnace  electric power  input.

A   relationship  between   furnace  power  input and production
was used  to  estimate  furnace  capacity.   Capacities of  open-
hood   and   low-hood   electric  furnaces  were related  to  the
capacities   of   baghouse,    scrubber,   and  electrostatic
precipitator   control    devices   required   to   satisfy   the
requirements.

 To estimate  these air  pollution   control   expenditures,   the
 existing   ferroalloy    industry   was   divided   into  three
 segments.   These segments  are shown  in   Table  3-16-1   under
 the  Process Characteristics heading.   Annualized  production
 and cost control data is  presented in  Table 3-16-1.
                            2-131

-------
to
I-1
w
                 ACTIVITY LEVEL
                     Table 3-16-1.
            Ferroalloy Industry Data Summary

                                    1975
1980
Capacity (1.OOO MT/Yr-KVA)          3,,168,0     3,992.0
Annual Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-85 » 4.07%
                                                                               1985

                                                                               4,368.0
                 PROCESS  CHARACTERISTICS

                 Open and Low Hoods
                 Open and Low Hoods
                 Low Hoods
                           Model plant Sizes
                           (1,000 MT/Yr)

                           14.6-37:41
                           33
                           32
                 EMISSIONS  (1.000 MT/Yr)

                   1971  Controls:

                      PartIculates

                   Legislated  Controls:

                      PartIculates

                 CONTROL COSTS (Million  1975  $)

                   Investment

                   Total  Annual
                      Capital
                      O&M
                                    1975
                                   162.01
                                    74.28
                                    71 .OS

                                    44.96
                                    36.24
                                     8.73
Pollutants Controlled   Control  Technology
PartIculates
Partlculates
Partlculates

198O
                                                            1985
                                               226.45
 8.24
 1 .23

68.82
54.42
14.40
                                                           255.97
 8.97
 O. 13

68.27
55. 3O
12.97
            Baghouse
            Scrubber
            ESP

            1971-8S
339,73

752.71
598.49
154.22
                1976-85
117. 14

654.27
519.02
135.25

-------
IRON AND STEEL INDUSTRIES

Production characteristics  and  Capacities.  The   iron  and
steel  industry  production operation includes the  following
major  sequential  processes:  recycling   (sintering),  coke
production,  and  steelmaking.   There  are  three  types of
steelmaking: open-hearth (OH), basic-oxygen  furnace   
-------
 to  coke  having  the  desired properties.    During   the   coking
 cycle,   volatile  constituents   and  noncondensible  gases  are
 distilled   and  transferred  via  collecting   mains  to  the
 byproducts   plant   for   the  recovery of.the  gas  and  various
 chemicals.   When the  coking cycle  is completed, the doors on.
 the ends of the oven  are   removed  and -. a  ram   pushes  the
 incandescent coke  from  the oven into a quench car.   The  hot
 coke  is  transported to a quench tower  where   it  is   cooled
 under  a direct  water  spray.   The  coke  is then  crushed  and
 screened for use in the  blast furnace or  for  other  purposes.
 The fines from  the  crushing operation are used as a fuel  in
 sintering operations, or are sold  commercially.

  Open-Hearth  SteelmaKing.  This method is the oldest  of  the
 three steelmaking processes presently being used  to  produce
 raw steel.   Open-hearth  steel production  has  declined  from  a
 peak  of 89 million  metric tons in  1964  to about 36  million
 metric tons in  1973.  In 1973t  there were an estimated  18
 operating open-hearth shops in  the integrated iron  and steel
 industry.    it  is  doubtful that  any   new   plants  will be
 constructed.  Furnace capacities range from 50 to  300  net
 metric   tons of  steel.    For   this report,  the  open-hearth
 plants have been grouped into five model  sizes as follows:
Average Size                 Capacity
(1,000 metric       No.      (million metric    Total
tons/year)          Plants   tons/year)         Capacity  (%)

   283.4            2           0.57            2.0
   982.6            3           2.95           10.4
  1360.5            6           8.16           28.9
  1814.0            4           7.26           25.7
  3099.0            3           9.30           32.9
The open-hearth furnace is a shallow-hearth furnace that can
be alternately fired from either end.  The process  consists
of  charging  scrap,  fluxes,  and  molten pig iron into the
furnace where the required melting and  refining  operations
are  performed  to  produce  the  desired analysis of steel.
Firing of an open hearth can  be  done  with  a  variety  of
fuels,  depending  on availability, cost, and sulfur content
in the fuel.

  Basic-Oxygen Furnace Steelmaking. BOF was . first  used  to
produce  steel  in  the  United  States  in  1955.  By 1965,
economic replacement of the open-hearth furnace by  the  BOF
had been well established.  BOF steelmaking expanded rapidly
                           2-134

-------
to  about 76 million metric tons in 1973.  Recently, a newer
process called Q-BOF has been used for commercial production
of steel.  This new process has been included with  the  EOF
process  for  the  purposes  of this report.  In 1973, there
were 19 companies operating 38 BOF plants, ranging  in  size
from  450,000  metric  tons  to  4.3  million metric tons of
annual capacity.  For the purposes  of  this  report,  these
plants have been grouped into four model sizes as follows:
Average Size
(net metric
tons/year)

   68-127
  136-172
  181-240
  263-295
        Capacity
No.     (million metric    Total
Plants   tons/year)        Capacity

10          11.2            14.7
 5           8.1            10.7
20          46.0            60.7
 3          10.5            13.9
In  BOF  steelmaking,  the  pear-shaped,  open-top vessel  is
positioned  at  a  45-degree  angle  and  charged  with  the
required  amount  of steel scrap, molten pig iron, and other
materials.  The vessel is vertically  positioned  and  high-
purity oxygen is blown into the molten bath through a water-
cooled  oxygen lance positioned above the bath.  Products  of
the oxygen reaction with the carbon, the  silicon,  and  the
manganese  in  the  charge  pass  off as carbon monoxide and
carbon dioxide gases, and manganese and  silicon  oxides   in
the slag.  When the required content of carbon, silicon, and
manganese  is.  obtained  in  the  melt,  oxygen  blowing   is
stopped, and ferroalloys are added as needed to  attain  the
desired final chemical composition of the steel.  The molten
steel is then poured into a ladle for transfer to subsequent
operations.

  Electric-Arc  Furnace  Steelmaking.  This process has  long
been the established unit for the production  of  alloy  and
stainless steels.  More recently, it has been widely used  in
mini-steel  plants  to  make  plain  carbon steels for local
markets.  In 1972, electric-arc furnace production  amounted
to  1.5  million  metric  tons  of stainless steel.  In  1973
there  were  almost  100  companies  operating  electric-arc
furnace  plants  ranging in size from 9 thousand metric  tons
to 1.2 million  metric  tons  annual  capacity.   The  total
electric-arc furnace production in 1973 was about 25 million
metric  tons.  For the purposes of this report, electric-arc
furnaces have been grouped into six model sizes as follows:
                            2-135

-------
Average Size                   capacity
{1,000 metric      No.         (million metric    Total
tons/year)         Plants      tons/year)         Capacity (%)

   45-77            11             1.0               -4.0
   82-127           26             2.5               10.1
  136-204           21             3.4               13.4
  218-340           11             3.1               12.3
  363-544           21             9.1               36.1
  907-1197           6             6.1               24.2
The electric-arc  furnace  is  a  short,  cylindrical-shaped
furnace  having  a  rather  shallow  hearth.   Three  carbon
electrodes project through the fixed or moveable  roof  into
the  furnace.   Charge  materials consist of prepared scrap,
although one or two  electric  furnace  shops  make  use  of
molten  pig iron as part of the charge.  After charging, the
melting operation is started  by  turning  on  the  electric
power to the electrodes which are in contact with the scrap.
Electrical  resistance  of  the  scrap  produces heating and
eventual melting of the scrap.  Additional scrap  is  added,
and  refining  is accomplished by blowing high-purity oxygen
into  the  molten  scrap  to  remove  carbon  and   silicon.
Ferroalloys  are added as needed .to attain the desired final
chemical composition of the steel.  Power is  shut  off  and
the molten metal is tapped into a ladle.

Emission  sources  and Pollutants. The processes employed in
producing steel are shown in Figure 3-17-1.  Five  of  these
processes  are  important  generators  of air emissions, and
therefore  they   must   be   controlled   to   meet   State
implementation  Plans  and  Federal  New  Source Performance
Standards.  Fugitive emissions are not  considered  in  this
study.  However, in the case of certain steel plants control
of  fugitive emissions may be necessary in order to meet air
quality standards.

  Sintering Plants. The  emissions  associated  with  sinter
plant  operations are particulates that (1) become entrained
in the combustion air as it  is  drawn  through  the  sinter
mixture  into  the  windbox,  (2)  are  generated during the
cooling operation, and (3) are generated during the crushing
and screening operations.  Sulfur contained in the  fuel  is
not  considered  to  be a major problem, although any sulfur
present in the sinter mix or  in  combustion  fuel  will  be
emitted as sulfur oxides.
                           2-136

-------
           Figure  3-17-1.
iron and steel Production  PrOcesses
                                      POLLUTANTS

SHUT
SINTER
CUNKER
r"
lOPEN-HEAl
1


ERING OR RECYCLING


COKE PRODUCTION






METAL UJRGICAL~COKE]
i
r

BASIC-
*™ OXYGEN
» -T!CL „


RECLAIMED
MATERIALS
t
ELECTRIC-

ARC -~
_J
PARTICULATES
».




HYDROGEN
SULF10E


          2-137

-------
  Coke  Plants.  Emissions  from the production of coke occur
as participates, hydrogen   sulfide,  sulfur  oxides,  carbon
monoxide,  hydrocarbons,  and  nitrogen oxides.  Particulate
emissions occur  from the following sources:  coal  receiving
and  stockpiling,- coal  grinding  and handling, charging of
coke ovens, pushing  the  coke  from  the  ovens,  and  coke
quenching.   Gaseous  emissions  occur  during the following
operations: charging the coke ovens, the coking  cycle,  and
subsequent combustion of coke-oven gases.

  Open-Hearth  Furnace  Steelmaking.  Particulates  are  the
primary  emissions  from    open-hearth-furnace   operations.
Emissions  of  iron oxide occur during the time the scrap is
melted and large quantities of iron, silicon, and  manganese
oxides are formed and carried into the exhaust system of the
furnace  where  high-purity oxygen  is blown into the steel
bath to remove the carbon.  Gaseous  emissions  are  largely
carbon  dioxide, but sulfur .oxides may result through use of
sulfur-containing fuels.  If the scrap used  in  the  charge
contains    combustibles,   greater   volumes   of   gaseous
contaminants will be produced.

  Basic-Oxygen Furnace Steelmaking. Particulates and  carbon
monoxide   are   major   emissions   in   EOF   steelmaking.
Particulate  emissions  occur  at  the  hot-metal   transfer
stations,  the flux and alloy material-handling and transfer
points, and the BOF  vessel.   Carbon  monoxide  and  carbon
dioxide are emitted at the  EOF vessel.

  Electric-Arc  Furnace  Steelmaking.  Particulates  are the
primary   emissions   released   by   electric-arc   furnace
steelmaking.   Charging,  scrap melting, oxygen blowing, and
tapping are major sources of particulate emissions.  Blowing
the  molten  steel  with  high-purity  oxygen  produces  the
highest emission rates.  Emissions from the scrap charge and
other operations are similar to those from other steelmaking
processes  and  constitute  the  larges portion of the total
emissions.

Control  Technology  and  Costs.  The  following  paragraphs
contain  a  brief analysis  of pollution control methods used
in each process of the iron and steel industry.

  Sintering Plants. Electrostatic precipitators, high-energy
scrubbers,  and  baghouses   are   used   to   control   the
particulates   originating  from  the  sinter  strand.   Dry
cyclones and baghouses are  used to control particulates from
other  emission  sources.   Developments  in   blast-furnace
technology which require additions of limestone and dolomite
to  the  sinter  mix  make  continued  use  of electrostatic
precipitators problematical because  of  the  difference  in
                           2-138

-------
electrical  properties  between  limestone  dusts  and iron-
containing dusts,  installation of high-energy wet scrubbers
may  be  required  as   replacements   for   some   existing
electrostatic precipitator installations.

  Coke Plants. The technology for controlling emissions  from
coke  ovens  is still in the developmental stage; definitive
control measures have not been established.   Scrubbers  are
being   used   as   the   principal  control  technique  for
particulates in the control systems now  under  development.
In  addition to air-pollution-control devices, improved  coke
oven  design  and  improved  operating  practices  {such as
sequence charging) are factors offering significant means of
control.

  Open-Hearth-Furnace       Steelmaking.       Electrostatic
precipitators  and  high-energy  scrubbers   are   used   in
controlling emissions from open-hearth furnaces.

  Basic-Oxygen     Furnace     Steelmaking.    Electrostatic
precipitators and high-energy scrubbers  are  the  principal
control  systems  applied  to  the BOF.  Baghouses have  been
suggested for use in the United States and have  been  tried
in  Europe.   Baghouses are used for collecting particulates
at the hot-metal  stations,  and  the  flux  and  ferroalloy
handling locations.

Table  3-17-1  shows  the  estimated  growth  of  the  steel
industry in terms of  sales,  production,  and  capacity in
SEAS.   it  is  estimated  that  the  open-hearth process of
making steel will decline in importance as the basic  oxygen
and electric-arc processes increase in importance.

The  most  recent  analysis  of  costs  for  this sector was
provided  to  the  Agency  by  Temple,  Barker   &   Sloane,
inc.,(TBS)1.    This  analysis  was  conducted  in  somewhat
greater depth than,  and  subsequent  to  the  general   data
gathering  efforts  associated  with  the  SEAS uniform  cost
calculation procedure, and is considered to be more precise.
However,   time   and   resource    constraints    prevented
incorporating  these  costs into the scenario analyses using
the SEAS model procedure.  The TBS estimates are as  follows
(in million 1975 dollars):

                             75-77       75-83

  incremental Investment     2,100       3,300
  incremental O&M              200       2,300
                           2-139

-------
Estimates  from the earlier SEAS  calculation  are  presented
below,  with  projected pollutant discharges  associated with
these'costs.   Principal  reasons  for  differences  between
these  cost  estimates  and  the   newer  data are  that TBS
estimates  are based on 1983 capacity while  SEAS  is based  on
1972   production   levels.    There are   also  substantial
differences in industry definition between  the two studies.

Estimates  from the earlier SEAS calculations  are  presented
in  Table   3-17-1.   The TBS study includes costs associated
with fugitive emissions and "other air." SEAS confines  its
analysis to stack emissions.  Fugitive emissions account for
40  percent of capital expenditures in 1975-1983 for the TBS
study.  TBS credits the 1974 Cost of Clean  Air  Report  as
being  a basis for the stack emission control costs of $1.65
billion over 1975-1983.   SEAS forecasts a   total  figure  of
$3.33  billion  for  meeting the  standards  by 1979.  In many
instances,  control of fugitive emissions  may be  necessary
for  plants  to  meet  air quality standards.  To the extent
that such  control is necessary, the SEAS forecasts  tend  to
underestimate  total  control costs.  The assumed phasing of
expenditures has almost half of this occuring before  1975,
with  a  resultant  estimate  of  $1.80 billion in 1975-1979.
This includes costs associated with expansion.  Allowing for
expansion  costs to 1983  gives a  figure  of  $2.27  billion.
SEAS  also  bases its calculations upon research done for the
1974  Cost   of  Clean  Air   Report  with    revisions   and
modifications  to assumptions by  the same group that did the
original Clean Air Report  computations.  Thus, much  of  the
differences between the  SEAS figures and those of TBS can be
attributed   to  differences  in   assumed growth patterns and
phasing of  capital expenditures.
» "Economic Analysis of Proposed and Interim Final Effluent
  Guidelines,  Integrated  Iron and Steel Industry",
  Temple, Barker & Sloane, Inc., March, 1976.
                           2-140

-------
to
I
                                       Table 3-17-1.
                             Iron and Steel Industry Data Summary

                ACTIVITY LEVEL                         1975         198O

                  Capacity  (1.0OO MT/Yr)            131,879      14O,159

                  Annual Growth Rate Over the Period  1976-85 = O.94%
   1985

136.358
                PROCESS CHARACTERISTICS

                   1. Sintering
                     (alternatives)
                     (alternat ives)
                  2. Coking
                     (sequential )

                  3. Open Hearth
                  4. Basic Oxygen
                                                   Model Plant Sizes
Segment
1

2
3
4
5

6
7
1
2
3
1
2
3
4

5
1
2
3
4
5

6
( 1 ,OQO MT/Yr)
508: 1 . 1OO;2,7OO;
5.25O
5OO
575
50O
422; 1, 100:2.375;
3, SCO; 5. 200
550
1 ,30O



2,OOO;3,375
125; 150
1 ,25O
500:750; 1.50O;
2,OOO:3,50O
1 ,250; 2, BOO
1. 125;2,333
875; 2.325
1 ,44O
965
1 ,633; 1.500:2.265:
3.50O
3,OOO;2,575;4,O5O
Control Technology
ESP

Flooded Disc Scrubber
ESP
Flooded Disc Scrubber
ESP

Flooded Disc Scrubber
Baghouses
CO gas desul fur izat ion
Charging Car Collector
Collection Hood
ESP
ESP
ESP
ESP

Scrubber
ESP
Scrubber
ESP
ESP
ESP

Scrubber
Standard
Pennsylvania

Pennsylvania
1 1 1 i no i s
1 1 1 i no i s
Federal

Federal
Federal
H2S Federal
Federal
Federal
Pennsylvania
Cal ifornia
11 1 1nois
Federal

Federal
Pennsylvania
Pennsylvania
Cal ifornia
11 1 inois
Federal

Federal

-------
                 Table 3-17-1. (Continued)
            Iron and Steel Industry Data Summary
  5. Electric Arc         1

                          2
                          3
                          4
                          5

                          6
                          7
                          8

                          9
                          10
                          1 1
EMISSIONS (1,000 MT/Yr)

Particulates

  1971 Controls:

     Open Hearth
     BOF
     Electr ic-Arc

  Legislated Controls:

     Open Hearth
     BOF
     Electric Arc

CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

  Investment

  Total Annual
     Capital
     O&M
64;120;185:272;
40O,8OO
200;350;488
1 ,000
8O;1O2;160
1O8;575

187;35O;GOO;725
1 ,OOO
69;108;175;338:463
7SO:1.177
100;35O
300;477;1,200
450
       Baghouse

       Building Evacuation
       Scrubber
       Baghouse
       Building Evacuation

       Baghouse
       Scrubber
       Baghouse

       Building Evacuation
       Scrubbers
       ESP
                   Pennsylvania

                   Pennsylvania
                   Pennsylvania
                   California
                   Cali fornla

                   111 1 no i s
                   11 Hno i s
                   Federal

                   Federal
                   Federal
                   Federal
   1975
  633.58

  156.64
  444,62
   32.32

  186.52

   45. 18
  132.OO
    9.34
1,091.86

  429.O1
  345.32
   83.69
               1980
84O.86

136.07
653.58
 51.21

 19.67

  3.06
 15.41
  1 .20
 36. OO

626.81
492.62
134.18
                           1985
889.34

 56.38
764,04
 68,92

 18.20

  1 . 1O
 15.69
  1 .41
  4.52

652.53
517.95
134.58
                                       1971-85
                                                      1976-85
3,551.84

6,961.31
5,467.79
1,493.52
1 . 193. 19

6.O87.11
4,789.28
1 ,297.83

-------
IRON FOUNDRIES INDUSTRY

Production Characteristics ana  Capacities.  Iron  foundries
may  be  found  in almost all urban areas.  The economies of
scale  for  the  industry  do  not  prohibit  the  continued
existence  of  relatively  small foundries.  Because many of
the foundries are operated in conjunction with steel  making
facilities,  iron  foundries  tend to be concentrated in the
major steel producing states:  Pennsylvania, Ohio, Michigan,
Illinois, and Alabama.

Iron  foundries  range  from  primitive,  unmechanized  hand
operations to modern, highly-mechanized operations.  Captive
plants  (owned  or  controlled by other businesses) are more
likely to be mechanized and better equipped  with  emission-
control equipment than are noncaptive plants.

In 1973, about 6 percent of the 1,432 plants were classified
as  large (over 500 employees), 29 percent as medium (100 to
500 employees), and 65  percent  as  small  (less  than  100
employees).

The  major markets for iron castings include motor vehicles,
farm machinery, and industries that build equipment for  the
construction,   mining,   oil,  metalworking,  and  railroad
industries.   Captive  plants   have   the   capability   of
economical  production  of  large  lots  of  closely related
castings.  Most of the largest plants are captive and do not
generally produce for the highly competitive open market.

Castings for machine parts, automotive partst and soil  pipe
are   produced  from  both  pig  iron  and  scrap.   Cupola,
electric-arc, electric-induction, and reverberatory furnaces
are used.  In 1973, 79 percent  of  the  production  was  by
cupolas,  12  percent  by  electric-arc  furnaces,  and  the
remainder by  induction  and  reverberatory  furnaces.   The
latter   two  types  emit  relatively  small  quantities  of
pollutants  and  require  little  or  no   emissions-control
equipment.

The  cupola  furnace  is  a vertical, cylindrical furnace in
which the heat for melting the iron is provided by injecting
air to burn coke which is in direct contact with the charge.
An  electric-arc  furnace   is   an   enclosed,   cup-shaped
refractory  shell  that contains the charge.  Three graphite
or carbon electrodes extend  downward  from  the  roof.   An
electric arc between the electrodes and the charge generates
the   required   heat.    The   cupola   melts   the  charge
continuously, while the arc  furnace  operates  in  a  batch
mode.
                           2-143

-------
Emission  Sources  and Pollutants.  Emissions  from  cupolas  are
carbon monoxide, participates,  and oil  vapors.    Particulate
emissions arise from dirt on  the metal  charge and from  fines
in  the  coke  and limestone charge.   Hydrocarbon emissions
arise primarily from partial  combustion and  distillation  of
oil  from  greasy  scrap  charged  to the  furnace, but  their
control is not costed in this report because the emissions
are  small.  Arc furnaces produce  the same Kind of emissions
to a lesser degree because  of  the  absence  of coke   and
limestone in the charge.

The  particulate   emission  factor for uncontrolled cupola
operation is taken to be 8.5 Kg per metric   ton.   The  best
available  estimate  of  the particulate emission factor  for
uncontrolled arc furnaces is taken to be  5  kg   per  metric
ton.

An uncontrolled cupola generates approximately 150 kg carbon
monoxide  per  metric  ton  of  charge.  Half of  this carbon
monoxide burns in  the stack.  On this basis,  the estimated
emission  factor   for  carbon  monoxide discharged  from an
uncontrolled cupola is approximately 75 kg per metric ton of
charge.   Uncontrolled  arc   furnaces    produce   negligible
quantities of carbon monoxide.

Control  Technology and Costs, in  industrial practice,  large
cupolas use high-energy scrubbers  to control the  emission of
particulates to acceptable levels.  Medium sized  cupolas can
use either a high-energy scrubber  or a  baghouse.  For  small
cupolas and arc furnaces, baghouses are preferred.

High-energy  scrubbers usually are operated  at a  particulate
collection efficiency of 95 percent.  This efficiency can be
increased to 99 percent by  increasing  the  pressure  drop.
Fabric filters (baghouses) have an efficiency of  98 percent.
Electrostatic precipitators also have a high efficiency rate
of 96 percent.

Afterburners  are  used to control carbon monoxide emissions
from cupolas.  The efficiency  of  afterburners   to  control
carbon  monoxide   emission  is  generally  taken  to  be  94
percent.

Table 3-18-1 presents annualized production and cost control
data for the industry; iron castings are made  using  either
the  cupola  or electric-arc process.   To estimate the costs
of controlling air pollution from  this  industry,  the  five
processes   were   listed  individually  for  cost-comparison
evaluation.
                           2-144

-------
                       Table 3-18-1.
            Iron Foundries Industry Data Summary
I
I—
>f»
Ul
ACTIVITY LEVEL
  Capacity (Million MT/Yr)
PROCESS CHARACTERISTICS

  Process 1 ~ Cupola
  Process 2 - Cupola
  Process 3 - Cupola
  Process 4 - Arc Furnace
  Process 5 - Arc Furnace

EMISSIONS d.OOO MT/Yr)

  1971 Controls:

     PartIculates
     Carbon Monoxide

  Legislated Controls:

     Partlculates
     Carbon Monoxide

CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

  Investment

  Total Annual
     Capital
     O&M
                                      1975
                                                  198O
                                                              1985
i Period
36.25
1976-85 = 3.
41
16%
Model Plant Sizes
(MT/Yr)
87.OOO;
87.OOO
13,060;
13.O6O;
13,060;

1
\
> )

13.060:2,180
2,180
2, 180
2,180
1975
9O.93
,171.81 1,
47.93
637. OO
86.85
154. OO
52.27
101 .73
.98
44.58
Pollutants Control
Carbon Monoxide
Part ieulates
Partlculates
Carbon Monoxide
Partlculates
198O
119,
539
21
313
16.
241,
79,
162,
.48
.83 1
. 12
.74
.66
.25
.22
.03
1985
129. 8O
.672.83
2.61
100.75
2.9.4
232. €2
82.95
149.67

led Control

Technology
Afterburners
Scrubber
Baghouse
Afterburners
Baghouse
1971-85


5O9.66
2,599.24
867. 16
1,732.07
1976-85


188 .-48
2,258.09
749.08
1,509.01

-------
STEEL FOUNDRIES INDUSTRY

Production characteristics  and  Capacities.  Two  types  of
steel  are  produced  from  steel  foundries:  carbon  steel
castings and alloy-stainless steel  castings,  carbon  steel
representing  90  percent  of  the productive capacity.  The
electric-arc furnace is the established  equipment  for  the
melting of steels that are subsequently poured into molds to
make castings.  Castings may be in a semi-finished form that
requires  considerable  machining  before  it can be used in
other components, or it may be a high quality  product  that
requires a minimum of additional worX before subsequent use.
Production   of   steel   castings   closely  parallels  the
production of steel.

in determining control costs, the foundries producing  large
castings  were  grouped with the foundries producing carbon-
steel castings on a one-shift basis.

Emission  Sources  and  Pollutants.  Particulates   comprise
almost  100  percent  of  the emissions occurring during the
production of steel for castings.  Minor amounts  of  carbon
monoxidet  nitrogen oxides, and hydrocarbons may be emitted.
Most of the particulate emissions, which  occur  during  the
charging  operation,  are  carried upward by the thermal gas
currents created by the hot  furnace;  these  emissions  are
generated  during  the  charging  operation and are the most
difficult to control.

Control Technology and costs.  The  allowable  emissions  of
particulates per unit of process weight per hour under state
Implementation   Plans   (Pennsylvania   standards  used  as
typical) and Federal New Source  Performance  Standards  for
electric   arc   steelmaking  were  used  as  guidelines  in
establishing the level of control likely to be required  for
electric-arc  furnace  steel  foundries,  and the subsequent
costs.

Baghouses are the only reported means  for  the  control  of
einissions  from steel foundry electric-arc furnaces.  One of
the  probable   reasons   for   not   using   scrubbers   or
electrostatic   precipitators  is  the  lack  of  space  for
installing the required water treatment  facilities  in  the
case  of  scrubbers,  and  a  reluctance  on the part of the
smaller foundry operators to get involved with electrostatic
precipitators

The inventory of electric-arc furnace steel  foundries  used
in  the  report  is  based  on  information  in  two foundry
directories and information in the published literature.   A
                           2-146

-------
few steel foundries still use open hearth furnaces but these
are rapidly being phased out of use.

Development   of   control  costs  for  steel  foundries  is
complicated by several factors: foundries do not operate the
same number of hours during  the  year,  different  furnaces
sizes  are used in a single plant, some foundries specialize
in plain-carbon steel castings, and some  foundries  produce
only those castings that can be produced in large production
runs,  while  a  small  number  produce  large,  complicated
castings on a one-or two-shift basis.   Table  3-19-1  shows
the annualized summary information for steel foundries.
                            2-147

-------
                                            Table 3-19-1.
                                Steel Foundries  Industry Data Summary
                     ACTIVITY  LEVEL
                                      1975
                     1980
it*
CO
                       Capacity  1M111ion MT/Yr)             1,724.0      1.998.O
                       Annual Growth  Rate Over the Period  1976-85 = 2.78%
         1985

         1,981 .O
PROCESS CHARACTERISTICS

  Carbon/Alloy               5,583

EMISSIONS (1,000 MT/Yr)

  1971 Controls:

     PartIculates

  Legislated Controls;

     PartIculates

CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

  Investment

  Total Annual
     Capital
     O&M
Model Plant Sizes
(1.OOO MT/Yr)
                                                            1975
                                                           27.39
                                                            15.57
                                                            3.39

                                                           43.28
                                                           40.77
                                                            2.51
Pollutants Controlled

PartIculates
                                                                        1980
                     36.82
                                                                        8.76
                      3.03

                     47.5O
                     43.21
                      4.29
                                                                                   1985
                                 37.68
                                                                                    O.82
         48.06
         43.82
          4.24
    Control  Technology

    Baghouse
                                                                                               1971-85
                                                            1976-85
269.23

58O.66
535.33
 45.33
 18.72

468.60
428.26.
 4O.34

-------
PRIMARY ALUMINUM INDUSTRY

Production  Characteristics  and  Capacities.   The   domestic
primary aluminum  industry  is  presently  comprised  of   12
companies  operating  31  reduction facilities in 16 states.
Three companies, Alcoa, Reynolds,  and Kaiser,  operate  about
two-thirds of the total capacity.   Plants tend to be located
in  areas  where  cheap  electrical power is available.   The
plant-size distribution for the industry is as follows:
  Size Range                 No.
  (1,000 Metric Tons/Year)   Plants            capacity(%)

        0-90.7                  6                    8.8
     90.8-136                  11                   28.1
    136.1-190                   8                   30.8
      191-254                   6                   32.3

                               31                  100.0
Aluminum is one of the most abundant  of  the  elements   and
when  measured  either in quantity or value,  its use  exceeds
that of any other primary metal except steel,  it  is  used to
some extent in virtually all segments of  the  economy,   but
its principal uses have been in transportation,  building  and
construction, electrical industry, containers and  packaging,
consumer durables, and machinery and equipment.   Growth rate
of  aluminum  industry  in  the United States has  averaged 7
percent in recent years.

Bauxite ore (typically containing 50-55 percent  alumina)   is
the principal source of aluminum.  Alumina is extracted from
bauxite  by  any  one of a number of variations  of the Bayer
process.  In turn, alumina is dissolved in  molten cryolite
and  reduced to aluminum by electrolysis in the  universally-
used  Hall-Heroult  aluminum  reduction  cells,   which    are
connected in series to form a potline.

The  aluminum reduction plant may be classified  according to
the type of anodes used in the cells; there  are   two major
types  based  on how they are replaced.  Prebaked  anodes  are
replaced intermittently, and Soderberg anodes  are replaced
continuously.   In the Soderberg continuous system, an anode
paste is continuously supplied to a rectangular  metal shell
suspended  above  the cell.  As the anode shell  descends, it
is baked by  the  heat  of  the  cell.   The  two   types   of
Soderberg  anodes  use different support methods:  a Vertical
                           2-149

-------
Stud System  supported  on  vertical   current-carrying   pins
(studs),  and  &  Horizontal   Stud  System  supported  by  pins
which are inclined slightly from the horizontal.

Emission  Sources  and  Pollutants.  All  three  alternative
processes   currently   used   to  produce   aluminum   release
particulates which must be controlled.

Of the three anode  systems  in  use,  prebaked,  horizontal
Soderberg,  and  vertical  Soderberg,  the vertical Soderberg
system emits the lowest quantity of  particulates,  and  the
prebaKed  and  horizontal  Soderberg   systems  are higher in
pollutant emissions.  On the other hand, the prebaKed system
is easiest to control, the vertical Soderberg somewhat   more
difficult,  and  the horizontal Soderberg the most difficult
to control, leading to a gradual phasing out of  the  latter
two processes.

Control  Technology  and  Costs,  in   this  analysis, it was
assumed that 98 percent control  of  particulates  would  be
sufficient  to  comply  with ambient standards in all cases.
New sources are assumed to be of the prebaked process  only,
and  it  is  further assumed that the  New source Performance
Standards for fluorides will be  met   by  the  same  control
processes  applied  for particulate control at no additional
cost.  Assumed control processes for   the   three  production
processes are shown below:
  Cell. Type
  Prebaked
  Horizontal
     Soderberg
  vertical
     Soderberg
Primary Control
Secondary control
Primary Collection   None Needed
(Hoods and Ducting),
Plus Fluidized-Bed
Dry Scrubber

Primary Collection,  Spray Screen and
Wet Electrostatic    Water Treatment
Precipitator, Spray
Tower, or Fluidized-
Bed Dry Scrubber
(experimental)
Primary collection,
Wet-Electrostatic
Precipitator or
Spray Tower
Spray Screen and
Water Treatment
                           2-150

-------
Table  3-20-1 shows the estimated growth of primary aluminum
production.  Note that the prebaked  anode  process  is  the
dominant  one  in existence now, and that all new plants are
assumed  to  employ  this  process.   Two   new   production
processes,  the  Alcoa and the Toth, which are claimed to be
essentially non-polluting, are now being  investigated.   if
successful,  costs  for  new  sources  beyond  1980 might be
substantially lower than indicated.
                            2-151

-------
ui
to
                                       Table 3-20-1.
                           Primary Aluminum Industry Data Summary
                ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                                      1975
                                                                  198O
                  Capacity (1,000 MT/Yr)              4,243       4,940
                  Annual  Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-85 =  1.69%
                                                              1985

                                                              4,653
PROCESS CHARACTERISTICS

  Prebaked Anode

  Horizontal Soderberg

  Vertical Soderberg


EMISSIONS (1,000 MT/Yr)

  Participates:

  1971 Controls:
Model Plant Sizes
(1.OOO MT/Yr)

144

137

32


         1975
                                                      49,22
Pollutants Controlled   Control  Technology

Particulates

PartIculates

Particulates
Hoods and Ducting;
   Scrubber
Hoods and Ducting;
   Wet ESP; Scrubber
Hoods and Ducting;
   Wet ESP
                                                                  1980
                                                                  65 .49
                                                                              1985
                                                                              63.90
                                             1971-85
                                                                                                         1976-85
Prebaked Anode
Horizontal Soderberg
Vertical Soderberg
Legislated Controls:
Prebaked Anode
Horizontal Soderberg
Vertical Soderberg
CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)
Investment
Total Annual
Capital
O&M
33.
12.
3.
24
16.
6
1

629
473
19O
282
41
,€7
14
.48
.62
.04
.82

.46
.02
.84
. 18
50.
1 1 .
2.
15,
11 .
2
1

6
669
288
381
61
97
91
,39
,90
.44
.OS

.64
.66
. 13
.51
53.
8.
1 .
3.
3.
O
0

0
59O
289
301
76
17
97
,64
07
.40
. 17

.25 2.O54.64
.56 7,295.29
.22 3,110.06
.34 4,185.23








699. O6
6,286.73
2,734.70
3,552.03

-------
SECONDARY ALUMINUM INDUSTRY

Production  characteristics  and  Capacities.   Aluminum  has
become  one  of  the most important metals  in  industry- only
iron surpasses it in tonnages used.  Major  uses of the metal
are in the construction industry,  aircraft/  motor  vehicles,
electrical   equipment  and  supplies,   beverage  cans,  and
fabricated metal products which include  a  wide  variety  of
home  consumer products.  The automotive industry is a large
user of secondary aluminum ingot.

Secondary  aluminum  ingot  is  produced to  specification;
melting to specification is achieved mainly by segrating the
incoming  scrap into alloy types.   The magnesium content can
be removed with a chlorine gas treatment in a   reverberatory
furnace.

For  the  purpose  of  this  report, the secondary aluminum
industry  is  defined  as  that  industry   which   produces
secondary  aluminum  ingot  to  chemical specifications from
aluminum scrap and sweated pig.  The industry  is  viewed  as
consisting  of secondary aluminum' smelters  excluding primary
aluminum companies, non-integrated  fabricators,  and  scrap
dealers.
Emission  Sources  and Pollutants.  The most  serious emission
sources during secondary aluminum smelting are:   the  drying
of  oil  borings and turnings, the  sweating  furnace, and the
reverberatory furnace.  Emissions from  the   drying  process
are  vaporized  oils,  paints,  vinyls,  etc;  the  sweating
furnace produces vaporized fluxes,  fluorides, etc-  and  the
reverberatory furnace emissions are similar  to the other two
plus  hydrogen  chloride,  aluminum  chloride, and magnesium
chloride from the chlorine  gas  treatment  used  to  remove
magnesium.    As   of  1970,  an  estimated   25  percent  of
chlorination station emissions were controlled,   and  it  is
estimated that by 1980, 80 percent  will be controlled.

The  several  processes  that  cause  emissions  during  the
operation of a reverberatory furnace must be  understood  to
calculate control costs properly; they are:

  •  Emissions at the forewell.  Secondary  smelters  charge
     scrap  directly  into the foreweli of the reverberatory
     furnace, and any oil, paint, vinyl,  grease,  etc.,  on
     the  scrap  vaporizes.  The emissions from the charging
     process  vary  greatly  with  the   material   charged.
     Quantitative data on forewell  emissions or the need for
     control  are  not available and costs or possible costs
     cannot be estimated.
                           2-153

-------
   •  Emissions  from  the  bath.   During the time the  aluminum
     bath  is  molten,  it  is  covered with a flux to protect it
     from  oxidation.

   •  Emissions   caused   by   chlorination.    The   magnesium
     content  of aluminum can be reduced by chlorination,  but
     chlorination  produces chloride  emissions.   Particulate
     emissions   from  the  chlorination  process   are    500
     kilograms   per   metric  ton  of  chlorine used.   Maximum
     magnesium   removal   requires   about   18   kilograms    of
     chlorine  per  metric   ton of  aluminum  which has an
     emission rate of 9  kilograms  of  particulates per metric
     ton of aluminum.  Magnesium  removal  is  practiced   by
     plants   representing    92 percent   of   the  estimated
     industry capacity.   A  small portion  of these plants  use
     aluminum fluoride fluxing  for magnesium  removal  rather
     than  chlorine.  This  report  assumes that control costs
     for these  few plants are   similar  to those  that   use
     chlorination.    Wet  scrubbing  is  the   usual  means of
     controlling  chlorination   station  emissions,-   recent
     innovations on a dry control  process are being  tested.

Control  Technology   and  Costs.  Dryer emissions  are  known to
exist and  in  many  cases   are   treated  with afterburners;
however,   there  is insufficient data relating to the drying
operations to permit  evaluations   of   possible   costs  that
might be expended to meetvair-quality specifications.

Sweating   furnace  emissions,   fluoride from  fluxes, organic
materials,  oils,  etc.,   can    be   controlled    by   using
afterburners,  followed  by  a wet  scrubber or baghouse,  for
which control costs have been reported.   However,  no data  is
available on the number,  capacity,  or location  of  sweating
furnaces.   Thus, realistic estimate of control costs cannot
be made,  industry costs and operating  data are included   in
Table 3-21-1.
                           2-154

-------
                                          Table  3-21-1.
                             Secondary  Aluminum  Industry  Data  Summary
NJ
I
ui
Ul
ACTIVITY LEVEL
Capacity ( 1 , OOO MT/Yr)
Annual Growth Rate Over
PROCESS CHARACTERISTICS
Model 1
Model 2
Mode 1 3
Mode 1 4
1975
1.O22 1,
the Period 1976-8S =
Model Plant Sizes
(MT/Yr)
5,261 ; 17, 12O;
43,536
198O 1985
361 1,635
5 . 80%
Pollutants Controlled
Particulates
Part iculates
Particulates
Particulates




Control Technology
Wet
Wet
Wet
Wet
Scrubber
Scrubber
Scrubber
Scrubber
                  EMISSIONS  (1.OOO MT/Yr)

                     1971 Controls:

                       Particulates

                     Legislated Controls:

                       Particulates

                  CONTROL COSTS  (Million 1975 $)

                     Investment

                     Total Annual
                       Capi tal
                       O&M
1975
 8.67
 4.79
12.74

 5.98
 3.11
 2.87
            1980
            13.88
             4.41
1 .49

9.48
4.36
5. 12
                        1985
                        17. 2O
                         3.65
 O.72

10.92
 5.04
 5.88
                                    1971-85
                                                   1976-85
 35.69

103.39
 48.23
 55. 16
11 .83

91 .85
42.59
49.26

-------
PRIMARY COPPER  INDUSTRY

Production  Characteristics  and  Capacities.  Copper  is  one  of
the most  important  of  the  nonferrous  metals,  surpassed only
by  iron  in ore  tonnage produced  in  the  United  States.  Its
extensive use depends  chiefly  upon its  electrical   and heat
conductivity,   corrosion  resistance,  ductility,  and  the
toughness of   its  alloys.    Mechanical   properties   (and
sometimes special  properties) are enhanced  by alloying with
zinc to form brass, with tin to  form  bronze,  with  aluminum
or  silicon  to  form  the  higher strength  bronzes,  with
beryllium to form high strength-high  conductivity  bronzes,
with  nickel  to  form corrosion  resistant  alloys, and with
lead to form bearing metals.

Principal  users    of   copper   include   the   'electrical,
electronic,  and  allied   industries  for  manufacturing power
transmission  lines,   other   electrical   conductors,   and
machinery.   The  automobile  industry  (radiators, wiring, and
bearings)  and    building-construction    industry   (tubing,
plumbing)  are  the  second-  and  third-largest  consumers  of
copper in the United States.

Copper  ore  is  either  surface    or   underground    mined,
concentrated  by  ore-beneficiation techniques,  then sent  to
the smelter.  Processing of  copper  concentrates  at a smelter
involves  the following  operations.   Roasting   is  normally
used  to  dry   the  finely ground  concentrates and to  remove
some sulfur,  arsenic,  antimony   and   selenium  impurities.
Roasting  is  frequently bypassed  in modern smelters because
better concentration methods remove free  pyrite  and   permit
the  substitution of  simple  dryers   for  roasters at some
smelters.   The   roasted   concentrate   is   treated    in   a
reverberatory   furnace  to produce an  intermediate material
called matte, which nominally  contains   copper,  iron,  and
sulfur.   The matte is converted to impure blister copper  by
blowing with air  of an air-oxygen mixture in a vessel  called
a converter to  remove the  sulfur and the  iron.   Removal  of
the  impurities   from blister copper is sometimes limited  to
fire refining,  in which the  impurities  are  removed  in  a
furnace  by  volatilization  and  oxidation.  More often,   it
entails a  two-step  procedure:  fire  refining  to  produce
electrodes for  further refining by  electrolytic methods.

The   principal   sectors   of  the   primary  copper  industry
(mining, smelting, refining, fabricating and marketing)  are
dominated  in  varying  degrees  by three large, vertically-
integrated companies.  The plant size  distribution  for  15
active  smelter  operations,  based  on  equivalent  roaster
charge, is shown  in the tabulation  below:
                           2-156

-------
        Capacity Range
         (1,000 metric       No.
         tons/year 1          Plants

             0-181             1
           182-363             4
           364-544             4
           545-816             3
           817-907             3
Emission Sources  and  Pollutants.  Emissions  from  coppper
smelters  are  primarily particulates and sulfur oxides from
the roaster, reverberatory,  and  converter  furnaces.   The
density  and  continuity  of'emissions vary with the furnace
type.   Particulates  can  contain  considerable   byproduct
credits,    particularly    noble   metals   and   selenium.
Accordingly, part of the traditional production  process  is
to   recycle  particulates  up  to  the  limit  of  economic
viability, between 90 to 99.5 percent control,  leaving  the
rest to be discharged as uncontrolled emission.

The  three processes that produce significant sulfur dioxide
and particulate  emissions  in  the  production  of  primary
copper are shown in Figure 3-2.2-1.  The roasting process may
be   bypassed   by   modern   smelters   that   have  better
concentration methods to remove free pyrite.   Half  of  the
plants  operating  in  1971  were able to bypass the roaster
process.
                           2-157

-------
           Figure 3-Z2-1.
Primary Copper Production Processes
                               POLLUTANTS
M1NIN
SMELT
RO/

f



G
cr (OR)


^STING

1 1 i



*EVERBERATORY
FURNACE
i
MATTE
t
CONVERTER
*







TSP
™

«.




SULFUR
DIOXIDE




             2-158

-------
Sulfur dioxide is emitted from all.three smelter operations;
however, the concentration of sulfur.dioxide  in  the  gases
varies   considerably   among  the  three.   Sulfur  dioxide
concentrations for fluid-solid roasters, reverberatory,  and
converter furnaces are 6-10 percent, 0.50-2 percent, and 2-5
percent by volume, respectively.

Control  Technology  and  Costs.  In  1971, approximately 95
percent of the particulate emissions were  being  controlled
from  copper  smelters  because of the economic advantage of
recovering precious metals.  Further removal of particulates
is required to allow the sulfur dioxide control  devices  to
operate effectively.

It  is  assumed that most smelters will manufacture sulfuric
acid by the contact process from the sulfur dioxide  in  the
roaster  and'the converter gases.  Two major conditions must
be met; (1) the concentration of sulfur dioxide in  the  gas
stream  should  be at least 4 percent by volume, and (2) the
gas must be practically free of particulate matter to  avoid
poisoning  the  catalyst in the acid plant.  Eleven smelters
already have acid plants.  The one plant   in  Michigan  does
not  require  an acid plant beause of the  low sulfur content
of the ore, and therefore it  is  not  costed  out  in  this
report.

Several  methods have been proposed and have been considered
here for the purpose of removing the sulfur dioxide from the
reverberatory gas stream.  These include:

  •  Absorption  of  sulfur  dioxide   in   dimethylaniline,
     followed by desorption and recovery.
  ••  cominco absorption process in which sulfur  dioxide  is
     absorbed  into  an  ammonium  sulfite  solution,  which
     yields concentrated  sulfur  dioxide  and  an  ammonium
     sulfate by-product.
  •  Wet lime scrubbing, whereby the  reverberatory  furnace
     gases are scrubbed in a slurry of lime and water.
  •  wet limestone scrubbing,  essentially  similar  to  wet
     lime  scrubbing except a slurry of limestone, is used as
     the scrubbing medium.

Annualized control costs and industry  operating  statistics
are detailed in Table 3-22-1.
                           2-159

-------
 I
t->
o
                                      Table 3-22-1.
                           Primary Copper Industry Data Summary
               ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                                      1975
                                                                  198O
                 Capacity  (Million MT/Yr)            9.06         1O.SS
                 Annual Growth Rate Over the Period  1976-85 = 2.62%
                                 1985

                                 1O. 26
               PROCESS CHARACTERISTICS
Model Plant Sizes
(MT/Yr)
Pollutants Controlled   Control Technology
Roaster
Reverberatoy Furnace or
Converter
EMISSIONS (1.0OO MT/Yr)
1971 Controls:
Sulfur Dioxide.
Part icul ates
Legislated Controls:
Sulfur Dioxide
Part Iculates
CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975
Investment
Total Annual
Capital
O&M
7O4 , OOO
40O,OOO;501
, 4OO
1975

2.O32
56

1 , 1O5
26
$)
267
21O
135
75

.58
.73

.54
.41

.78
.75
.44
,31

502 &
S02 &
S02 &
198O

2,966
82

475
3

25
319
195
123

.87
.81

.71
.79

. 13
. 18
.72
.46
TSP
TSP
TSP
Acid Plant
Limestone Scrubber
Acid Plant
1985

3.O1 1 ,
84.

98
2


318
196
121

.89
06

.42
.72

O
.57
.97
.60
1971-85





1 ,210.89
3 , 4O7 . 3O
2, 1O3. 11
1 ,3O4. 19
1976-85





378.67
2,954.45
1 ,817 .81
1 , 135.63

-------
SECONDARY BRASS AND BRONZE INDUSTRY

Production  Characteristics  and  Capacities.   The secondary
brass and bronze industry may be divided into  two  segments:
ingot  manufacturers  and brass mills.   Both segments of the
industry charge scrap into a furnace where it  is melted  and
alloyed   to   meet   design   specifications   for  chemical
composition.  Ingot manufacturers use  either   a  stationary
reverberatory  furnace or a rotary furnace for most of their
production.   Small  quantities  of   special    alloys   are
processed in crucible or electric induction furnaces.  A few
cupolas  exist  in  which  highly  oxidized metalt  such as
skimmings and slag, is reduced  by  heating the  charge  in
contact  with coXe.  Ingot manufacturing invariably requires
injection of air to refine the scrap.  Brass mills use scrap
that does not require such extensive refining;  the  channel
induction  furnace  is  the  most  common type used in these
mills.

The number of ingot manufacturing furnaces in   existence  in
1972  was  calculated  to be 122. Of these furnaces, 13 were
large, 29  were  medium,  and  80  were  small.   The  large
furnaces  produced  50  percent  of the total  annual ingots,
while the medium furnaces produced 30 percent, and tlie small
furnaces produced 20 percent.
The capacity of channel induction furnaces for  brass  mills
ranges  from  0.5  to  5  metric tons,  with smaller furnaces
being the most common.  It was estimated that there were  35
plants  in existence in 1973 with an average of 3.7 furnaces
per plant, or a total of 130 furnaces.

Emission  sources  and   Pollutants.   Metallurgical   fumes
containing  chiefly  zinc oxide and lead oxide are the major
emissions from the reverberatory and  rotary  furnaces  that
are  used  by  ingot  manufacturers  and  from the induction
furnaces that are used by the brass mills.  Fly ash, carbon,
and mechanically-produced dust  are  often  present  in  the
exhaust  gases,  particularly  from the furnaces used by the
ingot manufacturers.  Zinc oxide and lead oxide condense  to
form a very fine fume which is difficult to collect.

Control   Technology  and  Costs.  Ingot  manufacturers  use
fabric-filter  baghouses,  high-energy  wet  scrubbers,  and
electrostatic precipitators because of their high efficiency
in  collecting  the  fine zinc oxide fumes; 67 percent use a
baghouse, 28 percent use a scrubber, and 5  percent  use  an
electrostatic precipitator.
                           2-161

-------
The  collected  dust was assumed  to  have  a  value  of  10 cents
per kilogram, and  an average  collector  efficiency   of  97.5
percent.   This  value  of  collected dusts was applied as  a
credit to control  costs.
Fabric filter baghouses are  used  on  the  brass   induction
furnaces to collect the particulates.  Investment and annual
costs were obtained from three plants that use  furnaces with
capacities  ranging  from 22 to 32 metric tons  per  day.  The
average value for the three plants was used  for  the  model
furnace  of 25 metric tons per day.  NO credit  for  collected
dust is assumed for brass mills.

Annualized control costs and industry  operating  statistics
are detailed in Table 3-23-1.
                          2-162

-------
                                       Table  3-23-1 .
                      Secondary Brass and Bronze  Industry Data  Summary

                ACTIVITY LEVEL           '     .      1975         1980         1985

                  Capacity, (Mi 1 1 ion MT/Yr)         O.959        1.152        1.196
                  Annual Growth Rate Over the Period  1976-85  =  3.68%
N>
,L                                             Model Plant Sizes
                PROCESS CHARACTERISTICS       (MT/Yr)                 Pollutants Controlled   Control  Technology
0*3
                  Model  1                       716                  Particualtes             Fabric  Filter
                  Model  2                     2,966                  Particulates             Fabric  Filter
                  Model  3                     6,105                  Particulates             Fabric  Filter
                  Model  4                     11.O20                  Particulates             Fabric  Filter

                EMISSIONS (1.0OO MT/Yr)            1975         1980         1985         1971-85         1976-85

                  1971 Controls:

                     Particulates                   5.21        7.94        8.58

                  Legislated Controls:

                     Particulates                   2.57        0.51        0.54

                CONTROL  COSTS (Million  1975 $)

                  Investment                        5.16        O.54        O.O7       21.17            6.29

                  Total  Annual                      4.94        7.28        7.O8       78.03           67.53
                     Capital                        1.96        2.78        2.78       29 . 7O           25.58
                     O&M                           2.99        4.5O        4.30       48.33           41.94

-------
PRIMARY LEAD INDUSTRY

Production  Characteristics  and Capacities. Lead production
in the. united States involves  three  major  steps:  mining,
crushing,  and grinding of sulfide ores,-and benefication to
produce lead concentrates; smelting of the  concentrates  by
pyrometallurgical  methods  to  produce  impure lead bullion,-
and refining the bullion to separate other metal values  and
impurities.

The  U.S.  primary  lead  industry  has  some 80 small mining
companies  in  14  states  who  mine  and  mill  their   own
concentrates;  some  of  the  smaller  mines  utilize custom
mills.  Smelting and refining of lead in the  United  States
is done by four companies (Asarco, St. Joe, Amax, and Bunker
Hill)  that  operate  six smelters and five refineries.  St.
Joe is the only company  not  involved   in  custom  smelting
(outright   purchase   of  concentrates)  or  toll  smelting
(smelting of concentrates for a fee).

Battery components accounted for  46  percent  of  the  1.40
million  metric  tons  of  lead  consumed in 1973.  Gasoline
antiknock additives accounted for  16  percent,  pigments  7
percent,  ammunition  5  percent,  solder  4  percent, cable
covering 3 percent and miscellaneous metal products, such as
castings, weights, and ballast, the remainder.

Emission  Sources  and  Pollutants.  Emissions   from   lead
smelters  are primarily particulates and sulfur dioxide from
two sources: sintering machines and blast furnaces.  Most of
the sulfur dioxide is removed in the sintering machine;  the
density of emissions varies with the source.

Flue-gas  particulates include the following metals: as high
as 30 percent lead, and traces of zinc,  antimony,  cadmium,
and   copper.    in   Western  smelters,  often  significant
byproduct credits of noble metals are also emitted;  in  one
case,  over  30  ounces  of silver per ton and 0.14 ounce of
gold was recovered.  Thus, there is an  economic  reason  to
recover  particulates  in  addition  to  fume  control.  The
emissions  from  the  slag  furnaces  used  in  the  Western
smelters   to   recover   zinc   also  include  particulates
containing zinc oxide and zinc dust.

Control Technology and Costs. Sulfur oxides and particulates
in sintering machine off-gases are being controlled  by  the
use  of  sulfuric  acid  plants  in  three  of  the six U.S.
smelters.   in  these  smelters,  particulate   control   is
required  for  effective operation of the acid-plant system.
in the three U.S. smelters without acid plants, most of  the
particulates  in  the  processing off-gases are removed from
                           Z-164

-------
the cooled off-gases in  a  baghouse  prior  to  the   stack;
sulfur  oxide  in  the  off-gases is not controlled.   One of
these smelters has an acid plant which is used  only  on  the
off-gases from a copper converter in an adjoining plant.

Each  of  the  six  U.S.  plants  was  examined  in terms of
equipment required to bring the plant within Federal ambient
standards.  Acid plants were assumed for those  plants  which
do  not  now  control  sulfur  oxide  emissions.   Methods of
metallurgical operation at all six plants are  similar,  the
differences  stem  from the type of ore handled by the three
Missouri smelters and by the three Western smelters.   In the
West, lead ore concentrates  are  leaner  with   much   higher
amounts  of  gold,  silver, zinc, cadmium, copper, antimony,
and  arsenic  present.   Except  for  a  slagfuming  furnace
operation  in  the  Western  smelters  to  remove the  higher
amounts of zinc in the  concentrates,  there are  no  major
differences  in  the  basic  smelter operations.   There is  a
difference in degree in the refining  operations,  but off-
gases  are  not  a  problem  in  the  refineries.   Refining
involves kettle operations at low  temperatures  just  above
the melting point of lead; no fumes are produced.

To  determine  control  costs,  the following sequences were
assumed.  The feed has a sulfur content of  15   percent,  of
which  85 percent is removed as sulfur dioxide  in the  sinter
step.  Particulate emissions are 54.5 kg/ton of feed In  the
sinterer, and 13.6 Kg/ton of feed in the blast  furnace.

Sulfur  dioxide  from  the  sinter  step  is available  for
conversion into acid.  The acid plant is assumed to  convert
90  percent  of the sulfur dioxide it receives, emitting the
rest.  With an acid plant on the sinter, the additional  gas
cleaning  scrubber  is  assumed  to  remove  90  percent  of
particulates.   The  results  of  these   calculations  are
presented  in  Table 3-24-1  along with anticipated emission
levels.
                           2-165

-------
!-•

-------
SECONDARY LEAD INDUSTRY

Production Characteristics  and  Capacities.  The  secondary
lead  industry is defined as the industry that recovers lead
or lead alloys by smelting and/or refining lead scrap;  this
does  not  include  the  activities of scrap dealers who may
sweat lead.  A total of 22 companies in the  secondary  lead
industry  operate  45 plants.  The two leading producers are
estimated  to  account  for  about  64   percent   of   lead
production.
Approximately
526,000
metric  tor>s  of secondary lead were
recovered from scrap in 1970.  In 1971, production  rose  to
528,000  metric  tons.  By 1973, the production of secondary
lead rose to approximately 577,000 metric tons.

The assumption of an average emission factor for cupolas and
reverberatory furnaces allows the breakdown of the secondary
lead industry on the basis  of  capacity  alone.   Available
capacity   data  indicate  three  model  plant  sizes.   The
estimated industry capacity and model plant data  are  given
in the following tabulation:
Plant Model I
Plant Model II
Plant Model ill
     Capacity
     Range
     {metric
     tons/day)

     83-181
     27-82
     12-26
                                      Total
                                      Capacity
                               No.    (metric
                               Plants tons/day
        23
         6
        16
2,482
  327
  253
Model Plant
Capacity
(metric
tons/day

109
 54
 15.8
Totals
     12-181
        45
3,062
Emission  Sources  and  Pollutants. Emission of particulates
occurs  from  lead-processing  furnaces.  Generally,  about   67
percent or more of the output of the secondary lead  industry
is  processed  in blast furnaces or cupolas that are  used  to
reduce  lead  oxide in  the  form of battery plates or dross,  to
lead.   If oxide reduction is not needed, then lead scrap can
be processed  in  reverberatory  furnaces.   Kettle   or  pot
furnaces  may  be used to  produce small batches of alloys for
holding or refining lead.  These   lead  processing   furnaces
represent  obvious particulate emission sources; the  primary
emissions being lead  oxide.   Another  particulate   emission
source  is the slag tap and  feeding ports on the cupolas and
reverberatory  furnaces.   Although  lead  is   occasionally
                            2-167

-------
sweated in a reverberator/ furnace, reclamation of  secondary
lead by this means is a very small portion of the total  lead
production.  Emissions from slag operations are not known.

The  industry  estimate  of  90  percent net control  in  1970
indicates that nearly all plants had  emission  controls  of
some  sort.   A  control increase to 98 percent estimated by
1980 is based on implementation of the proposed  new  source
performance standards.

Control  Technology  and  Costs.  Either a baghouse or a wet
scrubber can be utilized to achieve emission  control.   The
baghouse  is  chosen  for  this  cost analysis because it is
generally cheaper- it is assumed baghouse life  averages  15
years.

Annual   costs   include   capital  charges,  operating  and
maintenance,  and  credits  for  byproduct  recovery  value.
Since  the  lead oxide collected in the control equipment is
recycled into the  smelting  furnace,  it  has  value  as  a
byproduct; therefore, the recovery of this lead oxide lowers
estimated operating and maintenance costs.

The  calculated  costs  for  Model  I,  II,  and  III plants
presented in this model plant cost  tabulation  included  in
Table 3-25-1 were based on the following key points:

  •  Model I plants are  assumed  to  require  two  separate
     baghouse  installations,  while  Model II and Model III
     were assumed to need only one baghouse for control.

  *  Baghouse airflow needs were  estimated  at  11.2  cubic
     sneters per ton of daily capacity.

  •  The  value  of  lead  oxide  recovered  from   baghouse
     operations  was  estimated  to be 5 cents per kilogram,
     plus 50 percent.  It was further assumed that only  the
     lead  oxide  recovered  by  going  from  90 percent net
     control in 1970 to an estimated 98 percent net  control
     in 1980 should be credited against control costs.  This
     amounts  to  6.17  kilograms per ton of lead processed.
     In addition,  production at full capacity was assumed.
                           2-168

-------
O\
                                          Table  3-25-1.
                                Secondary  Lead  Industry Data  Summary
                   ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                                          1975
                                                                      198O
                     Capacity  (MT/Day)                   3.2O6.2     3,598.6
                     Annual Growth Rate Over  the Period  1976-85 = 3.44%
                                 1985

                                 3.929.O
                   PROCESS CHARACTERISTICS

                     Secondary Lead

                   EMISSIONS  (1.OOO MT/Yr)

                     1971 Controls:

                        Particulates

                     Legislated Controls:

                        Particulates

                   CONTROL COSTS  (Million 1975 $)

                     Investment

                     Total Annual
                        Capital
                        O&M
Model Plant Sizes
(MT/Day)
15.8;54;109

         1975



          3.73




          2.35




          0.71

          1 . 1O
          0.26
          0.83
   Pollutants Controlled

   Particulates
              Control Technology

              Fabric Filter
1980
 5.68
 1.14
 O.62

 2.29
 0.88
 1 .40
            1985
             6.23
1.52
O. 19

2.77
1 .21
1 .55
                        1971-85
                                       1976-85
 6.33

23.94
 8.77
15.16
 4.57

21 .62
 8.29
13.33

-------
PRIMARY ZINC INDUSTRY

Production Characteristics and Capacities. Zinc ranks  after
aluminum,  copper,  and lead in tonnage of nonferrous metals
produced in the United States.   Major  uses  in  1973  were
zinc-base   alloys,  particulary  die-cast  alloys  used  in
automotive and electrical equipment  (41 percent), galvanized
steel  used  in  construction  and   electrical  transmission
equipment  (36 percent), brass and bronze used for plumbing,
heating,  and  industrial  equipment  (14   percent),   zinc
chemicals,  particularly  zinc  oxide,  used  in the rubber,
paint, and ceramic industries (4 percent), and  rolled  zinc
used in dry cells and lithographic plates (2 percent).

The  principal  ore  minerals  are   sulfides,  which  may be
predominantly zinc ores or lead-zinc ores.  Also, some  zinc
is  obtained  from  lead-base  and   copper-base  ores.  Zinc
sulfide concentrates produced from these ores are  converted
to  the  oxide state (calcine) by roasting, and then reduced
to metallic zinc by either  electrolytic  deposition  or  by
distillation  in  retorts  or  furnaces.   in  plants  using
distillation methods, the calcine  is  given  an  additional
sintering  step to provide a more compact feed as well as to
remove  impurities.   Some  zinc  producing  companies  also
produce  zinc  oxide.   in pyrolytic plants, both zinc metal
and zinc oxide are produced from zinc vapor;  in  the  first
case,  the  vapor is condensed to zinc metal; in the second,
it is oxidized in a chamber.

Over three-quarters of the domestic  mine  production  comes
from  these  six  statest Tennessee, Colorado, Missouri, New
York, Idaho,  and  New  Jersey.   Numerous  small  companies
participate  in  only the mining and beneficiation sector of
the zinc industry; these companies sell  their  concentrates
to custom smelters.

in  1973, six companies (St. Joe, Asarco, Amax, Bunker Hill,
New jersey zinc, and National Zinc) operated  eight  primary
zinc plants, all of which operate as custom smelters to some
extent.    information   on   the   locations,   acid  plant
installations, annual  capacities,  and  types  of  roasting
processes  used  is  also  included.   The  three  remaining
horizontal-retort plants totaling  161,000  metric  tons  of
capacity  are  in  various  stages  of  being  phased out of
operation.   New  electrolytic  capacity  totaling   354,000
metric  tons  of  zinc  will replace these horizontal retort
plants; plant  size  distribution  of  the  three  new  U.S.
electrolytic plants is tabulated below.
                           2-170

-------
                                            % of U.S. Capacity
                                            After closing
Capacity Feed        Capacity/  Slab  Zinc     Horizontal
(metric tons/yr)     (metric tons/yr)        Retort plants

    296,000              163,000                  29
    264,000              145,000                  26
     82,000               45,000                   8
The main product of zinc reduction  plants  is  slab zinc.  Ore
concentrate  capacity  in 1973 was  1,337,000  metric tons per
year,  equivalent  to  763,000  metric   tons   slab   zinc.
Approximately   24   percent   of    this   capacity  utilizes
horizontal retort plants; all of which  are   scheduled  for
phasing out in the near future.

In   1973,   the   three   types   of   pyrothermic   plants
(electrothermic, vertical  retort,   and  horizontal  retort)
accounted   for   almost  two-thirds of   the  primary  zinc
capacity.  This will change in the  near  future because three
new  electrolytic  plants  are  in   the  early   stages   of
construction,-  they  are:  the Asarco plant at stephensport,
Kentucky with a planned capacity of 163,000 metric  tons  of
zinc   annually,  the  New  Jersey   zinc   Company  plant  at
Clarksville, Tennessee with a planned   145,000  metric  tons
capacity,  and  the  Hew  National   Zinc plant at Blackwell,
Oklahoma with a planned capacity of 45,000 metric tons.

Emission  Sources  and  Pollutants. Emissions   from   zinc
reduction  plants  are  primarily   particulates  and  sulfur
dioxide from the roasters in the electrolytic  plants,  and
from  the roasters and traveling-grate  sintering machines in
the pyrothermic plants.  In  the electrolytic  plants,  the
calcine  from  the  roaster  is substantially sulfur-free so
that there is a heavy concentration of  sulfur dioxide in the
off-gases.  In the case of the pyrothermic plants,  roaster
off-gases   are   also  heavy,  but there are  only  light
concentrations of sulfur dioxide in the   sintering  machine
off-gases.    Particulates  are relatively   heavy  in  both
streams.

Control Technology and Costs. Sulfur oxide and  particulates
in  roaster off-gases are now being controlled by the use of
sulfuric acid plants in six of the  present eight plants,  in
these cases, particulate control necessary for the effective
operation  of  the  acid  plant  system is   achieved   with
associated  gas cleaning equipment. With  the closing of the
three horizontal retort plants,  all  the  roasters  in  the
                           2-171

-------
primary zinc plants are controlled with  acid plants.   In  the
two  remaining  pyrothermic  plants,   the   sintering machine
participates are controlled  in one case  by  settling   flues,
electrostatic  precipitators,  and a baghouse,  in  the  other,
by a venturi scrubber.

in general, the control scheme for the primary  zinc industry
is to use acid plants on the roaster off-gases  where most of
the sulfur dioxide is given off.  All other operations, with
the exception of three plants  using  a  horizontal  retort,
have  particulate  control  devices.   In   the  case of these
plants  with  horizontal  retorts,  conversion  to  vertical
retort  equipment  is the practical control scheme; however,
costs  for  this  conversion  were  not  obtained,  as  this
involves a major plant renovation.

with  the closing of the three horizontal retort plants, the
only new control equipment required for  the industry is  the
acid  plants and associated gas cleaning equipment necessary
to control sulfur dioxide and particulates in the three  new
electrolytic  plants under construction; these  controls come
under New source Performance Standards.

Annualized control costs are detailed in Table  3-26-2.
                           2-172

-------
to
                                        Table 3-26-2.
                              Primary Zinc Industry Data Summary
                 ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                                    1975
                   Capacity (1.0OO MT/Yr)        1.O24.O
                   Annual Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-85
                  198O

               1,2OO.O
                =  3.46%
                 PROCESS CHARACTERISTICS

                 Roaster and Sinter;
                 Electrolytic

                 EMISSIONS (LOGO MT/Yr)

                   1971 Controls:
Model Plant Sizes
(1,OOO MT/Yr)

42-226
45-163

      1975        1980
      1985

   1 ,283.O



Pollutants Controlled

Particulates (Zinc)
Sulfur Dioxide
Control Technology

Acid Plant
                              1985
                  1971-85
                                                         1976-85
Particulates (Zinc)
Sul fur Oxides
Legislated Controls:
Particulates (Zinc)
Sulfur Oxides
CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)
Investment
Total Annual
Capital
O&M
29
212

12,
98

8.
1 1 .
4 .
6,
.59
.98

.46
. 17

.07
O2
.03
,99
42
302

3.
34.

4,
25.
14.
1 1 .
. 14
.32

,32
.54

,61
70
47
23
46
331

3
3O

1 ,
31.
20.
1 1 .
. 18
.27

,26
.39

,52 64 . 49
,92 269.49
.49 145.36
.43 124. 13




42.80
245.32
137.70
107.62

-------
SECONDARY ZINC INDUSTRY

Production characteristics and Capacities. Zinc ranks  after
aluminum,  copper,  and lead in tonnage of nonferrous metals
produced in the United States.   Major  uses  in  1973  were
zinc-base  alloys,  particularly  die-cast  alloys  used  in
automotive and electrical equipment  (41 percent), galvanized
steel  used  in  construction  and  electrical  transmission
equipment  (36 percent), brass and bronze used for plumbing,
heating,  and  industrial  equipment  (14   percent),   zinc
chemicals,  particularly  zinc  oxide,  used  in the rubber,
paint, and ceramic industries (4 percent), and  rolled  zinc
used in dry cells and lithographic plates (2 percent).

Secondary  zinc  comes from two major sources: the zinc-base
alloys and the copper-base alloys.  Most  of  the  secondary
zinc  that is recovered comes from reconstituted copper-base
alloys,- slab zinc is next, then chemical products, and  zinc
dust.   For purposes of this report, the 14 operating plants
that comprise  the  secondary  zinc  industry  use  sweating
and/or distilling operations to produce zinc slab, dust, and
oxide solely from scrap.  The secondary zinc industry is not
considered to include the activities of:

  •  Primary zinc producers that may manufacture  zinc  from
     scrap and ore

  •  Secondary brass and bronze plants that recover zinc  in
     copper alloys

  •  Chemical manufacturers that produce zinc  compounds  by
     chemical treatment of zinc scrap

  •  Scrap dealers that may sweat zinc.

The total secondary industry zinc  slab  capacity  stood  at
18,100   metric  tons  at  the  end  of  1972.   Redistilled
secondary zinc slab production in  1971  was  73,400  metric
tons,  of that total 11,200 metric tons were produced by the
secondary zinc industry and the remainder  was  produced  by
the primary zinc industry.  Other zinc materials produced by
the  secondary  zinc  companies  included zinc dust and zinc
oxide,  in 1971, slightly over 24,500 metric tons of zinc in
the form of zinc oxide was produced from zinc scrap.  It  is
assumed  that  nearly  all  of this oxide is produced by the
secondary  zinc  companies  and  that  this  production   is
indicative of a secondary capacity of 31,700 metric tons per
year  of  contained  zinc.  Statistics are not available for
total secondary zinc dust and zinc oxide capacity; estimates
were derived from the available data.  To further complicate
                           2-174

-------
capacity  estimation,   some   production   set-ups   permit
production of either oxide or slab.

The  production  of  zinc  dust from zinc-base scrap in 1970
totaled 26,300 metric tons.  It is assumed that much of this
production  came  from  the  secondary  industry  and   that
secondary capacity is 31,700 metric tons per year.

No  data  is  available  for sweating capacity; which can be
performed in various types of furnaces,  it is assumed  that
much   of  the  feed  material  for  production  of  refined
secondary zinc is sweated; sweating  capacity  is  therefore
placed at 63,500 metric tons per year.

Emission  Sources  and  Pollutants.  There are at least four
operations which generate emissions in  the  secondary  zinc
industry:   materials   handling,  mechanical  pretreatment,
sweating, and  distilling.   This  analysis  considers  only
control costs for emissions from the sweating and distilling
operations,   as   insufficient   data   is   available  for
calculating the possible costs of controlling emissions from
the other sources.

in the sweating operation, various types of zinc  containing
scrap   are   treated  in  either  kettle  or  reverberatory
furnaces.  The emissions vary with the  feed  material  used
and  the  feed  material  varies  from time-to-time and from
plant-to-plant.  Emissions may vary from almost 0 to  15  Kg
of  particulates  per  metric  ton  of  zinc reclaimed.  For
purposes of this report, it  is  assumed  that  the  maximum
emission rate applies.

In  the  case  of  the  various  types  of  zinc  distilling
furnaces, the accepted emission rate  is  23  Kilograms  per
metric  ton  of  zinc  processed.   Some  distillation units
produce zinc oxide,  and  normally  utilize  a  baghouse  for
collection  of  the  product.  This report assumes that these
baghouses are sufficient to meet national ambient standards.
However, for the purpose of calculating  control  costs,  it
was assumed that essentially all of the estimated zinc oxide
capacity  could be switched to slab zinc or dust production,
and emission controls would be required.

Controlled and uncontrolled emissions  from  secondary  zinc
sweating  operations cannot be estimated with an acceptable
degree of probable accuracy because reliable  data  are  not
available.

The  estimated  emissions   from  secondary zinc distillation
based on  available  production  estimates  and  an  average
emission factor of 23 kg per metric ton are tabulated below.
                           2-175

-------
it  is  estimated  that  57  percent  of   the emissions were
controlled in 1971 and that 90 percent will be controlled  in
1980.

Control Technology and Costs. The major emission of  concern
is participates, consisting mainly of zinc oxide.  Baghouses
have   been  shown  to  be  effective  in  controlling  both
distillation and sweating-furnace emissions except when  the
charge contains organic materials such as oils.

A  complete  accounting  of secondary zinc plants by type of
furnaces used and the product or products  produced  is  not
available.   Based on the limited information, it is assumed
that the industry's 14 plants  can  be  represented  by  two
models:  two Model I plants, each consisting of 7,260 metric
tons per year sweating capacity and 10,900 metric  tons  per
year  distilling  capacity; and twelve Model II plants, each
consisting  of  4,080  metric  tons  per  year  of  sweating
capacity  and  4,990  metric  tons  per  year  of distilling
capacity.

Estimated annualized control costs for  the  secondary  zinc
industry are detailed in Table 3-27-1.
                          2-176

-------
                                       Table 3-27-1.
                            Secondary Zinc Industry Data Summary

                ACTIVITY LEVEL                         1975         1980         1985

                  Capacity (1,OOO MT/Yr)              85.83      1OO.63       107.56
                  Annual Growth Rate Over the Period  1976-85 = 3.46%
N>
i                                             Model Plant Sizes
!~J               PROCESS CHARACTERISTICS      (MT/Yr)                 Pollutants Controlled   Control Technology
~-j
                Sweating and Distilling      12.8OO;  5.50O           Particulates            Baghouse


                EMISSIONS (MT/Yr)                      1975         1980         1985        1971-85        1976-85

                  1971 Controls:

                     Partlculates                     332.O       471.0       516.0

                  Legislated Controls:

                     PartlculateS                     261.5       325.4       1O2.6

                CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

                  Investment                           0.28        0.14        0.03        2.52           1.32

                  Total Annual                         0.56        0.98.        1.06       1O.45           9.19
                     Capital                           0.16        0.31        0.33        3.15           2.78
                     O&M                               O.40        O.67        0.73        7.30           6.41

-------
ASBESTOS INDUSTRY

Production   characteristics  and  Capabilities. The asbestos
industry consists of the  following major activities:  mining
of  ore,  milling  of  ore,  and the manufacture of asbestos
products, all of which are used in thousands of products and
applications,  over 40 percent of annual consumption,  which
was   estimated  to be nearly 750,000 metric tons in 1972, is
used  for construction materials, primarily cement  products;
other  important  users   include floor tiles, paper, asphalt
felts,  friction products, and packing and gaskets.  Domestic
consumption  has been growing at an annual rate  of  about  5
percent.

Asbestos  is normally  handled  by  air  conveyance  during
processing.   The  air  conveying  system  must  be  tightly
controlled because of the adverse health effects of airborne
fibers, which are Kept airborne for significant distances as
a  result  of  their  fine  structure  and low density.  The
finishing  processes  that  involve  breaking,  grinding  or
polishing,   which  are required in making asbestos products,
account for  most of the air emissions.

A  total of nine milling   plants  were  in  operation  during
1970.  Over 98  percent of milling capacity (about 149,000
metric  tons) was  represented  by  five  large,  vertically-
integrated   firms,  imports represented nearly 85 percent of
the asbestos used in various manufacturing processes  during
1973.

Manufacturing   plants    can   be  grouped  into  facilities
producing the following types of general product categories:
construction materials,  floor  tiles,  felts  and  papers,
friction products, textiles, and miscellaneous.
Emission  Sources  and  Pollutants. Principal emission sources
of  asbestos are  from the  air  conveying systems used  in  the
processing  and  finishing stages required in making asbestos
products.    Asbestos  emissions  can  be  divided  into  two
categories:  either asbestos remains essentially a free fiber
throughout  the  process   and in  the  final product or the
asbestos is wetted or  bound into a matrix at an early  stage
of  processing.

Production  of   asbestos  textiles is the major manufacturing
process in the  first category,  in this  process,  the  long
asbestos   fibers   are  fluffed  and  then  blended  with  a
cellulosic fiber.   The subsequent processing, which involves
carding, lapping,  roving, spinning, and weaving or braiding,
is  performed on  equipment similar to  the  standard  textile
                            2-178

-------
machining   processes   requiring   frequent   access   when
operating.

virtually all other processes fall  in the   second  category.
Significant  emissions may occur in finishing operations  for
cement pipe and building products,   felts   and  papers,   and
friction   products.   Asbestos  emissions  from   floor-tile
manufacture are essentially nil after the  fibers   are  mixed
with  the  hot  vinyl or asphalt.  In friction products,  the
processes of molding and curing are usually pollution  free,
while  the  finishing  processes involving shaping,  cutting,
and sawing may give rise  to  some  emissions.    In  sprayed
insulation,  asbestos  emissions occur from handling the  dry
asbestos and cement mixture, the escape of non-wetted  fiber,
overspray and splash, and the disposal of  wastes.
 control  Technology and Costs. The  only  acceptable  control
 technique   for  asbestos  milling  and  manufacturing is the
 fabric  filter, or baghouse.  Efficiencies of  95  percent  or
 higher   are  relatively  easily  obtained.  This process was
 assumed  to  be applied at  all  plants.   Annualized  control
 costs and industry statistics are detailed in Table 3-28-1.
                            2-179

-------
                                           Table 3-28-1.
                                   Asbestos  Industry Data Summary
to
h-«
00
o
                    ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                                     1975
                                                                 1980
Capacity (1,OOOMT/Yr)       924.28    1,227.84
Annual Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-85 = 3.75%
                    PROCESS CHARACTERISTICS

                      Textile
                      Mlscellaneous
                      Felt Friction
                      Tiles
                      Construction
                      M1111ng
                           Model Plant Sizes
                           (MT/Yr)

                              608
                              189
                            2,721
                            6.893
                            3.592
                           29,024
                    EMISSIONS (LOOO MT/Yr)

                      1971 Controls:

                         Partlculates

                      Legislated Controls:

                         Partlculates

                    CONTROL COSTS (Mil 1 ion 1975 $)

                      Investment

                      Total Annual
                         Capital
                         O&M
                              1975
                              53.09
                              25.04
                               4.6O

                               2.99
                               2.38
                               O.61
                                          1980
                                          71 .41
                                           2.95
1 ..50

8. 18
3.85
4.33
           1985

        1.274.57



        Pollutants Controlled   Control Technology
        Partlculates
        Partlculates
        Partlculates
        Partlculates
        Partlculates
        Partlculates

           1985
                                                      79.42
            1.59
0. 1

8.91
4.03
4.88
                                                                  1971-85
24.76

74.89
41.37
33.52
                    Baghouse
                    Baghouse
                    Baghouse
                    Baghouse
                    Baghouse
                    Baghouse
                                                                                 1976-85
1O. 17

67.84
35.95
31 .89

-------
ASPHALT CONCRETE PROCESSING INDUSTRY

Production  Characteristics and Capacities. Asphalt concrete
includes a mixture  of  aggregates  and  an  asphalt  cement
binder.     Aggregates    usually   consist   of   different
combinations of  crushed  stone,  crushed  slag,  sand,  and
gravel.    Asphalt   concrete   plant  processing  equipment
includes raw-material apportioning  equipment,  raw-material
conveyors,  a  rotary dryer, hot-aggregate elevators, mixing
equipment,  asphalt-binder  storage,  heating  and  transfer
equipment,   and   mineral-filler   storage   and   transfer
equipment.

There   are    approximately    1,320   companies    employing
approximately  300,000   to  operate   4,800   asphalt concrete
plants in  the  United  States.    Plant  size   distribution   is
listed below;  60 percent  of  the  capacity  is  located  in
plants having  an average size  of  182  metric  tons   per  hour.
Based   on   a   1972 survey  conducted  by the  National  Asphalt
Pavement   Association  (NAPA)   covering  1,081   plants,   76
percent were  stationary plants and 24 percent were portable.
 Continuous  mixers  comprised   24  percent  of   the portable
 plants, compared with only 2 percent  for stationary plants.
                             2-181

-------
  Size Range       Average Size       No.
  (metric tons/hr) (metric tonsAr)   Plants      Capacity(%)

      82-100            91              694           6.6
     101-263           182            3,122          59.5
     264-282           273              520          14.9
     283-499           391              464          19.0

Totals                                4.800         100.0
Asphalt concrete  production  is  essentially  a  batch-type
operation;  continuous-mix represents only 10 percent of the
industry.

Emission Sources and Pollutants. The  predominant  emissions
are  dust  particulates  from  the aggregates used in making
asphalt  concrete.   The  largest  sources  of   particulate
emissions  are the rotary dryer and screening, weighing, and
mixing  equipment.    Additional   sources   that   may   be
significant  particulate  emitters, if they are not properly
controlled, are the mineral-filler  loading,  transfer,  and
storage  equipment,  and  the loading, transfer, and storage
equipment that handles the dust collected  by  the  emission
control  system.  Generally, the uncontrolled emissions from
asphalt batching plants amount to 23 kg of dust  per  metric
ton of product.

Control  Technology  and  Costs.  Practically all plants use
primary dust  collection  equipment,  such  as  cyclones  or
settling   chambers.   These  chambers  are  often  used  as
classifiers with the collected aggregate being  returned  to
the   hot-aggregate  elevator  to  combine  with  the  dryer
aggregate load.

The gases from the primary collector must be further cleaned
before venting to the atmosphere.  The most common secondary
collector is expected to be the baghouse,  although  venturi
scrubbers  are used in some plants.  The baghouse allows dry
collection of dust which can be returned to the  process  or
dropped  in  a  landfill.   The  venturi scrubber makes dust
hauling expensive due to the wetting of the dust.  Also, the
use of large settling ponds and the possible need for  water
treatment discourage the use of venturi scrubbers.

Annualized   control   costs  and  industry  capacities  are
detailed in Table 3-29-1.
                           2-182

-------
M
00
                                        Table 3-29-1.
                      Asphalt  Concrete Processing Industry Data Summary
                 ACTIVITY  LEVEL
                                                       1975
                                                                   198O
                   Capacity  (MT/Hr)                  1.118.71     1.O72.71
                   Annual  Growth  Rate Over  the Period 1976-85 = 2.2O%
                                 1985

                              1,115.88
                 PROCESS  CHARACTERISTICS

                  Type  1
                  Type 2
Model Plant Sizes
(MT/Hr)
                 EMISSIONS  (LOOO  MT/Yr)

                   1971 Controls:

                      Partieulates

                   Legislated Controls:

                      Part iculates

                 CONTROL COSTS  (Million  1975 $)

                   Investment

                   Total Annual
                      Capital
                      O&M
1OO,20O.30O,4OO


         1975
      3, 186.32
      1,371.11
        199.81

        2O1.06
         81.81
        119.24
      Pollutants Controlled

      PartIculates
                     198O
3.71O.72
                    113.54
   24.42

  289.O5
  103.89
  185.16
                                 1985
3.836. 16
                                 46.86
    2.21

  3CO.62
  1O8.O3
  192.59
                  Control Technology

                  VentuM Scrubbers
                  Baghouse
                                                                                           1971-85
                                          1976-85
  664.19

3,211.O9
1.181.97
2,029.12
  161.49

2,782.9O
1,O11.30
1.771.61

-------
CEMENT INDUSTRY

Production Characteristics and Capacities. Portland  cementt
which  accounts  for  approximately  96  percent  of  cement
production in the United States, is processed from  a  blend
of various calcareous, argillaceous, and siliceous materials
including  limestone, shell, chalk, clay, and shale.  As the
binder in concrete, portland cement is the most  widely-used
construction  material in the United States.  The four major
steps  in  producing  portland  cement  are:  quarrying  and
crushing;   blending,  grinding,  and  drying;  heating  the
materials in a  rotary  kiln  to  liberate  carbon  dioxide,
causing incipient fusion; and fine-grinding of the resultant
clinker,  with  the  addition  of  4  to  6  percent gypsum.
Finished cement is shipped either in bulk or in  bags.   All
portland  cement is produced by either a wet or dry grinding
process, the distinguishing characteristic being whether the
raw materials are introduced into the kiln as a  wet  slurry
or as a dry mixture.

in  1971,  170 plants producing portland cement clinker plus
five plants operating grinding  mills  to  produce  finished
cement  were controlled by 51 companies located in 41 states
and Puerto Rico.  Fifty  percent  of  this  cement  industry
capacity  is  owned  by  multiplant companies, and the eight
leading companies account for about 47 percent of the total.
Overcapacity has resulted in low profit margins,  inhibiting
modernization and construction of new plants during the past
several  years, and more stringent air-pollution regulations
have increased both capital  and  operating  costs.   Recent
trends  are toward increased operations through installation
of larger kilns to replace older marginal kilns,  permitting
more  economic  and  efficient  pollution  control.   Cement
manufacturing plant capacity and size distribution are show,n
below.
                           2-184

-------
                                    Total Annual*
Size Range                          Capacity
(metric          NO.      NO.       (million       Total
tons/day)        Plants   Kilns     metric tons)   Capacity*'

Less than 513       6      10            08          10
 514-1025          49      98           12*. 3         15 ".8
1026-1538          65     170           27.0         34 6
1539-2051          28      95           16.5         21.1
2052-2564          11      37            8.7         11.2
2565 and up        11      56           12.6         16.'s

Totals            170     466           77.9        100.0

» Based on 334-day operation.
Size distribution is expected to shift upwards as  new plants
are constructed and existing plants modified or closed,   so
the  total  number of plants is expected to remain about  the
same.  It is also assumed that there will be no major  shift
in  production  capacity  percentages  between  dry  and  wet
grinding processes, with the latter presently   estimated   at
59 percent.  Production is typically 75 percent of capacity.

Emission  Sources  and  Pollutants. Primary emission  sources
are the dry-process blending and grinding,  kiln  operation,
clinker  cooler, and finish grinding,  other sources  include
the feed and materials-handling systems.   The  primary  air
pollutant  is  dust  particulates.   Estimated dust-emission
factor for an uncontrolled dry-process kiln is  180  kg  per
metric  ton  of  cement, compared with 130 kg  per  metric  ton
for the wet-process plant, giving an average emission factor
of 151 kg per metric  ton  of  product.   The   corresponding
emission  factors  for  the  blending,  grinding,  and drying
processes are 48 and 16 kg per metric ton, respectively,  for
an average of 29 kg per metric ton.

Control Technology and Costs. Emissions from   the   blending,
grinding, and drying processes are generally controlled with
fabric   filters.    where   ambient  ^gas  temperatures  are
encountered  during  grinding,  conveying,   and   packaging
processes,  fabric filters are used almost exclusively.  The
greatest problems are encountered with high-temperature  gas
streams which contain appreciable moisture.

Both fabric filters and electrostatic precipitators are used
in   controlling   dust   emissions  from  tlie  kilns.   The
condensation problems from the high-moisture content  in  the
                           2-185

-------
wet-process plant may be overcome by insulating the ductwork
and  preheating  the  systems  on  start-up.   current state
regulations  may  be  met  with  either  fabric  filters  or
electrostatic precipitators; however, new source performance
standards  will require the filters.  At least one plant has
a wet scrubber, but its costs were estimated on the basis of
an electrostatic precipitator with  little  error  in  total
estimated costs.

The  total  cost  of  control for portland cement plants was
found by  estimating  the  costs  for  control  devices  for
grinding,  mixing and drying (drying not included in the wet
processes)  and  kilns,  which  are  the  major  sources  of
pollutant.   Kilns may have either baghouses for dry-process
kilns or electrostatic precipitators for wet-process  kilns;
baghouses  were  assumed to have been used in both cases for
the combined grinding, mixing, and drying processes.   Other
sources, including clinker coolers, packaging, and crushing,
are  not  costed due to prevailing industry control prior to
the 1970 Clean Air Act and/or minimal costs.

The capital cost of baghouses is assumed to be  proportional
to  the  0.91  power  of capacity, while the capital cost of
electrostatic precipitators  is  proportional  to  the  0.67
power  of  capacity;  in  each  case,  the operating cost is
linearly  proportional  to  the  capacity.   The   cost   of
baghouses  for  the  grinding, mixing, 'and drying operations
was scaled in the same manner.  However, the  required  size
was  scaled  by 0.78 (dry) and 0.26 (wet) to account for the
smaller airflow rates of these processes, and the absence of
control required for the wet-process raw  material  grinding
mills.

Annualized control costs are detailed in Table 3-30-1.
                           2-186

-------
00
                   ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                          Table 3-3O-1.
                                   Cement Industry Data Summary

                                                         1975
                                                                      198O
                     Capacity (1,000 MT/Yr)           154,992      186.O8O
                     Annual Growth Rate Over Period 1976-85 = 3.08%
                                                               1985

                                                            199,377
PROCESS CHARACTERISTICS

  Dry Process Kilns

  Wet Process Kilns

  Dry Gravel Mix

  Wet Gravel Mix


EMISSIONS (1.OOO MT/Yr)

  1971 Controls:

     Particulates

  Legislated Controls:

     Part iculates

CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

  Investment

  Total Annual
     Capital
     OSM
                                                Model Plant Sizes
                                                (MT/Day)
      Pollutants Controlled   Control Technology
                                                1 16.7;254,6;437.5;      Particulates
                                                   612.5:77O.O;933.3
                                                13O;254.5;433,3:606.7;   Part icu1ates
                                                   817.1;924.4
                                                116.7;254.6;437.5;      Particulates
                                                   612.5;77O.O;933.3
                                                13O;254.5;433.3;606.7;   Particulates
                                                   817.1;924.4
                                                         1975
                                                      5.235.45
                                                      2.139.7O
                                                        289.47

                                                        152.98
                                                         80.36
                                                         72.62
                                                                     1980
                                                                                 1985
7,012.04    7,897.26
                                                                     19.88
   25.08

  244.62
  119.49
  125.14
                                                                                 22.42
 13.73

258.26
123.86
134.40
                              Fabric Filter

                              ESP

                              Fabric Filter

                              Fabric Fi1ter
                                                                                             1971-85
                                                                                                            1976-85
  990.18

2,651 .60
1,287.97
1 ,363.63
  328.94

2,335.92
1.13O.48
1,205.45

-------
LIME INDUSTRY

Production   characteristics    and   Capacities.   There   are
currently 186  lime  producing  plants  in   the  United   States.
These  plants   can   be   divided into four  size  ranges, based
upon output  capacity of  metric  tons  per  year; the  number   of
plants in each size range  and their  estimated capacities  are
shown in Table 3-31-1,-

The  U.S.  lime  industry  can be conventionally divided  into
two product  sectors.  Approximately  35 percent  of  the output
•is consumed  by the  producers, while  the  remaining  65  percent
is sold in the open market.   Plants  are  located in 41 states
and Puerto Rico,  with over 22 percent of  U.S.   capacity   in
Ohio and the other  major capacities  located  in  Pennsylvania,
Texas,  and  Michigan;   plant  size  distribution is shown in
Table 3-31-1.   Recent trends  are toward  closing  of  small,
old plants and replacing old  kilns with  larger  units.
                        Table 3-31-1.
             Lime  Industry  Capacity  Distributions
 Size  Range
 (1,000  metric No.       Estimated  1972  Capacity,    Total
 tons/year)     Plants   (million metric tons/year)  Capacity(%>

      0-22.7      68                 0.6               3.2
   22.7-90.9      61                 3.0              16.2
   90.9-364       52                10.5              56.8
 More  than 364    5                 4.4              23.8
                186                18.5             100.0
 In   1972,   producers at  186 plants  sold  or  used  18.5  million
 metric tons.   Should the use of  lime  in   processes   for   the
 removal  of  sulfur   oxides  from  combustion gases   become
 standard practice, the demand for  lime   will be  increased
 substantially.     The   number  of  plants,   meanwhile,   has
 declined  from   195   in   1970  to  186  in   1972.     Further
 consolidation  may  be  expected to economically justify the
 increased  cost  of emissions controls.

 Lime is  formed  by expelling carbon  dioxide  from  limestone or
 dolomitic  limestone  by -high tempertures.   This   calcination
 process  forms   quicklime.    Hydrated   lime  is   made by the
 addition of water to  the  quicklime.    The  calcination  of
 dolomite   results  in  dead-burned,  (refractory)   dolomite.
                            2-188

-------
Major uses of lime are  for  basic  oxygen  steel  furnaces,
alkalies,  water purification, other chemical processes, and
refractory dolomite.

About 73 percent of lime is produced in two basic  types  of
rotary  kilns:  the  long  rotary kiln, and the short rotary
kiln with external preheater.  Vertical kilns  are  used  to
supply  27  percent of lime.  Almost all new lime production
is accomplished using the rotary process.

Emission Sources and Pollutants. Atmospheric emissions  from
lime  manufacture  are  primarily particulates released when
crushing the limestone to kiln size, calcining the limestone
in a rotary or vertical kiln, and crushing the lime to size;
also, fly ash is released if coal is  used  in  calcination.
Other  emissions, such as sulfur oxides, may be generated by
fuel combustion.

Uncontrolled emissions from rotary kilns are  about  100  kg
per  metric  ton  of  lime processed, compared with 4 kg per
metric ton from vertical kilns.   However,  economics  favor
use  of  the rotary kiln, and virtually all new and expanded
production is expected to be accomplished by this method.

Control Technology and Costs. Gases leaving  a  rotary  kiln
are usually passed through a dust-settling chamber where the
coarser  material  settles  out.   In  many installations, a
first-stage, primary dry cyclone  collector  is  used.   The
removal  efficiency  at  this  stage  can vary from 25 to 85
percent by weight of the  dust  being  discharged  from  the
kiln.

The  selection of a second stage to meet the high efficiency
level of 0.03 grains per actual cubic foot may be  either  a
high-energy  wet  scrubber,  fabric filter, or electrostatic
precipitator.  The higher capital cost of the  electrostatic
precipitator   may   be   more   than   offset  in  specific
installations by lower operating and maintenance costs.

It is  believed  that  vertical  kilns  can  be  effectively
controlled  to  allowable  emission  limits  with baghouses,
scrubbers, or cyclone/scrubber combinations.  In the  latter
cases, efficiencies of 99 percent have been reported.
Capital  costs   for  fabric  filters in existing plants were
assumed to be twice their cost  in new plants.  Capital costs
for  wet  scrubbers  and  electrostatic   precipitators   in
existing  plants  were assumed  to be 50 percent greater than
in new plants.  Annualized production and cost control  data
is presented in  Table 3-31-2.
                           2-189

-------
vo
o
                  ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                         Table 3-31-2.
                                   Lfrae Industry Data Summary

                                                        1975
                                                                    198O
                    Capacity (Ml 111on MT/Yr)            21.60       26.74
                    Annua-1 Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-85 = 3,74%
                                                              1985

                                                              29. 13
PROCESS CHARACTERISTICS

  Type 1
  Type 2
  Type 3

EMISSIONS (LOGO MT/Yr)

  1971 Controls:

     Particulates

  Legislated Controls:

     Particulates

CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

  Investment

  Total Annual
     Capital
     O&M
                                               Model Plant Size
                                               {1,OOO MT/Yr)
Pollutants Controlled   Control Technology
1O;54
1O;54
1O;54
)
; 232; 686
; 232; 686
; 232; 686
1975
1 .059.34
461 .53
55.25
34.93
23.89
6.O4
Particulates
Particulates
Particulates
198O 1985
1,413.85 1,561.67
27.33 29.92
3.34 1.80
52.83 54.13
42.51 43. 4O
1O. 32 10.73
Fabric Filter
Scrubber
ESP
1971-85
33O.O1
586.42
474.83
111 .59
                                                                                                           1976-85
                                                                                                          11O.27

                                                                                                          503.77
                                                                                                          4O5.24
                                                                                                           98.53

-------
STRUCTURAL CLAY PRODUCTS INDUSTRY

Production   Characteristics   and   Capacities.  There  are
currently 466 plants  in  the  United  States  manufacturing
structural  clay  products, including common brick, fireclay
or refractory brick, and sewer pipe.   The  latter' category
represents  approximately 90 percent of the total production
of structural clay materials, with common brick being by far
the largest category, or approximately 75 percent  of  total
production.   value  of shipments in 1972 were $404 million,
$143 million and $13 million for common  brick,  clay  sewer-
pipe,  and fireclay brick, respectively.  Plants are located
in 45 states with  North  Carolina,  south  Carolina,  Ohio,
Pennsylvania,  and  Texas accounting for about 45 percent of
production capacity.

For purposes of estimating air abatement costs, the industry
was divided into those plants using either continuous tunnel
kilns or periodic  kilns;  an  average  plant  capacity  was
selected for each process, as shown below.
                                   Est.  1974
                  Av.  Cap.          Cap.
                  (1,000     NO.     (million     Total
                  Mt/Yr)     Plants  Mt/Yr)       Cap.  (%)

 Periodic  kilns      21       336       6.9         35

 Continuous
   tunnel  kilns     100       130      12.9         65

 Totals                       466      19.8        100
 Miscellaneous  clays  and  shales   are  used   to manufacture
 common brick, sewer pipe, and refractory brick.    Typically,
 the  plants  are located in the proximity of  the clay mines.
 The clays are crushed and ground at the plant,  after  which
 they  are  screened  and  mixed  with  water  for the forming
 operation.  Common-brick, sewer  pipe  and  some  refractory
 brick  are  formed  by  extrusion;   most refractory brick is
 formed by die pressing.

 The formed materials are fire-treated by  either  continuous
 tunnel  or  intermittent  periodic  kiln  processes,  in the
 continuous tunnel kiln,  the charge  is  first  preheated  by
 airflow escaping from the bake oven, passed through the oven
 at  temperatures  of  approximately 1,900°F,  and then passed
                            2-191

-------
through a cooling stage,  in  contrast,  the  periodic  kiln
heats   the   charge   at  ambient  temperature  to  a  peak
temperature, after which the fuel is shut off, allowing  the
charge  to  cool  to  ambient  temperature again; this cycle
requires about 2 weeks, during which fuel is burned about 50
percent of the time.  The remainder of the  period  is  used
for  cooling  and physical discharging of the product, steps
which emit little if any air pollutants.

A process frequently practiced by  manufacturers  of  common
brick  is  flashing.  This process involves firing the brick
in  a  reducing  atmosphere  to   achieve   architecturally-
desirable surface colorations.  The process is noted because
when  it  is used in conjunction with periodic kilns, carbon
monoxide and/or hydrocarbon emissions usually result.

Emission Sources and Pollutants. Atmospheric emissions  from
the  manufacture of clay construction products are primarily
sulfur dioxides released  during  the  firing  process,  and
originating   from   the   sulfur  contained  in  the  clay.
Uncontrolled sulfur dioxide emissions are  estimated  to  be
about 0.37 metric ton per 100 metric tons of clay processed.
The  flashing  process  associated  with  the manufacture of
certain types of brick can also result  in- hydrocarbon  and
carbon monoxide emissions.  Approximately 0.42 metric ton of
hydrocarbons  and/or  carbon  monoxide  are  estimated to be
released per 100 metric tons of brick flashed.

Table   3-32-1   summarizes   estimated   uncontrolled   and
controlled   emissions   from   the   production   of   clay
construction materials.

Control Technology and Costs, it  is  anticipated  that  wet
scrubbers  will  be used to control sulfur dioxide emissions
from  the  production   of   clay   contruction   materials.
Presently,  only  a  few  plants were found to be exercising
this or any other control option.   control  of  hydrocarbon
and carbon monoxide emissions can be accomplished by the use
of  afterburners.   The  requirement  for  afterburners will
depend  on  the  duration  of  the  flashing  treatment   at
different  plants.   Likewise,  it  is probable that certain
plants will have minimal requirement for  scrubbers  because
of  the  negligible  sulfur content of some clays.  About 10
percent of existing plants  producing  common  brick,  sewer
pipe,  and  refractory  brick  were  assumed  to  be  either
equipped with adequate controls or using new clay  materials
sufficiently low in sulfur content to avoid the need for wet
scrubbers.

Annual  costs and industry operating statistics are detailed
in Table 3-32-1.
                           2-192

-------
                                         Table 3-32-1.
                         Structural  Clay Products Industry Data Summary
vo
u>
                  ACTIVITY LEVEL

                    Capacity (Thousand MT/Oay)
                  PROCESS  CHARACTERISTICS      (MT/Oay)
Tunnel Kiln
Periodic Kiln
300
20O
                    Periodic Kiln              20O


                  EMISSIONS (LOGO MT/Yr)

                    1971  Controls:

                       Hydrocarbons
                       Sulfur Oxides

                    Legislated Controls:

                       Hydrocarbons
                       Sulfur Oxides

                  CONTROL COSTS (Million  1975  $)

                    Investment

                    Total  Annual
                       Capital
                       O&M
1975
135.19
1976-85 «
ant Sizes
1S8O
155.73
1 . 07%
1985
155.88
Pollutants Controlled
Sulfur Oxides
Sulfur Oxides.
Hydrocarbons
Sulfur Oxides,
Hydrocarbons
1975
18.55
80.02
8.84
48.77
23.74
26.38
1O. 3O
16. .08
198O
14.49
102.59
0.37
22.83
O. 13
29.62
13. 06
16.56
1985
9. 14
1O5. 13
0.23
23. 03
0.68
25.25
13. 18
12.08


Control Technology
Wet Scrubber
Wet Scrubber
Thermal Incinerator
1971-85 1976-85


SO. 89 17.63
343.14 284. 3O
148.65 126.73
194.49 157.57

-------
SURFACE COATINGS INDUSTRY

Production  characteristics  and  Capacities.  Air  emission
abatement  costs  associated  with  the use of organic-based
surface  coatings  in  four  industries   were   considered:
automotive,  furniture,  major appliances, and metal or coil
coatings.  These industries are considered together  because
of  the  general  similarities between the coating processes
employed, the nature of the  resulting  emissions,  and  the
abatement technologies deemed applicable.

In 1971, approximately 606 million liters of coatings, i.e.,
paint, shellac, lacquer, and primers, were consumed by these
industries.   Since  over  75  percent  of the coatings used
contained about 50  percent  organic  solvents,  significant
hydrocarbon  emissions  resulted  during the application and
curing stages of  the  process.   Future  estimates  of  the
volume  of  hydrocarbon  emissions  attributable  to surface
coating  processes  must  be  considered  in  light  of  the
following factors:

  «  Increased use  of  non-hydrocarbon  solvent  materials,
     i.e., water-thinnable solutions.

  •  Application techniques involving solvent-free  systems,
     i.e.,   powder   coatings   applied   by  electrostatic
     spraying.

Where applicable, these process alternatives  would  provide
as  much as a 90 percent reduction in hydrocarbon emissions.
Faced with the alternative of conventional emission  control
techniques   (i.e.,  incineration) industries are expected to
adopt  the  newer  coating  formulations   and   application
techniques  at  an accelerated pace.  By 1985, as much as 50
percent of the coating processes may employ non-hydrocarbon-
based materials.

The  coating  process  consists  basically  of  two   steps:
application  and  curing.   Both  stages produce hydrocarbon
emissions through evaporation.   The  coating  is  generally
applied  by  a  spray  gun  in  a paint spray booth, and the
surface is then cured or dried in a drying  oven  where  the
solvent  is evaporated.  A summary of industry production is
presented in Table 3-33-1.
                            2-194

-------
                       Table 3-33-1.
                 Surface Coatings industry
                    Distribution (1971)
Automobile
Furniture
Metal Coil
  Coating
Major Appliance

Totals
  NO.  of
  Plants

  100
7,000*

   56
  144
Coating
Consumption
(million
liters)

   246
   189.5

    95
    76

   606.5
percent
of Coating
Consumption

    41
    31

    16
    12

   100
ilO  percent  of  furniture  manufacturers  account  for  65
percent of sales  ($).
  Automotive  Finishing,  in  1971,  there  were  100  motor
vehicle  (auto, truck, and bus) assembly plants  located in 28
states throughout the United States.  Included  in this group
are: motor vehicles and car bodies, truck  and   bus  bodies,
motor  vehicle  parts  and  accessories, truck  trailers, and
travel trailers  and  campers.   Approximately   246  million
liters   of  coatings  were consumed in finishing operations,
which is about 41 percent of the total  volume   of  coatings
used by  the four industries under consideration.

  Furniture   Finishing.   About  7,000  establishments  are
engaged  in manufacturing the following types  of furniture in
the United States:

  •  Wood Household Furniture
  •  Wood Furniture - Upholstered
  *  Metal Household Furniture
  •  Wood Cabinetry
  •  Household Furniture - Unclassified
  •  Wood Office Furniture
  •  Metal Office Furniture
  •  Public Building Furniture
  *  Furniture and Fixtures - unclassified.

 Approximately 10 percent of the establishments   account   for
 65   percent of  industry  sales, with the  10  largest  producers
 representing  nearly 20 percent of  industry  sales.   Furniture
                            2-195

-------
is,manufactured in all but seven states, and North Carolina,
the principal producer, accounts for 22 percent of the total
shipment value.

About 190 million liters of organic  solvent-based  coatings
were  consumed  by  the  industry in 1971.  Between 1967 and
1972  paint consumption has grown about 5 percent  annually,
Unlike  the  metal surfaces coatings,, the use of water-based
paints  and  finishes  for  wood  furniture  is  limited  in
practice  because  of  the  tendency  for  the occurrence of
surface distortions in the  wood.   Virtually  all  coatings
used,  therefore, are hydrocarbon-based and range from 30 to
70 percent by weight in organic content.

  Coil Coating. The coil coating process consists  primarily
of  the  pretreatment  of  sheet  metal in the strip or coil
form, followed by the application of an organic coating  and
subsequent  curing (or baking) to obtain the desired surface
characteristics.  It is estimated  that  56  plants  in  the
United  States  are engaged in this coating process.  Almost
60 percent of the plants are located in Pennsylvania,  Ohio,
and  Illinois,  presumably near sources of steel production.
In 1971, approximately 95 million liters  of  coatings  were
consumed  by  coil coating processes, representing an annual
increase of 14 percent since  1964  when  about  38  million
liters were consumed.

  Major  Appliances.  In  1971, there were 144 plants in the
United States engaged in the production of major  appliances
including:  cooking  equipment,  refrigerators and freezers,
and laundry equipment- about 76 million liters  of  coatings
were consumed in this production effort.  Growth in industry
consumption  of coatings averaged 4 percent annually between
1964 and 1971.

Emissions and  Sources  of  Pollutants.  While  paint  spray
booths  are  a source of hydrocarbon emission, the volume of
solvent released to the air through evaporation is dependent
on the degree of overspray, which can vary anywhere from  10
to  90  percent.   Aerosols  resulting  from  overspray  are
usually removed by filters or  water  scrubbers,  but  these
devices  have  little  impact on removal of emissions due to
solvent  evaporation.   The  major   source   of   emissions
attributable to coating processes are the drying ovens.
Control  Technology  and  Costs. Incineration of the solvent
vapors in the exhaust gases from the spray  booths  and  the
drying ovens is presently the most practicable technique for
limiting   hydrocarbon   emissions   from   surface  coating
                           2-196

-------
operations.  Control costs are primarily a function  of  the
exhaust gas volume.

Incineration  essentially involves oxidation of hydrocarbons
in the exhaust gases  to  form  carbon  dioxide  and  water.
Several  alternative  techniques  are  available,  including
flame  combustion,   thermal   combustion,   and   catalytic
combustion.   Presently,  technical considerations favor the
use of thermal incinerators.  However,  as  continuing  fuel
shortages  prevail  and  prices  rise,  catalytic units will
probably become more economical in the  future.   To  offset
the  impact  of current fuel shortages/ thermal incinerators
with  heat  exchange  units  were  considered  to  be   most
applicable  for   all but the furniture category where little
curing is employed.  The heat exchanger extracts waste  heat
from  the  hot  exhaust  gases, enabling reuse and operating
economy.

A  summary of estimated  investment and annual operating  costs
per model plant are provided in Table 3-33-2.
                            2-197

-------
to
I
V0
00
                                     Table  3-33-2.
                         Surface Coating  Industry Data Summary
              ACTIVITY  LEVEL
                                                    1975
                                                                1980
               Capacity  (Million  Liters/Day)        1.32        2.17
               Annual Growth  Rate Over  the Period  1976-85 = 6.38%
                                                              1985

                                                              2.42
PROCESS CHARACTERISTICS

  Application and Curing


EMISSIONS (1.OOO MT/Yr)

Hydrocarbons

  1971 Controls:

     Auto
     Major Appliance
     Furni ture
     Metal Coil

  Legislated Controls:

     Auto
     Major Appliance
     Furniture
     Metal Coll

CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

  Investment

  Total Annual
     Capital
     O&M
                                          Model Plant Sizes
                                          (Liters/Day)
                                                  Pollutants Controlled
Control Technology
2,274;9,854
175,477
; Hydrocarbons
1975
147.
49
148
60.
13O.
43.
67.
58.
9.
193.
48.
145,
. 19
.53
,09
.09
.06
.98
69
.75
58
37
30
O7
198O
212
82
243
81
177
66
23
68
8
385
78
3O6
.09
.93
.73
.34
.23
.52
.37
.42
.57
.65
.85
.81
Vapor
1985 1971-85
246.
1O3.
273.
9O.
9.
3.
26.
3.
5.
425.
83.
342.
O4
78
OO
.83
.26
.87
33
43
48 514.46
76 4, 098,47
.71 87O.16
03 3,228.31
Inci nerat ior
1976-f


217.72
3,633 .OS
742. 17
2,890.89

-------
STEAM ELECTRIC POWER PLANTS

Operating  Characteristics.  Among  the  largest  stationary
sources  of air pollution are the coal, oil, and natural  gas
burners.  Of the three fuels, coal is the most polluting  and
natural gas is the cleanest and most convenient to  use.   The
principal uses for these fuels include furnace operation   in
steam electric power plants, steam generation and heating in
the  industrial  sector, and space heating in the commercial
and residential sectors.  In 1976, 87 percent of  the   steam
coal   (in  contrast  to  coking  coal) produced was used  for
power generation.  About 63 percent of all residual fuel  oil
consumed and 18 percent of natural gas produced was used  for
the same purpose.  It is apparent from these estimates  that
utility  power burners are the major sources of emission  for
the pollutants  of  concern,  because  they  burn   the  most
polluting fuels in the largest quantities.

Emission  Sources and Pollutants. In the near future, energy
resources that will be consumed  in  large  amounts   are  the
nuclear    fuels   with   their   radioactive-waste-disposal
requirements,  and  the  fossil   fuels  with  their  residue
disposal  and  gaseous emission-control requirements.   Among
the  fossil fuels, natural gas is  the cleanest, but  it is   in
short   supply.   To  demonstrate  the  cleanliness  of  gas
relative to coal and oil,  the emissions resulting   from  the
use  of  each  fuel in a typical  uncontrolled 1,OOO megawatt
power  plant are given below.
                        Emissions  (kilograms per hour)

   Fuel               Particulates       S02      NOsc

   Coal                  69,000       41,000   13,OOO
   Oil                      600       12,500     8,60O
   Gas                      170            7     6,80O
 Natural  gas  is  the  preferred   fuel   from  an    emissions
 standpoint.    Gas-fired  power plants provided 16 percent of
 electricity  produced in 1975,  and gas  provided  about  one-
 fifth  of  all the heating energy derived  from fossil fuels.
 The production of gas in the  near  future  is  expected  to
 remain  fairly  constant, and  the growing  fossil  fuel demand
 will be supplied by coal and oil.

 Despite current shortages in the  United States, petroleum is
 still an abundant fuel internationally. For mobile sources,
                            2-199

-------
its derivatives/ gasoline and diesel oil, are  not  expected
to  be  supplanted  in  the  near future.  For utility power
burners, despite the potential switch from oil  to  coal  in
many  power  plants,  distillate  and residual fuel oil will
continue to supply a  significant  fraction  of  the  energy
required  in  1980.   Fuel  oils for utility burners contain
sulfur (typical sulfur contents average  about  0.7  percent
for  United  States  crude  oils  and  about 2.2 percent for
imported crude oils), much of  which  is  removed  from  the
final product.  The ash from residual oil combustion is low,
about 0.5 percent.

The  supply  of  crude oil and its derivatives in the United
States is becoming increasingly  critical  as  a  result  of
limited   reserves   of   domestic  sources  and  increasing
international demand for this versatile fuel.   Furthermore,
oil  is  in greater demand for producing electrical power in
areas where foreign oil was, and probably will  continue  to
be, more accessible.

The  most  abundant fossil fuel in this country is coal,  in
1975, about 405 million tons of coal were burned to  produce
about  half  of  the  electrical power.  In 1975, 70 million
tons were used for heating, 83 million  tons  were  used  to
produce coke for use in industrial processes, and 64 million
tons  were  exported.   The resources of coal are widespread
throughout the united States, but coal has not been used  in
proportion  to its availability in comparison with the other
fuels.

Coal typically has an ash content of  9  percent,  of  which
(under  uncontrolled  conditions)  about 85 percent would be
emitted from a dry-bottom boiler, and 65 percent from a wet-
botton boiler.  The resulting emissions would be  orders  of
magnitude  higher  than  those  from the other fossil fuels.
Particulate controls of varying efficiencies  are  found  on
all but the smallest coal burners.

Sulfur  dioxide  emissions  from  coal burning are even more
serious and more difficult to control.  In 1975, the  sulfur
content  of  coal burned by utilities, averaged 2.2 percent;
this sulfur  appears  as  sulfur  dioxide  and  some  sulfur
trioxide.  To reduce the sulfur oxides, a coal of low-sulfur
content  could be chosen.  However, much of the Eastern low-
sulfur coal is reserved  for  use  as  coke  by  the  metals
industries.   In  only  a  small  percentage of current coal
production is the sulfur content  low  enough  to  meet  New
Source  Performance Standards.  The major western low-sulfur
coals will  be  used  primarily  in  the  West  and  Central
Regions.
                           2-200

-------
Use of coal to supply most electric power in the near  future
seems   unavoidable.   Therefore,  more  stringent  emission
controls will be needed.  In addition to switching  to  low-
sulfur  coal, other strategies are possible, such as removal
of sulfur from flue gases, and removal of sulfur  from  high
sulfur fuels before burning.

The  uncontrolled  and  controlled  emissions  from  utility
fossil-fuel burners may be estimated from  known  (measured)
emission   factors,   for  the   first  case,  and  from  the
capability of the various control techniques in the second.

Control Technologies and  Costs.  The  following  paragraphs
analyze  the  different  technologies  presently employed to
control sulfur oxides, nitrogen  oxides,  particulates,  and
the related costs.

  Sulfur   Oxides.   The   state-of-the-art   of   flue  gas
desulfurization  (FGD) is such that the  so-called  throwaway
scrubbing  systems  (lime  and   limestone)  will predominate
through 1980.  By 1980, roughly  45 percent of  all  capacity
with   sulfur   oxide   controls  will  be  using  limestone
scrubbing, while 30 percent will use  lime  scrubbing.   The
balance  (about  25 percent) will be divided equally between
lime/limestone and "other" control  methods,  including  the
use of regenerative systems.  On this basis, the capital and
operating  costs  used  for  FGD  through  1980  will  be the
weighted average of lime and limestone costs.  The  capital,
operating, and annual costs of FGD systems are as follows:
                          New Plants     Existing Plants

investment  ($Aw)            51                 72
O&M  (millsAw hr)             1.2               2.0
Annual  (millsAw hr)          3.0               4.0
For  these  plants,   it   was   assumed   that   the   cumulative
generating capacity  controlled by this   technique   in   1971t
1972,   1975,  and  1980   will  be 0,  1,000, 7,000,  and  33,000
megawatts,  respectively.   Recent .  estimates  show a  more
accelerated   application  of  flue    gas   desulfurization
technology.   (See EPA Draft Report,  "The Economic  Impact of
EPA's   Air  and  water  Regulations  on the  Electric utility
Industry", November  1975.)  Investment  costs for each  period
were simply computed by  multiplying  the dollars per kilowatt
by the  net generating capacity for which FGD  systems  were
installed in  that period.
                            2-201

-------
Operating  and  maintenance  costs   (and   in  general   time-
dependent costs) for a given period  were computed  using  an
operating  rate  of  55  percent  and  the  cost in mils per
kilowatt hour.  The time, in years,  that   a  certain  annual
increment  controlled generating capacity  contributes to the
time period under consideration as well as the magnitude  of
the  increment  will determine its contribution to the  total
cost in that period.  The sum of the products of incremental
megawatt capacity and number of years contributed  was  used
to  compute  the O&M as well as annual and depreciation (10-
year) costs.

The same procedure was used to compute the costs of FGD  for
existing  plants.   An  operating  rate  of  70  percent was
assumed for these plants.

it is projected that a significant  number  of  Central  and
Eastern  utilities,  usually  burning high-sulfur coal, will
switch to  burning  western  and  much  less  significantly,
Eastern  low-sulfur  coal.   It is estimated that cumulative
generating capacities of 880 trillion,  1,540  trillion  and
1,650  trillion Btu's per year will switch from high-to low-
sulfur coal in 1975, 1977, and 1980, respectively.   western
low-sulfur coal will be transported over long distances, and
this  will  double  or  triple  the  cost of the coal.  Some
modifications in converting the power  plant  to  low-sulfur
coal  are necessary; these changes are related to such items
as  increased  capacity  of  coal  pulverization   equipment
necessary  to handle the higher tonnages and derating of the
power plant owing to the lower heating value of Western low-
sulfur coals.

In the period 1975-80, two other  sulfur  oxide  methods  of
abatement  will  be  employed  in  coal burners.  These will
involve the increased use of physically-cleaned coal and the
blending of low-sulfur coal with high-sulfur coal,  in  some
instances, low-sulfur coal will be burned exclusively during
episodes of adverse meteorological conditions.

The  approach  used here was to use FEA's base case scenario
for the  total  utilization  of  oil  and  gas.   Thus,   the
projected  energy  scenario outlined in Table 3-34-1, with a
modification  to  represent  the  expected  switch  of  some
existing oil burning plants back to coal:
                           2-202

-------
                       Table 3-34-1.
         Energy Consumption by Oil  and Gas  Burners

                   (In Trillion Btu/Year)
Fuel
                    1970
      1975
198O
Distillate Oil
  (0.3%S)              140
Fuel Oil <1%S)       1,100
Fuel Oil <1-2%S)       390
Fuel Oil (2+%S)        450
Natural Gas          4,000
Coal Switch              0
  240    482      389    706
1,942  2,471    3,137 4,067
  '682    412    1,098    676
  785    285    1,304    470
3,274  3,274    2,948 2,948
  113    113      985    985
The  differential  fuel costs resulting from the utilization
of Western and Eastern low-sulfur coal are given below.
                                      0/Million Btu
Cost of high sulfur coal
Cost of low-sulfur coal as burned
Cost of boiler modifications (as
  explained above)
Differential fuel cost due to CAA
   western,
   Chicago

      47
      60

       3
      16
Eastern,
Cleveland

   37
   73

     3
   39
 It is not known at this time what  percentage  of  the   low-
 sulfur coal usage will be western and what the price will be
 to  burn  it.   However,  most  of  the  coal  usage will be
 Western, and the differential price of 16 cents per trillion
 Btu will be used as explained  above.   The  unit  costs  of
 physically  cleaning  and  blending coal (transportation and
 storage mainly) are $4.5 and $0.25 per ton, respectively.

 Fuel oil burning utilities will in some cases be required to
 switch to low-sulfur fuel oil.  The  costs  of  the  various
 grades with respect to sulfur content are given below.
                           2-203

-------
                       % Sulfur          0 per Million Btu

Distillate                0.3                  90
Fuel Oil                  1.0                  82
Fuel Oil                  1-2                  71
Fuel Oil                  2                    65
For  the conversion of Eastern utilities to  low-sulfur  coal,
only  quantities  involved  between  1975  and   1980   were
considered.    Taking   1975  as  the  baseline  year   (zero
conversion) the post-1975 conversion  data   was  used.    The
levels  are  40  million and 77 million tons per year in  the
periods 1976-77 and 1978-80, respectively.   In  the  period
1975  to  1980,  this  will amount to a total of 272 million
tons.  The cost at 16 cents per million Btu  will come   to a
total of $800 million in the period under consideration.

Physical  coal  cleaning  and blending in the period 1975 to
1980  will  involve  65  and  182.5  million tons  in    the
respective  categories.   The  respective costs will be $292
million and $46 million.

In  oil-burning  utilities,  the  differential  fuel    costs
resulting   from  switching  to  low-sulfur  fuel  oils   and
distillates  has   been   estimated   by   integrating    the
differentials  between  the baseline case and that projected
for the years 1975 through 1980 in Table 3-34-1.

  Nitrogen oxides. These pollutants will  be controlled  by
applying  staged  combustion  and off-stoichiometric firing.
The unit costs for a 500 megawatt plant burning  coal,  oil,
and  gas  were  used in assessing the total  cost of control.
It was assumed that emissions of  nitrogen   oxides  will  be
abated  by the above technique starting in July 1975.   while
it is recognized that this may not necessarily  take  place,
the  costs  obtained  by  this  assumption will represent an
upper  limit  for  the  period   1975-80.    Variances    and
exemptions  issued  in  Air  Quality  Control Regions (AQCR)
where the ambient levels of this pollutant are not  critical
will of course lower the overall costs of control.

The  above-mentioned  control  technique applies only to  dry
bottom boilers; wet bottom boilers are not amenable to  this
abatement  technique.   Consequently,  if  total  control is
desired, massive conversion of the estimated 17  percent  of
the  coal steam-electric generating capacity with wet bottom
boilers will have to be converted to the dry bottom type.
                           2-204

-------
Berkau's unit cost data were used,  wherein  a  500  megawatt
model  plant  was  assumed;  the  investment  costs  were  as
follows:
              Fuel              $ per kw

                                New      Existing*

              Oil/Gas           0.56        0.75
              Coal              2.75        3.04

*Costs for new plants multiplied by  a  retrofit  difficulty
factor  of 1.35.  Operation and maintenance and total  annual
costs were assumed to be 2 and 18 percent of investment   per
year; depreciation was assumed to be 14 percent per year.
It  appears  that  only  AQCR's  24 and 67, whose boundaries
encompass  the  cities   of   Los   Angeles   and   Chicago,
respectively,  will  restrict  nitrogen.oxide emissions from
utility burners.  In Los Angeles, the 1975 total oil and gas
fired capacity to be controlled amounts to 11,770  megawatts
of  coal,  oil,  and  gas burning facilities.  An additional
2,000 megawatts of coal burning capacity is estimated  to  be
on-stream  by 1978.  Estimates of control costs in these two
AQCR's were made and added to the national estimates.

  Control of Particulates in Coal Burners. It  is  estimated
that  about  75  percent  of  all  coal-burning power  plants
existing in 1970 had particulate removal equipment of   about
90  percent efficiency.  However, it should be noted at this
point that it is difficult to substantiate this because of a
lack of data.  Stringent local (city and state)  regulations
initiated  the  expansion  of  serious  efforts  to  control
particulates in the  late  1960's  and  early  1970's.    The
assumption  has  been  made  that  a  gradual  upgrading  of
particulate control devices to-99.9  percent  efficiency  or
better will taXe place.

All   generating   capacity  in  operation  before  1975  is
considered to be controlled by electrostatic  precipitators,
and   existing  capacity  for  which  FGD  systems  will  be
installed before and after 1975 will not require  additional
particulate  control  capability.   New  generating capacity
coming into operation after 1975 and for which FGD  will  be
applied  will  require  a particulate control level up to 95
percent using electrostatic precipitators; this  is  roughly
half the investment required for control up to 99.5 percent.
                           2-205

-------
 Generating  capacity  existing  in  1971  together with that
 coming  on line between 1971 and 1975 (after FGD capacity  is
 subtracted)   will  have capacity efficiency upgraded to 99.9
 percent by electrostatic precipitators.  Increments  to  the
 1975  capacity {after taking out all FGD) will be controlled
 to 99.9 percent efficiency  by  electrostatic  precipitators
 and  wet  venturi scrubbing; the breakdown will be 90 and 10
 percent, respectively.  The  breakdown  in  capacity  to  be
 controlled as explained above is shown in Table 3-34-2.
                        Table 3-34-2.
             Control of Particulates 1971 to 1980
             (Trillion Btu Coal Burning Capacity)
Year

1971
1972
1973
1974
1975
1976
1977
1978
1979
1980
FGDi     FGD2
Existing New
         Remaining Capacity3
99.9 Percent   99.9 Percent
ESP            venturi Scrubbing
0
48.2
79.5
154
337
761
1,340
1,410
1,490 1
1,590 1
0
0
0
0
0
221
552
748
,060
,410
                      7,800*
                      8,350
                      9,000
                      9,700
                    10,500
                    10,680
                    10,760
                    11,460
                    12,080
                    12,670
   No  particulate controls  necessary.
  to time of installation  of FGD.
                  0
                  0
                  0
                  0
                  0
                 20
                 10
                100
                100
                100

           variances  granted  up
2 Control to 95 percent  before  FGD  system.

3 Calculated by difference  assuming on operating rate of  55
  and  70  percent   of   existing  and  new  plants  with FGD
  installed.  A heat rate of  0.01 trillion Btu per kw hr was
  also assumed.
  1971 capacity will  require only  half
  upgrading from  95 to  99.9 percent.
                                 the  investment  in
  Unit  Costs  of   Particulate  Control. The following costs
were used for 99.5  percent particulate control units:
                           2-206

-------
                          ESP
      Venturi  Scrubbing
Investment ($ per kw)     20.0*
O&M ($ per kw-yr)          0.35
            30.0*
             2.6
:* Applying applicable inflation factors result in
  investments of 43 and 46 in 1975$ for ESP and Venturi
  Scrubbing, respectively.
Capacity existing in 1971 will be gradually  (1971  to   1975)
upgraded  from  90  to 99.9 percent.  This implies that half
the investment will be required and  time-dependent  charges
(O&M  and  annual)  will carry for only 2 years instead of 4
years.

The most recent  anlaysis  of  costs  for  this  sector  was
provided  to  the  Agency  by  Temple, Barker & Sloane, Inc.
(TBS)1.  This analysis was  conducted  in  somewhat  greater
depth  than,  and  subsequent  to the general data gathering
efforts associated with the SEAS  uniform  cost  calculation
procedure,  and  is considered to be more precise.  However,
time and resource constraints prevented incorporating   these
costs  into  the  scenario  analyses  using  the  SEAS  model
procedure.  The TBS estimates are  as  follows  (in  million
1975 dollars):
  Incremental Investment
  O&M in 1985
(1975-1985)    20,000
               2,700
The TBS study results are  listed  below   (in  billion   1975
dollars):

                                   1975-1980   1975-1985
Flue Gas Desulfurization
Eastern Medium Sulfur coal
Western Low Sulfur Coal
  Equipment Modifications
  Precipitators
Washing and Blending
Other Precipitators

TOTAL
        9.3
        0.9

        0.6
        2.0
        0.2
        0.6

       13.6
12.8
 0.9

 1.3
 4.2
 0.2
 0.6
20.0
Estimates   from  the  earlier SEAS calculation are presented
below  with projected pollutant discharges associated with
                           2-207

-------
SEAS  lists   5.8   billion   associated   with   flue   gas
desulfurization  in   1975-1985,  and  4.5 billion during the
period 1975-1980.  As can be noted,  this  is  approximately
half  of the later, revised TBS calculations.  The forecasts
for electrostatic precipitators capital expenditures in SEAS
are 3.0 billion for 1975-1985 and 2.5 billion for 1975-1980.
SEAS assumed all costs associated with  fuel-switching  were
O&M,  as  opposed  to  capital  investment  required  by the
standard regulations.  Much of the  difference  between  the
two  studies is due to assumptions about capacity covered by
the regulations and interpretation of costs associated  with
the implementation of the standards.
  "The Economic impact of EPA's Air and WAter Regulations
  on the Electric Utilities Industries", Temple, Barker &
  Sloane, Inc., November, 1975.
                          2-208

-------
                                         Table 3-34-3.
                              Steam-Electric  Industry Data Summary
                  ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                                         1975
                                                                     198O
                    Capacity (Mega Megawatts)           O.73
                    Annual Growth Rate Over the Period  1976-85
                                                  1 . 12
                                               11.89%
I
N>

§
PROCESS CHARACTERISTICS

  Coal
                    Oi 1
                  EMISSIONS (1.0OO MT/Yr)

                    1971 Controls:

                       Part1culates
                       Ni trogen Oxides
                       Sulfur Oxides
                       Hydrocarbons
                       Carbon Monoxide
                       Other Gases & Mists
Pollutants Controlled

Partlculates
Nitrogen Oxides
Sulfur Oxides
Hydrocarbons
Carbon Monoxide
Other Gases & Mists
PartIculates
Nitrogen Oxides
Hydrocarbons
Carbon Monoxide
Sulfur Oxide
                                      1975

                                  29.446.74
               198O

           38,565,97
                                                              1985

                                                              1 .26
Control Technology

Venturi Scrubbers;ESP
Burner Modification
Flue Gas Desulfurization
None Appl1 cable
None Applicable
None Applicable
None Applicable
Burner Modification
None Applicable
None Applicable
None Applicable
                                                              1985
                                                          41 .544 ..68
                                       1971-85
                        1976-85
4,542.52
6,024.67
18,551 .79
79.46
248 . O8
0.22
6. 144.O4
7,963.90
24,018.66
1 1O. 92
328. 15
O.3O
6,673.94
8,905.93
25,474.75
126.62
363. 1 1
O.33

-------
                                        Table  3-34-3.
                              Steam-Electric  Industry Data Summary
to
to
ACTIVITY LEVEL

  Legislated Controls:

     PartIculates
     Nitrogen Oxides
     Sulfur Oxides
     Hydrocarbons
     Carbon Monoxide
     Other Gases & Mists

CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

  Investment
  Total Annual
     Capital
     O&M
1975
19
2
e
11







,819
, 14O
,244
,415
83
261
0
960
977
322
654
.85
.07
.42
.50
.62
.56
.23
.38
.OO
.50
.50
16

8
7




2
1
1
198O
,415,
5O9
,315
,O30
123
356
0
645
,691
, 121
,570
.40
.91
.29
.79
.81
.93
.32
.89
.36
.02
.34
19

9
7




2
1
1
1985
, 147 .
579.
,992.
,994
143.
424.
O.
187.
,7O2
,361
,34O
81
41
,42
.84
92
16
,35
.68
,66
.90
.76







1O.353. 11
26,630. 16
11 ,384.22
15,245.93
                                                                                                        7,9O5.69
                                                                                                       24.537.80
                                                                                                       1O,730.12
                                                                                                       13,807.68

-------
SOLID WASTE DISPOSAL

Solid  waste  disposal  contributes  to  air  pollution  from
incineration  and  open  burning  methods.   Air  pollutants
emitted  to  the  atmosphere  from  such  practices  include
particulates,  carbon  monoxide,  sulfur  oxides,   nitrogen
oxides,  fluorocarbons,  hydrochoric  acid,  and odors.  The
levels of pollutants emitted are primarily dependent on  the
input  or  the material being burned; incinerator levels are
also dependent on the specific incinerator design  and   upon
the  specific  methods  of operation.  Particulate emissions
are the highest concentrations,  making  them  the  specific
pollutant subject to controls.  There are no current Federal
regulations for odors, hydrochloric acid, and fluorocarbons.

The  solid  waste disposal methods that are discussed in the
following paragraphs were in use in 1971 in the  proportions
shown below:
  Disposal Method                  Solid waste Disposed  (%)

  Municipal incinerators                    5.3
  On-Site incinerators
      (Commercial and Industrial)            8.3
  Open Burning and Open Dumps              22.2
  Other Methods                            64.2

  Total Disposed wastes                   100.0
MUNICIPAL INCINERATORS

Operating  Characteristics  and capacities. Basically,  there
are two types of  municipal  incinerators:  the  refractory-
lined  furnace type, the most common  in this country,  and  the
water-wall  or  waste-heat  recovery type,  more  common in
Europe.  The water-wall units offer  the advantage  of  steair.
generation,  and  as  a consequence  of heat recovered during
steam  generation, flue-gas temperatures are lower  than  the
refractory-lined    units.    incinerators   with   lower  gas
temperatures have smaller volumes of flue gases to control,
and  thus require smaller, less-costly air-pollution  control
equipment.  In  addition, with the low temperatures from heat
recovery, incinerators can utilize   control  equipment  that
could  not survive the higher temperature  flue  gases from  the
refractory-lined  furnaces.
                            2-211

-------
Emission  Sources  and  Pollutants.  Municipal  incinerators
contribute to  air  pollution  by  releasing  a  variety  of
pollutants  to  the  atmosphere  that  include particulates,
hydrocarbons, sulfur oxides, fluorocarbons, nitrogen  oxides
and   carbon  monoxides.   The  levels  of  these  pollutant
emissions are directly related to the design  and  operation
of  the  incinerator,  but  more  importantly  to  the input
charge.  Of these pollutants, normally only the particulates
are considered to be emitted in concentrations that are high
enough to warrant controls.

Control  Technology  and  Costs.  Both  high-efficiency  wet
scrubbers  and  electrostatic  precipitators  are capable of
collection efficiencies to meet emission regulations  of  91
grams  per  45.4  Kilograms  of  refuse charged.  Annualized
control costs and industry statistics are detailed in  Table
3-35-1.
ON-SITE INCINERATORS  (COMMERCIAL AND INDUSTRIAL)

operating  Characteristics  and Capabilities. In 1972, there
were approximately 100,000 on-site incinerators  in  use  in
this  country.   These  intermediate-sized units are usually
associated with office buildings, large  retail  stores  and
apartment  buildings.  Of the over 23 million metric tons of
solid waste incinerated annually in the united States,  more
than  one-third is processed by on-site units that typically
process  about  90  tons  annually,  or  approximately   104
kilograms  per  hour.   States  bordering  the  Great  Lakes
(Minnesota, Ohio, Illinois,  Wisconsin,  Michigan,  Indiana,
New  York, and Pennsylvania) account for about 60 percent of
the total number of on-site units in the United States.

There are two types of commercial  building  and  industrial
incinerators:  single-chamber and multiple-chamber.  Single-
chamber incinerators  are similar to residential or  domestic
units and consist of  a refractory-lined chamber with a grate
on  which  the  refuse  is  burned.  Combustion products are
formed by contact between under-fire air and  waste  on  the
grate.  Additional air (over-fire air) is admitted above the
burning  waste  to  promote  complete combustion.  Multiple-
chamber  incinerators  employ  a  second  chamber  to  which
combustion  gases  from the primary chamber are directed for
further oxidation of  combustible gases.   Auxiliary  burners
are sometimes employed in the second chamber to increase the
combustion temperature.

it  is  estimated  that  the  use of apartment incinerators,
which account for  about  6  percent  of  installations  for
refuse  disposal,  will  become virtually extinct during the
                           2-212

-------
1976-85 period.  The number  of  industrial  and  commercial
units  should  remain  stable during that decade because new
installations will primarily be replacements of older units.

Approximatly 88 percent of all on-site incinerators are  the
multiple-chamber   type;   emissions  from  multiple-chamber
incinerators are generally  lower  than  the  single-chamber
incinerators.   The  design  capacity  of the incinerator in
this report is from 23 kilograms per hour to 1,816 Kilograms
per hour, and the average incinerator operates  between  3-5
hours a day.

Emission  Sources  and  Pollutants, while on-site units emit
various products of combustion, only particulates (fly  ash)
are   released   in   sufficient   quantities   to   warrant
installation of controls.  Approximate emission factors  for
single-chamber    and   multiple-chamber   incinerators   of
intermediate size are respectively 7.5 and 3.5 Kilograms per
metric ton of refuse charged.

Control Technology and Costs.  Operating  conditions   (e.g.,
air  supply  to the combustion chamber), refuse composition,
and basic incinerator design have a pronounced effect on the
volume and composition of air emissions.   Afterburners  and
wet  scrubbers  can  be  installed  to  control  particulate
emissions and  some other combustion products.  However, with
the shortage of natural gas and the expense of fuel oil, the
use  of  afterburners  as  retrofit  controls  on   building
incinerators   will  probably be curtailed.  Furthermore, the
newer multiple-chamber units already employ auxiliary  firing
techniques which  in  effect  fulfills  the  function  of  an
afterburner.

Wet    scrubbers   will  achieve  an  approximate  80  percent
reduction in particulates emissions.  This level of  control
is sufficient  to  meet Federal particulate emission standards
of 2 Kilograms per metric ton of refuse charged.

Annualized   control  costs  and  performance   statistics are
detailed in  Table 3-35-1.
 OPEN BURNING AND OPEN DUMPS

 Emission Sources and Pollutants.  Open burning refers to  the
 indiscriminate  and  unconfined  burning  of  wastes, such'as
 leaves,  landscape refuse,   and other  rubbish.    Open  dump
 burning   refers to unconfined burning of refuse  at municipal
 dumps.   Emissions from open dumps reflect the composition of
 the refuse as well as the  volume  of  such  items  as  paper,
                            2-213

-------
plastics,  garbage,  etc.   The  primary emissions  from open
burning are participates, smoke, and products of combustion.

Control Technology and Costs. There is no control technology
that can be applied to open burning, and the  only  suitable
alternatives  for emissions control are the use of municipal
incinerators for disposal and the use of sanitary landfills.
It was  assumed  that  all  on-site  open  burning  and  the
resultant  wastes  would  be diverted to sanitary landfills.
Annualized costs and process characteristics are detailed in
Table 3-35-1.
                          2-214

-------
N>
I
N>
                                       Table 3-35-1.
                         Solid Waste Disposal Industry Data Summary
ACTIVITY LEVEL                     1975

  Capacity
     Municipal Incln. (MT/Day)     44.49
     Open Burning (MT/Day)        159.3O
     On-Slte Incln. (MT/Yr)     _ 793.86

  Annual Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-85:

     Municipal Incineration  =  2.16%
     Open Burning            =  3.66%
     On-S1te Incineration    -  O.52%
                PROCESS CHARACTERISTICS

                  Municipal  Incinerators
                  Open Burning

                  On-S1te Incineration
                EMISSIONS (1.OOO MT/Yr)

                  1971  Controls:

                     Partlculates

                  Legislated Controls:

                     Partlculates
                                                               198O
                                                               52.00
                                                              2O6.62
                                                              856.57
                                                                           1985
            51.89
           217.34
           787.44
                          Model Plant Sizes
                          (MT/Day)

                             3OO
                             10O,300,50O,70O.
                             900.150O
                             10O,30O,50O,7OO,
                             90O.15OO

                                   1975
                                  148.78
                                                   88.43
   Pollutants Controlled   Control  Technology
   Partlculates
   Partlculates

   Partlculates
   ESP and Wet Scrubber
   Landfill  (Close or Remote)

   Landfill  (Close) or Wet
   Scrubber
198O
                                              183.52
                                               58.06
                                                           1985
                                                          183.44
                                                                          57.6O
1971-85
1976-85

-------
                               Table 3-35-1.  (Continued)
                       Solid Waste Disposal  Industry  Data  Summary

              CONTROL  COSTS  (Million 1975  $)      1975        1980         1985         1971-85         1976-85

I                Investment                       133.O9        42.72         3.29     1,948.33          634.68
N>
(-•
ox                  Municipal  Incinerators             0         3.98           O       162.24           93.65
                   Open Burning                  57.43        28.85         3.29     1,288.66          233.SO
                   On-Site  Incineration           75.66         9.89           O       497.43          3O7.43

                Total  Annual                     446.16       721.01       733.15     7,705.35        6,7OO.41

                   Capital                       189.09       274.7O       279.18     3.O46.92        2,602.15
                      Municipal  Incinerators       9.36        21.77        22.13       223.63          198.21
                      Open Burning              123.93       147.71       151.35     1,757.43        1.43O.53
                      On-Site Incineration       55.7O       105.22       1O5.7O     1.O65.86          9-73.35

                   O&M                          257.O7       446.31       453.97     4,658.43        4.O98.26
                      Municipal  Incinerators      24.88        41.4O        41.31       458.11          397.39
                      Open Burning              171.24       3O2.57       318.57     3,125.32        2,763.58
                      On-Site Incineration       6O.95       1O2.34        94.O9     1,075.OO          937.29

-------
SEWAGE SLUDGE INCINERATION INDUSTRY

Operating Characteristics and  Capacities.  Incineration  is
one  of several methods currently practiced for the disposal
of sludges accumulated by  the  municipal  sewage  treatment
plants.  There are four types of sewage sludge incinerators:

  •  Multiple-hearth
  •  Fluidized bed
  •  Flash drying
  •  Cyclonic-type.

The majority of existing  installations  are  the  multiple-
hearth  type.   The  capacity  distribution of sewage sludge
incinerators in 1968 is shown below:
Number of
Installations

     51
     103
     27
      7
 Capacity
 Range,
 Metric
 TPDi (dry
 solids)

 0.27-  9.1
 9.2 - 45.3
45.4 - 90.7
90.8 -272.0
Capacity
Metric
TPD (dry
solids)

   270
 2,132
 1,705
 1,214
             Average
             Cap.
             Metric
Total        TPD(dry
Capacity{%)  solids)
 27.13
 54.79
 14.36
  3.72
  5.3
 20.7
 63.4
173.4
     188                           5,321      100.00

   TPD  is  the  abbreviation  for  tons per day.
 Emission Sources and  Pollutants.  Particulate  emissions   from
 uncontrolled sewage-sludge  incinerators  range from.32 grains
 per  DSCM  (dry  standard  cubic   meter)  for  multiple-hearth
 type,  and  282  gr  per   DSCM   for    fluidized-bed   type
 incinerators.      Particulate    emissions   from   existing
 facilities contrplled by wet scrubbers range   from  0.35  to
 2.12 gr per DSCM, with an average value  of 1.45 gr per  DSCM.
 New  source  performance standards proposed by EPA limit the
 particulate emissions at no more  than  1.09 gr per DSCM.

 Control Technology and Costs. All sewage sludge incinerators
 in the United States  are equipped with   wet  scrubbers   that
 have  varying  collection  efficiency.    The  scrubbers  range
 from low-energy types, with pressure drops in the  range  of
                            2-217

-------
2.5  to  6  inches of water, to high-energy scrubbers with a
pressure drop of 18 inches of water.

Control  estimates  of  particulate  emissions  from  sewage
sludge incinerators were based on the following assumptions:

  1. Incinerator operating schedules  are  3,640  hours  per
     year  for installations with capacities in the range of
     0.3 to 45 metric tons per day, and 8,736 hours per year
     for installations with capacities in the range of  45.1
     to 272 metric tons per day.

  2. The  majority  of  the   existing   installations   are
     controlling  particulate emissions to about 90 percent,
     or 1.5 kg per metric ton.

  3. To meet State implementation Plans, existing facilities
     were to be upgraded  by  1975  to  control  particulate
     emissions  to  no  more  than 2 kg per metric ton.  New
     facilities will be controlled to an emission  level  of
     no more than 0.8 kg per metric ton.

Table 3-36-1 details the investment, annual costs, and total
cash  requirements  for  the  industry  along with operating
statistics.
                           2-218

-------
to
to
(-»
vo
                                     Table 3-36-1.
                    Sewage Sludge Incineration Industry Data Summary
              ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                                     1975
                                                                 198O
                Capacity (MT/Day)                    14.26O      25,293
                Annual Growth Rate Over the Period  1976-85 = 8.16%
                                                              1985

                                                              33,899
PROCESS CHARACTERISTICS

  Incineration

EMISSIONS  (LOCO MT/Yr)

  1971 Controls:

     PartIculates

  Legislated Controls:

     Participates .

CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

  Investment

  Total Annual
     Capital
     O&M
Model Plant Sizes
(MT/Day)
Pollutants Controlled
5. 28; 21 ; 63;
178
1975
38
19
)i
13
15
1O
5
.58
.58
.22
.74
.09
.65

Part
198O
68
11
6
36.
21 .
14.
.94
.27
. 1O
.05
,54
51
iculates
1985
92.36
1O. 78
5.93
44.O2
24.68
19.34
Control Technology

Wet Scrubbers
                                                                                        1971-85
                                                                                                        1976-85
                                                                                           186.3O

                                                                                           382.O2
                                                                                           228.60
                                                                                           153.42
                                                               111.40

                                                               346.16
                                                               2O4.3O
                                                               141.86
                These costs are not Included In the municipal water pollution control  cost estimates
                m Section Three.

-------
GRAIN HANDLING INDUSTRY

Production Characteristics  and  Capacities.  Traditionally,
grain  handling  is  considered  in terms of  series of  grain
storage facilities starting from the delivery by  the  farmer
and  ending  with  the  ultimate  user.  These grain  storage
facilities or grain elevators,  provide  storage  space  and
serve  as collection, transfer, drying, and cleaning  points.
There are two  main  classifications  of  grain   elevators—
country  and  terminal elevators.  Country elevators  receive
grains from nearby farms by truck for storage or  shipment to
terminal elevators or processors.  Terminal elevators  (this
category  is subdivided into  inland and port  terminals),  are
generally larger than country elevators and are   located  at
significant   transportation   or   trade  centers.   Inland
terminals receive, store, handle, and load these  grains  in
rail  cars  or  barges  for   shipment  to processors  or port
locations.  Port terminals receive grain and  load ships   for
export  to  foreign  countries.   It  has  been   noted  that
particulate emission is a function of  both   the  amount  of
grain  handled and the operations involved in handling..   The
cost of equipment for emission control is a function  of   the
size of the facility and operations involved.  Consequently,
model  sizes for the types of operations and size of  country
elevators, inland terminals and  port  terminals  have  be.en
selected,  ranging  from  0   to  70 thousand kiloliters (dry
measure), 70 to  700  thousand  kiloliters,  and  0.7   to  7
million  kiloliters.   it  should  be  noted  that  very  few
country elevators fall within the second range,  while  s.ome
inland terminal elevators may fall within the first capacity
range.

Using  data  for  the  number  and storage capacities of the
country and terminal elevators by states as of September 30
1972, size ranges and number of facilities  per  size  range
are estimated in Table 3-37-1.
                           2-220

-------
                       Table 3-37-1.
                  Grain Handling Industry
              Facilities Production Capacities
Ranges
(thousand
kl/yr)

  0-70
 70-700
700-7,000
Total
volume
Handled
(million Total     NO. of
kl/yr)   volume(%) Facilities
 217
  70.9
 103
55.5
18.1
26.4
7,147
  413
   64
 Average
 volume
 (thousand
 Kl/yr)

   30.4
  171.6
1.615
Totals
 390.9   100.0
           7,624
Emission  Sources  and Pollutants. Grain handling includes a
variety of operations which emit differing  amounts  of  air
pollutants,   primarily   particulates.    The  particulates
consist of attrition of the grain kernels and dirt.   Hence,
the  amount  of  the  dust (particulates) emitted during the
various grain handling operations depends  on  the  type  of
grain  being handled, the quality or grade of the grain, the
moisture content  of  the  grain,  the  speed  of  the  belt
conveyors  used  to  transport the grain, and the extent and
the efficiency of dust-collecting system being used, such as
hoods and sheds.

Control  Technology  and  Costs.  Systems  used  to  control
particulate emissions from grain handling operations consist
of  either  extensive hooding and aspiration systems leading
to a dust collector or methods for eliminating emissions  at
the  source.  Techniques which eliminate the sources of dust
emissions or which retain it in  the  process  are  enclosed
conveyors,   covers   on   bins,   tanks  and  hoppers,  and
maintenance of the  system's  internal  pressure  below  the
external pressure so that airflow is directed in rather than
out of the openings.

Control  methods  are  also available to capture and collect
the dust entrained  or  suspended  in  the  air.   The  dust
collection  systems  generally  used are cyclones and fabric
filters.

in order to meet the emission standards, it is assumed  that
(except  for  grain drying) fabric filters will be installed
                           2-221

-------
in  all  existing  plants  that  do  not  have  them  or  as
replacements for cyclones and other control devices.

Table  3-37-2 shows the future estimated sales of grains and
the volume of grain handled by the two types of elevators.
                            2-222

-------
to
to
                                        Table 3-37-2.
                             Grain  Handling  Industry Data  Summary
                 ACTIVITY  LEVEL
                                                       1975
                                                                   1980
                   Capacity  (1OS  Liters/Yr)            497.13       562.73
                   Annual  Growth  Rate  Over  the  Period  1976-85  =  2.82%
                 PROCESS  CHARACTERISTICS

                 Grain  Elevator

                 EMISSIONS  (1.OOO  MT/Yr)

                   1971 Controls:

                     Particulates

                   Legislated  Controls:

                     Particulates

                 CONTROL  COSTS (Million  1975 $)

                   Investment

                   Total  Annual
                     Capital
                     O&M
Model Faci1ity Size
(1O' Liters/Yr)
      1985

     641.79



Pollutants Controlled   Control  Technology
35:21O; 1.75O
1975
1 .024.48
423.55
)
7O1 .06
187.42
167.39
20- O3
1980
1 , 192.54
24.53
87. OS
329.79
292 . 09
37. 7O
Part 1 culates
1985
1.353.32
27.89
51 .40
362.89
326.04
36.85
Baghouse
1971-85 1976-
2.978.52 1.205.35
3,666.63 3,316.75
3,269.14 2,962.16
397.49 354.58

-------
DRY CLEANING INDUSTRY

Production  Characteristics  and   Capacities.   There   are
basically  two  types  of  dry cleaning installations,- those
using synthetic  solvents,  such  as  perchlorethylene,  and
those using petroleum solvents, such as Stoddard.  The trend
in  dry cleaning operations today is toward smaller-packaged
installations located  in  shopping  centers  and  surburban
districts.  These installations use synthetic solvents while
the  older, larger commercial plants still use the petroleum
solvents.  It is estimated that approximately 55 percent  of
dry-cleaning is accomplished by synthetic solvents, with the
remaining  45  percent  accomplished  by petroleum solvents.
NOW that the small, older petroleum solvent plant  is  being
replaced  by  synthetic  plants,  it  is  estimated  that 80
percent of the dry-cleaning in  1980  will  be  accomplished
using  synthetic  solvents.   The  larger, commercial plants
using petroleum solvents will comprise only  20  percent  of
the market.

Emissions  Sources  and  Pollutants. Older synthetic solvent
plants, which are using separate vessels  for  cleaning  and
drying,  emit about 105 kg of hydrocarbons per metric ton of
textiles.  The modern synthetic solvent plants  combine  the
cleaning  and  drying  operation  utilizing  one  vessel,  a
tumbler that is equipped with a condenser for vapor  solvent
recovery.   Emissions  from  the  single-vessel unit average
about 47 kg per metric ton of  textiles.   Plants  utilizing
activated-carbon   absorption   systems  for  further  vapor
recovery can reduce the emissions to 38 kg  per  metric  ton
for the older plants, and about 25 kg per metric ton for the
modern  plants.   These emissions can be reduced further (by
30 to 50 percent)  by  well-maintained  equipment  and  good
operating procedures by personnel.

Emissions  from  petroleum-solvent  plants can be as high as
154 kg of solvent per  metric  ton  of  textiles.   Although
there   are  adsorption  units  commercially  available  for
petroleum-solvent machines,  none  have  been  installed  to
date.   However, it is estimated that these adsorption units
are capable of recovering as  much  as  95  percent  of  the
evaporated petroleum solvents.

Control  Technology  and  Costs.  The  dry cleaning industry
contributes to air pollution  by  the  release  of  organic-
solvent  vapors  to  the  atmosphere.  The amount of solvent
emitted to the atmosphere from any one dry cleaning plant is
dependent upon the equipment design solvent used, the length
of  certain  operations  in  the   cleaning   process,   the
precautions   used  by  the  operating  personnel,  and  the
quantity of clothes cleaned.  The most  important  of  these
                           2-224

-------
items are the precautions used and the weight of the clothes
cleaned.   Because of the higher capital investment required
for emission controls on  petroleum-solvent  plants,  it  is
believed  that  all  new plants will use synthetic solvents,
and that 50 percent of the petroleum-naptha  solvent  plants
will shut down or convert to synthetic solvent operations by
1980,   Futhermore, increasing solvent costs will provide an
incentive for better evaporative emission control.

Annualized control costs and industry  operating  statistics
are detailed in Table 3-38-1.
                            2-225

-------
to
M
N>
                                        Table 3-38-1.
                              Dry Cleaning Industry Data Summary
                 ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                                       1975
                                                                   198O
                   Capacity (Million MT/Yr)             1.29        1.74
                   Annual Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-85 = 4.94%
                                                              1985

                                                               2.05
PROCESS CHARACTERISTICS

Synthetic Solvents
Petroleum Solvents
Switch from Petroleum to
  Synthetic
Model Plant Size
(MT/Yr)

57
1O6
1O6
                 EMISSIONS (1.OOO MT/Yr)

                   1971 Controls:

                      Hydrocarbons

                   Legislated Controls:

                      Hydrocarbons

                 CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

                   Investment

                   Total  Annual
                      Capi tal
                      O&M
                                      1975
                                     161.47
                                      96.09
                                      49.48

                                      2O.32
                                      2O. 32
                                          O
Pollutants Controlled   Control Technology
                                                                   Hydrocarbons
                                                                   Hydrocarbons
                                                                   Hydrocarbons
                                                  198O        1985
                                                 187. 13
                                                  74.65
                      6.01

                     31 . 13
                     31 . 13
                         0
                                                             184.49
                                                              92.42
             2.32

            33.44
            33.44
                0
                        Carbon Absorber
                        Carbon Absorber
                        Process Switch
                                                                          1971-85        1976-85
242.65

346.39
346.39
     O
 8O.44

3O2.74
3O2.74
     O

-------
INDUSTRIAL AND COMMERCIAL HEATING

Operating  Characteristics  and  Capacities. The majority of
commerical and industrial heating  is  accomplished  by  hot
water  and  steam  boilers.   Although  hot air  furnaces are
utilized for space heating, these units are fired on gas  or
distillate   oil   and  they  generally  do  not  contribute
significantly regional air pollution.

Commercial  equipment  normally  is  defined  as  having    a
capacity  in  the  range  of 0.05 to 2.11 million kg cal per
hour.  Industrial equipment normally is defined  as equipment
having a capacity in the range 2.11 to 169  million  kg  cal
per  hour.  These ranges are loosely defined and in practice
they often  overlap,-  the  equipment  size  distribution  by
location and fuel type is not available.

The  estimated   1974  installed  capacity  of commercial and
industrial boilers is 10 x 1015  kg cal per year  based  upon  a
1967 inventory  and assumed growth rates of 4.5   percent  per
year   for  commercial  units  and  4  percent  per  year for
industrial units.

Emission   sources  and   Pollutants.  Pollutants  emitted   by
fossil-fuel  combustion  are a  function of  fuel  composition,
efficiency of   combustion,  and the   specific    combustion
equipment  being used.  Particulate  levels  are related  to the
ash  content  of  the   fuel,  and   sulfur  oxides  levels are
related  to the  sulfur  content of the   fuel.   Emissions  of
nitrogen   oxides  result  not only  from the  high-temperature
reaction   of   atmospheric   nitrogen   and   oxygen    in  the
combustion  zone,   but   also  from  partial  combustion  of  the
nitrogenous  compounds  contained in  the   fuel;   thus,   levels
are   dependent   both on  combustion  equipment  design  and upon
 fuel    nitrogen.    Carbon   monoxide,    hydrocarbon,     and
particulate   levels   are  dependent   on  the   efficiency   of
 combustion as  it is  affected by combustion equipment   design
 and   operation.  Accordingly,  natural  gas  and distillate  oil
 are  considered  clean fuels because   of   their  low  ash  and
 sulfur  contents,   and  also because  they  are relatively easy
 to burn.   In contrast,  coal  (and some  residual  oils)  contain
 significant   amounts  of  sulfur  and   ash,    require   more
 sophisticated  combustion  equipment,  and are more difficult
 to burn than the clean fuels.

 The estimated  uncontrolled  emission  factors  and  average
 emission  factors,  as  required by the State Implementation
 Plans (SIP)   for  commercial  and  industrial  boilers,  are
 listed below and they are based on the following assumptions
 and conditions:
                            2-227

-------
  e  The  sulfur  contents  of;  coal/  residual   oil,   and
     distillate  oil are assumed to be 3, 2, and 0.2 percent
     by weight, respectively.

  »  The ash content of coal is assumed to be 12 percent  by
     weight.

  «  The difference in particulate emissions factors between
     commercial and  industrial  coal-burning  installations
     probably is related to differences in equipment design.

In  the  following  tabulation  of  emissions  factors,  the
factors  within  parenthesis  indicate  those  required   or
allowed by SIP where applicable:
          Emission Factors (kg per million kg cal)

Commercial          Particulates         Sulfur Oxides

Coal                   1.8                    8.6
                      (1.08)                 (5.8)

Residual Oil           0.29                   4.0
                      (1.08)                 (2.0)

Distillate Oil         0.18                   0.36
                      (1.08)                 (0.43)

Gas                    0.032                  0.0011
                      (1.08)

industrial

Coal                  11.7                    8.6
                      (0.63)                 (5.7)

Residual Oil           0.29                   4.0
                      (0.63)                 (2.0)

Distillate Oil         0.18                   0.36
                      (0.63)                 (0.43)

Gas                    0.031                  0.0011
                      (0.63)
Control  Technology and Costs. It is apparent that equipment
fired with gas and distillate oil essentially meets  all  of
                           2-228

-------
the  air  pollution  regulations.   The  most cost-effective
control technology has been switching from  coal  and  high-
sulfur  residual  oil  to  the  less-polluting  fuels.   The
current shortages and projected price rises for natural  gas
and  distillate  oils,  and the proposed ban on switching to
these fuels will require  implementation  of  other  control
technologies in many cases.

Estimates  of control costs are based on the assumption  that
for commercial boilers, fuel switching from coal  and  high-
sulfur   residual   oil   to   low-sulfur  residual  oil  is
attainable, and that for industrial boilers, fuel  switching
from  high-sulfur residual oil to low-sulfur residual oil is
attainable.  Alternative control technologies for coal-fired
industrial  boilers  include  dual  alkaline  scrubbers  for
sulfur  oxides and particulates control.  For the coal-fired
boilers, flue gas treatment appears plausible for the larger
units,  while  fuel  switching  appears  realistic   for  the
smaller  ones.  However, because no boiler size distribution
was  available  at  this  time,  all  industrial  coal-fired
boilers  were  assumed  to  be using  flue gas treatment  as  a
control  technology;  this  assumption  will  overstate  the
control costs.

Because of the present  instability and future uncertainty of
fuel  prices,  no  attempt  was made  to account for  the  cost
differential among fuels.  On a Btu or heating value basis,
there   could  be  little  difference  in costs.  Although it
appears that the cost of coal and high-sulfur  residual  oil
would   be  lower  than  the cost of the clean fuels  prior to
firing  in  a  boiler,  the higher costs  of  handling  the   coal
and    high-sulfur  residual  oil,  as well  as  the higher
equipment  maintenance costs, are judged to offset any  price
differential.    The  net effect of these considerations would
produce virtually equivalent   fuel  costs  on  a  consistent
basis.

The .estimated control  costs  for  the model heating plants are
given  in Table  3-39-1.   Investments and annualized costs are
considerably    lower    for    commercial   than   industrial
installations because of the relative ease of fuel switching
compared   to the  use   of   sophisticated   flue-gas   cleanup
systems.
                            2-229

-------
                                       Table 3-39-1.
                   Industrial & Commercial  Heating Industry Data Summary
                ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                                      1975
                                                                  198O
                                                                              1985
                  Capacity (MT/Hr)
                     Industrial                     301,637     386.962     455,758
                     Commercial                     13O.471     141,737     171,532
                  AnnuaJ  Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-85 = Industrial  5.O5%
                                                               Commercial  4.4O%
                PROCESS CHARACTERISTICS

                  Industrial
                  Commercial
Model Plant Sizes

N/A
N>
                EMISSIONS (1.OOO MT/Yr)

                  1971  Controls:

                     Combustion of  Coal:
                        Part iculates
                        Sulfur  Oxides
                        Nitrogen Oxides
                        Hydrocarbons
                        Carbon  Monoxide

                     Combustion of  Oil:
                        Part i culates
                        Sulfur  Oxides
                        Nitrogen Oxides
                        Hydrocarbons
                        Carbon  Monoxide

                     Combustion of  Natural  Gas:
                        Part iculates
                        Sulfur  Oxides
                        Nitrogen  Oxides
                        Hydrocarbons
                        Carbon  Monoxide
         1975
Pollutants Generated

Particulates
Sulfur Oxides
Nitrogen Oxides
Hydrocarbons
Carbon Monoxide
                     198O
                                 1985
2
3




3








, 192
,644
7O9
44
113
3O2
.767
835
42
56
78.
3
858
21
94
. 12
.91
.71
.54
.78
.47
.63
. 15
.01
.07
.02
.39
.69
.78
.68
3.O2O
4,977
979
59
151
398
4,975
1 ,O97
55
73
1 17.
4 .
1 .01 1 .
27,
1 14 ,
.69
.24
.03
. 1O
.46
.56
.44
.84
. 17
.74
.77
.06
.36
.33
.27
3,753
5,898
1 , 158
71
18O
46O
5,8O8
1,276
64
85
129
4
1 ,099
31
126
.83
,31
-O8
.09
.32
. 1O
.50
. 14
.76
.75
.89
.47
.42
.06
.45
Control Technology

ESP & FGD
Fuel Switching
                                             1971-85
                                                            1976-85

-------
                                             Table  3-39-1.  (Continued)
                               Industrial & Commercial Heating  Industry Data Summary
to
EMISSIONS (1.OOO MT/Vr)

     Combustion of Distilled Oil:
        Partloulates
        Sulfur Oxides
        Nitrogen Oxides
        Hydrocarbons
        Carbon Monoxide

  Legislated Controls:

     Combustion of Coal:
        Particulates
        Sulfur Oxides
        Nitrogen Oxides
        Hydrocarbons
        Carbon Monoxide

     Combustion of 011:
        Partlculates
        Sulfur Oxides
        Nitrogen Oxides
        Hydrocarbons
        Carbon Monoxide

     Combustion of Natural  Gas:
        Partlculates
        Sulfur Oxides
        Nitrogen Oxides
        Hydrocarbons
        Carbon Monoxide

     Combustion of Distilled Oil:
        Part iculates
        Sulfur Oxides
        Nitrogen Oxides
        Hydrocarbons
        Carbon Monoxide
                                                                   1975
                                                                               198O
                                                                                           1985
58. SO
117. OO
233.84
12.28
16.38
1,O2O. 85
2,837.62
736.38
45.72
116.38
314. 11
3,938.61
8O4 . 4O
43.48
58. 03
101 .21
3.51
893.65
22.44
98. 16
58. 9O
1 1 7 . SO
241.49
12.37
16.49
83. SO
167. O1
342.37
17.54
23.38
242.39
1 ,755.62
1.O15.52
61 .37
154.91
4O9 . 79
5, 184.42
91 1 .87
56. 5O
75.38
121 .06
4. 18
1,043.56
27.87
117.37
83. 2O
166. 4O
341. 13
17.47
23. 3O
1O2.7O
205 . 4 1
421. O9
21 .57
28.76
288. O6
1 ,972.63
1 . 186.65
72.29
182.97
477 . 92
6.O68. 11
1.055.23
64.99
86.78
132.55
4.57
1 , 125.72
31 .47
128.92
1O2.42
2O4 . 84
419.92
21 .51
28.67

-------
N>
N>
U>
to
                                   Table 3-39-1.  (Continued)
                     Industrial  & Commercial  Heating Industry Data Summary
EMISSIONS (1,000 MT/Yr)

CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

  Investment
     Industrial
     Commercial

  Total Annual
     Capital
        Industr ial
        Commercial
     O&M
        Industr ial
        Commercial
1975
            198O
1985
1 ,737
722
1 ,71O,
1 ,O33,
796
237
S77
269
4O7
.97
.31
.83
.31
. 19
. 12
.52
.79
.73


2
1
1

1


153.
350,
,94O.
,768.
,39O.
378.
,172.
5O5.
666.
55
60
86
67
25
.42
. 19
29
9O
141 .
83.
3 , 269 .
1,896.
1,455.
441
1 ,372
565,
8O6,
,O4
.00
.45
.69
.48
.21
.76
.87
.89
1 1
3
32
19
14
4
13
5
7
,O12.
,756.
,O77.
,O73.
,924.
, 148
,OO3
.446
,556
19
.23
.26
.51
.53
.98
.75
.88
.87
6,
1 ,
28,
16,
13,
3,
1 1 ,
4,
6,
537 .22
737.49
259.99
762. OO
124 .39
637 .61
497.99
85O. 12
647 .87

-------
Chapter 4
Mobile Source Pollution Control
            1.  MOBILE SOURCE EMISSION CONTROLS

Introduction

Mobile sources are recognized as significant contributors to
national   air-quality   problems.    In  areas  subject  to
photochemical smog formation, over half  the  reactants  can
generally   be   attributed   to   motor-vehicle  emissions.
Similarly, motor-vehicle emissions  frequently  cause  large
concentrations  of  carbon  monoxide in high-traffic-density
urban areas during traffic peaks.  In cities with large  and
busy  commercial airports, aircraft operations are often the
source of high  levels  of  carbon  monoxide,  hydrocarbons,
nitrogen  oxides,  and  particulates  in the vicinity of the
runways and terminals.

Passenger  cars  and  light-duty  trucks  have  been  highly
significant   and  visible  pollutant  sources because of the
large numbers in  service.   Consequently,  they  have  been
under  Federal  controls  since  the  1968  models.  Federal
controls on heavy-duty motor vehicles engines have  been  in
effect  since 1970, and controls on aircraft emissions went
into effect in 1974.

Other mobile  sources, such as railroad  locomotives,  marine
engines,  and farm, construction, and garden equipment, have
been under study by EPA, but to  date,  no  regulations   for
these sources have been promulgated or proposed.  Motorcycle
emissions  control regulations become effective in  1978, but
cost factors  were not developed soon enough to  be  included
in  this report.
 Review of  Recent Factors
 Affecting  Mobile Sources
 The  oil  crisis  of  late 1973  and early 1974 resulted in a
 trend toward smaller cars and increased  gasoline prices.   It
 also resulted in increased emphasis on fuel   economy,   which
 has   affected  the  present   and  future emission  control
 strategies.

 The recession of late 1974 resulted i* a  drastic  reduction
 in  new-car  sales for the last half of 1974-,  which continued
 into 1975.
                            2-233

-------
The Energy Supply  and  Environmental  Coordination  Act  of
1974i/  passed  by  Congress  on  June  22, 1974, included a
provision which delayed the scheduled 1976 and 1977 emission
standards.  With less stringent emission standards for these
2 years, the cost and fuel  consumption  penalties  will  be
less than estimated in the last cost of Clean Air Report.
The  changes in light- and heavy-duty truck regulations  call
for trucks in these  two  classes  to  meet  more  stringent
emissions   standards.   The   light  truck  class  has   been
enlarged to include all  trucks  under  8,500  pounds  gross
vehicle  weight.    (The  prior  definition applied to trucks
under 6,000 pounds.)
As provided  for  in  the  1970 Clean Air  Act   and  Amendments,
the auto companies  filed requests for  suspension of  the  1977
emission  standards early in January  of  1975.  The  decision
was made to  grant the request for  suspension  of  the   1977
hydrocarbon  and  carbon monoxide emission  standards, and  to
establish interim standards for  the  1977  model year  at  the
level of the current 1975-76 hydrocarbon  and carbon  monoxide
standards.   The 1977  legislated nitrogen  oxide standard  of
2.0 grams per  mile  (g./mile) was not affected.

The   1977  amendments   to  the   Clean  Air   Act    call    for
maintaining  1977 standards through the 1979 model  year.   The
CO  standards   are   7.0 in 1980  and  3.4  for 1981-85.  NOx  is
set at  1.0  for 1980-85, and HC at 0.41 for  the same  period.
 Light-Duty vehicle Controls

 EMISSION STANDARDS

 Since 1968, the Federal  Government  has regulated the  output
 of  air  pollutants from the exhaust of new light-duty motor
 vehicles.  Emission standards  are   expressed  in  terms  of
 maximum  levels of gaseous emissions per mile permitted from
 the vehicle while operating  on  a   prescribed  duty  cycle.
 Sampling  procedures  and test equipment are also prescribed
 by the regulations.

 Both emission levels and test procedures have  been  revised
 periodically  in  several  steps  of  increasing stringency.
 Changes in the Federal Test Procedure were  implemented  for
 the  1972  and 1975 model years.  Changes in emission levels
 were prescribed by the Environmental Protection  Agency  (or
 its  predecessors)  for 1970 and 1973 (nitrogen oxides), and
                            2-234

-------
were based  largely  on  evolving  technology  for  emission
control.

The  1970  Amendments  to  the  Clean Air Act called for the
Administrator to prescribe Federal  emission  standards  for
1975  and later year models effecting a 90 percent reduction
in the hydrocarbon and carbon monoxide emissions  from  1970
levels,  and to prescribe the Federal standards for 1976 and
later year  models  effecting  a  90  percent  reduction  in
nitrogen   oxide  emissions  from  1971  levels.   The  1970
Amendments further gave the Administrator the  authority  to
grant  a  1-year  suspension  of the 1975 and 1976 standards
under specified conditions if it could be  established  that
effective   control   technology   was   not  available  for
compliance.

After extensive hearings in March  1973,  the  Administrator
found  that,  although  the  necessary technology existed to
meet  the  1975  standards  through  the  use  of  catalytic
converters,   there   was   a  high  degree  of  uncertainty
concerning the industry's ability  to  certify  and  produce
catalyst-equipped  cars  in  1975 in large enough numbers to
meet production requirements for their full model line.   in
addition,  in-use  reliability of the catalysts had not been
established.  Because of this, it was found that the risk of
introducing catalysts on all vehicles in 1975 outweighed the
risk to human health if the  standards  were  delayed.   The
suspension was applied in two parts:

  «  National 1975 interim standards were established  which
     were  more  strict  than standards previously in force,
     but which were not anticipated to  necessarily  require
     catalysts on the majority of vehicles sold.

  •  More stringent standards were allowed for vehicles sold
     only in California, which would  require  catalysts  on
     cars  sold  in that state.  Under the California waiver
     provision in the Clean Air Act, the state was permitted
     to establish its own  hydrocarbon  and  nitrogen  oxide
     standards.   A  Federal standard that is more stringent
     than  that  applicable  to  cars  sold  elsewhere   was
     prescribed for carbon monoxide.

The  1975 statutory standards as originally established were
to be applicable to all cars sold in the  United  States  in
1976.

Similarly,  the  Administrator  suspended  the statutory NOx
standards for 1976 and later models, on July 31, 1973.  This
decision was based on the belief that technological  success
in  meeting  the  1976  statutory  standards  could  not  be
                           2-235

-------
reasonably predicted.   In  applying  this  suspension,  the
Administrator  established an interim nitrogen oxide Federal
standard of 2.0 g./mile, which is attainable  with  existing
advanced emission-control technology.

Finally,  the aforementioned Energy Supply and Environmental
Coordination Act of 1974 and  the  1977  amendments  to  the
Clean  Air  Act further delayed the light duty passenger car
requirements, as shown in Table 1-1.
                          2-236

-------
                                Table 1-1.
              Federal  Exhaust Emission Standards and Control
              Levels for Light-Duty Vehicles'  by Model  Year

                   Under 6,OOO-lb Gross Vehicle Weight
N>
to
w
Type of
Vehicle
                 Pre-19688         197O              1973/1974         1975/1976         1977/1979               198O/19853
                 HC    CO    NOx   HC    CO    NOx   HC    CO    NOx   HC    CO    NOx   HC    CO    NOx   HC    CO    NOx
       Light-duty
       gasoline
       passenger car    8.7   87     4.0   4.1    34

       Light-duty
       dlesel
       passenger car
       Light-duty
       gasoll$e
       truck

       Light-duty
       diesel
       truck
                                                            Emissions  expressed  in  grams  per  mile
                                                     3.O   28    3.1   1.5   15    3.1    1.5   15    2.O   O.41  3.4'  1.O1
                                                                       1.5   15    3.1    1.5   15    2.O   O.41  3.4   1.O
                                                     3-O   28    3.1   2.0   2O    3.1   2.O   20    3.1   2.O"  2O*   3.1
                                                                              2.O    2O     3.1    2.O    2O     3.1    2.O*   20    3.1
       1   Emission levels as measured on the 1975  FTP.
       '   Estimated levels before controls.
       1   1980 standards for CO are 7.O,  and for NOx  are  2.0
       *   Standards assumed are those used for determining  cost  of  compliance  in
          this report.   Actually promulgated standards  for  1979  and later model
          years are HC  = 1.7,  CO = 18,  NOx = 2.3 grams  per  mile.

-------
PASSENGER CARS

Control Devices/ 1968-1974 Model Years. From  1968  to   1974,
compliance  with  Federal emission standards  was achieved by
utilizing various combinations of the  followings

  •  Purging of crankcase fumes through the engine

  •  Recalibration and tighter precision of carburetor   fuel
     metering

  •  Engine intake air preheat and temperature control

  •  Spark retard at idle and low speeds

  •  Reduced   compression   ratios    and   elimination   of
     combustion chamber pockets

  •  Air injection into the exhaust manifold

  •  Changes in valve timing and  recirculation  of  exhaust
     gases

  •  Capture  of  fuel  evaporative  emissions  in  charcoal
     canisters or in the crankcase.

Table   1-2   summarizes  the  EPA  and  HAS  estimates  for
incremental cost increases per car due to  emission  control
requirement  for the period 1968 to 1974.  These data,  taken
from the 1974 Cost of Clean Air  Report f  are  expressed  in
current dollars.

Estimates  of  the  aggregate  initial-equipment  or  engine
modification costs per car for emission control through  1974
(expressed in December 1974 dollars) are $100 (EPA) and  $84
(NAS).  industry estimates for that same period are $50-$120
(expressed in December 1974 dollars).
                           2-238

-------
                         Table 1-2.
             Estimated Passenger Car Emission-
              Control Equipment Cost, 1968-74

Model                                       List Price1
Year                   item                 EPAZ
1968-69    Positive crankcase ventilation   $ 0.40   $ 2.85
           (PCV) valve

           Inlet air temperature control      5.00     3.80

           Cumulative cost through 1969     $ 5.40   $ 6.65

1970-72    Fuel evaporation control system   13.50    14.30

           Idle control solenoid             11.10     4.75

           Carburetor changes                 3.00     0.95

           Hardened valves and  seats  (for     2.00     1.90
           unleaded gasoline)

           Transmission control system         —      3.80

           ignition timing                     —      0.95

           Choke heat bypass                   —      4.18

           Compression ratio changes           —      1.90

           Cumulative costs through 1972     $35.00   $39.38

 1973-74    Exhaust gas recirculation         26.00     9.50
            (EGR),  11-14 percent

           Speed controlled spark  timing     26.00     0.95

           Precision  cams,  bores,  pistons      —      3.80

           Transmission changes               —      0.95

           Cumulative costs through 1974     $87.00   $54.53

 i    List price   includes  both   dealer   and  manufacturers
      profits,  expressed in  current dollars.
 2  From  Reference  7.
 3  From  Reference  8.
                            2-239

-------
Control  Devices,  1975-1976  Model  Years.  When  the  1975
Statutory  Standards were suspended for 1 year* and replaced
with less stringent interim standards,  it  became  apparent
that two types of emission-control systems could be used  for
the  1975  model  year.  These were: (1) oxidation catalyst-
equipped systems,  and   12)  advanced  engine  modifications
systems.  The oxidation catalyst systems have been preferred
by  the  industry,  and approximately 85 percent of the 1975
model year sales  included  catalysts.   Other  changes   and
additions for some 1975 model-year cars included:

  •  Quick-heat manifold

  o  High-energy ignition

  •  Advanced carburetors

  •  Air injection.

Since the 1976 emission  standards*"*  called  for  the  same
hydrocarbon,  carbon  monoxide, and nitrogen oxide levels as
the 1975 interim standards, only minor changes  in  emission
control  systems  were  made from 1975 models.  Proportional
exhaust gas recirculation was introduced in some models.

Estimates of the initial equipment  or  engine  modification
costs  per  car  for  emission control for the 1975 and 1976
model years are $200 (EPA estimate in  1975  dollars),  $159
(NAS), and $100-$450 (Industry).

Control  Devices,  1977  Model  Year, with the suspension of
1977 emission standards on March 5, 1975, and the setting of
interim standards for hydrocarbon and carbon monoxide at  the
1975-76 levels, and nitrogen oxide at a level of 2.0 g./mile
(which is 35 percent lower  than  the  1975-76  level),   the
automobile  companies met the 1977 standards with only minor
modifications  to  engines  and  control   devices.    These
modifications  took  the  form of increased use of secondary
air for catalyst  operation,  improved  exhaust  gas  recir-
culation,   ignition   timing   modification,   or  modified
catalysts with decreased use  of  secondary  air.   EPA   has
estimated   the  incremental  cost  to  meet  1977  emission
standards at $15.

Control Devices, 1978 and 1979 Model Years.  Since  Congress
has  passed Clean Air Act Amendments calling for maintenance
of 1977  emission  levels  through  the  1979  model  years,
cumulative  control  costs per vehicle are maintained at  the
1977  level  for  their  cost  analyses.   This  results  in
significant  cost  reduction over previous 1978 standards at
the expense of increased emissions to the environment.
                           2-240

-------
In addition to the modifications applied earlier,  standards
would  require  application  of  a  three-way  (HC, CO, NOx)
catalyst, plus electronic control modules for the  following
items:   spark  control,  exhaust gas recirculation, air-to-
fuel  ratio,   and   air   injection.    Costs   for   these
modifications  would  vary  with  size  of  vehicles, engine
design, engine calibration, etc.   EPA's  estimate  of  1980
incremental  costs  for an "average" vehicle is $220 for 3.4
g/mi. CO or $163 for a 9 g/mi. CO standard (1974 dollars).

Summary of Estimated Emission Control Equipment Costs. Table
1-3 summaries the various  estimates  for  incremental  cost
increases  per  car due to emission control requirements for
the period 1968 to 1985; data in this  table  were  obtained
primarily from Reference 11.
                         Table 1-3.
          Estimated Passenger Car Emission-Control
           Equipment Costs,  1968-1980 Model Years
                     List Price*  (December  1974 Dollars}
Model  Year           EPA^         MAS*     Industry*

Cumulative  costs     100           84        50-120
through  1974«

1975/76  incremental  100           75        50-330
costs

1977 incremental      15
costs

1978 incremental       0           145       215-500
costs

1980 incremental
costs                220

Cumulative  costs     435*          304       315-950
through  1985

 i  List  price includes dealer and factory  profits.
2  From  data submitted by  the domestic manufacturers.
 s  Data  obtained  primarily from Reference  11.
 *  Restated from  Table 1-2 in 1974  dollars.
 s $456 in 1975 dollars.
                            2-241

-------
Estimated Maintenance Costs Due to  Emission  Controls.  The
additional  per  vehicle  maintenance  costs attributable to
emission-control devices has been estimated by EPA to be $16
per year from model years 1968 through 1974.  For the  1975,
1976,  and  1977  model years, there are certain benefits in
reduced maintenance cost derived from the use of high-energy
ignition systems, long-life exhaust  systems,  and  unleaded
fuel.   For  the 1975-77 model years, the annual maintenance
cost benefits are estimated to be $23 per  catalyst-equipped
car  over 1974 cars; thus, the net maintenance cost over the
pre-controlled cars is a $7 benefit.

Additional maintenance costs are anticipated  for  the  1980
and  later  model  years  because  of the greater complexity
expected in the emission control systems  required  to  meet
the  lower  hydrocarbon and carbon monoxide standards.  This
increase over 1975 cars is  estimated  to  be  $8  per  car,
resulting in a net annual maintenance cost of $1 per car, or
about  the same as pre-controlled cars.

Annual  maintenance  cost  penalties  for  the various model
years  are shown in Table 1-4.  The estimated costs for  1975
through   1977  are  based  on  assuming  that  85 percent of
vehicles  sold in the United States in  1975  were  catalyst-
equipped,  80  percent  in  1976,  and   75  percent in  1977.
Recent data show that use of  catalysts  in  1976  and  1977
remained  at the 85 per cent level.
                            2-242

-------
                         Table 1-4.
          Estimated Incremental Maintenance Costs
        for Passenger Car Emission Control Systems,
                   1968-1980 Model Years
              Annual Incremental Maintenance         Net
Model Year    Cost increase (Decrease) per vehicle*  costs

1968-74                      $16                     $16

1975-79                      (23)2                   (?)

1980-81                        73                     Q

1982-85                        0                      0

i Additional cost over normal maintenance due to emission
  control.  1968-74, current dollars- 1975-80, December
  1974 dollars.

2 Assuming oxidation catalysts used all  five model years,
  and based on 1975 interim standards (1.5 HC, 15 CO, 3.1
  NOX).

3 Assuming dual catalysts  (oxidation plus reduction)
  to be used, and based on HC, CO, and
  NOx levels of 0.41, 3.4, and 1.0.  One catalyst change
  in 10 years assumed.
FUEL-CONSUMPTION PENALTIES

The   average   fuel  economy  of  motor  vehicles   decreased
gradually  from  the  1968  through the  1974 model   cars.    This
change   can  be attributed to variations  in vehicle weight,
engine   size,   optional  equipment,   and   the    effects    of
emission-control  equipment.   in  particular,   the specific
emission-control  measures  that   adversely    affect    fu^l
consumption     are   retarded   ignition    timing,   reduced
compression  ratio,  and exhaust-gas recirculation.

Fuel  economy penalties for the 1968  to  1973 model years  wece
obtained from an EPA study of  passenger   car   fuel economy
involving  tests  of nearly 4,000 vehicles ranging  from  1957
production models to 1975 prototypes.   The fuel economy   for
1973  model  cars decreased over pre-1968  cars  by about  10.1
percent.  For   1974 models,   fuel   economy decreased   10.4
percent   from   the  pre-1968   baseline, based upon  estimates
                            2-243

-------
from 1974 certification data and" 1974  sales  data  for  the
first 6 months.  A shift toward, lighter cars was observed in
the first 6 months sales, but the trend was reversed for the
remainder of the year.

Various  industry  sources as well as the EPA have indicated
that catalytic systems on most  1975  vehicles  resulted  in
fuel economy superior to 1973 and 1974 model-year cars.  The
EPA-measured   fuel  economy  data  for  1975  certification
vehicles, when weighted for  the  estimated  vehicle  sales,
resulted  in  a  gain of 12.2 percent over 1974 models, or a
slight fuel economy benefit over pre-1968 baseline  data  of
approximately 1.0-2.0 percent.

An additional fuel economy improvement was shown in the 1976
model  year,  resulting in an estimated fuel economy gain of
about 12.8 percent over pre-1968 cars.  No  change  in  fuel
economy  is anticipated for the 1977 model year (when the NOx
standard  drops from 3.1 to 2.0 g./mile) due to the expected
extensive use  of  proportional  exhaust  gas  recirculation
(PEGR) and other technological improvements.

It   is   assumed that by adopting optimal-fuel strategies for
the  1980 model year that a fuel economy improvement of about
two  percent  will  occur   due   to   improved   combustion
conditions.

No   additional fuel economy gains or penalties are estimated
for  model years 1980 through  1985 due to emission  controls.
in   separate   efforts  to  improve'  fuel  economy,  the auto
companies are  reducing the size and weight  of  vehicles  in
their  existing  model   line,  improving  engine efficiency,
changing axle  ratios, and introducing new  lighter,  smaller
models.   These projects will raise the average fuel economy
of  all affected models,  regardless of the  potential   effect
of   pollution  controls.   The  principal  impetus for these
developments is the Energy Policy and Conservation Act (P.L.
94-163)  passed and signed in  December 1975 that required all
manufacturers  to  meet   fuel  economy  standards   (on  the
average)  of   18,  19 and 20 miles per gallon  for their 1978,
1979,  and 1980 models, respectively.  The effect of emission
controls on passenger-car fuel economy for the  period  1968
to   19S5 is summarized in Table  1-5.  Fuel economy data were
obtained from  References  12,  13, and  14,
                            2-244

-------
                         Table 1-5
               Effect of Emission Controls on
         Fuel Economy of the Average Passenger Car*
                       Change in MPG of the Model Year
Model Year                   Cars Due to Controls

1967                               0.0
1968                              -0.65
1969                              -0.28
1970                               0.34
1971                              -0.35
1972                              -0.22
1973                              -0.43
1974                              -0.04
1975                               1.87
1976                               1.89
1977                               0.0
1978                               0.0
1979                               0.0
1980                               0.0
1981                               0.0
1982                               0.0
1983                               0.0
1984                               0.0
1985                               0.0

i Baseline fuel economy of 1967 model year car  (combined
  cycle city-highway) = 15.5 mpg.  All percentages shown
  are based on Urban Cycle Fuel Economy tested  on the 1975
  EPA Federal Test Procedures.
                            2-245

-------
LIGHT-DUTY TRUCKS

For  this  report,  it  is  assumed  that  emission  control
equipment  costs  for  light-duty trucks are the same as  for
passenger cars for 1973 and 1974. .Beginning  with  the  1975
model year, less stringent standards vere set for light-duty
trucks  than for passenger cars.  Consequently  it is assumed
in this report that emission control costs for  model  years
1975-85  will  be  only  moderately  higher  ($150 per car  in
December 1974 dollars) than for the 1973-74 model years.

Annual maintenance costs for 1973 and  1974 model year light-
duty trucks are estimated to be $16 per  vehicle.   For   the
1975  to  1985 model year period, it is estimated that there
will be a maintenance cost benefit of  $5 per vehicle due   to
the   use  of  catalysts,  low-maintenance  emission-control
components, and unleaded fuel  in a  significant  portion   of
light-duty trucks sold in that period.

Fuel economy of light-duty trucks is expected to be the same
as   for light-duty passenger cars for  1973 and  1974.  A fuel
economy gain of 6 percent is estimated for  the  1975  model
year, and no change for the 1976 to 1985 period.

The  costs calculated in this  report all assume that current
regulations for light-duty  trucks  will  remain  the  same.
However,  EPA  recently  made  two  significant  changes   to
existing regulations beginning with  the  1979  model  year,
which  are  not analyzed in this report.  First, the size  of
the  light-duty truck class was increased  from  the  present
class  which  includes  all trucks with gross vehicle weight
ratings of 0 to 6,000 pounds to an expanded  class to include
all  trucks weighing between 0  and  8,500  pounds.   Second,
emissions  standards  for light trucks were  reduced slightly
from existing levels.  These changes tend  to   increase   the
cost estimates  made  in  this report for the  years 1978 to
1985.  All 6,000- to 8,500-pound trucks that  are  currently
considered  heavy-duty  trucks and  are  controlled to less
stringent  standards  must  be  equiped   with  additional
pollution  control  devices,   though   the  0  to 6,000-pound
trucks should not require any  additional equipment  to  meet
the  lower  standard.  No change in fuel economy is expected
due  to this action.
 FUEL  COST  INCREASES

 Two EPA  regulations   affecting   fuel   costs   are   discussed
 belpw.   One  pertains  to requiring gasoline  marketers  to make
 available  91   research  octane  number  lead-free gasoline  by
                            2-246

-------
July  1,  1974,  for  use  in  oxidation   catalyst-equipped
vehicles.   The  other EPA regulation required that the lead
content of leaded gasoline be reduced to an average  of  0.5
grams  per  gallon  (g./gal.)  by October 1979.  This latter
regulation, aimed at reducing lead  in  the  atmosphere  for
health  purposes,  was  recently  upheld  by  the  courts as
discussed earlier in this chapter.  Thus, for  the  purposes
of this report, it is assumed that lead phase-down will take
place  as  called  for  by  EPA.   The  promulgated schedule
stretches the lead removal over a relatively long period  of
time.
AGGREGATE NATIONAL COSTS FOR
LIGHT-DUTY VEHICLE EMISSION CONTROLS

Costs  to the nation for light-duty vehicle emission control
will  be  comprised   of   the   aggregate   of   equipment,
maintenance,    and    fuel-consumption    cost   increments
attributable to the  control  devices.   Since  the  various
costs  attributable  to  emission controls are different for
each model  year,  total  costs  to  the  nation  have  been
estimated  separately  for  each  model  year using vehicle-
population data  for  previous  years  and  projections  for
future years.

Vehicle   Population   Estimates.  Registration  data**  are
available at this time for vehicle model years  up  to  1974
for  each  calendar year through 1974.  Estimates of vehicle
populations  for  future  years  are  based  on   the   U.S.
passenger-vehicle  sales  projections17  shown in Table 1-6.
These projections reflect  the  major  downturn  in  new-car
sales which began late in 1973.  Using these projections and
typical  scrappage-rate  histories1»,*»  for  previous model
years, the vehicle population trends shown in Figure 1-1 are
estimated.  As shown, uncontrolled passenger  vehicles  will
constitute  only  about 5 percent of the population by 1980,
and 92 percent of the vehicles will have  been  manufactured
under  controls  imposed  by the Clean Air Act Amendments of
1970.
                           2-247

-------
                         Table 1-6.
              Historical and Projected Sales
                   of Passenger vehicles
                             Sales
Model Year                   (Millions of Vehicles)

1968                               9.40
1969                               9.53
1970                               8.46
1971                               9.96
1972                              10.61
1973                              11.46
1974                               8.9
1975                               8.6
1976                              10.7
1977                              10.4
1978                               9.1
1979                               9.8
1980                              11.8
1981                              12.6
1982                              12.5
1983                              12.6
1984                              12.8
1985                              12.3

Notes:

1.   1968 to 1973 sales data based on data from Automotive
     News 1974 Almanac Issue, April 24, 1974.

2.   1974 sales, Automotive News, March 3, 1975.

3.   1977-85 predicted sales from the Chase Econometric
     Associates study for EPA/CEQ, June 1977.
                           2-248

-------
                 Figure  1-1.
     Estimated Passenger-car Population
120
  1968     1970
1972       1974        1976
       CALENDAR YEAR
1978
                                                              1980
                  2-249

-------
in estimating light-duty truck  population,  it  is  assumed
that  survival factors for presently registered light trucks
will be slightly higher than those for passenger carszo/ and
that new registrations of light trucks will follow the  same
pattern as passenger cars for the interval 1974-85.

Estimated  Total  Costs,  1968-1985.  A  breakdown of annual
national cost estimates for passenger car  emission  control
is  presented  in  Table  1-7.   Equipment  costs  for  each
calendar year are taken as the equipment  cost  attributable
to  the  new model-year vehicles.  Maintenance and equipment
costs  for  each  calendar  year  are  attributable  to  all
controlled   vehicles   over   1-year  old  in  the  vehicle
population for that year.  Costs attributable to fuel  price
penalties  are applied to all gasoline consumed by passenger
vehicles  for  the  affected   years   (assuming   continued
utilization   of   catalytic   converters).    Similarly,  a
breakdown of annual national cost estimates  for  light-duty
truck emission control is presented in Table 1-8.
                           2-250

-------
                         Table  1-7,
           Estimated National Costs Attributable
            to Light-Duty Passenger Car Emission
                    Controls. 1968-1985

   Annual Incremental Expenditures (Billions of Dollars')
Calendar
Year

1968
1969
197O
1971
1972
1973
1974
1975
1976
1977
1978
1979
198O
1981
1982
1983
1984
1985

1968-85'
1976-85
Equipment

   O.O9
   O.O9
   O.47
   O.5S
   0.53
   1 .27
   0.90
   1 .73
   2.35
   2.45
   2. 15
   2.31
   3.82
   5.75
   5.7O
   5.74
   5.84
   5.61

  47 .4
  41 .72
Ma i ntenance

   O.27
   O.52
   O.69
   O.9O
   1
   1
   1
   1 .
  . 12
  ,31
  .42
  .07
 O.86
 O.68
 O.5O
 O.31
 O. 14
 O.O3
(O.O4)
(O.15)
(O.17)
(0.17)

 9.29
 1 .99
Fuel
Consumpt ion
Penal ty3
O.21
O.28
0. 15
O.25
O.31
O.43
O.5O
(0. 14)
(0.94)
(0.81)
(0.72)
(0.67)
(0.69)
(0.65)
(0.64)
(0.60)
(0.55)
(0.35)
(4.63)
(6.62)
Fuel
Price
Penal ty
_-
__
--
--
--
--
--
O.07
O.24
O.36
O.51
O.67
O.88
1.10
1 .28
1 .37
1 .41
1 .43
9.32
9.25
                                                         Annual
                                                         Total
                                                      Cumulat1ve
                                                      Total
--
__
--
--
--
--
--
O.07
O.24
O.36
O.51
O.67
O.88
1.10
1 .28
1 .37
1 .41
1 .43
9.32
9.25
O.
O,
1 ,
1 .
1 .
3.
2.
2.
2.
2.
2.
2.
4 .
6.
6.
6.
6.
6.


.57
.89
.31
.71
96
.01
.82
73
51
68
,44
62
O7
23
30
36
53
52


O
1
2
4
6,
9.
12.
15.
17.
2O.
22.
27.
31 .
38.
44 .
50.
57.
63.


.57
.46
.77
.48
,44
.45
.27
.OO
.51
19
.63
.87
94
17
47
83
36
88



-------
tv>
C"
Table 1-7,
Estimated National Costs Attributable
to Light-Duty Passenger Car Emission
Controls. 1968-1985

Annual Incremental Expenditures (Billions of Dollars')

1   Current dollars used for 1968-74;  December 1975 dollars used for 1975-85.
   Interest Is not applied to annual  expenditures.

'   Fuel  prices assumed: 1968. 43.O cents/gal.;  1969.  44.0 cents/gal.;  197O,  45.0 cents/gal.;
   1971.  45.O cents/gal.;  1972, 43.O cents/gal.;  1973, 43.O cents/gal.:  1974-75 55 cents/gal.;
   1976,  60 cents/gal.; 1977. 6O cents/gal.; 1978, 61 cents/gal.;  1979,  62 cents/gal.; 198O.
   63 cents/gal; 1981,  64  cents/gal.- 1932-83,  65 cents/gal.;  1984, 66 cents/gal.;
   1985,  67 cents/gal.

3   Based on fuel cost increase due to lead-free and phasedown regulations of  1.0O cents/gal, for 1975-76,
   1.5 cents/gal,  for 1976-77,  and 1.7 cents/gal,  for 1978;  1.9 cents/gal, for 1979;  2.1 cents/gal, for 198O;
   2.3 cents/gal,  for 1981;  2.5 cents/gal, for  1982-85.

•   Totals may not  equal the sum of tabular entries due to rounding.

-------
N>
i
to
ui
                                  Table 1-8.
                    Estimated  National  Costs  Attributable
               to  Light-Duty Truck Emission Controls,  1973-1985

                          Annual  Incremental  Expenditures'  (Billions of  Dollars')
Calendar
Year

1973
1974
1975
1976
1977
1978
1979
1980
1981
1982
1983
1984
1985

1973-85
1976-85
                       Equipment    Maintenance
0.
0.
O.
O.
O.
O.
O.
0.
0.
O.
0.
O.
0.
3.
2.
17
13
2O
26
28
26.
26
29
29
29
3O
3O
31
34
84
0
O
O
O
O
O
0

(0
(0
(0
(0
(0
O
(0
.03
.05
.05
.04
.03
.02
.01
O
.01)
.02)
.03)
.04)
.05)
.08
.05)
Fuel
Consumption
Penalty'

   O.O7
   0.21
   O.28
   O.38
   O.48
   O.57
   O.66
   O.76
   O.87
   O.98
   1 , 10
   1 .22
   1 .35

   8.43
   8.37
Fuel
Price
Penalty'
—
--
O.O5
0.07
O. 11
O. 14
O. 16
O.22
O.25
O.28
O.31
O.35
O.39
2.33
2.28

Annua 1
Total
O.27
O.39
O.58
O.75
O.9O
O.99
1 .09
1.27
1 .40
1 .53
1 .68
1 .83
2.OO
14.68
13.44
Cumulat ive
Total

   O.27
   O.66
   1 .24
                                                                                                 99
                                                                                               2.89
                                                                                               3.88
                                                                                               4.97
                                                                                               6.24
                                                                                               7.64
                                                                                               3. 17
                                                                                              1O. 85
                                                                                              12.58
                                                                                              14.68
            Trucks  less  than 6.OOO pounds  gross vehicle weight.
            Interest  Is  not  applied to annual  expenditures.

            Current dollars  used 1973-74;  December 1974 dollars  used 1975-8S.

            Fuel  prices  assumed:   1973,  41.6 cents/gal.;  1974-75.  55 cents/gal.;  1976.  61  cents/gal.;
            1977, 63  cents/gal.;  1978,  65  cents/gal.;  1979,  67 cents/gal.:  198O,  69  cents/gal.

            Based on  fuel  cost  increase due to lead-free and phasedown  regulations of  1.O9 cents/gal,  for  1975-76
            1.3 cents/gal, for  1977-79,  and 1.5 cents/gal,  for  198O.

-------
Heavy-Duty Vehicle Controls

EMISSION STANDARDS

Separate  emission-control  regulations  have been in effect
since 1970 for new  heavy-duty  gasoline  and  diesel  truck
engines  manufactured for use in over-the-highway trucks and
buses of over 6,000 pounds  gross  vehicle  weight.   Trucks
under  6,000  pounds  gross  vehicle  weight  are  currently
considered light-duty vehicles and have been dealt  with  in
the  previous  paragraphs  of this section.  (Newly proposed
regulations would increase the  light-duty  class  to  8,500
pounds.)   Heavy-duty  truck engine emission test procedures
are performed on the engine itself and do not pertain to the
vehicle as in the case of light-duty truck and passenger car
regulations.

Federal regulations for emissions from  heavy-duty  gasoline
engines  are  shown  in  Table 1-10.  For 1970 through 1973,
regulations  covered   hydrocarbon   and   carbon   monoxide
emissions measured in terms of average concentrations in the
engine  exhaust  over a nine-mode, constant-speed, variable-
load dynamometer cycle.  In 1974, new  standards  went  into
effect  which  are  based on the same test procedure, but in
which  emissions  are  reported  in  terms  of   grams   per
horsepower-hour  (g./hp-hr).   The  sum  of  hydrocarbon and
nitrogen oxide emissions is limited to  16  g./hp-hr,  while
the standard for carbon monoxide is 40 g./hp-hr for 1974 and
later model-year heavy-duty gasoline engines.

Heavy-duty  diesel  truck  engine Federal standards are also
shown in Table 1-10.   Through  1970-73,  standards  covered
smoke  emissions  only.  In 1974, the standards were revised
to include hydrocarbon, nitrogen oxide, and carbon  monoxide
emissions  as  well  as more stringent smoke emissions.  The
permissible gaseous-emission levels  are  the  same  as  for
heavy-duty gasoline engines for 1974, but the test procedure
is  different.   For  diesels, emissions are averaged over a
13-mode, variable-speed, variable-load dynamometer cycle.

EPA is making changes to the heavy-duty engine standards and
test procedures effective for  model  year  1979.   Cost  of
control  estimates  made  in  this report do not reflect the
implementation of these  rules,  nor  do  they  reflect  the
change  in  the light-duty truck class to include all trucks
with  gross  vehicle  weights  belov  8,500  pounds.    This
regulation  will  reduce  the  size  of the heavy-duty truck
class  subject  to  the  heavy-duty  standards   and   would
therefore reduce the cost estimates for achieving heavy-duty
emissions standards.
                           2-254

-------
                         Table 1-9.
              Federal Standards for Heavy-Duty
            Gasoline and Diesel-Engine Emissions
                          Emission Standards*
Pollutant                 1970-73     1974

                      Gasoline Engines
Hydrocarbons (HO         275 ppm     16 g./hp-hr
Oxides of nitrogen (N0>c)
Carbon monoxide  (CO)      1.5 %       40 g./hp-hr

                       Diesel Engines
Smoke:
  Opacity in acceler-     40%         20%
     ating mode
  Opacity in lugging      20%         15%
     mode
  PeaX opacity in         —          50%
     either mode
HC + NOx                  --          16 g./hp-hr
CO                        —          40 g./hp-hr

*   For  use  in  vehicles  of  more than 6,000 pounds gross
  vehicle weight.
HEAVY-DUTY GASOLINE ENGINE CONTROLS

The emission control technology used for heavy-duty gasoline
engines through 1973 is similar to that employed for  light-
duty  trucks and passenger cars through the 1972 model year.
In fact, many heavy-duty gasoline engines are derivatives of
passenger car engines.  For 1974, the nitrogen oxide control
standards were generally attainable without the use of  EGR,
although  some  EGH  engines  were certified in the previous
year to meet California standards for 1973 which were at the
same level as Federal standards for 1974.

No detailed equipment cost estimates have been made  by  EPA
for  heavy-duty gasoline-truck engine emission controls.  In
the absence of such estimates, it is assumed for purposes of
this report that the per-vehicle emission control  equipment
cost  increment of 1970-73 engines is equivalent to that for
1970 model-year passenger car engines minus the cost of fuel
evaporation controls, equalling  $24  per  vehicle.   It  is
                           2-255

-------
further  assumed  that  the   1974 and  following  year  control
equipment costs will  be  equivalent   to   that   for   a   1973
passenger  car  engine  less  the cost  of EGR  and evaporative
controls, or $50.00 per vehicle.

Incremental annual maintenance costs for heavy-duty gasoline
truck engine controls for all years are assumed  to   be   the
same  as  passenger  car  costs for model years  1968  through
1974, or $16 per vehicle.  Fuel  consumption  penalties   are
estimated  to  be  3 percent  for the 1970-1973 period, and 5
percent for 1974 and beyond.  A baseline fuel economy of  8.5
mpg  is  assumed.   Estimates  of  total  per-vehicle  costs
attributable  to  emission controls for this  class of trucks
are summarized in Table 1-10.
                          2-256

-------
I
to
Calendar
Year

1970
1971
1972
1973
1974
1975
1976
1977
1978
1973
1980
1981
1982
1983
1984
1985

1970-85
1976-85
                                   Table 1-1O.
                      Estimated National Costs Attributable
                       to Gasol1ne-Fueled Heavy-Outy Truck1
                           Emission Controls. 1,970-1985

                         Annual Incremental Expenditures* (Billions of Dollars')
                      Equipment   Maintenance
O.O2
O.O2
O.O2
0.02
O.O4
O.O4
O.05
O.O5
O.O5
O.O5
0.05
O.O5
O.O5
O.O5
O.O5
O.O5

0.66
O.5C
                                     O.
                                     0.
O.01
O.O2
O.O3
O.05
O.O6
O.O8
O. 1O
  1 1
  13
O. 14
O. 16
O. 18
O.20
O.22
0.24
O.26

1 .99
1 .74
Fuel

Consumpt ion
Penal
O.
0.
0.
O.
O.
O.
O.
O.
O.
0,
O.
O.
O,
O.
O.
O.
5.
5.
ty
01
03
O4
O7
13
17
25
31
37
44
5O
55
60
65
70
75
57
12
Fuel
Price
Penal
--
--
--
-~
--
O.
O.
O.
o.
0.
o.
o.
o.
o.
o.
o.
2.
2.



Annual
ty





09
1 1
16
18
19
24
28
32
36
4O
44
77
68
Total
0.
0.
0.
0.
0.
0.
O.
O.
0.
0.
0.
1 ,
1 .
1 .
1 .
1 .
1O.

04
07
O9
14
23
38
51
63
73
82
95
O6
17
28
39
5O
99
1O. O4
Cumulateve
Total

   O.O4
   O. 11
   O.2O
   0.-34
   O.57
   0.95
   1 .46
   2,09
   2.82
  .3.54
   4 .59
   5.65
   S.82
   8. 1O
   9.49
  1O.99
              Trucks over 6.OOO pounds gross vehicle weight.

              Current dollars used 1970-74: December 1974 dollars used 1975-1985.

              Fuel prices assumed:  197O, 44.3 cents/gal.;  1971, 43.4 cents/gal.; 1972. 41.5 cents/gal.;
              1973, 41.S cents/gal.;  1974-75, 55 cents/gal.; 1976, 51 cents/gal.: 1977, 63 cents/gal.;
              1978, 65 cents/gal,; 1979. 67 cents/gal.;  198O, 69 cents/gal.
              Based on fuel cost increase due to lead-free and phasedown regulations of 1.O9 cents/gal, for  1975-76,
              1.3 cents/gal, for 1977-79. 1.5 cents/gal, for 198O.
              Interest not applied to annual expenditures.

-------
It is estimated that the population  of  1970-73  trucks  of
this  class will peak at about 4.5 million in 1973, and that
the  total   controlled   population   will   have   reached
approximately  9.0  million  in  1980.   Estimated costs for
heavy-duty gasoline  truck  Federal  emission  controls  are
presented in Table 1-11.
                        Table 1-11.
    Estimated Per-vehicle Cost Penalties for Heavy-Duty
              Gasoline Engine Emission Control
                                Model Years
incremental               1970-73     1974-85
Cost Item                    (1974 Dollars)

Emission-control             $24         $50
equipment cost

Annual maintenance            16          16

Fuel consumption               3%          5%
penalty1

>•  Based on 8.5 mpg for pre-1970 trucks.
HEAVY-DUTY DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS

Both  smoke  and gaseous emission  standards,  including those
for 1974, have been attained largely  through   fuel-injection
system modifications.  Nitrogen oxide and  smoke are the more
difficult  emissions  to  control;  even uncontrolled diesels
are  usually  well   within   carbon   monoxide   standards.
Equipment cost penalties are considered nominal;  further,  it
is  estimated  that  no fuel consumption penalties have been
incurred.   Accordingly,  no  national   cost   penalty    is
attributed to diesel-truck engine  emission controls.
Aircraft Emission  Controls

Aircraft   emissions   have   been   identified   as   significant
contributors   to   the  regional   burden  of    pollution    in
comparison to  other  sources which will have  to be controlled
to meet National Ambient Air Quality  Standards.
                            2-258

-------
Airports  are  concentrated  sources  of pollutant emissions
which will  in  many  cases  reduce  local  air  quality  to
unsatisfactory levels even though emissions from automobiles
and  stationary  sources are within acceptable levels within
the general area.  That is, unless  aircraft  emissions  are
reduced, airports will still remain intense area emitters of
pollutants,  even  after  emissions  from other area sources
have been greatly reduced.

The Clean Air Act directs the Administrator of  the  EPA  to
"establish  standards  applicable  to  emissions  of any air
pollutant from any class or classes of aircraft or  aircraft
engines  which  in  his  judgment cause or contribute to air
pollution which endangers the public health or welfare."  In
July  1973,  Federal  emission standards and test procedures
were established for  various  classes  of  new  and  in-use
aircraft  engines.21 These regulations are based on the need
to control emissions occurring under 3,000 feet  to  protect
ambient  air quality in urban areas.  However, the standards
are  not  quantitatively  derived  from  the   air   quality
considerations in affected areas but, instead, reflect EPA's
judgment  as to the emission levels that will be practicable
with  present  and  projected  technology.   The   requisite
technology  is assumed to include advanced combustion-system
concepts for turbine engines and improved fuel  systems  for
piston  engines.   The  standards  cover  (a)  fuel  venting
regulations beginning January 1, 1974,  (b)  smoke  emission
regulations  taking  effect  in  1974,  1976,  and  1978 for
various engine classes, and  (c)  gaseous  emission  (carbon
monoxide,  hydrocarbon,  and  nitrogen  oxide) standards for
1979 and 1981.  Gaseous emissions regulations are based on a
simulated  landing-and-take  off   operating   cycle   which
includes:  (1) taxi/idle (out), (2) take off, (3) climb out,
(4) approach, and (5) taxi/idle (in).   Piston  engines  are
included in the standards beginning in 1979.

in  general,  the  influence  of  the regulations will be to
contribute to the maintenance of the quality of the  air  in
and  around major air terminals throughout the post-1979 era
in which  air  traffic  is  undergoing  expansion.   Present
aircraft  emission  standards21  and  their  estimated  cost
impact"," are listed in Table 1-12.  Costs of fuel-venting
and smoke  emission  controls  through  1978,  totaling  $17
million,  are  minor  in  comparison to costs of controlling
other sources in that time period.
                           2-259

-------
                                 Table 1-12.
            Aircraft Emission Standards and Estimated Cost Impacts
to
         Calendar
         Year

         1974
          1974
          1976
         1981
   Standards

JT8D smoke standards.
Fuel venting restrictions for
   new and in-use engines
   (1975 for business-aircraft
   eng i nes).

Smoke standards, new turbine
   engines except JT3D, JT8D,
   and supersonic.

JT3D smoke standards.
Implementation
Technology

Combustor and fuel  nozzle
   retrofit.

Plumbing and/or operational
   changes.
None, engines already
   comply
                                                        Fuel nozzle retrofit.
Estimated Cost of
Implementation

Voluntarily completed.
   Cost not estimated

$2 mi 11 ion.
                                                                                         None.
                                                                                         $37.5 mil 1 ion.
         1979       Gaseous emission (HC. CO. and
                       NOx) standards for all
                       engines manufactured.

         1980       Same as 1979.

         1981-85    Gaseous emission standards
                       for newly certified engines.
         Sources:  EPA, References 12 and 24.
                                    Modified engine hot section.
                                    Same as 1979.

                                    Advanced combustor and
                                       engine concepts.

                                    1985 Cumulative Total
                                 $66 mi 11 ion' ,'



                                 $5 mill ion*,3

                                 $8 mi 11 ion


                                 $93 mi 11 ion'
         1   Principally development and recert1fication costs.  Includes additional engine hardware costs which will
            be incurred in 1979.  Maximum additional engine cost estimate to be:

                 $1O,OOO per large turbine engine
                   6,000 per small turbine engine over 8.0OO Ib thrust
                   2.OOO per small turbine engine under S.OOO Ib thrust, and per turboprop or APO engine
                      52 per piston engine.

         *   Estimated $2.9 million In piston engine fuel savings per year for 1979 and 198O is included.

         1   Estimated $3.5 million for hardware and $1.5 million for certification.

-------
The  estimated  cost  of  development  and   recertification
efforts   for  compliance  with  the  1979  gaseous-emission
standards is $66 million, and the additional engine-hardware
costs, which will be incurred in 1979, are estimated  to  be
$3.5  million.   The  costs  incurred in 1980 for compliance
with the 1979 standards are estimated to be $3.5 million  for
hardware and $1.5 million for certification for a  total  of
$5.0  million.   The  1979 standards promulgated for piston-
type aircraft are expected to  result  in  significant  fuel
savings:  $29  million  over  10  years.   Credit  for these
savings has been assumed at a uniform rate of  $2.9  million
per  year  in  estimating  the  cost  of  aircraft  emission
controls for 1979 and 1980.  In total,  cumulative  national
costs   through  1980  for  aircraft  emission  control   are
expected to total approximately $85 million (including  $5.8
million for fuel savings).
Discussion of unregulated
Mobile Source Emission

As  stated  in  the introduction, a number of mobile sources
are  presently  unregulated.    These   include:    railroad
locomotives, marine engines, and offroad farm, construction,
and garden equipment.

Emission  inventories  have  been performed on many of these
unregulated mobile sourceszs-aa.

As a general conclusion, most small-engined  mobile  sources
(such   as   garden   equipment,   outboard   engines,   and
snowmobiles) each contribute less  than  1  percent  of  the
total  hydrocarbon  and carbon monoxide from mobile sources,
and less than 0.1 percent of the total nitrogen oxide (based
on 1970 data).  While these percentages  are  increasing  as
passenger cars and trucks come under more stringent control,
it  would  not appear to be cost-effective to regulate these
mobile sources until some future time.

In a publication by HEW2», it was estimated that  the  total
carbon  monoxide emissions from railroad locomotives in 1968
constituted about 1.6 percent  of  the  emissions  from  all
transportation  sources.  Percentages for hydrocarbon, total
particulates, and sulfur oxides were 1.8,  16.7,  and  12.5,
respectively.  At present, there are no proposed regulations
for railroad locomotive exhaust emissions.
                           2-261

-------
         SUMMARY OF MOBILE SOURCE
         CONTROL COSTS

         The preceding costs estimates for light and heavy duty
         trucks and aircraft source air pollution controls are
         expressed 
                                 Table 1-13.
               Estimated Total  National  Costs for Mobile Source
                         Emission Control,  1968-1985
               Annual  National  Investment and O&M Expenditures
                          (Billions of  1975 Dollars)
         Year
                    Light-Duty Passenger
                    Car Emission Control
                   Light Duty Truck
                   Emission Control
                Heavy-Duty Vehicle
                Emission Control
                   Aircraft Emission
                      Control
               Total Annual
                  Cost
         1968
         1969
         1970
         1971
         1972
         1973
         1974
         1975
         1976
         1977
         1978
         1979
         1980
         1981
         1982
         1983
         1984
         1985

         1968-85
         1976-85
 O.57
 O.89
 1 .31
 1 .71
 1 .96
 3.01
 2.82
 2.73
 2.51
 2.S8
 2 .44
 2.62
 4.O7
 6.23
 6.3O
 6.56
 6.53
 6.52

61 .46
46.46
 0.29
 O.42
 O.63
 O.81
 0.97
 1.O7
 1 . 18
 1 .37
 1 .51
 1 .65
 1.81
 1 .98
 2. 16

15.85
14.51
 O.05
 O.O9
 O. 11
 0.17
 O.41
 O.79
 0.55
 0.68
 0.79
 0.89
   O3
   15
   27
   39
   51
 1 .63

11.97
1O.89
O.O2
O.O8
0.002
O.OO2
O.OO2
O.OO2

O. 1O8
O. 108
 O.57
 O.89
 .1 .36
 1 .80
 2.07
 3.47
 3.49
 3.77
 3.87
 4.33
 4 .32
 4.77
 6.47
 8.89
 9.22
 9.76
10.O2
10.31

89.38
71 .96
          Interest not applied  to  annual  investments.

-------
References

1.   Energy Supply and  Environmental  Coordination  Act  of
     1974.  Public  Law  93-319,  93rd Congress, H.R. 14368,
     June 22, 1974.

2.   "Certification of New  vehicles  intended  for  Initial
     Sale  at High Altitude/1 Federal Register, vol. 39, No.
     203, Friday, October 18, 1974.

3.   "Decision of  the  Administrator  on  Applications  for
     Suspension  of  1977  Motor  vehicle  Exhaust  Emission
     Standards,"  U.S.  Environmental   Protection   Agency,
     Washington, D.C., March 5, 1975.

4.   opening Statement by Administrator Russell E. Train  on
     1977 Suspension Decision, March 5, 1975.

5.   "Decision of  the  Administrator  on  Remand  From  the
     United  States  Court  of  Appeals  for the District of
     Columbia Circuit on Applications for Suspension of 1975
     Motor  vehicle  Exhaust   Emission   Standards,"   U.S.
     Environmental   Protection  Agency,  Washington,  D.C.,
     April 11, 1973.

6.   "Decision of  the  Administrator  on  Applications  for
     Suspension  of  1976  Motor  Vehicle  Exhaust  Emission
     Standards/'  U.S.  Environmental   Protection   Agency,
     Washington, D.C., July 30, 1973.

7.   The Economics of Clean Air. Annual Report to  Congress,
     U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, March 1972.

8.   Report by_ the  Committee  on  Motor  vehicle  Emission,
     National  Academy  of Sciences, EPA Contract No. 68-01-
     0402, February 12, 1973.

9.   "Decision of  the  Administrator  on  Remand  from  the
     United  States  Court  of  Appeals  for the District of
     Columbia Circuit on Applications for Suspension of 1975
     Motor  Vehicle  Exhaust   Emission   Standards",   U.S.
     Environmental   Protection  Agency,  Washington,  D.C.,
     April 11, 1973.

10.  "Decision of  the  Administrator  on  Applications  for
     Suspension  of  1976  Motor  vehicle  Exhaust  Emission
     Standards,"  U.S.  Environmental   Protection   Agency,
     Washington, D.C., July 30, 1973.

11.  Automobile Emission Control—The Technical  Status  and
     outlook   a_s   o|_  December.  1974 r  A  Report  to  the
                           2-263

-------
     Administrator, U.S. Environmental Protection Agency  by
     Emission control Technology Division, January 1975.

12*  A Report on Automotive Fuel Economy, U.S. Environmental
     Protection Agency, October 1973.

13.  Automobile Gasoline Mileage Test Results. 1974 Cars and
     Light-Duty  Trucks.   U.S.   Environmental   Protection
     Agency, September 18, 1973.

14.  Potential for Motor Vehicle Fuel  Economy  Improvement.
     Report to the Congress by U.S. Environmental Protection
     Agency, October 24, 1974.

15.  EPA  Analysis  of  FEQ  Review   qf_   Lead   Phase-Down
     Regulation, U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, April
     9, 1974.

16.  Automotive News 1973 Almanac^ April 30, 1973.

17.  Long Term Forecast. Chase Econometric Associates,  June
     1977.

18.  "Forecast of Motor  Vehicle  Distribution,  Production,
     and   Scrappage,   1971-1990,"   U.S.   Department   of
     Transportation, Federal Highway Administration, October
     1971.

19.  1973/74 Automobile  Facts  and  Figures.  Published  by
     Motor   vehicle   Manufacturers  Association,  Detroit,
     Michigan.

20.  Tingley, D.S., and Johnson, J.H., "Emissions  and  Fuel
     Usage   by  the  U.S.  Truck  and  Bus  Population  and
     Strategies for  Achieving  Reduction,"  SAE  Paper  No.
     740537, June 1974.

21.  "control of Air Pollution From  Aircraft  and  Aircraft
     Engines,  Emission  Standards  and  Test Procedures for
     Aircraft," Federal Register, Vol. 38, No. 136  Tuesday
     July 17, 1973.

22•  Aircraft  Emissions;    impact  on   Air   Quality   and
     Feasibility  of  Control. U.S. Environmental Protection
     Agency.

23.  cost   estimates   provided   by   R.   Sampson,    U.S.
     Environmental Protection Agency, Ann Arbor,  Michigan.
                           2-264

-------
24.  EPA Memorandum:   "Analysis  of  Estimated  Maintenance
     Costs  for Emission Control Systems Meeting the 1975/76
     Federal Standards."

25.  Hare, C.T.,  Springer,  K.J.,  Oliver,  W.R.,  Houtman,
     W.H.,  and  Huls,  T.A.,  "Motor Cycle Emissions, Their
     impact, and Possible Control Techniques", SAE Paper No.
     740627, Presented at SAE  West  Coast  Meeting,  August
     1974.

26.  Hare, C.T., Springer, K.J., Oliver, W.R., and  Houtman,
     W.H.,  "Small  Engine  Emissions and Their impact", SAE
     Paper No. 730859, Presented at SAE National FCIM and FL
     Meeting, September 1973.

27.  Hare, C.T., Springer, K.3., and  Huls,  T.A.,  "Exhaust
     Emissions  From  Two-Stroke  Outboard  Motors and Their
     impact",  SAE  Paper  No.  740737,  Presented  at   SAE
     National FCIM and FL Meeting, September 1974.

28.  Hare, C.T., Springer, K.J., and Huls, T.A., "Snowmobile
     Engine Emissions  and  Their  impact",  SAE  Paper  No.
     740735,  Presented at SAE National FCIM and FL Meeting,
     September 1974.

29.  Nationwide Inventory of_ Air Pollutant  Emissions—1968,
     U.S.  Department  of  Health,  Education,  and Welfare,
     Public Health service,  Environmental  Health  Service,
     National    Air   Pollution   Control   Administration,
     Publication No. AP-73, August 1970.
                           2-265

-------
              2.  TRANSPORTATION CONTROL PLANS

Summary

When new-vehicle emission  standards  and  stationary-source
control  are  fully  implemented,  twenty-seven  Air Quality
Control Regions (AQCR) are  still  expected  to  exceed  the
oxidant  and  carbon monoxide air quality standards of 1975.
To meet the air quality  standards,  these  AQCR's  will  be
required  to  implement  Transportation Control Plans  {TCP}.
The aim of the TCP's is to reduce total emissions of   in-use
vehicles  by  implementing  either  or both of the following
strategies to control total emissions from in-use vehicles:

  •  Measures that reduce  emissions  per  vehicle  mile  of
     travel

  •  Measures that  reduce  total  vehicle  miles  travelled
     (VMT).

The  first  strategy  includes   the  application of retrofit
control systems,  inspection and  maintenance of vehicles, and
service  station  vapor  controls.   The   second   strategy
contains  mass  transit  improvements, carpool programs, and
other  methods that will  reduce   the  use  of  low-occupancy
automobiles.

A  detailed discussion of measures contained  in the TCP's is
given  in the  following paragraphs.  Costs   for  implementing
the  inspection   and  maintenance programs,  installation of
retrofit devices,  and service  station vapor control   systems
are  estimated   for   each   AQCR   for the period 1976  to  1985
inclusive.  The  costs to the vehicle owners of  implementing
these  measures   are  estimated   to be $344 million in 1976,
$441 million  in  1977, and   thereafter  remaining   relatively
constant   through  1985.    However, a net  benefit  results by
taking into account  the  fuel savings that   are  expected to
result   from   tune-ups  'required  by   the   inspection   and
maintenance strategies.  Hence,  the cumulative  benefit   for
the  period   1976-85   is  estimated to be  about $540  million
 (see Table 2-13).   Approximately $664 million will  be  spent
 for  capital  investment  over the decade  and  a little  over $3
billion  will  go to operation and maintenance  of the   program
 (see   Table    2-14).     To maintain  maximum  clarity  and
 usability,  it was decided  not  to convert  the  U.S.   units of
measure  contained in this  section to metric  equivalents.
                            2-266

-------
Introduction

The  Clean Air Act Amendments of 1970  (hereafter referred to
as the  Act)  directed  EPA  to  set   national  primary  and
secondary   ambient  air  quality  standards.   The  primary
standards must be established so that  their  attainment  and
maintenance  will protect the public health with an adequate
margin of safety.  The secondary standards will protect  the
public welfare from any known or anticipated adverse effects
associated  with  the  presence of air pollutants.  In 1971,
national ambient air quality standards were established  for
six   pollutants,  including  the  four  primary  pollutants
associated with motor vehicles:. carbon  monoxide,  nitrogen
dioxide,    photochemical    oxidant,    and   hydrocarbons.
Hydrocarbons are reactants in the formation of oxidants, and
they have no known health effects at ambient concentrations.
The primary and secondary standards for these pollutants are
identical and are shown in Table 2-1.
                         Table 2-1.
         National Primary and Secondary Ambient Air
                     Quality Standards
                          Air Quality
Pollutant                 Standard1  (ppm)   Averaging Time

Hydrocarbons              0.24              3 hours
                          or                or
                          9.00              8 hours

Carbon Monoxide          35.00              1 hour

Nitrogen Dioxide          0.05              Annual

Photochemical Oxidant     0.08              1 hour

» Primary and secondary standards  for these  pollutants  are
  identical.   Standards  are  not   to be exceeded more than
  once a year.

Source: Reference  1.
 The  standards  for the motor-vehicle-related pollutants  have
 been  exceeded  in  a number of major  urban areas.  From the
 State  implementation Plans  (SIP) submitted  to  EPA  by  the
 states in  February  1972,  it was found  that of the 247 AQCR's
                            2-267

-------
in  the  United  States, 54 regions exceeded the air quality
standard for  oxidants,  29  exceeded  the  carbon  monoxide
standard,  and 2 exceeded the nitrogen dioxide standard.  In
total, sixty-six AQCR's, representing roughly 60 percent  of
the  nation's  population/  exceeded  one  or  more of these
standards.

The Act established three principal approaches to  achieving
the air quality standards:

  «  Emissions standards for new automobiles

  •  Emissions  standards  for  stationary  sources    (power
     plants, industrial sources, and general area sources)

  «  In-use vehicle controls.

EPA  is  authorized  to  promulgate  and  enforce  emissions
standards for new automobiles, trucks, and motorcycles.  EPA
has  used this authority to establish increasingly stringent
emissions standards  for  cars  and  initial  standards  for
trucks.    More   stringent   truck  standards  as  well  as
motorcycle emissions standards are now  under  development.2
The Energy Supply and  Environmental Coordination Act of 1974
extended  the  1975  and  1976  deadlines of the Act for two
years.

Reductions in pollutant concentrations  resulting  from  the
implementation   of    new-vehicle  emissions  standards  and
stationary-source controls were projected  to  significantly
reduce   the number of  AQCR's exceeding the oxidant or  carbon
monoxide  air quality standards.  These include approximately
40 percent of the nation's population.  Table 2-2 presents  a
list    of   these   AQCR's   together   with   the   ambient
concentrations    for    carbon   monoxide  and  photochemical
oxidants  measured  through  1972.   Having  controlled  the
emissions   from   stationary  sources and new vehicles  to the
extent  possible,  those states containing the AQCR's that are
still projected  to exceed the air quality standards will  be
required  to  implement  transportation control plans,  i.e.,
control of  in-use vehicles,  to meet the requirements of  the
Act.    This section describes the TCP's to be implemented in
those states  containing the  AQCR's  listed in Table 2-2,  and
it  includes the  estimated costs to  the nation.
                            2-268

-------
to
NJ
                                       Table 2-2.
              1971-1972 Air Quality Levels in Regions Projected to Exceed Primary Ambient Air
                               Quality Standards in 1975
              10-15
                         Carbon Monoxide - 8 Hour Average (ppm)

                                     16-2O                21-24
Indlanapolis
Minneapolis-St.
       San Diego            Sacramento
Paul   San Francisco        Baltimore
       San doaquin          Boston
       District of Columbia Springfield
       Seattle
       Spokane
       Chicago
                                                          Portland
                                                          Pi ttsburgh
                                                          Salt Lake City
                             Oxidant - 1 Hour Average (ppm)
              O.1O-O.15
                                     O.16-O.20
                                                          O.21-0.3O
              Phoenix-Tucson
              Philadelphia
              Pittsburgh

              Dallas-Ft. Worth
              San Antonio
              Indianapolis
              Rochester
              Cincinnat i
              Port land
              Seattle
              Springfield
                       Denver               Sacramento
                       District of Columbia San doaquin
                       New York City        Baltimore
                                            Boston
25-35

Fairbanks
Phoen i x-Tucson
Denver
Philadelphia
                                                 O.31-0.40

                                                 San Diego
                                                 San Francisco
                                                 Houston-Galveston
36-42

Los Angeles
New York City
                     Greater than
                     0.4O

                     Los Angeles
              Source;  Reference 2, p. 22.

-------
Overall Strategies

TCP's make use of either or both of the following strategies
to control total emissions from in-use vehicles:

  •  Measures that reduce  emissions  per  vehicle  mile  of
     travel

  •  Measures that  reduce  total  vehicle  miles  travelled
     (VMT).

The  first  strategy includes the inspection and maintenance
of vehicles in use and the application of  retrofit  control
systems.    The   second   strategy   includes  mass  transit
improvements, carpool programs, and other methods that  will
reduce  the  total  use of automobiles.  TCP's mainly pursue
the above strategies with respect to  automobile travel.   The
goals are to reduce emissions per  vehicle  mile  and/or  to
reduce VMT for automobiles.  Although motor vehicles are  not
the   only  source  of  hydrocarbons,  carbon  monoxide   and
nitrogen oxide emissions, Table 2-3   clearly  indicates   the
significance of automotive emissions.
                         Table 2-3.
       Mix of Emission Sources in Urban Areas -  1971
                              Percent  of  Total Emissions

                                          Trucks,
                                          Buses  &
                                          Motor-   Stationary
Pollutants                Automobiles    cycles   Sources

Carbon Monoxide           77-87           8-10       3-15
Hydrocarbons              50-65           5-10      25-45
Nitrogen Oxides           40-50           8-13      37-52

Source:  Reference  3,  p.  m-23.
 Measures  that  Reduce Emissions
 Per  Vehicle  Miles

 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE PROGRAMS

 The   term  "inspection   and maintenance"  covers  a variety of
 strategies  for reducing  air pollutant  emissions  from  light-
                            2-270

-------
duty   motor   vehicles    that    are  currently   in   use   by
establishing procedures that will ensure proper   maintenance
.of  vehicles.  Emissions  from most vehicles  tend  to  increase
with  use until the vehicle on the road  is   properly  tuned.
Thus,  most vehicles on the road  are emitting  more than they
were  designed to  emit or  more than they  would be   emitting
after  a   tune-up.   The  inspection and maintenance  programs
will  systematically reduce the emissions from  an  automobile
population.

Most  of   the  inspection and maintenance programs  have  two
distinct phases:

  •   An inspection phase, in which motorists are  required to
      periodically present their vehicles for examination

  •   A maintenance phase, in which vehicles  that fail   the
      examination  must  be tuned  up  to  bring  them into
      compliance.

Three classifications cover the major alternative approaches
in an inspection  and maintenance  program4.

  •   Exhaust emissions inspection
  •   Engine parameter inspection
  •   Mandatory maintenance.

The exhaust  emissions  inspection  will  be  the only   one
discussed  because it is the only  approach that is being used
at present in those states that have initiated the program.

Exhaust  Emissions  Inspection.   This  inspection technique
involves   sampling  the   exhaust  gases  from  the   examined
vehicle  and passing the  samples  through suitable analytical
instrumentation to measure the quantities of  air polluting
compounds  they   contain.  If  the  concentration   of each
compound falls below the  applicable emissions  standards,  the
venicle passes the examination.   If the concentration of  any
pollutant  is above the standard,  the vehicle  fails.   If  a
vehicle fails the test, it must then be adjusted  or  repaired
to  bring  the  emissions into   compliance.  Following  the
maintenance, the  vehicle  would normally be   resubmitted   for
an emission test  to ensure that it is in compliance.

There are two types of  vehicle  operating modes  that can be
used  in an emissions inspection test.  In an idle mode test,
emissions  from the vehicle are measured  using a tail-pipe
concentration while the vehicle is running in  neutral. In a
loaded  mode  test,  the   emissions  are  measured while  the
vehicle is running in gear on a treadmill-like device called
a dynamometer.    when  operating  in  this   test  mode,   the
                            2-271

-------
vehicle   can  be  drive  in  several  conditions,  such  as
acceleration, cruise, deceleration,  and   idle.   A  driving
cycle  composed  of  a series of different driving modes  can
more accurately represent actual driving conditions.   Thus,
emissions  measurements  taken  in  a  loaded  mode test  are
usually more representative of actual driving emissions than
the measurements taken in an idle tests.   However,  due  to
its  more  sophisticated  equipment,  the  need   for   larger
testing and facility areas, and a longer   testing time   per
vehicle,  the  cost  of a loaded mode program is  higher than
the cost of  an  idle  mode  program  for  a  given  vehicle
population.

The  choice  of  which inspection and maintenance program to
implement is a function of several  factors,  including   the
desired  emissions reduction, ownership and operation  of  the
inspection   stations   {public   or   private),   and   the
relationship  of the inspection and maintenance program with
existing vehicle safety inspection programs.

In general, it is desirable to  incorporate  the  inspection
and  maintenance  program  with  a vehicle safety inspection
program when one exists.  If this  approach  is   taken,   the
manner  in which the safety program is operated will have an
effect on the type of  inspection  and  maintenance  program
that  is  chosen.   Of  the thirty-two states, including  the
District of Columbia, which have safety programs, only three
states have publicly owned and  operated   stations.    Safety
programs  in  the  remaining  states  are  operated  through
private  garages  and   service   stations.    Loaded   mode
inspection  and  maintenance  programs could be incorporated
into a state-owned safety program, but it  would be difficult
to incorporate a loaded mode  test  program  into a   state-
licensed safety program because of the high cost  of the test
equipment.   Therefore,  in most cases idle mode  tests could
be incorporated with state-licensed stations and  loaded mode
tests with state-owned safety  inspection  stations.   If  a
loaded  mode  test  is  required  in  a  state with a  state-
licensed safety inspection program, it is  most likely  that  a
separate state-operated emission test program would have  to
be started.

Twenty-four   areas  are  required  to  have  some  form  of
inspection and maintenance program within  the next two years
under the TCP's which have  been  approved or  promulgated.
There  are  mandatory  safety inspections  in 13 of these  TCP
areas.  The plans specifically call for 20 idle mode   and  7
loaded  mode programs.  The number of plans do not add to 24
because some AQCR's will include both idle mode and a  loaded
mode or privately and publicly owned  inspection  facilities
as shown in Table 2-7.
                            2-272

-------
The  expected  emission  reductions  from  an inspection and
maintenance program are a function of  the  mode  type,  the
frequency  of  the  inspection,  and  the  percentage of the
vehicle population that fail the  inspection.   in  general,
inspection  programs  will  be conducted on an annual cycle.
Reductions in hydrocarbons and  carbon  monoxide  emissions,
but   not   nitrogen   oxide  emissions,  can  be  expected.
Table 2-4 provides expected emission reductions for the idle
and loaded mode programs for various failure rates.
                         Table 2-4.
Inspection and Maintenance Emission Reduction Effectiveness


              Hydrocarbon Emission Reductions
   (Percentage of Emissions from All Vehicles Inspected)

                        Failure Rate

              (Percentage of Vehicles Tested)

Mode Type        10       20       30       40       50
  Idle            6        8       10       11       11
  Loaded          8       11       13       14       15


            Carbon Monoxide Emission Reductions
   (Percentage of Emissions from All vehicles Inspected)

                        Failure Rate

              (Percentage of Vehicles Tested)

Mode Type        10       20       30       40       50
  Idle            3        68        9       10
  Loaded          4        7        9       11       12
The failure rate is  only  a  convenient  shorthand  way  of
referring  to  the  stringency  of  the  emission standards.
Actually, the state will adopt specific  emission  standards
which  each  vehicle  will  be  required  to meet.  When the
emission standards  are  compared  to  the  distribution  of
emissions  for  the total vehicle population, the percentage
of vehicles that are above  the  emission  standard  can  be
determined.    The  resultant  percentage  represents  those
vehicles that will fail the inspection  and  is  termed  the
failure  rate.   Thus,  the more stringent the standard, the
                           2-273

-------
higher the failure rate.  Since the  emissions  distribution
for the vehicle population can change from year to year, the
failure rate would also vary accordingly.

Costs  will vary positively with the failure rate.  Vehicles
that fail the test must receive corrective  maintenance  and
be  retested.   Program capacity must therefore be based not
only on the projected failure rate, but also on the rate  of
retesting.  Increased vehicle capacity must be met by adding
additional testing facilities and/or increasing the hours of
operation.
RETROFIT CONTROL PROGRAMS

A  retrofit  approach  can be defined as the addition of any
device or system and/or any modification or adjustment on  a
motor  vehicle  after  its  initial manufacture to achieve a
reduction in emissions*.  Retrofit programs  go  beyond  the
attempt  made by inspection and maintenance programs to Keep
in-use vehicles at minimum emission levels  consistent  with
their  type and original design.  The only way to reduce the
rate of emissions  from  vehicles  in-use  further  than  the
level  attained  through  inspection  and  maintenance is to
require retrofits.   The objective of a retrofit  program  is
to reduce the emission levels of an in-use vehicle below its
"well-maintained"  levels through the addition of a device or
system and/or a modification or adjustment after its initial
manufacture.

Normally,  a  retrofit  program  will  not be planned unless
additional  stationary-source   controls,   inspection   and
maintenance, and some modest VMT reduction measures are also
implemented because  retrofit devices alone are not enough to
meet   the   national   air   quality  standards.   This  is
principally because  of the high cost of retrofit devices and
the relatively short life-span of their effectiveness, i.e.,
as older vehicles  leave the population, so do  the  retrofit
devices,  and  the  effect  of the  low emitting new vehicles
becomes more predominant.  All retrofit programs must embody
several  important  factors to be  effective.   These   factors
include:

   1.  Choosing retrofit system that  is most  closely  matched
      to   the particular pollutant problem in  the area, since
      different retrofit systems provide  different  emission
      reductions  for  the three pollutants-

   2.  Assuring  that   a  sufficient   number  of  devices  and
      trained  installation personnel  will be available;
                            2-274

-------
  3. incorporating a testing  requirement  at  the  time  of
     installation; and

  4. Providing for  annual  inspection  and  maintenance  of
     retrofitted  vehicles  to  assure  proper  operation in
     subsequent years.

The two retrofit programs currently under consideration  for
wide-spread implementation are:

  •  vacuum Spark Advance Disconnect (VSAD)

  •  Air Bleed to intake Manifold

In addition, a high altitude modification to the  air  bleed
retrofits  has  been under consideration for Denver and Salt
Lake City.  This modification involves timing and carburetor
changes on the air bleed.  Preliminary test runs  in  Denver
by  EPA showed that the high altitude modification would not
significantly reduce emission levels.  Instead, an air bleed
system with exhaust gas recirculation  appears  to  be  more
desirable.

The  characteristics  of  the  two  main  types  of retrofit
systems,  including  a  description  of  the   system,   its
applicability,  the  expected  emission  reductions from its
implementation,  and  other  considerations  are   discussed
below.

Vacuum  Spark  Advance  Disconnect  (VSAD). Two basic engine
modifications employed by  motor  vehicle  manufacturers  in
meeting  Federal  exhaust  emission  standards have been the
leaning  of  air/fuel  ratios  and   the   modification   of
ignition(spark)   timing.    The   modification   of   these
parameters in precontrolled (pre-1968) vehicles will  reduce
carbon   monoxide   emissions   by  9  percent,  hydrocarbon
emissions by 25 percent, and nitrogen oxide emissions by  23
percent,  resulting  in  a fuel penalty of up to 2 percent7.
Durability data developed  by  General  Motors  over  25,000
miles  without  maintenance  show  no  deterioration  in the
reduction of hydrocarbons and nitrogen oxides over time, but
do show approximately a 20 percent deterioration for  carbon
monoxide.   Because  the  1968 model and newer vehicles have
utilized these modifications to some extent to meet  Federal
emission standards, this retrofit technique is considered to
be  applicable  primarily to precontrolled vehicles, but not
to approximately 10 percent of those precontrolled  vehicles
which do not employ vacuum spark advance.

Air  Bleed  to  intake  Manifold.  Many  devices  have  been
designed to introduce excess air in the fuel  mixture  prior
                           2-275

-------
to  combustion  by one means or another.  The effect reduces
hydrocarbon and carbon monoxide  with  possibly  some  small.
increase   in  nitrogen  oxide  emissions.   The  reductions
achieved vary directly with the amount of air  allowed   into
the  intake  system.   This  technique is applicable to  some
extent to all light-duty vehicles  through  the  1971  model
year,  but because of the relatively lean air/fuel ratios on
most  controlled  vehicles,  the  technique   is   primarily
applicable to precontrolled vehicles (pre-1968>.

Tests  conducted on this system for EPA indicate an expected
reduction of 23 percent for hydrocarbons and 50 percent   for
carbon  monoxide  emissions  with  a  fuel  benefit  up  to 4
percent*.  No significant effect on nitrogen oxide emissions
has been observed.  Durability data on the  system  are   not
adequate   for  judging  the  performance  of  this  control
technique over an extended time frame.
SERVICE STATION VAPOR CONTROLS

Although the hydrocarbon vapors emitted   to  the   atmosphere
from  service  stations  cannot be  considered in-use  vehicle
exhaust emissions,   the  relationship  between these  vapor
losses  and  vehicle use   is so  directly related  that  their
control can legitimately be thought of as  a   transportation
control.

Gasoline   is   a   volatile   liquid that tends  to evaporate  at
ordinary ambient   temperatures.   The  vapors  thus   created
become  a  significant  source of hydrocarbon emissions and,
consequently,   of  photochemical   oxidants.    In     some
metropolitan   areas  these   vapors  contribute as  much  as  15
percent of the total hydrocarbon  emissions".    Gasoline may
evaporate  at  any  of  the points at which  it is stored  or
handled and enter the atmosphere  either  through  "breathing"
from  vents   in   the storage tanks  (at the bulk terminal,  in
tanker  trucks, at the service station, or in  the   automobile
tank)   or during  the  process  of  transferring  from  or
refilling  of  each of these  tanks.

The California Air Resources Board  estimates  that  23  pounds
of hydrocarbons   are  emitted   for each thousand  gallons  of
motor  fuel sold at stations in  an uncontrolled situation;  11
pounds  from transferring   fuel   from  transport  to   station
storage;   11   pounds in  moving   fuel  from storage  to  a car
tank;  and  1 pound in "breathing"  losses  from  underground
storage.   A  study by the  Standard  Oil of California reports
similar  results*.  The   average  service   station    sells
approximately 25,000  gallons   of  gasoline  per  month  which
results in hydrocarbon emissions of 575   pounds  per  month.
                            2-276

-------
EPA  estimates  such  emissions  to be around 400 pounds per
station  per  month2,i<>,»i.   By  1975,  uncontrolled  vapor
losses  of  this  magnitude will make the service station as
significant a source of hydrocarbon emissions as some of the
vehicles it serves.  When translated into  grams  per  mile,
the  hydrocarbon  emissions from service stations exceed the
1977 new car hydrocarbon standards2.

Vapor Control Stages and Techniques. Service  station  vapor
losses  result primarily from tank truck unloading  (Staoe I)
and vehicle fueling  (Stage  II).   The  basic  measurei  to
reduce  either  the  evaporation  or  subsequent emif.s on of
vapors to the atmosphere in Stage I include the following:

  1. Floating roofs on large storage tanks.   These  devices
     reduce  the airspace above the liquid where evaporation
     may occur.

  2. Submerged filling of tanks.  This allows  new  gasoline
     to   flow   into   the  liquid  already  in  the  tank,
     eliminating splashing which  would  otherwise  increase
     the amount of vapor.

  3. Restrictions on vent pipes on  the  stationary  storage
     tanks.  This technique limits the amount of "breathing"
     which occurs through the vents.

  4. Use of vapor return lines.  This method  allows  vapors
     in  the  tank  being filled to be transferred back into
     the tank from which the gasoline is being taken.

  5. Secondary  recovery  systems.   Carbon  absorption   or
     refrigeration-condensation    systems   are   used   to
     neutralize or reprocess the vapors that otherwise might
     be emitted.

Of these control techniques^ submerged tank fill is required
for any new station storage container (in most regions) with
a capacity  greater  than  250  gallons,  and  any  existing
container over 2,000 gallons.  In addition, displaced vapors
must  be  either  transferred  back  to  the delivery vessel
through a vapor-tight return line, or they must be processed
on the location by a  refrigeration-condensation  system  or
other appropriate system designed to recover or eliminate at
least 90 percent (by weight) of the organic compounds in the
displaced  vapors.   If  the  vapors  are transferred to the
delivery vessel, such as a tanker truck, the tanker must  be
refilled  at  facilities  equipped  with  processing systems
(such  as  refrigeration-condensation,  carbon   absorption,
etc.)   which can recover at least 90 percent of the organic
compounds in the vapors.
                           2-277

-------
On February 8, 1974, sources were required to submit control
plans to EPA for Stage I vapor recovery by June  1,  1974*2.
EPA  has been unable to approve many control plans submitted
because sources failed to include sufficient information  or
technical  justification.   Guidelines  for  Stage  1  vapor
recovery  are  being  prepared  by  EPA  and  will  be  made
available  to  sources  in the very near future.  Therefore,
EPA postponed  the  date  for  sources  to  enter  and  sign
contracts  for  control  systems and the date for sources to
initiate on-site construction  or  installation  of  control
equipment.

Stage  II  controls  (recovery  of  vapors  displaced during
refueling of automobiles) could theoretically  make  use  of
any  of  the  Stage  I  control  techniques described above.
However, submerged  fill,  collapsible  bladders   (the  small
scale  equivalent  of a floating roof), and carbon canisters
to absorb all vapors during fueling would  require  redesign
of  present  automobiles and are not being considered by EPA
for Stage II controls.  Restrictions on  vent  pipes   (often
including  small  carbon  canisters  on  the  vehicles) were
introduced to comply with the Federal Motor Vehicle  Control
Program  in  the 1970 model year, although pre-1970 vehicles
have vent pipes  open  to  the  atmosphere.   The  remaining
control  technique  is  the  collection  of vapors displaced
during fueling, and the subsequent processing of  the  vapors
through  a  vapor return line to the service station storage
tank.

Essentially two  techniques  have  been  developed  for  the
collection of vapors displaced from automobile tanks through
vapor  return   lines:  simple  displacement or  "balance" and
vacuum-assist.  After the vapors are collected,  they can  be
recovered or reprocessed either at the service station or at
the  bulk  terminal.  Thus, recovery systems, such as  carbon
absorption, refrigeration-condensation, or  incineration, can
be installed either at the service station or  at  the  bulk
terminal.   A   substantial  controversy  has recently  arisen
over the effectiveness of simple  displacement   systems  and
the reliability of  vacuum-assist systems.   Comment period on
the  regulations  was  reopened,  and  EPA  has postponed the
requirement for submission of control  plans  from  June  1,
1974,  to  December 1, 1976, with the  final compliance to be
achieved no later than May 31, 1977.
                            2-278

-------
Measures that Reduce Total
vehicle Miles Travelled

THE NEED FOR VMT REDUCTIONS

In the previous section, three measures to reduce  emissions
per  vehicle mile (in-use controls) were described,  in this
section, a brief description of measures which reduce VMT is
presented.

The  potential  air  quality  benefits  of  in-use   vehicle
controls is shown in Table 2-5.  The table shows that if in-
use   vehicle   and  stationary-source  controls  are  fully
implemented by 1977, at least eight regions in 1980 and five
regions in 1985 are expected to fail to comply with  oxidant
and/or  carbon  monoxide  standards.   Therefore, if further
control of motor vehicle emissions is necessary,  reductions
in  automobile  use  are  required  to  comply  with the air
quality standards.
                         Table 2-5.
   Number of AQCR's Failing to Comply with Oxidant and/or
        Carbon Monoxide Standard in Indicated Year*
                                   Calendar Year

Conditions                   1977        1980        1985

Without In-use               21-24       12-14       9-10
  Vehicle Controls2

With In-use                  12-17        8-10       5-10
  Vehicle Controls'

i Ranges reflect uncertainty in degree of  stationary-source
  control  that  will  be achieved.  Air quality projections
  are based on  linear  rollback  for  carbon  monoxide  and
  Reference  13  for  oxidant.   Analysis excludes New York,
  Deliver, and Fairbanks.

2 Control strategy consists  of  stationary-source  controls
  and Federal Motor Vehicle Emission Control Plan (FMVECP).

3 Control strategy consists of  stationary-source  controls,
  FMVECP,  inspection  and  maintenance, retrofit (including
  catalyst retrofit), and vapor controls.

Source:  Reference 2.
                           2-279

-------
In any  particular  AQCR,  the  adequacy  of  transportation
emission  control  strategies  for  achieving  the  national
ambient air quality standards will depend on the severity of
the air pollution problem within the  region,  the  relative
contribution  of mobile and stationary emission sources, and
the relative growth rates of these sources.

Thus, the extent of  automobile  use  reductions  will  vary
substantially  among  the  AQCR's  in which they are needed.
Table  2-6  displays  the  distribution  of  automobile  use
reductions  (measured  as vehicle miles of travel) necessary
to  achieve  nationwide  compliance  with  the  ambient  air
quality  standards  in  1977  and  1985;  the  projected VMT
reductions needed in 1985 and beyond are  highly  uncertain.
This  is  due  to  their  extreme sensitivity to a number of
parameters used in the projection calculation-  namely,  the
relative  contributions  of  different emission sources, the
growth rates of these sources, and the extent of stationary-
source control achievable.  Accordingly, a  broad  range  of
the number of cities in each of two categories is shown; one
category shows the number of cities needing between zero and
25  percent  VMT  reductions,  the other shows the number of
cities requiring VMT reductions  greater  than  25  percent.
The  actual  reductions  needed by the cities in this latter
category  will  depend' primarily   upon   the   degree   of
stationary-source control that can be achieved in 1985.
                           2-280

-------
                         Table 2-6.
  Number of AQCR's Requiring Automobile use Reduction to
           Achieve Compliance with Qxidant and/or
                 Carbon Monoxide Standards*
                  Automobile Use Reduction

Calendar
Year       Less than 10%     10%-30%     30%-50%  50% or more

1977             8              544

19852         0-25%          25% or more
              6-8               4-6

* The VMT reductions estimated for each AQCR  are  based  on
  the   additional   control   of  motor  vehicle  emissions
  required, assuming the regional I/M and retrofit  programs
  for  in-use  vehicles  are fully implemented by 1977.  Air
  quality projections  are  based  on  linear  rollback  for
  carbon  monoxide and Reference 13 for oxidant.  The number
  of  AQCR's  whose  current  transportation  control  plans
  include  auto  use reductions exceeds the number used here
  because some plans  have  substituted  VMT  reduction  for,
  retrofit.   Auto  use  reductions are expressed as percent
  reductions in VMT.

z Ranges reflect uncertainty in the  degree  of  stationary-
  source control that will be achieved and the future growth
  in automobile use.  Source:  Reference 2.
The  automobile  use  projections,  upon  which the analyses
presented in Table 2-6 are based, reflect trends as of 1973.
Thus, nationwide automobile use (VMT)  is  projected  to  be
about  55  percent  greater  in  1985  than  in  1972.  This
projection assumes an  increasing  number  of  vehicles  per
person and an increasing annual mileage per vehicle.  If the
recent   downward  trend  in  automobile  sales  per  person
continues for a number  of  years  so  that  the  number  of
vehicles  per  person  and  the  annual  mileage per vehicle
remains constant through 1985, automobile use would be  only
about  18  percent  above current levels.  This -represents a
VMT reduction of 25  percent  from  the  projected  baseline
assumed for Table 2-6 which reduces significantly the number
of  AQCR's  requiring  VMT  reductions to achieve compliance
with the standards.
                           2-281

-------
STRATEGIES TO REDUCE VMT

There  are  generally  two   strategies   to   achieve   VMT
reductions:

  •  improvements in transit systems to encourage automobile
     drivers to reduce trips.

  •  Incentives to increase the  number  of  passengers  per
     automobile.

Transit  Improvements.  To  attract  significant  numbers of
automobile drivers out of their cars, a transit system  must
at least satisfy three conditions:

  •  It must have enough vehicles to carry the new riders.

  •  It must provide service whose quality is comparable  or
     superior to that of the automobile.  The most important
     component of service quality is travel time.

  •  Its cost to the rider must be  attractive  relative  to
     the cost of operating an automobile.

An  example  of  the relationship between travel time, cost,
and transit ridership  for  work  trips  is  illustrated  in
Figure  2-1,  which  is based upon the results of a study of
travel  behavior   in   Pittsburgh,   Pennsylvania**.    The
variables  included  in  the figure are the time required to
walk to and from the transit stop,  the  difference  between
automobile  and transit travel times, the difference between
automobile and transit costs, and  the  percentage  of  work
trips  taking  place by transit.  The importance of the time
and cost variables in determining transit ridership  can  be
illustrated  by  considering  the  case  where  transit  and
automobile travel times and costs  are  equal  (Point  A  of
Figure  2-1).   The figures indicate that 66 percent of work
trips would take place by transit,   in  constrast,  average
work-trip   transit   ridership  in  the  United  States  is
currently  less than 15 percent.
                           2-282

-------
                             Figure  2-1.
Dependence of work-Trip Transit Ridership on Service  Quality
              160
              140
              120
              100
            B
            «  80
            I

               60
               40
               20

                                           WALK TIME =5MW.
                                                                     WALK TIME =10MIN.
                                           WALK TIME = 0


                                           WALK TIME = 5MIN.
                                           WALK TIME =10MIN,
                -10      -50        5      10       15
                             TRANSIT TIME - AUTOMOBILE (MINUTES)
                                        20
             LEGEND:
AUTO COST = TRANSIT FARE
AUTO COST "TRANSIT FARE + $2.00
                                  2-283

-------
In practice,  it is  unlikely  that a transit system can  offer
widespread   service   which   is  as  fast  as  that  of  the
automobile.   A more  realistic  example  of  a  high-quality
transit  system  is  illustrated  by' Point B of Figure 2-1.
Here t the walk time is five   minutes,  transit  travel  time
exceeds  automobile  travel   time  by  10  minutes,  and the
transit  fare  and   automobile  cost  are   equal;   transit
ridership  is  21  per'cent.   If  the  walk and travel times
remain unchanged and the automobile  costs  $2.00  per  work
trip  more  than  transit owing  to  free  transit, parking
charges, or other'reasons, transit ridership for work  trips
increases to about  90 percent (Point C).

The   reductions in  the combined emissions of automobiles and
transit vehicles  thus  achieved  depend  on  the  kinds  of
transit  vehicles  used, and the design and operation of the
transit system.  For example, if diesel  buses  meeting  the
California  1975  heavy-duty  diesel  emission standards are
used and these buses carry an average load of 20 passengers,
the reductions in combined bus'and automobile emissions  are
roughly  30 percent for carbon monoxide and hydrocarbons and
15 percent for nitrogen  oxides   in   1977.   In  1985,  when
automobile  emissions  will  be less  than in 1977, the carbon
monoxide and hydrocarbon reductions  are 20  percent  and  25
percent,  respectively.   However,   nitrogen oxide emissions
increase  by  about  20  percent;  this  increase  would  be
eliminated if an average bus occupancy of 30 passengers were
achieved.

These  quantitative results  are  approximate because  of their
reliance on a  single  behavioral  study  and  rather  crude
Measures  of  trip characteristics.   However,  the conclusion
that a high-quality transit  system can  attract  high levels
of ridership  is  also supported by the experience of  existing
high-quality  transit operations,  such as the Shirley Highway
Express  in the Washington, D.C.  area»s.

Most transit  systems in the United  States  do not provide the
 high-quality  service needed to attract  high ridership.  For
 example,  nearly  50 percent  of  urban  area residences  are
 located   three or more blocks from  the  nearest  transit stop.
 Transit  routes are heavily downtown-oriented,  but only about
 1O percent of the  trips go  downtown.   Transit   trips   take
 nearly  'twice   as   long  as  automobile  trips.    Moreover,
 subsidized  free  or   reduced  rate  parking  confers  a   cost
 advantage, on the   automobile.    Transit   service   of   this
 quality  is  illustrated  by Point D of Figure 2>-l,   indicating
 a ridership  of 4 percent.

 Carpools.  Average automobile occupancy in the United States
 is  about two persons  per car.  Average  occupancy  for   work
                            2-284

-------
trips  is  about 1.4 persons per car16.  Since most cars are
capable  of  carrying  at  least  four  persons,  there    is
considerable  room for reducing automobile use and emissions
through carpooling.  The principal obstacle to carpooling  is
that carpools are highly restrictive in terms of the service
offered.  Carpoolers must have trip origins and destinations
that are close to one another, must travel at the same time,
and, to minimize the problems of locating carpool  partners',
must  make  trips that are repetitive from day-to-day.  As a
result, the greatest potential for increased carpool use   is
in  connection with peak-period work trips.  These trips are
responsible for about 25 percent of  urban  area  automobile
emissions*7.

The  present  automobile  low occupancy rates for work trips
indicate that substantial cajrpooling  will  not  take  place
unless  certain  measures  are  implemented to encourage it.
The limited experience to date  with  carpool  programs  has
provided  indications  of  the effectiveness of two possible
approaches to encouraging carpools:

  •  Preferential treatment  for  carpools  on  streets  and
     freeways.

  •  Parking restrictions combined with locator systems.

Preferential treatment for carpools  has  been  observed   to
increase  peak-period  automobile  occupancies  by  10 to  30
percent18.    Locator   systems   combined   with    parking
restrictions  appear  capable  of  doubling  occupancies for
downtown peak-period work trips to suburban locations1'.   If
these  preliminary  indications  are  confirmed  by   future
experience,  programs  to  encourage  carpooling  should   be
capable of reducing total urban area automobile emissions  by
5 to 10 percent.

Carpooling and transit systems appear to be competitive, not
complementary, approaches to reducing automobile use.   Both
approaches  operate  most  easily  in  connection with peak-
period work trips to high density areas, and transit  system
improvements tend to attract passengers from their carpools.
It  is  therefore  unlikely that the effects of high-quality
transit systems and carpooling on  automobile  use  will   be
additive.  For example, if transit system improvements alone
can  achieve  a  15  percent reduction in automobile use and
carpooling alone can achieve a  10  percent  reduction,  the
automobile  use  reduction  obtained  from implementing both
approaches together is likely to be greater than 15  percent
but less than 25 percent.
                           2-285

-------
TRANSPORTATION CONTROL MEASURES
TO REDUCE VMT

In  this section, specific VMT reduction measures considered
by the states, localities, and EPA in developing TCP's  will
be briefly explained.

Bus  and  Carpool Priority Treatment. Priority treatment  for
buses and carpools consists of allocating highway facilities
preferentially  to  these  vehicles  for  the   purpose   of
increasing  their  average  speeds.   The  usefulness of  bus
priority treatment in attracting automobile drivers  to   use
the  transit  is  dependent  on  the  quality of the transit
system or subsystem that uses priority  treatment.  Hence, in
areas where bus priority treatment is included in a TCP,  the
measure is a  part  of  an  integrated  transit  improvement
program.    For  example,  in  the  Washington,  D.C.  area,
priority treatment is used in  combination  with  bus  fleet
expansion,  the addition of new transit routes, and improved
bus scheduling.

  Carpooling  Programs.  Many  TCP's  include  measures  that
provide   computerized   carpool   matching   programs    and
preferential  carpool  treatment  programs.   The   matching
programs  provide  for  the  formation  of carpools, and  the
preferential  treatment programs provide incentives, such  as
free parXing, to encourage carpools.

Computerized  carpool locator programs  have been established
in cities such as Washington, D.C.,  Boston,  Massachusetts,
Knoxville, Tennesse,  and Omaha, Nebraska.

Employer  Transit  Incentive Regulations. Employer incentive
regulations applicable in several metropolitan areas require
major employers to implement measures that encourage the  use
of carpools   and  mass  transit,  while at   the  same  time
discouraging  the  use  of  single-passenger  automobiles  for
work-related  commuting.  Under this approach,  the  employer
has  the  flexibility  to develop his own plan  to minimize  the
impact  of his facility on the area's VMT.   The  concept  is
based   on already existing programs that have been developed
by  employers to  discourage  energy-inefficient  commuting
habits.     In addition,  many  employers  have  voluntarily
started such  programs to  avoid the acquisition of  land   for
additional  parking facilities.  Companies, such as Minnesota
Mining   and   Manufacturing  and   Aerospace Corporation of El
Segundo,    California,    have   already   illustrated     the
effectiveness   of    this   approach   in   reducing  commuter
automobile  usage.
                            2-286

-------
Parking Programs. Parking management programs  are  used  in
several   TCP's   to  complement  the  improvement  of  mass
transportation    and    carpooling    alternatives.     The
transportation  plans  include  two general types of parking
regulations:   on-street  parking   controls   and   parking
management  programs.   The  on-street  parking controls are
similar to common regulations in various cities  to  prevent
congestion  and  to  discourage  commuter  parking on public
streets.

The States are encouraged to  develop  their  own  area-vide
parking  facility  plans.   These  plans should focus on the
interrelationship of  transportation  alternatives  and  new
parking  facilities.   The plans should set forth the manner
in which the location, operation, and increase in the number
of parking-related facilities would be kept consistent  with
the  air quality needs throughout the area.  The plans could
also ensure that the new facilities complemented rather than
competed with existing and  developing  transit  facilities.
Several areas, such as San Diego, Los Angeles, Portland, and
Seattle, have begun such plans for parking restrictions as a
traffic control approach.

Transit  Expansion  and  Development.  The  improvement  and
expansion of mass transit  facilities  is  one  of  the  key
elements for the success of transportation plans.  Bus fleet
expansion will allow service to be upgraded in several major
respects:

  •  Existing routes can offer more frequent service.

  •  New routes can be established to allow more people  the
     opportunity of transit.

  •  Older, uncomfortable  vehicles  can  be  replaced  with
     smoother riding, air-conditioned vehicles.

Within  the   last  two  years,  many  areas have established
programs to improve and upgrade  existing  transit  systems.
Therefore,  in the near  future many areas will begin to offer
the  type   of  alternative  transit that is required  to help
achieve the required VMT reductions.  An example of the type
of  improvement which can effect a reduction in  VMT   is  the
Seattle  "Magic  Carpet" program.  City-wide  fare reductions
along  with  free  fares within the CBD were associated  with   a
fleet   expansion  and   exclusive  bus   lanes.  The  increased
ridership will,  help  Seattle  achieve  the  VMT  reductions
necessary   to   meet   the  National   Ambient  Air   Quality
Standards.
                            2-287

-------
Sufficient Federal funding is  necessary  if  areas  are  to
expand  transit  systems  to  the level necessary to provide
assistance in achieving the VMT reduction goals contained in
the plans.  EPA has been working  with  DOT  to  assure  the
availability  of  such  funding.   in  addition,  states and
localities must be willing to  increase  their  support  for
mass  transit.   ideas  such as using sales tax revenues for
capital and operating  expenses  and  therefore  stabilizing
fares   have   been  successfully  implemented  in  Atlanta,
Georgia.  Other areas must continue to provide the necessary
local commitment if expanded mass transit  is  to  become  a
reality.

Parking Surcharge and Parking Fees. The use of surcharges on
commercial  rates  for  parking both discourages non-carpool
commuting and provides a source  of  financing  for  transit
improvements.    The   measure   can   help  bring  about  a
significant change in urban driving habits vith a minimum of
social disruption if the fees are  properly  formulated  and
integrated  with transit improvements.  The program offers a
wide  latitude of individual choice  to  the  driver.   Those
whose  needs  or  preferences are strongly in  favor of using
the single passenger  automobile  may  continue  to  do  so,
although  at  a  somewhat  higher cost; those  who can easily
adapt to  other modes of transit or a carpool will  have  the
incentive to  take  such  action.   The  Energy  Supply and
Environmental Control Coordination Act of  June  1974   (P.L.
93-319) forbids  the EPA from promulgating surcharges.

Gasoline  Supply Limitations.  Gasoline  supply limitations
are,  at least in theory, one of the most  effective  methods
of  reducing VMT.  At the time the TCP's were first proposed,
gasoline  supply limitations were considered  to be  included
in  several plans.  Two  types of regulations were proposed:

   1.  A  gasoline   supply  lid  would  have  become  effective
      during   1974  or   1975,  which  would  have  limited the
      quantity of gasoline  sold  in an   area  to  fiscal   1973
      levels.

   2.  A  regulation, which would  be  implemented on   May  31,
      1977,  would  reduce  an area's gasoline supply  and  thus
      VMT  to the  extent  necessary  to achieve the  ambient  air
      quality  standards.

The  gasoline   supply   lid was dropped as  a primary control
measure  by   EPA at   the   time  the   plans    were    finally
promulgated.    The   determination   not to   include  gasoline
supply  lids  as  a  "reasonably   attainable"  alternative   was
based  upon  the  comments  received  during  the public  hearings
 held  on  each  plan   and   the   Agency's   evaluation   of   the
                            2-288

-------
 feasibility   of   implementing  and administering an effective
 program.   Moreover,  possibilities of. evasion,  the likelihood
 of noncompliance,  and  the  difficulty of. enforcement appeared
 too great  to  make  this measure praticable.

 However, the  gasoline  supply reduction to be implemented  on
 May  31, 1977, has been retained in plans for  severa-1  areas.
 In these areas,  this measure was included as a final  resort
 measure  to   fulfill  the   statutory requirement that  a plan
 must achieve  the ambient air quality standards by 1977.   In
 each  of these areas,  even with additional  stationary-source
 controls,  inspection and  maintenance  programs,  reasonable
 VMT  control  measures, and retrofit strategies, additional
•VMT reductions were  necessary  to demonstrate  attainment'  of
 the  standards.    As  the   EPA  Administrator   has stated  on
 several occasions, this measure has been included  in   these
 plans to meet, the  technical requirements of the law, and the
 EPA  does  not intend  to implement this measure unless it  is
 leagally required  to do so. EPA has  submitted  a  proposed
 amendment  to the  Clean Air Act which would allow additional
 flexibility in these heavily impacted areas.
 ADDITIONAL  VMT REDUCTION MEASURES

 Several  other   measures   were   considered   and  accepted   or
 rejected  for   use  in  TCP's.   Measures  used by the states or
 EPA  to a  limited   extent  include   bicycle  lane  programs,
 vehicle-free   zones, selective vehicle  exclusion strategies,
 and  gasoline truck  delivery bans.   Of thesef the  first  two
 measures  are   being implemented on a limited basis,  such as
 the  bicycle lane program now underway in   Denver,  Colorado,
 and   the vehicle-free  zones  in Springfield, Massachusetts,
 the  Camden-Trenton  area  of  New Jersey,  and Salt  Lake  City,
 Utah.    The last   two measures (selective vehicle exclusion
 and   gasoline   truck   delivery bans)   were  considered  for
 implementation but  were  rejected.
 Costs  of  Transportation
 Control Plans

 This   section   estimates   the   aggregate-  costs  to the  motor
 vehicle owners  of  implementing  TCP's.   In  order  to  estimate
 aggregate   costs    for    the:   period   1976-85,   costs   of
 implementing, various transportation  control  measures at each
 AQCR have been  computed.   Table 2-7  presents  the  list   of
 AQCR's .which   will   implement   specific   measures that will
 reduce emissions per VMT;   the  table  also  describes  the
 geographic and  model year  coverage of each measure.
                            2-289

-------
                         Table 2-7.
List  of  AQCR's  which Will  implement Measures to
   Reduce Emissions Per  vehicle Mile of Travel
AQCR
Boston
aprlnetield

NY-NJ-Coon.


Philadelphia




Southwest
Peon.
Baltimore
Hull. Capitol




Chicago


Indianapolis

CisoinB&ti

San Antonio

Houston -
GalVBCton
Denver
Pboenlz-
faoata


Wasatoh
Front

Los Angela*
San
Francisco
Sta Diego
f/M
Test
Idle
Idle

Idle

Loaded
Idle


Idle

Idle

Hie
Idle

Idle


Idle


SB»

Idle

Idle


Idls
Idle

Loadod



Idle

Lojd$i

Lotidec
T AfirfaH

Ownership
Private
Public

Public

Public
Private


Public

Private

Private
Public

Private


Public


Private

Public

Private


Private
•public

Public



Public

Public

Public
Public
Area
Covered
AQCR
Springfield
SMSA
N.J. part
of AQCR
N.Y. SMSA
Peon, part
of AQCR

N.J. part
of AQCR
AQCR

AQCR
Va. part of
AQCR
D.C. &MD
part of
AQCR
CookCty.
inc.
Chicago
Marion Co.

Hamilton
County
Hotel


AQCR
AQCR

AQCR



Note 2

AQCR

AQCR
AQCH
Retrofit
V8AD
Vehicle
Year
Pre-68












Pre-«8
Pre-fl8







Pre-68






Prv-64








195S-65

195S-8
1955-6
Area
Covered
AQCR












AQCR
AQCR














AQCR








AQCR

AQCR
AQCR
Air Bleed
Vehicle
Year
968-71


Pre-71


Pre-flS


Pre-71



1968-71








Marios
Co.






Pr»-«a

Pre-68



Pre-68





Area
Covered
AQCR


N.J. part of
AQCR

Pern, part
ofPhtla.
SMSA
N.J. part of
AQCR


AQCR
















AQCR

Phoenix 4

SMSA'e

AQCR
Tooele Co.




-ssvc
tages
i *n


i in





i in

i

i in
i an







i



IAD


ita
i tn







i in

Tin
tin
Area,
Covered
AQCR


N.J. part of
AQCR




N.J. part of
AQCR
Allegheny
County
AQCR
AQCR







Marion
County


San Antonio
County

AQCR
AQCR







AQCR

AQCR
AQCB
   14OTE8: 1 San Antonio SMSA and Kendall, Medina, Wttson, Ataacoaa, Comal Counties.
          S Ogdea, Salt Lake City, Provo- Orem SMSA's.
          5 Boston and Houston - Galvestoo AQCR's have recently cancelled retrofit programs.  Also, tha
            EPA Is presently considering the promulgation of I/M measures for Dallas-Fort Worth.
                                2-290

-------
             Table 2-7. (Continued)
List of AQCR's Which Will implement Measures to
  Reduce Emissions Per vehicle Mile of Travel
AQCH
Sacrum ento
San Joaquln
Puget
Portland

East Wash-
ington,
Idaho

Northern
Alaska




Austtn-
Waco
Dallaa- Ft.
Worth
El Paso




I/M
Test
Type
Loaded
Loaded
Hie
Idle



Idle


Idle













Ownership
Public
Public
Private
Public



Private


Public













Area
Covered
AQCR
AQCR
AQCR
Portland
SMSA


Spokane
SMSA

City of
Fairbanks
4 North
Star-
Borough









Retrofit
VSAD
Vehicle
Tear
1955-65
1858-65






















Area
Covered
AQCH
AQCR






















Air Bleed
Vehicle
Tear


Pre-68
Pre-68



Pre-68


Pre-68













Area
Covered


AQCR
Oregon part
of AQCR


Spokane
SMSA

AQCR













-ssvc
Stages
i in
its














I.

i&a
i&a




Area
Covered
AQCR
AQCR














AQCR

AQCR
El Paso
SMSA &
Texas
Counties
of AQCR
                     2-291

-------
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE PROGRAMS

Analysis of the inspection and maintenance program costs has
been  limited  to  the programs operating in Chicago and Hew
Jersey.  In both instances, the programs make  use  of  idle
mode  tests, and the inspection stations are state owned and
operated.  Reference 11  presents  a. description  of  these
inspection programs as well as estimated fixed and operating
costs for a publicly owned and operated emissions inspection
program.   A  brief  description  of the assumptions used in
estimating costs  of  inspection  and  maintenance  programs
follows.  Cost elements have been computed by the EPA Office
of  Land  Use  and  Transportation  Policy,  based  on  data
provided  by  Northrop/01 sen  Corporationzo,  The  City   of
Chicago2*,  and  the State of Arizona",  It is assumed that
the  inspection  facilities  would  be  either  publicly  or
privately  owned and operated with the needed maintenance of
rejected automobiles performed at privately owned garages or
repair facilities.  The number of inspection lanes  required
is computed from the projected light-duty vehicle population
for that area for the year of program implementation an
-------
  •  Test type  (loaded versus idle)

  •  Geographic location which  determines   the   total   site
     cost.

Table 2-9 presents the summary of costs assumed per two-lane
station.   Reference  11 gives the detailed  breakdown of  the
cost estimate.  The second cost area in the  program  is   the
maintenance  of failed vehicles.  An average tune-up cost of
$30 per failed vehicle,  of  which  $15  is  assumed  to  be
attributable  to  the inspection and maintenance  measure, is
considered.  Vehicles that fail the emissions inspection  and
subsequently are tuned are expected to incur  fuel  savings.
The  extent  of  annual  fuel  savings  from  the program is
dependent on the failure rate  among  other  things.   EPA's
Office  of Transportation and Land Use Policy estimates that
on the basis  of  recent  data  the  following  relationship
exists  between the failure rate and annual  fuel  savings  for
serviced vehicles.- Y = 31.5x~<>. s**, where x=percent  failure
rate  and  Y^annual fuel savings, expressed  in percents,  for
serviced vehicles.  Fleet-wide dollar savings  are  computed
for  each  AQCR  by  computing the fuel saving rate from  the
above equation and assuming an annual vehicle use of  10,000
miles,  a  fuel  consumption rate of 13.58 miles  per gallon,
and a price of gasoline of $0.75 per gallon.

Based on the inspection cost estimates given  in  Table  2-8
and  the  maintenance  cost  and  fuel  savings   assumptions
outlined above, the annual inspection and maintenance  fixed
and operating costs for each AQCR have been  computed for the
years  1976-85.   The  summary  annual  costs for the United
States are presented in Table 2-9.  As shown in   the  table,
the   fuel  savings  more  than  offset  the  costs  of  the
inspection and maintenance program, and in fact,  result  in
an  overall  net  benefit,  even  after  considering all TCP
costs.
                           2-293

-------
                                        Table 2-8.
                 Fixed and Operating Cost of a Two-Lane Inspection Station
to
vo
Cost Category

Capital Costs
  Equipment
  •  Instrumentation
  «  Automated System
  •  Dynamometer
  Installation Costs
  Site costs'
  Construction Costs'
Administration and Miscellaneous1
 . Contingencies'

Total Capital Costs

Annual  Costs:
  Annual Capital Costs"
  Operating Costs
  •  Salaries*
  •  Supplies
  »  Administrative Support and Overhead

Total Annual Costs
                                                              Loaded
                                                                                (In 1975 Dollars)

                                                                         Publ 1.c                         Private
                                                                                   Idle                 Idle
    $11,870
     14,850
      6.4OO
      5,000
  14,OOO-14O,OOO
     35.0OO
      3,000
   4.50O-10.80O

 $94,620-226,920


 $17,064-30,974

     64.OOO
      2,940
     33,060

$117,064-130,974
     $11,87O              $11,870
      14.85O                    0
           O                    0
       3.QOO                6.OOO
  14,OOO-140,OOO                6
      35.0OO                    0
       3, OOO                3, OOO
   4,O9O-7,OOO              1,040

 $85,81O:214,720           21,910


 $15,63O-28,9O7            $6,077

      64,OOO               64.OOO
       2,940                2,940
      33.OGO               33,060

$1 15.63O-128.9O7         $106,077
                1 Administrative and miscellaneous costs are assumed to be $3,OOO per station for the first year.

                1 Unforeseen contingency costs are calculated as 5 percent of the total cost for equipment, instal
                 latlon, land, construction, and administration.

                3 14.OOO Square feet at $1.OO to $1O.OO per square foot.

                * 2.5OO Square feet at $14.OO per square foot.  For private stations It is assumed that present
                 facilities will be adequate to house the small amount of equipment needed for  inspection.

                5 Assuming an economic life of 4O years for land and 1O years for other capital  costs at  1O
                 percent annual Interest and with zero scrap value.  The administrative and miscellaneous costs
                 which are incurred for the first year only are assumed to be non-depreciable.
               • One supervisor at $16,OOO and 5 Inspectors at $9,6OO each per year.

-------
                                     Table 2-9.
            Aggregate Cost . (Benefit) of  Inspection and Maintenance Programs, 1976-85

                                                           (In Millions of  1975 DoUars)
•s
 en
            Year

            1976
            1977
            1978
            1979
            198O
            1981
            1982
            1983
            1984
            1985

            Totals
Capital Annual 1 zed
Investment Capital Stati<
(1)
141
3
3
3
3
2
3
3
3
3
171
Costs (2) Costs
.9
.4
.3
.7
.8
.6
.2
.O
.4
.O
.3
18
18
19
19
20
20
21
21
21
22
2O3
.4
.8
.2
.7
.2
.6
.0
.4
.8
.2
,3
1O4
1O3
1O6
1O9
111
114
116
118
121
123
1,129.
.4
.8
.4
. 1
.9
.0
.4
.6
. 1
.4
. 1
         Operating & Maintenance (0/M)
                  Costs

            Owners'
Station 0/M Maintenance Savings
        >   Cost (4)

            186.0
            19O.8
            195.5
            2OO.3
            2O5.2
            2O9.6
            214,2
            218.7
            223.4
            228.1
Fuel
Sav 1 ngs
(5)
385.9
395.7
405.5
415.5
425.6
434.7
444. 0
453.3
462.9
472.5
Net 0/M
(6)
(3+4-S)
(95.5)
(101.1)
(1O3.6)
(1O6.1)
(1O8.5)
(111.1)
(113.4)
(116. O)
(118.4)
(121.0)
Annual
Costs (7)
(2+6)
(77.1)
(82.3)
(84,4)
(86.4)
(88.3)
(90. S)
(92.4)
(94.6)
(96.6)
(98.8)

Cumu 1 a-t 1 ve
(8)
(77.1)
( 159.4)
(243.8)
(33O.2)
(418.5)
(5O9.0)
(6O1 .4)
(696.0)
( 792 . 6 )
(891.4)
                                                            2,071.8
                      4,295.6
(1,094.7)
(891.4)

-------
RETROFIT PROGRAMS

vacuum Spark Advance Disconnect  (VSADK VSAD  retrofits  are
mainly   applicable   to   pre-1967  vehicles  as  shown   in
Table 2-7.  It is assumed that the installation  cost  of  a
VSAD retrofit would be approximately $20.00 per vehicle, and
it  is  estimated  that the annual maintenance cost would  be
approximately  $5.00  per  vehicle.   VSAD   retrofits   are
expected  to  increase  fuel  use from 0 to 2 percent, which
translates to a maximum annual fuel penalty  of  $11.2.5  per
vehicle,  assuming a fuel consumption rate of 750 gallons  at
$0.75 per gallon.

Air Bleed. The 11 AQCR's that will be implementing air-bleed
retrofit programs  are  listed   in  Table  2-7.   Air  bleed
devices   are  primarily  applicable  to  pre-1968  vehicles
although some areas, such as Baltimore  and  Boston,  extend
the   applicability   to  1971   model  year  vehicles.   The
installation cost of an air bleed retrofit is assumed to   be
$40  per  vehicle  for  simple air bleed devices and $55 per
vehicle for air bleed devices with exhaust gas recirculation
(EGR).  It is further assumed that the life of  the  devices
is 5 years, necessitating replacement of the equipment after
that  period  at  the same cost.  However, air bleed devices
are expected to increase the fuel economy by approximately 4
percent.  This fuel economy benefit translates to $22.50 per
year per vehicle.  Therefore, the net  benefit  over  the  5
year  life  of  the units would  be $72.00 per vehicle with a
simple air bleed device and $57.50 per vehicle with  an  air
bleed/EGR device.

Summary  Costs  of Retrofits. The summary aggregate costs of
the retrofit programs for 1976 through 1985 are presented  in
Table 2-10.
                           2-296

-------
                        Table 2-1O.
        Summary Costs of Retrofit Programs,  1976-85
k
^
Retrofit Program
VSAD
Cumulative
Air Bleed
Cumulative
Totals
Cumulative
1976'
34.
34.
34
34
,5
.5
.5
.5
1977
27.
61.
69.
69.
96.
130.
O
.4
2
2
2
.7
1978
13
75
(46
22
(32
98
.9
.4
.4)'
.8
.5)
.2
(In
1979
10.
85.
(33.
(10,
(23
75
2
.6
.4)
.6)
.2)
.0
Mil 1 ions
198O
7.
93.
(23,
(34,
(15
59
8
.4
5)
.1)
.7)
.3
of 1975 Dol lars)
1981 1982
6
1OO
(16
(5O
(9
49
.6
.O
-1)
.2)
.5)
.8
6.
1O6.
12.
(38
18
68
3
3 •
, 1
.1)
.4
.2
1983
6.
112
(8.
(46
(1
66
.3
.6
.1)
.2)
.8)
.4
1984
6
118
(7
(53
(0
65
.3
.9
.1)
.3)
.8)
.6
1985
6.3
125.2
(6.5)
(59.8)
(0.2)
65.4
1  Only California AQCR's will  implement  VSAD in 1976.

'  Numbers in parentheses indicate negative value,  i.e.,  economies gained by implementation of
  these retrofits.

-------
SERVICE STATION VAPOR CONTROLS

The recent controversy about  the  Stage  II  Vapor  Control
Systems   (simple   balance   and   vacuum-assist)   creates
uncertainty  as  to  the  type  of  system  which  will   be
implemented.   The  installation  cost  of  a  vacuum-assist
system is significantly higher than the simple  displacement
system.   Using the simple balance method, costs per station
may run between $2,000 (for a new station) and  $5,000   (for
existing   stations)   for  the  required  equipment  labor.
Vacuum-assist equipment costs anywhere from one and  a  half
to two times as much.  For a 75,000 gallon per month service
station,  the University of California, San Diego, estimates
the investment  costs  at  $6,727  and  $14,681  for  simple
balance and vacuum-assist systems, respectively.23

In  estimating  the investment and operating cost of service
station vapor control systems, it is assumed that for  Stage
II  controls,  one-third  of the systems implemented will be
simple balance and two-thirds will be vacuum-assist.   Based
on  EPA's  most  recent  data,  the investment and operating
costs of the systems are assumed to be as follows:
                                      Blower-  Simple
                                      Assist   Displacement

Investment
  Service station component
     (Stage II)                       $12,000  $8,000
  Support facilities component
     (Stage I)                          1,300   1,300

Total per station                     $13,300  $9,300

Operating costs per station
  per year                            $   556  $  556
For Stage I systems, a fuel savings benefit  of  $594  would
result,  assuming  90  percent  efficiency in recovering 880
gallons per station at $0-75 per gallon.  For Stage II,  the
fuel  savings  benefit  would  be  $495  for  simple balance
systems, assuming 75 percent recovery, and $627 for  vacuum-
assist  systems,  assuming  95 percent recovery.  Table 2-11
presents the summary costs of service station vapor controls
for the 10-year period.
                           2-298

-------
                        Table 2-11.
      Aggregate Costs of Service Station Vapor control
                     Programs, 1976-85
         Annual Costs (In Millions of 1975 Dollars)

Year       Fixed    Operating      Total    Cumulative

1977      $46.4    $(14.2)        $32.2      32.2
1978       46.4     (14.2)         32.2      64.4
1979       46.4     (14.2)         32.2      96.6
1980       46.4     (14.2)         32.2     128.8
1981       46.4     (14.2)         32.2     161.0
1982       46.4     (14.2)         32.2     193.2
1983       46.4     (14.2)         32.2     225.4
1984       46.4     (14.2)         32.2     257.6
1985       46.4     (14.2)         32.2     289.8
SUMMARY COSTS

Table 2-12 shows the summary costs associated with  measures
that  will  reduce  emissions  per vehicle mile.  Table 2-13
shows the breakdown between capital costs and operating  and
maintenance  costs  for  each control program for the period
from 1976 to 1985.

Approximately 90 percent of  the  total  cost  for  reducing
emissions per vehicle mile is attributable to the inspection
and  maintenance  programs.  Several factors account for the
large  costs  of  inspection  and  maintenance  relative  to
retrofit  and  service  station vapor controls.  Perhaps the
most significant is the  annual  operating  cost,  which  is
estimated  to be $100,000 per station.  Furthermore, because
of the random vehicle arrivals for inspection, it is assumed
that the stations will be idle 40 percent of  the  time  and
therefore  they  will not operate at optimum capacity.  This
idle factor obviously offers some potential for economy  and
reduction of overall costs; however, the amount of idle time
that could be utilized is indeterminable at this time.

A  second  factor  that  contributes  to  the  large cost of
inspection and  maintenance  programs  is  that  essentially
every  vehicle  in  the  control  area  must  submit  to the
inspection, and those that fail will require maintenance and
reinspection, whereas retrofit systems usually apply only to
a small portion of the total number of  vehicles.   Finally,
retrofit  and  service  station vapor control cost estimates
                           2-299

-------
include some partially compensatory  economies,  whereas  no
fuel economies are considered for inspection and maintenance
programs.
                          2-300

-------
to

U!
O
                        Table 2-12.
Summary of Costs for Measures that Reduce Emissions Per Vehicle Mile

                                               Annual Costs (In Millions of 1975 Dollars)


Measure

Inspect ion/
  Maintenance (I/M)
I/M Fuel  Savings
Net I/M Costs
Retrofit
Service Station
  Vapor Control

Net TCP Costs

Cumuiat1ve

Note:  Totals in this table differ somewhat from totals in other tables because of rounding.

Source:  Tables, 2-9, 2-1O, and 2-11.
1976
309
(386)
(77)
35
--
(42)
(42)
1977
313
(396)
(83)
96
32
45
3
1978
321
(406)
(85)
(33)
32
(86)
(83)
1979
329
(416)
(87)
(23)
32
(78)
(161)
1980
337
(427)
(90)
(16)
32
(74)
(235)
1981
344
(435)
(91)
(10)
32
(69)
(304)
1982
352
(444)
(92)
18
32
(42)
(346)
1983
359
(453)
(95)
(2)
32
(65)
(411)
1984
366
(463)
(97)
(D
32
(66)
(477)
1985
374
(473)
(39)
O
32
(67)
(544)

-------
u»
o
                                      Table 2-13,
                Investment and Operating Maintenance Costs for Measures
               Which Reduce Emissions Per Vehicle Mile Travelled 1976-85
                                                          (In Millions of 1975 Dollars)
Total Program
Costs
Retrofit
VSAD
Air Bleed
Subtotal
Inspection/
Maintenance
Service Station
Vapor Controls
Totals
$125.
(59.
$ 65.
($891.
289.
($536.
2
8)
4
4)
8
2)
Operating and
Investment Maintenance
Costs Costs
$ 22
153
$175
$2O3
285
$663
. 1
.4
.5
.3
. 1
.9
$1O3
(213
$(110
$3,2OO
4
$3,O95
. 1
.2)
.1)
.9
.7
.5
Fuel
Savings'


($4,295.6)

($4.295.6)
                Because the fuel savings associated with the inspection and maintenance measure have such a
                sizeable impact on overall TCP costs, they are broken out separately.

-------
COST OF IMPLEMENTING MEASURES
THAT REDUCE VMT

The   implementation   of   measures  to  reduce  automobile
emissions by reducing VMT will affect many aspects of  urban
activity  other  than  air  quality.   Some  non-air quality
aspects are:

  •  Energy consumption.  Transit systems  are  considerably
     more energy efficient than the automobile.  Bus transit
     uses  approximately  3,600  Btu's  per  passenger  mile
     compared to 8,000 Btu's in work  trips  by  automobile.
     Therefore,  reduction  in  automobile  use  achieved by
     diverting automobile travelers to  transit  buses  will
     reduce  energy  consumption.   Reductions in automobile
     use achieved through carpooling  will  also  result  in
     energy  savings  that are approximately proportional to
     VMT reductions.

  •  Transportation  noise.   The  diversion  of  automobile
     travelers  to  public  transit appears to be capable of
     reducing exposure to highway-generated noise.  A  study
     of  the  1-66 corridor near Washington, D.C., indicates
     that the transit option decreases exposure to  elevated
     noise  levels  by  10  to  20 percent, depending on the
     noise  level,  whereas  the  highway  option  increases
     exposure to noise by as much as 47 percent.2*

  •  Traffic  safety.   Transit  buses  have   roughly   one
     fatality  per 100 million passenger miles25 compared to
     about 1.6 fatalities per 100  million  passenger  miles
     for automobiles in urban areas.2*^27 BUS accident costs
     per  passenger  mile  are  roughly  two-thirds those of
     automobiles.2»,2»

  •  Traffic congestion  and  highway  construction.   Buses
     require  roadway  space of less than 2 automobiles, but
     carry up to 50 times as many passengers per vehicle  as
     automobiles.  Thus, the diversion of automobile drivers
     to  public  transit  as well as to carpools will reduce
     traffic volumes and congestion.   Furthermore,  reduced
     congestion  will  result  in  reduced  need for further
     highway construction.

  •  Travel times.  Transit buses require more time than the
     automobile for access,  collection,  and  distribution.
     These  transit  time disadvantages can be offset by the
     use of express bus routes and  priority  treatment  for
     transit   vehicles,    Carpools   have   also   a  time
     disadvantage   relative    to    the    single-occupant
     automobile.    This   diadvantage  is  incurred  during
                           2-303

-------
     collection and distribution and, as in the case of  bus
     transit,  it  can  be  offset  to  some  extent  by the
     provision of priority treatment.

Many  of  the  non-air  quality  effects  listed  above  are
beneficial  and would make the implementation of the control
measures desirable even if air quality were not  a  problem.
Indeed,  the transportation measures that have been proposed
to improve air quality have also been proposed to  alleviate
non-air quality related urban transportation problems.

There   has   been   little   direct  experience  with  many
transportation  control  measures   or   with   changes   in
transportation    system   attributes   of   the   magnitude
contemplated in some TCP's.  Certain types of  costs,  i.e.,
those  associated  with the changes in urban land use due to
transportation  control  measures  in  this  category,   are
particularly  difficult  to  estimate.30  Another  source of
difficulty  stems  from  the  joint  benefits  derived  from
transportation  control  measures.   Although  costs  for  a
transit  improvement  program  could   be   estimated   with
reasonable accuracy, it would be imappropriate to assign the
full cost to the cause of achieving air quality.  Other non-
air  quality benefits should share an appropriate portion of
the total cost.  Another source of difficulty of  estimating
costs of transportation control measures is that these costs
are  highly  dependent  on  the  specific  control  measures
implemented and the  manner  and  area  in  which  they  are
implemented.   Finally,  AQCR's  have  not yet specified the
specific VMT measures they will adopt.  For  these  reasons,
the  costs  of  transportation  control  measures related to
reductions in VMT are not estimated in this report.
                           2-304

-------
References

1.   "National Primary and  Secondary  Ambient.  Air  Quality
     Standards", Federal Register, Vol. 36, No. 84, Part  II,
     April 30, 1971.

2.   "Transportation Controls to Reduce Automobile  Use   and
     improve  Air Quality in cities: The Needs, the Options,
     and  Effects  on  Urban  Activity",  Report   by   U.S.
     Environmental  protection Agency, to the U.S. Congress,
     November 18, 1974.

3.   "Final Report on the Cost  of  Clean  Air",  Battelle's
     Columbus Laboratories, to U.S. Environmental Protection
     Agency, Contract No. 68-01-1538, January 15, 1974.

4.   "inspection and Maintenance  of  Light-Duty,  Gasoline-
     Powered  Motor  vehicles:  A Guide for Implementation",
     U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, August 1974.

5.   "Transportation Controls for Reducing  Air  Pollution",
     U.S.   Environmental  Protection  Agency,  February  21,
     1974.

6.   Federal Register, vol. 38, No. 110, June 8, 1973.

7.   "Control  Strategies   for   In-Use   Vehicles",   U.S.
     Environmental Protection Agency, November 1972.

8-   Federal Register, Vol. 39, NO. 118, June 18, 1974.

9.   "'Must Do1  Systems Will cost $1,000,000,000",  National
     Petroleum News, October 1974.

10.  "The Clean Air Act and Transportation Controls:  An EPA
     White Paper",  U.S.  Environmental  Protection  Agency,
     August 19710.

11.  Cronin, F.  J., "An Economic Analysis of  Transportation
     Control   Measures   to   Reduce   Automotive   Related
     Pollutants",  U.S.  Environmental  Protection   Agency,
     September 1974.

12-  Federal Register, vol. 39, February 8, 1974.
13.  Schuck, E. A., and Papetti,  R.,  "Examination  of  the
     Photochemical   Air   Pollution   Problem  in  Southern
     California", In:  "Technical Support Document  for  the
     Metropolitan Los Angeles Intrastate Air Quality Control
                           2-305

-------
     Plan",    Appendix   D,  U.S.  Environmental  Protection
     Agency, October 30, 1973.

14.  "A  Disaggregated  Behavioral  Model  of  Urban  Travel
     Demand",  prepared  by  Charles River Associates, Inc.,
     for the Federal Highway Administration  under  Contract
     NO. FM-11-7566, March 1972.

15.  "Additions and Revisions to the implementation Plan for
     the  Control  of  Carbon  Monoxide,  Nitrogen   oxides,
     Hydrocarbons,   and   Photochemical  Oxidants  for  the
     District of Columbia Portion of  the  National  Capitol
     interstate Air Quality control Region", prepared by the
     Government of the District of Columbia and the National
     Capitol  interstate  Air  Quality  Planning  Committee,
     April 1973.

16.  Strate,  H.E.,   "Automobile   Occupancy",   Nationwide
     Personal  Transportation  Survey,  U.S.  Department  of
     Transportation, Report No. 1, April 1972.

17.  Horowitz, J. I., and Pernela,  L.  M.,  "Comparison  of
     Automobile  Emissions  According  to  Trip  Type in TWO
     Metropolitan  Areas",  U.S.  Environmental   Protection
     Agency, May 1974.

18.  "Freeway  Lanes  for  High  Occupancy  Vehicles-  Third
     Annual  Progress Report", State of California, Business
     and Transportation Agency, December 1973.

19.  Pratsch, L,, "Carpool and Buspool Matching Guide", U.S.
     Department of Transportation, February 1973.

20.  "Mandatory    Vehicle    Emissions    Inspection    and
     Maintenance:    Technical   and   Economic  Feasibility
     Analysis", Northrop/Olson corporation, Vol.  Ill,  Part
     A, 1971.

21.  "vehicle Emission  Testing Program Final Report, Concept
     and  Criteria",    Personal   communication   from   the
     Department   of  Public  works,  City  of  Chicago,  to
     Northrop/Olson, February 1973.

22.  "Technical  Report:   The   Motor   Vehicle   Emissions
     inspection  Program",  The  State  of  Arizona, January
     1974.

23.  "Technical  Review  and  Evaluation  of  Vapor  control
     Systems",   University   of  California  at  San  Diego,
     Department  of  Applied   Mechanics   and   Engineering
     Sciences,  1974.
                            2-306

-------
24.  Howard,  Needles,  Tammen,   and   Bergendorff,   "1-66
     Corridor    Transportation   Alternatives   Study-Draft
     Environment Section 4(f) Statement", prepared  for  the
     Virginia Department of Highways, November 1973.

25.  Wells, J. D., ejt al., "Economic Characteristics of  the
     Urban Public Transportation industry", prepared for the
     Department  of  Transportation  by  the  Institute  for
     Defense Analysis, February 1972.

26.  "1973/74 Automobile Facts and Figures",  Motor  vehicle
   .  Manufacturers Association, Detroit, Michigan.

27.  Strate,  H.  E.,  "Automobile  Occupancy",   Nationwide
     Personal   Transportation   Survey,   Report   No.   lf
     Department of Transportation, April 1972.

28.  Frye,  F.  F.,   "Alternative   Multi-Modal   Passenger
     Transportation    Systems    -   Comparative   Economic
     Analysis",  National   Cooperative   Highway   Research
     Program Report No. 146, Highway Research Board, 1973.

29.  "Characteristics  of  Urban  Transportation   Systems",
     Deleuw,   Gather,   and   Company,   prepared  for  the
     Department of Transportation, May 1974.

30.  Curry, D. A., and  Anderson,  D.  G.,  "Procedures  for
     Estimating Highway User Costs, Air Pollution, and Noise
     Effects",  National Cooperative Highway Research Report
     No. 133, Highway Research Board, 1972.
                           2-307

-------
                       Section Three

                   THE ECONOMICS OF WATER
                     POLLUTION CONTROL
Chapter 1
Summary

The economics of  controlling  water  pollution  encompasses
both  the  expected  benefits  and  the  probable  costs  of
control.  The principal findings in the  control  cost  area
are  summarized  below-  benefits of water pollution control
are discussed in the next section of this chapter.

The benefits from controlling water pollution are the result
of reduced levels of pollutants in the  nation's  waterways.
Table   1  presents  estimates  of  the  amount  of  various
pollutants that are  expected  to  be  introduced  into  the
waters from 1971 to 1985.
                            3-1

-------
                                         Table  1.
                       National Trend  in Effluent Discharge Levels
                                                                          Net Weight
                                                                        (Metric Tons)
u>
i
Water Pollutants                            1971        1975

Industrial and Electrical Energy:

  BOD                                   2,067,693   1.966.OO1
  Suspended sol Ids                      6,744,996   6,235,049
  Dissolved sol1dS                     11,343.849  11,496,225
  Nutrients                                86.2O3      81,596
  Acids                                   233,623     224,038
  COD                                   3,353,814   3.312,273
                                                                                   1977'
                                                                                           1983*
                    1985
 1,315,045687,652 573 ,'299
 3.405.3OO771.352 444,866
11,488,0629,714,877 9,305,820
    54,297 39,249  38,609
    80,836   68    13
 2,851,155988,144 1,675,683
               Municipal Sewage':

                 BOD
                 Suspended sol Ids
                 Nutrients
                                        1,693,273   1,586,899    1,437,3936,400 702,669
                                        1,820,621   1,668,368    1.429,736983,516 822,O32
                                        1,014,442   1,061,768    1.080,43JO85,340 1,084,620
               1  A11 BPT Installed
               '  All BAT Installed
               '  Municipal sewage figures are based upon the following assumptions:
                    a. Percentage of population sewered: 1970(71.0), 1974(75.0), 1990(83.0)
                    b. Percentage of sewered population by type:
                       -Primary: 1971(21.3), 1974(21.0), 1977(2O.O), 1985(0.0)
                       -Secondary:  1971(62.3), 1974(62.6), 1977(67.5), 1985(81,2)
                       -Tertiary: 1971(1.4), 1974(4.4), 1977(6.5),  1985(18.8)
                       -No Treatment: 1971(15.0), 1975(12.0). 1977(6.0), 1985(0.0)
                    c. Removal efficiency of BOD, SS, Nitrates,  Phosphates-~by type :
                       -Primary:  38, 60, 0, O
                       -Secondary:   85,  85, O, O
                       -Tertiary:  97, 98, 91, 9O

-------
The direct costs of water pollution control will be  incurred
as expenditures to install and operate equipment, to control
the   pollution  from  "point  sources"   (i.e.,  those  with
channelized waste streams),  and  to  prevent  sediment  and
other run-off from "nonpoint sources".

On  the basis of the results of the 1976 Needs Survey  (Final
Report to the Congress, February 1977  "Cost  Estimates  for
Construction    of   Publicly-Owned   Wastewater   Treatment
Facilities"),  the  largest  single  category  of    required
expenditures   is  that  required  for  the  collection  and
treatment of municipal sewage and stormwater,  $150   billion
(in  1976  dollars  as  reported  in  Needs Survey)  by 1990.
These expenditure requirements have been  divided  into  six
categories,  depending  on  the  required  treatment  levels,
and/or the type of construction as follows:
  1. category I

  2. Category II
  3. category IIIA -


     Category IIIB -

  4; Category IVA  -

     Category IVB  -

  5. Category v


  6. Category VI
Secondary Treatment.

More Stringent Treatment Required  by
Water Quality (removal of phosphorus,
ammonia,    nitrates,   and   organic
pollutants).
Correction          of
infiltration/Inflow.

Major Sewer Rehabilitation.

Collector Sewers.

interceptor Sewers.

              of    Combined
                                Sewer
Correction
Overflows.
Treatment    and/or
Stormwaters.
                       Control
Sewer
   of
In  Table  2,  an  aggregated  summary of municipal costs is
presented for the two basic scenarios used in  this  report:
Federal    outlays   (and   associated   state   and   local
expenditures) resulting from current contract authority, and
Federal outlays  resulting  from  a.  recommended  additional
contract  authority  of  $4.5  billion per year beginning in
FY1978 and continuing for ten years.   Comparing  the  total
investment  under these two scenarios with the estimate $150
                            3-3

-------
billion (in 1973 dollars) from the  Needs  Survey  indicates
that  neither  program  will  meet  the  estimates of actual
requirements, although the  higher  scenario  will  meet  84
percent of the "backlog" needs in Categories i through v.
                          Table 2.
                 Summary of Municipal Costs
                 (Millions of 1973 Dollars)
Federal Grant
Authority

Current
                    1976-85
                  investment
26.4
            1985     1985
            O&M   Annualized
                  Capital
1.45
 4.23
Additional
$4.5 Billion
per year
{Beginning  in
1977)
63.3
3.48
10.1
 Industrial  water  pollution control investment expenditures
 over  the  same  1976-85 period will  amount  to   approximately
 $52   billion{1975$).  These expenditures are only 35  percent
 of the  municipal costs reported in the  1976 Needs Survey but
 are   higher    than   the   "current-authority"    municipal
 expenditures by 96 percent.  The anticipated water pollution
 control costs  from 1976  to 1985 are presented  for each major
 water polluting industry in Table 3, and Figures 1 and 2.
                             3-4

-------
                          Table 3.
            National Industrial investment costs
                 for Water Pollution Costs
                (Millions of 1975 Dollars)*
industry                  1974-1977   1978-1983   1976-1985

GROUP I

Feedlots                       50          24          54

Beet Sugar                     12          19          28

Cane Sugar                     22          22          28

Dairy                          54       1,035       1,096

Fruits & vegetables            35         429         479

Grain Milling                 NEC         144         145

Meat & Poultry Processing     117       1,134       1,210

Seafood                        40       1,122       1,292

Leather                        48         265         295

Textiles                      134         453         558

Builders Paper                 11         129         138

Pulp and Paper              1,963       2,503       6,654

Plywood, Hardboard
and Wood Preservation          71          43         425

inorganic Chemicals           632         333         516

Fertilizers                   111         173         285

Organic Chemicals             678       4,457       5,403

Phosphates                     69          77         131

Plastics & Synthetics         348       1,099       1,454
                            3-5

-------
        Table 3. (Continued)
National industrial investment Costs
     for Water Pollution Costs
    (Millions of 1975 Dollars)!
industry
GROUP I (cont'd.)
Petroleum
Rubber
Ferroalloys
iron and Steel
Bauxite Refining
Primary Aluminum
Secondary Aluminum
Copper
primary Lead
Primary Zinc
Asbestos
cement
Fiberglass
Flat Glass
Pressed & Blown Glass
Electroplating
Steam Electric Power
Soaps & Detergents
1974-1977

1,562
85
15
1,760
63
29
3
14
3
8
1
37
15
2
16
1,995
600
6
1978-1983

524
84
50
1,800
61
24
52
11
2
15
2
18
18
4
174
2,793
3,900
69
1976-19£

1,770
148
95
3,120
111
45
55
15
3
18
3
39
29
6
229
3,837
4,800
75
                 3-6

-------
                    Table 3. (Continued)
            National Industrial Investment Costs
                 for water Pollution Costs
                (Millions of 1975 Dollars)1
Industry                  1974-1977   1978-1983   1976-1985

GROUP II

Fabricated Metals           3,579       4,223       6,035

Machinery-Electrical        1,144       1,588       2,301

Machinery-Nonelectrical     3,165       4,068       5,318

Transportation Equipment    2,147       2,361       3,527

NATIONAL TOTALS            20,650      37,300      51,800
  Detailed independent studies of several of these
  industries were recently completed for EPA by various
  consultants.  The revised estimates are presented here,
  with explanations of the differences from SEAS estimates
  in the individual industry descriptions.

  Group II industries were analyzed by Gianessi and PesXin
  with different sub-categorizations.  ("The Cost to
  Industries of the Water Pollution Control Amendment
  of 1972," National Bureau of Economic Research,
  December 1975—Revised January 1976.)  The total overall
  industries in this group for their study was $9,870 million
  for BPT.  This compares very favorably with the SEAS total
  of $10,340 million.  For purposes of national impact
  analysis, both estimates are within an acceptable range of
  computational variance.
                            3-7

-------
                  Figure 1.
    Total  industrial Capital  Investment
       for Water Pollution Abatement
    32
    24
i
in
r-
S   16
u.
o
t/>
a
j
3
                                               TOTAL
                                               ANNUALIZED
                                               O&M
                                               ANNUALIZEO
                                               CAPITAL
       76   77  78  79   80  81  82   83  84  85
                         YEAR
                   3-8

-------
                 Figure 2.
 Industrial  Annual!zed Capital Investment
and operation  and Maintenance Expenditures
      for Water  Pollution Abatement
    80
    60
CO
§
in
u.
o
in
§
    40
    20
                                               CUMULATIVE
                                               INVESTMENT
                                              ANNUAL
                                              INVESTMENT
      76   77   78  79  80   81   82  83  84  85

                        YEAR
                 3-9

-------
Estimating  the  costs  of  nonpoint-source  water pollution
control is much more difficult.  Not only  has   little  work
been  done in this area, but both the amount of  pollution  to
be controlled and the appropriate methods of control  depend
on such complex variables as annual rainfall characteristics-
and  local  soil  conditions.   Control' and  implementation
strategies  are  not  sufficiently  well-defined to   allow
estimation of agricultural nonpoint costrs.

in  addition  to  the  expenditures  for  pollution   control
equipment, direct costs will also be incurred to operate the
government programs necessary  to  administer  the  pollution
control  program.  These costs, which will be experienced  at
all levels of government - national, state, and  local,  are
summarized in Table 4 below.
                          Table 4.
    Government Expenditures  for water  Pollution  Federal
        and  State-Local,  for Selected  Years,  1975-85
                (in Millions  of 1975 Dollars)
                     1977         1983         1985

Federal            367.9        311.9        311.9

State-Local        130.0        130.0        130.0

Total              497.9        441.9        441.9
 The   direct   costs discussed above are not  the only costs of
 the  water pollution control  program.   The burden of  meeting
 these  direct  costs will have repercussions on society,  and
 industry must somehow pay for the costs of   water  pollution
 control  equipment.   This payment may be manifested through
 increased consumer prices, changes  in  production,  or,   in
 extreme cases, plant closures.
                            3-10

-------
Chapter 2
The Benefits of Controlling
water Pollution
This  section  of   the  report  presents  a state-of-the-art
.assessment of  the  national   benefits  of  controlling  water
pollution.   A  broad   spectrum of  studies has  been reviewed
for information  on vater pollution  control   benefits.    The
information    is   fragmentary    and    localized,  requiring
questionable extrapolations   to   develop  estimates  at   the
national   level.   Table   1   summarizes the availability  and
reliability of the information contained  in these  studies.
                            3-11

-------
                          Table 1.
   Availability and Reliability of Information on Water
                     Pollution Damages
Pollutant
Health
Aesthetic
and        Outdoor    Product. Prop.
Ecological Recreation Losses   Values
Acidity
BOD
Col i form
Bacteria
Color
Floating
Solids
Hardness
Nutrients
Odor
Oil
Pesticides
Sediment
Temperature
IDS and
Salinity
TSS and
Turbidity
Toxic Metals
General
Pollution
U
U

SP
u
o
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u

SP
                          u
                          SP

                          u
                          u

                          u
                          u
                          u
                          u
                          SP
                          u
                          IF
                          SP

                          D

                          U
                          U

                          SP
                       SF
                       IF


                       SF
                       U


                       IF
                       U
                       SP
                       U
                       SP
                       O
                       IF
                       IF

                       U


                       SF
                       SP


                       AF
                        SP
                        IF

                        SP
                        O

                        SP
                        IP
                        SP
                        u
                        SP
                        u
                        IF
                        SP

                        IF

                        SP
                        SP

                        IF
U
U

U
U

U
u
u
u
u
u
SP
u

u

u
u

SF
        Availability:

        A - ample
        I - insufficient
        S - scarce
        U - unavailable
                  Reliability:

                  E - excellent
                  G - good
                  F - fair
                  p - poor
Future refinements  in   the  data   and   techniques  used   for
estimation   should   lead  to   a   better understanding of  the
damage sources,   as well  as  more  precise  estimates   for
respective  damages.
                            3-12

-------
                       HEALTH DAMAGES
Nature and Effects of Water Pollution
Damage to Health

The  negative  effects of water pollution on  health  were  the
earliest motivation  for water pollution  control.    Even   at
present  levels  of  wastewater treatment and  municipal water
supply treatment, harmful pollutants   can  be  ingested   and
cause   disease.   Bacteria  and  viruses  are   the  primary
pollutants  threatening  human   health,   although   recent
attention  has  also focused  on  carcinogens.   Among   the
diseases that have   been  investigated  are   gastroenteritis
(including  nausea,  stomach cramps and diarrhea), infectious
hepatitis, menengitis, congenital heart anomalies, and acute
myocarditis and pericarditis.  The existing literature  must
be. considered inadequate because of the number  of pollutants
and  diseases  for   which  there is insufficient statistical
correlation.
Survey of Source Studies

A survey of health damage studies was accomplished by  Neri,
Hewitt,   and  Schreiber  (1974),  who  surveyed  nearly  50
international epidemiological studies.  Unger, Emerson,  and
jqrdening (1973) present a graphic display of health impact,
effect  transmission,  and  pollutant  relationship in their
study.  Nearly all health benefit studies rely on the  Craun
and  McCabe  (1971) damage estimate of reported outbreaks of
waterborne illnesses.  The Environmental  Protection  Agency
(EPA) is currently studying the impact of water pollution on
human  health  by  examining  the relationship between water
quality and the absenteeism of elementary school children.
                 OUTDOOR RECREATION DAMAGES
Mature and Effects of Water Pollution
Damages to Recreation

Because of the  strong  dependence  associated  with  water-
related recreation to water quality, recreation accounts for
a  major  part  of  the  damages  caused by water pollution,
Svimming, boating, and fishing are among  the  most  popular
outdoor  activities-  the various pollutants discharged into
our waterways  clearly  interfere  the  enjoyment  of  these
activities.
                           3-13

-------
Swimming and other primary water-contact sports that provide
a likelihood of swallowing water are most strongly affected,
as is evident by the water quality criteria developed by the
Committee  on Water Quality Criteria who set requirements of
fecal coliform, pH, clarity, and  color.   Howevert  surveys
have  made  it  clear  that  much  more  than  these  health
considerations  influence   the   quality   of   water-based
recreation.   For  example,  fishing  clearly depends on the
capability  of  the  water  to  support  wildlife  which  is
affected by a number of water quality parameters, especially
dissolved oxygen, high temperatures, pH, phenols, turbidity,
ammonia, dissolved solids, nitrates, and phosphates.

The  aesthetic  experience  of  being  in, on, or near water
strongly  influences   the   pleasantness   of   all   water
recreational activities.  The measures of water quality that
are  most  highly-valued  in  people's  perceptions  of  its
aesthetic attractiveness  have  been  the  major  target  of
studies  done  by survey researchers.  They include floating
debris and oil, odor, clarity, and color;  these  conditions
can  cause  a  reduction  in  the  quality  and value of the
recreation experience, making it less enjoyable.   Secondly,
pollutants   can   increase   the   costs   of  obtaining   a
satisfactory recreational experience.  Such increased  costs
arise  primarily  from  increases in extended travel to gain
access to sufficiently clean water, but they can also result
from additional equipment  or  maintenance  expenses.   Both
decreased  quality  and  increased  cost  ususally lead to  a
reduction in the  frequency or intensity of  using  available
recreation sites.

Water  pollution  also  decreases  the value of recreational
experiences.   The study by Ditton and  coodale   (1972}  also
estimated  that   21  percent  of  the  existing  users would
experience higher value from recreation   if  pollution  were
reduced  by  1 percent.   The extent of  increased value was
estimated using Ericson's data on  willingness  to  pay   for
avoiding  polluted- water.  This estimate, which amounted  to
$5.75  per recreation day,  was  developed  for   tourists   in
Colorado.
 Survey of Source Studies

 An  excellent  survey of nearly 50 outdoor recreation damage
 studies  is  provided  by  aordening  (1974).    The   survey
 presents  tables containing over 30 water characteristics or
 constituents   that   are   detrimental     to    water-based
 recreational  activity,  as  well  as  reported  damages and
 established critical levels of specific pollutants.
                            3-14

-------
Major source studies employed in contemporary calculation of
damages and their respective  subject  areas  are  presented
below:

  *  Council on Environmental Quality (1972) - water quality

  •  Ericson (1975) - value of recreation experience

  •  Ditton and Goodale (1972) - recreationists'  reaction to
     water quality

  •  U.S. Fish and Wildlife Service (1972) - recreation days
     and travel mileage

  •  U.S. Bureau of Outdoor Recreation (1972)  -  recreation
     days

  •  Owens (1970) - travel  mileage  and  average  speed  of
     recreationists

  •  Burt and Brewer (1971) - travel cost of recreationists

  •  U.S. Federal Highway Administration (1974)  -  cost  of
     operating an automobile

  •  Walker and Gauger (1973) - value of household work.

Unger e_t al.   (1974)  presents  two  approximations  of  the
damages  to  outdoor  recreation  from water pollution.  Two
regional studies,  (Reiling e_t  al.^  1973  and  Nemerow  and
Faro,   1970)/  were  synthesized  to  extrapolate  national
damages  through  demand  analysis.   Total   damages   were
computed as a product of damages per acre, the percentage of
polluted water, water surface area, and a constant factor to
compensate for substitutions in the water-based recreations.
The   expenditure   method   that   equates   benefits   and
expenditures is an alternative method of estimating  outdoor
recreational   benefits.   U.S.  Bureau of Outdoor Recreation
(1967 and 1972) and U.S. Fish and  Wildlife  (1972)  studies
were  the  primary  sources  for this estimate,  in a current
EPA study of the recreational benefits  from  water  quality
improvement,   empirically  derived  damage functions will be
formulated  to  approximate  the  impact  of  water  quality
changes on recreation demand.
                           3-15

-------
              AESTHETIC AND ECOLOGICAL DAMAGES
Nature and Effects of Water Pollution
Damages on Aesthetic and
Ecological Values

Aesthetic   ana  ecological  values  are  damaged  by  water
pollution in a number of  ways.   Users  of  water  in   such
activities  as  recreation  and  to some extent, production,
also suffer damages because the quality of their  experience
has  been degraded by the presence of pollutants.  Non-users
also suffer damages which they would be willing  to  pay  to
avoid  even  though they do not intend to make direct use  of
the waters involved.  These aesthetic and ecological  values
result  from  the knowledge that clean and natural waterways
exist and will be preserved and protected from the danger  of
ecological loss.  A part of such willingness to pay  is  the
vicarious  satisfaction  derived from the knowledge that the
preserved waterway will be used and enjoyed by others,   even
the  members  of  future  generations  to  whom  the natural
environment is bequeathed.

Damages to non-users result from those pollutants that   have
the greatest impact on the readily-sensible aspects of water
quality;  these   include  floating  debris and oil, clarity,
color, and odor.  Reduced ability to support wildlife  would
certainly  be  considered  damaging  from the perspective  of
those non-users who place high value  on  these  ecological
aspects of water  quality.
 Survey of  Source Studies

 The  primary  source  study  used in estimating the national
 aesthetic  and  ecological  damages  was the study performed  in
 British Columbia by Meyer (1974).  This study focused on the
 Fraser  River,    a   major  waterway  in  Canada,   surveyed
 residents'  willingness to pay for fishing  and  preservation
 of  the salmon population.  Households were sent a carefully
 developed  questionnaire that placed questions concerning the
 value of the  salmon  resource  in  the  context  of  public
 service purchases  made  by the local municipal governments.
 Respondents were asked to  indicate  the  value  they  would
 place  on  preservation of the river's resources, even though
 they did not expect to use them.   The results  indicated  an
 average annual  willingness  to  pay of $223 per household,
 adding 54  percent to the  value of fishing.

 Colorado State University  is  conducting  a  study,  Option
 Value  a_s  a Benefit of_ Water Quality and Improvement - 1976.
                            3-16

-------
which  will   provide   an   empirical-based   estimate   of
individuals  willing to pay to assure future access to clean
water resources.
                     PRODUCTION DAMAGES

Water  pollution  causes  increased  production  costs   and
decreased  output because clean water is an important factor
in the production of many goods and services.  For  purposes
of  this  report, production uses of water have been grouped
into the following classes:

  •  Municipal
  •  Domestic  (i.e., household)
  •  Industrial
  •  Agricultural
  •  Commercial  fisheries
  •  Materials damage.
Nature and Effects of Water
Pollution Damage to Production

Water pollutants cause damages to municipal  water  supplies
increasing  both  the  extent of water treatment required to
produce potable water, and the costs  of  maintaining  water
treatment   and   supply   equipment.    The  most  damaging
pollutants are suspended and dissolved solids, bacterial and
viral  pathogens,  metal  ions,   (particularly   iron   and
manganese),   inorganic  and  organic  chemicals,  and  other
sources  of   bad  odor  and  taste.   The  municipal   water
treatment  operations  affected by additional pollutants are
decoagulation, filtration,  clarification,  demineralization
and  softening,  and  control  of  taste and odor.  Although
disinfection  is a major part of municipal  water  treatment,
it   now   appears   that   this   operation  would  not  be
substantially reduced by controlling man-made effluents.

Although most household water is drawn from treated  surface
waters  or  relatively clean groundwater sources, even these
supplies contain damaging pollutants; the remaining  effects
cause  damage to  water  pipes,  water  heaters,   fixtures,
appliances, fabrics, swimming pools,  shrubbery  and  lawns,
primarily  from  dissolved  solids  and  acidity.   A  major
difficulty in the assessment of these  damages  arises   from
the  need  to isolate  the  man-made  effects  from natural
pollution  levels.
                            3-17

-------
The major industrial uses of water are for  cooking,  boiler
feed,  and  processing.  About 25 percent of the 174 billion
liters per day drawn from surface water  is  treated  before
use.   Boiler  feed  water  must  be demineralized and given
tertiary treatment before use, but  this  process  would  be
necessary for natural pollutants only.  Cooling water, which
accounts  for  more  than  .67 . percent  of  industrial water
intake, is  not  highly  sensitive  to  pollution,  although
fouling  can  cause  reduced  heat-transfer  rates, and some
pollutants  reduce  equipment  life.   Although   the   most
troublesome  pollutants  vary substantially upon application
use, biological organisms, suspended and  dissolved  solids,
and   acids  are  among  those  most  widely   treated.    The
industries most  sensitive  to  pollutants  in their  water
supply   are  those  producing  Pharmaceuticals,  foods   and
beverages, chemicals and textiles.

The  pollutants most damaging to  agriculture   are  suspended
and  dissolved  solids,  and  micro-organisms.  Salinity  can
reduce crop yields and the range of crop varieties that   can
be   economically  raised under irrigation.  Sediments can be
damaging to some clay  soils, but have their greatest  impact
on   irrigation  ditches,  pumps,  and nozzles.  Bacteria  and
viruses  are of concern because of their potential damage  by
crop contamination and the spread of disease to livestock.

Water  pollution  has  seriously damaged commercial fisheries
by  reducing the size of  the catch,  increasing  its cost,   and
lowering   its  quality.   Fecal coliform and other bacteria,
reduced  oxygen, and toxic  metals,  such   as   mercury,   have
caused   the   closing  of   about  20  percent  of  marine
shellfishing areas.  National shellfish catches have dropped
by  more  than half   since   the  turn  of  the   century.    For
example,   oyster  production  in Chesapeake Bay,  has dropped
 from 12  million to  1 million  bushels per year.

The damage to  materials   by   water  pollution   arises   in  a
number   of the   above  categories  and  has   been   included
wherever appropriate.   Materials damage also occurs   in   the
production activities  associated  with  navigation.   Damages
 to navigation  arise from the  corrosive  and abrasive   effects
of   water   pollutants   on  bridges,  wharfs,  piers, navigation
 aids,  and  vessels,-  damages also   result   from   sedimentation
 and from floating debris,  including pollution-induced  growth
 of  algae and  weeds.
 Survey of Source Studies

 Damage  estimates  for  municipal water supplies are derived
 from U.S. Census Bureau publications (1970 and  1974)  which
                            3-18

-------
provided  treatment  costs and vater use  data.   Unger  et  al.
(1974), and Bregman and  Lenormand   (1966),   have   developed
•approximations  of  the  damages  to municipal water supplies
•using  assumptions  on  the  costs  of    removing    man-made
pollution.   Unit  treatment  costs resulting from  pollution
followed Bregman and Lenormand's  arbitrary   assumptions   of
costs per thousand gallons.  Bregman and  Lenormand  estimated
that  national  damages  to  municipal  water  supplies were
between $118 million and $1.8 billion.  Unger et al. revised
Bregman and Lenormand's costs per thousand gallons  estimates
by the consumer price index and estimated 1974  benefits.

National damage estimates  for  industrial water uses also
were reported by Unger et  al. This estimate  utilized Bregman
and  Lenormand's  estimate  of  pollution-related   treatment
costs per thousand gallons, and industrial   water   use data
for the year of the estimate.  As previously noted, Unger et
al.   applied  the  consumer  price  index   to   Bregman   and
Lenormand's figures- additionally, Unger  et  al.  extrapolated
their best estimate obtained from Bramer  (1960).

Agricultural  damage  estimates   have   for   the most   part
followed  the  methodology presented   by Unger et  al. Using
variables  relating  water  quality,   cost,   and    land-use
parameters,  Unger  e_t  al.  calculated  the direct salinity
impact on agriculture.  The American Society of Agricultural
Engineers was the source of the agricultural damage estimate
attributed to sediments.   A  Dow Chemical   Company  (1972)
study   developed  regional  sediment   impact  estimates   on
agriculture.

An irrigation water loss   estimate   was  first   reported   in
Holm,  weldon,  and  Blackburn   (1971).  They used  Timmons's
 (1960) estimate of acre-feet of water  loss   and Wollman   et
al's  (1962.) value of  an acre-foot of water.

The   commercial   fishery   damage  estimates   and range   are
reported  by Tihansky  (1973),  Bale   (1971),   Weddig  (1973),
Council   on   Environmental   Quality   (1970),   and U.S.
Environmental Protection Agency  (1972).

Studies such as Black  and veatch   (1967),   Hamner  (1964),
American  water   Works  Association   (1961), Patterson   and
Banker  (1968), Leeds, Hill, Jewett,  Inc.  (1969), Metcalf  and
Eddy  (1972), and  Williams  (1968)  were  reviewed   by   Tihansky
 to derive economic damage  functions  for household water use.
Unger  et  al.  also  reported damages from  similar sources.
Black and veatch  and  Metcalf  and   Eddy   were   the primary
 sources   employed  by Unger et al. Damages are  estimated  for
 total dissolved solids and hardness, and  the use of  bottled
 water.
                            3-19

-------
Bramer  (1972)  specifies  the  damages  from acid corrosion
which can be attributed to navigation.  Other studies  which
have  estimated  damages  to  materials  include  Ohio River
Committee (1943), U.S. Army Crops of Engineers   (1969),  and
Dow Chemical Company.
                   PROPERTY VALUE DAMAGES

Nature and Effects of Pollution
Damages as Reflected
in Property Values

The  effects  of  water pollution on the value of water  uses
have been shown to be also reflected in the  value of  nearby
properties.    The  water  use  values  that most  strongly
influence property values  are  those  directly  related  to
ownership   of    the   land,  namely  recreation,   aesthetic
enjoyment, and ecological enjoyment.  Production  activities
and health are less dependent on  locations directly adjacent
to  water, and damages in these categories are less strongly
reflected in  property values.  Residential and  recreational
properties  are   similarly  more  affected by water  pollution
than commercial and industrial properties, except for  those
commercial activities directly related to water recreation.

A  study  by  Dornbusch  and  Barrager   (1973)  included  an
interview survey  of property owners in  seven  areas  where
pollution  abatement  had occurred.  The responses  indicated
that wildlife support capacity is more important to property
owners  than  aesthetics or recreation.  The pollutants having
strongest damaging effect on  fish and wildlife are  included
in  the  National Sanitation Foundation's FAWL Index; these
are  biological   oxygen  demand,  heat,  acidity,   phenols,
turbidity, ammonia, dissolved solids, nitrate and phosphate.
The    pollutants  most   strongly  affecting   aesthetics   and
recreation   as  discussed   in  previous    sections    include
floating  debris, oil,  odor,  clarity,   color,  and   fecal
col i form.
                   SURVEY OF SOURCE STUDIES

 The primary study on water pollution and property values was
 performed under EPA sponsorship by Dornbusch  and  Barrager.
 This study applied multiple-regression analysis to determine
 the  relationship  between  changes  in  property  values as
 determined by sale prices, and water quality  as  determined
 by  the EPA Pollution-Duration-lntensity Index.  The results
                            3-20

-------
from seven case-study areas were extrapolated to  provide  a
national  estimate  by  separately  considering metropolitan
areas, towns, and rural areas.  The estimated capital  value
of  $0.6  to  $3.1  billion  in  1972  was annualized at a 6
percent discount rate, giving $33 to $175 million  per  year
with a best-estimate of $76 million.

In  an  earlier  study,  Nemerow and Faro (1969) showed that
property along the shore of  Qnondaga  Lake  near  Syracuse,
N.Y., would increase in value by over $1 million per year if
the  PDI  index  were  lowered  from 5 to 1.  David and Lord
(1969)  found  that  improvements  in   water   quality   on
artificial   lakes  in  Wisconsin  would  increase  adjacent
property values by 7 percent.  In a study of Rocky  Mountain
National   Park,  Ericson  (1975)  found  that  tourists  in
Colorado were willing to pay 123 percent more for land  that
was  adjacent to unpolluted waterways.  All of these studies
confirm the positive relationship between water quality  and
property  value,  although  the strength of the relationship
clearly varies from place-to-place.
                           3-21

-------
Bibliography

Abel, Fred H., Tihansky, Dennis P., and Walsh,  Richard  G.,
  National  Benefits  of.  water  Pollution  Control,  u.  S.
  Environmental Protection Agency, 1975.

American Society  of  Agricultural  Engineers,  professional
  paper 70-701.

American  Water works Association, Task Group 27709,  "Saline
  Water Conversion," Journal o_f  the  American  Water  works
  Association. September 1961.

Bale,  H.  E.,  Jr., Report on the Economic Costs of  Fishery
  Contaminants.  U.  S.  Department  of  Commerce,  National
  Marine Fisheries Service, October 1971.

Barker,  Bruce,  and Kramer, Paul, "Water Quality Conditions
  in Illinois," In Statewide water Resource Development Plan
  1972, Illinois Department of Transportation,  Division  of
  Water Resource Management, 1973.

Black and Veatch, Consulting Engineers, "Economic Effects of
  Mineral  Content  in  Municipal Water Supplies",  Office of
  Saline Water, May 1967.

Bramer,  Henry  C.,  The  Economic  Aspects  of  the   Water
  Pollution   Abatement  Program iji the Ohio River valley. Ph.
  D. Dissertation, University of Pittsburgh, 1960.

Bramer, Henry C.,  "Economically Significant  Physicochemical
  Parameters   of  Water Quality  for  Various Uses", Mellon
  Institute,  1972.

Bregman,  J., and  S.  Lenormand,  The  Pollutj.on  Paradox.
  Spartan Books, Inc.,  New York, 1966.

Burt,  Oscar   R.,  and  Brewer,  Durward,  "Estimation of Net
  Social Benefits  From  Outdoor  Recreation",  Econometrica,
  September  1971.

Chemical  Rubber   Company Handbook of_ Environmental Control.
  Chemical Rubber  Company, 1973.

Colorado  State University, Option  value   as_  a  Benefit  of_
  Water   Quality   Improvement. U.S. Environmental Protection
  Agency, Washington Environmental Research  Center, work   in
  progress.

Council   on  Environmental Quality, Ocean Dumping: A National
  Policy. 1970.
                            3-22

-------
Council on Environmental Quality,  Environmental  Quality  -
  1972.   The   Third   Annual  Report  of  the  Council  on
  Environmental Quality, August 1972.

Craun, Gunther  F.,  and  McCabe,  Leland  J.,  "Waterborne-
  Disease   Outbreaks,   1961-1970,"   U.  S.  Environmental
  Protection Agency, Water Supply Division, paper  presented
  at   the   Annual   Meeting  of  the  American  Waterworks
  Association, June 1971.

David, Elizabeth L., and Lord, William B., "Determinants  of
  Property   value   on   Artificial   Lakes,"  Agricultural
  Economics.  University   of   Wisconsin,   Department   of
  Agricultural Economics, May 1969.

Ditton,  Robert, and Goodale, Thomas, Marine Recreation uses
  2L Green Bay; A  Study  of_  Human  Behavior  and  Attitude
  Patterns,   Technical   Report   No.   17,  University  of
  Wisconsin, sea Grant Program/ December 1972.

Dodson, Harold, U. S. Environmental Protection Agency, Water
  Quality Office, personal communication, March 1975.

Dornbusch, David M., and Barrager, Stephen  M.,  Benefit  of
  Water   Pollution   control  on  Property  Values,  U.  S.
  Environmental Protection Agency, EPA-600/5-73-005, October
  1973.

Dow Chemical company, An Economic Analysis  of_  Erosion  and
  Sediment   Control   Methods   for  Watersheds  Undergoing
  Urbanization. February 1972.

Dreiling, Richard, U. S. Department of Commerce,  Bureau  of
  Economic Analysis, personal communication, March  1975.

Ericson,  Raymond  K., valuation of_ Water Quality in Outdoor
  Recreation,  forthcoming  Ph.  D.  Dissertation,  Colorado
  State University, 1975.

Federal   Water   Pollution  Administration,  water  Quality
  Criteria,  U.  S.   Department   of   Interior,   National
  Technical Advisory Committee, April 1968.

Hamner,   W.  G.,  "Electrodialysis  in  Buckeye-Operation,"
  Journal of_ the American water works Association.  December
  1964.

Holm,  L.  G., Weldon, L. W., and Blackburn, R. D., "Aquatic
  weeds," In Man's Impact on Environment. Thomas R. Detwyler
  (ed.), McGraw-Hill, New York, 1971.
                           3-23

-------
Jordening, David L., Estimating Hater Quality  Benefits.  U.
  S.   Environmental  Protection  Agency,  EPA-600/5-74-014,
  August 1974.

Kleinman, Alan P., Glad, J. varney, and Titnus,  Sigurd  G.,
  Economic  impacts  of_  Changes  In  Salinity Levels of_ the
  Colorado River. U. S. Department of the  Interior,  Bureau
  of Reclamation, February 1974.

Leeds,  Hill,  and Jewett, Inc., Development of_ a Least Cost
  Methodology for Evaluating water Quality Management  Plans
  jor the Santa Ana River Basin, July 1969.

Metcalf  and  Eddy  Engineers,  "The Economic Value of Water
  Quality," Office of Saline Water, January 1972.

Meyer,  Philip  A.,  Recreational  and  Preservation  values
  Associated  with the Salmon o_f the Fraser River L Fisheries
  and Marine  Service, Vancouver, B. C., Canada,   Information
  Report Series, No. PAC/N-74-1, 1974.

Nemerow,  Nelson L., and Faro, Robert C., Measurement o_f the
  Total Dollar Benefit of Water Pollution Control.  Syracuse
  University, January 1969.

Nemerow,  Nelson  L.,  and  Faro,  Robert  C.,  "Total Dollar
  Benefit  of water  Pollution  control",  Journal  o_f  the
  Sanitary Engineering Division. 1970.

Neri,   Luciano  C., Hewitt, David, and  Schreiber, George B.,
  "Can  Epidemiology Elucidate  the  Water  Story?"  American
  Journal of_ Epidemiology. February 1974.

Ohio River  Committee,  "Report Upon Survey of  the Ohio River
  and Its Tributaries  for Pollution Control,"  House Document
  vol.  19, No.  1,  78th Congress, 1st  Session,  1943.

Owens,   Gerald  P.,  Outdoor   Recreation;     Participation f
  Characteristics   of   Users.    Distances    Traveled.  and
  Expenditures, Ohio Agricultural  Research  and  Development
  Center, Research  Bulletin  1033,  April 1970.

Patterson,   W.   L.,  and   Banker,  R. F.,  "Effects of Highly
  Mineralized Water on  Household Plumbing  and Appliances",
  journal of_ the American  water works Association. September
  1968.

Reiling,  S.  D.,  Gibbs,  K.  C.,  and  Stoevener,  H. H., Economic
  Benefits   From  ari   improvement   in  Water   Quality, U.  S.
  Environmental  Protection  Agency,   EPA-R5-73-008,   January
   1973.
                            3-24

-------
Sonnen, Michael B.,  "Quality Related Costs of Regional  Water
  Users,"  paper  presented  at the ASCE National  Meeting  on
  water Resources Engineering,  January  29  -  February   2,
  1973.

Tihansky, Dennis P.,  "An Economic Assessment of Marine  Water
  Pollution Damages," Proceedings of the Third International
  Conference  on Pollution Control iji the Marine IndustriesF
  June 5-7, 1973.

Timmons, F. L., U. S. Department of Agriculture,   ARS-34-14,
  1960.

Unger,  Samuel  G., Emerson, M, Jarvin, and Jordening,  David
  L.,   State-of-Art  Review!    Water   Pollution  Control
  Benefits and Costs. U. S. Environmental Protection Agency,
  EPA-600/5-73-008a, October 1973.

Unger,  Samuel  G.,  et_  al.,  National  Estimates of  Water
  Quality  Benefits,   Development   Planning   &   Research
  Associates, Inc., November 1974.

Urban System & Engineering, Inc., Recreational Benefits from
  water  Quality  improvement U. S. Environmental  Protection
  Agency, Washington Environmental Research Center, work   in
  progress.

U.  S.  Army Corps of Engineers, A Study of the Need for and
  Feasibility of a Program for the Removal and  Disposal  of
  Drift  and  Other Debris, including Abandoned Vessels from
  Public  Harbors  and   Associated   Channels   Under   the
  Jurisdiction  of the Department of_ the Army, Department of
  Defense, August 1969.

U. S. Bureau of the Census,  Census  o_f  Manufacturers.  7th
  Subject   Report   Water-   Use  _Ln  Manufacturingf  U.  S.
  Government Printing Office, 1970.

U. S. Bureau of the Census, Goverjimental Finances  ir\   1972-
  7.3,  Series GS73, No. 5, JU. S. Government Printing Office,
  1974.

U. S. Bureau of the  Census,  Statistical  Abstract  o_f_  the
  United States;   1974, 95th ed., Washington, D.  C., 1974.

U.  S.  Bureau  of  Outdoor  Recreation,  The 1965 Survey of_
  Outdoor  Recreation  Activities,  U.   S.   Department   of
  interior, 1967.
                           3-25

-------
U.  S.  Bureau  of  Outdoor  Recreation,  The 1970 Survey of
  Outdoor Recreation Activities - Preliminary Reportt U.  S.
  Department of interior, February 1972.

U.  S.  Bureau of Outdoor Recreation, Outdoor Recreation - A
  Legacy for America. U. S. Department of Interior, December
  1973.

U. S. Department of Commerce, Survey  of_  Current  Businessf
  July 1974.

U.  S.  Department of interior, westwide Study Report on the
  Critical Water Problems Facing the Eleven Western  States,
  1974.

U.  S. Environmental Protection Agency, Fish Kills Caused by
  Pollution in 1971 - Twelfth Annual Report. 1972.

U. S. Federal Highway Administration, Cost o_f  Operating  an
  Automobile,  U.  S.  Department  of  Transportation,  April
  1974.

U. S. Fish and Wildlife  Service, National Survey of  Fishing
  and Hunting 1970, U. S. Department of Interior,  1972.

walker, Kathryn E., and  Gauger, William H., The Dollar  Value
  of  Household  work.   New  York  State  College  of   Human
  Ecology, Information Bulletin 60,  1973.

weddig, Lee J., National Fish Institute,  Inc.,  Washington,
  D.  C., personal  communication, January  1973.

Williams,  J.  W.,   "Effect  of  Water Conditioning  on  Waste
  water  Quality,"   Journal  of_  the  American  Water   works
  Association. December  1968.

Wollman,   Nathaniel,    e_t   al.,  The  Value  of.  Water  in
  Alternative Uses With  Special Application to water use  iii
  the  San  Juan   and  Rio   Grande   Basins  of.  New  Mexico.
  University of New  Mexico Press, Albuquerque, 1962.
                            3-26

-------
Chapter 3
The Costs of Controlling Water Pollution
                      1. INTRODUCTION

Scope

This section of the report presents national  level estimates
of the costs of meeting the provisions of the Federal  Water
Pollution  control  Act  amendments (P.I. 92-500), hereafter
referred to as the Act.

Costs  reported  include  those  attributable  directly   to
control   measures  (devices,  process  changes,  etc.)  and
program costs for research, administration,   enforcement  at
the  Federal,  state,  and  local  levels.  Sources of water
pollution are broken down into  industrial,   municipal,  and
nonpoint  categories, and direct control costs are estimated
for these categories.

industrial costs at the plant level are taken for  the  most
part  from  the  Effluent  Guidelines Development Documents,
which were prepared under Sections  304,  306,  and  307  of
PL92-500.   These  documents  define the levels of pollutant
removal that must be achieved by each industry  category  at
the  interim  level, best practicable technology  (BPT) to be
achieved  by  July  1,  1977,  and  the  final  level,  best
available  technology  (BAT) to be achieved by July 1, 1983.
Total industry costs are computed by developing  plant-level
costs  for  one  or more "model" plants of various sizes and
process configurations which are typical  of  those  in  the
industry.    The  total  output  of  the  industry  is  then
attributed to that number  of  model  plants  in  each  size
category   which   best   approximates   the   actual   size
distribution in the industry.  The total cost is then simply
the number of model plants in each size category  times  the
plant  level  costs  for that -category, summed over all size
categories.

Municipal costs are presented as  total  capital  investment
achievable  under  the  existing Federal contract authority,
(i.e., what will be spent rather than what  is  needed),  as
distinguished from the industrial costs, which are estimates
of what will be required to achieve given control technology
levels.   As  an  indicator  of  the  total  requirement for
municipal treatment plant construction, results from a  1976
survey  of 'state estimates of construction requirements were
taken from "Cost estimates  for  Construction  of  Publicly-
Owned  wastewater Treatment Facilities," Final Report to the
Congress, February 1977.
                           3-27

-------
Assumptions

The highlights of the assumptions made regarding  compliance
with  P.L.  92-500  are listed below.  With the exception of
municipal  treatment,   these   assumptions   reflect    full
compliance with the technology levels and deadlines  included
in  Federal  legislation.   in  the municipal program,  it is
recognized that the construction rate will  be  set  by the
level of Federal expenditure, i.e., the cost of bringing all
plants  to  at  least  secondary level treatment by  1977  (or
possibly by 1983) is beyond anticipated expenditure  levels.
The outlay schedule used in the Reference Case was projected
using  current  Federal contract authority- one other outlay
schedule is considered as an alternative.
FEDERAL COMPLIANCE ASSUMPTIONS

Industrial.  Except for publicly-owned treatment works,  BPT
must be applied to existing point sources of water pollution
by   July    1,    1977,   or   compliance  with  pretreatment
requirements must be met if  water  is  to  be  diverted   to
publicly-owned treatment works.

Except  for  publicly-owned treatment works, the BAT which  is
economically achievable for each pollutant category must   be
applied  to  all  point sources of pollution by July 1,  1983,
or compliance with pretreatment requirements must be met.

The   Effluent    Guideline   Development    Documents    for
pretreatment, BPT, BAT, and New Source Performance Standards
(NSPS)  are  the  source of regulations and costs relating  to
industrial sources of water pollution.

In some industries,  BAT  is  the   same  as  elimination   of
discharge  (EOD),  which  is  desired  by  1985-  in others,
extreme expense would be incurred   to  completely  eliminate
discharge.   Since  no Federal regulations currently require
EOD, it was  not considered in the   estimation  of  pollution
abatement costs.  The aspect of treatment requirements  above
BPT  in water-quality-limited stream segments, as per Section
301  of  the Act,  is not addressed in this analysis.  This
could result in a very slight underestimate of costs in the
1976-85 period.

Municipal.   According  to the Act, publicly-owned treatment
works in existence in July 1, 1977, or  approved  under the
act,  must   meet  secondary  effluent  limitations by July  1,
1977 (or ambient  water quality standards, if they  are  more
stringent).   However, the Reference Case assumption in this
report is that treatment plants will be built  only  at the
                            3-28

-------
rate   allowed  for  by  Federal  appropriations  and  state
matching funds as shown in Table 1-1.
                         Table 1-1.
     Projected Outlays Under Current Contract Authority
               (In Millions of 1976 Dollars}
           Direct Capital                Direct Capital
           Outlays (Fed.,                Outlays  {Fed.,
FY         State, Local)      FY         State, Local)

1975          2,773          1980           2,833
1976          3,628          1981           1,010
Transition    1,280          1982             598
1977          5,623          1983             251
1978          6,837          1984             251
1979          5,558          1985             251
The entries in Table 1-1 consist of Federal funds from  P.L.
84-660, P.L. 92-500, P.L. 94-447, and P.L. 95-26.  State and
local  matching  funds  are 60 percent for P.L. 84-660 funds
and 25 percent for all other authorizations.

The Act requires that by July 1, 1977,  all  publicly  owned
treatment  plants  should achieve effluent limitations based
on secondary treatment as defined by EPA, and that  by  July
1,  1985,  all  plants should achieve Best Practicable Waste
Treatment  Technology  (BPWTT)  (or  ambient  water  quality
standards,  if  they  are  more  stringent).   EPA's  'Water
Programs-Secondary Treatment information1 (40 CFR Part  133)
is  the  source  of  regulations  which define the secondary
treatment effluent levels.   For  this  analysis,  BPWTT  is
regarded   as   the  same  as  meeting  secondary  treatment
standards.
Pollutants

A complete description  of  water  quality  has  never  been
accomplished,  primarily  because  it would require chemical
analysis of a near-infinite  number  of •solid,  liquid  and
gaseous compounds, as well as the identification of numerous
biota   also   present  in  water.   Thus,  any  practicable
description of water quality can only be  conceived  with  a
very  limited  subset of all conceivable physical, chemical/
and biological aspects of actual waterbodies.  Typical water
                           3-29

-------
quality measurements are, in fact, oriented toward  a  small
group of commonly-observed pollution problems.

The   most  common  pollutants   (or  pollutant  groups)  are
discussed in the following paragraphs.  There are some other
pollutants which are subject to  effluent  limitations,  but
they  are  found in the waste streams of a very small number
of plants; these are covered in  the  industry  summaries  in
this chapter.
BIOCHEMICAL OXYGEN DEMAND

Biochemical  oxygen demand  (BOD) is a measure of the oxygen-
consuming capabilities of organic matter-  this matter  is  the
traditional  organic  wastes   and  ammonia  contributed    by
domestic  sewage  and  industrial wastes of  plant  and  animal
origin.  Besides human sewage,  such wastes result  from  food
processing,   paper  mill   production,  tanning,   and  other
manufacturing processes.  The  BOD does  not,  in itself, cause
direct harm to  a water system,  but it does exert an indirect
effect by  depressing  the  oxygen  content  of  the   water.
Conditions  are sometimes reached where all  of the oxygen is
exhausted, and  the continuing  anaerobic decay process  causes
production of noxious gases, such as  hydrogen  sulfide   and
methane.   In   addition, since  fish and plant life depend on
oxygen for life, failure  to   control   the  oxygen-demanding
wastes will kill the  fish.

Chemical  oxygen  demand  (COD)  is another  measure  of oxygen-
consuming  pollutants  in   water.   COD differs   from  BOD,
however,  in  that  COD is  a measure of the  total  oxidizable
carbon in the waste,  and  related  to   the  chemically-bound
sources  of  oxygen   in   the   water   (i.e.,  nitrate which is
chemically expressed  as N03) as opposed   to the  dissolved
oxygen.
 SUSPENDED SOLIDS

 Suspended   solids   include   both  organic  and  inorganic
 materials.  The inorganic components include sand,  silt,  and
 clay.   The  organic  fraction  includes  such  materials   as
 grease, oil, tar,  animal  and vegetable fats, various fibers,
 sawdust,  hair,  and various materials from sewers.  Some of
 these  solids may settle out rapidly and bottom deposits  are
 often   a mixture of both  organic and inorganic solids.   They
 adversely affect fisheries by covering  the  bottom  of  the
 stream  or lake with a blanket of material that destroys  the
 fish-food bottom fauna or the spawning ground.
                            3-30

-------
While in suspension, these solids increase the  turbidity  of
the   water,   reduce  light  penetration,  and   impair   the
photosynthetic activity of aquatic plants.
DISSOLVED SOLIDS

Total dissolved salts represent the  residue   (exclusive  of
total  suspended solids} after evaporation, and they include
soluble salts, such as sulfates and chlorides, and  possibly
nitrates  of calcium, magnesium, sodium, and potassium, with
traces of iron, manganese and other  substances.   Excessive
levels  of dissolved salts can make water unfit for drinking
and irrigation purposes.

Total dissolved solids are  particularly  significant  as  a
pollutant  in  discharges  from closed systems which involve
water  recirculation  and  reuse.   These  systems  tend  to
concentrate  dissolved solids as a result of evaporation and
require blowdown (continuous removal of a  small  amount  of
the recirculating water) to maintain dissolved solids within
acceptable limits.
NUTRIENTS

Nutrients  are substances that support and stimulate aquatic
plant  life,  such  as  algae  and  water  weeds.    Carbon,
nitrogen,  and  phosphous are the chief nutrients present in
natural  water.   Large  amounts  of  these  nutrients   are
produced  by sewage, certain industrial wastest and drainage
from fertilized lands.  Biological waste treatment processes
do not remove the phosphorus and nitrogen to any substantial
extent.  In fact, they convert the organic  forms  of  these
substances  into  mineral  form,  making them more usable by
plant life.  The problem starts  when  an  excess  of  these
nutrients   over-stimulates  the  growth  of  water  plants,
causing unsightly  conditions,  interfering  with  treatment
processes,  and  causing  unpleasant and disagreeable tastes
and odors in the water.
pH,ACIDITY, AND ALKALINITY

Acidity and alkalinity are  reciprocal  terms.   Acidity  is
produced   by   substances   that  yield  hydrogen  ions  by
hydrolysis, and alkalinity is produced  by  substances  that
yield  hydroxyl  ions,-  pH  is  a logarithmic measure of the
number of hydrogen ions present.  At a pH of 7, the hydrogen
and hydroxyl ion concentrations are  essentially  equal  and
the  water  is neutral,  waters with a pH above or below 7.0
                           3-31

-------
can be  corrosive  to  waterworks  structures,  distribution
lines, etc.


Water Pollutant Controls

The  control  of  water pollution involves a wide variety of
methods designed to reduce the flow of pollutants  into  the
nation's    waterways.     The   methods   employed   differ
considerably from location-to-location, depending  primarily
upon  the  types of pollutants present, the desired level of
treatment, the climate, and the quality and quantity of land
available.
THE TOTAL WATER POLLUTION CONTROL SYSTEM

A well-designed water pollution control system minimizes the
volume and  level of pollution of water that must be treated,
produces  the  desired  degree  of  purity  in   the   water
discharged,  and  properly disposes of the residual sludges.
The four general categories of control  which  comprise  the
total water pollution control system are described below.

In-Process   Controls.    In-process  controls  are  methods
designed to reduce water use and prevent the introduction of
pollutants  into  the  water  used.    These   methods   are
particularly   important  in  industry  where  changes in the
production  processes, the use of raw materials, and the flow
of process  waters can significantly reduce  the  volume  and
degree of pollution of the wastewater streams.

Collection  System.   Before treatment, the wastewaters must
be collected and channeled  to  the  treatment  plant.   The
collection  systems  of municipal treatment plants, the city
sewer systems,  represent  a  considerable  portion  of  the
municipal   investment  (approximately  55  percent) in water
pollution control.  Proper  maintenance  and  prevention  of
leaks   in   these  systems  can  significantly  reduce  the
wastewater  flow into municipal treatment plants.

Wastewater  Treatment.   The  actual  treatment  of  polluted
waters  is  designed through a wide variety of methods which
are discussed  in subsequent paragraphs.

Sludge Disposal.  The pollutants removed from the wastewater
must  be disposed of properly so that they do not  return  to
the   waterways.   The most common methods of sludge disposal
are sanitary  landfill, incineration, and land spreading.
                            3-32

-------
WASTEWATER TREATMENT SYSTEMS

The heart of any  water  pollution  control  system  is  the
wastewater  treatment  system  which  takes  in  wastewater,
removes   pollutants,   and   discharges   purified   water.
Wastewater   treatment   systems  consist  of  a  number  of
components designed to remove different types of  pollutants
at  different  stages  of  the treatment process.  Table 1-2
presents a summary of the most common  wastewater  treatment
processes,  the  types  of  pollutants  they are designed to
remove, and the level of treatment most often attained.  The
treatment systems  are  often  categorized  into  the  three
general types described below.
                           3-33

-------
                         Table  1-2.
           Common Wastewater Treatment Processes
TYPE                NAME

PHYSICAL-CHEMICAL

Pretreatment        Screening
Pretreatment
Pretreatment
Pretreatment
Primary
Primary
Tertiary or
  Advanced
Tertiary or
  Advanced
                    Equalizat1on
                    Neutralization
011 Separation
Sedimentation
Flotation
Chemical
preeipltat1on
or coagulation

F11tratlon
                     DESCRIPTION
                     Screens trap large particles.
Holding ponds equalize the
flow of wastewater to the
treatment plant.

Chemicals added to neutralize
acidity or alkalinity.

Oil skimmed off surface.
Wastewater 1s detained in
a holding tank so that
suspended sol Ids can settle
out.

Air bubbles bring the
suspended sol Ids to the
surface where they are
skimmed off.

The addition of chemicals
to the wastewater causes
metals, etc.  to settle out.

Fine media such as earth
sand, etc., are used to
filter out very fine
particles.
                                 POLLUTANTS
                                 REMOVED
                                                      SS
                                                                          Oil
                                                      SS,
                                                      BOD
                                                      SS,
                                                      BOD
Metals,
Phosphorous
                                                      SS
                  LEVEL OF
                  EXPECTED TREATMENT
                                                   Removes 1arge
                                                   suspended sol Ids
                  pH 6.5-8.5

                  Removes particles
                  > O.O15 cm in diameter

                  3O mg/1 - but
                  depends upon influent
                  3O mg/1 - but
                  depends on influent
< 5 mg/1



5-1O mg/1

-------
                   Table 1-2. (Continued)
           Common Wastewater Treatment Processes

Tertiary or   Carbon     Wastewater -is passed over   COD.      1O mg/1
 Advanced    absorbtion    powdered carbon which absorbs  TOC    2 mg/1
                            organic materials.

Tertiary or   Ion exchange and  Employs ionic resins or    Metals.TOS.dis- Depends on resin used
 Advanced    electrodialysis  electric current to remove   solved phophor- and pollutants present
                   charged particles.     ous, nitrogen

Tertiary or   Reverse osmosis  Wastewater is passed through  Organics and     ?
  Advanced           a suitable membrane under   Inorganics
                                pressure.

Tertiary or   Air stripping   Air is passed through    Ammonia    95% removal
         Advanced           Wastewater, pH has been
                       adjusted by the addition of


                         BIOLOGICAL

Secondary    Trickling    Wastewater is passed over   BOD     ? < 50 mg/1
       filter     bacteria growing on a bed of
                    rocks.

Secondary    Aerated     Air is pumped into the waste-  BOD     < 50 mg/1
       lagoons     water to aid the bacteria's
                       digestion of organic wastes.

Secondary    Stabilization   Digestion allowed to occur   BOO     ? < 5O mg/1
                  Ponds      in ponds without the
                             addition of air.

Secondary    Anaerobic    Uses a fermentation process  BOD     > 1OO mg/1
               ponds      to digest organic wastes.

-------
                                  Table 1-2. (Continued)
                          Common Wastewater Treatment Processes
to
W              Secondary    Activated sludge  Recycles bactferla-laden    BOD     < 25 mg/1
CTN                                         sludge to accelerate
                                          digestion of organic
                                               materials.

               Tertiary or   Nitrification/   Two-stage process with    Nitrogen    <  5 mg/1
                     Advanced    denitrif1 cat ion  aeration and sludge
                                               organisms.

                                      LAND  TREATMENT

               Secondary and   Irrigation or   Wastewater is applied to the  Organic and   Up to 1OO% removal
                Tertiary or   spray irrigation  land which acts as a natural  Inorganics
                                Advanced           filter

-------
Physical-Chemical.   These  processes  rely  primarily  upon
physical means, such  as  skimming,  screening,  or  gravity
settling,-  and  chemical  processes, such as neutralization,
chemical precipitation, carbon absorbtion, or ion exchange.

Biological.  The biological  processes  employ  bacteria  to
digest organic pollutants in the was'tewater, after which the
bacteria are removed primarily by physical means.  Comsnonly-
used  biological systems include tricKling filters, lagoons,
and activated sludge plants.  In tricXling filters, bacteria
are grown upon a bed of  stones  3-to  10-feet  deep.   When
wastewater  is  passed  over  these stones, the bacteria are
able to consume  most  of  the  organic  materials  present.
Where  more land is available, lagoons are employed to allow
the sunlight, oxygen, and algae to interact and restore  the
water  naturally.   Lagoons  may  be  anaerobic, aerobic, or
aerated  depending  upon  how  much  oxygen   is   required.
Activated  sludge  plants are more advanced systems in which
the  process  or  biological  digestion  is  accelerated  by
bringing  air  and  sludge  heavily-laden with bacteria into
close contact with the organic  wastes.   Septic  tanks,  are
smaller-scale biological treatment systems commonly employed
for individual residences.

Land    Treatment.    These   processes   allow   pretreated
wastewaters to  percolate  through  the  soil;  organic  and
inorganic  wastes  are  then removed by this natural filter.
Irrigation and spray irrigation are common methods  of  land
treatment  which  are  often  used  to  enhance agricultural
production.
STAGES OF TREATMENT

Each wastewater treatment system is comprised of a number of
components arranged in sequence  so  that  finer  and  finer
levels  of  treatment are achieved.  The components used and
the treatment required vary widely from  system  to  system;
however,  four  generally-accepted  stages  of the treatment
process are discussed below.

Pretreatment.  To prepare the wastewater for further on-site
treatment or for discharge to a municipal  treatment  plant,
suspended  solids  and  oils  are  removed  by  skimming  or
screening, acidity or  alkalinity  is  reduced  by  chemical
neutralization,   and   the  flow  of  wastewater  is  often
equalized through the use of storage ponds.  Heavy metals or
toxic materials might also be removed at this stage.

Primary Treatment.  After pretreatment,  the  wastewater  is
generally  allowed  to remain for some time in sedimentation
                           3-37

-------
tanks so that most of the remaining suspended material-.
allowed  to  settle  out.   Flotation  devices might al
employed to remove suspended solids in the primary treatment
stage.

Secondary Treatment.  Secondary treatment generally consists
of biological treatment processes  designed  to  remove  the
organic  wastes that have not settled out of the wastewater.
Further sedimentation may then be necessary  to  remove  the
bacteria generated by the biological treatment.

Tertiary  or  Advanced Treatment.  In the advanced treatment
processes, many remaining pollutants  are  removed  by  very
specialized  treatment processes designed to remove specific
chemicals, nutrients, metals, etc.  Before being  introduced
into  the  waterways, the water is often chlorinated to kill
any harmful bacteria that might be present.

NONPOINT SOURCE WATER POLLUTION CONTROL

The above discussion has  dealt  primarily  with  wastewater
treatment  systems  designed  to  treat  "point  sources" of
pollution,- i.e., wastewaters which are channeled  through  a
pipe.   A  significant amount of soils, nutrients, and other
pollutants are introduced into the waterways from  the  run-
off  of rainwater from fields, city streets, etc., which are
classified as "nonpoint sources" of water pollution.

The control of nonpoint source pollution  does  not  involve
treatment systems as sophisticated as those discussed above.
Usually/  nonpoint  sources can be controlled to some extent
by correct soil  conservation  practices,  the  planting  of
grass   and   other  vegetation,  and  when  necessary,  the
provision  of  settling  ponds  or   sedimentation   basins.
Considerable  research  is  underway  to  develop dependable
information   for   designing   nonpoint-source    controls.
However,  the level of controls to be applied nationally and
the best implementation strategy are still not  sufficiently
defined to warrant cost estimation for agricultural nonpoint
sources.
                           3-38

-------
               2. GOVERNMENT EXPENDITURES FOR
                  WATER POLLUTION CONTROL
Government  funds  for water pollution control are spent for
three major purposes:

  *  To  conduct  programs   of   monitoring,   enforcementy
     technical assistance, grant assistance, and research,

  •  To  abate   pollution   created   at   government-owned
     facilities, and

  *  To treat wastewater at municipal treatment facilities.

Generally, states have primary responsibility for monitoring
and enforcement with financial and other assistance provided
by the Federal government; research is  conducted  primarily
by  the  Federal  government,  and  treatment  of  municipal
wastewater  is  the  responsibility  of  local   and   state
governments with major financial assistance from the Federal
and state governments.

This  discussion  centers  on the general program of Federal
and state governments,  and  it  projects  their  respective
program  costs  over  a  10-year  period;  it  also includes
estimates of  the  cost  of  abating  pollution  at  Federal
facilities.   Details of the analysis are not presented here
since the main purpose of this effort is  to  determine  the
magnitude  of this category of expenditure relation to other
expenditures in the report.
PROGRAM COSTS

Federal and state program costs are summarized in Table 2-1.
Federal expenditures {exclusive of construction  grants  and
grants  to  states)  are projected to decrease from the 1975
level of $326 million to $187 million in 1978.  The  Federal
share  of  program expenditures is also projected to decline
over the forecast period  as  the  states  gradually  assume
greater  responsibility  in  implementing  the  programs and
regulations.  Total decade expenditures  for  this  category
are projected at 3,174 million.
                           3-39

-------
                         Table 2-1.
         Projected State and Federal Program Costs
I
o
Federal '
State
Totals

1976
211
13O
341

Tran-
sition3
41
33
74

1977
215
130
345

1978
187
13O
317
<
1979
187
13O
317
i in Mil
198O
187
13O
317
                                                           Costs per Fiscal  Year1
                                                        (In Millions of 1973 Dollars)
                                                                    1981  1982  1983  1984  1985  Total

                                                                    162  162  162  162  162  1842

                                                                    13O  13O  13O  130  13O  1333

                                                                    292  292  292  292  292  3174
1  Excludes'Construct Ion Grant funds which are Included 1n the Municipal  Cost section.
'  Excludes State Program Grant funds which are Included In the state totals,
'  Three-month period July 1  through October 31,  1976.  caused by change of Fiscal  Year
  from July 1-June 3O,  to October 1-September 3O.

-------
Federal Program Costs

Federal   responsibilities  which  are  exercised  primarily
through the  U.S.  Environmental  Protection  Agency   (EPA^
encompass  a  broad range of authorities, particularly since
enactment  of  the  Federal  Water  Pollution  Control   Act
Amendments  of  1972.   On  the  one  hand,  they  encourage
compliance through grants and other types of assistance;  on
the   other,  they  require  compliance  through  regulatory
programs.
ASSISTANCE PROGRAMS

EPA conducts  several  assistance  programs,  including  the
grants  for  wastewater treatment vorks, grants for regional
water  quality  planning,  program  development,   technical
assistance, and manpower development.

The  construction  grants  program  is  by  far the largest,
involving $2 billion in Federal funds in fiscal  year  1973,
$3  billion  in  1974,  $4 billion in 1975 and $9 billion in
1978.  The level of assistance has gradually increased since
the first permanent Federal  pollution  control  legislation
was . enacted in 1956; today, the Federal share is 75 percent
of  project  capital  costs.   A  variety  of  projects  are
eligible   for   funding,  including  treatment  plants  and
interceptor   sewers.    Details   of   this   category .  of
expenditures are presented in the next chapter.

EPA  also  provides  program  grants  to  assist the states,
interstate  and  regional  agencies  expand  and  improve  a
variety  of  activities  essential  to  the control of water
pollution.  The activities include  water  quality  planning
and  standards  setting, surveillance, enforcement, issuance
of permits, executive management, and administration of  the
construction grants program.  The level of assistance varies
from  one activity to another, as well as from year to year.
In 1975 and 1976 over $200 million dollars  was  granted  to
regional  agencies  for  areawide waste treatment management
plants.  However, in the future, funding  for  this  program
will drop to a low maintenance level for the next few years.

The  feasibility  of  a  new  consolidated grants program is
currently under study by the Agency which would combine  the
state  assistance  programs  for water quality, air quality,
water supply and  solid  waste.   if  such  a  program  were
initiated,  the  Abatement and Control category in Table 2-2
would drop by an amount roughly equal to the  water  quality
state   assistance   program.   Since  allocation  of  these
consolidated funds among the four categories might become  a
                           3-41

-------
state  option, forecasting future water quality expenditures
would require additional- analysis.

Technical assistance is another program receiving major  EPA
attention.   Many  pollution  problems  are  too complex for
states, communities, and industries to  handle  alone,   EPA
assi'sts  In  such  cases  by providing services ranging from
technical advice and consultation  to  extensive,   long-term
field   and   laboratory  studies.   Within  the  limits   of
available resources, this assistance is provided on request,
primarily to the states and municipalities.

As might be  expected,  the  rapid  expansion  of   pollution
control  activities  has  placed a strain  upon the  supply  of
trained manpower.  In providing assistance,  EPA  pursues   a
number  of  approaches;  these  include providing short-term
training by EPA  staff to upgrade the skills  of those  already
in the  field, and  employing  a  variety  of  ways   to  train
sewage  treatment plant operators.
 REGULATORY PROGRAMS

 To  facilitate enforcement of the many new pollution control
 requirements,  the  1972  Act  replaced  former  enforcement
 authorities   with   new  authorities  and  provided  a  new
 regulatory  scheme  based  largely  on  the  imposition   of
 specific requirements through a system of permits and termed
 the National Pollutant Discharge Elimination System (NPDES).
 Permit  conditions  and  other  requirements  of the Act are
 enforceable through EPA compliance orders and  civil  suits;
 violators  are subject to penalties.  A state may assume the
 responsibility if it meets certain  requirements,  including
 the capability and authority to modify, suspend, or revoke a
 permit,  and  it has the powers and procedures necessary for
 criminal penalties, injunctive relief, and other enforcement
 mechanisms.

 The Act  also  required  Federal  agencies  to  comply  with
 Federal,  state, interstate, and  local pollution control and
 abatement requirements to the same extent as any person must
 comply.  EPA's role steins from the Act and is  amplified  in
 Executive  Order 11752.  The role includes review of Federal
 facilities compliance with applicable  standards,  providing
 guidance to  the Federal agencies  for  implementing provisions
 of  the  Order,  providing coordination of Federal agencies'
 compliance   actions  with  state  and  local   agencies,  and
 providing technical advice on waste  treatment  technology.

 Table   2-2   projects  a   stabilized   Federal   water  quality
 program beyond FY78, reflecting  the  need  for Federal   fiscal
                             3-42

-------
restraints   and   the   gradual   acceptance   of   greater
environmental responsibilities by the states.  Water quality
program  expenditures  are  usually   divided   into   three
categories:   abatement  and  control  covers  the  numerous
management and assistance activities of  the  water  quality
program,  research  and  development provides the scientific
and technical  support  for  the  program,  and  enforcement
covers  actions  seeking compliance with the law.  Table 2-2
shows projected Federal program  expenditures  according  to
the three categories listed.
                           3-43

-------
                         Table 2-2.
    Projected Federal Water Quality Program Expenditures
Abatement and
  Control

Research and
  Deve1opment

Enforcement

     Totals
                       Tran-
                 1976  sltion   1977
145
        25
               153
 45     11      44

 21      5      21

211     41     218
                                                                 Fiscal Year Expenditures
                                                                 (In Millions of Dollars)
1978     1979     198O     1981  1982  1983  1984  1985  Total



150      150      ISO      150  ISO  150  150  150  1523



 44       45       45     45 45 45 45 45 459

 21       21       21     21 21 21 21 21 215

216      216      216      216  216  216  216  216  2197

-------
State Program Costs

STATE ROLE

Although  the  Federal  government has taken an increasingly
greater hand in dealing with  water  pollution,  the  states
continue  to  bear  the  major  share of the responsibility.
States inherently have  broad  powers  to  deal  with  water
pollution, and these powers, together with delegated Federal
authorities,  place  the  states  in  a  strong  position to
regulate  all  sources  of  pollution.   State  powers   and
responsibilities under the Act are exercised through a broad
range of activities, including:

  •  States prepare an annual strategy  and  program  report
     that  describes the interim goals to be achieved during
     the year, the state resources to be assigned in meeting
     the goals, and the method of assigning resources.

  •  States prepare basin water quality management plans, as
     required by section 303(e)  of  the  1972  Act.   These
     plans  are  designed to be the central management tools
     of the states  in  administering  their  water  quality
     programs.

  •  States are responsible  for  reviewing  areawide  waste
     treatment  management  plans  called for by Section 208
     and prepared by local agencies.

  •  States   have    major    responsibilities    in    the
     administration  of  the  construction  grants  program,
     including the responsibility for  assigning  priorities
     to  projects eligible for Federal financial assistance.
    , It is intended'-that certain  Federal  responsibilities,
     such   as   review  of  plans  and  specifications,  be
     transferred to the states as they are  able  to  assume
     them/*   Some states provide funds to assist communities
     in  constructing  waste   treatment   works.    Primary
     responsibility   for   monitoring  municipal  treatment
     plants to see that they operate  correctly  also  rests
     with the states.

  •  States have the basic responsibility for  planning  and
     implementing  programs  for control of nonpoint sources
     of pollution.

  »  Some states have assumed, and others are in the process
     of  ass-uming,  responsibility  for  the  HPDES   permit
     program.   States that have received the responsibility
     have   concurrently   assumed   extensive   enforcement
     responsibilities associated with permit compliance.
                           3-45

-------
  *   States and the Federal government share  responsibility
     for enforcement.

  •   States establish and implement water quality standards.
     Under the 1972 Act,  such  standards  are  extended  to
     intrastate, as well as interstate, waters.

  ®   States perform monitoring and surveillance functions to
     identify  and  assess  existing  and  potential   water
     pollution   problems,   and   also   to   measure   the
     effectiveness of the  permit  and  construction  grants
     programs.
AGGREGATE STATE PROGRAM EXPENDITURES

Methods  for estimating state program costs are discussed in
Section  1.   As  shown  in   Table   2-1,   state   program
expenditures  are  expected  to  remain  level at about $130
million per year,  within  this  stable  budget  expenditure
will  gradually  shift  from  planning  to enforcement.  The
assumptions behind the analysis suggests a  continuation  of
activity  in  almost every area.  Revisions of water quality
standards, issuance of a new round  of  permits,  compliance
and  ambient  monitoring  and  construction grant review, in
fact, may require the maintenance of  state  programs  at  a
higher   expenditure   level   than   projected.    However,
anticipated revenue constraints at  the  State  and  Federal
level  combined with competing social needs lend credence to
a level projection.
Expenditures by Other Federal Agencies

The  following information is  excerpted  and  adapted   from:
Office  of  Management and Budget,  "Special Analyses: Budget
of the United States Government," USGPO, 1976.

Although  covering  a  wide  range  of  activities,  Federal
environmental   programs   are  classified  in  three   broad
categories: pollution control and abatement;  understandingt
describing and predicting the environment, and environmental
protection  and  enhancement activities.  It is difficult  to
attribute non-EPA Federal expenditures to specific pollution
control legislation in many cases,  but an  approximation   of
P.L.  32-500  related  expenditures  is  given  by the  water
quality expenditures in the Pollution Control and  Abatement
category.   Principal  activities   in this category include
actions  necessary  to   reduce   pollution   from   Federal
facilities;  the establishment and  enforcement of standards,-
research  and  dvelopment;   and    the   identification   of
                            3-46

-------
pollutants, their sources, and their impact on health.  Non-
EPA  water quality expenditures by the Federal government in
FY1976, the transition quarter and FY1977 are 527,  83,  and
467, million dollars respectively.

Since  Federal spending is strongly influenced by policy and
competing social needs, forecasting is always problematical.
The best estimate currently is that such  expenditures  will
remain  stable  over the next several years, with only minor
growth or decline.   If  non-EPA  Federal  outlays  in  this
category were to be held constant at the FY1977 level, total
decade  expenditures  would  be  about  4.8 billion dollars.
While this is a large amount on an  absolute  basis,  it  is
relatively  small  compared  to total expenses in the nation
for P.L. 92-500.
                 3. MUNICIPAL CONTROL COSTS

Introduction

The 1972 amendments  to  the  Clean  Water  Act  established
technology  objectives  and  water  quality  objectives   for
controlling   pollution    from   municipal   sources.     The
technology   objectives    require  that   all  publicly-owned
treatment  works   install"   best   practicable   wastewater
treatment technology"  {BPWTT).  Provision for BPWTT requires
a  complete  evaluation,   on  a  case-by-case  basis, of  (1)
conventional treatment and discharge to  surface waters,   (2)
land  application  of wastewater, and (3)  reuse technologies.
As a minimum, either secondary treatment  (85 percent control
organic and suspended  solids and a pH between 6.0  and  9.0)
or  higher  levels of  treatment  as required to meet water
quality standards  must be  provided.   These  standards   are
based  on  achieving   a  level  of  water quality that will
provide   for  the  protection  and  propagation   of   fish,
shellfish,  and wildlife,  and will provide for recreation in
and on the water.  This section reports  the costs associated
with meeting these dual objectives.
DEFINING AND  MEASURING NEED

The  1976 Needs  Survey conducted  in  compliance   with   Section
516   (b)  (2)  of the  Act,  estimates  the  expenditures  required
to meet the technology and water quality   standards   and   to
provide   for  replacement or  expansion   of   facilities   as
necessary  to  serve the population projected to 1990.    Thus,
a   "need"  consists  of   the   resources  associated  with  the
                            3-47

-------
upgrading,  replacement,  expansion   or   construction   of
treatment   facilities  which  state  or  local  governments
consider to be necessary, based upon the Federal standards.

The  Needs  Survey  is  conducted   independent   from   the
comprehensive  analysis,  and  details  may  be  found  in a
separate  report  "Cost  Estimates   for   construction   of
Publicly-Owned  wastewater  Treatment  Facilities-1976 Needs
Survey," EPA-430/9-76-010.
DEFINING COST

while all other sections of the report  estimate  costs   for
compliance  with  effluent  or  emission  standards, several
complications preclude presenting that type of  analysis  in
this  case.  Because of the difficulty facing municipalities
in raising capital, and limitations in Federal  construction
grants,  treatment  plants  cannot  be  built fast enough to
assure compliance with the Act.  Instead, it is  assumed  in
this report that new plants will only be built as rapidly as
permitted  by  Federal  appropriations  and  state and local
matching funds.  The total investments shown  in  Table   3-8
are composed of Federal outlay estimates for the given year,
plus required state and local matching funds.

Not  all  costs reported herein are properly attributable .to
the standards created under the authority  of  P.L.  92-500.
The  costs  attributable to those standards are incremental;
only those costs associated  with  going  from  an  existing
level  of treatment to a higher level of treatment necessary
to meet technology and water quality objectives are propejrly
attributable to the standards.  Thus, costs for  replacement
of  facilities  built  prior  to 1972 which do not require,  a
different level of treatment, the cost associated  with   the
lower  level  of  treatment  that  would otherwise have been
achieved in  facilities  built  after  1972,  and  the  cost
associated   with  a  higher  level  of  treatment  than  is
necessary to meet the standards should be excluded from   the
costs  attributed  to  meeting  standards.   However,  since
Section 516(b) directs assessment of the costs of  "carrying
out  the  provisions of the Act," and the construction grant
program is an integral part of the Act, the entire range  of
costs attributed to that program are reported herein.

The  concept of cost employed in this report is that of cost
to society, not financial cost.  Hence,  the  interest  rate
applied in the annualization of investment cost (10 percent)
does  not  represent  the  cost  of  borrowing  funds in  the
municipal bond market; rather, it represents the opportunity
cost of applying to the  public  sector  those  funds  which
                           3-48

-------
might  otherwise  be  yielding  a  competitive return in the
private sector.
STATUS OF PUBLIC SEWERAGE

Since 1940, the nation's public sewerage  treatment  systems
have  improved  dramatically through expansions in the scope
of their coverage and in their capabilities  for  treatment,
but  the  systems  have  not  kept  pace  with the amount of
residuals to be processed.  The coverage of the systems  has
kept  pace  with population growth and expanded to encompass
parts of the population previously not served.  Between 1940
and 1974, U.S.  population  increased  by  37  percent-  the
population  served  by sewers increased 385 percent, and the
population served by treatment facilities increased  by  337
percent.   As  Table 3-1 indicates, approximately 73 percent
of the population was served by sewers and 92 percent of the
sewered population was served  by  treatment  facilities  by
1976.

The capability of the systems to treat waste has improved as
well.   in  the  same  period,  the  number of persons whose
wastes receive primary treatment  (physical  processes  that
remove  roughly 30 percent of solids and about 35 percent of
BOD5J  had  tripled.   The  population  employing  at  least
secondary  treatment  (biological  processes  that raise the
removal of BOD5_ and solids to the 70 to  85  percent  level)
increased  more  than  fourfold,  and  now includes about 50
percent of the  sewered  population.   Not  only  have  more
persons  been  connected  to more advanced types of sewerage
treatment facilities, but technological  modifications  have
improved  the removal efficiencies of each type,  (see Table
3-2).
                           3-49

-------
                         Table 3-1.
                 Degree of Sewage Treatment
        Population Served, by Sewerage (In Millions)
Year

1940
1945
1948
1957
1962
1968
1974
19762

Sources:
   NO
   Treatment

      29.9
      27.9
      28.0
      23.8
      17.0
      10.9
       3.2
      15.7
Less Than
Secondary
Treatment

   15.1
   17.2
   18.4
   25.7
   32.7
   36.9
   54.6-
   45.2
Secondary
Treatment*
Greater Than
Secondary
Treatment
   18.9
   21.7
   22.7
   43.3
   61.2
   85.6
  105.0
   35.2
   0.3
   2.7
  50.5
Engineering News Record, survey of
municipalities 1940-74; EPA and predecessor
agencies in "Municipal Waste Inventories",
1976 Needs Survey.
1 Plants employing secondary-type technology; they may  not
  meet current definitions of secondary effluent standards.
2 1976 figures were not incorporated into the overall cost
  estimates.
                            3-50

-------
                         Table 3-2.
            Effect of Sanitary Sewage Treatment
                    (Millions of pounds of BOD5_ per day)

              collected                        Discharged by
              by Sanitary    Reduced by        Treatment
Year          Sewers*        Treatment*        Plants

1957             16.4            7.7              8.7
1962             19.8           10.8              9.0
1968             23.3           15.0              8.3
1974             27.6           18.5              9.1
19763            41.8           31.8             10.0

* Based on 0.167 of BOD5_ per sewered person per day.
2 Based on the distribution of treatment facilities shown
  in Table 3-1 and on estimates of removal efficiency
  from a variety of sources.
3 1976 figures were not incorporated into the overall cost
  estimates.
                           3-51

-------
Although  the  coverage  and  treatment  capability  of  the
systems  have increased, the systems have not Kept pace with
the increasing volume of residuals to be removed.  While one
portion of the system/ the treatment  facilities,  increased
the  amount  of  BOD5_  diverted  from our waterways, another
portion, sanitary sewers, more than offset that  improvement
by delivering more BOD5_ for treatment.  These figures may be
overly  pessimistic  as  they  pertain  to sanitary sewerage
only; they do not  reflect  the  net  result  of  initiating
public  treatment  for  a  large  (but  unknown)  number  of
industrial facilities that  previously  discharged  directly
into  our  waterways.   On  the other hand, they do not take
into  account  the  increased  concentration  of  wastes  in
sanitary sewerage resulting from such innovations as kitchen
garbage disposals.

Although   expenditures   in   the  past  two  decades  have
significantly expanded  the capital stock of public  sewerage
facilities,   the   prospect  for  future  decades  is  that
replacement  expenditures may consume  larger  proportions  of
the  annual  investment  in sewerage facilities.  Between 1855
and  1973, the nation invested  an  estimated  $61.8  billion
(1972   dollars)  in its  public sewerage  facilities  (see Table
3-3); this investment represents  about  5  percent  of  the
total   state and  local government capital expenditures for
all  purposes since 1915 and resulted  in  approximately  $34
billion  worth   of  facilities  in  place  by  1971.   The
replacement  costs shown here represent  an upper  bound  since
they are based  on conservative lifetimes of 50  and 25 years
for  sewers and treatment plants, respectively.
                            3-52

-------
                         table 3-3.
          Investment in Public Sewerage Facilities
                          (Billions of 1972 dollars)
Period

1856-69
1870-79
1880-89
1890-99
1900-09
1910-19
1920-29
1930-34
1935-39
1940-45
1946-56
1957-61
1962-67
1968-73
Gross
Investment

   $  0.5
      0.6
      0.8
      1.2
      1.5
      2.7
      5.7
      2.5
      4.8
      2.1
     10.8
      7.5
      9.1
     12.0
Replacement2
Net
Investment
End of
Period
Capitali-
zation
     Totals   $ 61.8
$













$
0.1
0,1
0.2
0.4
0.6
0.9
1.6
1.3
1.6
2.3
5.1
3.2
4.8
5.4
27.6
$













$
0
0
0
0
0
1
4
1
3
(0
5
4
4
6
34
.4
.5
.6
.8
.9
.8
.1
.2
.2
.2)
.7
.3
.3
.6
.2
                             $
                  0.4
                  0,9
                  1.5
                  2.3
                  3.2
                  5.0
                  9.1
                 10.3
                 13.5
                 13.3
                 19.0
                 23.
                 27.
                                 .3
                                 .6
                               34.2
  Based on data published by the Department of Commerce and
  by EPA- all values converted to 1972 dollars through use
  of EPA's sewerage construction cost indices and the dis-
  continued Associated General contractor's Index of
  Construction Costs.
  Estimated funds required to "replace" existing facilities,
  rather than add new capacity.  Computed at a rate of 2
  percent for sewers and 4 percent for plants, based on
  estimates of the relative weight of each in each period.
Two aspects of this series of investments stand out.  First,
the  bulk  of  sewerage  capital  has  been  installed  very
recently;  almost  80  percent  since 1929, 60 percent since
World War II, and more than 30 percent since 1961.   Second,
the stock of capital in place is so large compared to annual
investments  that  replacement  of  existing  facilities has
absorbed   approximately   50   percent   of   all   capital
expenditures  since  1961.  The current level of replacement
costs is close to $1 billion a year and rising in proportion
to the growth of the capital stock.
                           3-53

-------
Needs Survey Summary

Although the needs survey data  are  not  used  directly  in
preparation  of  the  comprehensive national cost estimates,
they do provide essential  background  for  comparison  with
actual  estimated expenditures which are strongly influenced
by Federal subsidies.  In  this  interest,  the  1976  Needs
Survey is summarized below.
CATEGORIES OF NEED

The  state  estimates  of the cost of constructing publicly-
owned treatment works needed to meet the 1983 goals  of  the
Act,  while serving a projected 1990 population, are divided
into six major categories:

  Category I.  This includes the costs of  facilities  which
would   provide   a   legally-required  level  of  secondary
treatment,  or   best   practicable   wastewater   treatment
technology  (BPWTT).   For  the purpose of the survey, BPWTT
and secondary treatment were considered synonymous.

  Category II.  Costs reported  in  this  category  are  for
treatment facilities that must achieve more stringent levels
of  treatment.   This requirement exists where water quality
standards require removal of such pollutants as phosphorous,
ammonia, nitrates, or organic substances.

  Category IllA.  These costs are for  correction  of  sewer
system  infiltration/inflow  problems.   Costs could also be
reported for a preliminary sewer system analysis and for the
more detailed Sewer System Evaluation Survey.

  Category IIIB.  Requirements for replacement and/or  major
rehabilitation  of  existing  sewage  collection systems are
reported in this category.  Costs were to be reported if the
corrective actions were necessary to the total integrity  of
the  system.   Major  rehabilitation is considered extensive
repair  of  existing  sewers  beyond  the  scope  of  normal
maintenance programs.

  Category   IVA.   This  Category  consists  of  costs  for
construction of collector sewer systems designed to  collect
sewage  and/or  correct  violations  caused  by discharge of
untreated wastewater into receiving water, seepage to waters
from septic tanks  and  the  like,  and/or  to  comply  with
Federal, State or local regulations and special actions.
                           3-54

-------
  Category  IVB.   This  Category  consists  of costs of new
interceptor severs and pumping stations  necessary  for  the
bulk transport of wastewater to treatment facilities.

  Category  v.   Costs  reported  for  this  category are to
prevent periodic bypassing of untreated wastes from combined
sewers to an extent violating  water  quality  standards  or
effluent  limitations.  It does not include treatment and/or
control of stormwaters.

  Category VI. Stormwaters".  This  includes  the  costs  of
abating pollution from stormwater run-off channelled through
sewers  and  other  conveyances  used only for such run-off.
The costs of abating pollution from  stormwaters  channelled
through combined sewers which also carry sewage are included
in Category v.
RESULTS OF THE SURVEY

The results of the 1976 survey are presented in Table 3-4 in
aggregate  national  totals, by category.  Various subtotals
are  presented  to  give  an  indication  of  needs   versus
priorities.   For  example,  36  percent of the $150 billion
total is required for  stormwater  control.   State-by-state
data   for   the   same  categories  may  be  found  in  the
aforementioned separate report.
Assessment of Backlog

A new addition to the Survey in 1976 was the  assessment  of
need  for  present populations (the backlog of need).  Needs
for Categories l-v present populations are estimated  to  be
$75.1  billion,  or 78 percent of the 1990 needs.  Note that
because of their nature, 1990 Needs for Categories IIIA  and
IIIB  are  almost exclusively all backlog needs as well.  In
addition, because of  the  limitations  of  eligibility  for
Category  IVA  as detailed in Section 211 of P.L. 92-500 and
the Construction Grant Regulations (40 CFR  35.925-13),  all
of  the  Category  IVA needs for 1990 are theoretically also
backlog  needs.   The  differences,  therefore,   are   most
graphically  illustrated in Categories I, II, and IVB, where
backlog needs represent 61 percent of the 1990 needs.
                           3-55

-------
                         Table 3-4.
    Summary Table of National Estimates for construction
     of Publicly-Owned Wastevater Treatment Facilities
                          (Billions of 1976 dollars)

                                      1990 EPA       Backlog
     Needs Category                  Assessment      Estimate

I    (Secondary Treatment)             12'.955          8.093
II   (More Stringent Treatment)        21.279         11.313
IIIA (infiltration/inflow)              3.017          3.009
11IB (Replacement and/or'Rehab.)        5.486          5.365
IVA  (New Collector Sewers)            16.979         16.979
IVB  (New interceptor Sewers)          17.923         12.318
V    (Combined Sewer Overflows)        18.262         18.262

Total I, II, IVB                       52.158         31.762

Total I-V                              95.902         75.142

VI   (Control of Stormwater)           54.133         34.528

Total I-VI                            150.035        109.670
                            3-56

-------
The costs reported for the backlog are sufficient  only   for
facilities  necessary  to  serve  the June 1975 populations.
They do not include any costs  for  reserve  capacity  which
would  be  required  by  the  Act  to  be  included in these
facilities for population growth  beyond  1975.   They  also
exclude  estimates for treatment plants and sewers that were
not necessary at all  in  1975,  but  are  projected  to  be
necessary for 1990 populations.
PROJECTED NATIONAL INVESTMENTS

Table  3-5  shows  the anticipated (in August 1977) year-by-
year capital investment for municipal  treatment  facilities
as  controlled  by  Federal grant awards.  Some of the  funds
expended during the period are from grants awarded prior  to
P.L.  92-500,  which  were  matched by state and local  funds
averaging about 60 percent of total project costs.  The  $18
billion from P.L. 92-500, the $480 million from P.L. 94-447,
and  the  $1 billion from P.L. 95-26 require only 25 percent
state and local matching funds.  These  matching  funds  are
included in the totals.

The  total  investment  over  the decade of $26.4 billion is
seen to be 83 percent of the category I, II, and IVB backlog
total needs, but only 35 percent of the category l-V backlog
total and 24 percent of the  category  l-vi  backlog  total.
Therefore,  EPA  has recommended that the construction  grant
program be augmented by $4.5 billion per year for the period
1978-1987.  If Congress were to  authorize  and  appropriate
these  funds,  the  expenditure  schedule shown in Table 3-6
would result, with the  1976-85  decade  total  being   $63.3
billion,  which  exceeds  the  Category  I, II, IVB (highest
priority) requirements for 1990 population.
                           3-57

-------
                        Table  3-r5.*
           Projected Federal, State,  and  Local
          Investment  for Sevage Treatment  Systems
                  Under  Current Authority
                   (Millions of Dollars)
              Fiscal  Year             Calendar Year

           1976        3,628       1976        4,499
           TQ          1,280
           1977        5,623       1977        5,927
           1978        6,837       1978        6,517
           1979        5,558       1979        4,877
           1980        2,833       1980        2,377
           1981        1,010       1981          907
           1982          598       1982          511
           1983          251       1983          251
           1984          251       1984          251
           1985          251       1985          251

TOTALS                28,120                  26,368
* The numbers in this table are based upon 1974 data.  These
  are the totals that were used in the estimation  of  total
  costs  that  appear  in  the summary analyses.  Table 3-5a
  contains more recent estimates of the investment costs  for
  sewage treatment systems, based on 1977 data.

  TQ * Transition Quarter
                            3-58

-------
                        Table 3-§a.*
            projected Federal, State, and Local
          Investment for Sewage Treatment Systems
                  Under Current Authority
                   '(Millions of (Dollars)
              Fiscal Year
                Calendar Year
           1976
           TQ
           1977
           1978
           1979
           1980
           1981
           1982
           1983
           1984
           1985
 3,628
 1,291
 4,437
 5,631
 5,537
 3,857
 2,097
   955
   955
   955
   955
1976

1977
1978
.1979
1980
1981
1982
1983
1984
1985
4,215
4,735
5,608
5,116
3,416
1,811
  955
  955
  955
  955
TOTALS
30,299
           28,721
*• -These data were collected in  1977.   They  represent  the
  latest estimates available.  They are not reflected in the
  total  cost  estimates  in  the  summary  portion  of this
  report.  Publication deadlines precluded such inclusion.

  TQ = Transition Quarter
                           3-59

-------
                         fable 3-6*
             Projected Federalt State and Local
      Investment for Sewage Treatment Systems Assuming
         Increased Funding of $4.5 Billion per Year
                     for Period FY78-87
                   (Millions of Dollars)
              Fiscal Year
                Calendar Year
           1976
           TQ
           1977
           1978
           1979
           1980
           1981
           1982
           1983
           1984
           1985
TOTALS
 3,638
 1,280
 5,623
 7,063
 7,105
 6,927
 6,157
 6,438
 6,438
 6,438
 6.438
63,535
1976

1977
1978
1979
1980
1981
1982
1983
1984
1985
 4,499

 5,983
 7,083
 7,059
 6,735
 6,227
 6,438
 6,438
 6,438
 6,438

63,338
* The numbers in this table are based upon 1974 data.  These
  are the totals that were used in the estimation of total
  costs that appear in the summary analyses.  Table 3-6a
  contains the more recent estimates of costs based on 1976
  data,  it was impossible to incorporate the 1976 data
  into the totals without causing undue delay in the
  publication of this report.
                           3-60

-------
                        Table 3-6a*
             Projected Federal,  State and Local
      Investment for Sewage Treatment Systems Assuming
         Increased Funding of $4.5 Billion per Year
                    for Period FY78-FY87
                   (Millions of Dollars)
              Fiscal Year
                Calendar Year
           1976
           TQ
           1977
           1978
           1979
           1980
           1981
           1982
           1983
           1984
           1985
TOTALS
 3,628
 1,292
 4,437
 5,752
 6,617
 7,097
 7,017
 6,675
 6,675
 6,675
 6,675
62,540
1976

1977
1978
1979
1980
1981
1982
1983
1984
1985
4,215

4,765
5,968
6,736
7,076
6,931
6,675
6,675
6,675
6,675
           62,391
* These data were collected in 1977.  They represent the
  latest estimates available.  They are not reflected in
  the total cost estimates in the summary portion of this
  report.  Publication deadlines precluded such inclusion.
  TQ = Transition Quarter
                           3-61

-------
Time Phasing and Annualization
of Costs

Annual costs are the sum of the annualized capital costs and
O&M costs.  These annualiEed capital costs are calculated by
amortizing the  investment  over  its  economic  life  at  a
discount rate of 10 percent.  The economic life of treatment
plants is assumed to be 25 years and that of interceptor and
collector sewers is assumed to be 50 years.

As  in  the  industrial  sectors, the total capital-in-place
used to calculate annualized capital costs is the cumulative
investment beginning with calendar year 1971.  The  standard
capital  recovery  formula  was  used  to calculate increase
annualized costs as a  function of new investments.

Annual operation and maintenance costs are  estimated  as  a
percent  of  total  capital-in-place.  For treatment plants,
the value is 7.5 percent,  and  for  sewer  investments  the
value is one percent.  The aggregate value varies, depending
on  the  estimated  year-by-year  expenditures  in these two
categories.

Results of these analyses  are  found  in  Table  3  in  the
Executive Summary.
                            3-62

-------
                4. INDUSTRIAL CONTROL COSTS

Introduction

The  extent  of water pollution and the costs of treating it
vary significantly among  industries  and  among  the  firms
within  an  industry;  therefore, it is important to examine
the structure, production  methods,  sources  of  pollution,
effluent  standards,  and  wastewater control technology for
each industry.   The  following  sections  of  this  chapter
briefly  summarize  the  relevant  characteristics  of  each
industry and report the  estimated  annual  abatement  costs
attributable  to  achieving  full  compliance  with the 1977
 and 1983  (BAT) effluent standards.

[NOTICE:  The costs in  this  r'eport  result  from  analyses
using  1975  data  on  industrial  facilities  and  proposed
control technologies.  Since that time more detailed studies
of particular industries have been completed;  in  addition,
the  definition  of  BAT  has been altered owing to concerns
about toxic materials in effluents.  As a result the control
costs which appear in this Section must be viewed as  having
only  historical  significance  in  many  instances prior to
using these  estimates  for  decision  making  purposes  one
should  check   with the Office of water Quality Planning and
Standards in EPA to assess their currency].

Although 32  industries  are  summarized  in  the  following
sections,  this report  does  not  purport to encompass all
industries or even all parts of any   industry.   only  those
industries  or  parts  of an industry which have significant
pollution problems, or for which  effluent  guidelines  have
been  defined,  are   included.   In the interest of brevity,
only the most   significant  polluting  segments  of  certain
industries have been  discussed but costs have been estimated
for  the  entire   industry.   Footnotes  to  the  cost table
following each  industry summary will  denote the  assumptions
used  in  the   cost calculations and  the industry operations
that were evaluated.
 Methodology

 COST CONCEPTS

 Only those costs attributable  to  standards  imposed  undsr
 P.L.  92-5,00  have  been  reported.   Not all water pollution
 control costs are associated with this law-  an industry  may
 perform some treatment irrespective of the standards imposed
 under  the  legislation-  changes in manufacturing processes
 made  on  grounds  of   production   efficiency   or   cost-
                            3-63

-------
effectiveness  may  result  in  higher  levels  of  effluent
control or a  reduction  in  the  use  of  water;  and  some
investments  in abatement equipment may have been made prior
to the enactment of the law.

The  annual  investment  costs  reported  herein   are   not
expenditures;  they are the amounts of total investment that
have been annualized; i.e., a capital  recovery  factor  has
been  applied to the total capital cost.  Hence, in any year
the actual  capital  expenditure  would  far  exceed  'annual
investment  cost.   (For purposes of feedback to the INFORUM
Module, expenditures have been used.)

The costs presented  here  are  incremental.   The( cost  of
achieving  1977  Best Practicable Technology (BPT) standards
is the cost of going from the level of treatment in the base
year to the  level  of  treatment  defined  as  BPT  in  the
effluent  guidelines.   The cost of achieving Best Available
Technology (BAT) is the cost of going from the BPT level  of
treatment  (or  if  such  a level is not specified, the base
year level of treatment) to the level of  treatment  defined
as  1983  BAT standard in the effluent guidelines.  The cost
of achieving New Source Performance Standards (NSPS) is  the
cost   of  going  from  a  general  industry-wide  level  of
treatment in the base  year  to  the  cost  of  meeting  the
effluent guideline standards for new sources.
MODELING AN INDUSTRY

The  essential  estimating  technique used  in preparing  cost
estimates was to define certain models or   "typical"  plants
and  generalize  from  these  plants  to the total industry.
Cost sensitive parameters, such as  wasteload,  water  flow,
water  use  efficiency, and treatment-in-place, were defined
for model or typical plants in  EPA  Development  Documents.
In  most  cages,  the  model  or typical plant data in these
documents were taken from actual plants.  Unfortunately,  the
lack of statistically adequate samples of the plants in  most
industries render it impossible to know just  how  "typical"
the typical plant is in terms of cost-sensitive parameters.

Industries  may be defined in various ways.  In general,  the
classification scheme used in the EPA Development  Documents
was  followed.   A  problem  with  any classification scheme
arises  from  the  multi-product  plant,  for  example,   the
petrochemical  plant  which produces a variety of chemicals.
Such a plant may  be  subject  to  more  than  one  effluent
guideline  and may be classified in one of  several different
categories.  An attempt was made  to  avoid  double-counting
these  plants but no attempt was made to develop costs which
                            3-64

-------
adequately reflect the costs of treating residuals generated
by all products produced in these plants.

The plants in an industry have various options by  which  to
comply  with the water pollution standards.  In general they
may:

  1. Fully treat their effluents.

  2. Pretreat their effluents and discharge to  a  municipal
     system.

  3. Change  their  manufacturing  process   to   eliminate,
     recycle or reduce their effluents.

To estimate abatement costs for an industry, it is necessary
to  know  or  assume  what fraction of plants in an industry
take each option.  Of course, there is no data  as  to  what
proportion  of  the  plants in an industry will take various
options.  Therefore, judgments  were  made  as  to  how  the
industry  will  behave  in  this respect.  Generally, plants
were assumed to take the lower cost option, but in  no  case
were  plants  assumed  to  close rather than comply with the
standards.  Thus, the costs reported  for  industries  where
plant closure is a persuasive strategy are overstated.

All  industry  costs were estimated using cost curves of the
standard form Y=AX , where Y is total cost, X is  a  measure
of  plant  size, and the exponent B defines how costs change
with changes in plant size.

In some cases,  special  detailed  industry  studies,  which
produced  more  precise  estimates  than  this simple model,
became  available  after   the   model   calculations   were
completed.   These  values  are  reported  along  with SEAS-
estimated values in the various industrial  summaries  which
follow.
Industry Cost Summaries

Table  4-1  lists  the  industries in the sequence for which
estimates have been developed by SEAS; this sequence is also
followed to arrange the Group I industry summaries that  are
presented  in this section.  The distinction between Group I
and Group II is that Group I industries are considered major
polluting industries and Group II industries are  considered
to  be  of  lesser  significance  as polluters.  Phase I and
Phase II refer to the  manner  in  which  the  EPA  Effluent
Guidelines   Division  has  subdivided  the  industries  for
purposes  of  developing  effluent  limitations  guidelines.
                           3-65

-------
Generally,  the  most  significant  polluting segments of an
industry have been included in  Phase  I.   Table  4-1  also
lists  the Standard Industrial Classification (SIC) code for
each industry evaluated by SEAS.

                         Table 4-1.
                 Industrial Sector Coverage
Group I
Phase I
 1. Feedlots                    x
 2. Beet sugar                  x
 3. Cane sugar                  x
 4. Dairy                       x
 5. Fruits and vegetables       x
 6. Grain mills                 x
 7. Meat processing             x
     & Poultry
 8. Seafood                     x
 9. Leather                     x
 10. Textiles                    x
 11. Builders paper              x
 12. Pulp and paper              x
 13. Plywood, hardboard,  and     x
     wood preserving
 14. Inorganic chemicals         x
 15. Fertilizer                  x
 16. Organic chemicals           x
 17. Phosphates                  x
 18. Plastics and  synthetics     x
 19. Petroleum                   x
 20. Rubber                      x
 21. Ferroalloys                 x
 22. Iron and steel              x
 23. Bauxite                     x
 24. Primary aluminum            x
 25. Secondary aluminum         x
 26. Primary & Secondary  copper  *
 27. Primary lead                *
 28. Primary zinc                *
 29. Asbestos                    x
 30. Cement                      x
 31. Fiberglass                  x
 32. Flat glass                  x
 33. Pressed and blown  glass     *
 34. Electroplating              x
 35. Steam electric  power       x
 36. Soaps and detergents       x
            SIC
Phase II    Number

   *        0211
   *        2063
   N        2062
   *        2021,2022,2023,2024,2026
   x        2033
   x        2043,2046
   N        2011,2016

   x        2091,2092
   *        3111
            225,227,228,2211,2231,2297
*
X
N
P
N
P
N
N
*
N
X
P
*
*
*
X
X
X
X
it
*
*
X
N
*
*
2661
2621
2432
2812,2816,2819
2873
2818
2874
2821,2823,2824
2911
2822,3011
3313
3312,3315,3316
2819
3334
3341
3331,3341
3332
3333
3293,3293
3241
3296
3211
3221,3229
3471
4911
2841



,2873



,3079



,3317














                                       3-66

-------
                   Table 4-1. (Continued)
                 Industrial Sector coverage

                                                     SIC
Group II                     Phase I     Phase II    Number

Fabricated metal                x           *        34
Machinery                       x           *        35
Electric and                    x           *        36
  electronic equipment
Transportation                  x           *        37
  equipment
Key:

x    Complete  coverage
*    Not applicable
P    Partial coverage
N    No Coverage

As  discussed in the  Executive  Summary of   this  report,  BPT
and BAT   effluent guidelines  undergo continual revision/  as
new information  and   experience   are  obtained   and   new
administrative and   judicial   decisions   are  reached.  The
estimates  contained  herein  do  not  purport   to  be  the   most
precise estimate  of  projected  costs available at press  time,
but represent a snapshot of conditions,  knowledge, and
assumptions existing as of  1976.   Further, the estimates  do
not reflect   the removal   of  toxic materials which may  be
required by BAT   regulations  revised   subsequent  to   1976.
Current  specific industry cost   estimates  are  available
through  the  Agency's   Office  of  water   and   Hazardous
Materials.
                            3-67

-------
FEEDLOTS INDUSTRY

Production  Characteristics  and  Capacities.  Feedlots is a
term which applies to many  different  types  of  facilities
used  to  raise  animals in a "high density" situation.  For
the purpose of establishing effluent limitations guidelines,
the term feedlot has been defined  by  the  following  three
conditions!

  »  A high concentration of animals held in  a  small  area
     for  periods of time in conjunction with the production
     of meat, milk, eggs, and/or breeding stock; and/or  the
     stabling of horses;

  •  The  transportation  of  feed  to   the   animals   for
     consumption•

  •  By virtue of the confinement of animals or poultry, the
     land Or area will neither  sustain  vegetation  nor  be
     available for crop or  forage production.

The effluent limitations guidelines issued  to date  (phase I)
by  the  EPA  cover  feedlots for beef cattle, dairy cattle,
swine, chickens,  turkeys,  sheep,  ducks,  and  horses.   A
variety of  facility types are included within the definition
of  feedlots;  these include:   open lots, housed lots, barns
with stalls, free stall barns,  slotted floor  houses,  solid
concrete   floor  houses, a variety of poultry houses, and wet
lots for ducks containing swimming areas.

Raw materials used in the feedlots industry are simply feed,
water, and  in some cases, bedding.  The production  processes
are defined by the type of  facilities employed, and  consist
mostly  of  delivering  supplies to the animals and carrying
away manure and  litter.

Although most of the feedlots are classified as  small,  the
bulk  of production  for many animals is accounted  for by the
very large  producers.  Only 1.4 percent  of the   fed-cattle
feedlots   accounted  for over 60 percent of 1972 production.
Although this concentration is  not so dominant  in  some  of
the  other  animal  groups, the trend toward  larger units of
production  is common in all segments of the industry.

Many producers have diversified into  grain production   for
direct  marketing  and  production  of  other   livestock and
poultry.   Some are  involved in  feed grain  production,   feed-
manufacturing,    feeder-cattle   production,    and/or   meat
packing.
                            3-68

-------
Ownership  of  commercial   feedlots   ranges   from   sole-
proprietorships to corporate farms, including co-operatives.
The  feedlot  operator  may  own  the  animals being  fed or/
particularly in the  case  of  fed-cattle,  may  custom-feed
animals owned by others.

Projections  of  production  capacity  through  1983  for the
cattle, dairy, and hog segments  of  the   feedlots  industry
anticipate  that  the  trend  is  toward   fewer  numbers  of
production units but the very large units  will  continue  to
increase  their  output volume.  Similar projections  are not
available  for  the  remaining  segments   of  the   feedlots
industry.   However,  the  growth  of  production  of major
agricultural commodities for the  period   1970-85  has  been
estimated.  The percentage changes are as  follows:  beef and
veal   (33  percent)-  pork   (13  percent); milk (2 percent);
chicken   (36  percent);  turkey   (44  percent);   eggs    (10
percent); and lamb and mutton (65 percent),  in all segments
of  the   feedlots industry,  it is anticipated that the trend
toward larger feedlots will  continue.  No  growth projections
are available for ducks or horses.

Waste  Sources and Pollutants.   Animal   feedlots  wastewater
originates from two principal sources:

   »  Rainfall runoff

   •  Flush or washdown water used  to  clean  animal   wastes
      from  pens,   stalls,   milk   center  areas,   houses,
      continuous  overflow  watering   systems   or    similar
      facilities,  spillages,  duck  swimming areas, washing of
      animals, dust  control,  etc.

 The  amount of wastewater varies  considerably, depending  upon
 the  way  manure, bedding, etc.,  are stored  and  handled;   in
 the   outdoor   feedlots,  rainfall  and   soil characteristics
 determine wastewater  characteristics.

 Animal  feedlot  wastes  generally 'include  the    following
 pollutants:

   •   Bedding  or  litter  (if used)  and  animal  hair  or  feathers

   •   Water and  milking  center wastes

   •   Spilled  feed

   •   Undigested  and   partially  digested   food    or   feed
      additives

   •   Digestive juices
                            3-69

-------
  a   Biological  products of metabolism

  *   Micro-organisms from the digestive tract

  «   Cells and cell-debris from the digestive tract

  «   Residual soil and sand.

The  primary discharge constituents of concern for  pollution
control  can  be  described  as  organic  solids, nutrients,
salts, and bacterial contaminants.  The  following  specific
pollutant  parameters  have  been  identified  as  being  of
particular importance:   BOD,  COD,  fecal  coliform,  total
suspended  solids,  phosphorus,  ammonia  and other nitrogen
forms, and dissolved solids.

With the exception of the duck feedlot subcategory, EPA  has
concluded  that  animal  feedlots can achieve a BPT level of
waste control which prevents the  discharge  of  any  wastes
into  waterways by July  1, 1977, except for overflows due to
excessive rainfall or similar unusual climatic  events   (10-
year,  24-hour  storm  as  defined  by  the National weather
Service).  The effluent  limitations for discharges from  duck
feedlots have been set at 0.9 Kilogram of BOD5^ per  day  for
every  1,000  ducks  being   fed, and a total viable coliform
count  less than that recommended by the  National  Technical
Advisory  Committee  for shellfish-producing waters which is
400   fecal   coliform  per   100  milliliters.   The  effluent
limitations  guidelines  for  all subcategories effective  July
1,  1983  (BAT), and  for all  new sources (NSPS) are  still at
no  discharge of wastewater  pollutants, except for overflows
due to rainfalls in excess  of the 25-year, 24-hour storm (as
defined  by the National  Weather Service).

Control  Technology  and Costs.  In-process technologies   used
for   the  control of wastewaters from  animal  feedlots  include
site   selection,  selection of  production  methods,  water
utilization   practices,   feed  formulation   and  utilization,
bedding  and  litter  utilization, and housekeeping procedures.
all of these are  important  in minimizing wastewater  flow and
pollutants.

The  various technologies   available    for    end-of-process
treatment may   be  classified  as  either partial  or complete.
Partial  technologies  are defined  as   those   that  produce   a
product   or   products   which  are  neither sold or  completely
utilized  on   the   feedlot.     Thus,   gasification    and
incineration of  manure  are considered partial technologies,
because  a significant  quantity of  ash must  be  disposed   of.
Lagoons,  trickling  filters, and other biological systems are
classified  as  partial  technologies  because  the  effluent may
                            3-70

-------
not be suitable for  discharge,  and  in  all  cases  sludge
disposal  is  necessary.   Complete  treatment  technologies
produce a marketable  product  or  a  product  that  can  be
entirely reused at the feedlot, and which has no appreciable
byproducts,  residues,  or  polluted  water  discharge.  The
dehydration and sale of manure, for example, is  a  complete
technology.  The spreading of animal wastes on land for crop
fertilization is also a .complete control technology.

The  1977  BPT  guidelines  for  all animal feedlots (except
those for ducks), the 1983 BAT, and the NSPS guidelines  all
assume  the  use  of  complete  control technology.  The BPT
guidelines are based on the containment of all  contaminated
liquid  runoff and the application of these liquids, as well
as the generated solid wastes, to productive cropland  at  a
rate  which  will provide moisture and nutrients that can be
utilized by  the  crops.   Technologies  applicable  to  BAT
guidelines  include  some of the complete technologies, such
as wastelage, oxidation ditch-mixed liquor refeed,  and  the
recycling  of  wet-lot  water  for  ducks, which are not yet
fully available  for general use.   The  BPT  guidelines  for
duck  feedlots   require  the equivalent of primary settling,
aeration,  secondary  settling,  and  chlorination  prior  to
discharge.

Comprehensive  and  reliable   data  are not available on the
number  of  feedlots  that  will  require  construction   of
pollution   control   facilities   to   meet   the  effluent
limitations  guidelines.   It  is  generally  accepted  that
housed    (total   confinement)  and  pasture  operations  can
generally  meet the  guidelines without  new  investment  or
operating  cost outlays.

Furthermore, open or partially-open  feedlots may  be situated
so  that   they   are  not point-source dischargers.  Finally,
some feedlots  have  already   installed  control   facilities
which  meet  the guidelines'  requirements.  Recent  estimates
suggest that only 10 to 40  percent  of  all   feedlots  will
require additional  investment  for control  facilities.

A  recent  analysis  of  costs  for  this  sector was  conducted  by
Gianessi   and  Peskin   (G&P)1.   This   study   was  conducted
independently  and   subsequent to the general  data gathering
efforts associated  with the  SEAS  uniform   cost   calculation
procedure.  However,  time  and resource  constraints prevented
 incorporating   these   costs  into the  scenario analyses  using
 the SEAS model procedure.   The G&P  estimates  are as  follows
 (in million'1975 dollars):

   Incremental  BPT Investment     $49.9
   Incremental  BPT O&M           $ 4.0
                            3-71

-------
Estimates from the earlier SEAS  calculation  are  presented
below,  with  projected pollutant discharges associated with
these costs.   Principal  reasons  for  differences  between
these cost estimates and the new data are changes in Feed lot
inventory   estimates,   differences   in   beef  production
estimates  and breadth of industry coverage (SEAS  considers
beef  only,
also).
while  G&P  considers  small  animal production
  Gianessi, L. P. and H. M. PesKin, "The Cost to Industries
  of the Water Pollution Control Amendment of 1972",
  National Bureau of Economic Research, December, 1975.
  (Revised January, 1976)
                           3-72

-------
                                                Table 4-1-1.
                                                   Feedlots
                                            Industry Data Summary
                         ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                                               1977
                                                                               1983
                                                                                              1985
                           Capacity (Mil lion Heads)             11.9            14.6

                           Annual Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-1985 = 3.21%
                              15.5
I
>J
U)
                         EFFLUENTS (1,OOO MT/Yr)

                           1971 Controls:
                              TSS
                              BOD5
                              COD
                              Nutrients
                           Legislated Controls:
                              TSS
                              BOD5
                              COD
                              Nutrients
1977
               1983
                              1985
330
136
470
60
82
34
117
15
.93
.32
.96
.20
.88
. 14
.95
.08
385.86
158.95
549. 14
70.20
O
O
O
O
4O2
165
572
73
O
O
O
O
.43
.78
.72
.21




                         CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

                         Investment

                           Existing Plants
                              On-site Treatment
                              Pretreatment

                           New Plants

                           Municipal Investment Recovery

                           Totals
                     AGGREGATED  OVER

      1974-77            1978-83     1976-85



      128.28   (8PT)       0.0 (BAT)  65.06
       O.OO               O.OO     O.OO

       15.92              24.23    46.91

       O.OO               O.OO     O.OO

      144.19              24.23    111.97

-------
                   Table  4-1-1.  (Continued)
                           Feedlots
                    Industry Data  Summary
I
^4
It*
CONTROL COSTS  (Million  1975 $)  - Continued

Annual ized Costs

Annual 1 zed Capital'
  On-site Treatment
  Pretreatment
  Totals
1977
18.96
 7.94
 0.0
 7.94
COST IN YEAR

   1983     1985    1976-85

   22.14    23.34    2O2.19'
    9.9O    1O.51   89.16
    0.0    O.O    0.0
    9.9O    1O.51   89.16
Municipal Charges

  Investment Recovery
  User Charges*
  Totals

Grand Totals
 O.O
 O.O
 0.0

26.89
    O.O
    O.O
    O.O

   32.05
                                                                                  0.0
                                                                                  0.0
                                                                                  O.O
O.O
O.O
0.0
                                                                       33.85  291.35
 1 Annual 1 zed on-s1te and pretreatment costs are computed on the assumption of a 15 year useful  life
  at  10 percent  interest with zero salvage value.

 1 The decade total of annualized cost may not be relatable to the decade total of investment because
  of  the timing of investment expenditures over the decade

 3 O&M costs in any year are relative to  investment made in -the year plus all prior year investments
  commencing in  1973.  Hence, O&M expenditure in any year bears no particular relationship to the
  investment made 1n that year.

 * User charges denote the O&M component of the municipal treatment charges.  The Investment com-
  ponent Is denoted under Investment recovery.
Note:   The Feedlots industry Includes beef cattle feedlots that use storage lagoons and spray
        Irr igatIon.

-------
BEET SUGAR INDUSTRY

Production Characteristics and Capacities.   There  were  52
beet  sugar  plants  owned  by  11  companies  in  1973.  An
additional two plants began processing in 1974 and  a  third
began operations in 1975.

The   size  range  is  classified  according  to  production
capacity, small  (2,086 metric tons per day), medium  (2,086-
3,537 metric tons per day), and large (3,537 metric tons per
day).

Typical plant production is estimated to be 3,265 kkg sliced
beets  per  day.   The  main products from this industry are
refined sugar, dried beet pulp  (used for animal  feed),  and
molasses.

The  beet  sugar processing industry is a subcategory of the
sugar processing industry.  Water is commonly used  for  six
principal  purposes:   (1) transporting (fluming) of beets to
the processing operation, (2) washing beets,  (3) processing
(extraction  of  sugar  from the  beets), (4) transporting beet
pulp and  lime mud cake  waste,  (5) condensing  vapors  from
evaporators and  crystallization pans, and (6) cooling.

Transporting  beets  into the plant is accomplished by water
flowing in a narrow channel   (flume)  that  removes  adhered
soil.   The  beets  are then  lifted from the flume and spray
washed.   Flume water accounts for about 50  percent  of  the
total plant water consumption.

Process   water   is   associated  with  the  operations  of
extracting sugar from  the beets.   Diffusers  draw  the  raw
juice   from  the  beets into  a  solution which contains 10-15
percent sugar.   Exhausted beet  pulp  is  later  pressed  to
remove  moisture.   This  exhausted  pulp  water  is usually
recycled  back to the diffuser.

Lime mud  cake waste results when lime is added  to  the  raw
juice   and  the  solution is  pumped with carbon dioxide gas,
causing calcium  carbonate to  precipitate.  The sludge  formed
contains  suspended impurities from the juice.

Water   from  barometric  condensers  is  employed   in   the
operation of  pan  evaporators and  crystallizers  in  the
industry.  Water is   used   in  large  quantities,  but  the
quality   is,  not critical since the source of cooling water
comes  from wells or streams.    Condenser  water  is  usually
cooled  by some device  and recycled for use in the plant.
                            3-75

-------
in  addition  to  the  above, about 40 percent of the plants
employ the Steffen  process  to  recover  additional  sugar.
Syrup  remaining from the above processes is concentrated to
form molasses, which is desugared by the Steffen process  as
a  method  of  sugar  recovery.  Water is used to dilute the
molasses and calcium oxide is added to the solution, causing
precipitation.   The  precipitation  process  produces   the
Steffen  filtrate  and  recovered sugar,- the filtrate may be
directly discharged as a waste or it may be mixed with  beet
pulp to produce byproducts.

The  sugar  industry  is  protected  and operates on a quota
system (domestic and foreign)  established  by  the  Federal
Sugar Act of 1948 and amended in July 1962.  Under this Act,
the  total  national sugar requirement is projected annually
and  sales  quotas  to  domestic  producers   are   adjusted
accordingly.   The  Act  also  includes  a provision for the
industry to increase its production at a rate of  3  percent
annually.   Areas  of  future  growth  will be along the Red
River between northern Minnesota and North Dakota,  and  the
Columbia River Basin.

Waste  Sources and Pollutants.  The major waste sources stem
from  the  primary  production  processes.   These  include:
(!) beet   transport  and washing,  (2) processing  (extraction
of sugar  from the beets),  (3) carbonation of raw  juice,  and
(4) Steffen   processing    (for  those  plants  involved  in
desugaring of molasses).  Barometric condensers are  also   a
wastewater  source.   The  primary wastes resulting from the
beet sugar processing industry are: flume  water,   lime  mud
caKe  from  carbonation process, barometric condenser water,
and Steffen process dilution water used to  dilute  molasses
for desugarization.

The  basic  parameters  used  in establishing water effluent
guidelines to meet BPT are:  BOD5,  total  suspended  solids,
pH,  fecal  coliform, and temperature.

Control   Technology  and   Costs.   Presently,   11  of the 52
operating  plants  are achieving zero discharge of  wastewaters
to navigable  waters.  A total  of five plants discharge  flume
and/or  condenser  water to  municipal sewage systems.

Current  pollution control   technology   does  not  provide   a
single   operation that   is  completely applicable  under all
circumstances.   The major  disposal  methods  are:   reuse  of
wastes,  coagulation, waste retention ponds or  lagooning, and
 irrigation.

BPT  and  BAT are extensive  recycle and reuse of  wastewaters
within   the   processing   operation with  no  discharge   or
                            3-76

-------
controlled  discharge  of  process  wastewater pollutants to
navigable waters.  To implement this  level  of  technology,
the following are required:

  *  Flume waters.  Recycling with partial or complete  land
     disposal   of   excess   wastewater.    This  includes:
     (1) screening,  {2} SS  removal  and  control  in   the
     recirculating    system,   and   (3) pH   control   for
     minimization of odors, bacterial populations,  foaming,
     and corrosive effects.

  •  Barometric condenser water.  Recycling for condenser or
     other  inplant  uses  with  land  disposal  of   excess
     condenser water.

  «  Land disposal  of  lime  mud  slurry  and/or  reuse  or
     recovery.

  «  Return of pulp press water and other process  water  to
     the diffuser.

  •  Use of continuous diffusers.

  *  Use of pulp driers.

  •  Handling  all  miscellaneous   wastes   (washings)   by
     subsequent treatment and reuse or land disposal.

  »  Entrainment control devices on barometric condensers to
     minimize entrainment.

A recent analysis of costs for this sector was conducted  by
Gianessi  and  Peskin  (G&P)1.   This  study  was  conducted
independently and subsequent to the general  data  gathering
efforts  associated  with  the SEAS uniform cost calculation
procedure.  However, time and resource constraints prevented
incorporating these costs into the scenario  analyses   using
the  SEAS model procedure.  The G&P estimates are as follows
(in million 1975 dollars):

                                Total    Existing    New

  incremental BPT investment    $11.5      9.6       1.9
  Incremental BPT O&M           $ 0.7      0.6       0.1
                           3-77

-------
Estimates from the earlier SEAS  calculation  are  presented
below,  with  projected pollutant discharges associated with
these costs.   Principal  reasons  for  differences  between
these  cost  estimates  and  the  newer  data  are different
assumptions for industry growth, differences in  attribution
of O&M to federal laws, different assumptions of land costs,
different   model  plant  cost  assumptions,  and  different
distribution of investment costs over industry.
  Gianessi, L. P. and H. M, Peskin, "The Cost to Industries
  of the Water Pollution Control Amendment of 1972",
  National Bureau of Economic Research, December, 1975.
  (Revised January, 1976)
                            3-78

-------
                                         Table 4-2-1.
                                           Beet Sugar
                                      Industry Data Summary
                  ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                                         1977
                                                                        1983
                                                                                       1985
                    Capacity (MT/Day)                  173,025.        218,841.

                    Annual Growth Rate Over the Period  1976-1985  =  3.49%
                             229.725.
I
--J
\D
                  EFFLUENTS (1,OOO MT/Yr)

                    1971 Controls:
                       TSS
                       BODS
                    Legislated Controls:
                       TSS
                       BODS
 1977
125.67
 33.46
 31.46
 33. 5O
                1983
156.61
 41 .70
   O
 10.41
                               1985
164.12
 43.69
 O
 O
                  CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

                  Investment

                    Existing Plants
                       On-site Treatment
                       Pretreatment

                    New Plants

                    Municipal Investment Recovery

                    Totals
       1974-77
      AGGREGATED OVER

          1978-83     1976-85


                         1 .66
3.59 (BPT) 0.0 (BAT) 1
0 . OO 0 . OO O . OO
0.40
1 .as
5.28
8.34
10.41
18.75
10.03
15.30
26.99

-------
                             Table 4-2-1. (Continued)
                                    Beet Sugar
                              Industry Data Summary
Co

8
CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $) - (Continued)

Annual1zed Costs

Annual 1zed Capital'

O&M'
  On-s1te Treatment
  Pretreatment
  Totals

Municipal Charges

  Investment Recovery
  User Charges*
  Totals

Grand Totals
                                                                      COST IN YEAR
1977
O.52
4.24
0.0
4.24
1983
1 .62
5.69
O.O
5.69
1985
1 .84
5.95
0.0
5.95
1976-85
1 1 .68'
5O.83
O.O
SO. 83
                                                          O.58
                                                          1 .01
                                                          1 .60

                                                          6.36
 1 .94
 1 .69
 3.63

10.93
 1 .97
 1 .75
 3.72

11 .51
15.30
20.87
36. 17

98.68
           '  Annualized on-site and pretreatment costs are computed on the assumption of  a 15 year useful  life
             at 10 percent Interest with zero salvage value.

           1  The decade total  of annual1zed cost may not be relatable to the decade total  of  investment  because
             of the timing of  Investment expenditures over the decade,

           1  O&M costs In any  year are relative to Investment  made In the year  plus all pr.lor year Investments
             commencing In 1973.  Hence, O&M expenditure in any year bears no particular  relationship to the
             Investment made in that year.

           •  User charges denote the O&M component of the municl-pal  treatment charges.  The Investment com-
             ponent  Is denoted under investment recovery.
           Note:    The Beet Sugar industry products are refined sugar,  dried beet  pulp for  animal  feed,  and molasses

-------
CANE SUGAR REFINING INDUSTRY

Production Characteristics  and  Capacities.   There  are  a
total  of 24 cane sugar refineries in the continental United
States and Hawaii.  Of these,  18  are  crystalline,  4  are
liquid, and 2 are combination crystalline-liquid refineries.
Crystalline  cane  refineries  are  classified into two size
ranges: 172-499 and 635-3,175 metric tons per day of  melted
sugar,  and  there  is  one  range  for  liquid  cane  sugar
refineries: 272-771 metric tons per day of melted sugar.

The  cane  sugar   refining   industry   consists   of   two
subcategories:  (1) crystalline  cane  sugar  refining,  and
(2) liquid cane sugar refining.  Liquid sugar production  is
essentially  the same as crystalline sugar production except
that the primary product is not recrystallized.

Raw sugar consists primarily  of  crystals  of  sucrose  and
small  percentages  of  dextrose  and levulose, with various
impurities such as particles, organic  and  inorganic  salts
and micro-organisms.  A film of molasses is contained in raw
sugar.   Crystalline  raw  sugar is washed to remove part of
the molasses  film,  placed  into  solution,  taken  through
various purification steps, and finally recrystallized.

The  major  processes  involved  in cane sugar refining are:
(1) melting,     {2} clarification,      (3) decolorization,
(4) evaporation,   (5) crystallization,  and  (6) finishing.
Melting is the first step where raw crystals  are  put  into
syrup  solution  by heating and then fine-screened to remove
coarse materials.  Clarification is the step where  screened
melt  liquor  still  containing fine suspended and colloidal
matter  is  treated  chemically  to  form  precipitation  of
organics.   Decolorization  involves  physical absorption of
impurities and color using bone char as a primary  media  to
remove  color.  Evaporation consists of concentration of the
decolorized sugar liquor and sweet water in continuous  type
evaporators.   Crystallization  of  the  concentrated  sugar
liquor and sweet waters  occurs  in  batch-type  evaporators
called  vacuum pans which must be supersaturated in order to
entrain the sugar on the pan.  Finishing provides drying  or
granulation   which   removes  moisture  and  separates  the
crystals that are later cooled and fine-screened.

The molasses produced as a byproduct of cane sugar  refining
is  used  as  a sweetener, as an ingredient for animal feed,
for the making of alcohol, for organic chemicals, and  other
uses.
                           3-81

-------
It is estimated that the capacity of the cane sugar  industry
in 1971 was 30,539 metric tons per day of melted sugar.

waste Sources and Pollutants.  Major process waste from cane
sugar   refining   include   char   wash,   wastewater  from
decolorization, and activated carbon process water from non-
char refineries.  Most of  the  waste  streams  produced   in
other  -processes  are  recovered  as low purity sweet water.
Wastewater from  barometric  condenser  cooling  is  usually
recirculated and represents a minor waste stream.

Sources  of  wastewater  pollutants  are associated  with the
water used as an integral part of the process (primarily the
decolorization techniques of either  bone  char  washing   or
activated  carbon  washing),  the  result  of entrainment,  of
sucrose into barometric condenser  cooling  water,   and  the
water used to slurry the filter cake.

Parameters  under  effluent guidelines for meeting BPT, BAT,
and NSPS include BOD5^, suspended solids, and pH.  Additional
parameters  of  significance   include   COD,   temperature,
sucrose, alkalinity, total coliforms, fecal coliforms, total
dissolved solids, and nutrients.

Currently, 50 percent of crystalline sugar refineries and  60
percent  of  liquid  cane  sugar  refineries  discharge into
municipal systems.  The  average  wastewater  discharged   is
38.4  mVfckg  from  crystalline  sugar  refineries,  and 18.8
m3/kkg from liquid cane sugar refineries.

Control  Technology  and  Costs.   Current  technology   for
control  and  treatment  of  cane sugar refinery wastewaters
consists primarily of process control (recycling  and  reuse
of  water,  prevention  of sucrose entrainment in barometric
condenser  cooling  water,  recovery   of   sweet    waters),
impoundage  (land  retention), and disposal of process water
to municipal sewer systems.

Best Practicable Technology consists of a combination of in-
plant changes and end-of-pipe treatment.   In-plant  changes
include:  (1) collection and recovery of all floor drainage,
(2) use of  improved  baffling  systems,  demisters,  and/or
other  control  devices  to  minimize sucrose entrainment  in
barometric condenser cooling water, and (3) dry handling  of
filter  cakes  after  desweetening with disposal to  sanitary
landfills, or complete containment of filter cake  slurries.
End-of-pipe  treatment  consists  of biological treatment of
all wastewater discharges other  than  uncontaminated  (non-
contact)  cooling  water  and  barometric  condenser cooling
water.
                           3-82

-------
Best Available Technology is essentially the  same  but,  in
addition  to  BPT, the following are applicable: (1) recycle
of barametric condenser cooling water by utilizing either  a
cooling  tower  or  pond,  (2) biological  treatment  of the
assumed 2 percent blowdown  from  the  cooling  system,  -and
(3) sand   filtration   of   effluent  from  the  biological
treatment system.  Essentially, the same control  technology
is  applicable  to  both  crystalline  and liquid cane sugar
refineries.

A recent analysis of costs for this sector was conducted  by
Gianessi  and  Peskin  (G&P)*.   This  study  was  conducted
independently and subsequent to the general  data  gathering
efforts  associated  with  the SEAS uniform cost calculation
procedure.  However, time and resource constraints prevented
incorporating these costs into the scenario  analyses  using
the  SEAS model procedure.  The G&F estimates are as follows
(in million 1975 dollars):

                              Phase I &
                              Phase II   Phase I  Phase II

  incremental BPT investment    $21.6      7.7      13.9
  Incremental BPT O&M           $ 6.4      2.2       4.1

Estimates from the earlier SEAS  calculation  are  presented
below,  with  projected pollutant discharges associated with
these costs.   Principal  reasons  for  differences  between
these  cost  estimates  and  the  newer  data  are  industry
definition expansion (G&P includes the Phase II  segment  of
the  industry),  and  differences  in  attribution of O&M to
federal laws.  Note that Phase I estimates from both studies
are,   nonetheless,   within   an   acceptable   range    of
computational variance.
  Gianessi, L. P. and H. M. Peskin, "The Cost to  Industries
  of   the  Water  Pollution  Control  Amendment  of  1972",
  National Bureau  of  Economic  Research,  December,  1975.
  (Revised January, 1976)
                           3-83

-------
                              Table 4-3-1. (Continued)
                                Cane Sugar Refining
                               Industry Data Summary
w
oo
CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $) - (Continued)

  New Plants

  Municipal Investment Recovery

  Totals
Annualtzed Costs

Annual(zed Capital1

O&M'
  On-s1te Treatment
  Pretreatment
  Totals

Municipal Charges

  Investment Recovery
  User Charges'
  Totals

Grand Totals
                                                          0.2O

                                                          O.97

                                                          8.31
                                                           1977

                                                           0.96
                                                           2.88
                                                           O.O
                                                           2.88
                                                           O.44
                                                           O.74
                                                           1 . 18

                                                           5.02
COST IN YEAR

      4.93     6.O9

      7.68    11.29
     22.31
   1983

   2.89
   1 .43
   1 .21
   2.63

   9.84
   3O.63
 1985    1976-85
 3.O4
 1 .45
 1 .23
 2.68

12.19
18.91'
   4.32     6.47    4O.OO
   O.O      O.O     O.O
   4.32     6.47    4O.OO
11 .29
15. 13
26.42

85.34
             1 Annual 1zed on-slte and pretreattnent costs are computed on the assumption of a 15 year useful life
              at  1O  percent  Interest with zero salvage value.

             ' The decade total of annualIzed cost may not be relatable to the decade total of Investment because
              of  the timing  of Investment expenditures over the decade.

             1 O&M costs 1n any year are  relative to Investment made 1n the year plus all prior year Investments
              commencing 1n  1973.  Hence, O&M expenditure In any year bears no particular relationship to the
              Investment made 1n that year.

             * User charges denote the O&M component of the municipal treatment charges.  The Investment com-
              ponent 1s denoted under Investment recovery.
            Note:   The Cane Sugar  Industry  Includes crystalline cane sugar refining and liquid cane sugar refining.

-------
DAIRY PROCESSING INDUSTRY

Production  Characteristics  and Capacities.  In 1970, there
were 5,241 dairy plants reported in the United States.   The
size  of each plant is determined by the number of employees
required, where a small  operation  has  1-19  employees,  a
medium  one  has  20-99  employees, and the largest over 100
employees.

The dairy processing industry comprises  12  product-related
operations:   (1) receiving  stations,  (2) fluid  products,
(3) cultured  products,  (4) cottage   cheese/   (5) butter,
(6) natural   cheese,  (7) ice  cream,  (8) ice  cream  mix,
(9) condensed milk, (10) dry milk,  (11) condensed whey,  and
(12) dry whey.

A  great  variety  of  operations   are employed in the dairy
products  industry,  but   for   simplification,   they   are
considered   to   be   a   chain  of  operations  involving:
(1) receiving      and      storage,       (2) clarification,
(3) separation,  (4) pasteurization, and (5) packaging.

Receiving and storage of raw materials is  conducted by using
bulk carriers, pumps, and  refrigerated tanks.  Clarification
is  the  removal  of  suspended  matter  by  centrifugation.
Separation   is   the  removal  of  cream  by  centrifugation.
Pasteurization   is  accomplished  by  passing  the  material
through a unit where it is first rapidly heated  and  cooled
by   contact   with  heated  and  cooled   plates  or  tubes.
Packaging  involves  the   final  handling  of  the  finished
product prior to storage.

In  1970,  a total  of  51  billion  kilograms  of milk was
processed.   Of this total, 36.5 billion kilograms  of  final
products were produced.

waste  Sources   and  Pollutants.  Materials are lost through
direct processing of raw materials  into   finished  products
and from ancillary operations.  The former group consists  of
milk,  milk  products,  and  non-dairy  ingredients   (sugar,
fruits, nuts, etc.), while the  latter consists  of  cleaners
and  sanitizers  used  in  cleaning equipment and lubricants
used in certain  handling equipment.  All of these contribute
to  the release of organic  materials, which exert a high BOD,
and suspended solids to  the  process  water.   Phosphorous,
nitrogen,  chlorides, heat, and  dairy fat can also be  found.

The  major   waste  sources  in  the  dairy products processing
industry come from the following:  (1) washing  and  cleaning
out  of  product remaining  in  tanks  and.piping performed
routinely  after every    processing   cycle,    (2) spillage
                            3-86

-------
produced  by  leaks, overflow, freezing-on, boiling-over and
careless handling,  (3) processing  losses,  (4) wastage  of
spoiled  products, returned products, or by-products such as
whey, and (5) detergents used in the washing and  sanitizing
solutions.

The primary waste materials that are discharged to the waste
streams  in  practically  all dairy plants include: (1) milk
and  milk  products  received  as  raw  materials,  (2) milk
products   handled   in   the   process   and   end-products
manufacture, (3)  lubricants   (primarily  soap  and  silicone
based)  used in certain handling equipment, and (4) sanitary
and domestic sewage from toilets, washrooms,  and  kitchens.
Other   products,  such  as   non-dairy  ingredients  (sugar,
fruits, flavors,  and  fruit   juices)  and  milk  by-products
(whey, buttermilk) are potential waste contributors.

The   basic   parameters   used   in  establishing  effluent
guidelines are: BOD^,  suspended  solids,  and  pH.   it  is
recommended  that  the pH of  any final discharge be within a
range of 6.0-9.0.

Control Technology and  Costs.   Dairy  wastes  are  usually
subjectable  to biological breakdown.  The standard practice
to reduce oxygen-demanding materials in the  wastewater  has
been to use secondary or biological treatment consisting of:
activated   sludge,   trickling  filters,  aerated  lagoons,
stabilization ponds or land   disposal.   Tertiary  treatment
(sand  filtration,  carbon adsorption) is practically nil at
the present time.

BPT and BAT consists essentially of the same practices.  In-
plant control includes  improvement  of  plant  maintenance,
waste monitoring  equipment and quality control improvements.
End-of-pipe control includes  biological treatment  (activated
sludge,  trickling  filters   or aerated lagoons) followed by
sand filtration.  BAT, in addition to BPT,  includes  multi-
media filtration.

A  recent analysis of costs for this sector was conducted by
Gianessi  and  Peskin  (G&P)1.   This  study  was  conducted
independently  and  subsequent to the general data gathering
efforts associated with the SEAS  uniform  cost  calculation
procedure.  However, time and resource constraints prevented
incorporating  these  costs into the scenario analyses using
the SEAS model procedure.  The G&P estimates are as  follows
(in million 1975  dollars):

  Incremental BPT Investment    $54.3
  Incremental BPT O&M           $10.6
                           3-87

-------
Estimates from the earlier SEAS  calculation  are  presented
below,  with  projected pollutant discharges associated with
these costs.  The principal reasons for differences  between
these  cost  estimates  and  the  new data are substantially
different  estimates   "capital-in-place"   for   particular
segments  of  the  industry  and  projected  growth patterns
within the industry.
  Gianessi, L. P. and H. M. Peskin,  "The Cost to Industries
  of the Water Pollution Control Amendment of 1972",
  National Bureau of Economic Research, December,  1975.
  (Revised January, 1976)
                            3-88

-------
                                                Table 4-4-1.
                                                    Dairy
                                            Industry Data Summary


                         ACTIVITY  LEVEL                         1977            1983           1985

                           Capacity (1.0OO kg ME/Day)        865,439        948,840        981,318
                           Annual  Growth Rate Over  the Period 1976-1985 =  1.45%

                         EFFLUENTS (1.OOO MT/Yr)                1977            1983           1985
                           1971  Controls:
w                          Fluid M1lk, Cottage Cheese:
I                              TSS                                0.93           1.O2         1.O5
00                             BOD5                              3.10           3.39         3.49
                           Butter:
                              TSS                                2.64           3.35         3.54
                              BOD5                              6.48           8.22         8.68
                           Natural,  Processed Cheese:
                              TSS                                O.4O           O.49         O.52
                              BOD5                              7.5O           9.15         9.61
                           Ice Cream & Frozen Desserts:
                              TSS                                0.38           0.43         0.44
                              BOD5                              0.75           O.85         0.88

                           Legislated Controls:
                           Fluid M1lk, Cottage Cheese:
                              TSS                                0.63           0.27         0.17
                              BOD5                              1.94           1.O6         O.87
                           Butter:
                              TSS                                0.68           O.O2         0.02
                              BOD5                              2.04           0.19         0.04
                           Natural,  Processed Cheese:
                              TSS                                0.15           O.O2         0
                              BOD5                              2.40           0.33          0.17
                           Ice Cream & Frozen Desserts:
                              TSS                                0.38           0.18         0.11
                              BOD5                              0.76           0.52         0.43

-------
                                Table 4-4-1.  (Continued)
                                         Dairy
                                 Industry Data Summary
O)
vo
o
CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

Investment

  Existing Plants
     On-slte Treatment
     Pretreatment
  New Plants
  Municipal Investment Recovery
  Totals
                                                          1974-77
384.65
  O.O
  2.32
 95.63
482.60
              CONTROL  COSTS  (Million  1975  $)  -  (Continued)

              Annualized  Costs                                1977

              Annualized  Capital1                            5O.88
             O&M'
               On-site  Treatment
               Pretreatment
               Totals

             Municipal  Charges

               Investment Recovery
               User Charges'
               Totals

             Grand Totals
             On-slte Treatment
                                              46.65
                                               0.0
                                              46.65
                                              43.38
                                              76.02
                                             119.4O

                                             216.93
      AGGREGATED OVER

         1978-83    1976-85


(BPT)    119.45 (BAT) 322.23
           0.0      O.O
         146.45   193.53
         769.32   1,129.67
       1,035.22   1,645.42
      COST IN YEAR

         1983     1985    1976-85

        85.85    92.04   675.67'
                 71.26   114.31    662.72
                  O.O      O.O     0.0
                 71.26   114.31    662.72
                142.49
                112.5O
                254.99

                412.11
                144.82
                113.11
                257.93
1,129.67
1,472.93
2.602.60
                         464.28    3,940.99
               Annual 1 zed on-slte and pretreatment costs are computed on the assumption of a 15 year useful life
               at  10  percent  Interest with zero salvage value.

               The decade total of annualIzed cost may not be relatable to the decade total of Investment because
               of  the timing of Investment expenditures over the decade.

-------
                  Table 4-4-1. (Continued)
                           Dairy
                   Industry Data Summary


'  O&M costs in any year are relative to investment made in the year plus all  prior year investments
  commencing in 1973.  Hence, O&M expenditure in any year bears no particular relationship to the
  investment made in that year.

'  User charges denote the O&M component of the municipal  treatment charges.   The Investment com-
  ponent is denoted under investment recovery.


Note:   The Dairy industry products and operations include fluid milk,  cottage cheese,  butter,  natural
        cheese, ice cream and frozen desserts, and condensed and evaporated  milk.

-------
FRUITS AND VEGETABLES INDUSTRY

Production Characteristics and Capacities.  The   fruits  and
vegetables processing industry includes processors of canned
fruits  and  vegetables, preserves,  jams,  jellies, dried and
dehydrated  fruits  and  vegetables,   frozen    fruits   and
vegetables, fruit and vegetable juices, and specialty items.
The  effluent  limitations  guidelines issued by the EPA are
limited to processors  of  apple  products  (except  caustic
peeled  and  dehydrated  products),  citrus products (except
pectin  and  pharmaceutical  products),    and    frozen   and
dehydrated  potato  products.   The  principal items in each
group are as follows:

  •  Apples: slices, sauce, and juice  (cider)

  *  Citrus: juice, segments, oil, dried peel, and molasses

  •  Potatoes: chips, frozen products, dehydrated products,
     canned hash, stew, and soup products.

The manufacturing processes employed,  which depends upon the
particular product, include: harvesting, receiving, storage,
washing and sorting, peeling and coring,   sorting,  slicing,
segmenting  or  dicing,  pressing  or  extraction /for  juice
products), cooking,  finishing,  blanching  (for potatoes),
juice  concentration,  dehydration,  canning,  freezing, can
rinsing and cooling, and cleanup.  Many processes previously
performed by hand, such as peeling   and  coring,  have  been
automated.    Peeling,   for   example,    may  be performed
mechanically or caustically, a process in  which  the fruit or
vegetable is dipped in a hot  lye  solution  to   loosen  and
soften  the peel, which is then removed by brushes and water
spray.

The canning and freezing  industry   is characterized  by  a
large  number  of  small,  single-plant  firms.   These  firms
share a very small segment of the total market and have very
little influence on industry prices  and total supply.   Over
the  past  20  years,  there  has been a steady  trend in the
industry to fewer large plants from  many smaller operations.
The   four  largest  firms  in  the   canning,  freezing,  and
dehydrating industries account for approximately 20, 25, and
35  percent,  respectively,  of  the total value of industry
shipments.  Although a large proportion of  the   plants  are
relatively old, the industry has generally maintained modern
technology through renovation and equipment modernization.

It  is  likely  that  the  trend toward fewer plants is also
expected  to  continue.   New  large  plants  will  probably
                            3-92

-------
continue  to  replace  the production capacity of the small,
older plants that will close.

Waste sources and Pollutants,  water is used extensively  in
all phases of the food processing industry, it is used as:

  «  A cleaning agent to remove dirt and foreign material

  •  A heat transfer medium  for heating and cooling

  •  A solvent for removal of undesirable ingredients from
     the product

  •  A carrier for incorporation of additives into the
     product

  •  A method of transporting and handling the product.

Although  the  steps  used   in   processing   the   various
commodities   display   a    general  similarity,  there  are
variations in the equipment  used  and  in  the  amount  and
character of the wastewaters produced.  For example, caustic
peeling  produces  a  much   higher  pollution load than does
mechanical peeling.  Similarly, water transport adds a great
deal  to  a  plant's  wastewater  flow   compared   to   dry
transportation methods.

The pollutant parameters that have been designated by EPA as
of   major   significance  for  apple,  citrus,  and  potato
processors  are  BOD,  suspended  solids,  and  pH.    Minor
pollutant  parameters  include  COD, total dissolved solids,
ammonia  and  other  nitrogen   forms,   phosphorus,   fecal
coliforms, and temperature.

Control   Technology   and   Costs.    Control  technologies
applicable to  wastewaters   from  the  fruit  and  vegetable
processing industry consist  of both in-plant  (or in-process}
technologies and as conventional end-of-pipe waste treatment
technologies.    in-plant    control  methods  include  field
washing of crops, substitution of dry transport methods   for
flumes, replacing conventional hot water and  steam blanching
methods  by  fluidized bed, microwave, hot gas, or individual
quick  blanching methods, using  high  pressure  nozzles   and
automatic  shutoff  valves on hoses, reuse of process waters
using  counter-current flow systems, recirculation of cooling
waters, etc., and minimum use of  water  and  detergents   in
plant  cleahup.

End-of-pipe  treatment   technologies  used in the fruits  and
vegetables processing industry generally include preliminary
screening, equalization, catch basins  for  grease  removal,
                            3-93

-------
sedimentation  and  clarification,  followed by a biological
treatment system such as activated sludge, trickling filter,
anaerobic lagoons  or  aerated  lagoons.   Where  necessary,
neutralization  and  chlorination  are also included.  Other
technologies that are or may be used by the industry include
solids removal by air flotation or  centrifugal  separation,
chemical coagulation and precipitation, biological treatment
through  the use of a rotating biological contactor, sand or
diatomaceous earth filtration, and other advanced  treatment
technologies.   The  liquid portion of cannery wastes can be
"completely" treated and discharged through percolation  and
evaporation lagoons or by spray irrigation.

Because  the  wastes  from  fruit  and  vegetable processing
plants are primarily biological, they  are  compatible  with
municipal  sewage  treatment  systems,  therefore, discharge
into municipal systems is also a practicable alternative for
fruit and vegetable processors.

BPT guidelines are based upon the  average  performances  of
exemplary   biological   treatment   systems.    Thus,   the
technology  called  for  includes   preliminary   screening,
primary  settling  (potatoes only), and biological secondary
treatment.  Cooling towers for  the  recirculation  of  weak
cooling  water  is  considered  BPT for the citrus industry.
In-plant control methods should  include  good  housekeeping
and  water use practices.  No special in-plant modifications
are  required.   Land  treatment  methods  such   as   spray
irrigation are of course, not excluded from use.

BAT  and  NSPS  guidelines  assume  the  use  of  BPT,  plus
additional secondary treatment, such as more aerated lagoons
and/or  shallow  lagoons  and/or  a  sand  filter  following
secondary  treatment; disinfection {usually chlorinationl is
also included.  Management controls  over  housekeeping  and
water  use  practices  are  assumed to be stricter than BPT.
Although  no  additional  in-plant  controls  are  required,
several  modifications  may  be economically more attractive
than  additional  treatment  facilities.    These   include:
recycling  raw material wash water, utilization of low water
useage peeling equipment, recirculation  of  cooling  water,
and utilization of dry cleanup methods,  where suitable land
is  available,  land  treatment is not only recommended from
the discharge viewpoint, but will usually be more economical
than other treatment methods.
                           3-94

-------
A recent analysis of costs for this sector was conducted  by
Gianessi  and  PesXin  (G&P)*.   This  study  was  conducted
independently and subsequent to the general  data  gathering
efforts  associated  with  the SEAS uniform cost calculation
procedure.  However, time and resource constraints prevented
incorporating these costs into the scenario  analyses  using
the  SEAS model procedure.  The G&P estimates are as follows
(in million 1975 dollars):

  Incremental BPT Investment    $35.2
  Incremental BPT O&M           $ 4.4

Estimates from the earlier SEAS  calculation  are  presented
below,  with  projected pollutant discharges associated with
these costs.   Principal  reasons  for  differences  between
these  cost  estimates  and  the  newer  data are changes in
abatement  strategy:  G&P  assume  some  plants   use   land
disposal,  some  use activated sludge and some use "no cost"
methods,  whereas  SEAS  assumes  all  facilities  currently
without controls will install activated sludge systems which
have costs two to six times higher.
  Gianessi, L. P. and H. M. Peskin,  "The Cost to Industries
  of the Water Pollution Control Amendment of 1972",
  National Bureau of Economic Research, December, 1975.
  (Revised January, 1976)
                           3-95

-------
                                          Table 4-5-1.
                                      Fruits and Vegetables
                                      Industry Data Summary
                   ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                                         1977
                                                                        1983
                                                                                       1985
                     Capacity (Million Liters/Day)      2.42O          3,157

                     Annual Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-1985 = 4.29%
                                                                   3,395
VO
EFFLUENTS (LOCO MT/Yr)

  1971 Controls:
     TSS
     BODS
                                                         1977
                                                         62.55
                                                         46.22
                                                                        1983
81.OO
59.85
                                                                                       1985
86.85
64. 18
                     Legislated Controls:
                        TSS
                        BODS
                                      27.24
                                      21. 7O
14.77
23.03
11.74
23.58
                   CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

                   Investment

                     Existing Plants
                        On-slte Treatment
                        P re t rea tment

                     New Plants

                     Municipal Investment Recovery

                     Totals
                                                           AGGREGATED OVER

                                            1974-77           1978-83    1976-85


                                             6O.82   (BPT)      99.69 (BAT) 13O.14
                                              O.OO               O.OO     O.OO

                                             16.25             1O2.14   139.64

                                             28.2O             226.62   333.O8

                                            1O5.27             428.45   6O2.86

-------
                                          Table 4-5-1.
                                      Fruits and Vegetables
                                      Industry Data Summary
                   ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                                         1977
                                                                        1983
                                                                                       1985
                     Capacity (Million Liters/Day)      2,420          3,157

                     Annual Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-1985 = 4.29%
                                                                   3,395
U>
Ch
EFFLUENTS (1.OOO MT/Yr)

  1971 Controls:
     TSS
     BODS
                                                         1977
                                                         62.55
                                                         46.22
                                                                        1383
81. OO
59.85
                                                                                       1985
86.85
64. 18
                     Legislated Controls:
                        TSS
                        BODS
                                      27.24
                                      21 .70
14.77
23.03
11.74
23.58
                   CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

                   Investment

                     Existing Plants
                        On-slte Treatment
                        Pretreatment

                     New Plants

                     Municipal Investment Recovery

                     Totals
                                                           AGGREGATED OVER

                                            1974-77           1978-83    1976-85


                                             6O.82   (BPT)      99.69 (BAT) 13O.14
                                              O.OO               O.OO     O.OO

                                             16.25             1O2.14   139.64

                                             28.2O             226.62   333.O8

                                            1OS.27             428.45   6O2.86

-------
                                  Table 4-5-1.  (Continued)
                                   Fruits and Vegetables
                                   Industry Data Summary
u>
10
-j
CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $) - (Continued)

Annual1zed Costs                               1977

Annual1zed Capital'                            10.13

0&M>
  On-s1te Treatment                           28.54
  Pretreatment                                 0.0
  Totals                                      28.54

Municipal Charges

  Investment Recovery                         12.64
  User Charges'                               21.65
  Totals                                      34.29

Grand Totals                                  72.97
                                                                           COST IN YEAR

                                                                              1983     1985    1976-85

                                                                             36.67    4O.68   238.7OZ
45.59    62.72   4O7.26
 0.0      0.0     0.0
45.59    62.72   407.26
                                                                             42.14
                                                                             36.17
                                                                             78.31
         42.90
         37 .26
         80. 15
333.OB
451.22
784.29
                                                                            16O.56   183.55   1.43O.26
                '  AnnualIzed on-slte and pretreatment costs are computed on the assumption of a 15 year useful  Hfe
                  at 10 percent Interest with zero salvage value.

                *  The decade, total of annual 1 zed cost may not be relatable to the decade total of Investment because
                  of the timing of investment expenditures over the decade.

                3  O&M costs in any year are relative to investment made in the year plus all  prior year investments
                  commencing in 1973.  Hence, O&M expenditure in any year bears no particular relationship to the
                  investment made in that year.

                '  User charges denote the O&M component of the municipal treatment charges.  The investment com-
                  ponent is denoted under investment recovery.
                Note:   The Fruits and Vegetables Industry includes all aspects of canned and preserved food processes,
                        and frozen packaged foods.

-------
GRAIN MILLING INDUSTRY

Production  Characteristics and Capacities.  For purposes of
establishing water effluent guidelines,  the  grain  milling
industry  is divided into four major subcategories: wet corn
milling, dry corn milling, bulgur wheat flour  milling,  and
parboiled  rice  milling.   Two  other subcategories, normal
wheat flour milling  and  normal  rice  milling,  have  been
excluded because they do not use process water.

wet  corn  milling comprises three basic process operations:
milling, starch production, and  syrup  manufacturing.   The
finished products of starch and corn sweeteners are used for
paper   products,   food  products,  textile  manufacturing,
building materials, laundries, home uses, and  miscellaneous
operations.

Dry  corn milling process separates the various fractions of
corn,  namely  the  endosperm,  brain,  and   germ.    These
fractions are later ground and sifted after separation.  The
final  products  include:  corn meal, grits, flour, oil, and
animal feed.

Bulgur wheat flour milling produces  parboiled,  dried,  and
partially debranned wheat for use in either cracked or whole
grain  form.   Bulgur  is produced primarily for the Federal
Government as part of a national effort to  utilize  surplus
wheat   for   domestic   use   and   for   distribution   to
underdeveloped countries.

Parboiled rice  milling  utilizes  rice  that  is  carefully
cleaned,  parboiled  by soaking in water, and then cooked to
gelatinize the starch.  After cooking, the water is  drained
and  the  parboiled  rice is dried before milling.  The bran
and germ are later separated  from  the  milled  rice.   The
final   product   has  superior  cooking  qualities  because
vitamins from the bran are forced into the endosperm.

The use of dry corn milling  products  in  direct  food  has
declined  significantly  over  the  past  20  years but this
decline has been offset by the growing use of  the  products
as  ingredients  in  processed foods.  Consumption of bulgur
wheat  flour  milling  products  has  been   increasing   in
developing  nations  due  to  the high nutritional values of
bulgur wheat.  Rice milling including parboiled products are
60 percent exported and 40 percent used for domestic trade.

Waste Sources and Pollutants.  Principal wastewater  sources
in  wet corn milling are modified starch washing, condensate
from   steepwater   evaporation,   mud   separation,   syrup
                           3-98

-------
evaporation,  animal  feeds,  and  corn  steeping.  Dry corn
milling process wastes originate from infrequent washing  of
corn.   Bulgur  wheat flour milling process wastewater stems
from  steaming  and  cooking  of  bulgur,   although   these
quantities  are  relatively  small.   Parboiled rice milling
process  wastewater   stems   from   steeping   or   cooking
operations,  and  at  least one plant uses wet scrubbers  for
dust  control,  which  generates  an  additional  source  of
wastewater.

The    basic    parameters   used   to   define   wastewater
characteristics are BOD15, suspended solids  and  pH.   About
one-fourth of the wet corn milling plants discharge directly
into surface water.  The majority of the plants in the other
subcategories discharge into municipal systems.

Control  Technology and Costs.  Except for wet corn milling,
little attention has been focused on either in-plant control
or treatment of the wastewaters.   In  many  instances,   the
treatment technologies developed for wet corn milling can be
transferred  to  the  other industry subcategories.  Current
in-plant control consists of water recycling cooling systems
(barometric condensers),  and  some  plants  use  biological
treatment (activated sludge).

Best  practicable  technology  for  the  four  subcategories
consists of the following:

Phase I

  •  Wet corn milling.  Equalization and activated sludge

  •  Dry corn milling.  Primary sedimentation and  activated
     sludge

  •  Bulgur wheat flour milling.  Activated sludge, and

  •  Parboiled rice milling.  Activated sludge.

Best available technology for the four subcategories is deep
bed  filtration in addtion to BPT.   New  source  performance
technology  is the same as BAT.

Since  the  wet corn milling industry contributes the largest
amount of wastewater  discharges,  control  costs  for  this
industry are of primary concern.

A  recent analysis of costs for this sector was conducted by
Gianessi  and  Peskin  (G&P>*.   This  study  was  conducted
independently  and  subsequent to the general data gathering
efforts associated with the SEAS  uniform  cost  calculation
                           3-99

-------
procedure.  However, time and resource constraints prevented
incorporating  these  costs into the scenario analyses using
the SEAS model procedure.  The G&P estimates are as  follows
(in million 1975 dollars):

                              Phase I &
                              Phase II   Phase I  Phase II

  Incremental BPT investment    0.          0.       0.
  Incremental BPT O&M           0.          0.       0.

Estimates from the earlier SEAS  calculation  are  presented
below,  with  projected pollutant discharges associated with
these costs.  Phase II costs are assumed to be zero for  in-
house  treatment by both studies.  All costs associated with
Phase II production are municipal  treatment  changes.   The
G&P study states that only negligible costs will be incurred
by  Phase  I  production,  since  only one of the plants not
using municipal systems to discharge wastes  has  not  fully
installed  the  necessary equipment.  SEAS lists five plants
requiring equipment, with 44 percent already installed prior
to standard implementation.
  Gianessi, L. P. and H. M. Peskin, "The Cost to  Industries
  of   the  Water  Pollution  Control  Amendment  of  1972,"
  National  Bureau  of  Economic  Research,  December  1975.
  (Revised January 1976).
                           3-100

-------
                       Table 4-6-1.
                       Grain Milling
                   Industry Data Summary
ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                      1977
                                                     1983
                                                                    1985
  Capacity:
     Phase I (Dry 1.OOO Liters/Day)  45,623.
     Phase II (kkg/Day)           8.584.40O.

  Annual Growth Rate Over the Period, 1976-1985:
     Phase I  = 13.02%
     Phase II =  4.83%
              55,535.
          11.641,7OO.
              58,273.5
          12,598,000.
EFFLUENTS (1.OOO MT/Yr)

  1971 Controls:
     TSS
     BODS
1977
10.70
15. 14
               1983
13.87
19.65
                              1985
                        14.70
                        2O.83
  Legislated Controls:
     TSS
     BODS
 5.76
 6.57
 2.69
 3.62
                         1 .49
                         2.79
CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

Phase I

Investment

  Existing Plant's
     On-slte Treatment
     Pretreatment

  New Plants

  Municipal Investment Recovery

  Totals
1974-77


 12.27
  0.0

  O.54

 14.53

 27.34
                     AGGREGATED OVER
                        1978-83
               (BPT)
  0.0
  0.0

  6.24

124.94

131.18
                  (BAT)
1976-85


   5.46
   O.O

   7.3O

 183.30

 196.O6

-------
LO
I
I-1
O
N)
                 Table 4-6-1. (Continued)
                       Grain Mil 11ng
                   Industry Data Summary

CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $) - (Continued)

Phase I (Continued)

Annualized Costs

Annualized Capital1

O&M3
  On-site Treatment
  Pretreatment
  Totals

Municipal Charges

  Investment Recovery
  User Charges*
  Totals

Grand Totals
                                                                           COST IN YEAR
1977
1
2.
O
2
6,
12,
18.
.68
. 11
.O
. 11
,74
.23
.97
1983
2.
2.
0.
2,
23.
21 ,
44.
.51
.85
,0
.85
,31
.02
.33
1985
2
3
0
3
23
21
45
.64
.06
.0
.06
.75
.71
.47
1976-85
21 .
25.
0.
25,
183
256
44O
.44'
23
O
.23
.30
.87
. 17
                                                              22.76
                                                                             49.68
                                                                                            51 . 16
                                                                                                             486.83
                1  Annualfzed on-s1te and pretreatment costs are computed on the assumption of a 15 year useful  life
                  at 10 percent interest with zero salvage value.
                *  The decade total of annualIzed cost may not be relatable to the decade total of Investment because
                  of the timing of Investment expenditures over the decade.

                1  O&M costs In any year are relative to investment made 1n the year plus all  prior year investments
                  commencing in 1973.  Hence, O&M expenditure In any year bears no particular relationship to the
                  investment made in that year.

                *  User charges denote the O&M component of the municipal treatment charges.   The investment com-
                  ponent is denoted under investment recovery.
                Note:    The Grain Milling (Phase I),  industry Includes wet-corn milling processes.

-------
U)
I
o
W
                                      Table 4-6-1.  (Continued)
                                           Grain M11 Hng
                                       Industry Data Summary
Phase II

CONTROL COSTS (Million  1975 $)

Investment

  Existing Plants
     On-site Treatment
     Pretreatment

  New Plants

  Municipal Investment Recovery

  Totals


Annual1zed Costs

Annual 1zed Capital1

O&M1
  On-site Treatment
  Pretreatment
  Totals

Municipal Charges

  Investment Recovery
  User Charges'
  Totals
                                                                1974-77
                                                                               AGGREGATED OVER

                                                                                  1978-83
                                                                                                    1976-85
o.o
o.o
0.0
1 .02
1 ,02
1977
O.O
O.O
O.O
O.O
0.57
1 .30
1 .86
(BPT) 0.0 (BAT)
O.O
O.O
12.68
12.68
COST IN YEAR
1983
0.0
O.O
O.O
O.O
2.39
2.48
4.88
O.O
O.O
O.O
18.42
18.42
1985
O.O
O.O
O.O
O.O
2,45
2.67
5. 12




1976-85
0.0'
O.O
O.O
O.O
18.42
29.03
47.45
                    Grand Totals
                                                                   1.86
                                                              4.88
5. 12
                                                                                                                 47.45

-------
                               Table 4-6-1.  (Continued)
                                   Grain Mill1ng
                                Industry Data  Summary

             Phase  II  (Continued)

I
O            '  Annual1zed  on-site and pretreatment costs are computed on "the assumption of a  15 year useful  life
•^              at 10 percent  Interest with zero salvage value.

             *  The  decade  total  of annual1zed  cost may not be relatable to the decade total of investment because
               of the  timing  of  Investment expenditures over the decade.

             3  O&M  costs  1n any  year are relative to  investment made in the year plus all prior year  investments
               commencing  in  1973.  Hence, O&M expenditure in any year bears no particular relationship  to  the
               investment  made  in that year,

             *  User charges denote the O&M component of the municipal treatment charges.  The  Investment com-
               ponent  is denoted under Investment recovery.


             Note:   The Grain Milling (Phase  II) industry includes ready-to-eat cereals, wheat starch,  and
                    gluten production processes.

-------
MEAT PROCESSING INDUSTRY

Production  Characteristics and Capacities. According to the
Department   of   Agriculture,   there   were   5,991   meat
slaughtering  plants  in the United States on March 1, 1973.
Commercial slaughter of beef, hogs, calves, sheep, and lambs
totaled 26.9 million metric tons in 1972  according  to  the
USDA.   Of  these  plants, 84 were large plants [over 90,800
metric tons annual live weight  killed  (LWK)],  309  medium
plants  (11,340-90,247 metric tons annual LWK), and the rest
were small.   Of  the  small  plants,  North  Star  Research
Institute  estimated 5,200 to be "locker" plants (very small
meat packing plants that slaughter animals and  may  produce
processed  meat  products which are usually stored in frozen
form).  The other  400  plants  are  assumed  to  be  plants
between 453.5-11,340 metric tons annual LWK.

A  total  of  90  percent  of  the  industry's production is
accounted for by 15 percent of  the  plants.   Although  the
total  number  of  "plants in North Star's slaughterhouse and
packinghouse categories is only 793 (15 percent of 5,993  is
899),  they  assumed that these plants produce 90 percent of
the output, and locker plants account for the  remaining  10
percent.

The  meat  processing industry comprises four subcategories:
simple   slaughterhouse,   complex   slaughterhouse,    low-
processing  packinghouse,  and high-processing packinghouse.
The plants in this industry range from those that carry  out
only  one  operation,  such  as slaughtering, to plants that
also carry out commercial meat processing.

Simple   slaughterhouses   have   very   limited   byproduct
processing  and  usually  no  more than two other operations
such as:  rendering,  paunch  and  viscera  handling,  blood
processing,  or  hide  processing.   Complex slaughterhouses
carry out extensive byproduct processing with at least three
of the aforementioned operations.  Low process packinghouses
process only animals killed  at  the  plant;  normally  they
process   less   than   the   total   kill.    High  process
packinghouses process both animals slaughtered at  the  site
and additional carcasses from outside sources.

Income  from meat slaughtering and meat processing plants in
1972  was  $23.8  million.    Factors  serving  to   restrain
potential  growth  of  the  American  meat  packing industry
include higher meat prices, removal of  import  quotas,   and
the availability of synthetic (soybean protein) substitutes.
The  trend  is  -for  any  new  plants  to be larger and  more
specialized (such as large beef or pork slaughterhouses)  and
                           3-105

-------
to be located closer to the  animal  supply   (movement  from
urban to rural areas).

Waste    Sources    and    Pollutants.    wastewaters   from
slaughterhouses and  packinghouses  contain   organic  matter
including  grease, suspended solids, and inorganic materials
such as phosphates, nitrates,  and  salt.   These  materials
enter the waste stream as blood, meat and fatty tissue, meat
extracts,  paunch  contents,  bedding,  manure,  hair, dirt,
curing and pickling solutions, preservatives, and caustic or
alkaline detergents.

Water is a raw material used in the meat processing industry
to cleanse products and to remove  unwanted   material.   The
primary  operations where waste water originates are: animal
holding pens  (waste from water troughs, washdown, and liquid
wastes), slaughtering (killing,  blood  processing,  viscera
handling and offal washing, and hide processing), and clean-
up.

The  basic  parameters  used to define waste  characteristics
are BOD5_, suspended solids, grease, and  ammonia  (NSPS  and
BAT).   The   total  number  of  municipal  dischargers is 70
percent of the number of  plants.   The  average  wastewater
flows  for  simple  slaughterhouse,  complex  slaughterhouse,
low-process   packinghouse,  high-process  packinghouse   are
1.17,   4.40,   3.22,  and  4.55  million  liters  per  day,
respectively.

Control Technology and Costs. Current end-of-pipe  treatment
for direct dischargers assumes that all plants have in-plant
controls   for   primary  treatment,  and  a  second  system
employing anaerobic  and  aerobic  lagoons.   Dissolved  air
flotation  is  used  for  primary treatment,  either alone or
with screens; however, 30 percent of the plants use a  catch
basin.   Since  a  small percentage of the industry has more
advanced secondary  treatment  systems   (such as  activated
sludge,  trickling  filters or spray irrigation) and a small
percentage of meat packers have no  waste  treatment  beyond
primary  treatment, it can be assumed that the typical plant
today is characterized by primary treatment   plus  anaerobic
and aerobic lagoons.

Best   practicable   Technology   consists    of  end-of-pipe
treatment represented by anaerobic plus aerated  lagoon  and
aerated  lagoon  with  efficient  solid  liquid  separation.
Disinfection  by  chlorination  is  also   required.    Land
disposal, when available, may be an economical option.  End-
of-pipe  treatment  is  assumed  to  be preceded by in-plant
controls: reduction of water use  through  shut-off  valves,
extensive dry cleaning, gravity catch basins, blood recovery
                            3-106

-------
and dry dumping of paunch waste.  NSPS are the same for 1977
with an additional requirement for control of ammonia.

In  addition  to  BPT,  Best  Available  Technology suggests
chemical  additions  prior  to  dissolved   air   flotation,
nitrification  denitrification  (or  ammonia stripping), and
sand filtration following Secondary Treatment.

A recent analysis of costs for this sector was conducted  by
Gianessi  and  Peskin  (G&P)1.   This  study  was  conducted
independently and subsequent to the general  data  gathering
efforts  associated  with  the SEAS uniform cost calculation
procedure.  However, time and resource constraints prevented
incorporating these costs into the scenario  analyses  using
the  SEAS model procedure.  The G&P estimates are as follows
(in million 1975 dollars):

                       Meats    Meats
                       Phase I  Phase II  Rendering  Poultry

  Incremental BPT
  Investment            90.5      3.4       1.8       21.1
  incremental BPT O&M    7.2      0.6       0.4        3.4

Estimates from the earlier SEAS  calculation  are  presented
below,  with  projected pollutant discharges associated with
these  costs.  The SEAS cost estimates   for  Meat  Processing
include  Phase  I  only.   For  slaughterhouses  and packing
houses, both  studies  assumed the same number of  plants  and
discharge levels  to municipalities  in the base data year.   A
major  difference  is that G&P  includes  estimates  for Locker
Plants in the Phase I costs, which  SEAS  does  not.   Locker
Plants amount  to almost half  of the G&P Phase  I estimates.
The remaining differences are  largely due   to  variances   in
capital in  place  assumptions between  the two  stuides.

Poultry  Processing estimates  are within an acceptable range
of computational  variance.
   Gianessi,  L.  P.  and H.  M.  Peskin,  "The Cost to industries
   of  the Water  Pollution  Control  Amendment of 1972",
   National  Bureau  of Economic Research,  December,  1975.
   (Revised  January, 1976)
                            3-107

-------
                                                Table 4-7-1.
                                        Meat Processing and Poultry
                                            Industry Data Summary
                         ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                                               1977
                                                                              1983
                                                                                             1985
o
CO
                         Capaci ty:
                           Meat (kkgs/Day)
                           Poultry (kkg/Day)
                                  305,373.
                                   50,340.
372,322.
 61,365,
                           Annual  Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-1985 = 3.21%

                         EFFLUENTS (l,OOOMT/Yr)               1977           1983
1971 Controls:
   TSS
   BOD5
   COD (Poultry only)
   Oils and Greases

Legislated Controls:
   TSS
   BOD5
   COD (Poultry only)
   Oils and Greases
395,52O.
 65.188.
                                                                  1985
106.51
182. OS
68.31
3O4 . 3 1
4O.61
56. 7O
21 .52
82.35
129.
221 .
83.
370.
11 .
8.
4.
3.
74
79
2O
67
57
94
78
56
137.6O
235.24
88.25
393. 14
8.70
6.86
4.23
2.35
                         CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)
                         Meat Processing

                         Investment

                           Existing  Plants
                              On-slte Treatment
                              Pretreatment

                           New Plants

                           Municipal  Investment Recovery

                           Totals
                                                         AGGREGATED OVER
                                          1974-77


                                           17.54
                                            O.OO

                                           29.36

                                           58. 19

                                          105.1O
                                                            1978-83
                                                                       1976-85
  (BPT)     3O2.O7 (BAT) 311.61
              O.OO     O.OO

             58.29   1O9.O3

            498.97   731.46

            859.33   1,152.1O

-------
                                     Table 4-7-1. (Continued)
                                   Meat Processing and Poultry
                                      Industry Data Summary
w
I
CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $) - (Continued)
 Meat Processing (Continued)

Annual1zed Costs                               1977

Annual 1zed Capital'                             6.17

O&M'
  On-s1te Treatment                           16.27
  Pretreatment                                 O.O
  Totals                                      16.27

Municipal Charges

  Investment Recovery                         26.99
  User Charges'                               49.O5
  Totals                                      76.O3

Grand Totals                                  98.47
                                                                              COST IN YEAR


                                                                                 1983     1985    1976-85

                                                                                53.54    56.87   274.64'
                                                                                49.O9   22O.67   643.O1
                                                                                 O.O      O.O     O.O
                                                                                49.O9   22O.67   643.O1
 92.81     94.47
 78.74     8O.70
171.55    175.17
731.46
996.70
1,728.16
                                                                               274.19   452.7O   2,645.81
                   1  Annuallzed on-site and pretreatment costs are computed on the assumption of a 15 year useful  life
                     at 1O percent Interest with zero salvage value.

                   1  The decade total of annual 1zed cost may not be relatable to the decade total  of Investment because
                     of the timing of Investment expenditures over the decade.

                   *  O&M costs in any year are relative to investment made 1n the year plus all  prior year Investments
                     commencing 1n 1973.  Hence, O&M expenditure 1n any year bears no particular relationship to the
                     investment made in that year.

                   *  User charges denote the O&M component of the municipal  treatment charges.   The  Investment com-
                     ponent is denoted under Investment  recovery.
                   Note:    The Meat Processing industry  includes  slaughterhouse and packinghouse processing operations.

-------
                  Table 4-7-1. (Continued)
                Meat Processing and Poultry
                   Industry Data Summary
I
1—•
t-1
o
CONTROL COSTS (Million  1975 $)
Poultry

Investment

  Existing Plants
     On-site Treatment
     Pretreatment

  New Plants

  Municipal Investment Recovery

  Totals
Annual1zed Costs

Annual 1 zed Capital1

O&M'
  On-site Treatment
  Pretreatment
  Totals

Municipal Charges

  Investment Recovery
  User Charges'
  Totals
                                                                                  AGGREGATED OVER
                                                                   1974-77
                                                                                     1978-83
                                                                                                1976-85
17. 8O
O.OO
8.52
25.42
51 .74

1977
3.46
3.74
0.0
3.74
11 .90
22. 07
33.96
(8PT) 38
O
12
223
274,
COST IN
1983
1O. 16
5.87
0.0
5.87
41 .66
36.42
78. OS
.26 (BAT) 46.84
.00 0.00
.71 24. 7O
.63 327.58
,6O 399.12
YEAR
1985 1976-85
10.79 65.60'
19.75 75.53
O.O O.O
19.75 75,53
42.43 327.58
37.92 454.51
8O.35 782.09
Grand Totals
                                              41 . 17
                                                             94. 1 1
                                                                     11O.89
                                                                              923.22

-------
                                 Table 4-7-1. (Continued)
                               Meat Processing and Poultry
                                  Industry Data Summary
GO
'               Poultry (Continued)
                ' Annual 1zed on-sfte and pretreatment costs are computed on the assumption of a 15 year useful life
                 at  10 percent Interest with zero salvage value.

                ' The decade total of annual1zed cost may not be relatable to the decade total of investment because
                 of  the timing of Investment expenditures over the decade.

                ' O&M costs in any year are relative to investment made in the year plus all  prior year investments
                 commencing In 1973.  Hence, O&M expenditure in any year bears no particular relationship to the
                 investment made in that year.

                * User charges denote the O&M component of the municipal treatment charges.   The investment com-
                 ponerit is denoted under investment recovery.


               Note:   The Poultry industry includes prepareation of most domestic fowl products,  such as frozen ducks,
                       turkeys, chickens, and game birds.

-------
SEAFOOD PROCESSING INDUSTRY

Production  Characteristics  and   Capacities.   There   are
approximately 1,800 seafood processors located in the United
States,  including  tuna processing plants located in Puerto
Rico and American Samoa.   The  crab,  shrimp,  and  catfish
processers  have a large number of small producers.  Some of
these  are   associated   with   large   national   seafoods,
processors,   but   there   is   no  significant  degree  of
concentration in these industries.  In the  crab  processing
industry,   there  seems  to  be  an  increasing  number  of
multiplant firms and a growing importance of  large  plants.
The   catfish   processing   industry   is  very  small  and
fragmented.  This  study's  count  of  30  plants  does  not
include  a  number of very small "backyard" operations which
are thought  to  be  scattered  throughout  the  South.   In
general,  these  segments of the seafood processing industry
can   be   characterized   as   possessing    many    small,
underutilized,  old  plants  that in some cases compete with
efficient, low-cost foreign producers.

On the other hand, the tuna industry is  dominated  by  five
firms  that  operate 14 large-scale plants which account for
over 90 percent of the industry production; these firms are:
Bumble Bee, Del Monte, Starkist,  van  Camp,  and  Westgate-
California.

In  general,  the volume of production is dependent upon the
amount of seafood harvested,  both  domestic  and  imported.
Recent  analyses  by  the  U.S.  National  Marine  Fisheries
Service indicate that there is  little  potential  available
for  continuing  to  increase  either harvests or imports of
crab, shrimp, or tuna.  Significant increases might come  if
the  limit of the U.S. territorial waters is extended to 200
miles, or if  significant  technological  breakthroughs  are
achieved in deep ocean fishing; but these conditions are not
anticipated.

Because  catfish  processors are currently plagued with very
low utilization of capacity, the  same  expectation  of  "no
growth"  holds  for  this  segment of the seafood processing
industry.

The effluent limitations guidelines issued for  the  seafood
processing industry by the EPA cover the processing of crab,
shrimp,   tuna,   and   farmed   catfish.   All  methods  of
preservation, fresh-pack, freezing, canning or  curing,  are
included.

Processing  seafood involves variations of a common sequence
of operations: harvest,  storage,  receiving,  preprocessing
                           3-112

-------
(washing,  thawing, etc.), evisceration, precooking, picking
or cleaning/  preservation,  and  packaging.   Many  of  the
operations,  such  as  picking, shelling, and cleaning, have
been mechanized, but much of the industry still  depends  on
conventional hand operations.

For   the   purpose  of  establishing  effluent  limitations
guidelines, the seafood processing industry has been divided
into 14 subcategories.  These guidelines are based upon  the
type  of  product,  the  degree  of  mechanization,  and the
location or remoteness  of  the  processing  plant.   Remote
Alaskan  plants  have  been placed in a separate subcategory
because their  isolated  locations  render  most  wastewater
treatment  alternatives  infeasible because of the high cost
of overcoming engineering  obstacles  and  the  undependable
access  to  transportation  during  extended  severe  sea or
weather conditions.

Waste Sources  and  Pollutants.  Pollution  sources  in  the
seafood  processing  industry include both the fishing boats
(mostly their discharged bilge  water)  and  the  processing
plants  themselves.   water  uses  in   the processing plants
include: washing the seafood, plants, and equipment;   flumes
for  in-plant  transport of product and wastes,- live holding
tanks;  cooling  and  ice  making,-  cooking,-   freezing;  and
brining.

The  solids   and   effluents  from  all   fish   and   shellfish
operations  consist of:

   •  Solid  portions  consisting   of   flesh,   shell,   bone,
     cartilage and viscera.

   •  Hot   and cold  water  (fresh or   seawater)   solutions
     containing  dissolved materials  (proteins and  breakdown
     products),
   •  Suspended solids consisting  of bone,  shell or  flesh,

   •  Foreign  material carried  into the  plant   with   the  raw
     material.

The   following   pollutant  parameters   are  controlled  by the
effluent  limitations  guidelines for the  seafood  processing
 industry:   5-day  biochemical   oxygen   demand   (BOD5),  total
 suspended  solids (TSS),  and  oil and grease.    Pollutants   of
peripheral   or    occasional    importance   that    are  not
 specifically  controlled  by  the  guidelines   include  high
 temperatures1,   phosphorus,   coli forms,  chloride,   chemical
oxygen demand,  settleable solids,  and  nitrogen.
                            3-113

-------
control   Technology   and   Costs.   Control   technologies
applicable  to  the seafood processing industry include both
in-plant- changes and end-of-pipe treatment.  Basic  in-plant
changes include:

  •  Minimizing  the  use  of  water  by  substituting   dry
     handling  for flumes, using spring-loaded hose nozzles,
     etc.

  «  Recovery of dissolved proteins  by  precipitation  from
     effluent   streams,  enzymatic  hydrolysis,  brine-acid
     extraction,  or  through  the  conventional   reduction
     process for converting whole fish or fish waste to fish
     meal.

  *  Recovery of solid portions for use as edible product or
     as byproducts by mechanical deboning and extruding, and
     by shellfish waste utilization.

Very few end-of-pipe waste treatment systems  are  currently
installed  in the seafood processing industry.  However, the
essentially bio-degradable nature of the wastes  allows  for
the  easy  application  of  conventional  treatment methods.
These  include  screening  and   sedimentation   to   remove
suspended solids- air flotation and skimming to remove heavy
concentrations  of  solids,  greases,  oils,  and  dissolved
organics; biological treatment systems,  such  as  activated
sludge,  rotating  biological contactors, trickling filters,
ponds, and  lagoons  to  remove  organic  wastes;  and  land
disposal methods where land is available.

In   general,   BPT   guidelines  call  for  in-plant  "good
housekeeping"  practices,  but  do  not  assume  significant
equipment changes.  End-of-pipe technologies associated with
BPT  are  represented  by  simple  screening and grease trap
methods, with dissolved air flotation for  tuna  plants  and
grinders or comminutors, followed by discharge to deep water
for  remote  Alaskan  processors  where adequate flushing is
available.  BAT and NSPS guidelines place much more emphasis
on  in-plant  changes,  including  in-process  modifications
which  promote  efficient water and wastewater management to
reduce water consumption, recycling some water streams,  and
solids or byproduct recovery where practicable.  End-of-pipe
technologies associated with BAT and NSPS guidelines include
more  extensive  use  of  dissolved  air flotation, plus the
addition of aerated lagoons and activated  sludge  treatment
for tuna processors in 1983.
                           3-114

-------
A  recent analysis of costs for this sector was conducted by
Gianessi  and  PesKin  (G&P)*.   This  study  was  conducted
independently  and  subsequent to the general data gathering
efforts associated with the SEAS  uniform  cost  calculation
procedure.  However, time and resource constraints prevented
incorporating  these  costs into the scenario analyses using
the SEAS model procedure.  The G&P estimates are as  follows
(in million 1975 dollars):

  Incremental BPT Investment    $39.5
  Incremental BPT O&M           $ 3.9

Estimates from the earlier SEAS  calculation  are  presented
below,  with  projected pollutant discharges associated with
these costs.   Principal  reasons  for  differences  between
these   cost  estimates   and  the  new  data  are  different
estimates  of    "capital-in-place"   and   plant   inventory
estimates   (SEAS  calculates  costs  for 875 plants, but G&P
uses a  baseline of 330 plants).
   Gianessi,  L.  P.  and H.  M.  Peskin,  "The  Cost  to  Industries
   of  the Water  Pollution  Control  Amendment  of  1972",
   National  Bureau  of Economic Research, December,  1975.
   (Revised  January,  1976)
                            3-115

-------
                       Table 4-8-1.
                     Seafood Processing
                   Industry Data Summary
ACTIVITY LEVEL
  Capacity (kkg/Day)
     Canned & Cured
     Fresh & Frozen
                                      1977
 58,449.
382,587.
                                                     1983
 76.238.
499,072.
  Annual Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-1985 = 4.29%
                                                                    1985
 81,977.
536,649.
EFFLUENTS (1.OOO MT/Yr)

  1971 Controls:
     TSS
     BOD5
     Bases
     011s and Greases

  Legislated Controls:
     TSS
     BOD5
     Bases
     Oils and Greases
  1977
                 1983
                                1985
23.35
3O.72
.08
11 .44
16.79
26. CO
.04
7.23
30.24
39.78
. 1O
14.82
1O.34
17.62
.04
4. 16
32.42
42.65
. 11
15.89
8.02
13. 9O
.04
3.26
CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

Phase I

Investment

  Existing Plants
     On-site Treatment
     Pretreatment

  New Plants

  Municipal  Investment Recovery

  Totals
                       AGGREGATED OVER
        1974-77


        266.21
          O.OO

         62.96

          O.O

        329.17
           1978-83
                      1976-85
  (BPT)     511.24 (BAT) 641.20
              O.OO     0.OO

            37O.98   5O1.92

              O.O     O.O

            882.22   1,143.13

-------
                  Table 4-8-1. (Continued)
                     Seafood Processing
                   Industry Data Summary
I
(_.
»—
'•J
CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $) - (Continued)

Annual1zed Costs

Annual 1zed Capital1

O&M1
  On-slte Treatment
  Pretreatment
  Totals

Municipal Charges

  Investment Recovery
  User Charges*
  Totals

Grand Totals
  1977

 43.28
 88.78
  O.O
 88.78
  O.O
  0.0
  0.0

132.O6
COST IN YEAR

   1983     1985    1976-85

 129.27   133.O3   841.48'
 145.53   28O.83   1,444.28
   0.0      O.O     0.0
 145.53   28O.83   1,444.28
   O.O
   O.O
   O.O
O.O
O.O
O.O
O.O
O.O
O.O
 274.8O   413.85   2.285.76
1  Annual1zed on-s1te and pretreatment costs are computed on the assumption of a 15 year useful life
  at 1O percent Interest with zero salvage value.

1  The decade total of annual1zed cost may not be relatable to the decade total of Investment because
  of the timing of Investment expenditures over the decade.

*  O&M costs In any year are relative to Investment made 1n the year plus all prior year Investments
  commencing 1n 1973.  Hence, O&M expenditure 1n any year bears no particular relationship to the
  Investment made 1n that year.

*  User charges denote the O&M component of the municipal treatment charges.   The investment com-
  ponent 1s denoted under Investment recovery.
Note:   The Seafood (Phase I) industry includes fresh and frozen packaged fish products.

-------
I
H--
(-•
00
                  Table 4-8-1. (Continued)
                     Seafood Processing
                    Industry Data Summary
CONTROL COSTS  (Million  1975 $)

Phase II

Investment

  Existing Plants
     On-slte Treatment
     Pretreatment

  New Plants

  Municipal Investment  Recovery

  Totals



Annual1zed Costs

Annual 1 zed Capital

O&M3
  On-slte Treatment
  Pretreatment
  Totals

Municipal Charges

  Investment Recovery
  User Charges*
  Totals
                                                                    1974-77
                                                           AGGREGATED OVER
                                                                                      1978-83
                                                                                                 1976-85
91 .31
0.00
20.27
0.0
1 1 1 .58

1977
14.67
28. 13
O.O
28. 13
O.O
O.O
0.0
(BPT) 120,
0,
119.
O.
239.
COST IN
1983
46. 18
46.58
O.O
46.58
0.0
O.O
O.O
.69 (BAT)
.00 0,
.01 161.
.0 0.0
.70 326.
YEAR
1985
5O.61
54. 16
O.O
54. 16
O-O
O.O
0.0
165.21
00
12

33

1976-85
3 1 7 . 59 '
389.33
O.O
389.33
O.O
O.O
0.0
Grand Totals
                                              42.8O
                                                             92.77
                                                                                             1O4.77   706.92

-------
                  Table 4-8-1. (Continued)
                     Seafood Processing
                   Industry Data Summary



Phase II (Continued)

'  Annual 1zed on-site and pretreatment costs are computed on the assumption of a 15 year useful  life
  at 1O percent Interest with zero salvage value.

*  The decade total of annual 1zed cost may not be relatable to the decade total  of investment because
  of the timing of investment expenditures over the decade.

3  O&M costs 1n any year are relative to investment made 1n the year plus all  prior year investments
  commen*jng in 1973.  Hence, O&M expenditure in any year bears no particular relationship to the
  investment made in that year.

•  User charges denote the O&M component of the municipal treatment charges.   The investment com-
  ponent is denoted under investment recovery.


Note:   The Seafood (Phase II) Industry includes canned and cured seafood processing  operations.

-------
LEATHER TANNING & FINISHING INDUSTRY

Production  Characteristics  and  Capacities.   The  leather
tanning  and  finishing  industry  is  engaged in converting
animal   skins   into   leather.    Cattlehides   constitute
approximately  90  percent of the tanning done in the United
States, followed by  sheepskins,  lambskins,  and  pigskins.
Other  types  of skins or hides processed include goat, kid,
hairsheep, horse, and a variety of skins on a  very  limited
basis,   such   as   deer,  elk,  moose,  antelope,  rabbit,
alligator,  crocodile,  seal,  shark,  and  kangaroo.   Once
tanned and finished, the leather from these skins is shipped
by  the industry to process manufacturers for the production
of shoes, coats, gloves, and other leather products.   Three
primary processes are involved in the production of finished
leather:  beamhouse•  tanhouse  and/or retan, color and fat-
liquor; and finishing.

The beamhouse process consists of receiving hides  that  are
either  cured,  green-salted,  or brined.  Trimming, washing
and  soaking,  fleshing  (removal  of  fatty  tissue),   and
unhairing are the steps that prepare hides for processing.

The tanhouse process involves placing the hides in solutions
of  ammonium  salts  and enzymes in order to de-lime, reduce
swelling, peptize fibers,  and  remove  protein  degradation
products.   Prior  to  tanning, hides are pickled in a brine
and acid solution, and then tanned using  either  chrome  or
vegetable tannins.  The tanned hide is later split to form a
grainside  piece  and  a flesh side layer.  The retan, color
and fat-liquor process imparts different characteristics  to
the  finished  leather.   Bleaching and coloring using acids
and dyes, along with  applying  oils  to  replace  the  lost
natural oils, allow the leather to be pliable.

The finishing process, or last step, includes drying, wet-in
coating,  staking  or tacking, and plating.  The wastes from
these processes may be disposed of  in  either  wet  or  dry
form.

The  industry  may  be divided into major subcategories based
on the primary processes employed; these  subcategories  are
presented in Table  4-9-1.
                            3-120

-------
                        Table 4-9-1.
           Leather Tanning Industry Subcategories
                                               Leather
Subcategory   Beamhouse         Tanning        Finishing

     1        Pulp Hair         Chrome            Yes

     2        Save Hair         Chrome            Yes

     3        Save Hair         Vegetable         Yes

     4        Hair previously   Previously        Yes
              removed           tanned

     5        Hair previously   Chrome            Yes
              removed or re-
              tained

     6        Pulp or Save      Chrome or         No
              Hair              no tanning

Source: EPA Development Document, March 1974.
The  two processes used for unhairing are save hair and pulp
hair.  Save hair is a process that loosens hair by lime  and
sharpeners  (sodium  hydrosulfite,  etc.); the hair is later
removed from the hide by machines.  Pulp hair is similar   to
save  hair  except  that  higher chemical concentrations are
used; the proteinaceous hair is solubilized sufficiently   to
disperse it in the processing liquid.

There  were  513  industry establishments operating in 1972;
estimations  are  that  176  tanneries   use   wet   process
operations, and 225 to 260 plants are engaged in dry process
finishing  operations  on  leather  which was tanned at some
other location.  Some 40 to 90 firms  are  estimated  to   be
converters and miscellaneous small operators.  Approximately
80   percent   of   the  plants  in  the  industry  fall   in
Subcategory 1.

in 1972, a total of 36.5 million cattle  (90 percent  of  the
total  hides  tanned) were slaughtered in the United States;
about 47 percent of these hides  went  to  foreign  tanners.
The  number  of  tanneries  has steadily decreased since the
turn of the century.  For example, in 1967, there  were  474
companies   operating  519  establishments  in  the  leather
                           3-121

-------
tanning  and  finishing  industry  (including  dry   process
tanners) as compared to 521 companies and 578 establishments
10 years earlier.

After  reaching a peak volume in 1967 of 32.4 million cattle
hide equivalents, volume has dropped sharply each year.   in
1972,  volume  had •declined  to  24.0  million  cattle hide
equivalents or a decrease of 25 percent from the peak  year.
Two major factors have contributed to this decline:

  •  Increased exporting of raw hides for tanning abroad.

  •  Increased competition from synthetic leathers, both  in
     terms of physical product and price.

The  records  of the Tanner's Council of America indicate 33
plants  (representing  a  tanning  capacity  of  5.3  million
hides) ceased operations between 1968 and June of 1974.

Waste Sources and Pollutants.  The main sources contributing
to  the total waste load come from the processes used in the
tanning and finishing of hides.  In order  to  define  waste
characteristics, the following basic parameters were used to
develop  guidelines for meeting BPT and BAT: BOD5_, suspended
solids, total nitrogen, chromium,  oil  and  grease  (hexane
solubles), sulfide, and pH.

Currently,  about 60 percent of industry waste is discharged
to  municipal  sewerage  systems,  while  the  remainder  is
discharged directly to surface waters.  It is estimated that
60 percent of the wet-process tanners discharge to municipal
sewers.

Control  Technology and Costs.  Waste treatment practices in
the leather tanning  and   finishing  industry  vary  widely.
Some  tanneries  use  no treatment or only simple  screening.
Others  have employed activated  sludge,  trickling   filters,
spray   irrigation,  and   lagoon  systems.   In-plant  waste
control procedures have included efforts by  some  tanneries
to conserve water and materials.  Although the potential  for
materials   conservation   has   not  been   fully  realized,
recycling  and   recovery   techniques  have   generally   been
applied  only  in  those areas where direct  cost savings  are
demonstrated.  BPT  guidelines  for  plants  discharging  to
waterways  call  for  a  major removal of BOD5_ and suspended
solids  through the  installation  of  preliminary  treatment
(chromium   removal,  screening,  equalization  and  primary
clarification) and secondary biological  treatment  (activated
sludge, aerobic  or anaerobic lagoons),   in addition  to major
removals of BOD5_ and suspended  solids,  the BAT  guideline
requires  reductions  in sulfide and nitrogen through  use of
                            3-122

-------
aeration  and  mixing  with  a  carbon   source   to   cause
denitrification  and  filtration of the final effluent using
deep-bed, mixed-media filters to  remove  suspended  solids.
New  source  performance  standards  are the same as BPT for
existing plants.

A recent analysis of costs for this sector was conducted  by
Gianessi  and  PesXin  (G&P)1-.   This  study  was  conducted
independently and subsequent to the general  data  gathering
efforts  associated  with  the SEAS uniform cost calculation
procedure.  However, time and resource constraints prevented
incorporating these costs into the scenario  analyses  using
the  SEAS model procedure.  The G&P estimates are as follows
(in million 1975 dollars):

  Incremental BPT Investment    $79.2
  Incremental BPT O&M           $ 9.1

Estimates from the earlier SEAS  calculation  are  presented
below,  with  projected pollutant discharges associated with
these costs.   Principal  reasons  for  differences  between
these cost estimates and the newer data are changes in plant
inventory  estimates,  different  estimates  of "capital-in-
place",  different  assumptions  for  industry  growth,  and
different  engineering  cost  estimates  for  O&M in BPT and
pretreatment,  The  pretreatment  investment  estimates  are
very  close for both studies; G&P lists 31.2 million dollars
and SEAS forecasts 30.2.
  Gianessi, L. P. and H. M. Peskin, "The Cost to industries
  of the Water Pollution Control Amendment of 1972",
  National Bureau of Economic Research, December, 1975.
  (Revised January, 1976)
                           3-123

-------
                                                  Table 4-9-2.
                                          Leather Tanning and Finishing
                                              Industry Data Summary
                           ACTIVITY  LEVEL
                                      1977
1983
1985
                             Capacity  (Hides/Day)               145,100        176,500

                             Annual  Growth Rate  Over  the  Period 1976-1985  =  1.88%
                                                                  169,250
I
i-1
ts>
It*
EFFLUENTS (l,OOOMT/Yr)

  1971 Controls:
     TSS
     BOD5
     Dissolved Sol ids
     Nutrients
     Oils and Greases
                             Legislated  Controls:
                                TSS
                                BOD5
                                Nutrients
                                Oils  and Greases
                                Dissolved  Sol ids
                                                                 1977
1983
1985
43.49
23.50
.90
10.05
8.74
16.51
8. 18
10.O1
2.62
.28
47.74
25. 8O
.99
11.03
9.6O
3.02
1.71
2.89
.50
.05
45.63
24.65
.94
10.54
9. 17
1.21
1. 1O
,21
.43
.04
                          CONTROL COSTS  (Million  1975  $)

                          Investment

                            Existing Plants
                               On-site Treatment
                               Pretreatment

                            New Plants

                            Municipal Investment  Recovery

                            Totals
                                            1974-77


                                              82.06  (BPT)
                                              3O.18

                                               8.36

                                               3.40

                                             124.OO
      AGGREGATED  OVER

         1978-83     1976-85


          187.54  (BAT)  229.66
            O.OO     O.OO

           5O.75     5O.75

           26.63     39.19

          264.92    319.6O

-------
                                  Table 4-9-2.  (Continued)
                               Leather  Tanning  and Finishing
                                   Industry  Data  Summary
I
I-1
to
CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $) - (Continued)

Annual1zed Costs                               1977

Annua11 zed Capital'                            15.86

O&M'
  On-s1te Treatment                            9.59
  Pretreatment                                 5.82
  Totals                                      15.41

Municipal Charges

  Investment Recovery                          1.52
  User Charges*                                2.56
  Totals                                       4.O8

Grand Totals                                  35.35
                                                                           COST  IN  YEAR

                                                                              1983      1985

                                                                             47.18     47.18
                                                                              4.95
                                                                              4.11
                                                                              9.06

                                                                             76.08
          5.03
          4.07
          9.1O
                  1976-85

                 308.56'
12.75    29.87   15O.23
 7.O9     6.79    66.64
19.84    36.66   216.87
39. 19
52.18
91 .37
         92.94   616.80
                1  Annual 1zed on-slte and pretreatment  costs  are  computed  on the  assumption  of  a  15  year useful  life
                  at  10 percent  Interest with zero salvage value.

                *  The decade total  of annual1zed cost  may  not  be relatable  to  the  decade  total of  Investment  because
                  of  the timing  of  Investment expenditures over  the  decade.

                ]  O&M costs  1n any  year  are  relative to  Investment made In  the year plus  all prior  year Investments
                  commencing In  1973.  Hence,  O&M expenditure  1n any year bears  no particular  relationship to the
                  investment made in that year.

                *  User charges denote the O&M component  of the municipal  treatment charges.  The investment com-
                  ponent 1s  denoted under investment recovery.
                Note:    The  Leather  industry includes  tanning  and  finishing operations.

-------
TEXTILES INDUSTRY

Production Characteristics and Capacities.  The U.S. textile
industry includes over 7,000 establishments engaged  in  the
processing   of  wool,  cotton,  and  man-made  fibers  into
finished  fabrics.   Man-made   fibers,   including   rayon,
acetate, nylon, acrylic, polyester, polypropylene, and glass
fibers, are the most important raw materials, accounting for
over  60  percent  of  the  rav  materials  consumed  by the
industry in 1972.  Cotton accounted for  about  36  percent,
and wool only 2 percent of the total raw materials used.

The  natural  fibers  are supplied to the industry in staple
form,* or short fibers.   Man-made  fibers  are  supplied  as
either  staple  or continuous filament.  In either case, the
fiber is spun  into  yarn,  which  is  simply  a  number  of
filaments  twisted together.  The yarn is then woven or knit
into a fabric, which is then dyed and treated to impart such
characteristics as  shrink  resistance,  crease  resistance,
etc.    The   finished  fabric  is  then  delivered  to  the
manufacturers  of  textile  products,  either  directly   or
through converters, jobbers, and wholesalers.

In  transforming  fibers into the finished fabrics, two types
of processes are  used:  wet  and  dry.   The  dry  processes
include    spinning,   weaving,   knitting,   bonding,   and
laminating,-  wet  processes  include   scouring,   desizing,
mercerizing, bleaching, dyeing, and finishing.

For   the   purpose  of  establishing  effluent  limitations
guidelines, the textiles industry has been divided into  the
following  eight  subcategories, based upon the raw material
used and the process employed:

  •  Wool scouring
  «  Wool finishing
  •  Dry processing
  *  Woven fabric finishing
  •  Knit fabric  finishing
  •  Carpet mills
  «  Stock and yarn dyeing and finishing
  •  Commission finishing.

wool scouring is  the process of washing the  raw  wool  with
detergent  or  solvent  to  remove  natural  grease, soluble
salts,  and  dirt.   Wool   finishing   operations   include
carbonizing   (removing vegetable matter by treating the wool
with  sulfuric  acid  at  high  temperatures),  rinsing  and
neutralization,   fulling   (chemical  treatment  followed  by
washing  and  mechanical  working  to   produce   controlled
                            3-126

-------
shrinkage),  dyeing  and/or whitening or bleaching, and moth
proofing.

Dry processing mills include greige mills (any  mill  making
unfinished   fabric)   and   producers  of  coated  fabrics,
laminated fabrics, tire cord fabrics, felts, carpet tufting,
and carpet backing.

Woven fabric finishing operations include desizing  {acid  or
enzyme  treatment  to  remove  chemicals  applied  prior  to
weaving), scouring, bleaching, mercerizing  {treatment  with
sodium  hydroxide  followed by neutralization and washing to
increase   dye   affinity   and   add   tensile   strength),
carbonizing,  fulling,  dyeing,  printing,  resin treatment,
waterproofing, flame proofing, soil repellency, and a number
of special finishes.

The main difference between woven and knit fabric   finishing
is  that  the sizing/desizing and mercerizing operations are
not required for knits.  Stock and yarn dyeing and  finishing
requires mercerizing but not sizing/desizing.   Carpets  are
made from yarn through a dry operation called tufting, which
is followed by printing or dyeing, washing, and drying.  The
processing  operations performed in commission finishing may
be any sequence of the operations discussed above.

In general, the industry is  highly  fragmented,  with  many
small  plants  and a few very large establishments.  In most
industry subcategories, the small plants  account   for  over
half of the annual production.

Although  the  total industry production has grown  at a rate
of approximately 3 percent per year, this  growth   has  been
confined  to the production of man-made fabrics and carpets.
The cotton and wool segments of the industry  have  declined
drastically  over  the  years, resulting in a decline in the
number of establishments, which has been caused in  part  by
the switch to synthetic fibers and in part by an increase in
imported  textiles.   U.S.  imports  of textile products and
clothing have risen  from  $1.5  billion  in  1967  to  $4.0
billion  in 1974;  this trend is expected to continue through
1980.

Waste Sources  and Pollutants.   As  described  above,  the
processing and finishing of textile fabrics involve a number
of wet processes that introduce a wide variety of animal and
vegetable- wastes,  dyes, bleaches, and other chemicals into
the waste streams.  For example, raw wool scouring  produces
pollutants  removed  from  the wool, such as oil and grease;
sulfur, phenolic,  and  other  organic  materials   that  are
separated   from   the  sheep  urine,  feces,  blood,  etc.;
                            3-127

-------
insecticides,- and dirt and grit.  In addition, the  scouring
liquor  is  a  significant pollution source in itself, along
with the chemicals used to recover oil and grease   from  the
liquor.   The scouring and rinsing of detergents, chemicals,
etc., from intermediate and final  products  are  common   to
most  finishing  operations.   About  80  percent of all the
water used in textile wet processing is  used  for  removing
foreign  material—either  that carried on the raw  material,
or that resulting from processing operation.  Another  major
wastewater  source  in  the  textile  industry is the dyeing
operation.  Exhausted dye baths are generally discharged   to
the  sewers,  as  are  the  scouring and rinsing waters used
before and after the dyeing operation.

in most of the wet processes,  chemicals  (generally  in   an
aqueous  solution) are brought into contact with the fabrics
and are washed or rinsed away, the waste  streams   that  are
generated   contain  a  wide  variety  of  pollutants.   The
principal source of  effluent  from  dry  processes is  the
washing and cleaning of equipment.

For the purposes of establishing effluent guidelines for the
textile  industry,  the following wastewater parameters have
been defined to be of major  polluting  significance?  total
suspended  solids,  COD,  oil  and  grease, color,  chromium,
sulfide, phenol, fecal coliform, and  pH.   Minor   pollution
parameters   include   total   dissolved  solids,   nitrogen,
phosphates, temperature (heat), organic chemicals,  and heavy
metals.

Control Technology and Costs.  The  technology  for control
and  treatment  of  waterborne  pollutants  in  the textile
industry can be  divided  into  two  broad  categories!  in-
process  and  end-of-pipe.   in-process control depends upon
two major conditions:

   •  Altering the processes that generate water pollutants,

   •  Controlling water use in non-process as well as process
     areas.

Specific in-process control practices that are applicable  to
the textile  industry include: effective water management and
conservation programs, control and containment of leaks  and
spill6;  segregation of waste streams; use of "double laced"
box washers  and counter-current flows to reduce  the  amount
of  water  used  in  washing  and rinsing operations; use  of
solvents instead of water as media in processing operations;
recycling some wastewater streams,-  and  increased  recovery
and reuse of processing chemicals.
                            3-128

-------
At present, the textile industry is primarily concerned with
end-of-pipe   treatment  of  its  wastewaters  because  most
textile wastes  are  amenable  to  treatment  by  biological
methods  that  include  activated sludge, trickling filters,
anaerobic  and  aerobic  lagoons,  and  rotating  biological
contactors.   Advanced  wastewater.  treatment  methods  also
applicable to the industry include:

  •  Phase Change Systems-distillation, freezing.

  •  Physical   Separation    Systems-filtration,    reverse
     osmosis, ultrafiltration, electrodialysis.

  •  Sorption  Systems-activated   carbon,   ion   exchange,
     polymeric adsorption resins.

  •  Chemical Clarification-chemical.coagulation.

The recommended  technology  for  achieving  BPT  guidelines
relies  primarily  upon  the  use  of  biological  treatment
systems.   Recommended   technology    includes   preliminary
screening,  primary  settling   (wool   scouring  only),  latex
coagulation  (carpet mills  and  dry  processing  only),   and
secondary   biological   treatment.    Chlorination  is  also
included   for  dry  processing  mills.    Strict   management
control  over  housekeeping  and water use practices is also
assumed.   BAT guidelines are based upon the above, plus  the
use  of  advanced  treatment  methods  such  as  multi-media
filtration and  chemical  coagulation   and   clarification
following  biological  treatment.   Chlorination is included
for all subcategories.  NSPS are based on BPT plus  the  use
of multi-media filtration.

Many    textile  mills  already  have   primary  or  secondary
treatment  systems in operation,  and   they  discharge   their
wastewaters  into municipal sewer systems. Data  from EPA  and
from   the  American Textile Manufacturers Institute indicate
that about 35 percent  of the water used  is now discharged to
municipal  sewers,  15  percent  receives . no  treatment,  5
percent  receives primary  treatment, and  45 percent receives
secondary  treatment.
                            3-129

-------
A recent analysis of costs  for this sector was conducted  by
Gianessi  and  Peskin   (G&P)1.   This  study  was  conducted
independently and subsequent to the general  data  gathering
efforts  associated  with   the SEAS uniform cost calculation
procedure.  However, time and resource constraints prevented
incorporating these costs into the scenario  analyses  using
the  SEAS model procedure.  The G&P estimates are as follows
(in million 1975 dollars):

  Incremental BPT investment    $134.0
  Incremental BPT o&M           $ 14.8

Estimates from the earlier SEAS  calculation  are  presented
below/  with  projected pollutant discharges associates with
these costs.  As can be noted, both estimates are within  an
acceptable  range  of  computational  variance.   Some minor
differences,  however,    are   attributable   to   different
techniques in estimating wasteloads per product unit.
  Gianessi, L. P. and H. M. Peskin, "The Cost to industries
  of the Water Pollution Control Amendment of 1972,"
  National Bureau of Economic Research, December, 1975.
  (Revised January, 1976)
                          3-130

-------
                       Table 4-1O-1.
                          Textiles
                   Industry Data Summary
ACTIVITY LEVEL

  Capacity (1.0OO kg/Day)

  Annual Growth Rate Oven the Period

EFFLUENTS (1.0OO MT/Yr)

  1971 Controls:
     TSS
     8005
     COD
     011s and Greases
        (Wool Scouring only)
     D1sso1ved So1 Ids
        (Knit, Woven Wool, and
        Raw Stock only)

  Legislated Controls:
     TSS
     80D5
     COD
     011s and Greases
        (Wool Scouring only)
     Dissolved Sol Ids
        (Knit, Woven Wool, and
        Raw Stock only)

CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

Investment

  Existing Plants
     On-s1te Treatment
     Pretreatment

  New Plants

  Municipal  Investment Recovery

  Totals
  1977           1983

 34,045.         52.O93.

 1976-1985 = 7.37%

  1977           1983
 220.52
 186.96
,OO4.23

  52.06
    .22
 127.8O
  75.01
 52O.O4

   6.36
  311.94
  263.OS
1,416.62

   7O.36
                   .22
   60.06
   46.97
  286.17

     .31
                  1985

                 55,788.



                  1985
  330.54
  278.39
1,499.62

   73.97
                                .20
   29.54
   43.22
  195.75

   . 17
    .06
                   .01           .01

                      AGGREGATED OVER

        1974-77            1978-83    1976-85


        82.28   (8PT)      85.22 (BAT) 148.81
        40.37               O.OO     O.OO

        17.O7             198.74   229,37

        19.86             169.24   248.68

        159.57             453.21   626.86

-------
                 Table 4-1O-1.  (Continued)
                          Textiles
                   Industry Data Summary
u>
I-'
u>
CONTROL COSTS  (Million  1975 $) -  (Continued)

AnnualIzed Costs                                1977

Annualized Capital1                            17.49

O&M3
  On-s1te Treatment                             2.13
  Pretreatment                                 16.66
  Totals                                       18.79

Municipal Charges

  Investment Recovery                           8.81
  User Charges'                                15,09
  Totals                                       23.90

Grand Totals                                   SO. 18
COST IN YEAR

   1983     1985    1976-85

  54.82    57.49   391.11'
   3.47     5.16    32.17
  25.36    26.61   218.33
  28.83    31.77   250.50
  31.85
  32.83
  64.68
                                                                                       32.55
                                                                                       34. 4O
                                                                                       66.95
248.68
373.02
621 .7O
 148.33   156.22   1,263.31
1  AnnualIzed on-slte and pretreatment costs are computed on the assumption of a 15 year useful life
  at 1O percent interest with zero salvage value.

*  The decade total of annual1zed cost may not be relatable to the decade total of Investment because
  of the timing of investment expenditures over the decade.

1  O&M costs 1n any year are relative to investment made in the year plus all prior year investments
  commencing in 1973.  Hence, O&M expenditure in any year bears no particular relationship to the
  investment made in that year.

'  User charges denote the O&M component of the municipal treatment charges.  The investment com-
  ponent is denoted under investment recovery.
Note:   The Textiles industry includes wool scouring, wool finishing, woven and knit fabric finishing,
        carpet mills, and stock yarn processes.

-------
BUILDERS PAPER AND ROOFING
FELT INDUSTRY

Production  Characteristics  and  Capacities.  There were 81
mills in this industry group in  1972.   Although  there  is
some  overlapping,  they  are  generally  divided based upon
their announced production as follows:
     Dry roofing felt                    17 mills
     Saturated/coated roofing felt       58 mills
     Combination of the above             6 mills
Since  mills  frequently  discontinue   old   products   and
introduce new ones, this distribution can only be considered
as illustrative.

Builders  paper  and  roofing   felt mills are geographically
distributed over most of the United States; the majority are
located in or near metropolitan areas where the quantity  of
waste  paper  required  is readily available.  As a result of
their  locations, the majority of the mills  (50 - 75 percent)
are  estimated  to  be  discharging  into  municipal  sewage
systems.

Mills  in this industry produce building papers and felts as
their  primary products  using wood, waste paper, and rags  as
raw  materials.   Although  the processes are similar, mills
may  use different equipment depending upon  the raw materials
used.

The  raw materials are   prepared  by  cooking,  beating,  and
pulping   in  a  blending  chest to reduce them to individual
fibers.   The fibers are then formed on  a paper  machine  and
dried  by  a  steam-heated multidrum dryer.  Finishing coats
are  then  applied  to  protect  the  fibers;  the  coatings
generally  consist  of  mineral  fragments  in  a bitumen or
asphalt medium, depending upon  each client's specifications.

Building paper products are usually a heavy paper  used  in
construction  for  support  or  backing.    Roofing felts are
usually in shingle or   roll  form,  although  sometimes  the
paper  fibers' are woven with asbestos to make a roll  roofing
product of exceptional  strength that   needs  no  protective
coating.
                            3-133

-------
It  is  important to note that the percentage of waste paper
as a constituent in builders  paper  and  roofing  felts  is
expected  to rise from 27.1 percent in 1969 to 40 percent in
1985.

In 1971, a total of 1,469,000  metric  tons  were  produced.
Less than 5 percent of total industry output went to foreign
markets  and  imports  were  also fairly insignificant; this
condition is due to the tight supply and demand  balance  at
home.   American  producers  have  enjoyed  a cost advantage
because of cheaper  raw  material  sources.   However,  this
advantage  may be eliminated by 1980 because of the European
economic community tariffs.

Waste sources and Pollutants.  The sources  contributing  to
the total waste load come from the following:

  •  The main water use is for  cleanup  of  fiber  buildup,
     fiberizing, and the design function of seal and cooling
     waters, agitators, and pumps.

  •  The next largest usage is for emergency  make-up  water
     and  cooling  water for the power boiler, heat exchange
     condensate, and the asphalt saturation process.

in order to  define  waste  characteristics,  the  following
basic parameters were used to develop guidelines for meeting
BPT, BAT, and NSPS:  BOD5, TSS, pH and settleable solids.

Control  Technology and Costs.  Waste treatment practices in
the industry  vary  according  to  whether  the  control  is
internal  or  external.   Internal waste treatment practices
include:

  •  Reuse of Whitewater

  •  Save all system

  •  Shower water reduction/reuse

  •  Gland water reduction/reuse

  •  internal spill collection

  •  Segregation of non-contact process water

  •  LOW volume cooling spray shower nozzles.

External waste treatment practices currently employed  in the
industry include:
                           3-134

-------
Basic Function            Alternative Technologies

Screening                 Traveling, self-cleaning bar
                             screen.
Suspended solids          Mechanical clarifier, earthen
  removal                    basin, mixed (multU-media
                             filtration, coagulation.
BOD5 removal              Aerated stabilization basin,
                             activated sludge storage
                             oxidation ponds.
Temperature control       Cooling tower.

Source: EPA Development Document
BPT guidelines for plants discharging to waterways call   for
a  limitation  of  BOD5,  TSS,  settleable solids, and pH by
installation of the following treatment technologies:

Internal

   *  Water showers-self cleaning,  low volume, high pressure.

   •  Segregation  of  white  water  systems-  maximum  reuse
     within stock preparation machine systems.

   •  Press water filtering, using  vibrating  or  centrifugal
     screen.

   •  Collection systems for vacuum pump/water reduction.

   •  Control of asphalt spills.

External

   •  TSS  reduction  by  earthen  stilling   basin,  mechanical
     clarification, and sludge removal.

   •  BOD5. reduction using biological oxidation with  nutrient
     addition  by activated sludge  aerated  basins or  storage
     oxidation ponds.

   •  Secondary solids  removal  by mechanical  clarifiers,
     stilling  ponds, or  aquiescent zone  in  an aerated  basin
     which   is beyond  the   influence    of    the    aeration
     equipment.

   •  Sludge  disposal by land  disposal or  incineration.
                            3-135

-------
  In addition to the above,  BAT  guidelines  call  for  the
following:

Internal

  •  Control of spills with a bypass to the retention  basin
     for  reuse,  discharge  into  the  treatment  system or
     separate treatment.

  •  Intensive internal reuse of process waters.

  •  Separation of  cooling  waters  from  other  wastewater
     streams with subsequent heat removal and reuse.

  •  Intensive reduction of gland water spillage.

External

  •  BOD5_ reduction by biological  oxidation  with  nutrient
     addition.

  •  Suspended solids reduction by  mixed  media  filtration
     with,   if necessary,  chemical addition and coagulation.
     New Source Performance Standards  (NSPS) are  the  same as
     BAT for existing plants.

A recent analysis of costs for this sector was conducted  by
Gianessi  and  PesKin   (G&P)1.   This   study  was conducted
independently and subsequent to the general  data gathering
efforts  associated  with  the SEAS uniform cost  calculation
procedure.   However, time  and resource constraints prevented
incorporating these costs  into the scenario  analyses  using
the  SEAS   model  procedure.  The builders paper  and  roofing
felt industry G&P estimates are as follows  (in million  1975
dollars):

   Incremental BPT Investment       10.9
   Incremental BPT O&M               1.3

Estimates  from  the  earlier SEAS  calculation  are presented
below,  with projected  pollutant discharges associated with
these  costs.  Of the 81  plants covered in  both studies,   G&P
assumes that   75   percent are  dumping wastes  to municipal
treatment  systems,  and   seven  percent have  no  treatment.
SEAS  assumes   that fifty  percent dump to  municipal  systems,
with all of the  remainder  incurring associated BPT costs.
 * Gianessi, L.  P. and H.  M.  Peskin,  "The Cost to  Industries
   of   the  Water  Pollution  Control  Amendment  of  1972,"
                            3-136

-------
National Bureau  of  Economic  Research,  December,  1975.
(Revised January, 1976)
                         3-137

-------
                       Table 4-11-1.
               Builders Paper & Roofing  Felt
                    Industry Data  Summary
ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                       1977
                                                      1983
                                                                     1985
  Capacity (kkg/Day)                  8,987.         11,690.

  Annual Growth Rate Over the Period  1976-1985  = 4.O3/4
                             12,266.
I
>-•
00
EFFLUENTS (1.OOO MT/Yr)

  1971 Controls:
     TSS
     BODS
1977
64.41
88.32
               1983
 83.94
115. 10
                              1985
 89. 12
122.21
  Legislated Controls:
     TSS
     BODS
39.17
41. 75
 15.20
 15.28
8.71
 11 .04
CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

Investment

  Existing Plants
     On-s!te Treatment
     Pretreatment

  New Plants

  Municipal Investment Recovery

  Totals
                     AGGREGATED OVER

      1974-77           1978-83    1976-85


       19.82   (6PT)      93.83 (BAT) 1O3.46
        O.OO               0.00     O.OO

        3.23              16.21    19.93

        2.37              18.72    27.54

       25.43             128.76   ISO.93

-------
                               Table 4-11-1. (Continued)
                             Builders Paper & Roofing Felt
                                 Industry Data Summary
u>
U>
vo
CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $) - (Continued)

Annualized Costs

Annual1zed Capital1

O&M1
  On-s1te Treatment
  Pretreatment
  Totals

Municipal Charges

  Investment Recovery
  User Charges*
  Totals

Grand Totals
                                                                         COST IN YEAR
1977
3.03
5.8O
O..O
5.8O
1983
17. 5O
8. 19
O.O
8. 19
1985
17.84
15.77
O.O
15.77
1976-85
97.91'
86.06
O.O
86. 06
                                                             1 .06
                                                             1.77
                                                             2.83

                                                            11 .66
 3.48
 2.98
 6.46

32. 15
 3.54
 3.O3
 6.57

40. 18
 27.54
 37. 15
 64.70

248.67
              1  Annual 1 zed on-s1te and pretreatment costs are computed on the assumption of a 15 year useful  life
                at 10 percent Interest with zero salvage value.

              1  The decade total of annualIzed cost may not be relatable to the decade total  of  Investment because
                of the timing of Investment expenditures over the decade.

              '  O&M costs 1n any year are relative to investment made in the year plus all  prior year investments
                commencing in 1973.  Hence,  O&M expenditure in any year bears no particular relationship to the
                investment made in that year.

              4  User charges denote the O&M component of the municipal  treatment charges.   The investment com-
                ponent is denoted under investment recovery.
              Note:   The Builders Paper industry includes heavy construction paper and roofing  felts.

-------
PULP, PAPER AND PAPERBOARD INDUSTRY

Production  Characteristics and Capacities.  The pulp, paper
and paperboard industry  can  be  divided  into  five  major
subcategories   based   on   the  processes  involved.   The
subcategories are:

  •  Unbleached kraft
  •  Neutral sulfite semichemical  (NSSC) sodium base
  •  Unbleached kraft and NSSC cross recovery
  •  Paperboard from waste paper.

The majority of industry production is  from  unbleached Kraft
and cross recovery processes.  A description of process  and
product use by subcategories follows:

  Unbleached  Kraft.   Pulp  is  produced  without  bleaching
using a "full cook"  process  with  a   high  alkaline-sodium
hydroxide  and  sodium  sulfide  cooking liquor,  unbleached
kraft products are used for linerboard, the  smooth  facing  in
corrugated boxes, and grocery sacks.

  Sodium Base-Neutral  Sulfite  Semichemical  (NSSC).    Pulp
production occurs without bleaching, using a neutral sulfite
cooking  liquor  with  a  sodium base;  mechanical fiberizing
follows  the  cooking  stage.   The  main  product  is   the
corrugating  medium  or  inner  layer   in  the  corrugated box
"sandwich."

  Ammonia Base-Neutral Sulfite Semichemical  (NSSC). Pulp  is
produced without bleaching, using  a neutral  sulfite cooking
liquor with an ammonia base.  Products  are similar  to sodium
base NSSC.

  Unbleached   Kraft-Neutral   Sulfite  Semichemical   (cross
recovery).  Unbleached kraft and sodium base NSSC   processes
are  in  the same mill.  NSSC liquor is recovered within the
unbleached kraft recovery process.   The   products  are  the
same as  for the unbleached kraft and NSSC  subcategories.

  Paperboard  from   Waste  Paper.   Paperboard products are
produced from a variety of waste papers such  as  corrugated
boxes,   box board or newspapers without doing  the bleaching,
de-inking, or wood pulping operations.  Plants classified  in
this subcategory must obatin at  least  80   percent   of   their
fibrous  materials  from waste paper.

All  of  the processes are similar  in their digestion of  wood
chips  with a chemical  cooking   liquor  and   the  subsequent
removal  of  the   spent   liquor.   Process  differences relate
primarily  to the   preparation,   use,   and  recovery of  the
                            3-140

-------
cooking  liquor.   in  the case of paperboard, no pulping is
involved.

Exports are primarily woodpulp and  liner  board.   American
producers  have  a  cost  advantage  because  of  cheap  raw
material sources; however, this advantage may be  eliminated
by   the   European   Economic  Community  tariff  increases
scheduled for 1980.  (Europe comprises  43  percent  of  the
export  market.)   Imports  of  pulp,  paper, and paperboard
products are not significant,

Waste sources and Pollutants.  The main sources contributing
to the total waste load come from the  following  processes:
wood preparation, pulping processes and the paper machine.

In  order  to  define  waste  characteristics, the following
basic parameters were selected as guidelines for meeting BPT
and BAT: BOD^, TSS, pH, and color.
Control Technology and Costs.  Waste treatment practices  in
the   pulp,   paper  and  paperboard  industry   include  the
following methods.

  •  Reuse of gland, vacuum pump seal, knot removal  shower,
     wash and condensate waters

  •  Internal spill  collection:  hot  stock  screening  and
     chemical and dregs recovery

  •  Land disposal: save all systems

  •  Screening  and neutralization

  •  Suspended  solids removal by mechanical clarifier, earth
     basin,  filtration and dissolved air flotation

  •  BOD!> removal by aerated stabilization basin,  activated
     sludge  and storage control

  •  Form control by chemical and mechnical means

  •  Color removal  by  lime  treatment,  activated  carbon,
     coagulation-alum, and reverse osmosis

  *  Resin adsorption, ultra-filtration, amino treatment and
     ion flotation.

The  technology  called for in BPT, BAT  and  SSPS guidelines
are  summarized  as  follows:
                            3-141

-------
Guideline
and Area
Subcategories
BPT internal  Unbleached Kraft
Technology Called For

Hot stock screening, spill and
evaporator boil-out storage,
multi-stage counter current
washers
              Sodium base-
              NSSC
              Ammonia base-
              NSSC
               Unbleached
               Kraft-NSSC
               Paperboard
                  Non-polluting spent liquor dis-
                  posal by (a) partial evaporation/
                  incineration (b) fluidized bed
                  reactor

                  Non-polluting spent liquor dis-
                  posal by partial evaporation/
                  incineration

                  Hot stock screening, spin and
                  evaporator boil-out storage,
                  efficient pulp washing

                  TSS reduction by earthen basin,
                  mechanical clarification and
                  sludge removal, and dissolved
                  air flotation
 BPT External   All  Subcategories
                                 TSS  reduction by:  earthen basin
                                 mechanical  clarification and
                                 sludge removal,  and dissolved
                                 air  flotation

                                 BOD!> reduction by:  activiated
                                 sludge, aerated stabiliza-
                                 tion basins, storage oxidation
                                 ponds

                                 Biological  solids removal by:
                                 mechanical  clarifiers, stilling
                                 ponds, stilling pond with an
                                 aerated stabilization basin, or
                                 quiescent zone in an aerated
                                 stabilization basin beyond the
                                 influence of aeration equipment

                                 Sludge disposal by landfilling
                                 or incineration
                            3-142

-------
Guideline
and Area      Subcategories     Technology Called For

BPT Paper     All Subcategories
  Machines

                                Water Showers

                                Segregation of white water

                                Press water filtering  by
                                vibrating or centrifugal  screen

                                Collection system  for  vacuum
                                pump seal water

                                Gland water reduction

BAT Internal  All Subcategories

                                Reuse of  fresh water  filter
                                backwash

                                Control of spills-retention,
                                reuse or  separate  treatment

                                Reduction of pulp  wash and
                                extraction water

                                internal  reuse of  process
                                waters

                                Separate  cooling,  waters  from
                                the other wastewater  streams-
                                treat,  removal,  and reuse

                                Reduction of gland water
                                spillage
                            3-143

-------
BAT External  All Subcategories
                                BOD5_ reduction by: biological
                                oxidation with nutrient
                                addition.  TSS reduction by:
                                mixed media filtration and
                                chemical addition and coagulation
                                color reduction-minimum lime
                                treatment for cross recovery
                                mills and reverse osmosis for
                                NSSC both sodium and ammonia
                                base
Guideline
and Area      Subcategories     Technology Called For
NSPS          All Subcategories
                                Coagulation and  filtration  not
                                included  for  any Subcategories,
                                color reduction  for  both  NSSC
                                bases are  not included.   Same
                                as BAT, no real  process changes
                                but changes to increase
                                efficiency.
A   recent  analysis  of  costs  for  this  sector  was  conducted  by
Gianessi   and   PesXin   (G&P)1.    This  study  was   conducted
independently   and   subsequent to the general  data gathering
efforts associated  with  the  SEAS  uniform  cost  calculation
procedure.   However, time  and resource constraints prevented
incorporating   these   costs  into the  scenario  analyses using
the SEAS model  procedure.  The G&P estimates are as  follows
{in million 1975 dollars):

                                 Total   Phase I  Phase II

   Incremental  BPT Investment $2,045.1  369.2    1,675.9
   Incremental  BPT O&M         $   189.8    49.3      140.5

Estimates  from the earlier SEAS   calculation  are   presented
below,  with  projected  pollutant discharges associated with
thses costs.   Principal  reasons  for  differences  between
these cost estimates and the newer data are  estimates of the
distribution  of costs between model  plant sizes,  as well  as
basic costs associated with  a particular model plant.
   Gianessi,  L.  P.  and H.  M.  Peskin,  "The Cost to Industries


                            3-144

-------
of the water Pollution Control Amendment of 1972",
National Bureau of Economic Research, December, 1975.
(Revised January, 1976)
                        3-145

-------
                       Table 4-12-1.
                Pulp, Paper, and Paper-board
                   Industry Data Summary
ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                      1977
                                                     1983
                                                                    1985
I
»-•

o\
  Capacity:
  Phase I (MT/Day)
  Phase II (MT/Day)
 64,114.
128,020.
  Annual Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-1985:
     Phase I  =  4.22%
     Phase II =  6.13%
EFFLUENTS (1,000 MT/Yr)

  1971 Controls:
     TSS
     BODS
  1977
 901.44
 88O.17
                                                                        83,675.
                                                                       186,760.
                 1983
                                                                      1,276.82
                                                                      1,234.30
 88,032.
202,140.
                                1985
1,378.35
1,329.73
  Legislated Controls:
     TSS
     BOD5
 571.34
 399.98
                                                                        282.10
                                                                        179.66
  173.70
  138.13
CONTROL COSTS (Million 197B $)

Phase I

Investment

  Existing Plants
     On-s1te Treatment
     Pretreatment

  New P1 ants

  Municipal Investment Recovery

  Totals
                        AGGREGATED  OVER
         1974-77



         182.72
           O.OO

          16.55

           1.32

         2OO.59
                                                                                   1978-83
         1976-85
                                                                          (BPT)     666.22 (BAT) 751.61
                                                                                      O.OO     O.OO

                                                                                    189.32   220.11

                                                                                      10.02     14.76

                                                                                    865.56    986.48

-------
                             Table 4-12-1.  (Continued)
                            Pulp, Paper, and Paperboard
                               Industry Data Summary
w
CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $) - (Continued)

Phase I (Continued)

Annual1zed Costs

Annaulized Capital1

0»M>
  On-site Treatment
  Pretreatment
  Totals

Municipal Charges

  Investment Recovery
  User Charges'
  Totals

Grand Totals
                                                           1977
                                                         26.2O
47.8S
 0.0
47.85
                                                          0.58
                                                          0.94
                                                          1 .51

                                                         75.56
             COST IN YEAR



                1983     1985    1976-85

              138.68   142.54   824,O3'
88.73   156.44   783.71
 O.O      O.O     O.O
88.73   156.44   783.71
                1 .86
                1 .62
                3.48
          1 .90
          1.66
          3.56
14.76
19.91
34.67
                                                                       23O.89   3O2.54    1,642.42
            1  Annual 1zed on-slte and pretreatment costs are computed on  the assumption of a  15 year useful  life
              at  10  percent  Interest with zero salvage value.

            1  The decade total of•annual1zed cost may not be  reTatable to-the decade total of  Investment because
              of  the timing  of investment expenditures over the decade.

            1  O&M costs  in any year are  relative to  Investment made in the year plus all prior year investments
              commencing in  1973.  Hence, O&M expenditure 1n  any year bears no particular relationship to the
              investment made 1n that year.

            *  User charges denote  the O&M component  of the municipal treatment charges.  The  investment com-
              ponent is denoted under  investment recovery.

            Note:    The Pulp and Paper (Phase I) industry includes unbleached kraft, NSSC, and paperboard from waste
                 products.

-------
                               Table 4-12-1. (Continued)
                              Pulp, Paper, and Paperboard
                                 Industry Data Summary
CO
I
00
CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

Phase II

Investment

  Existing Plants
     On-s1te Treatment
     Pretreatment

  New Plants

  Municipal Investment Recovery

  Totals



AnnualIzed Costs

Annual1zed Capital'

O&M'
  On-s1te Treatment
  Pretreatment
  Totals

Municipal Charges

  Investment Recovery
  User Charges'
  Totals
                                                                         AGGREGATED OVER
                                                          1974-77
                                                          847.12   (BPT)
                                                            O.OO
                                                                            1978-83
                                                                                       197S-85
2,473.44 (BAT) 2,846.42
    O.OO     O.OO
126.61
99.27
1.O73.OO


1977
128
1O9
0
1O9
44
74.
118
.02
.46
.0
.46
.07
.47
.54
993.
8OO,
4,267
COST
IN
1983
583,
208.
0.
208
149
143.
293
.77
.86
.0
.86
.75
.82
.57
03 1
81 1
.28 5
YEAR
,204,
,178.
,229

7O
,53
.64

1985
6O8.
453.
0.
483.
152.
151.
304.
26
43
0
43
S3
80
63
3
2
2
1
1
2


1976-85
,527.
,142
0.0
,142
,178
,685
.864
,68'
.67
.67
.53
.63
. 15
              Grand Totals
                                                           356.02
                                                          1,086.2O   1.366.33   8.534.5O

-------
                 Table 4-12-1. (Continued)
                Pulp. Paper, and Paperboard
                   Industry Data Summary



Phase II (Continued)

1  Annual1zed on-slte and pretreatment costs are computed on the assumption of a 15 year useful  life
  at 10 percent Interest with zero salvage value.

*  The decade total of annualized cost may not be relatable to the decade total of investment because
  of the timing of investment expenditures over the decade.

1  O&M costs in any year are relative to investment made in the year plus all  prior year Investments
  commencing 1n 1973.  Hence, O&M expenditure 1n any year bears no particular relationship to the
  investment"-made in that year.

*  User charges denote the O&M component of the municipal treatment charges.  The investment com-
  ponent 1s denoted under Investment recovery.


Note:   The Pulp and Paper (Phase II) Industry Includes bleached kraft,  sulfite processes, soda and groundwood
        processes, deInked processes, and non-Integrated processes.

-------
PLYWOOD, HARDBOARD, AND WOOD
PRESERVING INDUSTRY

Production  Characteristics  and  Capacities.  The  plywood,
hardboardy   and  wood  preserving  segment  of  the  timber
products  processing  industry  is  a  large   and   complex
conglomerate.    For   purposes   of  establishing  effluent
limitations guidelines, and standards of performance, it has
been  divided  into  eight  subcategories  as  follows:  (1)
barking,  (2)  veneer,  (3}  plywood,  (4)  hardboard  - dry
process,  (5) hardboard - wet process, (6)  wood  preserving,
(7)  wood  preserving  -  steam,  and  (8) wood preserving -
boultonizing.

There were 916  operating  plants  in  1973  comprising  the
plywood,  hardboard,  and  wood  preserving  segments of the
timber  industry.

Barking  includes the operations that remove  the  bark   from
logs,   either  through  mechanical  abrasion or by hydraulic
force.   Veneer includes  converting  barked  logs  or  heavy
timber  into thinner sections of wood, which may be later cut
and  conditioned   to  improve  its quality.  Plywood includes
operations of laminating layers of veneer  to   form  finished
plywood,  either   softwood  from  veneers  of  coniferous or
needle  bearing trees or hardwood from  deciduous  or  broad-
leaf  trees.   Hardboard  includes the operations leading to
the production of  panels from  chips, sawdust,  logs, or other
raw materials, using either the dry  (air)  or wet   (water)
matting  processes   for   forming  the   board  mat.    wood
processing  includes all pressure or  non-pressure  processes
employing water-borne  salts  (copper, chromium, or arsenic),
in which steaming  or vapor drying  is  not the  predominant
method   of  conditioning.   Wood  preserving-steam  includes
steam impingement  on   the  wood  being   conditioned.    Wood
preserving-boultonizing uses  a vacuum extraction of water as
the conditioning method.  Timber products  are  used primarily
for the building and construction industry, commercial uses,
and home and  decorative purposes.

Waste   Sources   and Pollutants. Wastewater sources are given
for the following  segments:

   •  Barking.  Hydraulic barking  contributes high  suspended
     solids  and  BOD, as does  drum barking.

   »  Plywood  and   veneer.   Log   conditioning, cleaning of
     veneer   dryers,  washing of  the   glue   lines and  glue
     tanks,  and  cooling water.
                            3-150

-------
  •  Hardboard.    Wastewater  discharge  is  low   for   dry
     processing   but can occur due to washing.  Sources from
     wet processing include: raw materials  handling,  fiber
     and mat formation, and processing.

  •  Wood preserving.  Oils, simple sugars,  cooling  water,
     steam condensate, boiler blowdown.

The  major pollutant parameters common to all subcategories
but not necessarily present in process water  from  all  the
categories  for  which effluent guidelines and standards are
presented, include the following: BOD5,  COD,  phenols,  oil
and  grease,  pH,  high temperature, dissolved solids, total
suspended solids, phosphorus, and ammonia,

wood preserving subcategories may also include the following
pollution contributors: copper, chromium, arsenic, zinc, and
flourides.  The above pollutants or pollutant parameters are
not  always  present  in  process   water    from   all   the
subcategories,  and their presence depends on the processing
methods,

Presently, 20 to 30 percent of the veneer and plywood plants
are  achieving  the   no  discharge   limitations.   About  25
percent  of  the  hardboard  manufacturers   and from 5 to 10
percent of the wood preserving plants  are also achieving the
no discharge limitations.

Control Technology and Costs.  Current   technology   includes
the  following:

   *  Barking.  Clarifiers.

   •  veneer.  Reduce   amount  of  wastewater by  reuse  and
     conservation.

   «  Plywood.  Minimal wastewater reduction  in water use.

   •  Hardboard-Dry.    Oil   and    water   separation,   waste
     retention ponds  or  spray  irrigation.

   *  Hardboard-wet.      Water      recycle,       filtration,
     sedimentation,  coagulation,  evaporation, and biological
     oxidation    such   as   lagoons,   aerated lagoons,   and
     activated sludge systems.

   «  wood   Preserving.    Storage or  discharge   to  sewers,
     evaporation     and    incineration,    flocculation   and
     sedimentation.

 BPT  includes  the  following:
                            3-151

-------
  •  Wood Preserving,  implementation of  good  housekeeping
     practices, and minimizing water use.

NSPS is the same as BPT for barking, and the same as BAT for
the remaining processes in the industry.

Annualized control costs are detailed in Table 4-13-1.
                             3-153

-------
                                            Table 4-13-1-
                                Plywood. Hardboard, and Wood Preserving
                                        Industry Data Summary
                     ACTIVITY LEVEL                         1977           1983           1985

                       Capac1ty:
                       Plywood & Veneer
                           (Million Sq. M/Day)               2.121.         2,595.       2,534.
                       Wood Preserving (Liter/Day)      3,811,109.     4,662.812.     4.552.324.
                       Hardwood (kkg/Day)                   5.125.         7.494.       7,316.
ui
>*>
  Annual Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-1985 = 3.22%


EFFLUENTS (1.OOO MT/Yr)               1977           1983

Note: Residual data not available at time of Report Issue.

  1971 Controls:

  Legislated Controls:
                                                                                          1985
                     CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

                     Investment

                       Existing Plants
                          On-s1te Treatment
                          Pretreatment

                       New Plants

                       Municipal Investment Recovery

                       Totals
                                            1974-77


                                              66.24  (BPT)
                                               O.OO

                                               5. 12

                                               0.0

                                              71.36
AGGREGATED OVER

   1978-83    1976-85


     16.43 (BAT)  44.26
      0.00     0.00

     26.46    26.63

      O.O     O.O

     42.89    70.89

-------
                             Table  4-13-1.  (Continued)
                      Plywood, Hardboard, and Wood  Preserving
                              Industry Data Summary
U>
CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $) - (Continued)

AnnualIzed Costs                               1977

Annuallzed Capital1                            9.38

O&M3
  On-s1te" Treatment                           22.93
  Pretreatment                                 0.0
  Totals                                      22.93

Municipal Charges

  Investment Recovery                          O.O
  User Charges'                                O.O
  Totals                                       O.O

Grand Totals                                  32.31
                                                                      COST  IN YEAR

                                                                          1983      1985

                                                                         15.O2     15.O4
                                                                         O.O
                                                                         0.0
                                                                         O.O

                                                                         47.36
 O.O
 O.O
 O.O
         1976-85

        122.81'
                                                                         32.34    38.76   302.33
                                                                         O.O      O.O     O.O
                                                                         32.34    38.76   302.33
O.O
O.O
O.O
53.80   425.14
            1  Annuallzed  on-s1te  and  pretreatment  costs  are  computed  on  the  assumption of a  15 year useful  life
              at  10  percent  Interest  with  zero  salvage value.

            1  The decade  total  of annual1zed  cost  may not  be relatable to  the  decade  total of  Investment because
              of  the timing  of  Investment  expenditures over  the decade.

            5  O&M costs  1n any  year are  relative to  Investment made  In the year plus  all prior year Investments
              commencing  In  1973.. Hence,  O&M expenditure  1n any year bears  no particular relationship  to  the
              Investment  made  1n  that year,

            *  User charges denote the O&M  component  of the municipal  treatment charges.  The  Investment com-
              ponent 1s denoted under investment recovery.
            Note:    The Plywood,  Hardboard  and  Wood  Preserving  Industry  Includes softwood and hardwood plywood and  veneer
                processing,  wet  and dry  hardboard,  and  preserving  processes.

-------
INORGANIC CHEMICALS INDUSTRY

Production  characteristics and Capacities.  The complex and
heterogeneous   inorganic   chemicals   industry    produces
thousands  of  chemicals.   Each of the chemicals covered by
the effluent guidelines  is  manufactured  by  one  or  more
processes,   most  of  which  are  covered  by  the  current
guidelines.  Because  the  various  products  and  processes
differ  considerably from one another, it is not possible to
describe them in detail.  Generally, they  can  be  said  to
involve  the chemical reaction of raw materials, followed by
the separation, collection, and purification of the product.
Table 4-14-1 identifies each of the  processes  covered  and
summarizes  briefly the raw materials used and the nature of
each process.
                          3-156

-------
 I
H*
Ol
Product (Use)
Aluminum chloride (catalyst In
petrochemical and plaatlci
industry)
Aluminum sttUate
(water purificatioa)
Calcium carbide (manufacture
of acetylene)
Calcium chloride (delclng and dust
control on roads, stabilizer In
pavement and cement)
Calcium oxide and calcium
hydroxide (lime) (many chemical
and Industrial uses)
Chlorine and sodium or potassium
hydroxide (chlor-aikall) (many
Industrial uses)
Hydrochloric add (many Industrial
and chemical uses, particularly
pickling of steel)
Processes Covered
by Phase t Effluent
Limitation* Guidelines
All
All
Uncovered furnaces only
Brine extraction
All
Mercury cell diaphragm
cell
Direct chlorine-
hydrogen reaction
Daw Materials
Gaseous chloride, molten
aluminum
Bauxite, coke, chlorine
Hydrated aluminum or bauxite
ore; hydrochloric aold
Bauxite ore or other aluminum
compound, concentrated aulfurie
acid
Limestone; coke, petroleum
coke or anthraclde
Salt brines or solvay process
waste liquor
Limestone
Sodium chloride or potassium
chloride brines
Chlorine, hydrogen
Description
Chloride Introduced below surface of
aluminum, product sublimes and is selected
by condensation. -Produces anhydrous
aluminum chloride.
Qround ore and «cld reacted In a digester.
Muds sod Insoluble* settled sad filtered oat.
Limestone and carbon reacted In a furnace. '
Brines oocentrated and purified! then <
evaporated to yield product which Is flaked '.
and calcined to yield a dry acid. '
Limestone nested in a kiln.
Brines purified, then electrolysed. Products
- collected at electrodes and purified.
Hydrogen and chlorine gases reacted la «
vertical burner. Acid Is cooled and absorbed
la water.
                                                                                                                                                                                0
                                                                                                                                                                                rf
                                                                                                                                                                                   3
                                                                                                                                                                                       0)
                                                                                                                                                                                       cr
c  H-
n  n

w  o

ft)  ft)
3  s
Oi  H-
    o
hfl  {u
                                                                                                                                                                               m
                                                                                                                                                                              -01
                                                                                                                                                                               m
                           Souroei  SPA Development Document.

-------
00
 I
Cn
00
Product (Una)
Sodium oarboaate (sod* ash) (glass
ami Bon-ferrous metal*, otter
products)
Sodium chloride (table ult)


Sodium dtcbromate (manufacturing of
pigments, otbar industrial uses,
corrosion Inhibition)
Sodium metal (manufacture of
tetraethyl toad and other productai
nuclear coolant)
ffrufhnu silicate (manufacture of
olllcatel)
jtorffrqr* Sttifite (Mfta<*hlftgi food
preservative; boiler feed water
additive)
Processes Covered
by Phase I Effluent
Limitations Guidelines
Sotvay process
Solar evaporation
Solution brlnemlalng
AU
Downs cell prooeaa
AU

and soda ash
Raw Materials
Ammonia} salt brine; carboQ
dioxide
Salt water
Water; salt deposits
Chrome ore: sodium carbonate;
lime; sulfurta acid
Sodium chloride; alkali fluorides)
calcium chloride
Caustic soda; silica
Sulfur dioxide gas; sodium
carbonate (soda ash)
Description
Sodium bicarbonate produced from reacting
the raw materials In an aqueous solution.
This la then converted to soda ash by heating.
Salt water concentrated by evaporation to open
ponds. The brine Is then crystallized wherein
sodium chlorine precipitates.
Water pumped Into an underground salt deposit.
Brine pumped out and purified. Product
crystallized out.
Raw materials calcinated, then leached.
Soluble chromates converted to dlchromatea
with sulfurio sold. Dlchromatea crystallised
out.
Mixture melted and electrolysed. Sodium
collected at cathode.
Caustic soda and silica sand mixed, Uten
charged In a furnace. Water and steam added
to dissolve the silicate. Silicate evaporated.
Oas passed into a soda ash solution. Solution
heated. Sulfate Is purified, filtered.
crystallized.
3
o»
e      H

n-      cr
n  M  M

^g  «


g  9>  i—'

C  H-  I
n  n  t-

a>  o
    3-  ^.
jy  <^  O
3  a  o
ft H-  3
    o  n-
 ^  &  H*1
        3
                                                                                                                                                                                O
                                                                                                                                                                                o
                                                                                                                                                                                0
                                                                                                                                                                                (0
                                                                                                                                                                                0)
                                                                                                                                                                                       (D
                                                                                                                                                                                       o.
                             Souroei EPA Davelopmeat Docmnent.

-------
 I
M

VO
Product (Use)
Hydrofluoric add (production at
floorlnated organics end
p!ttsUes>«to.)
Hydrogen peroxide (btephlng tgant)
HUrto add flortilitctu, explosives)
Potassium matml (used io organo-
potassium compounda and in
sodiui&->pot&a8Uun BUuxufacbirB)
Potassium dtchromttte ({dags
pigment and photographic
development)
Potassium outfate (agriculture)

;w!da rartety a! uses «m»ini
-------
U>
 I

Product (Use)

Sulfurlo acid (fertilizer, petroleum
refining, explosive*, other*)



Titanium dioxide (white pigment to
paint, ink, aod1 other produ.-t»)





Proceeaea Covered
by Phase I Effluent
Limitation. Guidelines
Contact proceaa {single
and double absorption)



Chloride prooes*

Bulfate proceaj




Raw Material*

Sulfur




Titanium dioxide oreaj
ohlorloo; ooka

Titanium dioxide oreaj
aulfurio aold



De»oriptlOd

Sulfur burned to yield lulfur dioxide, mixed
with air, hatted, and then Introduced Into «
catalytic converter to produce luUur trlodde.
This gas to then cooled «nd absorbed la «
•utfurlc acid loiutloa.
ChlortiuUon of ore« produces tltoalum
tetraohlorlde, which la then oxidlcad to form
tho product^
Ores dissolved In aulfurlo told «t Ugh
temperatures to produce titanium aulfate
which it hydrolyxed to form a hydrate. TU«
U then oalolned to form the product.
 o.
 C      t-3
 m      o
 rr     CT
 1  H  M
K:  3  ID
    o


a    SO  M
    3  rf*
 c  H-  i
 n  n  (-•
 rr     .
 »  o

 &*  fD  O
 3  3  O
 a H-  3
O
O

a
CD

n
                                                                                                                                                                                        3
                                                                                                                                                                                        c
                         Sourcei EPA Development Document.

-------
Production capacity of some of the chemicals is concentrated
in the hands of a few producers,- in the  case  of  potassium
dichromate,  there  is  only  one.   The  market  for  other
products is much more competitive; for  example,  there  are
over  100  producers  of  lime.  The total production of the
inorganic  chemicals  covered  by  the  Phase   I   effluent
limitations  guidelines  was about 139 million tons in 1971.
Of this total  production,  about  48  million  tons  or  34
percent  actually come within the control of the guidelines.
The remaining 66 percent is comprised of chemicals which are
either produced by processes not covered by  the  guidelines
or  are  produced  in  plants  that  are classified as other
industries, such as pulp mills and steel mills.

Waste Sources and Pollutants.  Water is  used  in  inorganic
chemical manufacturing plants for three principal purposes:

  •  Cooling.  Non-contact cooling water.

  •  Process.  Cdntact cooling  or  heating  water,  contact
     wash  water,  transport  water,  product  and  dilution
     water.

  •  Auxiliary water.

The  effluent  limitations  guidelines  apply   to   process
wastewater  pollutants only.  This includes those wastewater
constituents in water which directly  contact  the  product,
byproduct,  intermediate,  raw  material,  or waste product.
Examples are waters used for barometric condensers,  contact
steam  drying,  steam  distillation,  washing  of  products,
intermediates or raw materials;  transporting  reactants  or
products  in  solution, suspension or slurry form; and water
which becomes an integral part of the product or is used  to
form a more dilute product.

The  following basic pollutant parameters are covered in the
effluent limitations guidelines for the inorganic  chemicals
industry:  total  suspended solids (TSS), cyanide, chromium,
chemical oxygen demand (COD),  iron,  lead,  mercury,  total
organic carbon (TOO, and pH.

Control  Technology  and  Costs.  The manufacture of some of
the inorganic chemicals covered by the effluent  limitations
guidelines  produces  no waterborne wastes.  In these cases,
the only  control  technology  required  is  the  isolation,
handling,  and  often reuse of water from leaks, spills, and
washdowns.  The most common wastewater  treatment  practices
in  the  remainder  of  the industry are neutralization, the
settling  of  suspended  solids  in  ponds,   storage,   and
discharge  of  the  neutralized  and  clarified  effluent to
                           3-161

-------
surface  waters.    Deep-well   disposal    is    also    used,
particularly   for sodium chloride brine-mining waters.  When
more control is necessary because of the presence of harmful
wastes, more advanced technology, such as  ion  exchange  and
chemical  reduction  and  precipitation,   is  employed.  In-
process   control   measures   commonly    employed   include
monitoring  techniques, safety practices,  good housekeeping,
containment provisions, and segregation practices.

Table 4-14-2 summarizes the  control  techniques  associated
with  BAT and BPT guidelines.  BPT assumes  the normal use of
practiced  in-process  controls,  such  as   recycling   and
alternative  use  of  water,  and  recovery  and/or reuse of
wastewater constituents.  BAT assumes the highest degree  of
in-process  controls that are available and are economically
achieveable.

New source performance standards (NSPS) are the same as  BPT
for  all  chemicals  except chlorine (chlor-alkalis), sodium
dichromate,  and  titanium  dioxide.   For  chlorine,  metal
anodes  may  be used to eliminate lead discharges.  For both
chlorine  and  sodium  dichromate,   NSPS  guidelines  assume
decreased   water   discharges  based  upon  improved  water
processing designs in new plants.   NSPS for titanium dioxide
are the same as BAT.
                           3-162

-------
                       Table 4-14-2.
                    Inorganic Chemicals
          Industry Summary of Control Technologies
Chemical
Aluminum chloride
  (anhydrous)
Aluminum sulfate

Calcium carbide

Hydrochloric acid
  chlorine burning


Hydrofluoric acid


Sodium bicarbonate
Sodium chloride
  (solar process)

Sodium si 1icate
Best Practicable Technology (BPT)

No water scrubbers for white or
   grey aluminum chloride production.
For yellow aluminum chloride
   production, gas scrubbing and sale
   of scrubber wastes as aluminum
   chloride solution, or
Gas scrubbing followed by chemical
   treatment to precipitate aluminum
   hydroxide and recycle

Settling pond and reuse

Dry dust collection system

Acid containment and isolation with
   centralized collection acid
   wastes and reuse

Acid containment and isolation,
   and reuse

Evaporation and product recovery,
   or
Recycle to process

Good housekeeping to prevent
   contamination of waste salts

Storage of wastes in an evaporation
   pond, or
Ponding and clarification
Best Available Technology (BAT)

Same as BPT
Same as BPT

Same as BPT

Same as BPT



Same as BPT


Same as BPT



Same as BPT
                                                                 Ponding or clarification and
                                                                    recycle of treated wastewater

-------
                 Table 4-14-2. (Continued)
                    Inorganic Chemicals
          Industry Summary of Control Technologies
Chemical
Sulfuric acid
  (sulfur burning
  contact process)

Lime
Nitric acid


Potassium (metal)

Potassium dichromate



Potassium sulfate
Calcium chloride
  (brine extraction)
Hydrogen peroxide
  (organic)
Sodium (metal)
Best Practicable Technology (BPT)
Acid containment and isolation with
   recycle to process or sell as
   weak acid

Dry Bag Collection Systems,
   or
Treatment of scrubber water by
   ponding and clarification and
   recycle

Acid containment and isolation
   and reuse

No process water used in manufacture

Replacement of barometric condensers
   with non-contact heat exchangers:
   recycle of process liquor

Evaporation of brine waters with
   recovery of magnesium chlorine,
   or
Reuse of brine solution in process
   in place of process water

Settling pond or clarification
Isolation and containment of
   process wastes; oil separation
   and clarification

Salting pond,
   and
Partial recycle of brine waste
   solution after treatment
Best Available Technology (BAT)
Same as BPT
Same as BPT





Same as BPT


Same as BPT

Same as BPT



Same as BPT
Same as BPT plus replacement of
   barometric condensers with
   non-contact heat exchangers
   and additional recycle

Chemical decomposition for
   peroxide removal and carbon
   adsorption for organic removal

10O% brine recycle and reuse or
   sale of spent sulfuric acid

-------
u>
I
01
                                 Table 4-14-2. (Continued)
                                    Inorganic Chemicals
                          Industry Summary of Control  Technologies
                Chemical
                Sodium chloride
                  (solution mining)
                Sodium sulfite
                Soda ash
                  (sodium carbonate)
                  So Way Process

                Hydrogen peroxide
                  (electrolytic)
                Sodium dlchromate and
                  sodium sulfate
                Chlor-alkal1
                  (diaphragm eel 1)
Best Practicable Technology (BPT)
Containment and isolation of spills,
   packaging wastes, scrubbers, etc;
   partial recycle to brine cavity

A1r oxidation of sodium sulfite
   wastes to sodium sulfate—94%
   effective, and final filtration to
   remove suspended solids

Settling ponds
                                       Best Available Technology (BAT)
                                       Same as BPT plus replacement of
                                          barometric condensers with
                                          non-contact heat exchangers

                                       Same as BPT plus recovery of
                                          waste sodium sulfate
                                       Settling ponds and clarification
                                       Same as BPT plus segregation of
                                          wastewater from cool ing water
                                          and evaporation of the waste
                                          stream and recycle of the
                                          distil late
Ion exchange to convert sodium
   ferrocyanide to ammonium
   ferrocyanide which 1s then reacted
   with hypochlorlte solution to
   oxidize It to cyanate solutions,
   and
Settling pond or filtration to remove
   catalyst and suspended solids

Isolation and containment of spills.    Same as BPT plus evaporation of
   leaks, and runoff, and
Batchwise treatment to reduce
   hexavalent chromium to trivalent
   chromium with NaHS, plus precipi-
   tation with lime or caustic;  and
Settling pond with controlled discharge

Asbestos and cell rebuild wastes are   .Same as BPT plus:
   filtered or settled in ponds  then
   land dumped, and
Chlorinated organic wastes are Incin-
   erated or land dumped, and

Purification muds from brine purifi-
   cation are turned to salt cavity or
   sent to evaporation pond/sett11ng
   ponds, and
Weak caustic-brine solution from the
   caustic filters Is partially  recycled
                                          the settling pond effluent with
                                          recycling of water and land
                                          disposal  or recovery of solid
                                          waste
                                          Reuse or sell  waste sulfurlc add
                                          Catalytic treatment of  the
                                             hypochlorite waste and reuse
                                             or recovery
                                          Recyc1e of all  weak br1ne
                                             solutions
                                          Conversion to  stable anodes

-------
                                  Table 4-14-2. (Continued)
                                     Inorganic Chemicals
                           Industry Summary of Control Technologies
                 Chemical
                 Chlor-alkal1
                   (mercury eel 1)
u>
I
                 Chlor-alkal1
                   (mercury eel 1)
                   (continued)
                 Titanium dioxide
                   (chloride process)
                 Titanium  dioxide
                   (sulfate  process)
Best Practicable Technology (BPT)
Cell rebuilding wastes are filtered
   or placed  in settling pond, then
   used for landfill, and
Chlorindated  organic wastes are
   incinerated or placed in containers
   and land dumped, and
Purification  muds from brine purifi-
   cation are returned to brine cavity
   or sent to evaporation/settling
   ponds, and
Partial recycle of brine waste streams,
   and

Recovery and  reuse of mercury effluent
   by curbing, insulation and
   collection of mercury containing
   streams, then treatment with sodium
   sulf1de

Neutralization with lime of caustic,
   and
Removal of suspended solids with
   settling ponds or clarifier-
   thickener,  and
Recovery of byproducts

Neutralization with lime or caustic,
   and
Removal of suspended solids with
   settling ponds or clarlfiei—
   th1ckener,  and
Recovery of byproducts
Best Available Technology (BAT)
Same as BPT plus:
   Reuse or recovery of waste
      suifuric acid
   Catalytic treatment of the
      hypochlorite waste and
      reuse or recovery
   Recycle of all weak brine
      solutions
Same as BPT plus additional
   clarification and polishing
Same as BPT plus additional
   clarification and polishing
                Source:  EPA Development  Document

-------
The most recent  analysis  of  costs  for  this  sector  was
provided  to  the  Agency  by Arthur E>. Little, Inc. (ADD*.
This analysis was conducted in somewhat greater depth  than,
and   subsequent  to  the  general  data  gathering  efforts
associated with the SEAS uniform cost calculation procedure,
and is considered to be more  precise.   However,  time  and
resource  constraints  prevented  incorporating  these costs
into the scenario analyses using the SEAS  model  procedure.
The  estimates  are  as  follows, for comparable portions of
industry (in million 1975 dollars):

                                  ADL       SEAS

  Incremental BPT Investment    $210.6      180.3

SEAS and ADL give investment figures  for only  11  chemicals
in common.  There is a substantial difference  in segments of
the  industry covered by the two studies.  The split between
BPT and BAT  costs  for  treatment  of  chemical  production
varies  considerably  for  these  chemicals  associated with
these costs is extremely close in  most  instances.   As  an
example, titanium dioxide  (sulfate process) was investigated
by both studies with associated investment costs forecast as
follows (in millions 1975  dollars):

                       BPT        BAT

  ADL                  14.0        2.1
  SEAS                 15.6        0.4

For Phase II chemicals,  there  is  not  any  consistency   for
model plant costs of the two studies.
 » ."Economic Analysis  of  Proposed Effluent  Guidelines  -
   Inorganic Chemicals, Alkaline and  Chlorine  Industries
   (Major  Products)",  Arthur D. Little,  Inc.,  August,  1973.
   "Economic Analysis  of  Proposed Effluent  Guidelines
   for  the Inorganic Chemicals  industries,  Phase  II",
   Arthur  D. Little, inc.,  Sept., 1974.
                            3-167

-------
                                              Table 4-14-3.
                                           Inorganic Chemicals
                                          Industry Data Summary
w
00
                       ACTIVITY LEVEL

                         Capac 1 ty:
                         Phase I (kkg/Day)
                         Phase II (kkg/Day)
                                                             1977
                                    235.O1O.
                                        623,
                         Annual Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-1985:
                            Phase I  =  5.26%
                            Phase II »  6.65%
EFFLUENTS (1.OOO MT/Yr)

  1971 Controls:
     TSS
     BOOS
     COD
     Dissolved Sol Ids
     Adds

  Legislated Controls:
     TSS
     BOD5
     COD
     Dissolved Sol Ids
     Acids

CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

Phase I

Investment

  Existing Plants
     On-site Treatment
     Pretreatment

  New Plants

  Municipal  Investment Recovery

Totals
                                                             1977
                                                                            1983
  325.950.
      93O.
                                                                            1983
                                                                                           1985
   35O.2OO
     1,013
                                                                                           1985
1O6
43
165
5, 1O3
293
32
15
91
4,419
75
.81
.01
.07
. 18
.06
.74
.48
.76
.02
.57
110
60
230
5,232
325
4
5
53
1,292

.36
.67
.43
.25
.76
.78
.39
.86
.80
.01
1O5.O4
65.49
248. 16
4,965.65
324.07
3.O3
4.44
4O.32
383. O7
0
                                                                                  AGGREGATED OVER
                                                                   1974-77
                                                                                     1978-83
                        1976-85
                                                                    201
                                                                      O.

                                                                     21

                                                                      O

                                                                    223
64  (BPT)
00

98

O

62
198.O9 (BAT) 282.88
  O.OO     O.OO

115.48   143.25

  O.O     O.O

313.57   426.14

-------
                               Table 4-14-3.  (Continued)
                                  Inorganic Chemicals
                                 Industry Data Summary
to
I
vo
CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $) - (Continued)

Phase I (Continued)

Annuallzed Costs

Annualized Capital1

O&M'
  On-slte Treatment
  Pretreatment
  Totals

Municipal Charges

  Investment Recovery
  User Charges*
  Totals

Grand Totals
                                                             1977

                                                            29.4O
                                                            92.72
                                                             0.0
                                                            92.72
  O.O
  O.O
  O.O

122.12
              COST IN YEAR



                 1983     1985    1976-85

                7O.63    73.27   499.86*
                99.84   12O.62   1.OO8.39
                 O.O      0.0     O.O
                99.84   12O.62   1.OO8.39
0.0
O.O
O.O
O.O
O.O
O.O
O.O
O.O
0.0
                                                                          17O.47    193.89 1.508.25
                Annuallzed on-s1te and pretreatment costs are computed on the assumption of  a 15  year  useful  life
                at  1O percent interest with zero salvage value.

                The decade total  of annual 1zed cost may not  be relatable to the decade  total  of  Investment  because
                of  the timing of  Investment expenditures over the decade.

                O&M costs 1n any  year are relative to Investment  made 1h the year plus  all prior  year  Investments
                commencing 1n 1973.  Hence, O&M expenditure  1n any year bears no particular  relationship to the
                Investment made in that year.

                User charges denote the O&M component of the municipal  treatment charges.  The  Investment com-
                ponent 1s denoted under Investment recovery.
              Note:    The phase I  Inorganic chemicals industry Includes  aluminum sulfate,  calcium  chloride,  mercury  eel 1-
                      chlor alkali,  mercury eel 1-diaphragm,  hydrochloric acid,  hydrogen peroxide,  nitric  add,  potassium
                      dichromate,  potassium sulfate,  sodium  carbonate, sodium chloride,  sodium dichromate,  sodium  metal,
                      sodium silicate,  sodium sulfite,  sulfuric acid,  titanium  dioxide,  and  lime.

-------
                 Table 4-14-3.  (Continued)
                    Inorganic Chemicals
                   Industry Data Summary
I
H-

O
CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)


Phase II

Investment

  Existing Plants
     On-s1te Treatment
     Pretreatment

  New Plants

  Municipal Investment Recovery

  Totals
Annual1zed Costs

Annual1zed Capital'

O&M'
  On-s1te Treatment
  Pretreatment
  Totals

Municipal Charges

  Investment Recovery
  User Charges'
  Totals
                                                                             AGGREGATED OVER
                                                               1974-77
                                                                                 1978-83
                                                                                           1976-85
4.71
O.OO
1.58
0.0
6.30

1977
0.83
O.37
O.O
0.37
O.O
0.0
O.O
(BPT) 11.
O.
7.
0.
19.
COST IN
1983
3.39
0.74
O.O
0.74
O.O
0.0
0.0
58 (BAT) 13.91
00 0.00
87 10.15
0 O.O
45 24.06
YEAR
1985 1976-85
3.57 21.56'
1.58 7.37
O.O O.O
1.58 7.37
0.0 O.O
O.O 0.0
O.O 0.0
Grand Totals
                                                                  1.20
                                                               4. 13
5.16
                                                                                28.93

-------
                 Table 4-14-3. (Continued)
                    Inorgan1c Chera1ca1s
                   Industry Data Summary

Phase II (Continued)



'  Annual1zed on-slte and pretreatment costs are computed on the assumption of a 15 year useful  life
  at 1O percent interest with zero salvage value.

!  The decade total of annualized cost may not be relatable to the decade total of Investment because
  of the timing of Investment expenditures over the decade.

3  O&M costs in any year are relative to investment made in the year plus all prior year investments
  commencing 1n 1973.  Hence. 08>M expenditure in any year bears no particular relationship to the
  investment made in that year.

•  User charges denote the O&M component of the municipal treatment charges.  The investment com-
  ponent is denoted under investment recovery.


Note:   The Phase II Inorganic Chemicals industry includes calcium carbonate, chrome pigments and
        iron blues, and potassium permanganate.

-------
FERTILIZER CHEMICALS INDUSTRY

Production  Characteristics  and Capacities.  The  fertilizer
industry  can  be  divided  into  phosphate   and   nitrogen
fertilizer  production  areas,  containing  a  total  of  11
subcategoriee:

1. Phosphate Fertilizers
  •  Phosphate rock grinding
  •  Wet process phosphoric acid
  •  Phosphoric acid concentration
  *  Normal superphosphate (HSP)
  •  Triple superphosphate (ISP)
  •  Ammonium phosphates
  •  Sulfuric acid

2. Nitrogen Fertilizers
  •  Ammonia
  •  Urea
  *  Ammonium nitrate
  *  Nitric acid

These  subcategories  include  both  mixed   and   non-mixed
fertilizers.

The  manufacture  of these fertilizers involves a variety of
chemical processes.  Three of the processes - phosphate rocX
grinding, phosphoric acid concentration, and phosphoric acid
clarification  -  do  not  require  process   waters.     The
remaining processes are summarized in Table 4-15-1.
                           3-172

-------
                       Table 4-15-1.
      Basic Fertilizer Chemicals Manufacturing Process
Product
Raw Material
Process
Wet process
Phosphoric acid

Normal super-
phosphate

Triple super-
phosphate
Phosphate rock,
sulfuric acid, water.

Sulfuric acid, ground
phosphate rock, water.

Ground phosphate rock,
phosphoric acid, water.
Mixing.
Mixing, curing
for 3-8 weeks.

Run of pile
process=mixing
curing.
Ammonium
phosphates

Sulfuric acid
Ammonia
Ammonia, wet process,
phosphoric acid.

s°2, 02, pellitized
vanadium oxide cata-
lyst, water.
Natural gas or other
hydrogen source, air,
activated carbon,
catalysts.
   or

Granular triple
superphosphate
process (GTSP)=
mixing into a slurry,
drying.

Similar to GTSP
above.

Acid buring process
S02 % O2 catalyzed
to form S03, water
addled to form final
product.

Hydrogen production
followed by cataly-
sis with air to form
ammonia.
                           3-173

-------
                 Table 4-15-1. (Continued)
      Basic Fertilizer chemicals Manufacturing Process
Product

Urea
Raw Material

Ammonia, sulfur
dioxide.
Process

Ammonium carbonate
formed then dehy-
drated by prilling
or crystallization
to form urea.
Ammonium nitrate    Ammonia, nitric acid.
Nitric acid
Ammonia, air, water,
platinum-rhodium
gauze catalyst.
Combined in a
neutralized acid,
then prilled or
neutralized to con-
centrate the product.

Ammonia and air oxi-
dized, absorbed in
water, then cata-
lyzed.
Sulfuric  acid  and nitric acid are intermediate products in
the basic fertilizer chemicals industry.   Approximately  25
percent of the plants produce these chemicals as part of the
production  of the final products listed above; they are not
considered as separate  plants  for  the  purposes  of  this
report.   Plants  which produce sulfuric acid or nitric acid
as end products are covered under  the  inorganic  chemicals
industry.

In  terms of retail value, exports amounted to approximately
12.5 percent of domestic production, and imports 7  percent.
By  weight, exports totaled a considerably higher proportion
of production, approximately 45 percent (171 million  metric
tons).   Of  this,  phosphate  rock  comprised  the  largest
portion, 13.6 million metric tons.  With  the  exception  of
ammonium  nitrates,  the  United States is a net exporter of
all the fertilizers covered in this study.

Because fertilizers are traded in a world-wide  market,  and
the  raw  materials  used are also used in a wide variety of
markets, the fertilizer market is subject  to  many  outside
influences.     These    influences    include    world-wide
agricultural demand, the use of nitrates in explosives,  and
hence  pressures  from the international military situation,
and the world market for synthetic fibers.
                           3-174

-------
In  1972,  the  fertilizer  industry  was   suffering   from
overcapacity  with  no  new plants being built.  However, in
1973,  world   demand   increased   so   dramatically   that
substantial shortages were created in the industry.

Projections published by the National Fertilizer Development
Center  of  the Tennessee valley Authority indicate that the
shortages  in  supply  of  phosphate   materials   will   be
alleviated as significant surpluses develop by 1976 or 1977.
The nitrogen shortage is expected to continue longer, with a
balanced market developing in the late 1970's.

Waste  Sources  and  Pollutants.  The major fertilizer waste
components   include   the   following:   pH,   phosphorous,
fluorides,  total  suspended  solids  
-------
  •  Boiler blowdown.

  «  Process condensate„

  «  Spills  and  leaks  that  are  collected  in  pits   or
     trenches.

  «  Nonpoint sources collected- from rain or snow.

in order to  define  waste  characteristics,  the  following
basic parameters were used to develop guidelines for meeting
BPT  and BAT: phosphate Fertilizers: phosphorous, fluorides,
total  suspended  solids  and  pH.   Hitrogen   Fertilizers:
ammonia, organic nitrogen, nitrate, and pH.

Control  Technology and Costs.  Waste treatment practices in
the fertilizer industry include:  monitoring units, retaining
areas,  cutoff  impoundments,  reuse.,  recycle,  atmospheric
evaporative    cooling,    double-lining,   two-stage   lime
neutralization, surrounding  diKes  and  seepage  collection
ditches,   sulfuric   acid,   dilution   with   pond  water,
evaporation,  ammonia  stripping  (steam  and   air),   high
pressure air/steam stripping, urea hydrolysis, nitrification
and  denitrification,  ion exchange, cation/aniou separation
unit,  selective  ion  exchange  for  ammonia  removal,  oil
separation and ammonium nitrate condensate reuse.

BPT   guidelines   for   the   phosphate  segment  call  for
limitations  on  pH,  TSS,  phosphates,  and   florides   by
installing  the  following:  double-lime treatment of gypsum
pond  water,  pond  design  to  contain  a  10-year   storm,
monitoring  system  for  sulfuric  acid  plant  control, and
facilities for contaminated water isolation.  BPT guidelines
for the nitrogen  segment  can  be  met  by  installing  the
following.-  ammonia  steam  stripping, urea hydrolysis, leak
and  spill  control,  containment  and   reuse,   plus   oil
separation.

BAT  guidelines  call for increased limitations of the above
parameters  by  installation  of  pond  water  dilution   of
sulfuric acid for the phosphate segment, and by installation
of  one  of  the following for the nitrogen segment: ammonia
steam stripping followed by  either  high-flow  ammonia  air
stripping   or   biological   nitrification-denitrification,
continuous ion  exchange  followed  by  denitrification,  or
advanced  urea  hydrolysis, followed by high-flow ammonia air
stripping.

NSPS standards call  for the following  process  improvements
for  the  nitrogen segment (phosphate segment is the same as
BAT):
                           3-176

-------
  •   Integration  of  ammonia   process   condensate   steam
     stripping  column  into  condensate  boiler  feed water
     systems of ammonia plant.

  •   Use   of   centrifugal   rather   than    reciprocating
     compressors.

  •   Segregation of contaminated water collection systems so
     that  common  waste  streams  can   be   treated   more
     efficiently and cheaply.

  •   Locate cooling towers  upwind  to  minimize  chance  of
     absorbing ammonia in tower water.

  •   Design low velocity airflow prill tower  for  urea  and
     ammonium nitrate to minimise dust loss.

  •   Design lower pressure steam levels  in  order  to  make
     process condensate and recovery easier and cheaper.

  •   Install  air-cooled  condensers   and   exchangers   to
     minimize cooling water circulation and blowdown.

A  recent analysis of costs for this sector was conducted by
Gianessi  and  Peskin  (G&P)1.   This  study  was  conducted
independently  and  subsequent to the general data gathering
efforts associated with the SEAS  uniform  cost  calculation
procedure.  However, time and resource constraints prevented
incorporating  these  costs into the scenario analyses using
the SEAS model procedure.  The G&P estimates are as  follows
(in million 1975 dollars):

  Incremental BPT Investment    $110.7
  incremental BPT O&M           $ 54.9

Estimates from the earlier SEAS  calculation  are  presented
below,  with  projected pollutant discharges associated with
these costs.  The principal reason for  differences  between
these  cost  estimates and the newer data are increased unit
cost estimates for BPT in ammonia and  phosphate  fertilizer
plants in the G&P analysis.
  Gianessi, L. P. and H. M. Peskin, "The Cost to Industries
  of the water Pollution Control Amendment of 1972",
  National Bureau of Economic Research, December, 1975.
  (Revised January, 1976)
                           3-177

-------
I
(-•

00
ACTIVITY LEVEL
                       Table 4-15-2.
                 Basic Fertilizer Chemicals
                   Industry Data Summary
                                       1977
                                                                        1983
  Capacity (MT/Yr)                    54.69O.       73,600.

  Annual Growth Rate Over the Period  1976-1985 = 5.O4%



EFFLUENTS (1.0OO MT/Yr)               1977           1983

Note: Residual data not available at  time of Report Issue,

  1971 Controls:
 1985


82.O6O.





 1985
  Legislated Controls:
CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

Investment

  Existing Plants
     On-s1te Treatment
     Pretreatment

  New Plants

  Municipal Investment Recovery

  Totals
                                                                              AGGREGATED OVER

                                                               1974-77           1978-83    1976-85


                                                                9O.16   (BPT)     1O8.10 (BAT) 148.91
                                                                 O.OO               O.OO     O.OO

                                                                22.28              64.93    93.89

                                                                 O.O                O.O     O.O

                                                               112.44             173.O2   242.SO

-------
                               Table 4-15-2.  (Continued)
                               Basic Fertilizer Chemicals
                                 Industry Data Summary
W
I
CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $) - (Continued)

Annual1zed Costs                                1977

Annual1zed Capital1                           14.78

O&M'
  On-s1te Treatment                            3.98
  Pretreatment                                 0.0
  Totals                                       3.98

Municipal Charges

  Investment Recovery                          O-O
  User Charges'                                0.0
  Totals                                       0.0

Grand Totals                                  18.77
                                                                         COST IN YEAR

                                                                            1983     1985    1976-85

                                                                           37.53    39.85   257.84'
                                                                            3.79    33.0O   114.O3
                                                                            O.O      O.O     0.0
                                                                            9.79    33.OO   114.03
 O.O
 O.O
 0.0

47.32
 0.0
 0.0
 O.O

72.85
 0.0
 0.0
 O.O

371.87
              1  Annualized  on-s1te  and pretreatment  costs are computed on  the assumption of a  15 year useful  life
                at  1O percent  Interest with  zero  salvage value.

              1  The decade  total of annualized cost  may not be relatable to  the decade total of Investment because
                of  the timing  of  Investment  expenditures over the decade.

              3  O&M costs  in any year are  relative to  Investment made in the year plus all prior year investments
                commencing  in  1973.  Hence,  O&M expenditure 1n any year bears no particular relationship to the
                Investment  made in  that year.

              '  User charges denote the O&M  component of the municipal treatment charges.   The investment com-
                ponent  is denoted under investment recovery.
             Note:
        The Fertilizers industry Includes production  of  ammonia, ammonium nitrates urea, and phosphate
        fert11izers.

-------
ORGANIC CHEMICALS INDUSTRY

Production Characteristics and Capacities. Approximately 450
companies  operating  over 650 establishments are engaged in
producing  organic  chemicals,-  however,  the  four  largest
producers  account  for  a  minimum  of  36 percent, and the
hundred largest for  more  than  92  percent  of  the  total
shipments.   Much  of the industry's production is accounted
for not only by the large chemical companies,  but  also  by
the  major  petroleum  refineries.   At the other end of the
spectrum are many small companies  operating  small  plants.
There  are  about  27  plants employing more than 1,000, and
about 220 plants with less than 10 employees.

The organic chemicals industry includes  a  vast  number  of
products and processes.  The effluent limitations guidelines
for  Phases  I and II of the industry cover only part of the
organic   chemicals   industry.     primary    petrochemical
processing,    (i.e.,   chemicals   produced   at   petroleum
refineries},   plastics,  fibers,   agricultural   chemicals,
pesticides,  detergents, paints, and Pharmaceuticals are not
included.
Synthetic  organic  chemicals  are  derivative  products  of
naturally  occurring  raw materials (petroleum, natural gas,
and  coal}  which  have  undergone  at  least  one  chemical
conversion.   The  organic  chemicals industry was initially
dependent upon coal as its sole  source  of  raw  materials.
However, during the last two decades it has moved so rapidly
from  coal  to  petroleum-based  feedstocks  that  the  term
"petrochemicals" has come into common use.

The basic raw.materials are  usually  obtained  by  physical
separation  processes  in  petroleum  refineries.   The  raw
materials are then chemically-converted to a. primary  group
of  reactive precursors- these precursors are then used in a
multitude of specific chemical conversions to  produce  both
intermediate and final products.

Processing   of  organic  chemicals  usually  involves  four
stages:  feed  preparation  -  the  vaporization,   heating,
compressing,  and  chemical  or physical purification of raw
materials; reaction - the reaction  of  the  raw  materials,
usually  in the presence of a catalyst; product separation -
the condensation, distillation, absorption, etc., to  obtain
the  desired  product;  product purification - distillation,
extraction, crystallization,  etc.,  to  remove  impurities.
Processing  methods  may be carried out either in continuous
                           3-180

-------
operations or in individual batches.  Facilities  using  the
continuous  processing  method  manufacture products at much
greater volumes and at lower unit costs than those using the
batch methods.

The effluent limitations guidelines promulgated to  date  by
EPA  (for  Phase  I)  apply  only  to  those products of the
organics   chemicals   industry   produced   in   continuous
processing  operations.   These operations have been divided
into seven subcategories, based first  upon  the  degree  of
process  water  used,  and  second  upon the raw waste loads
generated; Table 4-16-1 lists the  seven  subcategories  and
the products and processes included.
                           3-181

-------
                       Table 4-16-1.
          organic Chemicals Manufacturing industry
               Products and Related Processes
Subcategory A

  Products

BTX Aromatics
BTX  Aromatics
Cyclohexane
Vinyl Chloride


Subcategory B


  Bl Products
Non Aqueous Processes

   process Descriptions

      Hydrotreatment of pyrolysis gasoline
      Solvent extraction from reformate
      Hydrogenation of benzene
      Addition of hydrochloric acid to
         acetylene

Process with Process Water Con-
      tact as Steam Diluent or Absorbent

Bl Process Descriptions
Acetone
Butadiene
Ethyl benzene
Ethylene and Propylene
Ethylene dichloride
Ethylene oxide
Formaldehyde
Methanol
Methyl amines
vinyl acetate
Vinyl chlorine

  B2 Products

Acetaldehyde
Acetylene
Butadiene
Butadiene
Styrene
      Dehydrogenation of isopropanol
      Co-product of ethylene
      Alkylation of benzene with ethylene
      Pyrolysis of naphtha or liquid
         petroleum gas
      Direct chlorination of ethylene
      Catalytic oxidation of ethylene
      Oxidation of methanol
      Steam reforming of natural gas
      Addition of ammonia to methane
      Synthesis of ethylene and acetic acid
      Cracking of ethylene dichloride
B2 Process Descriptions

      Dehydrogenation of ethanol
      Partial oxidation of methane
      Dehydrogenation of n-butane
      Oxidative-dehydrogenation of n-butane
      Dehydrogenation of ethylbenzene
                           3-182

-------
                 Table 4-16-1.  (Continued)
          Organic Chemicals Manufacturing  Industry
               Products and Related Processes
Subcategory C       Aqueous Liquid Phase Reaction
                          Systems

  Cl Products       Cl Process Descriptions

Acetic acid               Oxidation of acetaldehyde
Acrylic acid              Synthesis with carbon monoxide  and
                             acetylene
Coal tar                  Distillation of coal  tar
Ethylene glycol           Hydrogenation of ethylene oxide
Terephthalic acid         Catalytic oxidation of p-xylene
Terephtahalic acid        Purification of crude terephthalic
                             acid

  C2 Products       C2 Process Descriptions

Acetaldehyde              Oxidation of ethylene with  oxygen
Caprolactam               Oxidation of cyclohexane
Coal Tar                  Pitch forming
Oxo Chemicals             Carbonylation and condensation
Phenol and Acetone        Cumene oxidation and cleavage

  C3 Products       C2 Process Descriptions

Acetaldehyde              oxidation of ethylene with  air
Aniline                   Nitration and hydrogenation of benzene
Bisphenol  A               condensation of phenol  and  acetone
Dimethyl terephthalate    Esterification of terephthalic acid

  C4 Products       C4 Process Descriptions

Acrylatee                 Esterification of acrylic acid
p-cresol                  Sulfunation of toluene
Methyl methacrylate      Acetone  cyanohydrin  process
Terephthalic acid        Nitric  acid process
Tetraethyl lead           Addition of ethyl chloride to  lead
                              amalgum
 Source-.  EPA Development Document,  April  1973, pp. 28-29.
                            3-183

-------
Waste  Sources  and  Pollutants.   Water  is  used  in  many
production processes as a reaction vehicle, and  also  as  a
vehicle  to  separate  or  to  purify  the final products  by
scrubbing, steam stripping, or absorption.  In  addition,  a
considerable amount of water is used for heating (steam) and
cooling, and for washing reaction and storage vessels, etc.

The   effluent   limitations   guidelines  for  the  organic
chemicals industry cover  the  following  pollutants:  BOD5,
COD,   total   suspended   solids,  phenols,  and  pH.   The
limitation placed upon pH in all cases in  between  6.0  and
9.0.  it should be noted that process wastewaters subject  to
limitations include all process waters exclusive of auxilary
sources,  such  as  boiler and cooling water blowdown, water
treatment  back  wash,  laboratories,  and   other   similar
sources.

Control  Technology and Costs.  Technologies employed in the
organic chemicals industry for  the  control  of  wastewater
pollutants   include   in-process  modifications,  pollution
control equipment,  and  end-of-pipe  wastewater  treatment.
From  a  pollution-control  standpoint, the most significant
change that can be made in process chemistry is from a "wet"
process to a "dry" process/ that  is,  the  substitution   of
some  other  solvent  for  water  in  which to carry out the
reaction  or  to  purify  the  product.   Other   in-process
technologies   observed   or  recommended  for  the  organic
chemicals industry include the substitution of surface  heat
exchangers for contact cooling water, substitution of vacuum
pump  steam  Jet  ejectors,  recycle  of scrubber water, and
regeneration of  contact  process  steam  from  contaminated
condensate.

Biological treatment systems are the most common end-of-pipe
technologies  used  in the organic chemicals industry today.
These systems include activated sludge,  trickling  filters,
aerated  lagoons, and anaerobic lagoons.  Other systems used
include  stripping  towers,  deep-well  disposal,   physical
treatment,   activated   carbon,  and  incineration.   Where
phenols are present in wastewaters, they may be  removed   by
solvent     extraction,     carbon    absorption,    caustic
precipitation, or steam stripping; cyanide may be removed  by
oxidation.  Five of  34  plants  surveyed  discharged  their
effluent  to  a  municipal  treatment  system;  three had  no
current treatment systems.

In-process   controls   commensurate   with   BPT    include
segregation of waste streams, the substitution of nonaqueous
media  in  which to carry out the reactions or to purify the
products, recycling or  reuse  of  process  water,  and  the
recovery  of products and byproducts from the wastewaters  by
                           3-184

-------
solvent extraction, absorption,  or  distillation.   End-of-
pipe  treatment commensurate with BPT is based on the use of
biological  systems  as  mentioned  above.   These   systems
include    additional    treatment    operations   such   as
equalization, neutralization, primary clarification with oil
removal, nutrient addition, and  effluent  polishing  steps,
such  as coagulation, sedimentation, and filtration.  Phenol
removal is also required in some cases.

Technology commensurate with BAT includes  the  addition  of
activated  carbon  to  the BPT biological systems to achieve
substantial reductions of dissolved organic compounds.   In-
process controls applicable to BAT include:

  •  Substitution of non-contact heat exchangers  for  direct
     contact water cooling

  •  Use nonaqueous quench media

  •  Recycle process water

  •  Reuse process water as a make-up to evaporative cooling
     towers

  •  Use process water to  produce  low pressure  steam by  non-
     contact heat  exchange

  •  Recover spent acids or caustic  solution  for  reuse

  •  Recover and reuse spent  catalysts

  •  Use  nonaqueous  solvents  for  extraction products.

 End-of-pipe  technology  for NSPS   is   defined   as   biological
 treatment   with  suspended solids removal  via clarification,
 sedimentation,  sand,  or  dual-media filtration,   in addition,
 exemplary in-process controls,  as previously  enumerated, are
 also assumed to be applicable,  particularly   where  biotoxic
 pollutants must be controlled.
                            3-185

-------
A  recent analysis of costs for this sector was conducted by
Gianessi  and  Peskin  (G&P)1.   This  study  was  conducted
independently  and  subsequent to the general data gathering
efforts associated with the SEAS  uniform  cost  calculation
procedure.  However, time and resource constraints prevented
incorporating  these  costs into the scenario analyses using
the SEAS model procedure.  The G&P estimates are as  follows
(in million 1975 dollars):

                              Total    Phase I    Phase II

  incremental BPT investment  $941.2   684.0      257.3
  Incremental BPT O&M         $ 75.5    55.1       20.5

Estimates form the earlier SEAS  calculation  are  presented
below,  with  projected pollutant discharges associated with
these costs.   Principal  reasons  for  differences  between
these  cost  estimates  and  the  newer  data  are  industry
definition expansion, different  estimates  of  "capital-in-
place", different model plant sizes, and different hydraulic
load data.
  Gianessi, L. P. and H. M. Peskin, "The Cost to industries
  of the water Pollution Control Amendment of 1972",
  National Bureau of Economic Research, December, 1975.
  (Revised January, 1976)
                           3-186

-------
I
M
CO
                       Table 4-16-2.
                     Organic Chemicals
                   Industry Data Summary
ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                       1977
  Capacity:
  Phase I (1.0OO Liters/Day)      4,515,900.
  Phase II (kkg/Day)                 37,140.
  Annual Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-1985:
     Phase I  =  6.55%
     Phase II =  6.65%
EFFLUENTS (1.OOO MT/Yr)

  1971 Controls:
     TSS
     BOD5
     COD
     Dissolved Sol ids
     Oils and Greases
     Adds
     Bases
     Nutrients

  Legislated Controls-.
     TSS
     BOD5
     COD
     Dissolved Sol Ids
     Oils and Greases
     Acids
     Bases
     Nutrients

CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)
Phase I

Investment
                                                             1977
                                                      1983
                                                                        6,736,900.
                                                                           55,406.
                                                                            1983
                                                                     1985
            7.336.9OO.
              60,335
                                                                                           1985
48. 16
274.85
798.04
3,756,08
11. 05
0
18.46
25.78
65.22
37O.77
1,079.50
5,251 .61
14.79
0
25.81
36.37
68.77
393,49
1,143.76
5,616.55
15.68
0
27.44
66. 12
17.39
79.21
628.97
3.767.O3
1O.43
0
16.24
25.84
4.98
7.39
322 . 76
5.237.20
12.99
0
21.69
36.19
2.94
4.41
185.60
5,591.88
13.57
O
22 97
61.29
                                                                                  AGGREGATED OVER
                                            1974-77
                                                              1978-83
                                                                         1976-85
  Existing Plants
     On-site Treatment
     pretreatment

  New Plants

  Municipal Investment Recovery

  Totals
                                                                  995.55
                                                                    6.OO

                                                                  337.61

                                                                   26.83

                                                                 1.365.98
(BPT)    1,465.44  (BAT)  1,954.53
            O.OO      O.OO
        1,685.03

          229.06

        3,379.53
2, 175.05

336.46

4,466.03

-------
                           Table 4-16-2. (Continued)
                               Organic Chemicals
                             Industry Data Summary


          CONTRdL COSTS (Million 1975 $) - (Continued)               COST  IN  YEAR

          Phase I (Continued)

          AnnualIzed Costs                               1977           1983      1985     1976-85

          Annualized Capital'                          176.06         590.11    631.47    4.0O6.74'

          O&M1
U>           On-s1te Treatment                          682.18       1,063.43    1,364.76   9,586.90
,L           Pretreatment                                 2.66           4.13      4.49     35.71
00           Totals                                     684.84       1,067.56    1,369.25   9,622.60
00
          Municipal  Charges

            Investment Recovery                         12.11          42.97     43.88    336.46
            User Charges*                               21.14          42.36     44.65    493.4O
            Totals                                      33.25          85.33     88.52    829.86

          Grand Totals                                 894.15       1,742.99    2,089.24  14,459.20


          1  Annual 1 zed on-s1te and pretreatment costs are computed on the assumption of a 15 year useful life
            at 10 percent Interest with zero salvage valge.

          '  The decade total of annual1zed cost may not be relatable to the decade total of Investment because
            of the timing of Investment expenditures over the decade.

          5  O&M costs 1n any year are relative to Investment made In the year plus all prior year Investments
            commencing in 1973.  Hence, O&M expenditure 1n any year bears no particular relationship to the
            Investment made In that year.

          1  User charges denote the O&M component of the municipal treatment  charges.   The Investment com-
            ponent 1s denoted under Investment recovery.


          Note:   The Phase I Organic Chemicals Industry Includes subcategories A, B-1, B-2, C-1, C-2, C-3, and C-4
                  as defined 1n Table 4-16-1.

-------
                                   Table 4-16-2. (Continued)
                                       Organic Chemicals
                                     Industry Data Summary
CO
\o
CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

Phase II

Investment

  Existing Plants
     On-s1te Treatment
     Pretreatment

  New Plants

  Municipal Investment Recovery

  Totals



Annualized Costs

Annual 1zed Capital1

OSM3
  On-slte Treatment
  Pretreatment
  Totals

Municipal Charges

  Investment Recovery
  User Charges'
  Totals
                                                                             AGGREGATED OVER
1974-77


 71 . 12
 13.87

 33.35

 15.77

134.10



   1977

  15.55
                                                                24.45
                                                                 5.38
                                                                29.83
                                                                 7. 12
                                                                12.43
                                                                19.54
                                                                                1978-83
                             1976-85
                                                                       (BPT)     511.83 (BAT) SS3.58
                                                                                   O.OO     O.OO
                                                                                 167.16

                                                                                 134.64

                                                                                 813.63
  215.79

  197.76

  967.14
                                                                             COST IN YEAR

                                                                                1983     1985

                                                                              1O4.82   1O8.91
         1976-85

        595.64'
                 41.58   117.89   496.50
                  8.81     9.54    75.62
                 5O.39   127.43   572.12
                 25.26
                 24.90
                 5O. 16
25.79
26.24
52.03
197.76
290.02
487.78
                  Grand Totals
                                                                64.92
                                                            2O5.36   288.37   1,655.54

-------
                               Table 4-16-2.  (Continued)
                                   Organic Chemicals
                                  Industry Data Summary
w
I
               Phase  II  (Continued)
               1 Annual 1 zed on-slte and pretreatment costs are computed on the assumption of a 15 year useful life
                at  10  percent  Interest with zero salvage value.

               1 The decade total of annual Ized cost may not be relatable to the decade total of investment because
                of  the timing  of Investment expenditures over the decade.

               * O&M costs 1n any year are  relative to  investment made In the year plus all prior year Investments
                commencing 1n  1973.  Hence, O&M expenditure in any year bears no particular relationship to the
                Investment made in that year.

               * User charges denote the O&M component  of the municipal treatment charges.  The Investment com-
                ponent 1s denoted under InvestmenJ recovery.


               Note:    The Phase II Organic Chemicals industry includes subeategorles B-3, C-3, C-5, C-6 and D-4 as
                       defined  In Table 4-16-1.

-------
PHOSPHATE MANUFACTURING INDUSTRY

Production  Characteristics  and Capacities.  Establishments
included in the phosphate manufacturing industry as  defined
by  the effluent limitations guidelines are manufacturers of
the following chemicals:

     Phosphorus
     Fer rophosphorus
     Phosphoric acid  (dry process)
     Phosphorus pentoxide
     Phosphorus pentasulfide
     Phosphorus trichloride
     Phosphorus oxychloride
     Sodium tripolyphosphate
     Calcium phosphates (food grade)
     Calcium phosphates (animal feed grade).

This industry is almost entirely based on  the production  of
elemental  phosphorus   from mined phosphate rock.  Elemental
phosphorus   and    ferrophosphorus   (a    byproduct)    are
manufactured  by  the  reduction of phosphate rock  by coke in
very large  electric   furnaces,  using  silica  as a   flux.
Because  elemental  phosphorus  is  relatively  low in  weight
compared to phosphate   rock  and  to  phosphoric   acid,  the
elemental  phosphorus   is  produced near the mining site and
shipped to locations  near  the  final  markets  for  further
processing.

Over  87  percent   of   the  elemental  phosphorus  is used to
manufacture high-grade phosphoric acid by  the  furnace  or dry
process.  This process involves burning of liquid  phosphorus
in  air, the  subsequent  quenching  and  hydrolysis  of  the
phosphorus  pentoxide   vapor,  and  the  collection  of  the
phosphoric acid mists.

The manufacture  of   the  anhydrous  phosphorus   chemicals-
phosphorus pentoxide  ),
and phosphorus  trichloride   (PC13)  -  is  essentially the
direct  union of phosphorus with the  corresponding elesvonx:.
Phosphorus oxychloride (POC13_) is manufactured  from PC13 and
air or  from PC13_, P2O5^, and chlorine.

Sodium    tripolyphosphate     is    manufactured    in  the
neutralization of phosphoric acid with caustic  soda and soda
ash in  mix tanks.   The resulting  mixture  of   mono-and  di-
sodium  phosphates   is dried  and  the crystals calcined to
produce the tripolyphosphate.
                            3-191

-------
The  calcium  phosphates  are   similarity   made   by    the
neutralization of phosphoric acid with lime.  The amount  and
type  of  lime  used  and  the amount of water needed in  the
process determine whether  anhydrous  monocalcium  phosphate
monohydrate,  dicalcium  phosphate  dihydrate, or tricalcium
phosphate is the final produdt.  Animal feed grade dicalciam
phosphate is produced by  the  same  process  as  the  other
calcium  phosphates  except that, because less purity in  the
final product is necessary, wet process phosphoric  acid   is
normally  used  and  the  reaction  may be conducted without
excess water.

For the most part, the products included  in  the  phosphate
manufacturing  industry  ar6  produced by divisions of large
chemical  or  petroleum  companies.   The   derivatives    of
phosphorus  are generally manufactured by the same companies
that produce elemental  phosphorus.   Furthermore,  a  large
proportion  of  the  products  are  used  internally  by  the
producing company for the production of other products  and,
hence, are not sold on the open market.

The  biggest  factors determining the future of the industry
are government regulation and technological innovation.   The
declining production of  phosphorus,  for  example,  is   the
result  of  government  bans  on  phosphate  detergents.   In
addition, the TVA plant i'6 expected to shut down in 1976,  as
a  shift  to  production   of   wet   phosphoric   acid    is
accomplished.

Waste  Sources  and  Pollutants,  tfater is primarily used  in
the phosphate manufacturing  industry  for  eight  principal
purposes:  non-contact  cooling  water,  process and product
water, transport-water, contact cooling  or  heating'  water,
atmospheric  seal  water,  scrubber water, auxiliary process
water, and miscellaneous uses.   very  large  quantities   of
non-contact  cooling water are used for cooling the electric
furnaces used in  phosphorus  production.   Contact  cooling
water  is  used  to  quench  the  slag  from the phosphorous
furnaces.  Process or product vater contacts  and  generally
becomes  part  of  the  product,  'such as the hydrolysis and
dilution water used in phosphoric add manufacture  and  the
water  used  as  a  reaction  medlu» in food-grade dicalcium
phosphate manufacture.  Because some  of  the  materials   in
this  industry spontaneously ignite on contact with air, the
air is Kept out of reaction vessels vith a water  seal,  and
liquid  phosphorus  is  protected  by  storage under a water
blanket; these seal waters are  considered  process  waters.
Auxiliary   process   water  includes  those  used  in  such
auxiliary operations as ion exchange regeneration, equipment
washing, and spill and leak washdown.
                           3-192

-------
The following pollutant parameters have been designated  for
the  industry's process wastevaters: total suspended solids,
phosphate and elemental phosphorus, sulfates  and  sulfites,
fluoride,  chloride,  dissolved  solids,  arsenic,  cadmium,
vanadium, radioactivity, temperature (heat),  and  pH.   The
primary parameters, i.e., those which need to be used to set
effluent   standards,   are  total  suspended  nonfilterable
solids, total phosphorus, fluoride, arsenic,  and  pH.   The
remaining  pollutants are either adequately treated when the
primary parameters are treated, or are present only in waste
streams for which a zero discharge standard has been set.

The effluent limitations guideline for most of the phosphate
manufacturing industry is discharge  of  process  wastewater
pollutants to navigable waters.  Process water is defined as
any  water  that  comes  into  direct  contact  with any raw
material, intermediate product, byproduct, or gas or  liquid
that has accumulated such constituents.

The   only   exceptions  to  these  standards  are  the  BPT
guidelines for phosphorus  and  ferrophosphorus,  phosphorus
trichloride,  phosphorus oxychloride, and food-grade calcium
phosphates.

Control  Technology   and   Costs.    Traditional   sanitary
engineering   practices   that  treat  effluents  containing
organic material in order to reduce biological oxygen demand
are inapplicable to  the  phosphate  manufacturing  industry
where  such  pollutant  constituents  are  not  significant.
Hence, control and treatment of wastes are of  the  chemical
and    chemical    engineering   variety.    These   include
neutralization, precipitation, ionic reactions,   filtration,
centrifugation,  ion exchange, demineralization,  evaporation
and    drying.    in-process   abatement   measures   include
segregation  of waste streams, recycling scrubber water, dry
dust   collection,  containment  of  leaks  and  spills,  and
minimization  of the quanitity of wash water.  Table 4-17-1,
lists  the  major  treatment  alternatives  that  have   been
identified  for manufacturers in the phosphate manufacturing
industry.   Many   of   the   manufacturing   establishments
currently  have  no  treatment  installed, while  others  have
already  achieved zero discharge.
                            3-193

-------
               Table  4-17-1.
     Phosphate Manufacturing  industry
     Effluent Treatment Alternatives
Subcategory
Phoophorua
consuming

Phosphorus










Phosphate
producing




Chemical
P4(Fe2P>

V°4
PO

P2S5

PC13


POC^


K«BP3°1D
CaHPO

CaHP04
Feed grade
Alternative
A
B
A
B
A
B
A
B
C
A
B
C
D
A
B
C
D
A
A
B
A
B
Description
Existing control complete recycle of phoasy water. Evaporation
of some other process water. Lime treatment and sedimentation
of remaining process water prior to discharge.
Piping, pumping, and controls for 100% recycle of process
waste waters.
No treatment. (Only waatawaters originate from leaks, spills,
etc.)
Tight1") hOTSflk""Tf"iI """I TT^lltW*"''"- nlt« nnd rfBTn around
pumps, valves, tanks, etc. Provide sumps and sump pumps.
Treat with lime and landfill the sludge.
No treatment.
Lime treatment, settling tank, recycle of tank overflow back to
process, and landfill sludge.
No treatment.
Recycle scrubber water.
Lime treatment, settling tank, recycle tank overflow back to
process, I«II»MII sludge, + B,
No treatment.
Recycle scrubber water.
Lime treatment, settling tank and landfill sludge, + B.
Evaporation, + B+ C.
No treatment.
Recycle scrubber water.
Lime treatment, settling tank, and landfill sludge + B.
Evaporation + B •*• C.
Dry dust collection already In existence at exemplary plant. May
be economically justified on the basis of product recovery.
In-process controls for phosphate and lime dusts and for
phosphoric acid mists, Including dry dust collection and scrubber
water recycle to process.
Lime treatment, settling-pood, recycle of clarified water to acid
scrubbers, and landfill sludge, + A.
Replace wet scrubbers with baghouses.
Lime treatment, filtration of slurry, recycle of filtrate, and
landfill of Biter cake/ + A.
Source: EPA Development Document, January 1974.
                  3-194

-------
The technology recommended  to  achieve  zero  discharge  of
wastewaters in the phosphate manufacturing industry consists
of  recycling  atmospheric  seal ("phossy") waters, scrubber
liquors, and other process waters following  lime  treatment
and  sedimentation  or alternative methods of reducing water
flow, such as the use  of  dilute  caustic  or  lime  slurry
instead  of  pure  water  in  the  process;  use of dry dust
collectors, and the return  of  process  waste  streams  and
blowdown streams to the process.

Zero  discharge  of  arsenic-rich  still  residues  from the
manufacture  of  phosphorus  trichloride  can  be   achieved
through treatment with trichloroethylene.

For  those  industry  subcategories  where some discharge is
allowed,  the  recommended  treatment  consists  of   waste-
reducing  steps such as those above, but with some discharge
following lime treatment and sedimentation,  sometimes  with
flocculation.    Additional   treatment   to   achieve  zero
discharge  for  these  subcategories   consists   of   total
recycling  of  all  process waters for phosphorous producer •
control of  PCH  vapors  by  installation  of  refrigerated
condensers,  minimization  of  wastewaters  and treatment by
lime neutralization followed by evaporation to  dryness  for
manufacturers   of  phosphorus  trichloride  and  phosphorus
oxychloride;  and  the  addition  of  vacuum  filtration  of
treated   wastewaters   followed   by  total  recycling  for
producers of food-grade calcium phosphates.

A  recent analysis of costs for this sector was conducted  by
Gianessi  and  Peskin   (G&P)1.   This  study  was  conducted
independently and subsequent to the general  data  gathering
efforts  associated  with  the SEAS uniform cost calculation
procedure.  However, time and resource constraints1 prevented
incorporating these costs into the scenario  analyses  using
the  SEAS  model procedure.  The phosphate G&P estimates are
as follows  (in million  1975 dollars):
   Incremental  BPT Investment        68.6
   Incremental  BPT O&M              15.5

 Estimates  from the earlier  SEAS   calculation  are   presented
 below,   with  projected pollutant discharges associated  with
 these costs.  The principal reason for   the  differences  is
 that   G&P   scaled the .costs associated with each model plant
 size  because of industry and Department  of  Commerce comments
 concerning the low level of the  estimates.
                            3-195

-------
Gianessi, L. P. and H. M. Peskin, "The Cost to  Industries
of   the  Water  Pollution  Control  Amendment  of  1972,"
National Bureau  of  Economic  Research,  December,  1975.
(Revised January, 1976)
                         3-196

-------
w
I
VD
-J
                    ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                           Table 4-17-2.
                                      Phosphate Manufacturing
                                       Industry Data Summary
                                                          1977
                                                                         1983
  Capacity (kkg/Day)                 16,590.        26,567.

  Annual Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-1985 = 7.23%


EFFLUENTS ('1 .OOO MT/Yr)               1977           1983

Note: Residual data not available at time of Report Issue.

  1971 Controls:



  Legislated Controls:
 1985


28,938.




 1985
                    CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

                    Investment

                      Existing Plants
                         On-s1te Treatment
                         Pretreatment

                      New Plants

                      Municipal Investment Recovery

                      Totals
                                                           AGGREGATED OVER

                                            1974-77           1978-83    1976-85


                                             33.21   (BPT)      34,13 (BAT)   49.76
                                              O.OO               O.OO     0.00

                                              1.83              42.88    5O.57

                                              O.O                0.0     0.0

                                             35.05              77.01    10O.33

-------
                               Table 4-17-2. (Continued)
                                Phosphate Manufacturing
                                 Industry Data Summary
vo
00
CONTROL COSTS (Million 197S $) - (Continued)

Annualized Costs                               1977

Annual 1zed Capital'                            4.61

O&M3
  On-site Treatment                            4.41
  Pretreatment                                 0.0
  Totals                                       4.41

Municipal Charges

  Investment Recovery                          O.O
  User Charges*                                0.0
  Totals                                       O.O

Grand Totals                                   9.02
                                                                         COST IN YEAR

                                                                            1983     1985

                                                                           14.73    15.74
                                                                            0.0
                                                                            0.0
                                                                            0.0

                                                                           23.06
 O.O
 0.0
 0.0

26.92
         1976-85

        1O0.27*
                                                                            8.33    11.18    72.26
                                                                            O.O      0.0     O.O
                                                                            8.33    11.18    72.26
 0.0
 0.0
 0.0

172.53
              1  Annual1zed on-slte and pretreatment costs are computed on the assumption of a 15 year useful life
                at 10 percent Interest with zero salvage value.

              *  The decade total of annualized cost may not be relatable to the decade total of Investment because
                of the timing of investment expenditures over the decade.

              3  O&M costs in any year are relative to investment made in the year plus all prior: year investments
                commencing in 1973.  Hence, O&M expenditure in any year bears no particular relationship to the
                investment made in that year.

              '  User charges denote the O&M component of the municipal treatment charges.  The investment com-
                ponent Is denoted under- Investment recovery.
              Note:   The Phosphate Manufacturing industry includes the production of elemental phosphorus from
                      mined phosphate rock.

-------
PLASTICS AND SYNTHETICS INDUSTRY

Production  Characteristics and Capacities. The plastics and
synthetics  industry  comprises  17  product  subcategories.
Current effluent limitations guidelines do not apply to four
product   subcategories,   epoxies/   melamine,   urea,  and
phenolics, and the 13 remaining product  subcategories  are:
polyvinyl chloride, ABS/SAN, polystyrene, polyvinyl acetate,
low-density    polyethylene,    high-density   polyethylene,
polypropylene, acrylic, polyester, nylon  6  and  nylon  66,
cellophane, cellulose acetate, and rayon.

The   main  raw  materials  sources  for  the  plastics  and
synthetics industry are petroleum and natural gas.  In terms
of volume, the  rayon,  cellophane,  and  cellulose  acetate
subcategories  are  the  major  producers.  The plastics and
synthetics industry is an intermediate  type  industry  that
takes  the processed raw material or monomer and converts  it
into a resin or plastic material which  is  later  converted
into a plastic item by another segment of the industry.

Over  50 percent of synthetic resins are used for one of the
following:

  •  Building  and  construction:  paint,   flooring,   wall
     covering, siding, etc,-

  •  Packaging: polyethylene  films, rigid plastic containers
     and bottles, etc.; and

  •  Automotive: trim, steering wheels, grill, etc.

Manufacturing  in  the  various  subcategories  involves    a
variety  of chemical polymeterization processes in which the
large synthetic molecules, or polymers, are formed.  In  the
high  pressure  mass polymerization process, ethylene gas  is
mixed with air or oxygenated organic compounds as  catalysts
and  with recycled ethylene.  This mixture is then raised  to
a high temperature in a reciprocating compressor to  produce
the  desired polymer,, in this case, low density polythylene.
Rayon, polyester, cellulose acetate  and  other  fibers  are
produced   by   adding   a    spinning   process   after  the
polymerization is complete.

Exports amount to 6-8 percent of production and  outstripped
imports,  which only amounted to 4-5 percent of consumption.
Foreign competition is intense, but it  has  no  significant
effect on potential domestic  revenue.

Waste  Sources  and  Pollutants.   In  order  to set effluent
limitations  guidelines,   the   dimension   of   wastewater
                            3-199

-------
characteristics was chosen as a basis for subcategorization.
The four major subcategories are defined as:

  •  Major Subcategory I: Low waste load (< 10 kgAkg),   low
     attainable  3OD5_  concentration  (< 20 Jtig/D*  Products
     affected:  polyvinyl   chloride,   polyvinyl   acetate,
     polystyrene, polyethylene, and polypropylene.

  •  Major Subcategory II: High waste load  (>  10  kgAkg),
     low   attainable   BOD5_   concentration  <<  20  mg/1).
     Products affected: ABS/SAN, cellophane, and rayon.

  »  Major Subcategory III: High waste load (>  10  kgAkg),
     medium  attainable  BODjj^  concentration  (30-75  mg/1).
     Products affected! polyesters, nylon 66, nylon  6,   and
     cellulose acetates.

  •  Major Subcategory IV: High waste load  (>  10  kgAXg],
     low treatability.  Product affected: acrylics.

The  main  sources contributing to the total waste load come
from spills, leaks, and accidents.  'Other  sources  include:
washdown  of  process  vessels,  area  housekeeping, utility
blowdowri, and laboratory wastes.  Waste streams from cooling
towers,-steam-generating  facilities,  and  water  treatment
facilities  are  generally  combined with process wastewater
and then are sent to the treatment plant.

in order to  define  waste  characteristics,  the  following
basic parameters were used to develop guidelines for meeting
BPT,  BAT,  and  NSPS:  BOD£,  COD,  TSS, zinc, pH, phenolic
compounds, and total chromium.'

Control Technology and Costs. Waste treatment methods in  the
plastics and  synthetics  industry  include  the  following:
biological  treatment,  single  or  double  stage  aeration,
adsorption,  granular-activated  carbon  systems,   chemical
precipitation,  anaerobic  process,  air stripping, chemical
oxidation, foam  separation,  algae  systems,  incineration,
liquid  extraction,  ion  exchange,  reverse osmosis, freeze
thaw, evaporation, electrodialysis, and in-plant controls.

BPT guidelines for existing point sources are based  on   the
application  of  end-of-pipe  technology, such as biological
treatment for BOD reduction  by  activated  sludge,  aerated
lagoons, trickling filters, aerobic-anaerobic lagoons, etc.,
with   preliminary   treatment   typified  by  equalization,
dampening of shock loadings,  settling,  and  clarification.
BPf  also  calls  for  chemical treatment for the removal of
suspended solids, oils, and other elements, as  well  as  pH
control  and  subsequent treatment typified by clarification
                           3-200

-------
and polishing processes for  additional  BOD  and  suspended
solids   removal,   and  dephenolizing  units  for  phenolic
compound removal when needed,  in-plant technology and other
changes  that  may  be  helpful  in  meeting   BPT   include
segregation  of  contact process wastewater from non-contact
wastewaters,   elimination   of   once-through    barometric
condensers,   control   of   leaks,  and  good  housekeeping
practices.

BAT standards call for the segregation  of  contact  process
waters   from  non-contact  wastewater,  maximum  wastewater
recycle and reuse, elimination  of  once-through  barometric
condensers,  control  of  leaks, good housekeeping practices
and end-of-pipe technology,  further  removal  of  suspended
solids  and  other  elements  typified  by media filtration,
chemical treatment, etc.   Also  included  are  further  COD
removal  as typified by the application of adsorptive floes,
and incineration for the treatment  of  highly-concentrated,
small  volume  wastes,  as  well  as  additional  biological
treatment for further BOD5 removal when needed.

NSPS are based on BPT and  call  for  the  maximum  possible
reduction   of   process   wastewater   generation  and  the
application of media filtration and chemical  treatment  for
additional  suspended  solids,  other  element  removal, and
additional biological treatment for further BOD5_ removal  as
needed.

A  recent analysis of costs for this sector was conducted by
Gianessi  and  Peskin   (G&P)*.   This, study  was  conducted
independently  and  subsequent to the general data gathering
efforts associated with the SEAS  uniform  cost  calculation
procedure.  However, time and resource constraints prevented
incorporating  these  costs into the scenario analyses using
the SEAS model procedure.  The G&P estimates are as  follows
(in million.1975 dollars):

   Incremental BPT investment    $355.6
   Incremental BPT O&M           $ 36.3
                           3-201

-------
Estimates from the earlier SEAS  calculation  are  presented
below,  with  projected pollutant discharges associated with
these costs.   Principal  reasons  for  differences  between
these  cost  estimates and the newer data are basic industry
definition expansion, changes in plant inventory  estimates,
different   estimates  of  "capital-in-place",  and  varying
discharges to municipal treatment systems.
  Gianessi, L. P. and H. M. Peskin, "The Cost to Industries
  of the water Pollution control Amendment of 1972",
  National Bureau of Economic Research, December, 1975.
  (Revised January, 1976)
                            3-202

-------
                                                Table 4-18-1.
                                           Plastics and Synthetics
                                            Industry Data Summary
                         ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                                               1977
                                                                              1983
                                                                                             1985
                           Capacity (Million kg/Yr)            57.96          93.35

                           Annual Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-1985 = 8.19%
                                                                    102.01
N)
EFFLUENTS (1.OOO MT/Yr)

  1971 Controls:
     TSS
     BOD5
     COD
     Dissolved Solids (Rayon only)
                           Legislated Controls:
                              TSS
                              BOD5
                              COD
                              Dissolved Solids (Rayon only)
                                                               1977
                                                                              1983
                                                                                             1985
193
417
87O
22
123
213.
516,
5.
.83
.96
.28
.47
.55
.79
.10
.91
264
585
1,218
34
8O
82.
294
.80
.34
.97
.02
.41
.75
.80
.25
281.
625.
1 , 303 .
37.
67,
55.
228.
. 16
91
88
85
09
11
06
09
                         CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

                         Investment

                           Existing Plants
                              On-site Treatment
                              Pretreatment

                           New Plants

                           Municipal Investment Recovery

                           Totals
                                            1974-77
AGGREGATED OVER

   1978-83    1976-85
464,63 (BPT) 228.83 (BAT) 474. <
38 . 8O O . OO O . OO
167. 12
0.04
670.59
870. 15
O.36
1,099.34
1 , 084 . 39
O.53
1,558.95

-------
                                Table 4-18-1. (Continued)
                                 Plastics and Synthetics
                                  Industry Data Summary
W
I
CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $) - (Continued)

Annualized Costs

Annual!zed Capital1

O&M1
  On-site Treatment
  Pretreatment
  Totals

Municipal Charges

  Investment Recovery
  User Charges*
  Totals

Grand Totals
                                                              1977

                                                             88. 16
75.51
 2.OS
77.59
                                                              O.O2
                                                              0.03
                                                              O.O5

                                                            165.8O
             COST  IN YEAR

                1983     1985     1976-85

              232.65   249.67  1.729.41'
144.60   158.O6    1,211.82
  3.98     4.29     33.21
148.58   162.34    1,244.72
                0.07
                O.07
                O. 14
           O.O7
           0.07
           0. 14
O.53
O.8O
1 .32
              381.36   412.16 2,975.45
                 Annualized on-site and pretreatment costs are computed on the assumption of a 15 year useful life
                 at 10 percent  interest with zero salvage value.

                 The decade total of annualized cost may not be relatable to the decade total of investment because
                 of the timing  of investment expenditures over the decade.

                 O&M costs in any year are  relative to  investment made in the year plus all prior year  investments
                 commencing in  1973.  Hence, O&M expenditure in any year bears no particular relationship to the
                 investment made in that year.

                 User charges denote the O&M component  of the municipal treatment charges.  The  Investment com-
                 ponent is denoted under investment recovery.
               Note:   The Plastics and Synthetics  industry  includes production of cellophane,  rayon,  polyester,  and
                       nylon 6.

-------
PETROLEUM REFINING INDUSTRY

Production Characteristics and  Capacities.   The  petroleum
refining  industry  comprises  about 130 firms operating 24?
refineries in 39 states.  Firms in  the  petroleum  refining
industry  can  be  classified  according  to  size, range of
products, extent of integration, and the number and size  of
refineries  owned.   All  refineries  are necessarily multi-
product, and all perform the entire  process  of  converting
qrude oil into salable products.  As of 1974, the 17 largest
firms, operating 110 of the 247 refineries, accounted for 80
percent of the industry's capacity.

The   petroleum   refining  industry  produces  hundreds  of
distinguishably different products,  which  can  be  grouped
into  four  broad  product classes: gasoline, intermediates,
residual, and oil and all  others.   Gasoline  accounts  for
about  45 percent of industry output; intermediates comprise
about 33 percent,  including  military  and  commercial  jet
fuel, Kerosene, space heating oil, and diesel fuel; residual
oil  amounts  to  about  8  percent  of  domestic  petroleum
production;  and  other  all   products   include   asphalt,
lubricants,   liquefied,  petroleum  gas   (mostly  propane),
naphthas   and   solvents,   coke,    petrochemicals,    and
petrochemical  feedstocks.   Crude oil is the most important
raw material used  by   the  industry;  natural  gasoline,  a
liquid  product of the  natural gas industry, furnishes about
5  percent  of  refinery  intakes.   There  are   no   other
significant raw materials.

Small  refineries  are  designed  to process low-sulfur crude
oil   into  the  naturally  occurring  volumes  of  gasoline,
intermediates,   and  residual  products.   Such  refineries
require only a crude  oil  distillation  unit,  a  catalytic
reformer  with   feed  pretreater,  two  or  three additional
distillation .columns, and treating units.  Because  asphalt,
one   of  the  residual  products,  is costly to transport, a
large'percentage of the nation's asphalt  is  produced   in
small   refineries.     Over  a  third  of  the  plants  with
capacities below  10,000 barrels per day produce asphalt as a
principal product.

On the  other hand,  large refineries produce a  full range   of
fuel    products   plus    lubricants,   industrial  solvents,
liquified petroleum gas, and a "few common  chemicals-  these
refineries  have  more  than  a  score  of  process units  to
produce  these diversified products.
                            3-205

-------
Although a typical oil refinery is technically complex,  the
process  is  conceptually  simple.   Crude  oils,  which are
liquid mixtures of  many  carbon-containing  compounds,  are
first  separated  into  several  groups of varying molecular
size Known as cuts.  The chemical  composition  of  some  of
these cuts is then altered by changing the average molecular
size.  Some cuts are further processed to alter the shape or
structure  of  the molecules.  Most of the original cuts are
"treated" to make the impurities innocuous or to remove them
completely, particularly  sulfur.   Treated  cuts  are  then
blended  to  produce  finished  products,  to  which various
substances, known as  additives,  may  be  added  to  impart
certain desireable properties.

Refining   operations   may   be  divided  into  12  general
categories or groups of refining operations;

  »  storage and transportation
  e  Crude processes
  «  Coking processes
  *  Cracking and thermal processes
  «  Hydrocarbon processing
  »  Petrochemical operations
  •  Lube manufacturing processes
  »  Treating and finishing
  »  Asphalt production
  •  Auxiliary activities.

Refineries, which may  incorporate  some  or  all  of  these
operations,   are   classified  according  to  the  specific
operations included.  Based upon an analysis of refinery raw
waste  loads,  EPA  has  divided  the  industry  into   five
subcategories:

  Topping.   Topping  plants are refineries whose processing
is largely confined to converting oil into raw  products  by
simple  atmospheric  distillation.   The topping subcategory
includes all refineries that combine  all  processes  except
cracking and coking.

  Cracking.   The  term  cracking  applies  to  a  group  of
processes in which heavy molecular weight or  fractions  are
broken down into lover weight fractions.  Refineries in this
subcategory   are  those  that  have  topping  and  cracking
operations.

  Petrochemical.  Plants in this subcategory  have  topping
cracking, and petrochemical operations.

  Lube.   This subcategory includes refineries with topping,
cracking, and lube oil manufacturing processes.
                           3-206

-------
  Integrated.  Integrated refineries are those with topping,
cracking,   lube   oil    manufacturing    processes,    and
petrochemical operations.

Current   industry  capacity  is  approximately  14  million
barrels per day.  Very few new refineries have been built in
the last 5 years, and industry growth has occurred primarily
through  the  expansion  of   existing   facilities.    This
situation  is  caused  in part by the difficulty in securing
approval for new  refinery  sites.   The  intensity  of  the
energy  shortage  in  1974  resulted in the largest absolute
capacity increase since  1967  and  the  largest  percentage
increase  in  at  least  a  decade.   This  increase was 6.2
percent, compared with 2.3-4.3 percent for the  preceding  3
years.

Waste  Sources  and  Pollutants.   wastewater pollutants are
generated  in  the  various  refining  processes   as   high
temperature  water,  suspended solids, total organic carbon,
and salts separated from the crude  oil.   Acids,  caustics,
catalysts,  and  various  solvents  that  are  brought  into
contact with the oil are collected, washed out,  or  allowed
to  leak  into  the waste stream.  Pollutants also enter the
waste stream from washing tanks, equipment, catalysts, etc.;
from  cooling water blowdown; and from  leaks  and  spillage.
Additional  flows and waste loads are created by storm water
runoff from the refineries' grounds and from the disposal of
ballast water.

The following parameters  are  covered  under  the  effluent
limitations  guidelines:  BODS^, total suspended solids, COD,
oil and grease, phenolic compounds, ammonia  {as N), sulfide,
total chromium, hexaualent chromium, and pH.

Each  different process in the oil industry is  a  series  of
unit   operations   that  cause  chemical  and  or  physical
synthesis of the desired products.  Each unit operation  may
have  drastically different water usages associated with it;
this  in turn  implies  that  the  types  and  quantities  of
wastewater  generated  by  each plant's total production mix
are unique.

Control  Technology   and   Costs.    Wastewater   treatment
processes  currently used in the petroleum refining industry
include equalization and storm diversion;  initial  oil  and
solids  removal  (API separators or baffle plate separators);
further oil and  solids removal   (clarifiers,  dissolved  air
flotation,,  or   filters);   carbonaceous   waste   removal
(activated  sludge,  aerated   lagoons,   oxidation   ponds,
trickling  filter   activated  carbon,  or   combinations  of
                            3-207

-------
these);  and  filters  (sand   or   multi-media)    following
biological treatment methods.

BET  guidelines are based upon both in-plant and end-of-pipe
control practices widely used within  the  industry.    These
include the above listed end-of-pipe technologies plus:

  •  Installation of sour  water  strippers  to  reduce the
     sulfide   and   ammonia   concentrations  entering the
     treatment plant.

  •  Elimination of once-through barometeric condenser  water
     by using surface condensers  or  recycle  systems  with
     oily water cooling towers.

  *  segregation of sewers, so that unpolluted storm  runoff
     and   once-through   cooling  waters  are  not  treated
     normally with the process and other polluted waters.

  «  Elimination of polluted once-through cooling  water  by
     monitoring  and  repair of surface condensers or by use
     of wet and dry recycle systems.

  •  Granular media filtration or polishing ponds  prior  to
     discharge.

BAT guidelines call for further reductions of water flow in-
plant,  and  the  addition  of a physical-chemical treatment
step (activated carbon) in the end-of-pipe treatment system.
BAT in-plant technology is based on control practices now in
use by some plants in the industry and include:

  •  Use of air cooling equipment.

  •  Reusing; sour water stripper bottoms in crude desalter-
     once-through cooling water  as  make-up  to  the  water
     treatment plant; boiler condensate as boiler feedwater-
     overhead  accumulator  water  in  desalters; and heated
     water from the vacuum overhead condensers to  heat  the
     crude.

  •  Recycling: water from coking  operations,  waste  acids
     from  alkylation  units-  and  overhead  water in water
     washes.

  •  Use of wastewater treatment plant effluent  as  cooling
     water,  scrubbing  water,  and  influent  to  the water
     treatment plant.

  •  Use of closed compressor and pump cooling water system*
                           3-208

-------
  •  Use of rain water runoff as cooling  tower  make-up  or
     water treatment plant feed.

NSPS  are based upon the application of BPT practices to the
wastewater flows used as the basis for BAT.

The most  recent  anlysis  of  costs  for  this  sector  was
provided to the Agency by Sobotka & Co., Inc./ (S&C)*.  This
analysis  was  conducted in somewhat greater depth than, and
subsequent to the general data gathering efforts  associated
with  the  SEAS  uniform  cost calculation procedure, and is
considered to be more precise.  However, time  and  resource
constraints  prevented  incorporating  these  costs into the
scenario analyses using the SEAS model procedure.   The  S&C
estimates are as follows (in million 1975 dollars):

                             BPT      BAT

  Incremental Investment   $1,610     $476
  Incremental O&M          $  180     $ 46

Estimates from the earlier SEAS  calculation  are  presented
below,  with  projected pollutant discharges associated with
these costs.   Principal  reasons  for  differences  between
these   cost  estimates  and  the  newer  data  are different
estimates of "capital-in-place", differences in  attribution
of  O&M  to  federal laws, and differences in cost estimates
for sludge handling,  it is interesting  to  note  that  the
forecasts  of  investment expenditures over the period 1976-
1985 are in extremely close agreement for both studies, with
S&C forecasting  1,770  million  dollars  and  SEAS  listing
1,713.    S&C  assumes  elimination  of  the  "once-through"
cooling water to be identified  with  BPT  systems,  whereas
SEAS  placed  this  to  be  BAT treatment.  Of the total S&C
incremental investment figure for BPT, 43 percent is related
to end-of-pipe treatment processes or auxiliary and handling
equipment.  This figure represents an  estimate  27  percent
higher  than the SEAS corresponding projection.  Much of the
difference  in  these  two  figures  can  be  attributed  to
engineering   assumptions   about  equipment  necessary  for
auxiliary and sludge handling, which accounts  for  over  45
percent of these costs.  S&C also estimates $379 million for
BPT   related   expenditures  on  in-plant  measures.   SEAS
includes associated land costs, unlike S&C.  The methodology
for extrapolating costs differed markedly  between  the  two
studies.  S&C made its primary distinction between large and
small   plants  (<10,000 barrels/day).  For large plants, data
was available such that cost calculations could be made  for
121  refineries.   These  were  then  extrapolated  over the
entire  category.  For  small  plants,  11  refineries,  were
sampled,  and  the  results  similarly  extrapolated.   SEAS
                           3-209

-------
calculations  are  based  upon  model  plants   in   several
categories.   Three  model  plant  sizes  vere  assumed  for
topping;   three   for   catalytic   cracking,-   three   for
petrochemicals,  BPT treatment; five for BAT treatment; lube
oils lists three model plant sizes for  BPT,  with  six  for
BAT;  and  integrated having three classes for BPT; five for
BAT.

Another important  factor  in  the  cost  estimates  is  the
assumed  growth  pattern.  Although S&C and SEAS differ very
little in total growth for 1972-1983,  the  distribution  of
the  growth  is  graphically different.  S&C assumes that 64
percent  of  the  growth  occurs  between  1973   and   1977
(3,195,000   barrels/day),  while  SEAS  assumes  only  23.3
percent of overall growth (1,179,800 barrels/day}  to  occur
during the initial five-year period.

S&C  also  calculates costs for "grass roots" refineries and
expansions on a different basis.  The expansions after  1977
must  make  substantially  higher  investments, so the total
expansions investment figure  is  somewhat  weighted  toward
this  latter period.   The distribution of the growth in size
categories also differed markedly between  the  two  studies
with  S&C  assuming expansion in the large plant sizes, with
SEAS making no distinctions between types of  expansion  and
spreads the expansion over the model plant sizes.
  "Economic impact of EPA'S Regulations on the Petroleum
  Refining industry", SobotXa & Co., inc., April, 1976.
                           3-210

-------
                       Table 4-19-1.
                     Petroleum Refining
                   Industry Data Summary
ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                      1977
                                                     1983
                              1985
  Capacity (1,OOO Bbl/Day)           15,776.        20,228.

  Annual Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-1985 = 3.99%
                             21,651.
EFFLUENTS (1.OOO MT/Yr)

  1971 Controls:
     TSS
     BOD5
     COD
     Oils and Greases
  Legislated Controls:
     TSS
     BOD5
     COD
     Oils and Greases
1977
               1983
                              1985
10.
19,
88.
3
9.
15.
88.
3.
.66
.62
.78
.01
,31
81
, 15
14
13
25
113
3
5.
7.
44.
1 .
.66
. 14
.73
.86
95
72
.39
60
14
26
121
4
4
4.
23,

.59
.84
.44
. 12
.53
.51
.83
.85
CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

Investment

  Existing Plants
     On-site Treatment
     Pretreatment

  New Plants

  Municipal  Investment Recovery

  Totals
      1974-77
AGGREGATED OVER

   1978-83
                                          1976-85
447.34 (BPT)
1 .55
24.47
3.91
477.27
913
0
421 .
30.
1 , 365 .
.11 (BAT)
.00
,72
36
19
1, 136.89
O.OO
532.01
44.68
1 ,713.57

-------
                                Table 4-19-1.  (Continued)
                                    Petroleum Refining
                                  Industry Data Summary
w
I
N>
CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $) - (Continued)

AnnualIzed Costs

Annual 1 zed Capital'

O&M3
  On-slte Treatment
  Pretreatment
  Totals

Municipal Charges

  Investment Recovery
  User Charges*
  Totals

Grand Totals


1977
62,
67.
O.
68.
.23
.64
.41
.05
COST
IN YEAR
1983
237.
99.
O.
99.
,73
. 17
.36
.53
1985
252.
168.
0.
168.
.06
.00
.32
.32
1976-85
1,481
961
3
965
.60'
.79
.72
.51
                                                              1.73
                                                              2.9O
                                                              4.62

                                                            134.91
  5.64
  4.78
 10.42

347.68
  5.74
  4.93
 10.67

431.05
   44.68
   59.77
  1O4.45

2,551.55
               1  AnnualIzed on-site and pretreatment  costs  are  computed  on  the  assumption  of a  15  year  useful  life
                 at  10 percent  interest with zero salvage value.

               '  The decade total  of annualized cost  may not  be relatable to  the  decade  total of  investment  because
                 of  the timing  of  Investment expenditures over  the  decade.

               3  O&M costs  in any  year  are relative to  investment made  in the year plus  all prior  year  investments
                 commencing in  1973.  Hence,  O&M expenditure  in any year bears  no particular relationship  to the
                 investment made In that year.

               *  User charges denote the O&M component  of the municipal  treatment charges.  The  investment com-
                 ponent is  denoted under investment recovery.
               Note:    The  Petroleum  industry  includes  topping, cracking, petrochemical,  lube oil, and  integrated
                       refining  processes.

-------
RUBBER PROCESSING INDUSTRY

Production  Characteristics  and  Capacities.   The  phase I
categories of the rubber processing industry covered by  the
effluent  limitations guidelines are the tire and inner tube
industry and the synthetic rubber industry.

The manufacture of  tires and inner tubes employs  completely
different  processing techniques than does the production of
synthetic rubber.   The typical  tire  manufacturing  process
includes the following:

  •  Preparation or compounding of the raw materials

  •  Transformation of these compounded materials into  five
     tire  components—tire  bead coating, tire treads, tire
     sidewall, inner liner stock, and coated cord fabric

  •  Building, molding, and curing the final product.

The raw materials used include a variety  of  synthetic  and
natural  rubbers; three categories of compounding materials:
filler, extenders,  and reinforcers (carbon black and oil are
two common examples); and other chemicals that are  used  as
antioxidants,  pigments,  or  curing and accelerator agents.
Compounding is usually carried out in a batch-type, internal
mixing device called a Banbury  mixer.   After  mixing,  the
compound  is  sheeted  out  in  a roller mill, extruded into
sheets, or pelletized.  The sheeted material  is  tacky  and
must  be  coated  with  a  soapstone solution to prevent the
materials  from  sticking  together  during  storage.    The
compounded  rubber  stock is transformed into one of the tire
components by molding, extruding, calendering, and a variety
of other operations.  The tire is built up as a cylinder  on
a  collapsible,  round  rotating  drum by applying the inner
layer, then by adding  layers  of  cord,  beads,  belt,  and
tread.   Finally  the "green" tire is molded and cured in an
automatic press, and the excess rubber is ground off.  Inner
tubes are produced  using the same basic processing steps.

The  synthetic  rubber  industry  is  responsible  for   the
production  of  vulcanizable elastomers by polymerization or
co-polymerization.   Table  4-20-1  identifies  the  various
synthetic  rubbers, and  lists  their  principal production
processes and end uses.
                            3-213

-------
                    Table  4-20-1.
           Rubber  Processing  Industry
       Synthetic  Production  Statistics
               Families at Synthetic Rubbers Included En SIC 2822, Polymerization
                       Processes, and Annual U. S. Production (1972)
Principal Synthetic Rubber
Tiro Rubbers
Styrene-Butadlene robbers (SBR)
Polybutadlene rubbers (PER)
Folytsoprene robbers
Polyiaobutylene-lsoprene robbers

-------
                Table 4-20-1.  (Continued)
                Rubber  Processing  industry
           Synthetic  Production  Statistics
Principal Synthetic Rubber
CUoroauifoaated Poiyethylaoes


Polyaulfida rubber*

Specialty Rubber Sub-Total
Synthetic Rubber Total
Annual U.S.
Production
(l,OOOMT/yr)
15


10

129
3.121
Polymerization
Process
Poat-polymerl-
zattoo chlorina-
ttoo
Condensation



Principal End-use
Wire and cable,
shoes, linings.
paints
Sealing, glaring.
hose


Other Family
Members
Chlorinated
robber.
Kypalon
Thlol



 Although nltrtle and neoprene-type rubbers are not normally termed tire rubbers, they are relatively large
 production volume rubbers and, for convenience, can be Included with.the major tire rubbers.

ZSilloone, polyurethane and fluorocarbon derivative rubbers are considered part of the Plastics and
 Synthetics Industry and are not covered by this document.

SChloro8ulfonatad and chlorinated polyethylenes should be considered part of the PlEatioa and Synthetics
 Industry.  They are not covered by this document.

*Polysulflde rubbers are produced by a condensation-type reaction which is not directly comparable to either
 emulsion or solution polymerization. Per unit of rubber production, generated wastawaters are of considerably
 poorer quality and more troublesome to treat than those of either emulsion or solution or solution processes.
 Polyaulflds rubber production Is not covered by this document.  It la recommended that a separata study be
 made of the polysulflde, rubber Industry.
Source:  C. F. Ruobenaaal, The Rubber Industry Statistical Report International Institute of Synthetic Rubber
        Producers, Inc.
Reproduction from EPA Development Document, February 1974.
                              3-215

-------
.For  the  purpose  of  establishing    effluent    limitations
guidelines,  the  synthetic rubber industry has  been  divided
into three'subcategories: emulsion   crumb,   solution   crumb,
and  latex.  Crumb rubbers, generally  for tires,  are  sold in
a  solid  form,  and  are  produced  through two  different
processes:     'emulsion    polymerization     and    solution
polymerization.   Latex  rubbers,  generally for  specialty
products,  are  sold in  latex  form,  and  are produced  through
emulsion polymerization.

Emulsion  polymerization is  the  traditional  and  dominant
process  for   producing  synthetic rubber.   The raw  materials
(monomers) are usually styrene and   butadiene,   to  which  a
catalyst,  activator,  and  modifier  are   added  in   a  soap
solution to  produce  an  emulsion   in  an   aqueous  medium;
polymerization   proceeds   step-wise  through   a  train  of
reactors.  The product rubber   is  formed   in  the  emulsion
phase  of  the  reaction  mixture,   which   is  a milky white
emulsion  called  latex.   Urire.acted  monomers   are   then
recovered from the latex by vacuum stripping; the production
process  ends  at  this  point for -latex rubbers.  If crumb
rubber is desired, sulfuric acid  and  .sodium  chloride   are
added  to the  latex to coagulate out the crumb rubber, which
is then dewatered, rinsed, filtered, and finally dried  with
hot air to produce the final product.

The    production   of   synthetic   rubbers  by  solution
polymerization is a step processing  operation  very  similar
to  emulsion  polymerization.   For  solution polymerization,
the  monomers  must  be  extremely   pure,   and   the  solvent
(hexane,  for  example)  must   be~completely anhydrous.   The
polymerization reaction  is more rapid  (1 to 2 hours)  and  is
taken  to  over  90  percent   conversion as compared to 60
percent  conversion  for  emulsion   polymerization.     Both
monomers  and  solvents  are generally passed through drying
columns to remove all water.   After  reaction,   the  mixture
leaves the reactor as a rubber cement; i.e.  polymeric rubber
solids    dissolved    in   solvent.     As   with  emulsion
polymerization,   coagulation,  dewatering,  and     drying
processes produce the final product.

Tire  and  tube  products ; are produced in 56 plants in the
United States,- about 70 percent of these plants are operated
by  Firestone,  General  Tire,  Goodrich,   Goodyear,    and
Uniroyal.   The  remaining  plants   are  operated  by 11 other
companies.  Tire plants vary widely  in capacity;  the  largest
produce approximately 30,000 tires per day,  and  the smallest
produces less  than 5,000 per day.

Fourteen companies operating 28 plants  produce  the major
synthetic  rubbers  in   the  United  States.   Most of these
                           3-216

-------
plants are part of diversified complexes that produce  other
products, such as rubber processing chemicals, plastics, and
basic intermediate organic chemicals.
Waste  Sources  and Pollutants.  The primary water useage in
the tire and inner tube industry is for non-contact  cooling
and  heating.   Discharges  from service utilities supplying
cooling water and steam are the major source of contaminants
in the final effluent.  However, these  non-process  related
discharges  are  not  covered  by  the  effluent limitations
guidelines of this report.  The process wastewaters  consist
of  mill  area  oily  waters, soapstone slurry and latex dip
wastes, area washdown waters, emission scrubber waters,  and
contaminated  storm  waters from raw material storage areas,
etc.  For the purposes of establishing effluent  limitations
guidelines  for  manufacturers of tires and inner tubes, the
following  pollutant  parameters  have  been  designated  as
significant:  suspended  solids,  oil  and  grease,  and pH.
Pollutant parameters considered to be of  less  significance
are  biochemical  oxygen  demand,  chemical  oxygen  demand,
dissolved solids, temperature  (heat), and chromium.

The  principal   waste   streams   from   synthetic   rubber
manufacture  are  steam  and  condensate  from  the  monomer
recovery  stripping  operation,  overflow   of   coagulation
liquors,  and  overflow  of  the  crumb rubber rinse waters.
Area washdown and equipment clean-out wastewaters  are  also
major  sources  of'  pollutants, particularly in latex rubber
plants where clean-up is more  frequent  because  of  smaller
production  runs.   For  manufacturers of synthetic rubbers,
the following pollutant parameters have been  designated  as
significant:  chemical  oxygen  demand,  biochemical  oxygen
demand,  suspended  solids,  oil   and   grease,   and   pH.
Pollutants  also  present  in  measurable  quantities in the
waste streams, but not designated as  significant,  include:
total  dissolved solids, surfactants, color, and temperature
(heat).

Control Technology and Costs.  In the tire  and  inner  tube
industry, the emphasis for present environmental control and
treatment   technologies  is  placed  on  the  control of air
quality and  the  reduction  of  pollutants  in  non-process
wastewaters.   As  a result, no adequate overall control and
treatment   technology  is  employed  by  plants  within  the
industry.   Primary  emphasis  is  on  removal  of separable
solids  from  the  non-process  boiler  blowdowns  and  water
treatment   wastes, and from process washdown waters from the
soapstone area.  Because of substantial dilution of  process
wastewater  by   non-process  waters,  treatment is much less
                            3-217

-------
effective than could be expected,  especially  for  oil  and
grease.

End-of-pipe  treatment  generally  involves the treatment of
combined process and non-process  wastewater  in  a  primary
sedimentation basin or lagoon.

Of  17  plants  surveyed,  four used chemical coagulation to
further reduce solids levels.  Six plants had some  form  of
secondary  treatment,  either aerated lagoons, stabilization
ponds, or activated sludge treatment, and four discharged to
municipal  systems.   Only  one  plant   performed   totally
adequate treatment of all process water streams by achieving
no  discharge  through  the  use  of  spray  irrigation  and
evaporation.  In-process controls commonly employed  include
recirculation  of soapstone solutions, elimination of drains
in dirty areas, and the use of oil sumps or separators.

The technology recommended to meet the effluent  limitations
guidelines are:

  1. Elimination of any discharge of soapstone solution by:

     •  Recycling

     «  Installation of curbing and the sealing of drains in
        the soapstone dipping area

     •  Reuse the recirculating system washwater as  make-up
        for fresh soapstone solution.

  2. Elimination of any discharge of latex solution by:

     •  Installation of curbing and the sealing of drains in
        the latex dipping area

     •  Containment of  all  wastewaters  in  the  area  and
        disposal by landfill.

  3. Segregation, control, and treatment of all  oily  waste
     streams.

  4. isolation   of   process   waters   from    non-process
     wastewaters.

  5. Treatment of process wastewaters with API-type  gravity
     separators to remove separable oil and solids.

  6. Additional treatment through an  absorbent  filter  for
     further oil removal.
                           3-218

-------
Existing  control  and treatment technology practiced by the
synthetic rubber industry emphasized  end-of-pipe  treatment
rather    than    in-plant    reduction   because   in-plant
modifications could  affect  processing  techniques  or  the
quality of the final product.

Current  treatment  technology  for  both emulsion crumb and
latex plants involves primary  clarification  with  chemical
coagulation   of   latex   solids,  followed  by  biological
treatment.  As an alternative to chemical  coagulation,  air
flotation  clarification  of primary and secondary solids is
also  practiced.   Biological  treatment   systems   include
activated sludge, aerated lagoons, and stabilization ponds.

The control and treatment technology recommended to meet BPT
and  NSPS  guidelines for emulsion crumb and latex plants is
chemical  coagulation  and  biological  treatment,  improved
houskeeping  and  maintenance practices, as well as in-plant
modifications, particularly the use of crumb pits to  remove
crumb  rubber  fines from coagulation liquor and crumb rinse
overflows.  BAT has been defined as BPT plus the  equivalent
of   dual-media  filtration  followed  by  activated  carbon
treatment of the  effluent  from  the  biological  treatment
systems.   Because solution crumb wastewaters do not contain
uncoagulated latex solids, the chemical coagulation step  is
not  necessary.   BPT and NSPS technology for solution crumb
plants  have  been  defined   as   comparable   to   primary
clarification  and  biological  treatment,  with  the use of
crumb pits to catch crumb  rubber  fines  before  treatment.
BAT  for  solution  crumb  plants  is  the  same as that for
emulsion crumb plants.

A recent analysis of costs for this sector was conducted  by
Gianessi  and  Peskin   (G&P)1.   This  study  was  conducted
independently and subsequent to the general  data  gathering
efforts  associated  with  the SEAS uniform cost calculation
procedure.  However, time and resource constraints prevented
incorporating these costs into the scenario  analyses  using
the  SEAS model procedure.  The G&P estimates are as follows
(in million 1975 dollars):

  incremental BPT investment    $86.3
  Incremental BPT O&M           $ 8.1
                            3-219

-------
Estimates from the earlier SEAS  calculation  are  presented
below,  with  projected pollutant discharges associated with
these costs.   Principal  reasons  for  differences  between
these  cost  estimates  and  the  newer  data  are  that G&P
includes the industry subcategories in Phase II of  the  EPA
Effluent Guidelines.
  Gianessi, L. P. and H. M. Peskin, "The Cost to industries
  of the water Pollution Control Amendment of 1972",
  National Bureau of Economic Research, December, 1975.
  (Revised January, 1976}
                          3-220

-------
                                     Table 4-2O-2.
                                   Rubber Processing
                                 Industry Data Summary
to
              ACTIVITY LEVEL
                Capacity
                                                     1977
                                                                    1983
                                                                                  1985
Old Tires Proc. (Units/Day) 1 ,025,786.
Synth. Rubber (Met. Tons/Day)
Annual Growth Rate Over the Period
EFFLUENTS (1.OOO MT/Yr)
1971 Controls:
TSS (except Rubber Reclaiming)
BOD5 (except Rubber Reclaiming)
Dissolved Sol Ids
(Latex Mfg. only)
011s and Greases
COD (Syn. Rubber only)
Legislated Controls:
TSS (except Rubber Reclaiming)
BODS (except Rubber Reclaiming)
Dissolved Sol ids
(Latex Mfg. only)
011s and Greases
COD (Syn. Rubber only)
11,178,
1976-1985
1977

19.95
9.91

O.76
3.91
41 .03

6.81
3. 15

O.2O
1.34
15.23
1,435.303.
14. 158.
= 5.79%
1983

26.99
12.89

O.94
5.29
S5.52

2.96
1.O5

0.02
0.63
8.62
1,539.463.
14,838.

1985

28.01
13.65

0.98
5.66
59.39

3. 12
1.11

O.02
0.67
9. 18
              CONTROL COSTS  (Million  1975 $)

              Investment

                Existing Plants
                   On-s1te Treatment
                   Pretreatment

                New Plants

                Municipal Investment  Recovery

                Totals
              Annualized Costs
1974-77
               AGGREGATED  OVER

                  1978-83
1976-85
82.10 (BPT)
O.OO
2.25
0.0
84.35
1977
37.09
O.OO
45.08
O.O
82. 17
1983
(BAT) 76.93
O.OO
52.84
0.0
129.77
1985
                                                1976-85

-------
                           Table 4-2O-2. (Continued)
                               Rubber Processing
                             Industry Data Summary
               CONTROL  COSTS  (Million  1975 $)  -  (Continued)
w
to
Annualized Capital'

0&M>
  On-site Treatment
  Pretreatment
  Totals

Municipal Charges

  Investment Recovery
  User Charges'
  Totals

Grand Totals
                                                         11 .09
4.42
0.0
4.42
                                                          0.0
                                                          0.0
                                                          0.0

                                                         15.51
                                                                 COST IN. YEAR


                                                             21.89           22.89
7.77
0.0
7.77
               0.0
               0.0
               O.O

              29.67
16.02
 0.0
16,02
               0.0
               0.0
               0.0

              38.92
                                                                                                        166.72'
79.21
 0.0
79.21
                   0.0
                   O.O
                   O.O

                 245.93
            1 Annualized on-site and pretreatment costs are computed on the assumption of a 15 year useful life
             at 1O percent interest with zero salvage value.

            *. The decade total of annual 1zed cost may not be relatable to the decade total of Investment because
             of the timing of investment expenditures over the decade.

            3 O&M costs in any year are relative to investment made in the year plus all prior year investments
             commencing in 1973.  Hence, O&M expenditure in any year bears no particular relationship to the
             investment made in that year.
            * User* charges denote the O&M component of the municipal treatment charges.  The investment com-
             ponent is denoted under investment recovery.
           Note:   The Rubber Industry includes old and new tire processing, emulsion crumb and solution crumb
                   processing, and latex rubber processes.

-------
FERROALLOY INDUSTRY

Production  Characteristics  and  Capacities.  There were 44
plants  in  the  United  States  in  1972   which   produced
ferroalloy manganese, chromium, and other additive metals.

The  smelting and slag processing segments of the ferroalloy
manufacturing   industry   are   subdivided    into    three
subcategories  as  follows:  Subcategory  I:  open  electric
furnaces with wet air pollution control devices, Subcategory
II: covered electric furnaces and other smelting  operations
with wet air pollution control devices, and Subcategory  nit
slag  processing.   In the first two subcategories, the  main
source  of  wastewater  results  from  the   air   pollution
scrubbers.   In  the third category, water is used only  as a
transport or cooling medium.

Submerged-arc electric furnaces operate continously as power
is applied to the electrodes  and  they  are  supplied   with
materials  that consist mostly of reducing material (coal or
coke),  iron and steel borings and turnings and ores that may
be charged to the furnace  on  either  a  continuous  or an
intermittent  basis.   Due  to  the  large  volume  of gases
emitted, water-cooled covers collect the  gases  and  reduce
the amount of heat generated by the furnaces.

The   four  most  important  ferroalloys are: ferromanganese,
ferrosilicon,    ferrochromiura,     and     silicomanganese.
Ferroalloys  are  used to produce steels of greater strength
and corrosion resistance, and in the deoxidation,  alloying,
and graphitization processing of steel and cast  iron.

Waste   Sources  and Pollutants.  The major wastewater source
in the  ferroalloy manufacturing industry  results  from  the
use   of wet  scrubbers   (venturi-typei   for  air  pollution
control.  Approximately one-third of  the   furnaces   in  the
industry  use   such  devices.   The  cooling  of   ferroalloy
furnaces also required large  quantities  of  water.   other
sources  of    wastewater   stem    from   boiler   feed,  air
conditioning, and sanitary uses.    wastewaters   result   from
slag  processing  operations  in  which   slag is crushed and
sized for recovery of metal values, or   from  slag  shotting
operations  in which the slag is granulated  for  further use.

The   primary wastewater effluents resulting  from wet  methods
 for  air pollution  control  are:  suspended   insoluble metcl
compounds,   soluble metal  compounds, cyanides,  acid or basic
effluents,  tars, and  thermal discharges.
                            3-223

-------
The basic parameters, used  in  establishing  water  effluent
guidelines are: suspended solids, total chromium, hexovalent
chromium, total cyanide, manganese, phenol, and pH.

Control  Technology  and  Costs.   Current  water  pollution
control and treatment  technology  used  in  the  ferroalloy
industry  for  those  plants  utilizing  wet  air  pollution
control devices has been through sedimentation  of  scrubber
water  in  large  lagoons.  Hence, wastewaters are now being
treated by physical means.

Best Practicable  Technology  for  Subcategories  I  and  II
involves  both  physical  and chemical treatment by means of
sedimentation (clarifiers and  flocculators)  and  chemicals
such as: caustic or stilfuric acid solutions, sulfur dioxide,
and  chlorine dioxides.  Also included is recycling of water
at the scrubber to  aid  in  removal  of  toxic  pollutants.
Process  water  quality requirements for Subcategory III are
less  stringent  than  the  other  two,  but  also  requires
sedimentation and chemical treatment when necessary.

Best Available Technology (and NSPS) for Subcategories I and
II,  in  addition  to  BPT,  includes  recirculation  of the
wastewater,  which  necessitates  the   addition   of   sand
filtration  for  suspended solids removal.  Subcategory III,
in addition to BPT, will require process water recirculation
for suspended solids removal.

In order to compute the incremental capital  costs  to  this
industry,  it  is necessary to estimate the number of plants
that  have  wet  air  pollution  control  devices.   It   is
estimated that 32 percent have wet air pollution control, 38
percent  have dry air pollution control, and 30 percent have
no air pollution control.

A recent analysis of costs for this sector was conducted  by
Gianessi  and  PesXin  (G&P)».   This  study  was  conducted
independently and subsequent to the general  data  gathering
procedure.  However, time and resource constraints prevented
incorporating  these  costs into the scenario analyses using
the SEAS model procedure.  The ferroalloy G&f estimates  are
as follows fin 1975 dollars):

  Incremental BPT Investment       15.0
  Incremental BPT O&M               5.0

Estimates from the earlier SEAS  calculation  are  presented
below,  with  projected pollutant discharges associated with
these costs.   Principal  reasons  for  the  differences  are
industry definition expansion and changes in plant inventory
                           3-224

-------
estimates.   Note  that  both  studies  agree  to  within 12
percent.
                            3-225

-------
                                              Table 4-21-1.
                                                Ferroalloy
                                          Industry Data Summary
                       ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                                             1977
                         Capad ty
                            Slag Process (kkg/Day)             256.57
                            Ferrolloys (MW of Furnace Oper.) 2,129.
                                                                            1983
                                                       355.26
                                                     2.639.
                         Annual Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-1985 = 4.07%
                                                                                           1985
           358.55
         2,669.
1^
to
01
EFFLUENTS (1.OOO MT/Yr)

  1971 Controls:
     TSS
     Dissolved Solids
     Nutrients
     011s and Greases
                         Legislated Controls;
                            TSS
                            Dissolved Sol ids
                            Nutrients
                            Oils and Greases
                                                             1S77
                                                                            1983
                                                                                           198.5
4
3


1 .
1 .


.52
.71
. 12
.35
.98
,81
. 14
41
5
4


0.
0,


.70
.68
. 15
.44
.97
. 18
.08
,3O
5.
4.


0.
0.
.

79
90
16
46
91
15
O5
24
                       CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

                       Investment

                         Existing Plants
                            On-site Treatment
                            Pretreatment

                         New Plants

                         Municipal  Investment Recovery

                         Totals
                                            1974-77
AGGREGATED OVER

   1978-83
                                                                                1976-85
1 1 .37 (BPT)
0.00
5.89
O.O
17.27
2O.45 (BAT)
0.00
29. 05
O.O
49. 5O
25.76
O.OO
31 .63
O.O
57. 4O

-------
                              Table 4-21-1.  (Continued)
                                      Ferroalloy
                                Industry Data Summary
U)

to
NJ
CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $) - (Continued)

Annualized Costs

Annualized Capital1

Q&M*
  On-s1te Treatment
  Pretreatment
  Totals

Municipal Charges

  Investment Recovery
  User Charges4
  Totals

Grand Totals


1977
2
1
O
1
0
0
O
.27
. 10
.0
. 1O
.0
.0
.O
COST
IN YEAR
1983
8.
1 .
0.
1 .
0.
0.
O.
78
47
O
47
O
0
0


1985
8
1
O
1 ,
0
O.
O.
.90
.76
.O
.76
.0
,O
.0


1976-85
57
13
O
13.
O.
0.
O.
.65'
.55
.O
.55
O
.0
O
                                                            3.37
10,25
10.67
                                                                                                           71.19
             1 Annualized on-site and pretreatroent costs are computed on the assumption of a 15 year useful life
               at 1O percent Interest with zero salvage value.

             * The decade total of.annualized cost may not be relatable to the decade total of investment because
               of the timing of investment expenditures over the decade.

             1 O&M costs in any year are relative to investment made in the year plus all  prior year investments
               commencing in 1973.  Hence,  O&M expenditure 1n any year bears no particular relationship to the
               investment made in that year.

             4 User charges denote the O&M component of the municipal  treatment charges.   The  Investment  com-
               ponent is denoted under investment recovery.
             Note:   The Ferroalloy Industry includes open and covered electric arc  furnaces  and  slag processing.

-------
IRON AND STEEL INDUSTRY

Production Characteristics and  Capacities.   The  iron  and
steel  industry  is  one  of  the  largest  in  the  nation,
comprising some 179 companies operating 420 plants; 23 steel
companies operate approximately 65 integrated steel  plants.
These  integrated  plants  represent about 90 percent of the
total steel-making capacity.   The  balance  of  the  steel-
making  capacity  is represented by the non-integrated steel
producers, many of whom are classified as mini-mills.

The iron and steel  industry  comprises  the  coking,  blast
furnace-sinter plant, iron casting, steel manufacturing, and
steel  casting  segments.  The industry is primarily engaged
in manufacturing hot metal, pig iron, and  ferroalloys   from
iron  ore  and  iron  and steel scrap, and in converting pig
iron, scrap iron, and  scrap  steel  into  steel.   Merchant
blast  furnaces and byproduct or beehive coke ovens are  also
included in the industry.

Three basic steps are involved in  the production   of  steel.
First,  coal  is  converted to pure carbon or coke.  Second,
coke is then combined with iron ore and limestone  in a blast
furnace to produce  iron.  Third, the iron  is  purified   into
steel  in  either an open-hearth,  basic-oxygen, or electric-
arc  furnace.   Further   refinements  include  degassing   by
subjecting  the  steel  to a high  vacuum.  Steel that is not
cast in  ingot  molds  can  be  cast  in   a  process  :called
continuous casting.

For  the  purpose   of  establishing effluent guidelines, the
industry has been divided into  12  subcategories as follows:

   •  Byproduct  coke

   *  Beehive coke

   •  Sintering

   •  Blast  furnace  (iron]

   •  Blast  furnace  (ferromanganese)

   •  Basic-oxygen  furnace (semi-wet air pollution
     control methods)

   •  Basic-oxygen  furnace (wet  air pollution
      control  methods)

   •  Open-hearth furnace
                            3-228

-------
  •  Electric-arc furnace (semi-wet air pollution
     control methods)

  •  Electric-arc furnace (wet air pollution
     control methods)

  *  vacuum degassing

  •  Continuous casting.

Basic-oxygen  furnaces  and  open-hearth  furnaces   produce
almost  all  of  the steel;• electric-arc furnaces are mostly
mini-mills.  Only seven electric-arc furnaces  reported  the
use  of  "wet"  air pollution control equipment.  Hence, the
effluent limitations guidelines apply mainly to  the  large,
integrated mills.

The  total annual raw steel capacity tn 1972 of the iron and
steel industry was approximately 1,070 million metric  tons.
Of  this,  the  integrated mills accounted for approximately
154 million metric tons (94 percent).-

Although  the  year-to-year  production  of  raw  steel  has
fluctuated  widely,  the  average annual rate of growth over
the past 15 years  has  been  about  3.5  percent,  from  84
million  metric  tons  in  1959  to an estimated 136 million
metric tons in 1973.  This hasi been accomplished with a very
modest establishment of new integrated mills, although  many
non-integrated  "mini-mills"  have  been built.  Most of the
increase in capacity  has  been  accomplished  by  upgrading
capacities  of  existing steel plants, building larger blast
furnaces, and replacing  open-hearth .  furnaces  with  basic-
oxygen furnaces.

Waste  Sources  and  Pollutants.   The  principal  source of
wastewater pollutants from the iron and  steel  industry  is
cooling  water.   Enormous  amounts of water are used in the
steel-making process to cool  furnaces  and finished products,
and to quench hot coke, slag, etc.  Much of this  is  "once-
through" cooling water, although blowdown from recirculating
systems  and  barometric  condenser  water  is also present.
Water used  in  "semi-wet"  air  pollution  control  systems
constitutes  the  second-most important source of wastewater
from the iron and steel industry.  Other significant sources
of wastewater include excess  ammonia liquor  and  light  oil
recovery wastes from byproduct coke-making, and gas cleaning
water from  blast furnace operation.

Pollutants  covered  by  the  effluent  limitations guidelines
are cyanide, phenol,  ammonia,  oil  and  grease,  suspended
solids,  sulfide,  fluoride,  manganese, nitrate, zinc,  lead,
                            3-229

-------
and pH.  The guidelines apply  to  aqueous  waste  discharge
only, exclusive of non-contact cooling waters.

Control  Technology  and Costs.  Treatment control practices
currently employed in the iron and  steel  industry  may  be
summarized as follows:
Source

Ammonia liquors


Quenching


Gas  cleaning
 Vacuum  degassing
 Continuous casting
Treatment Control Practices

Ammonia stripping, solvent recovery,
detarring

Settling followed by discharge or
recycle

Thickening, alkaline chlorination,
chemical coagulation, sometimes with
settling or filtration followed by
discharge or recycle

Evaporative cooling or cooling towers,
sometimes with settling or filtration
followed by recycle

Settling, filtration, evaporative
cooling followed  by recycle
 The  treatment  technologies  called  for  by  the  effluent
 limitations guidelines are summarized in Table 4-22-1.

 The most recent  analysis  of  costs  for  this  sector  was
 provided  to  the Environmental Protection Agency by Temple,
 Barker & Sloane, Inc.(TBS)1.  This analysis was conducted in
 somewhat greater depth than, and subsequent to  the  general
 data gathering efforts associated with the SEAS uniform cost
 calculation procedure, and is considered to be more precise.
 However,    time    and   resource   constraints   prevented
 incorporating these costs into the scenario  analyses  using
 the  SEAS model procedure.  The TBS estimates are as follows
 (in million 1975 dollars):
                            3-230

-------
                       Incremental
                       Investment     incremental O&M

1974-77                  1,760            290
Phase I                    250             30
Phase II                 1,330            130
Storm Runoff                20
Other water                160             30

1978-83                  1,820          2,610
Phase I                    400            420
Phase II                   850          1,270
Storm Runoff               130            100
Other Water                440            820

The earlier SEAS calculations are presented in Table 4-22-2,
with projected pollutant discharges  associated  with" these
costs.  SEAS addresses only Phase I and Phase II costs.  The
Phase   I  investment  costs  of  both  studies  are  within
approximately five percent of each other for 1974-1977, with
Phase I investment costs over  1978-1983  approximately  ten
percent in difference.  Phase II investment costs over 1978-
1983  are  extremely  close—within three percent.  However,
the timing of the payments varies substantially between  the
two studies for Phase II.

While  the total investment expenditures of both studies are
remarkably similar for  1374-1983,  significant  differences
exist  in  assignment  of  these costs to meeting BPT or BAT
regulations.  TBS states a BPT cost of $1,390 million,  with
an   additional   cost   of  $150  million  for  changes   in
construction, yielding a total estimate  of  $1,540  million
for  Phase I and Phase II investment costs.  SEAS lists $865
million plus 108 million for  expansion  costs  during  this
period for a total of $973 million.  NO estimate for changes
in  construction  work  is  included  in SEAS.  Phase I cost
estimates of TBS for meeting BPT regulations are lower  than
SEAS,  whereas  Phase  II  is substantially higher.  This  is
because TBS estimates are derived from  the  more  stringent
guidelines  issued by EPA in March 1976.  SEAS Phase II cost
estimates were based upon an earlier guideline  outlined   by
EPA in August 1975.  An additional source of variance in the
cost  projections  is  that  TBS  bases their forecasts upon
projected 1983 production levels.  SEAS  uses  estimates   of
1972  production,  and  historical  growth  patterns  of the
industry to forecast future production.
                            3-231

-------
"Economic Analysis of Proposed and Interim Final Effluent
Guidelines, Integrated Iron and Steel Industry", Temple,
Barker & Sloane, inc., March, 1976.
                          3-232

-------
                                       Table 4-22-1.
                            Iron and Steel Control Technologies

                Subcategory                  BPT

                Byproduct                    Ammonia  still operation
                                             with lime operation.
                                             dephenolizatibn, sedimen-
                                             tation,  neutralization.
                            BAT
                                                       NSPS
oo
                Beehive coke
                Sintering
                Blast  furnace (iron)
                Blast  furnace
                (ferromanganese)
                Basic-oxygen furnace
                (semi-wet  air pollution
                control  methods)
                Basic-oxygen furnace
                (wet air  pollution control
                methods)
Settling basin with
complete recycle and no
aqueous blowdown.

Thickener with chemical
flocculation, tight
recycle, surface skimming,
neutralIzation.

Thickening with blymer
addition, recycle using
cool ing tower.
Thickening with blymer
addition, scrubber water.
recycle with evaporative
cooling, pH adjustment.

Sett!ing tank with
chemical and/or magnetic
flocculation, complete
recycle and no aqueous
b1owdown.

Class if ier/thickener
with chemical and/or
magnetic flocculation,
tight recycle,  neutrali-
zat ion.
                            BPT,  less dephenolization  Same as BAT.
                            plus  sulfide oxidation,
                            clarification,  multi-stage
                            biological  oxidation with
                            methanol  addition (or
                            alkaline  ch1 orination and
                            carbon  adsorption),  and
                            pressure  filtration.
                                                                        Same as BPT.
BPT. plus  lime preci-
pitation of fluorides.
BPT, plus alkaline
chlorination, press use
filtration, and carbon
adsorption, neutrali-
zation.

Same as above.
Same as BPT.
Blowdown treatment using
lime precipitation of
fluorides and sand filtra-
tion or improved settling
with coagulation.
                                                                                                   Same as BPT.
                                                                                                   Same as BAT.
                           Same as SAT.
                                                                                                  Same as BAT,
                                                                                                  Same as BPT.
                           Same as BAT,

-------
                             Table 4-22-1. (Continued)
                        Iron and Steel Control  Technologies
I
N>
U>
if*
            Subcategory

            Open-hearth furnace
Electric-arc furnace
(semi-wet air pollution
control methods)
            Electric-arc furnace
            (wet  air  pollution control
            methods)
            Vacuum degassing
           Continuous casting
                             BPT

                             Same as above.
Settling tank with
chemical and/or magnetic
flocculation with complete
recycle and no aqueous
blowdown, or controlled
wetting of gases to form
sludge only, no recycle
or blowdown.

Classifier/thickener with
chemical and/or magnetic
flocculation,  tight
recycle, neutralization.
BAT

Same as above with
anaerobic denitri-
fication.

Same as BPT.
NSPS

Same as BAT
without
denitrification.

Same as BPT.
                             Settling via classifier,
                             tight recycle over a
                             cool ing tower.
                             Scale pit with dragout
                             conveyor, oil  skimmer,
                             flatbed filtration.
                             recycle with cooling
                             tower.
Blowdown treatment using
lime precipitation of
fluorides and sand filtra-
tion or improved settling
with coagulation.

Blowdown treatment with
coagu1 at i on/c1ar1f i ca11on
and anaerobic denitrifi-
cation (or substitution
of another gas for nitro-
gen), neutralization.
                           BPT,  plus
                           blowdown.
          fi1tration or
                                                                                   Same as BAT
                                                      Same as BAT
                                                      wi thout
                                                      deni tnf ication.
                           Same as BAT.
           Source: EPA Development Document, June  1974.

-------
                                               Table 4-22-2.
                                               Iron and Steel
                                           Industry Data Summary


                       ACTIVITY  LEVEL                         1977            1983           1985

                         Capacity:
                         Phase I  (MT/Day)                   178,597.        2O6.751.        197,989.
                         Phase II  (kkg/Day)               1,156,790.      1,249,267.      1.2O5.6OO.
I                        Annual  Growth  Rate Over  the Period  1976-1985  =  1.41%
N
J£                      EFFLUENTS  (1.OOO MT/Yr)                      1977            1983            1985

                         1971 Controls:
                            TSS                                  1,389.36        1,534.13        1,547.71
                            BOD5  (Beehive & Byproduct
                               Coking only)                        26.42          28.46          28.61
                            Dissolved Solids                      718.O9         821.41         839.86
                            Nutrients (Open Hearth Fur.  only)         .18             .10             .06
                            Bases  (Beehive & Byproduct  Coking,
                               and  Iron Foundry only)             186.82         2O1.54         202.66
                            Oils and Greases (Except  Iron
                               Foundry  & Beehive Coking)          4O1.04         478.72         495.15

                         Legislated Controls:
                            TSS                                   418.98          57.64          12.23
                            BOD5_ (Beehive & Byproduct
                               Coking only)                        1O.42           3.02           2.41
                            Dissolved Solids                      152.22           2.56           2.26
                            Nutrients (Open Hearth Fur. only)        .04            .02            .01
                            Bases (Beehive & Byproduct Coking,
                               and Iron Foundry only)              58.77           4,97           2,10
                            Oils and Greases (Except Iron
                               Foundry & Beehive Coking)          121.01          2O.19           3.34

-------
                                   Table 4-22-2. (Continued)
                                         Iron and Steel
                                     Industry Data Summary
to
CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)
Phase I

Investment

  Existing Plants
     On-s1te Treatment
     Pretreatment
  New Plants
  Municipal Investment Recovery
  Totals

Annual1zed Costs

Annual 1zed Capital1

O&M1
  Qn-site Treatment
  Pretreatment
  Totals

Municipal Charges

  Investment Recovery
  User Charges4
  Totals

Grand Totals
                                                        1974-77
                                                           O.O
                                                           0.0
                                                           0.0

                                                         3O3.07
                                                                       AGGREGATED OVER
                                                                          1978-83
                                                                                            1976-85
211 .
O.
25.
O.
237.
99
00
74
O
73
1977
31
.26
271 .82
0.0
271 .82
(BPT)
273.
O.
79.
O.
352.
.03
.00
.63
,O
67
1983
77
3O7
0
307
.62
.01
.0
.01


(BAT)

364.
0.
81.
O.
446.
.65
,OO
.99
.0
64
1985
77
423.
0
423
.35
.71
.O
.71






1976-85
534.
3, 143.
0.
3. 143.
. 13'
. 14
.0
. 14
  O.O
  O.O
  0.0

384.63
  0.0
  0.0
  0.0

501.05
    0.0
    O.O
    O.O

3,677.27
            '  Annual 1 zed on-s1te and pretreatment costs are computed on the assumption of a 15 year useful life
              at 1O percent Interest with zero salvage value.

            *  The decade total of annual1zed cost may not be relatable to the decade total of investment because
              of the timing of investment expenditures over the decade.

-------
w
U>
                 Table 4-22-2. (Continued)
                       Iron and Steel
                   Industry Data Summary

'  (3&M costs 1n any year are relative to Investment made 1n the year plus all prior year Investments-
 commencing 1n 1973,  Hence, O&M expenditure 1n any year bears no particular relationship to the
                Investment made m that year.

*  User charges denote the O&M component of the municipal treatment charges.   The Investment com-
        ponent 1s denoted under Investment recovery.

Note: The iron and Steel  (Phase I) Industry Includes byproduct coking;  blast furnace production; electric
   arc, open hearth, and basic oxygen furnace operations;  and continuous casting processes.
           CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

           Phase II

           Investment

             Existing Plants
                On-s1te Treatment
                Pretreatment

             New Plants

             Municipal Investment Recovery

             Totals



           AnnualIzed Costs

           Annuallzed Capital1
                                            1974-77
                                                           AGGREGATED OVER
                                                              1978-83
                                                                                1976-85
652.73
O.OO
82.36
0.0
735.09

1977
96.65
(BPT) 1,211.09
O.OO
29 1 . 4 1
O.O
1 . 5O2 . SO
COST IN YEAR
1983
294. 19
(BAT) 1,516,
O
3O4,
O.
1,821 .

1985
284.82
.49
.OO
.64
,0
13

1976-85
1 , 866 . 22 '

-------
                            Table 4-22-2.  (Continued)
                                  Iron and Steel
                              Industry Data Summary

                                       O&M'
            Qn-site Treatment        151.93  188.58  257.47   1,871.60
                 Pretreatment           O.O    O.O    O.O     O.O
                Totals           151.93  188,58  257.47   1.871.6O

                                Municipal  Charges
w
!               Investment Recovery         0.0    0.0    O.O     O.O
*>                User Charges"           0.0   0.0    O.O     O.O
oo                  Totals             O.O     O.O     O.O     O.O

             Grand Totals          248.57   482.77  542.29   3,737.82

           Phase II (Continued)


           1  Annualized on-site  and pretreatment  costs are computed  on the  assumption  of  a  15  year  useful  life
             at 1O percent interest with zero salvage value.

           *  The decade total of annualIzed cost  may not  be relatable  to  the  decade  total of  investment  because
             of the timing of  investment expenditures over the decade.

           3  O&M costs in any year are relative to investment  made in  the year plus  all prior  year  investments
             commencing in 1973.   Hence, O&M expenditure  in any year bears  no particular  relationship  to the
             investment made in  that year.

           *  User charges denote the O&M component of the municipal  treatment charges.  The  investment com-
             ponent is denoted under investment recovery.


          Note:    The Iron and  Steel  (Phase II)  industry includes cold rolling, hot forming,  pipe  and tubing
                   production, hot and cold coating process, and other chemical processing operations.

-------
BAUXITE REFINING INDUSTRY

Production Characteristics and Capacities.  There  are  nine
domestic  bauxite  refineries owned by five primary aluminum
producers.  Bauxite refining is carried  on  only  by  these
primary  aluminum  producers,  ususally  in very large-scale
installations.

Size range distribution and alumina production capacities of
the refineries are classified as: small  (500,000 metric tons
per year), medium  (501,000  -  1,000,000  metric  tons  per
year), and large (>1,000/000 metric tons per year).

The  bauxite  refining  industry  is  a  subcategory  of the
aluminum segment of the nonferrous metals industry.  Bauxite
is the principal ore of  aluminum  and   the  only  one  used
commercially  in the united States.  It  consists of aluminum
oxide  (hydrated) and contains various  impurities,  such  as
iron oxide, aluminum silicate, titanium  dioxide, quartz, and
compounds  of  phosphorous  and vanadium.  Two processes are
used in alumina  refining:  Bayer  process  and  combination
process.

The  Bayer process is classically used in the united States.
impure alumina in the bauxite is dissolved in a hot,  strong
alkali  solution  (generally NaOH), to form sodium  aluminate.
Upon dilution and cooling, the sodium aluminate  hydrolyzes,
forming   a  precipitate  of  aluminum   hydroxide  which   is
filtered and calcined (roasting or burning  to  bring  about
physical or chemical changes) to alumina (pure).

The  combination process is applied to high-silica bauxites.
It  is  similar  to  the  Bayer  process but   includes    an
additional  extracting  step.  This is accomplished by mixing
the red mud residue  from the prior step  with   limestone   and
sodium carbonate,   and then sintering this mixture  at  1100°
to  1200°C.  Silica  is   converted  to  calcium   silicate   and
residual  alumina to  sodium aluminate.  The sintered  products
are leached to produce  additional sodium aluminate solution,
which   is  either   filtered and  added to the main  stream  for
precipitation or is  precipitated separately.    The  residual
solids  (brown mud)  are  slurried  to a waste lake.

Higher  taxes  and  levies on imported bauxite  have increased
the interest  in  the  possible use  of  alternative  materials
 located in the United States to  produce  alumina.   Efforts to
 use  domestic  sources  of  raw  materials,   such   as  clays,
 alunite,   and  anorthosite,  are   increasing,   and  a    U.S.
producer   is  now using  a  Soviet  process  termed successful in
 refining  alumina from alunite.
                            3-239

-------
Waste Sources and  Pollutants.  The  primary  waste   from  a
bauxite  refinery  is  the  gangue (worthless rock)  from the
ore, known as red or brown mud, which is produced  in   large
quantities.  From about one-third to one ton'of red  mud will
be  produced  per ton of alumina.  An increase of 2  to  2-1/2
ton. per'ton occurs from brown mud.

The principal water streams in a bauxite  refinery   are the.
following:   red  mud  stream,  spent   liquor,  condensates,
barometric condenser cooling water, and storm water  runoff.

The major process waste  is  the  mud   residue.   The   Bayer
process  produces  a  red  mud while the combination process
treats this mud and  forms  a  brown  mud.   However,   these
differences do not alter the problem of disposal.

wastewater   parameters   used   for    determining   effluent
guidelines include: alkalinity, pH, total dissolved   solids,
total  suspended solids, and sulfate.   Mud residue resulting
from process operations is produced on  a large scale (500  to
nearly 4,000 kkgs  per  day).   Use  of  wastewater  recycle
systems, along with complete waste retention, will eliminate
the  discharge  of  all  process  wastewater  pollutants   to
receiving waters.

The guidelines for all three levels of  control (BPT, BAT and
NSPSV are essentially no discharge of process wastewaters  to
navigable waters.  To allow for certain climatic conditions,
the guidelines permit a bauxite refining plant to  discharge
an  amount  of  water  equal to the amount by which  rainfall
exceeds the natural evaporation.  This  amount is  applicable
to  only that rainfall landing directly  in impoundment areas,
such  as  active  and  dormant  mud lakes and neutralization
lakes.

Control Technology and Costs. Since enormous  aqueous   waste
suspensions   are   generated   in   bauxite   refining,   no
practicable or  currently  available  treatment  or   control
technology  for these wastes exists, except  for impoundment.
In  all but two plants, a  large diked area for impounding the
red mud has been made  available.   Wastes   containing  high
alkalinity  or acidity can be neutralized, but this  leads  to
the creation of dissolved solids.  Mud  and other  pollutants
from  refining,  however, can be impounded in a red  mud lake
system.   Cooling  towers  may  be  an   alternative   for the
cooling water supply for barometric condenser effluents.

Two plants  are  known   to  be  currently operating with  no
discharge of water.  Four other plants  have  prepared or are
implementing plans to achieve no discharge of process waters
before  the  effective  date  of  effluent limitations. Two
                            3-240

-------
plants  are  currently  discharging  all  wastes,  but   are
implementing plans to impound red mud.

A  recent analysis of costs  for this sector was conducted by
Gianessi  and  Peskin   (G&P)*.   This  study  was  conducted
independently  and  subsequent to the general data gathering
efforts associated with the  SEAS  uniform  cost  calculation
procedure.  However, time and resource constraints prevented
incorporating  these  costs  into the scenario analyses  using
the SEAS model procedure.  The bauxite G&P estimates  are  as
follows (in 1975 dollars):

  Incremental BPT Investment         63.4
  Incremental BPT O&M                  6.7

Estimates from the earlier SEAS  calculation  are  presented
below,  with  projected pollutant discharges associated with
these costs.  G&P lists costs  on   a  plant-by-plant  basis,
whereas  SEAS  utilizes model plants with associated  average
costs.  This, combined  with  the capital  in place assumptions
of the computer model,  resulted in  different cost estimates.
 * Gianessi,  L.  P.  and  H.  M.  Peskin,  "The  Cost  to   Industries
  of    the   water   Pollution  Control   Amendment   of   1972,"
  National   Bureau  of Economic   Research,  December   1975.
   (Revised  January 1976)
                            3-241

-------
                                           Table 4-23-1.
                                          Bauxite Refining
                                       Industry Data Summary
                    ACTIVITY  LEVEL
                                      1977
1983
1985
                      Capacity (1.OOO MT/Yr)               7,276.          9,831

                      Annual  Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-1985  =  4.82%
                                                                   1O.O41,
to
rf»
to
EFFLUENTS (1.OOO Metric Tons)

  1971 Controls:
     TSS
     Dissolved Sol Ids
                      Legislated Controls:
                         TSS
                         Dissolved  Sol ids
                    CONTROL  COSTS  (Million 1975  $)

                    Investment

                      Existing  Plants
                        On-site Treatment
                        Pretreatment

                      New Plants

                      Municipal Investment Recovery

                      Totals
                                                          1977
                                                                         1983
                                                                                        1985
2, 182. 1O 2. 771. SO 2,923.85
88. SO 112.54 118.72
641.19 O O
26 . O3 O O
AGGREGATED OVER
1974-77 1978-83
34.86 (BPT) 0.0 (BAT)
O.OO O.OO
15.36 6O.71
O.O O.O
5O.22 6O.71



1976-85
15.85
O.OO
67 .98
O.O
83.83

-------
                               Table  4-23-1.  (Continued)
                                   Bauxite Refining
                                 Industry  Data  Summary
w
to
»*»
u>
CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $) - (Continued)

Annualized Costs

Annua1i zed Cap1ta1'

O&M1
  On-site Treatment
  Pretreatment
  Totals

Municipal Charges

  Investment Recovery
  User Charges*
  Totals

Grand Totals


1977
6
51
O
51.
0.
O
0,
.60
.68
.O
68
.O
.O
.O
COST
IN YEAR
1983
14
71
0
71
O
O
0
.58
.55
.O
.55
.O
.O
.0


1985
14
72
O
72
O
O
O
.94
.77
.0
.77
.O
.O
.0


1976-85
114
636
O
636.
O.
0.
0.
.66*
.24
.O
.24
O
0
O
                                                           58.29
                                                                          86. 13
                                                                                         87.71
75O.91
              1 Annualized on-site and pretreatment costs are computed on the assumption of a  15 year useful  life
               at  1O  percent  interest with zero salvage value.

              ' The decade total of annualized cost may not be relatable to the decade total of Investment because
               of  the timing  of Investment expenditures over the decade.

              1 O&M costs in any year are  relative- to  Investment made in the year plus all prior year investments
               commencing In  1973.  Hence, O&M expenditure in any year bears no particular relationship to the
               Investment made in that year.

              * User charges denote the O&M component  of the municipal treatment charges.  The investment com-
               ponent is denoted under investment recovery.
             Note:   The Bauxite Refining  industry  includes two alumina refining processes: Bayer and combination.

-------
PRIMARY ALUMINUM SMELTING INDUSTRY

Production  Characteristics  and  Capacities.    The  primary
aluminum  industry  has  three  production  stages:  bauxite
mining,   bauxite  refining  to  produce  alumina   (aluminum
oxide), and the reduction of  alumina  to  produce   aluminum
metal;  this  last  state  is  commonly  Known   as   aluminum
smelting.

The reduction  of  alumina  to  produce  aluminum  metal   is
carried  out  in  electrolytic  cells,  or  pots,  that   are
connected  in  series  to  form  a  potline.    The   facility
containing  a  number  of  potlines  is  referred  to  as  the
potroom.  The electrolysis takes  place  in  a   molten bath
composed principally of cryolite, which is a double  fluoride
of  sodium  and  aluminum;  alumina  is  added   to   the bath
periodically.   As  electrolysis   proceeds,    aluminum    is
deposited  at  the  cathode,  and  oxygen  is evolved  at  the
carbon anode.  The oxygen reacts with  the carbon to  produce
a  mixture  of  carbon monoxide and carbon dioxide while  the
anode  is consumed.

Two methods of replacing the anodes are practiced-  they   are
referred to as the prebaked anode  (intermittent replacement)
and  the  Soderberg  anode   (continuous  replacement).   For
either system, the anode preparation   begins  in  the  anode
paste  plant, where petroleum coke  and  pitch are hot-blended.
For  prebaked  anodes,  the anode  paste is pressed  in  molds,
and the  anodes are baked in the anode  bake plant.   The baked
anodes are used to replace consumed anodes,  and  the  anode
butts  are  returned   to the anode preparation  area.  In  the
Soderberg  anode  system,  the  anode  paste  is  not  baked
initially,  but is fed  continuously in the  form of  briquette
through  a shell into the pot.  As  the  paste  approaches   the
hot  bath,  the  paste   is baked  in place  to  form  the  anode.
Soderberg anodes are supported in  the  sleeves by vertical or
horizontal studs.

The  continuous evolution of  gaseous reaction  products  from
the   aluminum  reduction   cell yields  a  large volume of  fume
that  requires  ventilation  systems   to  remove   it   from   the
potroom.   The  ventilation  air must  be  scrubbed to minimize
air  pollution  and  both dry and  wet   scrubbing   methods   are
used   for   this purpose.   Water  from  wet  scrubbers,  used  for
air  pollution  control  on potroom   ventilation   air,   is   the
major  source  of wastewater in  the  primary  aluminum,industry.

The  liquid  aluminum  produced  is  tapped periodically, and  the
metal  is cast  in  a separate  cast-house facility.  The  molten
metal   is   degassed  before casting by bubbling  chlorine  or a
mixed  gas   through   the   melt.    The    chlorine   degassing
                            3-244

-------
procedure  also  produces  a fume which must be scrubbed for
air pollution control.

A few aluminum smelters have metal  fabrication  facilities,
such  as  rod  mills,  rolling  mills,  etc., on the primary
reduction  plant  site.   Since  these   metal   fabrication
operations   will   be   covered   under  separate  effluent
limitations,  they  are  not   covered   by   the   effluent
limitations derived for this report.

waste  Sources and Pollutants.  As mentioned previously, the
major source of wastewater in the primary aluminum  smelting
industry   is  the  water  used  in  air  pollution  control
equipment (scrubbers) that  are  installed  on  potline  and
potroom ventilation air systems.  Scrubbers are also used on
anode bake furnace flue gas, and on cast-house gases,  other
significant  sources  of  wastewater  include: cooling water
used  in  casting,  rectifiers,  and   fabrication;   boiler
blowdown;   and   storage  area  run-off,  especially  water
contaminated with fluoride from spent cathodes.

The  following  pollutant  parameters  have  designated  the
following  significant  pollutants from the primary aluminum
smelting industry for the purposes of establishing  effluent
limitations  guidelines:  fluoride,  total suspended solids,
and pH.  Other wastewater pollutants identifiable  with  the
industry,  but  not considered significant, include: oil and
grease,  cyanide,  dissolved  solids,   chloride,   sulfate,
chemical oxygen demand, temperature, and trace metals.

Control Technology and Costs.  The existing technologies for
controlling  wastewater  volume in this industry include dry
fume scrubbing, and recycling  of  water  to  wet  scrubbers
after precipitation by lime or alum, absorption of activated
alumina  or  hydroxylapatite, and reverse osmosis.  Table 4-
24-1  summarizes  the  present  and  potential  control  and
treatment  technologies  for  the  primary aluminum smelting
industry, as forecast by SEAS.
                            3-245

-------
00
I
              Wastewater  Source

              Pot  (primary)
                wet  scrubber

              Pot  (primary)
                wet  scrubber
Pot (primary)
  wet scrubber

Pot (primary)
  wet scrubber

Potroom (secondary)
  wet scrubber
             Potroom  (secondary)
               wet scrubber

             Cast house
               wet scrubber

             Anode bake plant
               plant wet

             Paste plant
               wet scrubber

             Cast house
               cool ing

             Rect ifier
               cooli ng

             Rainfal1 runoff
                                                        Table
                                     Primary Aluminum Smelting
                          Present Practice

                          Discharge without
                          treatment

                          Discharge without
                          treatment
Lime and settle
once-through

Cryolite 'or line
pptn. with recycle

Discharge without
treatment
                          L1me and settle
                          once-through

                          Settle
                          Settle
                          Settle
                          Discharge without
                          treatment

                          Discharge without
                          treatment

                          Discharge without
                          treatment
                                                 4-24-1.
                                                 Industry Control  Technology
                                                                                       Possible
                                                                                       Added Treatment
                        Possible
                        Added Control

                        Convert to dry
                        scrubbing
                        Install  cryolite or     Install  lime treat-
                        line pptn.  plus recycle ment of  bleed stream
                        with bleed
Install recycle with
bleed
Instal1  cryolite
or line pptn. plus
recycle

Install  recycle
                        Convert to alternate
                        degassing

                        Recycle
                                                  Recycle
                        Close loop
                        Convert to air-
                        cooled rectifiers

                        Route to cryolite
                        recovery and recycle
Install alumina
adsorption

Install lime treat-
ment of bleed stream
                                                Install  alumina
                                                adsorption
                                                                          Flocculate and
                                                                          aerate
                        Cool1ng tower


                        Cool ing tower
             Reproduced from EPA Development Document; March 1974.

-------
BPT includes the treatment of wet scrubber water  and  other
fluoride-containing  effluents  to precipitate the fluoride,
followed by settling of the precipitate and recycling of the
clarified liquor to the wet scrubbers.  A  holding  pond  or
lagoon  might also be necessary to minimize the discharge of
suspended solids.  Precipitation methods currently available
use cryolite  and  lime.   Alternate  control  technologies,
which  can  be  employed  to  achieve  the required effluent
levels, include dry fume scrubbing, total  impoundment,  and
reuse of effluent water by a companion operation.

The  application  of  the  BPT  described above results in  a
relatively  low-volume, high-concentration bleed stream  from
the  recycling  system.   BAT  is  lime  or calcium chloride
precipitation treatment  of  the  bleed  stream  to   further
reduce  the  discharge of fluorides.  Use of this technology
assumes  the  volume  of  fluoride-containing  effluent   is
reduced  to  approximately  5,000  liters  per metric ton of
aluminum.   Alternatively, volumes as high as  50,000  liters
per  metric  ton of aluminum may be possible if the effluent
is treated  by  absorption  methods   (activated  alumina  or
hydroxy1apat i te).

NSPS   technology   assumes  the  application  of  dry  fume
scrubbing systems or, alternatively, wet scrubbing equipment
together with total impoundment or total  recycling   of  the
scrubber  water.   The  treatment for  flouride and suspended
solids removal  is essentially  the same  as   for  BPT  above.
The  NSPS require the restriction of  the discharge volume to
835  liters  per  metric ton of aluminum  with a final  fluoride
concentration   of   30  mg  per  liter;  or  an  equivalent
combination of  fluoride level  and volume.  Alternatives  for
reducing  water use and pollutant levels include air-cooled,
solid  state rectifiers; molten metal  degassing; and   careful
cleaning of the anode butts  before recycling.

Approximately   one-third  of   the  primary aluminum smelting
plants in  the United States  are  currently  operating  with
discharge    levels   of  pollutants   within  the  July  1977
guidelines.
                            3-247

-------
A recent analysis of costs  for  this  sector was conducted  by
Gianessi  and  PesKin  (G&P)1.    This   study  was  conducted
independently and subsequent  to the  general  data  gathering
efforts  associated  with   the  SEAS  uniform cost calculation
procedure.  However, time and resource  constraints prevented
incorporating these costs into  the scenario  analyses  using
the  SEAS model procedure.  The G&P  estimates are as follows
(in million 1975 dollars):

  incremental BPT investment     $28.7
  Incremental BPT O&M            $ 7.0

Estimates from the earlier  SEAS  calculation  are  presented
below,  with  projected pollutant discharges associated with
these costs.  Several reasons for differences between  these
cost   estimates  and  the  newer data exist.   One  major
discrepancy resulted from differences in the application  of
engineering   estimates.    SEAS and   the  EPA  Development
Document used exemplary plant data to derive  average  costs
per  plants,  while  G&P  used  each  plant as a model for its
size class.  As a result, capital costs per  ton  of  output
were 60 percent higher in the G&P study.  Another difference
is due to estimates of "capital-in-place".  G&P assumed that
70 percent was already installed as  compared to a 30 percent
level  assumed  by SEAS.  O&M costs  vary considerable due to
the considerations affecting  plant inventory  and  treatment
levels  as  well as differences in attribution of the O&M to
federal laws.
  Gianessi, L. P. and H. M.  Peskin,  "The  Cost  to  Industries
  of the Water Pollution Control  Amendment  of  1972",
  National Bureau of Economic Research, December,  1975.
  (Revised January, 1976)
                            3-248

-------
                                                        Table 4-24-2.
                                                  Primary Aluminum  Smelting
                                                    Industry Data Summary
             ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                                    1977
                                                                   1983
                                                                                  1985
               Capacity (MT/Day)                  49,827         62,759.

               Annual Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-1985 = 3.63%
                                                                   64.615.
u*
vo
EFFLUENTS (1,OOO MT/Vr)

  1971 Controls:
     TSS
     Dissolved Sol Ids
                                                    1977
                                                   23.60
                                                   21.35
                                                                   1983
29.66
26.84
                                                                                  1985
•31 .20
28.23
               Legislated Controls:
                  TSS
                  Dissolved Sol ids
                                       6.85
                                       7.61
 1. 18
 1 .62
   46
   .42
             CONTROL COSTS (Million  1975 $)

             Investment

               Existing Plants
                  On-site Treatment
                  Pretreatment

               New Plants

               Municipal Investment Recovery

               Totals
                                                           AGGREGATED OVER

                                            1974-77           1978-83           1976-85


                                             39,13   (BPT)      24.35  (BAT)      43.92
                                              o.oo              -o.oo              o.oo

                                              0.0                0,0               o.o

                                              O.O                O.O               O.O

                                             39.13              24.35             43.92

-------
                                               Table 4-24-2. (Continued)
                                               Primary Aluminum Smelting
                                                 Industry Data Summary


          CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975.$) - (Continued)               COST IN YEAR

          Annual1zed Costs                               1977           1983           1985           1976-85

          Annual 1 zed Capital'                             5.14           8.35           8.35             65.9O'

          O&M'
U>           On-s1te Treatment                           26.11          27.9O          32.53            285.14
•           Pretreatment                                 O.O            0.0            O.O               0.0
Ui           Totals                                      26.11          27.9O          32.53            285.14
O
          Municipal Charges

            Investment Recovery                          O.O            O.O            O.O               O.O
            User Charges'                                O.O            O.O            O.O               O.O
            Totals  '                                     O.O            O.O            O.O               O.O

          Grand Totals                                  31.26          36.25          4O.88            351.O4


          1  Annualized on-s1te and pretreatment costs are computed on the assumption of a 15 year useful life
            at 1O percent interest with zero salvage value.

          !  The decade total of annualized cost may not be relatable to the decade total  of investment because
            of the timing of Investment expenditures over the decade.

          3  O&M costs in any year are relative to investment made In the year plus all  prior year investments
            commencing in 1973.  Hence, O&M expenditure in any year bears no particular relationship to the
            investment made in that year.

          *  User charges denote the O&M component of the municipal treatment charges.  The investment com-
            ponent is denoted under investment recovery.


          Note:    The Primary Aluminum industry includes three major production stages: bauxite mining, bauxite
                  refining,  and alumina reduction.

-------
SECONDARY ALUMINUM SMELTING INDUSTRY

Production Characteristics and  Capacities.   The  secondary
aluminum  industry  comprises  an estimated 54 firms with 58
plants.  Other sources list  the  industry  as  having  more
plants,  but  these numbers include sweaters, scrap dealers,
and  non-integrated  fabricators.   For  purposes  of   this
report,   the  number  of  plants  reported  excludes  these
portions of the industry as they do not employ  any. of  the
processes included in the effluent limitations guidelines.

The secondary aluminum smelting industry is a subcategory of
the  aluminum segment of the nonferrous metals manufacturing
category.  This industry recovers,  processes,  and  remelts
various grades of aluminum-bearing scrap to produce metallic
aluminum  or  an  aluminum alloy as a product, which is used
primarily to supply the following industries:  construction,
aircraft,  automotive,  electrical equipment, beverage cans,
and fabricated metal products, which include a wide  variety
of  home  consumer  products.  The largest user of secondary
aluminum ingot is the automotive industry.

The estimated 1973 capacity was 966,572  metric  tons.   The
top  four firms (Alcoa, Reynolds, Kaiser, and Ormet) account
for about 50 percent of the capacity.

Waste Sources and Pollutants,  wastewaters are generated  by
the   following   processes:   (1) ingot  cooling  and  shot
quenching,  (2) scrubbing of furnace fumes during  demagging,
and  (3) wet  milling  of  residues  or  residue  fractions.
Secondary aluminum  ingot  is  produced  to  specifications-
melting  to  specification is achieved mainly by segregating
the incoming scrap into alloy types.  The magnesium  content
can   be   removed   with  a  chlorine-gas  treatment  in   a
reverberating furnace.

The  following  are  the   primary   wastewater   pollutants
discharged by the above processes: oil and grease,  suspended
and dissolved solids, and salts of aluminum and magnesium.

In  metal  cooling,  molten  metal in the furnace is usually
either cast into ingot or sow  molds  or  is  quenched  into
shot.   When  cooling  water  is  generated, ingot  molds are
sprayed while on conveyor belts to solidify the aluminum and
allow  its ejection from the mold.   Shot  is  solidified  by
having   metal   droplets  fall  into  a  water  bath.   The
wastewater generated  is  either  vaporized,  discharged  to
municipal  sewage  or  navigable  waters,  recycled  for some
period  and  discharged   (6-month  intervals),  continuously
recycled with no discharge, or discharged to holding ponds.
                            3-251

-------
Fume scrubbing results when aluminum scrap contains a higher
percentage  of  magnesium  than  is  desired  for  the alloy
produced.    Magnesium   removal,   or    "demagging,"    is
accomplished  by  either  passing  chlorine through the melt
(chlorination) or with aluminum fluoride.   While  magnesium
is  extracted,  heavy  fuming  results from demagging, which
requires passing the fumes through a wet  scrubbing  system.
water  used  in scrubbing gains pollutants, primarily in the
scrubbing of chlorine demagging fumes.

Residue  processing  takes  place  in  the  industry   since
residues  are  composed  of  10 to 30 percent aluminum, with
attached aluminum oxide fluxing salts (mostly NaCl and KCl^,
dirt, and various other chlorides,  fluorides,  and  oxides.
The  metal  is  separated from the non-metals by milling and
screening, which is performed wet or dry.  In  wet  milling,
the dust problem is minimized but the resulting waste stream
is   similar   to   scrubber  waters  in  make-up  but  more
concentrated in dissolved solids.  Water is  passed  into  a
settling pond before discharge.

The  major  wastewater  parameters  stem from two wastewater
streams: wet milling of residues and  fume  scrubbing.   Wet
milling   of   residues  include:  total  suspended  solids,
fluorides, ammonia, aluminum, copper,  COD,  and  pH.   Fume
scrubbing includes: total suspended solids, COD, and pH.

Control  Technology  and costs.  Approximately 10 percent of
the industry is currently discharging directly to  navigable
waters.   The  majority of the industry discharges effluents
into municipal treatment works, usually with some treatment.

Currently,  some  plants  are  utilizing   various   control
alternatives for each of the three major wastewater sources.
The control technologies required to meet BPT and BAT are as
follows:
                           3-252

-------
BPT

• Metal Cooling.  Air cooling  or  continuous  recycling  of
  cooling  water  with  periodic  removal,  dewatering,  and
  disposal of sludge.

• Fume Scrubbing.  Chlorine fume  scrubbing  {for  magnesium
  removal  using  chlorine):  pH  adjustment  and 'settling.
  Fluoride  fume  scrubbing  (for  magnesium  removal  using
  aluminum  fluorides):  pH  adjustment, settling, and .total
  recycling.

• Residue Milling.  pH adjustment with  settling  and  water
  recycle.
BAT

• Metal Cooling.  Air cooling, water cooling   (for  complete
  evaporation) and total use and recycle of cooling water by
  use of settling and sludge dewatering.

• Fume Scrubbing.  Use of aluminum  fluoride   for  magnesium
  removal,  and  entrapment  of  fumes  without major use of
  water, using  alternatives  such  as  the  Alcoa  process,
  Derham process or the Tesisorb process.

• Residue  Milling.   Dry  milling,  and  a  water  recycle,
  evaporation, and salt reclamation process.

A  recent  analysis of costs for this sector was conducted by
Gianessi   and  Peskin   (G&P)*.   This   study   was  conducted
independently  and  subsequent to the general  data gathering
efforts associated with the SEAS  uniform  cost  calculation
procedure.  However, time and resource  constraints prevented
incorporating  these  costs into the scenario  analyses' using
the  SEAS model procedure.  The G&P estimates are as   follows
(in  million 1975 dollars):

  Incremental BPT Investment    $2.5
  Incremental BPT O&M           $0.6
                            3-253

-------
Estimates from the earlier SEAS  calculation  are  presented
below/  with  projected pollutant discharges associated with
these costs.  Several reasons for differences between  these
cost   estimates  and  the  newer  data  exist.   One  major
discrepancy resulted from differences in the application  of
engineering   estimates.    SEAS  and  the  EPA  Development
Document used exemplary plant data to derive  average  costs
per  plants,  while  G&P  used each plant as a model for  its
size  class.   O&M  costs  vary  considerable  due  to    the
considerations   affecting  plant  inventory  and  treatment
levels as well as differences in attribution of  the  O&M  to
federal laws.
 i Gianessi, L. P. and H. M. Peskin,  "The  Cost  to Industries
  of the Water pollution Control Amendment  of  1972",
  National Bureau of Economic Research/ December/  1975.
  (Revised January, 1976)

 PRIMARY COPPER INDUSTRY

 Production  Characteristics  and   Capacities.    The   primary
 copper industry  includes establishments primarily engaged in
 smelting  copper  from  ore  and   in  refining   copper    by
 electrolytic  or other processes,   operations involving the
 mining of copper ore, as well as the rolling,   drawing,   and
 extruding  of  copper,  are  not   included   in this  industry
 category.  The basic process  used   by the primary  copper
 industry  is pyrometallurgical.  Copper concentrates are fed
 to  the primary   smelter,   which  produces  "blister   copper"
 after  roasting,  smelting,  and   converting.    The   blister
 copper is then purified  by  fire-refining.   If  additional
 purification   is   required,  an   electrolytic  process  is
 employed, with   the  final  product  being   cathode   copper.
 Byproducts,   such  as  gold  and  silver which  were contaminants
 of  the blister copper,  are  collected as   "slimes"  during
 electrolytic  refining  and  are  subsequently  recovered.

 In   the   roasting   operation,  the  copper   concentrates are
 subjected to  controlled heat to  burn away sulfur  and  other
 impurities.    The   copper   silicate  thus  produced   is then
 charged  to  a  reverberatory or  an electric furnace along with
 scrap  copper,   recycled   slab,   and  fluxing   materials  to
 produce   a   copper-iron-sulfide   material called matte.   The
 liquid  matte  is  then  converted to a relatively  impure  form
 of  copper   called  blister  copper  by an oxidation process
 involving the blowing of  thin  streams  of  air  through  the
 molten  material.
                            3-254

-------
                                                                 Table 4-25-1.
                                                          Secondary A1 urn1num Sme11 i ng
                                                             Industry Data Summary
                      ACTIVITY  LEVEL
                                                            1977
                                                                           1983
                                                                                          1985
                        Capacity  (MT/Yr)                 1.995.7OO.      2.85O.17O.

                        Annual  Growth Rate Over  the Period 1976-1985  =  5.8O%
                          3,056,733.
I
N>
tn
Ui
                      E- ;LUENTS  (1,OOO MT/Yr)

                        1971 Controls:
                          TSS
                          COD
                          Dissolved  Sol Ids
                          Bases
                        Legislated Controls:
                          TSS
                          COD
                          Dissolved  So1Ids
                          Bases
1977
               1983
         1985
2.52
1 .02
t .37
19.26
2.02
.27
.66
5. 01
3
1
1
27




.60
.46
.96
.47
.67
O3
. 17
,52
3.94
1 .60
2. 15
3O.O9
O
O
0
O
                     CONTROL COSTS  (Million  1975 $)

                     Investment

                        Existing Plants
                          On-s1te Treatment
                          Pretreatment

                        New Plants

                        Municipal Investment Recovery

                        Totals
      1974-77
AGGREGATED OVER

   1978-83
                                          1976-85
14. 2O (BPT)
O.OO
6.55
0.0
20.76
34.14 (BAT)
O.OO
17.56
O.O
51.70
4O.OO
O.OO
23. 04
0.0
63. 04

-------
                                                Table 4-25-1. (Continued)
                                               Secondary Aluminum Smelting
                                                  Industry Data Summary
            CONTROL  COSTS  (Million  1975 $)  -  (Continued)
                                                           COST IN YEAR
w
t
tn
Annualized Costs

Annuallzed Capital1

0&MJ
  On-s1te Treatment
  Pretreatment
  Totals

Municipal Charges

  Investment Recovery
  User Charges'
  Totals

Grand Totals
1977
2.73
6.21
0.0
6.21
1983
9.53
8.55
0,0
8.55
1985
9.92
1O. 83
O.O
1O. 83
                                                          O.O
                                                          O.O
                                                          O.O

                                                          8.94
 O.O
 0.0
 0.0

18.08
 O.O
 O.O
 O.O

2O.75
                                                                                                       1976-85

                                                                                                         57.32'
                                 78.58
                                  O.O
                                 78.58
  O.O
  O.O
  O.O

135.90
           1 Annuallzed on-s1te and pretreatment costs are computed on the assumption of a 15 year useful life
             at 1O percent Interest with zero salvage value.

           ! The decade total of annual 1 zed cost may not be relatable to the decade total of Investment because
             of the timing of .Investment expenditures over the decade.

           5 O&M costs In any year are relative to Investment made 1n the year plus all prior year Investments
             commencing in 1973.  Hence-, O&M expenditure 1n any year bears no particular relationship to the
             Investment made In that year.

           4 User charges denote the O&M component of the municipal treatment charges.  The Investment com-
             ponent Is denoted under Investment recovery.
           Note:   The Secondary Aluminum Industry Includes Ingot and wet-milling processes.

-------
in  the fire-refining process, air is introduced beneath the
molten copper  in  reverberatory  or  cylindrical  furnaces.
Sulfur  dioxide passes off as a gas, and metal oxides appear
in a slag which is skimmed off.  The remaining metal is then
deoxidized by the addition of coke and by insertion of large
poles of  green  hardwood,  which  decompose  into  reducing
gases;  alternatively,  natural  gases may be used to reduce
the cuprous oxide.  Almost all fire-refined copper  is  cast
into  anodes  for  electrolytic  refining.  In this process,
copper  is.  separated  from   impurities   by   electrolytic
dissolution  at  the anode and disposition of the pure metal
at the cathode; the electrolyte used  is  usually  a  dilute
solution of sulfuric acid and copper sulfate.

Waste  Sources  and Pollutants.  The primary copper industry
generates  wastewater  in   the   following   processes   or
operations:

  1. Slag granulation, i.e. spraying molten slag  with  jets
     of water to produce slag granules.

  2. Slowdown from the sulfuric acid plants used to  control
     sulfur dioxide emissions.

  3. Water used to cool fire-refined copper,  anode  copper,
     shot  copper,  and  various  forms  of  cathode  copper
     casting.

  4. Refining  operations  such   as   disposal   of   spent
     electrolyte,  electrolytic refinery washing, and slimes
     recovery.

  5. Miscellaneous  operations   such   as   blowdown   from
     scrubbing  system, slurry overflow from dust collection
     systems, plant washdown, and byproduct scrubbing.

  6. Storm   water   run-off   commingling   with    process
     wastewaters.

Non-process  water  uses,  such as  non-contact cooling water
and  water   used   in  o.n-site  power  generation,  are  also
possible  sources  of wastewaters, but they are.not covered  in
the  effluent guidelines.

Wastewater   constituents,  which  have been determined to  be
present  in  the process wastewaters  of  the  primary  copper
industry   in   sufficient quantities to warrant their control
and  treatment, are  as  follows:    total  suspended  solids,
arsenic,   cadmium,  copper,   lead,  selenium,  zinc, oil and
grease, and  pH.   other pollutant  parameters  which  may   be
present   include   dissolved  solids, sulfate, chloride, other
                            3-257

-------
metals, cyanide, chemical  oxygen  demand,  and  temperature
(heat).

For   the   purpose  of  establishing  effluent  limitations
guidelines, the primary copper  industry  has  been  divided
into three subcategories:

  1. Primary copper smelters  including  refineries  located
     on-site with smelters.

  2. Primary copper  refineries  located  in  areas  of  net
     evaporation.

  3. Primary copper  refineries  located  in  areas  of  net
     rainfall.

The effluent limitations for the first two subcategories for
BPT,  BAT,  and NSPS guidelines are essentially no discharge
of process water pollutants into navigable waters except:

  1. A volume of wastewater equivalent to that  which  falls
     within  a  properly-designed  impoundment  in excess of
     that attributable to  a 10-year, 24-hour rainfall event.

  2. During  any  calendar month  a  volume  of  wastewater
     equivalent  to the difference between the precipitation
     for that month which  falls within the  impoundment  and
     the  evaporation  for that  month   (or  the difference
     between the  means  of  precipitation  and  evaporation
     established for the area).

Control  Technology  and   Costs.  Most of the primary copper
industry employs judicious practices to control  the  volume
of  wastewater  discharged.   Very  little,  if any, process
wastewaters are  discharged  at  most  operations.   Primary
copper   smelters,  because  of  the  integration  of  their
operations,  have   numerous   possibilities   for   process
wastewater  controls.   Refineries  with  no on-site  smelting
operations do not  have  available  all   of  these   possible
control  approaches.   The following list summarizes some of
the  alternatives  available  for  controlling   wastewaters
discharged from the principal sources in  the industry:

   1. Slag  granulation.  Conversion to slag dumping;  recycle
     and/or reuse of wastewaters.

   2. Acid  plant  blowdown.   Reuse  and   minimization   of
     blowdown  by reducing  particulate load and heat.
                            3-258

-------
  3.  Contact cooling water.   Minimizing "temperature"   bleed
     by   providing  sufficient  cooling  ponds  or  towers;
     recycling and/or reuse;  use of air cooling.

  4.  Refinery wastes.  Converting from vacuum evaporators to
     open evaporators; sale   of  spent  electrocyle-  recyle
     and/or   reuse   of   spent  electrolyte,  electrolytic
     refining  washing,  and   scrubber  waters;   reuse   of
     washdown  waters;  segregation  and  retention of storm
     water runoff.

The treatment of wastewater streams prior  to  discharge  in
the primary copper industry normally includes neutralization
and  precipitation,  additional  chemical precipitation, and
oil  and  grease  removal  by  skimming   where   necessary.
Advanced  technologies  with  possible  applications include
reverse   osmosis,   ion   exchange,   evaporation,   carbon
adsorption, deep-well disposal, and fixation as a solid.

The  control  technologies  recommended  for  primary copper
smelters and  for primary copper refineries in areas  of  net
evaporation   consist  of  the elimination of water discharge
through  the  use  of  recycling   or   reuse,   and   other
technologies,  such  as  those  listed above, and the use of
impoundment with disposal by solar evaporation.

Disposal sources, such as the reuse of process waters at on-
site  mining,  milling,  and  smelting  operations  are  not
available   to   refineries   not  provided  with  smelters.
Consequently,  control  technology   recommended    for   BPT
guidelines  consists  of  reduction  of  process  wastewater
volumes  through recycling, reuse, etc., as discussed  above,
plus   the   liming  and  settling of resultant  effluents.  To
meet BAT and  NSPS guidelines, a continued reduction   in  the
volume of process waters is recommended.

Most   of the  facilities  in   the  primary   copper industry
currently discharge  very little wastewater.

Annualized  costs  are summarized  in  Table  4-26-1.   Although
this   report  does   not  include   an   industry  summary  for
Secondary Copper,  Table  4-26-2  summarizes   industry  data,
including  investment and control  costs.
                            3-259

-------
                                                               Table 4-26-1.
                                                               Primary Copper
                                                           Industry Data Summary
                    ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                                          1977
                                                                         1983
                                                                                        1985
                      Capacity (MT/Yr)                3,362,460.     4,140,470.

                      Annual Growth Rats Over the Period 1976-1985 = 3.17%
                                                                4,186,710.
to
I
O\
O
EFFLUENTS (LOCO MT/Yr)

  1971 Controls:
     TSS
     Dissolved Sol Ids
     Oils and Greases
                      Legislated Controls:
                         TSS
                         Dissolved Sol Ids
                         011s and Greases
                                                          1977
                                                                         1983
                                                                                        1985
4
1

1


.90
.40
.05
.24
.37
.02
6.O9
1.74
• 06
.01
.01
.OO4
6,34
1.81
.06
,OO3
.OO3
.OO1
                    CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

                    Investment

                      Existing Plants
                         On-s1te Treatment
                         Pretreatment

                      New Plants

                      Municipal Investment Recovery

                      Totals
                                            1974-77
                                                           AGGREGATED OVER

                                                              1978-83
                                                                                1976-85
2.69 (BPT)
O.OO
O.86
O.O
3.54
3.18 (BAT)
O.OO
3.S6
O.O
6.74
4. 17
O.OO
3.65
O.O
7.82

-------
                                                  Table 4-26-1. (Continued)
                                                       Primary Copper
                                                    Industry Data Summary
CO

to
CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $) - (Continued)

Annualized Costs

Annual 1 zed Capital*

O&M3
  On-s i te Treatment
  Pretreatment
  Totals

Municipal Charges

  Investment Recovery
  User Charges*
  Totals

Grand Totals

1977
O.47
1 .95
O.O
1 .95
COST
IN YEAR
1983
1 ,
3.
O,
3.
.35
.20
.O
20


1985
1 ,
7.
0.
7.
,36
19
,0
, 19


1976-85
9
34.
0.
34.
.52
.94
,0
94
                                                            O.O
                                                            0.0
                                                            O.O

                                                            2.42
O.O
O.O
O.O

4.56
0.0
O.O
O.O

8.55
 O.O
 O.O
 O.O

44.47
              1 Annual1zed on-site and pretreatment costs are computed on the assumption of a 15 year useful life
               at 1O percent  interest with zero salvage value.

              ' The decade total of annualized cost may not be relatable to the decade total of investment because
               of the timing  of investment expenditures over the decade.

              3 O&M costs in any year are  relative to investment made in the year plus all prior year investments
               commencing in  1973.  Hence, O&M expenditure in any year bears no particular relationship to the
               investment made 1n that year.

              * User charges denote the O&M component of the municipal treatment charges.  The Investment com-
               ponent is denoted under investment recovery.
             Note:   The Primary Cooper industry Includes ore smelting processes and refining operations.

-------
                                                           Table 4-26-2.
                                                          Secondary Copper
                                                       Industry Data Summary
                ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                                      1977
                                                                     1983
                                                                                    1985
                  Capacity (MT/Yr)                1,224,260.      1,555,270.

                  Annual  Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-1985 =3.68%
                                                                1,591,780.
w
I
to
EFFLUENTS (1.OOO MT/Yr)

  1971 Controls:
     TSS
     D1sso1ved So11ds
     011s & Greases
                  Legislated Controls:
                     TSS
                     Dissolved Sol Ids
                     Oils & Greases
                                                      1977
                                                                     1983
                                                                                    1985
56.16
8. 2O
0.23
13.98
2.O4
0.06
69.69
10. 18
0.28
O.O
O.O
0.0
72.66
1Q.61
O.29
O.O
O.O
O.O
                CONTROL  COSTS (Million 1975 $)

                Investment

                  Existing  Plants
                     On-s1te Treatment
                     Pr^etreatment

                  New Plants

                  Municipal  Investment Recovery

                  Totals
                                            1974-77
                                                           AGGREGATED OVER

                                                              1978-83
                                                                                1976-85
9.03 (BPT)
O.OO
0.9O
O.O
9.92
O.O (BAT)
O.OO
3.92
O.O
3.92
3.43
O.OO
4.O7
O.O
7.5O

-------
                                                  Table 4-26-2, (Continued)
                                                       Secondary Copper
                                                    Industry Data Summary
w
to
o>
CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $) - (Continued)

Annual!zed Costs

AnnualIzed Capital'

O&M1
  On-s1te Treatment
  Pretreatment
  Totals

Municipal Charges

  Investment Recovery
  User Charges*
  Totals

Grand Totals

1977
1 .30
€.82
O,O
6.82
O.O
O.O
O.O
COST IN YEAR
1983
1 .82
9.71
O.O
9.71
O.O
O.O
0.0

1985
1.84
9.81
O.O
9.81
O.O
O.O
O.O

1976-85
16. O61
87.86
O.O
87.86
O.O
O.O
O.O
                                                            8.12
                                                                          11.53
11 .65
                 1O3.93
               Annual 1zed on-s1te and pretreatment costs are.computed on the assumption of a 15 year useful life
               at 1O percent Interest with zero salvage value.

               The decade total  of annual1zed cost may not be relatable to the decade total  of Investment because
               of the timing of  Investment expenditures over the decade.

               O&M costs 1n any  year are relative to Investment  made In the year plus all  prior  year investments
               commencing in 1973.  Hence,  O&M expenditure in any year  bears  no particular relationship to  the
               investment made in that year.

               User charges denote the O&M component of the municipal  treatment charges.   The  investment  com-
               ponent Is denoted under Investment recovery.

-------
PRIMARY LEAD INDUSTRY

Production Characteristics and Capacities.  The primary  lead
industry  includes establishments that are primarily engaged
in smelting lead from  ore  and  in  refining  lead  by  any
process.  Those establishments that are primarily engaged  in
the  mining or milling of ores, and in rolling, drawing, and
extruding lead are not Included in this industrial category.

primary lead in the United States is recovered entirely  from
sulfide ores, which  are  associated  with  other  minerals,
principally  zinc,:copper, and silver.  The sequence of  lead
smelting and  refining  processes  are:  charge  preparation
(blending  of  the  concentrate  with  flux and a variety  of
recycling products, including dust from collection  systems,
fumes, etc.), pellitzing, sintering, blast furnace smelting,
and  the  subsequent  refining  operations to remove,  and  in
some cases recover, metallic impurities.  In  the  sintering
process, the pellets of ore concentrate are burned to  remove
sulfur  and  other  impurities,  and  to produce ."sinter"  of
suitable size and strength for subsequent treatment  in  the
blast  furnace.  By a combination of heat and reducing gases
in the blast furnace, the sinter, recycled slag,  etc.,  are
separated  into  two  constituent  phases:  molten metal and
slag.  The metals that are easily  reduced,  such  as  lead,
copper, silver, gold, bismuth, antimony, and arsenic,  become
part  of  the  metal  phase.  -Refining  operations include:
dressing, the cooling of the  molten  lead  so  that   excess
copper  floats  to  the  surface-  softening,  either  by air
oxidation or by slag oxidation to remove antimony; and  fire
refining methods, where the molten lead is treated with  zinc
or  with  calcium  and  magnesium  to form gold, silver, and
bismuth compounds which float to-the surface.

The primary  lead industry consists  of  five  domestic  lead
smelters and  five refineries, three of which are located on-
site with smelters.

The  major uses of lead in the United States are as follows:
batteries-36 percent, gasoline additives-19 percent,   alloys
and  miscellaneous-27  percent,  pipe  and  sheet-4 percent,
pigments-9 percent, and cable-5  percent.   Lead  'useage   is
heavily dependent upon the automobile industry.  At present,
the  continued  use  of  ackyl-lead  compounds  as  gasoline
additives is  in question; this market  might  eventually  be
eliminated.   Basically,  lead  has - no  substitutes   in its
numerous alloy, pipe, and sheet uses; its  growth  in- these
markets  is   closely  tied to the .growth of the construction
industry.
                            3-264

-------
Waste Sources and  Pollutants.   The  principal  sources  of
wastewaters from the primary lead industry are as follows:

  •  Slowdown from the sulfuric acid plants used to  control
     sulfur  dioxide  emissions  from , sintering  operations
     (three plants).

  •  Streams from blast  furnace slag, speiss,  and/or  dross
     granulation.   Molten  slag, dross, etc., is granulated
     by impacting the molten  stream  with  a  high-pressure
     water   jet.    Usually   the  wastewater  streams   are
     intermittent  overflows  or  bleed   streams    from    a
     recirculating water  system (five plants).

  •  wastewaters from wet scrubber  equipment  used  in   the
     control of air pollution (four plants).

various  applications  of non-contact cooling water  are also
found  in  primary'  lead  smelters,  but  these  non-contact
streams   are   not  covered  by  the  effluent  limitations
guidelines.

A broad range of pollutants  are  found  in  the  wastewater
streams  from  primary   lead  smelters  and  refiners.    The
following pollutants have been found to occur in  sufficient
quantities  to  warrant   their  control and treatment; total
suspended solids, cadmium,  mercury,  lead,  zinc,   and   pK.
Other  pollutants  that   may  be  present  include   arsenic,
chemical oxygen demand,  cyanide, oil and grease, temperature
(heat),   dissolved   chlorides,    fluorides,    phosphates,
carbonates, calcium, magnesium, bismuth, and other metals.

Control  Technology and  Costs.  Wastewater pollution control
practices in the primary lead industry consist of in-process
controls  designed  to   reduce  the  volume  of   wastewater
discharged  and end-of-pipe systems to treat the wastewaters
before discharge.  Control practices currently used  in   the
industry  to reduce water discharges include: segregation of
waste streams, recycling slag granulation water, recycle  and
reuse scrubber water, and good housekeeping  provisions   for
the  control  of  leaks  and spills, stormwater run-off, pond
failure,  etc.-  Wastewater  treatment  technology   normally
involves  lime  precipitation  of   heavy metals.  Additional
treatment methods which  could be employed include:   hydrogen
sulfide  treatment  to   precipitate  heavy  metals,  reverse
osmosis  to remove ionic  materials,  and evaporation.

The  effluent  limitations guidelines  for  the  primary  lead
industry  are  based  upon maximum use of water recycling  and
reuse plus the treatment of discharged wastewaters   by  lime
neutralization and  clarification.
                            3-265

-------
Five  of  the seven plants in the primary lead industry have
either already achieved no discharge of  process  wastewater
pollutants,  or  are  very near and anticipate reaching this
goal.   The  two  plants   currently   discharging   process
wastewater  are  geographically  located  in  areas  of  net
precipitation  and  operate  metallurgical  sulfuric   acid
plants.

Annualized costs are detailed in Table 4-27-1.
                           3-266

-------
                                                             Table  4-27-1.
                                                               Primary  Lead
                                                          Industry Data Summary
                  ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                                         1977
                                                                        1983
                                                                                       1985
                    Capacity  (MT/Yr)                 1.653.O65.     2.O51.26O.

                    Annual Growth Rate Over the Period  1976-1985 = 3.44%
                                                                2,128,640.
Oi
EFFLUENTS (1.OOO MT/Yr)

  1971 Controls:
     TSS
     Dissolved Sol Ids
                    Legislated Controls:
                       TSS
                       Dissolved Sol ids
                                                         1977
                                                                        1983
                                                                                       1985
O.O2
O.O1
O.O1
O.O04
O.O3
O.O1
O.O1
O.OO3
O.O3
O.O1
O.O1
O.OO3
                  CONTROL COSTS  (Million  1975 $)

                  Investment

                    Existing Plants
                       On-slte Treatment
                       Pretreatment

                    New Plants

                    Municipal Investment Recovery

                    Totals
                                            1974-77
                                                           AGGREGATED OVER

                                                              1978-83
                                                                                1976-85
2.52 (BPT)
O.OO
0.15
0.0
2.67
O.O (BAT)
O.OO
1.95
0.0
1 .95
1. 16
O.OO
2,16
O.O
3.31

-------
                                                    Table 4-27-1.  (Continued)
                                                           Primary Lead
                                                      Industry Data Summary
to
CT\
oo
CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $) - (Continued)

Annualized Costa

Annuallzed Capital

O&M3
  On-s1te Treatment
  Pretreatment
  Totals

Municipal Charges

  Investment Recovery
  User Charges4
  Totals

Grand Totals

1977
0 • 35
3.74
O.O
3.74
COST- IN YEAR
1983
O.61
4.68
0.0
4.68

1985
O.63
5.02
O.O
5. 02

1.976-85
4.98*
43.23
O.O
43.23
                                                              O.O
                                                              O.O
                                                              0.0

                                                              4.09
O-O
0.0
0.0

5.28
O.O
O.O
O.O

5.66
 O.O
 O.O
 O.O

48.21
               1  Annualized on-site and pretreatment costs are computed on the assumption of  a 15  year  useful  life
                 at 1O percent Interest with zero salvage value.

               2  The decade total  of annualized cost may not be relatable to the decade total  of  investment  because
                 of the timing of  investment expenditures over the decade.

               3  O&M costs in any  year are relative to investment  made in the year plus all prior  year  investments
                 commencing in 1973.   Hence,  O&M expenditure in any year bears no particular  relationship to the
                 investment made 1n that year.

               *  User charges denote the O&M component of the municipal  treatment charges.  The investment com-
                 ponent  is denoted under investment recovery.
               Note:    The Primary Lead industry includes ore smelting and refining processes.

-------
PRIMARY ZINC INDUSTRY

Production Characteristics and Capacities.  The primary zinc
industry  consists  of  establishments  that  are  primarily
engaged in smelting zinc from ore or in refining zinc by any
process.  Establishments that are primarily engaged  in  the
mining  of  zinc ore, or the rolling, drawing, and extruding
of zinc are not included.  The U.S.  primary  zinc  industry
includes  both  electrolytic  and  pyrometallurgical  retort
plants.  Processes involved.in the smelting and refining,  of
zinc  include  roasting, sintering, reduction, and refining.
in the roasting operation, the zinc concentrate is heated in
an oxidizing atmosphere to burn off sulfur, lead, and  other
impurities.   For  pyrolytic  or  retort plants, roasting is
followed  by  sintering  in  which  the  roasting   product,
calcine,  is  heated together with various residues and zinc
oxide materials to further reduce impurities and to  produce
a  more  compact  feed  for  the  retort  furnaces.   In the
reduction process, heating  of  the  sinter  in  a  reducing
atmosphere  removes  most  of  the zinc oxide.  Refining the
zinc includes processes that are designed to further  purify
the  zinc;  for  example, by reducing the temperature of the.
molten  zinc  so  that  iron  and  lead  precipitate  or  by
distillation of the molten zinc.

For  the  electrolytic  reduction  of zinc, sintering is not
necessary.  However, acid washing of the zinc concentrate is
necessary  before  roasting  to  remove  magnesia.    Before
reduction,  the  calcine  from  roasting is leached with the
spent sulfuric acid electrolyte to dissolve the zinc and  to
precipitate  impurities.   The  purified  solution  is  then
introduced into electrolytic cells where zinc  is  deposited
from  the  solution onto aluminum cathodes- the zinc cathode
is then washed and sent to the casting plant.

The zinc industry is comprised  of   four  electrolytic  (one
recently   converted)  and  three  pyrometallurgical  retort
plants.  U.S. production of zinc has declined  from  916,977
metric  tons  in 1967, to 562,340 metric tons in  1974.  Half
of the  14 plants operating  in  1969 have closed; however, one
plant in Illinois reopened  in  1973  and  additional  p-lant
capacity  is expected.  The retort plant in Amarillo, Texas,
is  scheduled   to  close,   but  two  new  plants  have  befeh
announced.

Waste   Sources and Pollutants.  Two  major sources of process
wastewaters have .been  identified as  common to all plants   in
the primary zinc industry:

   •  Slowdown  from the sulfuric acid plants  used  to   control
     emissions of  sulfur dioxide  from roasting operations-
                            3-269

-------
  »  Metal casting cooling water.

Other sources of  wastewaters  identified  for  some  plants
include:  scrubber  water  used  to  wash gases emitted  from
pyrolytic reduction  furnaces,  spent  liquor  from  cadmium
leaching, and scrubber water from dust control streams.  The
industry  also  uses  a  great  deal  of non-contact cooling
water, but these wastewater streams are not covered  by  the
guidelines.

The wastewater parameters which have been determined for the
process wastewaters of the primary zinc industry and warrant
control  and treatment are.- total suspended solids, arsenic,
cadmium, mercury, selenium, zinc, and pH.   Other  pollutant
parameters  which  also may be considered include: dissolved
solids,  chemical  oxygen  demand,  lead,  nicKel,   copper,
cyanide, and temperature (heat).

Control   Technology   and  costs.   The  current  treatment
practices applied  to  process  wastewater  streams  in  the
primary  zinc  industry  include both settling and lime-and-
settle of either segregated unit process  streams  or  total
plant  effluents.   control  measures currently used include
recycling  with   bleed-off   and   reuse   of   wastewater.
Additional  treatment  methods  that  could  be employed for
further reduction of pollutants  include:  hydrogen  sulfide
treatment for further precipitation of heavy metals, reverse
osmosis  to  concentrate   ionic  materials, evaporation, and
chemical fixation,

BPT guidelines are: the minimization of discharge or process
wastewater recycling, reuse, or  segregation-  and  chemical
treatment  to  achieve controlled precipitation, followed  by
sedimentation (lime and settle).   Specifically  recommended
control measures include:

   1.  The minimization of acid plant blowdown by  appropriate
      proper   operation  of  prescrubber  gas  and  cleaning
      facilities  to minimize particulate   loadings  into  the
      wet  scrubbers,  cooling  capacity   and  provisions for
      settling in the scrubber liquor  recycle  circuit,  and
      possible  reuse  of   the scrubber bleed stream in other
      plant operations.

   2.  The  minimization  of metal  casting   cooling   water
      discharge   by  recycling, possibly including provisions
      in the circuit for removal of suspended solids, oil and
      grease, and thermal loads.

   3.  The exploitation of the  evaporative capacity  of  hot
      gases or hot metal  for in-plarit disposal of wastewater.
                            3-270

-------
Technology  recommended to meet BAT and NSPS is analogous to
the above  technology,  and  includes  control  measures  to
further minimize the volume of process wastewater streams by
additional recycling, reuse, segregation and the application
of  chemical  treatment to achieve controlled precipitation,
followed by sedimentation.

One plant in the primary zinc industry has already  achieved
no  discharge  of  wastewater pollutants and another is very
close to closure, of the remaining plants,  four  have  lime
and settle treatment systems.

Annualized costs are summarized in Table 4-28-1.
                            3-271

-------
                                                              Table 4-28-1.
                                                               Primary Zinc
                                                          Industry Data Summary
                   ACT-IVITY LEVEL
                                                         1977
                                                                        1983
                                                                                       1985
                     Capacity (MT/Yr)                1,731,999.      2,177,36a.

                     Annual Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-1985 = 3.46%
                                                                2,239,200.
to
to
^j
to
EFFLUENTS (1.OOO MT/Yr)

  1971 Controls:
     TSS
     Dissolved Solids
                                                         1977
                                                          0.74
                                                          1.15
1983
 0.9O
 1.4O
1985
 O.95
 1 .46
                     Legislated Controls:
                        TSS
                        Dissolved Sol ids
                                       0.31
                                       0.29
 0.18
 0.02
 0. 16
 O.O3
                   CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

                   Investment

                     Existing Plants
                        On-s1te Treatment
                        Pretreatment

                     New Plants

                     Municipal  Investment Recovery

                     Totals
                                            1974-77
      AGGREGATED OVER

         1978-83
                                                                                1976-85
7.18 (BPT)
O.OO
0.64
O.O
7.82
9.38 (BAT)
O.OO
5. 19
O.O
14.57
12.27
O.OO
5.54
O.O
17.81

-------
                                     Table 4-28-1. (Continued)
                                            Primary Zinc
                                       Industry Data Summary
CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $) - (Continued)

Annualized Costs

Annual 1zed Capital1

0&M"
  On-site Treatment
  Pretreatment
  Totals

Municipal Charges

  Investment Recovery
  User Charges*
  Totals

Grand Totals

1977
1 .03
2.81
0.0
2.81
COST IN YEAR
1983
2.94,
4.57
0.0
4.57

1985
2.99
10. 48
O.O
10.48

1976-85
19.89'
49.48
0.0
49.48
0.0
0.0
0.0

3.84
0.0
0.0
0.0

7.52
 O.O
 O.O
 O.O

13.47
 O.O
 O.O
 O.O

69.37
  Annual 1zed on-site and pretreatment costs are computed on the assumption of a 15 year useful  life
  at 10 percent interest with zero salvage value.

  The decade total of annualized cost may not be relatable to the decade total  of Investment because
  of the timing of Investment expenditures over the decade.

  O&M costs in any year are relative to investment made in the year plus all  prior year investments
  commencing in 1973.  Hence, O&M expenditure in any year bears no particular relationship to the
  investment made in that year.

  User charges denote the O&M component of the municipal treatment charges.   The investment com-
  ponent is denoted under investment recovery.
Note:   The Primary 21nc industry includes ore smelting and refining processes.

-------
ASBESTOS MANUFACTURING INDUSTRY

Production  Characteristics  and  Capacities.  There were 68
plants operating  in the asbestos manufacturing  industry  in
1972.   A majority of these asbestos plants incur wastewater.
during production.

with the exception of roofing and floor tile  manufacturing,
there  is a basic similarity in the manufacturing methods of
various asbestos  products.  The asbestos  fibers  and  other
raw  materials  are slurried with water and then formed into
sheets.   Save-alls   (settling  tanks}  are  used   in   all
processes.    In   roofing manufacture, asphalt or coal tar is
soaked into asbestos  paper.   in  floor  tile  manufacture,
asbestos  is  added  to the tiles for its special structural
and dimension-holding qualities.

Asbestos cement products are the  largest  overall  user  of
asbestos  fibers, and cement pipe is the largest producer in
th'is category.  Asbestos sheet is used for laboratory  table
tops   and    other  structural  uses.   Asbestos  paper  and
millboard  have   a  great  variety  of  uses,  but   it   is
particularly  used, for applications where direct contact with
high  temperatures  occur.  Asbestos roofing and floor tiles
are essentially fabricated products that take  advantage  of
the unique qualities of asbestos.

A  favorable  trade  balance  may  be projected for asbestos
products, regardless of any price effects resulting from the
effluent standards.  However, there has been a recent  trend
towards  an   increase  in  the  value  of  imports,  with an
increase from $8.8 million in 1969 to $11.3 million in 1972.

Waste Sources and Pollutants. Asbestos manufacturing  wastes
include: total suspended solids, BOD5, COD, pH {alkalinity},
high   temperature,   total   dissolved   solids,  nitrogen,
phosphorous,  phenols,  toxic  materials,  oil  and  grease,
organic matter, nutrients, color, and turbidity.

The  major source of industry wastewater is the machine that
converts slurry into the formed wet product.  Water is  used
as:  an  ingredient, a carrying medium, for cooling, and for
auxilliary  uses  such  as  pump  seals,  wet  saws  or  for
pressure-testing  the  pipes.  In most plants, wastewater is
combined  and discharged  into  a  single  sewer.    In  all
subcategories,  water is removed during various steps to the
save-all system (settling tank).  Waste characteristics  are
defined  by the following parameters: total suspended solids
(TSS), COD, and pH.
                           3-274

-------
Municipal discharge by subcategories is as follows:  pipe-21
percent,  sheet-46  percent,  paper-42 percent, millboard-57
percent, roofing-44 percent,  and  floor  tiles-54  percenti
Total   discharge  by  subcategories  is:  pipe-11 x 10'lpd,
sheet-7 x 10*lpd,  paper-20 x 10*lpd,.  millboard-5 x 10'lpd,
roofing-2.2 x 10«lpd, and floor-tile-7.4 x 10«lpd.

Control  Technology  and Costs, .waste treatment methods used
in the asbestos industry are summarized in Table 4-29-1.

A recent analysis of costs  for this sector was conducted  by
Gianessi  and  Peskin  (G&P)*.   This  study  was  conducted
independently and subsequent to the general  data  gathering
efforts  associated  with   the SEAS uniform cost calculation
procedure.  However, time and resource constraints prevented
incorporating these costs into the scenario  analyses  using
the  SEAS model procedure.  The G&P estimates are as follows
(in million 1975 dollars):

  Incremental BPT Investment    $1.4
  Incremental BPT O&M           $0.2

Estimates from the earlier  SEAS  calculation  are  presented
below,  with  projected pollutant discharges associated with
these costs.   Principal  reasons  for  differences  between
these   cost  estimates  and the newer data are the  levels of
discharge to municipal treatment systems.  The sources using
municipal treatment  incur a lower capital  cost  requirement
(municipal  investment  recovery)  than do plants  having on-
site treatment.
   Gianessi,  L.  P.  and H.  M.  Peskin,  "The Cost to Industries
   of  the Water  Pollution  Control  Amendment  of 1972",
   National Bureau  of Economic Research,  December,  1975.
   (Revised January,  1976)
                            3-275

-------
                       Table 4-29-1.
              Asbestos Manufacturing industry
                  Haste Treatment Methods
Subcategories

Asbestos Cement
Pipe
  BPT
  BAT
  NSPS
Asbestos Cement
Sheet
  BPT
  BAT
  NSPS
Sedimentation &
Neutralization
      x

      x
                          Sedimenation &
                          Coagulation
Asbestos Paper
  BPT
  BAT
  NSPS
complete
Recycle
                           x
                           X
                        Complete
                        Recycle
Millboard
  BPT
  BAT
  NSPS
                           X
                           X
                          Sedimentation         Complete Recycle
                          (Elastomeric binder)   Starch binder)
                           X
                           X
                           X
                          Sedimentation S,
                          SKimming
Roofing
  BPT
  BAT
  NSPS
Floor Tile
  BPT
  BAT
  NSPS
                        Complete
                        Recycle
                           X
                           X
                           X
                           X
                           3-276

-------
                                                               Table 4-29-2.
                                                           Asbestos Manufacturing
                                                           Industry Data Summary
to
                    ACTIVITY LEVEL

                      Capacity  (MT/Day) Phase  I
                                (Liters/Day) Phase  II
EFFLUENTS (1,000 MT/Yr)

  1971 Controls:
     TSS
     BOOS
     COD~
     Dissolved Sol Ids
     Bases

  Legislated Controls:
     TSS
     BOD5
     COD
     Dissolved Sol Ids
     Bases

CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

Phase I

Investment

  Existing Plants
     On-s1te Treatment
     Pretreatment

  New Plants

  Municipal Investment Recovery

  Totals
                                                           1977
                                                                         1983
                                                                                        1985
21,595
217,424
I 1976-1985 = 3.
1977
0.97
O.O9
O.OO1
13. 05
3.67
O.59
O.09
O.OO1
14.30
1 .01

1974-77
4.64
0.00
O.3O
0.0
4.94
26,956.
333, 81O.
18%
1983
1.22
0. 11
O.OO1
16.34
4.6O
O. 13
O.O3
0
4. 18
0


(BPT)



27 , 6O4
341 ,825

1985
1.28
O. 12
O.OO1
17.09
4.81
O
0
0
0
O
AGGREGATED OVER
1978-83
O.O8 (BAT)
O.OO
1.36
O.OO
1.44






1976-85
2.08
O.OO
1 .40
O.OO
3.48

-------
                                                     Table 4-29-2,  (Continued)
                                                       Asbestos Manufacturing
                                                       Industry Data Summary
-4
00
CONTROL COSTS (M1U1on 1975 $) - (Continued)

Phase I (Continued)

Annual1zed Costs

Annualized Capital1

O&M1
  On-s1te Treatment
  Pretreatment
  Totals

Municipal  Charges

  Investment Recovery
  User Charges*
  Totals

Grand Totals
                                                                           COST IN YEAR
1977
O.65
2.47
O.O
2.47
0.0
O.O
0.0
1983
O.66
3.81
O.O
3.81
0,0
O.O
O.O
1985
O.68
6.92
0.0
6.92
0.0
0.0
O.O
1976-85
3.69
38.14
O.O
38.14
0.0
0.0
O.O
                                                               3. 12
                                                                              4.47
                                                                                             7.6O
                                                                                                              41 .65
                1  Annual 1zed on-s1te and pretreatment costs are computed on the assumption of a 15 year useful  life
                  at 1O percent Interest with zero salvage value.

                '  The decade total of annual1zed cost may not be relatable to the decade total  of Investment because
                  of the timing of Investment expenditures over the decade.

                '  O&M costs 1n any year are relative to Investment made 1n the year plus all  prior year Investments
                  commencing In 1973.  Hence, O&M expenditure In any year bears no particular relationship to the
                  Investment made 1n that year.

                4  User charges denote the O&M component of the municipal treatment charges.  The Investment com-
                  ponent 1s denoted under investment recovery.

                Note:   The Asbestos Industry Includes the production of roofing and floor tile, sheet materials, and
                        cement products.

-------
u>
I
N>
^1
VO
CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

Phase II

Investment

  Existing Plants
     On-slte Treatment
     Pretreatment

  New Plants

  Municipal Investment Recovery

  Totals



Anriuallzed Costs

Annual!zed Capital1

O&M'
  On-slte Treatment
  Pretreatment
  Totals

Municipal Charges

  Investment Recovery
  User Charges'
  Totals
                                                     Table 4-29-2.  (Continued)
                                                       Asbestos Manufacturing
                                                       Industry Data Summary
                                                            1974-77
                                                                           AGGREGATED OVER
                                                                              1978-83
                                                                                                1976-85
O.26
O.OO
O.24
O.O
0.5O

1977
0.07
0.04
O.O
O.04
O.O
0.0
O.O
(BPT) O.08 (BAT)
O.OO
O.O2
O.O
O.1O
COST IN YEAR
1983
O.O8
O.O6
0.0
0.06
O.O
O.O
0.0
O.O8
O.OO
O.O2
O.O
O.1O

1985
O.08
O. 1O
O.O
O. 1O
0.0
0.0
0.0





1976-85
O.72'
O.6O
O.O
O.6O
O.O
O.O
O.O
               Grand  Totals
                                                              0.11
                                                                             O. 13
                                                                             O. 18
                                                                                                              1 .33

-------
                                                   Table 4-29-2. (Continued)
                                                     Asbestos Manufacturing
                                                     Industry Data Summary
i
{£             Phase II (Continued)
O
                Annual 1zed on-slte and pretreatment costs are computed on the assumption of a 15 year useful life
                at 1O percent Interest with zero salvage value.

                The decade total of annualIzed cost may not be relatable to the decade total of Investment because
                of the timing of. Investment expenditures over the decade.

                O&M costs 1n any year are relative to investment made in the year plus all prior year Investments
                commencing 1n 1973.  Hence, O&M expenditure 1n any year bears no particular relationship .to the
                Investment made 1n that year.

                User charges denote the 08>M component of the municipal treatment charges.  The Investment com-
                ponent 1s denoted under Investment recovery.

-------
CEMENT INDUSTRY

Production  Characteristics  and  Capacities.   The   cement
industry  is comprised of three subcategories, which operate
in two basic  manufacturing  processes,  wet  and  dry,  and
materials storage runoff:
  •  Wet process leaching plants.  The kiln dust comes  into
     direct  contact  with water in the leaching process for
     reuse and from the wet  scrubbers  that  control  stack
     emission.

  •  Non-leaching plants.  The contamination  of  water  not
     associated with the water usage.

  •  Pile materials.  Kiln  dust,  clinker,  coal  or  other
     materials that are subject to rainfall runoff.

The   raw  materials  for  cement  production  include  lime
(calcium oxide), silica, aluminum, iron, and gypsum.   Lime,
the  largest  single  ingredient,  comes   from  cement rock,
oyster shell marl, or chalk.

The wet process grinds up the raw materials with  water  and
feeds them into the kiln as a slurry.

The  dry  process  drys  the  raw materials, grinds and then
feeds them into the kiln in a dry state.

In each of these processes, there  are  three  major  steps:
grinding   and  blending,  clinker  production,  and  finish
grinding.  Clinker is a material about  the  size  of  large
marbles  that  has  been  through  the kiln but has not been
fine-ground  into finished cement.

The cement industry numbered 170 establishments in 1971 with
the typical  plant production estimated to  be 520,000 kkg per
year.

In 1973, 80.5 million metric tons were produced.  From  1967
to  1973,  production increased at a  compound annual average
r^ie of 5.3  percent,  imports have  risen  to  meet  demand,
growing from 1.0 metric tons in 1967  to 6.1 million in 1973.
Exports have increased to 454,000 metric tons in 1974.

Prices  have  increased  due  to higher production costs and
pollution  abatement costs.   Fuel  cost  increases  and  the
paper bag  shortage are expected to affect  prices.
                            3-281

-------
Waste sources and pollutants.  The main sources contributing
to  the  total  waste load come from the following: in-plant
leakage, non-contact steam  cooling  water,  process  water,
kiln   dust   piles  runoff  water,  housekeeping,  and  wet
scrubbers.

In order to  define  waste  characteristics,  the  following
basic parameters were used to develop guidelines for meeting
BPT  and  BAT:   pH, total dissolved solids, total suspended
solids,  alkalinity,  potassium,  sulfate,  and  temperature
(heat).

BPT  for  plants  in  the  non-leaching subcategory has been
defined as no discharge  of  pollutants  from  manufacturing
except  for  high  temperature  where  an increase of 3°C is
permitted.

For plants in the leaching  subcategory,  BPT  is  the  same
except for the dust-contact streams where reduction of pH to
9.0  and  suspended  solids to 0.4 kgAkg of dust leached is
required.  For plants  subject  to  the  provisions  of  the
Materials  Storage  Piles  Runoff  Subcategory,  either  the
runoff should be  contained  to  prevent  discharge  or  the
runoff  should be treated to neutralize and reduce suspended
solids.

BAT for both leaching and non-leaching plants is defined  as
no  discharge  of  pollutants.   For  plants  subject to the
provisions   of   the   Materials   Storage   Piles   Runoff
Subcategory, the definition of BPT is applied to BAT.

NSPS  is  the  same  as  BPT  except  that  no  discharge is
permitted for plants with materials storage pile runoff.

Control  Technology  and  Costs.   The  main   control   and
treatment  methods  for  the cement industry involve recycle
and reuse  of  wastewater.   The  devices  employed  include
cooling  towers  or ponds, seizing ponds, containment ponds,
and clarifiers.

For leaching  plants,  additional  controls  are  needed  to
adequately   control   alkalinity,   suspended  solids,  and
dissolved   solids.     Alkalinity    is    controlled    by
neutralization,   or   carbonation;   suspended   solids  by
clarification, sometimes with the addition  of  flocculating
agents.   Although none of the leaching plants currently use
a treatment method  to  control  dissolved  solids,  several
processes   that  might  be  employed  include  evaporation,
precipitation,    ion     exchange,     reverse     osmosis,
electrodialysis, and combinations of these.
                           3-282

-------
In-plant   control  methods  include  good  maintenance  and
operating procedures  to  minimize  solid  spillage  and  to
return  dry  dust  to  the  process.  Solids introduced into
storm water runoff can be  minimized  by  paving  areas  for
vehicular traffic, providing good ground cover in other open
areas,  and  removing  accumulations  of dust from roofs and
buildings, and by building  ditches  and  dikes  to  control
runoff from materials storage piles.

A  recent analysis of costs for this sector was conducted by
Gianessi  and  Peskin  (G&P)1.   This  study  was  conducted
independently  and  subsequent to the general data gathering
efforts associated with the SEAS  uniform  cost  calculation
procedure.  However, time and resource constraints prevented
incorporating  these  costs into the scenario analyses using
the SEAS model procedure.  The G&P estimates are as  follows
(in million 1975 dollars):

  Incremental BPT Investment    $39.1
  Incremental BPT O&M           $ 6.0

Estimates from the earlier SEAS  calculation  are  presented
below,  with  projected pollutant discharges associated with
these costs.  As can be noted, both estimates are within  an
acceptable  range  of  computational  variance.   Some minor
difference, however, may be attributed to model  plant  cost
assumptions.
 1 Gianessi,  L.  P.  and  H.  M.  Peskin,  "The  Cost  to  Industries
  of  the  Water  Pollution  Control  Amendment  of  1972",
  National Bureau  of Economic Research, December,  1975.
  (Revised January,  1976)
                            3-283

-------
                                                                  Table 4-3O-1.
                                                                     Cement
                                                              Industry Data Summary
t*>
I
00
                       ACTIVITY LEVEL
                         Capacity (MT/Day)
EFFLUENTS (1.0OO MT/Yr)

  1971 Controls:
     TSS
     Dissolved Sol Ids
     Bases
                         Legislated Controls:
                            TSS
                            Dissolved Sol Ids
                            Bases
1977
80,605.
1977
34.27
75.21
17.87
23.73
58.42
9.98
1983
98 . 3 1 3 .
1983
43. 15
94.72
22.50
5.71
14.95
2.06
1985
101,915.
1985
45.38
99.61
23.66
0
O
O
                       CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

                       Investment

                         Existing  Plants
                            On-s1te Treatment
                            Pretreatment

                         New Plants

                         Municipal  Investment Recovery

                         Totals
                                            1974-77
                                                           AGGREGATED OVER

                                                              1978-83
                                                                                1976-85
35.91 (BPT)
O.OO
5.37
0.0
41 .28
5.83 (BAT)
O.OO
12.27
0.0
18. 1O
21 .02
O.OO
16.08
O.O
37. 1O

-------
                                            Table 4-3O-1. (Continued)
                                                      Cement
                                              Industry Data Summary


       CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $) - (Continued)            COST IN YEAR

       Annual1zed Costs                            1977           1983           1985           1976-85

       Annual1zed Capital'                         5.43           7.81           8.O8             65.66'

       O&M'
Y»        On-slte Treatment                         7.25           9.OS          1O.48             82.O1
jU        Pretreatment                              O.O            O.O            O.O               O.O
»        Totals                                    7.25           9.05          10.48             82.01

       Municipal Charges

         Investment Recovery                       O.O          .  O.O            O.O               O.O
         User Charges'                             O.O            O.O            O.O               O.O
         Totals                                    O.O            O.O            O.O               O.O

       Grand Totals                               12.68          16.85          18.55            147.67


       1  Annual 1zed on-s1te and pretreatment costs are computed oh the assumption of a 15  year  useful  life at  1O percent interest
         with zero salvage value.

       *  The decade total of annual1zed cost may not be relatable  to the decade total of  Investment because of  the
         timing of Investment expenditures over the decade.

       1  O&M costs in any year are relative to Investment made in  the year plus all  prior  year  investments commencing 1n 1973.
         Hence, O&M expenditure 1n any year bears no particular relationship to the  Investment  made 1n that year.

       *  User charges denote the O&M component of the municipal  treatment charges.
         The Investment component is denoted under investment recovery.


       Note:   The Cement industry includes the production of cement  by  the wet and  dry or the  materials storage
               run-off process.

-------
INSULATION FIBERGLASS INDUSTRY

Production  Characteristics  ana Capacities.  The insulation
fiberglass industry has no subcategories.  The raw materials
for fiberglass production are 55-73 percent silica and 27-45
percent fluxing oxides  (e.g./  limestone  and  borates)  to
manufacture  the  fiberglass filaments, and a phenolic resin
to bind the filaments together.  Four basic types  of  glass
are  used:  low-alkali  lime alumina borosilicate, soda-lime
borosilicate, lime-free borosilicate, and soda-lime.

The basic process for fiberglass manufacture is as  follows:
the  raw  materials  batch  is  melted to form a homogeneous
glass stream (there are two ways that  the  melting  process
can  be  done:  direct  melting or marble process), then the
molten glass stream is fiberized to form  a  random  mat  of
fibers  which  are  bonded  together  with  a  thermosetting
phenolic binder or glue.  The  glass  is  fiberized  in  two
ways:  flame  attenuation and rotary spinning.  The trend in
the industry is toward more use of direct  melting  and  the
rotary spinning fiber-forming process.

The  primary  domestic  uses  for insulation fiberglass are:
insulating material, noise insulation products, air filters,
and bulk wool products.

In 1972, there were 19 plants operated  by  three  companies
involved   in  fiberglass  production.   The  typical  plant
produces 123,000  metric  tons  per  year,  and  all  plants
contribute to wastewater discharge.

In  1972,  total  fiberglass  production  amounted  to  0.77
million metric ton.  Of the $427 million  in  annual  sales,
exports  amounted  to  $8.4  million  and  imports were $0.7
million,- therefore,  foreign  trade  is  not  a  significant
portion of total consumption.

waste Sources and Pollutants.  The main sources contributing
to  total  waste  load  are  summarized in Table 4-31-1.  in
order  to  define  waste  characteristics,   the   following
parameters were chosen to develop guidelines for meeting BPT
and BAT:

  •  Phenols
  •  BOD5
  •  COD~
  •  Total Suspended Solids  (TSS)
  •  pH
                           3-286

-------
00
                                 Table 4-31-1.
                Insulation Fiberglass Industry Pollutant Sources


                                                         Oil  &                         Specific
          Waste Stream  Phenols  BODS  COD   DS    SS    Grease   Amonla    pH  Color  Turbidity Temp.  Conductance
Air
Scrubb1ng

Boiler
B1owdown

Caustic
B1owdown

Chain
Spray

Gullet
Cool1ng

Fresh Water
Treatment

Hood Spray

Noncontact
Cool1ng Water
                                             X

                                             X
X

X
X

X
                                                                               X   X
                                                                               X   X
                             X    X
          Source: EPA Development Pocument,  January 1974.

-------
Control Technology and Costs.  Because of the  large  volume
of  process  waters and the reaction of the chain wash water
to treatment and recycle, total recycling of wastewaters  is
the most economical treatment alternative for the insulation
fiberglass  industry.   Sample  recycling systems consist of
coarse filtration, followed by  either  fine  filtration  or
flocculation and settling.

A  'recent analysis of costs for this sector was conducted by
Gianessi  and  Peskin  (G&P}».   This  study  was  conducted
independently  and  subsequent to the general data gathering
efforts associated with the SEAS  uniform  cost  calculation
procedure.  However, time and resource constraints prevented
incorporating  these  costs into the scenario analyses using
the SEAS model procedure.  The GfiP estimates are as  -follows
(in million 1975 dollars)!

  Incremental BPT Investment    $15.0
  incremental BPT O&M           $ 2.6

Estimates from the earlier SEAS  calculation  are  presented
below,  with  projected pollutant discharges associated with
these costs.  As can be noted, both estimates are within  an
acceptable range of computational variance.
  Gianessi, L. P. and H. M. Peskin, "The Cost to industries
  of the water Pollution Control Amendment of 1972",
  National Bureau of Economic Research, December, 1975.
  (Revised January, 1976)
                           3-288

-------
                                                           Table 4-31-2,
                                                       Insulation Fiberglass
                                                       Industry Data Summary
                ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                                      1977
                                                                     1983
                                                                                    1985
                  Capacity (Million kg/Yr)             912.         1,132.

                  Annual Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-1985 = 2.73%
                                                                                     136.
U>
N)
00
EFFLUENTS (LOCO MT/Yr)

  1971 Controls:
     TSS
     BOD5
     COD
     Dissolved Sol ids
                  Legislated Controls:
                     TSS
                     BODS
                     COD
                     Dissolved Sol ids
                                                      1977
                                                                     1983
                                                                                    1985
2.
2
11
9
O
O
3
2
.OS
.73
.60
.90
.58
.77
.27
.79
2.57
3.41
14.49
12.37
O
O
0
0
2.69
3.57
15. 16
12.94
O
O
O
0
                CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

                Investment

                  Existing Plants
                     On-site Treatment
                     Pretreatment

                  New Plants

                  Municipal Investment Recovery

                  Totals
                                            1974-77
AGGREGATED OVER

   1.978-83
                                                                                1976-85
16.14 (BPT)
O.OO
1 .92
0.0
18.06
11.49 (BAT)
O.OO
6.OO
0.0
17.49
18.63
O.OO
6.65
0.0
25.28

-------
                                                 Table 4-31-2.  (Continued)
                                                   Insulation Fiberglass
                                                   Industry Data Summary
I
f>>
v>
O
CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $) - (Continued)

Annualized Costs

Annualized Capital'

O&M'
  On-site Treatment
  Pretreatment
  Totals

Munclpal Charges

  Investment Recovery
  User Charges*
  Totals

Grand Totals


1977
2
5
0
5
0
O.
0
.37
.90
.0
.90
.0
.O
-O
COST
IN YEAR
1983
4
8
0
8
O
0
0
.67
.66
.0
.66
.0
.0
.O


1985
4.
15
0.
15,
O,
0.
0
.70
.62
.O
.62
.O
,O
.O


1976-85
34.
?7.
O.
87.
0.
0.
0
86'
.38
O
38
.0
,O
.0
                                                           8.28
                                                                         13.34
                                                                                        20.31
                                                                                                         122.24
            1  Annualized on-s1te and pretreatment costs are computed on the assumption of a 15 year useful  life
              at 10 percent Interest with zero salvage value.

            1  The decade total  of annualized cost may not be relatable to the decade total  of investment because
              of the timing of  investment expenditures over the decade.

            3  O&M costs in any  year are relative to investment made in the year plus all  prior year investments
              commencing in 1973.  Hence,  O&M expenditure 1n any year bears no particular relationship to the
              Investment made in that year.

            *  User charges denote the O&M component of the municipal treatment charges.   The Investment com-
              ponent is denoted under investment recovery.
            Note:    The Insulation Fiberglass industry includes the production of insulating material, noise
                    insulation processes,  and bulk wool  products.

-------
FLAT GLASS INDUSTRY

Production  Characteristics  and Capacities.  The flat glass
industry may be divided into six major  subcategories  based
on  the  processes  employed.   However, since the sheet and
rolled glass manufacturing industries do  not  contribute  a
wastewater  discharge,  they  will not be considered for the
purposes of this report.  The major division in the industry
is between primary and automotive  glass  manufacturers  and
the  processes  they use.  Automotive glass manufacture is a
fabrication process using primary glass.  The four  industry
subcategories  covered  in this study are: plate and float—
primary glass production,  and  tempering  and  lamination—
automotive glass production.

There  were  47 establishments in the flat glass industry in
1972.  Of these, it is estimated that 34 have waste  process
water.    The  plants  that  are  contributing  to  effluent
discharge produced 7,400 metric  tons  per  day  of  primary
glass  and 172,700 square meters per day of automotive glass
in 1972.

Glass is produced by combining the following raw  materials:
sand    (silica),   sodium   carbonate,   calcium  carbonate,
magnesium carbonate, and cullet (waste  glass  of  which  25
percent  can  be  reused).   The  float glass process is the
major user of these materials.

In primary glass production, the following processes  affect
wastewater   discharge:    (1) washing,    (2) batching,   and
(3) grinding and polishing.  In the production of automotive
glass, the following processes affect wastewater  discharge:
(1) seaming,  (2) grinding,  (3) drilling,  (4) cooling, and
(5) washing.

The batching process in primary glass  manufacturing  brings
together  the  raw materials and mixes them to a homogeneous
consistency.

The grinding and polishing process is used for plate, float,
and tempered glass.  This process uses either  a  single  or
twin  configuration.    (The  twin  configuration  grinds and
polishes simultaneously.)  The grinding part of the  process
uses  a slurry of sand and water which is continuously being
blown down in order to  be  recycled  and  classified  as  a
progressively    finer   grinding   medium  is  needed.   The
polishing process uses a polishing surface of  animal  felt,
and  a  polishing  medium  of water and iron oxide or cerium
                            3-291

-------
oxide slurry.  The  glass  is  reduced  15  percent   by   the
combined grinding and polishing process.

The  washing  process  is used for plate glass to remove  the
slurry,  and  in  float  glas.s  to. remove  the   protective
chemicals  coated  on  the  rollers- which prevents the glass
from getting marked.

The cooling process utilizes water for cooling   in   all   the
melting  tanks,  the  float tanks, and bathing tanks.  Water
for cooling is also used on rollers for plate glass,  to cool
the annealing lehr, bending the lehr and  in  the  tempering
process.

The  se.aming  and  drilling  processes  in  automotive glass
manufacture are basic  fabrication  processes! that   aid   in
handling and meeting product specifications.

The  tempering  process  includes  heating  and  then  rapidly
cooling the glass.

Primary glass is used for  all  architectural  and   building
requirements  and is the basic component for  fabricated flat
glass products.  Automotive  glass  is  used  primarily   for
windshields and safety glass.

In  1972,  a  total  of 2,2,2. million square meters of  primary
glass and 77 million square meters .of automotive  glass   was
produced.    It   is   estimated  that  plants   contributing
wastewater produced 7,400 metric -tons  per  day  of   primary
glass and 172,700 square meters per day of automotive glass,.

The  number  of  flat  glass  plants has increased in recent
years but plate glass  plants  have  decreased   due   to   the
greater profitability of the float glass process- u.  S. flat
glass exports are not significant.  There has been a  gradual
increase  in the amounts of imports, with imports comprising
about 21 percent  of  total  consumption.   The  demand   for
tinted  or  colored  glass for reflective architectural uses
and for tempered glass for safety applications in  buildings
is  expected to grow,  it should be noted, however, that  the
consumption  of  flat  glass  moves  with   the   level   of
residential construction and automobile manufacturing.

Waste Sources and Pollutants.  The major glass manufacturing
wastes  include:  sand, silt, clay,.grease, oil, tar, animal
and vegetable fats, fibers, sawdust, hair sewage  materials,
phosphorus,  alkaline  flow  (affecting pH) from plate glass
manufacturing and thermal pollution  (4.7°  c  over   ambient
temperature).
                           3-292

-------
The  main  sources contributing to the total waste load come
from  the  following  processes  in  each  segment  of   the
industry:   Float—washing;  Plate—batching,  grinding  and
polishing,   and   washing;   Tempered—seaming,    grinding
drilling,  cooling  and  washing  (wash-water  is  the major
source); and Laminated—cooling, seaming, and washing.

In order to  define  waste  characteristics,  the  following
parameters  were  used  to  develop  effluent guidelines for
meeting BPT and BAT: total suspended solids,  oil,  pH,  and
total phosphorus.

Effluent  limitations  and  standards of performance for new
sources  are  no  discharge  for  the  sheet   plate   glass
manufacturing   subcategory   and   best  available  control
technology for the three remaining subcategories.

At the present time, the waste from about 70 percent of  the
industry  is discharged tb municipal sewage systems, and 20-
30 percent of  the  wet  process  flat  glass  manufacturers
discharge  to  municipal  sewers.  The typical discharge for
each segment is as follows: Float-138 liters per metric ton;
Plate-45,900 liters per metric ton- Tempered-49  liters  per
square meter: and Laminated-175 liters per square meter.

Control  Technology  and  costs.   waste treatment practices
vary in each segment of the fla't glass industry.  Some use a
lagoon system with a polyelectrolyte or partial recycling of
process  water.   Others  use  no  treatment  or  have  only
eliminated  detergent  in  the  -wash water,  control methods
include: filtration, filtration and recycle,  total ! recycle
with  a  reverse  osmosis unit, coagulation sedimentation, a
two-stage   lagoon   with    mixing    fcanfc     for    proper
polyelectrolytic  dispersion,-  an oil absorbing diatomaceous
earth filter ^and sludge dewatering by centrifugation.

The guidelines for BPT call for control-and removal of total
suspended solids  (TSS), oil,'pH, and total phosphorus.   BPT
calls   for"the following control methods for each seqment of
the industry:

   •  Plate.  Two-stage lagoon with a mixing tank for proper
     polyelectrolytic dispersion.

   •  Float.  Cream separator type centrifuge for sludge
     dewatering, and. elimination of detergent use.

   •  Tempered and Laminated.  Coagulation/sedimentation.
                            3-293

-------
The BAT assesses the availability of in-process controls, as
well as calling for additional  treatment  techniques.   The
following  additional  treatment methods for each segment of
the industry are:

  •  Plate.  Add a return of filter backwash to lagoon systems.

  •  Float.  Eliminate all detergent use and add oil absorptive
     diatomaceous earth filtration.

  •  Tempered.  Add oil absorptive diatomaceous earth filtration.

  •  Laminated.  Recycle post-lamination washing and initial hot
     water rinse, gravity separation of remaining rinse waters,
     reduce detergent usage and add oil absorptive diatomaceous
     earth filtration.

A recent analysis of costs for this sector was conducted  by
Gianessi  and  Peskin  (G&P)».   This  study  was  conducted
independently and 'subsequent to the general  data  gathering
efforts  associated  with  the SEAS uniform cost calculation
procedure.  However, time and resource constraints prevented
incorporating these costs into the scenario  analyses  using
the  SEAS model procedure.  The G&P estimates are as follows

-------
                                                               Table 4-32-1,
                                                                 Flat Glass
                                                           Industry Data Summary
                    ACTIVITY  LEVEL
                                                          1977
                                                                         1983
                                                                                        1985
                      Capacity (SQM/Day)                 213,313.        279,930.

                      Annual  Growth Rate  Over the Period 1976-1985  =  4.14%
                                                                  286,77O.
I
N>
to
ui
EFFLUENTS (1.0OO MT/Yr)

  1971 Controls:
     TSS
     BOD5 (Flat Glass only)
     COD
     011s and Greases
                     'Legislated Controls:
                         TSS
                         BOD5  (Flat  Glass only)
                         COD
                         011s  and Greases
                    CONTROL  COSTS  (Million 1975  $)

                    Investment

                      Existing  Plants
                         On-s1te Treatment
                         Pretreatment

                      New Plants

                      Municipal Investment Recovery

                      Totals
                                                          1977
                                                                         1983
                                                                                       •198S
1
o
34
34
O
O
5
5
.51
.72
.22
.08
.87
.40
.55
.55
1 .
O.
43.
43.
O.
0.
0.
O.
.94
.92
89
71
34
.46
.46
. 11
2.
0.
46.
45.
o.
O.
O.
0.
O3
97
1O
92
12
47
47
08








AGGREGATED OVER






1974-77
4.67
1 .50
O.O7
O.OO
6.24


(BPT)








1978-83
3.47
O.OO
O.58
O.OO
4.O5

(BAT)




1976-85
5.81
O.OO
O.63
O.OO
6.44

-------
                                     Table 4-32-.1. (Continued)
                                             Flat Glass
                                       Industry Data Summary
CONTROL COSTS (Million  1975 $) - (Continued)

Annual Ized Costs.

Annual1zed Capital'

0&M]
  On-slte Treatment
  Pretreatment
  Totals

Municipal Charges

  Investment Recovery
  User Charges*
  Totals

Grand Totals

1977
O.75
O.36
O. 19
O.54
O.O
O.O
O.O
COST IN YEAR
1983
1 ,29
O.51
0'. 16
O.66
O.O
O.O
0.0

1985
1 .29
O.7O
0.13
O.84
O.O
O.O
O.O

1976-85
9.89'
4.79
1 .71
6. SO
0.0
O.O
0.0
                                               1 .30
                                                              1 .95
2. 13
                                                                                              16.39
 1 AnnualIzed on-s1te and pretreatment costs are computed on the assumption of a 15 year useful life
  at 10 percent Interest with zero salvage value.

 1 The decade total of annual 1zed cost may not be relatable to the decade total of Investment because
  of the timing of Investment expenditures over the decade.

 3 O&M costs in.any year are relative to Investment made 1n the year plus all prior year investments
  commencing In 1973.  Hence, O&M expenditure in any year bears no particular relationship to the
  investment made in that year.

 * User charges denote the O&M component of the municipal treatment charges.  The  Investment com-
  ponent is denoted under investment recovery.
Note:   The Flat Glass industry includes tempered and laminated processing.

-------
PRESSED AND BLOWN GLASS INDUSTRY

Production  Characteristics  and  Capacities.   The effluent
limitations guidelines  for  the  pressed  and  blown  glass
manufacturing   industry   cover   manufacturers   of  glass
containers for commercial packing, bottling,  home  canning,
and  the  manufacturers  of  glass  and  glassware, which is
pressed, blown, or shaped from glass produced  in  the  same
establishment.

The   industry   has   been   divided   into  the  following
subcategories,  based   upon   differences   in   production
processes and wastewater characteristics:

  •  Glass containers

  *  Machine-pressed and blown glass

  •  Glass tubing

  •  Television picture tube envelopes

  •  Incandescent lamp envelopes-forming and frosting

  •  Hand-pressed and blown  glass-leaded  and  hydrofluroic
     acid   finishing,   non-leaded  and  hydrofluoric  acid
     finishing, and non-hydrofluoric acid finishing.

Four manufacturing steps are common to  the  entire  pressed
and  blown  glass  industry:  weighing  and  mixing  of  raw
materials, melting  of  raw  materials,  forming  of  molten
glass,  and  annealing  of  formed  glass products.  Further
processing  (finishing)  is  required   for  some   products,
especially  television  tube  envelopes,  incandescent  lamp
envelopes, and hand-pressed and blown glass.

Sand (silica) is the major ingredient of glass and  accounts
for  about  70  percent  of  the raw materials batch.  Other
ingredients may include soda or soda  ash   (13-16  percent),
potash,  lime,  lead  oxide, boric oxide, alumina, magnesia,
and iron or other coloring agents.   The  usual  batch  also
contains between 10 and 50 percent waste glass (cullet).

Melting   is  done  in  three  types  of  units:  continuous
furnaces, clay pots, or day tanks.   Methods  used  to  form
glass  include  blowing,  pressing,  drawing,  and  casting.
After the glass is formed, annealing is required to  relieve
strains  that  might  weaken  the glass or cause it to fail.
The  entire  piece  of  glass  is  brought  to   a   uniform
temperature  that  is  high  enough to  permit the release of
                            3-297

-------
internal stresses, and then it is cooled at a  uniform  rate
to  prevent  new  strains  from  developing; finishing steps
include abrasive polishing, acid  polishing,  spraying  with
frosting  solutions,  grinding,  cutting,  acid etching, and
glazing.

In 1972, approximately 300 plants manufactured  pressed  and
blown  glass  products -in the United States, and! almost half-
of these manufactured glass containers.  The glass container
industry is relatively concentrated with the  eight  largest
firms producing about 80 percent of the industry's shipments
and  operating  about  two-thirds  of the individual plants.
Because  of  the  special  nature  'of  their  products,  the
machine-pressed  and blown glass industry is also relatively
concentrated; as are the  tubing,  television  picture  tube
envelope, and incandescent lamp envelope industries.  On the
other  hand,  the  hand-pressed  and blown glass industry  is
characterized  by  a  large  number  of  family-owned   and-
operated,  single-plant  companies.  Of the 46 firms in this
industry, only four operate more than one plant.

Waste Sources and Pollutants.  Water is used in the  pressed
and  blown  glass  manufacturing  industry  for  non-contact
cooling, cullet quenching, and product rinsing following the
various finishing operations.  Water may also  be  added   to
the  raw  materials  batches for dust suppression,  wet fume
scrubbers used  in  acid  polishing  areas  also  contribute
wastewater discharge.

For   the  purposes  of  establishing  effluent  limitations
guidelines, the following  pollution  parameters  have  been
designated  as  significant:  fluoride,  ammonia, lead, oil,
chemical oxygen demand(COD), suspended solids(SS), dissolved
solids, temperature(heat>, and pH.  These parameters are not
present in the wastewater from every subcategory, and may  be
more  significant  in  one  subeategory  than  in   another.
Wastewaters  from  non-contact  cooling,  boilers, and water
treatment are not considered process wastewaters and are not
covered by the guidelines.

Control Technology and Costs.  The pressed and  blown  glass
industry  is currently treating its wastewaters to reduce  or
eliminate most of the pollutants.  Oil is reduced  by  using
gravity separators.  Treating for fluoride and lead involves
adding  lime,  rapid mixing, flocculation, and sedimentation
of the resulting reaction products.  Several glass container
plants recycle non-contact cooling and cullet quench  water.
Treatment  for ammonia removal is presently not practiced  in
the industry.
                           3-298

-------
Additional treatment systems  that  are  applicable  to  the
industry  include  chemical  or  physical methods to further
reduce   oil   levels,   such   as   high-rate   filtration,
diatomaceous  earth  filtration,  and  chemical  addition or
coagulation;  additional  treatment  of  fluorides  by  ion-
exchange   or  activated  alumina  filtration-  and  ammonia
removal by stream or air stripping, selective ion  exchange,
nitrification/denitrification, or break-point chlorination.

Because current treatment practices in the pressed and blown
glass  industry  provide wastewater pollutant concentrations
that are  already  at   low   levels,  no  additional  control
technologies are proposed for most subcategories to meet BPT
guidelines.   The  major  exception is the addition of steam
stripping   to   control   ammonia   discharges   from   the
incandescent lamp envelope manufacturing subcategory.

Additional technologies required for BAT and NSPS guidelines
include  segregation  of  non-contact cooling water from the
cullet  quench  water,  recycling   cullet   quench   water,
treatment  of  cullet quench water blowdown by dissolved air
flotation and diatomaceous earth filtration,  and  treatment
of   finishing  wastewaters   by sand filtration and activated
alumina filtration.

Table 4-33-1 summarizes the  control technologies recommended
for  each subcategory; as  indicated, most of  the  plants   in
the  pressed and blown glass  industry already have sufficient
operating  technology   to meet BPT guidelines,  in addition,
as shown in  Table  4-33-1,  only  about  one-third  of  the
approximately   300   plants covered  by  these  guidelines
discharge to surface waters. The  remaining  plants  either
have no  discharge  or,  as  in most cases, they discharge  to
municipal systems.

All  annualized costs are  detailed  in Table 4-33-2.
                            3-299

-------
                       Table 4-33-1.
                  Pressed and Blown Glass
          industry Pollution Control Technologies
Subcategories

Glass Containers
Machine-pressed &
blown glass
Glass tubing
TV tube envelopes
Incandescent lamp
envelopes
Hand-pressed &
blown glass
BPT

Housekeeping



Housekeeping



Housekeeping
Lime addition,
coagulation,
and sedimen-
tation
BAT

Recycle, gravity oil
separation and
filtration

Recycle, gravity oil
separation and
filtration

Cooling tower and
filtration
Sand filtration,
activated alumina
filtration
Steam stripping,  Sand filtration,
lime precipi-     activated alumina
tation and re-    filtration
carbonization
Batch lime pre-
cipitation,
coagulation,
sedimentation
Sand filtration,
activated alumina
filtration
NSPS are the same as BAT for all subcategories.
                           3-300

-------
w
I
w
o
                                                           Table 4-33-2.
                                                        Pressed & Blown  Glass
                                                        Industry Data  Summary
                 ACTIVITY  LEVEL
                                                       1977
                                                                      1983
  Capacity (kkg/Day)                 75,644.        109,240.

  Annual Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-1985 = 6.14%


EFFLUENTS (1,OOOMT/Yr)               1977           1983

Note: Residual data not available at time of  Report Issue.

  1971 Controls:
  1985


116,17O.




  1985
                   Legislated  Controls:
                 CONTROL  COSTS  (Million  1975  $)

                 Investment

                   Existing  Plants
                      On-s1te Treatment
                      Pretreatment

                   New Plants

                   Municipal Investment  Recovery

                   Totals
                                            1974-77
                                                           AGGREGATED OVER

                                                              1978-83
              1976-85
4.70 (BPT)
O.OO
2.26
8.69
15.66
44.32 (BAT)
0.00
20.74
1O8 . 59
173.65
46.58-
O.OO
24. 1O
157. 9O
228.59

-------
                                                    Table 4-33-2.  (Continued)
                                                      Pressed & Blown  Glass
                                                      Industry Data  Summary
               CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $) - (Continued)

               AnnualIzed Costs                               1977
I
w
O
Annualized Capital1

O&M'
  On-site Treatment
  Pretreatment
  Totals

Municipal Charges

  Investment Recovery
  User Charges*
  Totals

Grand Totals
                                                              O.92
0.60
O.O
O.6O
                                                              4.72
                                                             10.62
                                                             15.34

                                                             16.86
                                                           COST  IN YEAR

                                                              1983


                                                              9.47
1.73
O.O
1.73
              20.61
              22.55
              43. 16

              54.36
                              1985
                                                                                            9.84
6.22
0.0
6.22
              21 .09
              23.73
              44.82

              6O.88
                              1976-85


                                53.12'
20.71
 O.O
20.71
                157.9O
                256.84
                414.74

                488.57
               1  AnnualIzed on-site and pretreatment costs are computed on the assumption of  a 15  year  useful  life
                 at 1O percent Interest with zero salvage value.

               1  The decade total  of annualIzed cost may not'be relatable to the decade total  of  Investment  because
                 of the timing of  Investment expenditures over the decade.

               '  O&M costs 1n any  year are relative to Investment  made 1n the year  plus all prior  year  investments.
                 commencing in 1973.  Hence, O&M expenditure 1n any year bears no particular  relationship to the
                 investment made In that year.

               *  User charges denote the O&M component of the municipal  treatment charges. The Investment com-
                 ponent  is denoted under investment recovery.
               Note:    The Pressed and Blown Glass industry includes the production of T/V tubes,  tubing,  containers,
                       incadescent bulbs,  machine-pressed processing,  and hand-pressed processing.

-------
ELECTROPLATING

Production    Characteristics    and    Capacities.      The
electroplating  industry   is  a  subcategory  of  the  metal
finishing industry and includes  establishments  engaged  in
applying   metallic   coatings   on  surfaces  by  electrode
position.  These coatings  provide corrosion protection, wear
or  erosion  resistance,   antifrictional   characteristics,
lubricity,   electrical    conductivity,   heat   and   light
reflectivity, or other special surface characteristics.

This  analysis  covers  the  Phase  I  guidelines  for   the
electroplating  of   copper,  nickel,  chromium,  and zinc on
ferrous,  nonferrous,  and plastic  materials.   Phase   II
regulations,  which  cover the  additional  metal-finishing
operations  of  anodizing, buffing,  and  polishing,   were
promulgated too late for  inclusion in this report.

An electroplating process  involves cleaning, electroplating,
rinsing,  and  drying.  The cleaning operation comprises two
or more steps, usually sequential treatments in an  alkaline
solution  and an acid solution,  to remove grease, oil, soil,
and oxide films from the  basic metal surfaces to insure good
adhesion.  In the electroplating operation,  metal  ions  in
either  acid,  alkaline,  or neutral solutions are reduced on
the work pieces  being  plated,  which   serve  as  cathodes.
Hundreds  of  different   electroplating   solutions have been
adopted commercially,  but only two  or  three  types  are
utilized  widely  for a single metal or  alloy.  For example,
cyanide solutions are popular  for copper, zinc, and cadmium.
Acid  sulfate  solutions and non-cyanide   alkaline  solutions
containing pyrophosphate -or another chelating agent are also
used.   The   parts   to be plated are usually immersed  in the
electroplating  solutions  upon  racks,  although  small  parts
are allowed  to  tumble  freely  in  open barrels.

Mechanized  systems  have been  developed  for  transferring both
barrels and  racks  from cleaning, plating, and rinsing  tanks.
In  some   instances,  dwell   time   and   transfer periods are
programmed   on  magnetic   tape   or   cards    for   complete
automation.

Approximately   20,000    companies   are engaged   in  metal
finishing   activities.    In   over   85    percent   of   these
companies,    metal    finishing  is  merely   one   step  in   a
manufacturing  process.    Because    these   "captive   shop"
operations   are not classified,  it  is extremely difficult  to
obtain good  information on most  of  the  U.S.  metal  platers.
                            3-303

-------
Hence,   this  analysis  addresses  only  independent   (non-
captive) electroplating facilities.

Electroplating  facilities  vary   greatly   in    size    and
character.   Over 70 percent of the shops have fewer than 20
employees, while  the  largest  shops  have  more  than   150
employees.   The  area  of  the products being electroplated
varies from less than 10 to more than  1,000  square  meters
per  day.   Products  being  plated vary in weight from  less
than 30 grams to more than 9,000  kilograms.   Most  of   the
plants  perform  specialized  batch  operations, but in  some
plant operations, continuous strip and wire are plated on a
24-hour per day basis.  Some companies have capabilities  for
electroplating  10 or 12 different metals and alloys; others
specialize in just one or two.

waste  Sources   and   Pollutants.    Water   is   used   in
electroplating operations to accomplish the following tasks:

  •  Rinsing of parts, racks, and equipment

  •  Washing equipment and washing away spills

  *  Washing the air in ventilation ducts

  •  Dumps of operating solutions

  •  Cooling water to cool  solutions  
-------
demand,  biochemical  oxygen   demand,   oil   and   grease,
turbidity, color and temperature.

Control   Technology   and  Costs.   Pollution  control  and
wastewater treatment technologies  for reducing the discharge
of  pollutants  from  copper,  nickel,  chromium,  and  zinc
electroplating  processes include  both in-plant controls and
end-of-process treatment  system.   The  most  commonly-used
treatment  in  the  electroplating industry is the chemical
method.  The rinse waters are usually segregated into  these
three streams prior to treatment:

  •  Those containing hexavalent chromium,

  •  Those containing cyanide, and

  •  The remainder containing water from acid  dips,  ackali
     cleaners, acid copper, nickel, and zinc baths, etc.

The  cyanide  is  oxidized  by  chlorine,  and the hexavalent
chromium  is  reduced  to   trivalent  chromium  with  sulfur
dioxide  or  other  reducing  agents.  The three streams are
then combined, and the metal hydroxides are precipitated  by
adjusting  the pH through chemical addition.  The hydroxides
are  allowed  to  settle  out,  often  with the   help   of
coagulating  agents, and the sludge is hauled to a lagoon or
filtered and used as land fill.  These  chemical  facilities
may be engineered for batch or continuous  operations.

Water  conservation can be  accomplished by: in-plant process
modifications and materials substitutions   requiring  little
capital  or  new  equipment  (substituting low concentration
electroplating solutions for high  concentration baths or the
use of noncyanide solutions); good housekeeping  practices;
reducing  the  amount  of   rinse   water   lost when parts are
removed from the solution;  and reducing the volume of  rinse
water  used by installing counterflow rinses, adding wetting
agents,  and  installing  air   or  ultrasonic   agitation.
Significant  amounts of water can  also be  conserved by using
advanced  treatment   methods,   such   as  ion   exchange,
evaporative  recovery,  or  reverse  osmosis  to  treat  and
recycle in-process  waters.   Other  more   experimental  in-
process treatment methods include  freezing, electrodialysis,
ion-flotation,   and  electrolytic stripping.   One  system
currently   in  operation  has  achieved   zero  discharge  of
pollutants  through  the  use of reverse  osmosis followed by
evaporation  and  distillation  of the   concentrated  waste
stream from the  reverse osmosis unit.

BPT  for the electroplating  industry is based upon the use of
chemical  methods  of treatment of the wastewater at the end
                            3-305

-------
of the process controls to conserve rinse water  and  reduce
the amount of treated water discharged.  NSPS are based upon
the above technology plus the utilization of the best multi-
tank  rinsing  practices after each process.• Maximum use of
combinations  of  evaporative,  reverse  osmosis,  and   ion
exchange   systems   for   in-process   control   are   also
recommended.  BAT is  the  use  of  in-process  and  end-of-
process  control  and  treatment  to achieve no discharge of
pollutants.

An informal survey  suggests  that  substantial  amounts  of
waste  treatment  equipment are currently installed in metal
finishing   plants.    These   data   indicate   that   most
electroplating  establishments have at least some of the BPT
equipment already in place.  Some of this will  have  to  be
upgraded to satisfy BPT requirements, but a  total investment
in  new  technology will not be necessary.   In addition, the
majority of electroplaters discharge  their  wastewaters  to
municipal sewage systems.

A  recent analysis of costs for this sector  was conducted by
Gianessi  and  PesKin  (G&P)1.   This  study was  conducted
independently  and  subsequent to the general data gathering
efforts associated with the SEAS  uniform  cost  calculation
procedure.  However, time and resource constraints prevented
incorporating  these  costs into the scenario analyses using
the SEAS model procedure.  The G&P estimates are as  follows
(in million 1975 dollars):

                              Total    Phase I    Phase II

   Incremental BPT Investment 1,994.1  1,794.1       200.
      Direct Discharging        516.6    470.6        46.1
      Pretreating             1,447.5  1,323.5       154.0

   Incremental BPT O&M          856.5    816.3        40.3
      Direct Discharging        223.6    215.2         8.4
      Pretreating               633.0    601.1        31.9

Estimates  from the earlier SEAS  calculation are  presented
below,  with  projected pollutant discharges associated with
these costs.  SEAS addressed  only  those  costs  associated
with    Phase   I  production..   As  noted   in  the  industry
description,  SEAS addresses only independent electroplating
facilities,   and does not  calculate costs  for captive shops,
as does  G&P.   Growth  rate  assumptions  also  affect  the
forecasts.
                            3-306

-------
Gianessi, L. P. and H. M. Pesfcin, "The Cost to  Industries
of   the  water  Pollution  Control  Amendment  of  1972,"
National  Bureau  of  Economic  Research,  December  1975.
(Revised January 1976)
                          3-307

-------
                                                            Table 4-34-1.
                                                            Electroplating
                                                        Industry Data Summary
                 ACTIVITY  LEVEL
                                                       1977
                                                                      1983
                                                                                     1985
O
09
                   Capacity (MT/Yr)                   365,491        481,173.

                   Annual  Growth  Rate  Over  the  Period 1976-1985  =  3,78%
EFFLUENTS (1.OOO MT/Yr)

  1971 Controls:
     Dissolved Sol Ids
     Nutrients
     Acids
                   Legislated  Controls:
                      Dissolved  Sol ids
                      Nutrients
                      Acids
                                                       1977
                                                                      1983
                                                                  506,233.
                                                                                     1985
155.84
3. 19
16.52
107.53
1.O1
4.79
207
4
21
25
0
O
.25
.24
.97
.20
.04
.06
22O. 13
4.50
23.33
O
0
O
                CONTROL COSTS  (Million  1975  $)

                Investment

                  Existing Plants
                     On-site Treatment
                     Pretreatment

                  New Plants

                  Municipal Investment  Recovery

                  Totals
                                            1974-77
                                                           AGGREGATED OVER

                                                              1978-83
                                                                                1976-85



1
359.
381.
816.
53.
,61 1 .
87 (BPT)
23
25
79
15
1
1

2
,O18
0
,367
4O7.
.792
.22 (BAT)
.00
. 16
. 16
.54
1
1

3
, 189
O
,676,
60O
,466
. 18
.00
.96
.06
.20

-------
                                                   Table 4-34-1.  (Continued)
                                                         Electroplating
                                                     Industry Data Summary


              CONTROL COSTS  (Million  1975 $) -  (Continued)               COST IN YEAR

              Annual 1zed Costs                               1977           1983            1985            1976-85

              -Annual 1zed Capital'                           186.77         50O.39         530.5O           3,612.56*

              O&M'
                On-s1te Treatment                           27.9O          72.45         295.67            946.31
                Pretreatment                                115.22         271.93         362.71           2,119.82
w              Totals                                      143.12         344.39         658.38           3.O66.13

•O            Municipal Charges
vo
                Investment Recovery                         23.53          75.63          76.97            6OO.O6
                User Charges'                               37.99          63.68          64.99            798.81
                Totals                                      61.52         139.31.         141.96           1,398.88

              Grand Totals                                  391.42         984.09       1,330.84           8.O77.57


              ' Annual 1zed on-slte and pretreatment costs are computed on the assumption of a 15 year useful life
                at  1O percent Interest with zero salvage value.

              1 The decade total of annualized  cost may not be relatable to the decade total of investment because
                of the timing of Investment expenditures over the decade.

              3 O&M costs 1n any year are relative to  Investment made 1n the year plus all prior year Investments
                commencing 1n 1973.  Hence, O&M expenditure 1n any year bears no particular relationship  to the
                Investment made  1n that year.

              * User charges denote the O&M component of the municipal treatment charges.  The Investment com-
                ponent 1s denoted under Investment recovery.


              Note:   The Electroplating Industry includes job shop operations that apply metallic coatings
                      to material surfaces.

-------
STEAM ELECTRIC POWER INDUSTRY

Production  Characteristics  and  Capacities.   The electric
utility industry is composed of three  types  of  companies:
those   owned  by  investors,  those  owned  by  the  public
(Federal, state or local governments), and  those  owned  by
cooperatives.    Companies   owned   by  the  public  or  by
cooperatives are engaged primarily in  the  distribution  of
electricity;  companies  owned  by  investors are engaged in
generation, transmission, and distribution.

The  500  investor-owned  companies  serve  fewer   separate
electrical  systems  than  cooperatives  or publically-owned
companies, but they  account  for  most  of  the  generating
capacity  and  generate  most  of the electricity.  In 1973,
investor-owned companies had 78 percent  of  the  generating
capacity;  publically-owned  companies  had  20 percent, and
cooperatives had 2 percent.

The steam electric power  industry  has  been  divided  into
three sub-categories according to size and age of generating
plants,  and  a  fourth  based  on  area;  a  summary of the
subcategories follows:
                    Generation Capacity
Subcategory         (megawatts)             Date Initial Operation*

Generating Unit            > 25             After 1/1/74
                           >500             After 1/1/70

Small Unit                 < 25

Old unit                   >500             On or before 1/1/70
                           <500             on or before 1/1/74

Area Runoff               All Sizes
*Final effluent guidelines were issued on October  8,  1974
in  the  Federal  Register  (39FR36186).   These  guidelines
exempt all  units  placed  into  service  before  1970  from
meeting limitations on the discharge of heat.
The  generating  capacity  of  the  industry  may be further
classified by  the  type  of  fuel  employed  to  drive  the
generator.    As   shown   in  Table  4-35-1,  coal  is  the
predominant fuel used.  In recent years, there  has  been  a
                           3-310

-------
shift  from coal to oil, principally because state and local
environmental restrictions required the use  of  low  sulfur
fuels, a requirement more easily met by oil then coal.  More
recently,  the  increasing  prices of foreign crude oil have
caused a reversal of this trend as utilities return to lower
priced coal as their fuel.
Waste Sources and Pollutants.  The major waste product  from
electric power generation is heat.  Depending on the type of
fuel  consumed,  substantial  quantities  of  metal cleaning
wastes, water treatment wastes,  miscellaneous  housekeeping
wastes,  bottom ash and fly ash may also be produced.  Waste
cooling water may contain corrosion inhibitors and biocides,
principally chlorine.

The main sources contributing to the total waste  load  come
from  both  power generation and housekeeping: cooling water
and cooling water blowdown, boiler blowdown, metal  cleaning
wastes,   ash   transport  water,  low  volume  wastes,  and
construction and storage runoff.

In order to  define  waste  characteristics,  the  following
parameters  were  used  to develop guidelines for meeting BPT
and BAT: (1) total suspended  solids,   (2) oil  and  grease,
(3) free  available  chlorine,   (4) total  copper, (5) total
iron,   (6) zinc,   (7) chromium,   (8) phosphorous,  (9) other
corrosion    inhibitors,    (10) polychlorobiphenyls    (PCB),
(11) pH, and  (12) heat.

Specific waste  loads have not been characterized,  but  they
may be  expected to vary with the type of  fuel:

  •  Coal burning plants  produce  the  heaviest  burden  of
     wastes  because  of  the   large  amounts of  fly ash and
     bottom ash produced.   Pollutants are  caused  by   runoff
      from   coal   storage  areas,  boiler   blowdown,  metal
     cleaning  wastes, once-through cooling water or  cooling
     water  blowdown,   and   low volume  wastes,  including wet
     scrubber  wastes, water  treatment wastes,  laboratory and
     sampling  wastes, and housekeeping  wastes,  such as pump
     seal oil.

  *  Oil burning plants generate no bottom ash  and much less
      fly ash   than   coal  burning  plants.   Otherwise,  the
     wastes   are   about  the   same  except   that  there  are
      substantial quantities of  oily water  from  oil  use  and
      storage,  but  no runoff  from coal storage.

  •   Gas  burning plants produce almost  no ash  and require no
      air pollution equipment  for control  of  particulates and
      sulfur dioxide.  Otherwise,  the  wastes  are  the same  as
      for   coal  and  oil except  that there  is no waste  stream
                            3-311

-------
                                           Table 4-35-1.
                              Steam Electric Power Industry Structure
w
i> Size
£J (megawatt)
< 25
25-500
> 500
Totals
Coal
No. Total
Plants Cap. (%)
213
537
173
923
14.
11.
37.
62.
0
0
5
5
NO.
Plants
6O
151
49
26O
Oil
Total
Cap. (%)
5
4
11
2O
.0
.0
.2
.2
No.
Plants
115
1O1
2
218
Gas
Total
Cap. (%)
8.
O.
7.
15.
0
1
1
2
Nuclear
No. Total
Plants Cap. (%)
3
15
15
33
O
1 .
1
2
.2
.O
. 1
.3
Total
No. Total
Plants Cap. (
391
8O4
239
1434
27.2
16. 1
56.9
1O0.21
'Percentages do not add to 1OO because of rounding.

Source: EPA Development Document.

-------
     associated with fuel storage/ and none associated  with
     maintenance cleaning of the stack.

  •  Nuclear plants produce no ash  or  fuel  storage  waste
     streams,  and  metal cleaning wastes are limited to the
     cooling tower basin and  generator  tubes.   Otherwise,
     the  wastewaters  are  similar  to those of fossil fuel
     plants.  Radioactive wastes are not covered in effluent
     guidelines.

Control  Technology   and   costs.    wastewater   treatment
generally has not been practiced in the steam electric power
industry;  however,  based  on  assumptions  concerning  the
nature of the  wastestreams,  the  treatment  technology  is
readily projected.

  *  Cooling Water,  where  unlimited  discharge  of  heated
     water   is  permitted,  there  is  no  requirement  for
     treatment.  Where recirculating cooling  water  systems
     are  in  use,  it will be necessary to remove corrosion
     inhibitors from the blowclown  to  meet  1983  criteria.
     This  can  be achieved by treatment with sulfur dioxide
     to reduce  hexavalent  chromium  followed  by  chemical
     precipitation   of  heavy  metals  and  phosphate,  and
     filtration.  Since  new  source- performance  standards
     permit no discharge of corrosion inhibitors, it will be
     necessary to construct cooling facilities of corrosion-
     inhibiting materials.

  •  Metal  Cleaning  Wastes  and  Boiler  Slowdown.   Metal
     cleaning wastes are generated on an intermittent basis.
     treatment  of  this  stream,  as  well  as  the  boiler
     blowdown  stream,  can  be  achieved  by  equalization,
     chemical precipitation of heavy metals, and filtration.
     Where  chemical treatment of cooling waters blowdown is
     necessary, these streams can be combined for treatment.

  •  Ash  Transport  Water  and  Low  Volume  Wastes.    The
     blowdown  from recirculating ash transport water can be
     treated to meet all standards  by  neutralization,  oil
     separation,  and  clarification.   Where  discharge  of
     pollutants from fly ash  transport  is  prohibited,  it
     will  be  necessary  to  resort to dry removal methods.
     Low  volume  wastes  are   treated   by   equalization,
     neutralization,   oil  separation,  and  clarification.
     They  may  be  combined  with  the  blowdown  from  ash
     transport water, for treatment.

  •  Area  Runoff.   Area   runoff   may   be   treated   by
     impoundment,   lime   addition    for  pH  control,  and
     discharge of the neutral, settled water.
                            3-313

-------
The most recent  analysis  of  costs  for  this  sector  vas
provided  to  the  Agency  by Temple, BarKer & Sloane/ Inc.,
(TBS)1.  This analysis was  conducted  in  somewhat  greater
depth  than,  and  subsequent  to the general data gathering
efforts associated with the SEAS  uniform  cost  calculation
procedure,  and  is considered to be more precise.  However,
time and resource constraints prevented incorporating  these
costs  into  the  scenario  analyses  using  the  SEAS model
procedure.  The TBS estimates are  as  follows  (in  million
1975 dollars}:*

  incremental investment (1974-1983)        4,500
  Incremental O&M (1974-1983)               2,100

Estimates from the earlier SEAS calculations  are  presented
in Table 4-35-1 (with capital expenditures during the period
1974-1983  equal  to  5.2 billion dollars).  The SEAS values
were  based  upon  the  EPA  report  Economic  Analysis   of
Efficient Guidelines. Steam Electric Plants (December 1974).
Costs  for  enhancement  were  not estimated in this earlier
report, and thus are not included in the  SEAS  projections.
Two  significant  modifications  are included in the revised
baseline  estimates  for  the  electric  utility   industry.
First,   capital  expenditures  requirements  have  declined
primarily because reduced  growth  for  the  industry  means
fewer  new  units  will  be  built  than had previously been
expected.- The O&M costs have risen  due  to  the  increased
fuel  costs  acclerating  the  cost  of making up the energy
penalties associated with  closed-cycle  cooling.   The  net
change  from the results associated with the 1974 report has
been  approximately  a  seventeen   percent   reduction   in
kilowatts   covered  by  the  relatively  expensive  thermal
guidelines,  a   twelve   percent   reduction   in   capital
expenditure impacts and a substantial increase in operations
and maintenance expenses.
  "Economic and Financial impacts of  EPA's  Air  and  Water
  Pollution  Controls  on  the  Electric  utility Industry,"
  Temple, BarKer & Sloane, Inc., May 1976.
                           3-314

-------
                                                               Table 4-35-2.
                                                            Steam Electric Power
                                                           Industry Data Summary
                    ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                                          1977
                                                                         1983
                                                                                        1985
                      Capacity (Megawatts)              726,560.      1.12O.30O.

                      Annual Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-1985 = 7.62%
                          1,267,OOO.
U>
                    EFFLUENTS (1.0OO MT/Yr)
1977
                      1971 Controls:
                         TSS (Coal  only)                  80.61
                         Dissolved Sol Ids
                            (Coal  and Elec.  Utilities) 2,724.21
               1983


               89.35

            3.043.OO
         1985


         93.73

      3,2O1.58
                      Legislated Controls:
                         TSS (Coal  only)                  65.35          16.39            O
                         Dissolved Solids
                            (Coal and Elec.  Utilities) 2.832.O2       3,155.48       3,322.16
                    CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

                    Investment

                      Existing Plants
                         On-site Treatment
                         Pretreatment

                      New Plants

                      Municipal  Investment Recovery

                      Totals
      1974-77
AGGREGATED OVER

   1978-83
1976-85
1,018.50
O.OO
1 ,608. 16
O.O
2,626.67
(BPT) 157
0
2,453
O
2,610
.13 (BAT)
,OO
.46
.0
.60
698.23
0.00
4,674.41
O.O
5,372.64

-------
                                     Table 4-35-2. (Continued)
                                        Steam Electric Power
                                       Industry Data Summary


CONTROL COSTS  (Million 1975 $) - (Continued)               COST IN YEAR

Annualized Costs                               1977           1983           1985           1976-85

Annua11 zed Capital'                          345.34         67O.92         788.53          5,346.65!

O&M5
  On-s1te Treatment                          131.88         253.57         331.04          2,108.53
  Pretreatment                                 0.0            0.0            O.O               O.O
  Totals                                     131.68         253.57         331.04          2,108.53

Municipal Charges

  Investment Recovery                          O.O            0.0            O.O               O.O
  User Charges'                                O.O            0.0            O.O               0.0
  Totals                                       O.O            O.O            0.0               O.O

Grand Totals                                 477.22         924.49       1,119.57          7,455.18


1  Annualized on-s1te and pretreatment costs are computed on the assumption of a 15 year useful life
  at  1O percent Interest with zero salvage value.

*  The decade total of annualized cost may not be relatable to the decade total of Investment because
  of the timing of investment expenditures over the decade.

3  O&M costs in any year are-relative to Investment made in the year plus all prior year investments
  commencing in 1973.  Hence,  O&M expenditure In any year bears no particular relationship to the
  investment made  in that year.

•  User charges denote the O&M component of the municipal treatment charges.  The investment com-
  ponent is denoted under investment recovery.


Note:   The Steam Electric Industry includes power generation using coal, oil, natural gas, and
        nuclear fuels.

-------
SOAP AND DETERGENT INDUSTRY

Production Characteristics and Capacities.   Data  from  the
Census  of  Manufacturers. 1967. identify 668 establishments
in the industry,  in spite of this large number,  production
is    highly-concentrated    in   the   industry   with   12
establishments accounting for 47 percent of  the  industry's
value-added, and 28 establishments accounting for 73 percent
of  value-added.   The   "big  three"  companies, Proctor and
Gamble, Lever Brothers,  and Colgate-Palmolive, dominate  the
package detergent industry with 80-85 percent of the market.

The  soap  and detergent industry establishments are engaged
in the manufacture of soap,  synthetic  organic  detergents,
inorganic  alkaline  detergents, or any combination of these
processes.  Crude  and   refined  glycerine  production  from
vegetable  and  animal  fats and oils is also accomplished by
firms in the industry,   in  popular  use,  the  term  "soap"
refers  to  those cleaning agents based primarily on natural
fat.   The  term  "detergent"  is  generally  restricted  to
cleaning  compounds  derived  largely  from  petrochemicals.
Detergents can be formulated with entirely different organic
and inorganic chemicals to exhibit the same  cleaning  power
or have the same biodegradability.

Basic  raw  materials   used  in the manufacture of soap come
from  chemical  and  agricultural  processors  arid   include
caustic  soap,  fats/ and oils.  Raw materials for detergents
are supplied mostly  from large  chemical  and  petrochemical
companies  and  consist primarily  of  detergent  alkylate,
alcohols, and surfactants.

Soaps  and  detergents   are  produced  with  a  variety   of
manufacturing  processes.   In  the traditional batch-Kettle
process of manufacturing soap,  a  mixture  of  refined  and
bleached  fats, oils, caustic soda, and salt is alternatively
boiled,  settled,  and   drained  of lye, etc., over a period
from 4 to 6 days.  Another process first converts  the  fats
and oils to fatty acids, then mixes these with caustic soda,
soda  ash,  and  salt   to  produce  soap-  this  "fatty acid
neutralization"  process  is  faster   and   produces   less
wastewater.

Detergents  customarily .consist of two main components, the
surfactant or   active   ingredient,  and   the  builder  which
performs  many  functions including buffering the pH and soil
dispersion.  Surfactants,  usually alcohol sulfate  or  alkyl
benzene   sulfonate,  are produced from a variety of processes
in which  alcohols,   alkyl   benzene  and/or  ethoxylates  are
combined   in a  reactor  with sulfur compounds, usually sulfur
trioxide.   The  resultant products are then  neutralized  and
                            3-317

-------
blended with the requisite builders and additives to produce
the desired detergent.

waste   Sources   and  Pollutants.   waste  loads  from  the
different soap and detergent  manufacturing  processes  vary
considerably.  Some processes are completely dry and produce
no  wastewaters.   The  major  pollution  sources from other
processes are leaks and  spills,  washout  waters/  scrubber
water  from  air  pollution  control  equipment,  barometric
condensate,  and   cooling   tower   blowdown.    Wash   and
wastewaters produced by some of the processes result in some
very  strong  pollutants,  such  as  sewer lyes, salt brine,
acids, glycerine foots, and spent catalysts.

Pollutants covered by the  effluent  limitations  guidelines
include  BODI5,  COD,  suspended solids, surfactants, oil and
grease, and pH.

Control Technology and Costs.  Almost all  (98  percent)  of
the  plants  in  the  soap  and detergent industry discharge
their wastewater into  municipal  treatment  systems.   This
leaves  fewer  than  a  dozen  plants which are point-source
dischargers into navigable waters.  Of these, only one has a
complete primary-secondary treatment system.  Several plants
have aerated or non-aerated lagoons.

The major  pollutants  and  the  treatment  methods  usually
employed to handle them are as follows:
                           3-318

-------
     Pollutants
Treatments
     Oil  and  grease
     Suspended solids
     Dispersed organics
     Dissolved solids
        (inorganic)
1. Gravity separation
2. Coagulation and sedimentation
3. Carbon absorption
4. Mixed-media filtration
5. Flotation

1. Plain sedimentation
2. Coagulation and sedimentation
3. Mixed-media filtration

1. Bioconversion (i.e., aerated
      lagoons, extended aeration,
      activated sludge, contact
      stabilization, trickling
      filters)
2. Carbon absorption

1. Reverse osmosis
2. ion exchange
3, Sedimentation
4. Evaporation
     Acidity or alkalinity   1. Neutralization
     Sludge disposal
1. Digestion
2. Incineration
3. Lagooning
4. Thickening
5. Centrifuging
6. Wet oxidation
7. Vacuum filtration
     Source:  EPA Development Document, April 1974, p.96.
Probably the largest reductions in the pollution  load  from
this industry can be made through lower process water usage.
One of the biggest improvements would be either changing the
operating   techniques   associated   with   the  barometric
condensers  or  replacing   them   entirely   with   surface
condensers.    Large   reductions  in  water  usage  in  the
manufacture of liquid detergents could be  achieved  through
the  installation  of additional water recycling, and by the
use of air rather than water to blow out filling lines.

BPT guidelines call for plants to  adopt  good  housekeeping
procedures,  adopt  recycling where appropriate, and install
biological   secondary   treatment   (byconversion).    BAT
                           3-319

-------
guidelines  assume  improvement  in  manufacturing prpcesses
such as the replacement of barometric condensers  by  surface
condensers,   the   installation   of  tandem-chilled  water
scrubbers  (for spray-dried detergents), and'  the  use  of  a
batch  counter-current  process  in  air-SO3  sulfation  and
sulfonation.   in  addition,  improvements  in    end-of-pipe
treatment  are  expected  including  the addition of sand or
mixed-media filtration or the installation of  a  two-stage,
activated  sludge process.  New source performance standards
are  the  same  as  BAT  for  most  product   subcategories.
improvements over BAT are expected where the installation of
new, lower-polluting processes, such as continuous processes
instead of batch processes, is possible.

Since  approximately  90  percent  of the soap and detergent
manufacturers discharge into  municipal  sewers,  the  total
cost  to  the  industry  of meeting these guidelines is low.
Annualized  control  costs  and  industry   statistics   are
detailed in Table 4-36-1.

A  recent analysis of costs for this sector was conducted by
Gianessi  and  PesKin  (G&P)*.   This  study  was conducted
independently  and  subsequent to the general data gathering
efforts associated with the SEAS  uniform  cost   calculation
procedure.  However, time and resource constraints prevented
incorporating  these  costs into the scenario analyses using
the SEAS  model  procedure.   The  soap  and  detergent  G&P
estimates are as follows (in 1975 dollars):

  incremental BPT Investment            7.0
  Incremental BPT O&M                   1.1

Estimates from the earlier SEAS calculations  are  presented
below,  with  projected pollutant discharges associated with
these costs.  The principal reason for the difference in the
estimates is that G&P  assumes  that  95  percent  of  total
process water flow is discharged to municipalities,  and that
77  percent  of  the  plants incur pretreatment costs,  being
detergent plants.  SEAS assumes no pretreatment  costs,  the
only  costs  to the industry being municipal charges.  There
is also a substantial difference in growth assumptions  about
the industry.  The municipal charges listed by G&P for  soaps
and detergents is 24.7 million dollars,  as compared   to  the
SEAS  estimate  for  Municipal  Investment Recovery  and User
Charges, summing to 28.0 million dollars over  a  comparable
period.
                           3-320

-------
Gianessi, L. p. and H. M. Peskin, "The Cost to  Industries
of   the  Water  Pollution  Control  Amendment  of  1972,"
National Bureau  of  Economic  Research,  December,  1975.
(Revised January 1976)
                          3-321

-------
                                           Table 4-36-1
                                         Soap and Detergent
                                       Industry Data Summary
ACTIVITY LEVEL
                                      1977
                                                     1983
                                                                    1985
  Capacity (KKG/Day)                  2,773.          4,469.

  Annual Growth Rate Over the Period 1976-1985 = 7.16%
                             4,865.
EFFLUENTS (1,000 MT/Yr)

  1971 Controls:
     TSS
     BOD5_
     COD
     Oils and Greases
  Legislated Controls:
     TSS
     BOD5
     COD
     011s and Greases
1977
               1983
                              1985
5.54
16.51
12.97
O.58
2. 14
6.38
6.08
O.22
8.
25.
20.
O.
1 .
2,
3.
0.
56
53
06
89
55
,54
. 17
. 16
9.32
27.80
21 .84
0.97
1 .68
2. 01
2.48
0. 18
CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $)

Investment

  Existing Plants
     On-site Treatment
     Pretreatment

  New Plants

  Municipal Investment Recovery

  Totals
      1974-77
                     AGGREGATED OVER

                        1978-83
                                          1976-85
O.O (BPT)
0.0
O.O
8.89
8.89
O.O (BAT)
0.0
O.O
68.99
68.99
0.0
0.0
O.O
1O1 .74
101.74

-------
                                                             Table 4-36-1
                                                           Soap and Detergent
                                                         Industry Data Summary
to
00
CONTROL COSTS (Million 1975 $) - (Continued)

Annualized Costs                               1977

Annualized Capital1                            O.O

0&MS
  On-site Treatment                            O.O
  Pretreatment                                 O.O
  Totals                                       O.O

Municipal Charges

  Investment Recovery                          3.88
  User Charges4                                6.36
  Totals                                      1O.24

Grand Totals                                  1O.24
                                                                             COST IN YEAR

                                                                                1983

                                                                                O.O
                                                                                0.0
                                                                                0.0
                                                                                O.O
                                                                               12.91
                                                                               12.85
                                                                               25.76

                                                                               25.76
 1985

 O.O
 O.O
 0.0
 O.O
13. 19
13.76
26.94

26.94
1976-85

   0,0*
   O.O
   O.O
   0.0
 1O1.74
 146.92
 248.66

 248.66
                  1  Annualized on-site and pretreatment costs are computed on the assumption of a 15 year useful life
                    at 1O percent interest with zero salvage value.

                  1  The decade total of annualized cost may not be relatable to the decade total  of investment because
                    of the timing of investment expenditures over the decade.

                  3  O&M costs in any year are relative to investment made in the year plus all  prior year investments
                    commencing in-1973.  Hence, O&M expenditure in any year bears no particular relationship to the
                    Investment made in that year.

                  *  User charges denote the O&M component of the municipal  treatment charges.   The investment com-
                    ponent is denoted under investment recovery.
                  Note:   The Soap and Detergent industry includes the manufacturing of  soap,  organic and inorganic
                          detergents,  and any combination of the three.

-------
                        Section Four

      A COMPREHENSIVE ASSESSMENT OF POLLUTION CONTROL:
        IMPACT MEASUREMENT UNDER ALTERNATIVE FUTURES
This Section presents national- and sectoral-level estimates
of the key economic, environmental, and  energy  impacts  of
Federal  pollution  control  laws  and  regulations.   These
impacts  are  examined  under  different   sets   of   basic
assumptions   about  economic  activity  levels  and  energy
conservation policies and  programs.   The  period  of  1971
through  1985   is evaluated since it includes the time frame
during which the Federally mandated  environmental  policies
will  be  put   into  effect.   The  analysis is conducted by
running alternative scenarios through a computerized  system
for impact estimation and analysis; the computer system used
is the Strategic Environmental Assessment System (SEASK

The  magnitude  and interrelationships of estimated relative
impacts  are  forecast  based  upon  the  assumptions   made
explicit  in  each  scenario.   The  basic  structure of the
economy, and the fiscal policies which help  guide  it,  are
maintained  for each  specific  run  of  the  model system.
Changes in  these  and  other  basic  assumptions  are  what
constitute a specific scenario.

All  industrial, pollution control cost functions utilized in
this  section   are  those  used   in   the   original   SEAS
calculations.   They  have  not  been  modified  by the more
recent data which accompany SEAS cost estimates in  Sections
2  and  3,  and which  have  been  included  in  nationally
aggregated cost totals presented elsewhere  in the report.

This situation  has  little effect on  the  analyses  in  this
section,  since the  principle objective is to indicate the
relative impacts of potential alternative future  conditions
on   the  national  pollution  control  costs  and  residual
discharges,  and  not  to  precisely  define  the  pollution
control costs  for particular  sectors of the economy.
                             4-1

-------
Chapter 1
impact Estimation Using
The Strategic Environmental
Assessment system (SEAS)
in  several  previous  studies  and reports/ there have been
estimates made of the  projected  impacts  on  the  national
economy  of pollution abatement programs.  The Environmental
protection Agency (e.g., see The Economics of.  Clean  wajter-
1973  and  The  Economic impact of the Federal Environmental
program-1974V, the Council on Environmental Quality   (Annual
Reports},  the  U. S. Congress Joint Economic Committee, and
other agencies have utilized a variety of economic models to
project impacts upon overall price inflation and  levels  of
economic  activity.   These  models have included procedures
developed either by the agencies themselves  or  by   private
groups, such as Chase Econometrics Associates, the BrooXings
Institute,  and  Data  Resources incorporated.  For the most
part, this previous vork has  led  to  forecasts  indicating
that  the  inflationary  influences  of  pollution abatement
programs  would  be  comparatively  minor  relative   to  the
presence of numerous other inflationary influences, and that
the  effects  on  national  income  would also be relatively
minor.

Several of  the  previous  studies  of  pollution  abatement
impacts   have   also   devoted"  considerable  attention  to
evaluating the benefits and costs attributable to  pollution
abatement   programs.   The  purpose  of  such  benefit/cost
analyses has been to assess whether the nation would  receive
economic  and  environmental  benefits  greater   than   the
expenditures required to achieve them.

The  work  described  in  this  section  departs  from these
previous efforts in three important ways:

  •  First, no attempt is made to develop a  single   set  of
     impact   projections,-   rather,  impacts  are  measured
     relative to different  sets  of  general  socioeconomic
     assumptions of future conditions;

  •  Second, the analysis focuses on how these  impacts  are
     differentially    affected   by   the   various   basic
     assumptions about future economic and pollution  control
     activities  and  energy  policy,  rather   than   their
     absolute levels (although these are also presented)-

  •  Third, control costs and resultant pollution  estimates
     are  developed  at a greater level of industrial detail
     and  the  effect  of  cost  feedbacks  by  sector   are
                            4-2

-------
     included.   (Feedbacks are purchases made for pollution
     control  implementation  and  operation  that  increase
     purchases from sectors that produce such items.)
The  present  imprecise  state  of  knowledge  regarding the
evaluation of future benefits makes any attempt to compile a
national aggregate figure  for  benefits  subject  to  large
uncertainties.   AS  a  substitute approach, consequences of
pollution abatement programs are analyzed through  tradeoffs
among  the various costs and impacts of achieving legislated
Federal control objectives.

The general procedure  used  for  tradeoff  analysis  is  as
follows:

  1. Select  a   consistent   set   of   general   economic,
     environmental,    demographic    and    resource-energy
     assumptions;

  2. Calculate a set of forecasts of the  economy,  industry
     outputs, environmental residuals and energy usage given
     that  specific  industry environmental controls are not
     increased beyond those present in 1971.

  3. Calculate the same forecasts, given that  environmental
     controls,    costs,   and   equipment   purchases   are
     superimposed on  the  original  economic  structure  as
     necessary  to  comply  with  Federal  pollution control
     legislation.

  4. Compare  the  differences  in  forecasts  between   the
     abatement  case and the non-abatement case  for national
     level statistics and for industry-detailed  statistics.

This procedure was performed for three alternative  sets  of
assumptions,  plus  one  variation on environmental controls
and costs.  Steps 1 and 3  draw on  the  data   provided  in
Sections  Two  and  Three  of   this  report.   The forecasts
required  in Steps 2 and 3 are derived from operation of SEAS
using  these  data.   Step  4,   the  impact  analysis,  is  a
quantitative  analysis  of  the SEAS simulation results for
each   scenario  to  determine   impacts  upon   environmental
pollution,   pollution   control  costs,  and  economic  and
resource  usage statistics.   (See  Appendix  A  for  a  brief
description of the SEAS system  used for this application.)
                             4-3

-------
Chapter 2
Scenario Assumptions
Six  major  scenarios  were  constructed  to  develop impact
estimates through 1985 for alternative sets  of  assumptions
about  the future.  The six scenarios are divided into three
pairs, with each pair representing a  predefined  "case"  of
future  economic  and  energy-consumption  conditions.   The
three cases selected for this study are a Reference Case,  a
Low productivity Case, and an Energy conservation Case.

A   "non-abatement"   scenario   and   an   "abatement"   or
"compliance"  scenario  were  run   to   provide   the   two
alternative  forecasts  for  each  case, thereby showing the
incremental impacts of  pollution  control.   Each  forecast
provides   annual   projections   through   1985   of  major
macroeconomic and demographic variables, industrial outputs,
energy usage, domestic demand for virgin  stocks,  recycling
levels,  transportation  demand, and environmental pollution
levels.  The first, or non-abatement scenario, estimates the
value of these variables in the absence of Federal pollution
control  legislation  after  1970.   It  assumes   that   no
incremental  expenditures are made by industries, utilities,
and  municipalities  to  improve  pollution  control  beyond
processes  in  place  in  1971,  and that all new industrial
facilities will control pollution to the same extent as that
practiced  in  1971.    it   also   assumes   that   Federal
expenditures  do  not  include  any additional subsidies for
pollution control past 1971.   The  non-abatement  scenario,
however,  does allow for pollution reductions resulting from
switching to  new  process  technologies  which  would  have
occurred without Federal legislation.

The  second  or abatement scenario in each pair assumes that
sufficient abatement expenditures are made to bring air  and
water  pollution  from  industry,  utility,  municipal,  and
mobile sources into full compliance with  Federal  statutes.
It  also  provides  for  additional  Federal expenditures to
cover the cost of pollution abatement at Federal plants  and
the  cost  of  other  Federally-sponsored  pollution control
programs.  The abatement scenarios provide estimates of  the
incremental  costs  of  pollution  control  through 1985, in
addition to estimates of the same variables forecast in 'the
non-abatement scenarios.

The  six  scenarios  run  for the three cases are summarized
below:
                            4-4

-------
              Non-Abatement
              Scenarios  (Without      Abatement Scenarios
              Incremental Control     {With incremental
Case          Costs)                  Control Costs)
Reference        Scenario 1              Scenario 2

Low
Productivity     Scenario 3              Scenario 4

Energy
Conservation     Scenario 5              Scenario 6
The following names  are   used   in  the  remainder  of  this
Section to identify each scenario;

  Scenario 1  -   The Reference  Scenario

  Scenario 2  -   The Reference  Abatement Scenario

  Scenario 3  -   The Low Productivity  Scenario

  Scenario 4  -   The Low Productivity  Abatement Scenario

  Scenario 5  -   The Energy  Scenario

  Scenario 6  -   The Energy  Abatement  Scenario
The  six  scenarios were  produced  in   the   sequence  shown  in
Figure  1.   This sequence  is  designed to permit  a comparative
analysis  of   the  relative   impacts  and  tradeoffs between
logical  scenario  pairs..   Certain   pairs  are  compared  to
analyze   the   consequences  of   pollution  control under the
conditions assumed for  each  case:  (1,2),   (3,4)  and   (5,6).
Other   pairs  . provide  an analysis   of   the  impacts  of the
assumptions themselves, both in  the  absence of  incremental
abatement   costs:  (1,3)   and  (1,51;  and  with these costs
applied:  (2,4) and (2,6K
                             4-5

-------
      Figure 1.
Scenario Run  Sequence
                     KEY:        - SIMCLE SCENARIO RUN

                          f      J-SCENARIO COMPARISON RUN

                 SI - THE REFERENCE SCENARIO
                 S3 - THE REFERENCE ABATEMENT SCENARIO
                 S3 - THE LOW PRODUCTIVITY SCENARIO
                 S4 - THE LOW PRODUCTIVITY ABATEMENT SCENARIO
                 55 - THE ENERGY SCENARIO
                 S6 - THE ENERGY ABATEMENT SCENARIO
       4-6

-------
The objective in comparing the economic, environmental,  and
energy  consequences  of  two scenarios is not to claim that
one is better or more  realistic  than  the  other,  but  to
develop  an  analysis that will provide meaningful abatement
cost  forecasts  for  a  range  of   economic   and   energy
projections.   Examples  of the kind of analysis afforded by
constrasting scenario cases is presented below:

  •  The Reference Case vs. The Low Productivity Case -  The
     two  Reference Case scenarios call for the U.S. economy
     to approach full employment in the early 1980's along a
     relatively  high  productivity,  high  growth   supply-
     oriented  path.   The alternative Low Productivity Case
     scenarios  reflect  a  lower  productivity  and  growth
     profile.   By  comparing  first  the  Low  Productivity
     Scenario with the Reference Scenario, and then the  Low
     Productivity  Abatement  Scenario  with  both  the  Low
     Productivity  Scenario  and  the  Reference   Abatement
     Scenario,  one can analyze the economic, environmental,
     and  energy  consequences  of  implementing   pollution
     controls     with     alternative    labor-productivity
     conditions.  Such an analysis affords insights into the
     differences in abatement cost impacts arising from  two
     relatively  realistic,  but potentially very different,
     economic  futures.  By 1985, the difference in  GNP  due
     to  these  alternative productivity conditions is about
     12 percent.

   •  The Reference Case vs. The Energy Conservation  Case  -
     The  Reference Case scenarios contain a number of basic
     energy conservation policy measures.   The  alternative
     Energy Conservation Case scenarios provide for an even
     more stringent set of energy conservation policies  and
     programs.  A comparison of the Energy Scenario with the
     Reference  Scenario,   followed  by  comparisons  of the
     Energy Abatement  Scenario with the Energy Scenario  and
     the  Reference Abatement Scenario, affords insight into
     the    differences   in    the    potential    economic,
     environmental,   and  energy  consequences of  legislated
     pollution  controls  under a range of energy  consumption
     assumptions.

 The  detailed assumptions used to construct the Reference and
 Reference   Abatement   Scenarios  are presented in Appendix B
 along  with  the  changes  in  those assumptions made  for the Low
 Productivity and  the  Energy  Conservation Cases.
                             4-7

-------
Chapter 3
Macro-Analysis Results
Results from the six SEAS scenario runs  were  subjected   to
both  macro-  and  sector-level  analyses  of  the estimated
economic,  environmental,   and   energy   consequences    of
pollution  control.   The  following discussion presents  the
macro-level findings, beginning with the Reference  Scenario
and  proceeding  through the selected scenarios and scenario
comparisons.-  In addition, Appendix C presents  an  analysis
of  the  Municipal  Scenario,  a  variant  of  the Reference
Abatement Scenario that assumes a  continuing  appropriation
of   $7  billion  a  year  for  municipal  sewage  treatment
facilities through the 1976-1985 decade.

A summary of the major results from the  SEAS  scenarios   is
presented  in  Table  1.   These results show that, over  the
decade 1976-85, the total cost of complying with Federal  air
and  water  pollution  control  legislation  constitutes   a
relatively  small  portion  of the decade's cumulative gross
national product (<3NP).  Total decade abatement costs, as  a
percentage of GNP, range from 2.09 percent for the Reference
Case   to  2.25  percent  for  the  Reference  Case  variant
identified above as the Municipal Scenario.

Table 1 indicates a fairly constant increase in  energy   use
by  1985  of 4.2 to 4.9 quadrillion Btu's resulting from  the
addition of pollution abatement practices  in  each  of   the
four  abatement  scenarios.   It also shows the reduction  in
net  residuals  (residuals  discharged  to  the  environment
either  before  or  after  treatment)  achieved by 1985 as a
percentage of the Reference Scenario forecasts for  each   of
five  air  and  four  water  pollutants.   In  general,   the
greatest abatement (reduction of residuals released  to   the
carrier  medium)  is  attained in the Low Productivity Case,
except for the lower amounts of  biochemical  oxygen  demand
(BOD),  suspended  solids, and nutrients are achieved in  the
Municipal Scenario.

The annual composition of  detailed  data  on  the  economy,
energy   use,  resource  demand,  pollutant  residuals,   and
abatement costs are presented  in  the  individual  scenario
analyses which follow.
                            4-8

-------
                          Table 1
                Summary of Scenario Results



*> Scenario
vo
Reference
Reference
Abatement
Municipal
Low Productivity
Low Productivity
Abatement
Energy
Energy
Abatement


1976-85
Decade GNP
(Trillion 1975$)
2O.OO7

20. 153
20.181
18.596

18.8O4
2O.O62

2O. 187
1976-85
Incremental
Decade
Pollution1
Control Cost
(% GNP)

2.O9
2.25


2.22


2. 13


1985 Energy
Consumption
(Quad Btu's)
1O9.O

113.5
113.9
1O2.O

106.2
95.7

10O.4
                                                                       Net  Residuals  1n 1985'  (% of Reference)
                                                                 SO   Part   NO   HC   CO  BOD SS   OS  Nut.

                                                                 1OO.O  1OO.O 1OO.O  10O.O 10O.O 10O.O 10O.O 10O.O 10O.C
                                                                  38.514.O91.439.523.621.9  9.862.38O.5

                                                                  38,614.191.739.523.615.O  5.662.428.4

                                                                  9O.490.688.587.284.792.491,388.399.1


                                                                  34.612.581.635.22O.32O.5  9.455.O8O.1

                                                                  89.896 . 491 .886. 386 . 399. 599 .096 . TOO, O



                                                                  35.213.584.835.O21.521.8  9.959.68O.5
'  See Tables 4,  12.,  and 21  1n this  chapter  and Table  C-1  1n  Appendix C, for composition of pollution  control
  costs by year  from 1976  through 1985.

1  SO * Sulfur Oxides.  Part  =  Partlculates,  NO  » Nitrogen  Oxides, HC = Hydrocarbons, CO « Carbon Monoxide,
  BOD * Biochemical  Oxygen  Demand,  SS  *  Suspended  Solids, DS = Dissolved Solids, Nut. = Nutrients

-------
                   THE REFERENCE SCENARIO

The  Reference  Scenario, which acts as the baseline for all
subsequent  projections,  includes  the   general   forecast
assumptions described below.  {See Appendix B for a detailed
discussion of these assumptions.)

  1. High productivity and government policy  to  achieve  a
     full-supply  labor  force economy by the mid-1980s will
     produce a 1985 GNP of  $2.36  trillion  (1975  constant
     dollars) with an unemployment rate of 4.4 percent for a
     projected   labor   force  of  107.7  million  civilian
     workers.

  2. No municipal or industrial process  will  increase  its
     pollution  control  treatment  efficiency  levels above
     those in use during 1971.

  3. Energy usage and conservation will be  consistent  with
     energy forecasts of the $7.00/barrel "Business-as-Usual
     Without Conservation" scenario of Project independence,
     with an aggregate energy requirement of 109 quadrillion
     Btu's in 1985.

Based  on these assumptions, the Reference Scenario forecast
was  projected  over  the  decade  1976-85.   Some   general
statistics that characterize the baseline projections appear
in Table 2.

The picture of the national economy for this baseline is one
in  which  the  economy  will gradually grow out of the 1975
recession to achieve an unemployment rate of 4.4 percent  by
1985.   GNP  grows  at  a 6.5 percent rate between the years
1975-80 and at a 4.0 percent rate between 1981-85.

Over the decade, the personal consumption  expenditures  and
equipment  investment  components  of  the  GNP show greater
growth rates than the overall GNP growth rate.   Non-Federal
government  expenditures increase at rates well ahead of the
increases in the eicogenously set Federal expenditures  level
(4.4 percent annual increase compared to 1,6 percent).

Total  industrial  output  grows  at a rate somewhat greater
than GNP with the sectors related to agriculture and  mining
showing  the  slowest rates of growth, manufacturing sectors
growing at a rate slightly less than that for total  output,
and   the   sectors  related  to  services,  transportation^
communications,  and  electric  utilities   exhibiting   the
highest  growth  rates.  The slowdown in the growth rate for
the GNP in the years 1980-85 as the country catches up  from
the  downturn  of  the  early Seventies is also reflected in
                           4-10

-------
decreasing rates for most of these industrial output
rates.

The  energy  requirement  to  support  this economic pattern
reflects a growing demand for electricity.   By  1985,  coal
and  nuclear  sources  will  account  for  63 percent of all
energy used in electrical generation, with  coal  accounting
for  33  percent.  Growth in natural gas, petroleum and coal
usage to meet non-electrical energy  demands  on  an  annual
rate  basis  over the decade is 1.1 percent, 2.8 percent and
3.8 percent, respectively.
                            4-11

-------
                          Table 2.
    General Projections of the Reference Scenario (S1),
                         1976-1985
Statistics

Population (Millions)
Labor Force (Millions)
Unemployment Rate (%)
Disposable Income
  Per Capita (1.OOO 1975

Gross National Product
  (Trill1on 1975 $)
Persona1 Consumpt1on
  Expenditures
Investment
Government Expenditures
  Federal
  Other

Total Output
  (Trill Ion 1975 $)

Total Energy Use
  (Quadrillion Btu's)
  Natural  Gas
  Petroleum
  Coal
  Electricity

U.S. Demand
  (Mill ion Metric Tons)
  Copper
  Iron
  A1urn1num

Recycled Materials
  (Mm ion Metric Tons
  Paper/Paperboard
  A1um1num
  Ferrous Metals
                                1976
                                         1977
                                                  1978
                                                           1979
215.80
95.40
7.90
5.62
1.56
0.97
O.26
0.32
O. 12
0.20
2.61
79.97
19.06
31 .36
4.59
24.95
3.20
141 .97
5.65
65.76
6. 19
1 .48
38.26
217.70
97.00
7.10
5.99
1 .67
1.02
0.29
O.33
0. 12
0.21
2.8O
83.48
18.96
32.38
4.89
27.26
3.55
15O.81
6.15
69.73
6.62
1.64
40.27
219.80
98.60
6.OO
6.61
1.77
1,12
0.29
O.34
0. 12
O.22
2.98
86.63
19.43
33.40
5. 01
28.78
3.73
149. 4O
6.42
72.75
7.16
1 .70
41.33
22 1 . 9O
1OO.20
5.5O
7.04
1 .89
1. 19
0.32
O.35
O.12
O.23
3, 19
9O. 12
19.92
34.52
5.28
30. 4O
3.93
158.88
6.89
76.72
7.67
1.88
43. 13
 1980  1981  1982  1983  1984  1985

 224.1O. 226.40 228.7O 231.CO 233.4O 235.7O
 1O1.8O 1O3.20 104.50 1O5.7O 1O6.7O 107.70
 5.1O 5.30 4.8O 4.60 4.50 4.4O

7.54 7.73 8.O7 8.31  8.55 "8.78
 2.01 2.O8 2.15 2.22 2.29 2.36

 1.28 1.32 1.39 1.46 1.51 1.56
 0.34 0.35 O.36 0.36 0.37 O.38
 O.36 O.37 0.38 0.39 O.4O 0.41
 O.12 O.12 O.13 O.13 O,13 O.14
 O.24 0.25 O.25 0.26 0.27 O.27
 3.41 3.53 3.67 3.8O 3.93 4.O7
93 .6296 . 4O99 . 4
-------
                Table 2. (Continued)
General Projections of the Reference Scenario (S1),
                     1976-1985
I
NJ
Ul
Statistics

Total Vehicle Kilometers
  (TM11 Ions)
  Auto
Total Freight Metric Ton-
  Kilometers (Billions)
  Truck
  Rail

Net Air Residuals
  (Million Metric Tons)
  PartIculates
  Sulfur Oxides
  Nitrogen Oxides
  Hydrocarbons
  Carbon Monoxide

Net Water Residuals
  (Million Metric Tons)
  Biochemical Oxygen
     Demand
  Suspended Sol ids
  Dissolved Solids
  Nutrients

Incremental
Air Control Costs
  Investment'
  Annual1zed Costs
     Capital'
     05M
  Capital  in Place
  Direct Employment
                            1976     1977     1978     1979     198O  1981  1982  1983  1984  1985
                                                                2.O5 2.11 2.21 2.28 2.35 2.42
                                                                2.03 2.09 2.19 2.26 2.33 2.40

                                                                4.35 4.49 4.64 4.80 4.96 5.13
                                                                O.95 1.OO 1.04 1.O9 1.14 1.2O
                                                                1.37 1.41 1.45 1.49 1.53 1.57
                                                               37 .4138 . 1538.9939.9540.9442.OO
                                                               44.1244.6145.3746.2547.2648.44
                                                               23.1823.7724.6025.3926.2427.16
                                                               14.0114.2814.7515.1415.5515.94
                                                               89.2091.9O96.1O99.3OO2.5O 1O5.70
                                                                5.12 5.24 5.4O 5.55 5.69 5.84
                                                               11.7711.9712.1812.4112.6412.89
                                                               14.2314.3314.5114.6614.8014.95
                                                                1.28 1.30 1.33 1.35 1.37 .1.4O
                                                       0        0        O      OOOOOO
                                                       0        O        0      OOOOOO
                                                       0        0        0      OOOOOO
                                                       0        0        O      OOOOOO
                                                       O        0        0      OOOOOO
                                                       0        0        O      OOOOOO
1 .
1 .
3.
O.
1 .
3O.
36.
18.
12.
7O.
4.
9.
12,.
1 .
62
61
55
73
14
37
74
65
17
3O
23
78
O6
19
1
1
3.
O
1 .
32
39
20.
12
74,
'4,
10.
12
1
.70
.68
.76
.79
.21
.43
.87
,00
.42
.10
.44
.31
.57
,21
1
1
3
0
1,
33
41
21 .
13,
79,
4
1O,
13.
1 ,
.85
.83
.92
.83
.25
.85
. 14
.07
.02
.80
.68
.67
. 14
.23
1
1
4
O
1
35
42
22.
13.
84,
4.
11 .
13,
1 ,
.94
.92
. 14
.89
.31
.61
.59
.07
.46
.20
.89
.20
.68
.26
                              O
                              0
                              O
                              O
                              0
                              0

-------
                    Table 2. (Continued)
    General Projections of the Reference Scenario (S1),
                         1976-1985
I
M
rf»
Statistics

Incremental
Water Industrial Costs
  Investment
  Annual1zed Costs
     Capital
     O&M
  Capital In Place
  Direct Employment

Incremental
Water Municipal Costs
  Investment
  Annual1zed Costs
     Capital
     O&M
  Capital 1n Place
  Direct Employment
1976     1977      1978      1979      198O   198,1   1982   1983   1984   1985
  O        O        O        O      OOOOOO
  O        0        0        0      OOOOOO
  O        0        0        O      OOOOOO
  0        O        O        O      OOOOOO
  O        0        0        O      OOOOOO
  0        0        0        O      OOOOOO
  O        0        O        0      OOOOOO
  0        0        0        0      OOOOOO
  O        O        0        0      OOOOOO
  0        0        0        O      OOOOOO
  0        0        0        O      OOOOOO
  0        0        O        0      OOOOOO
     Includes state transportation control costs and mobile source pollution abatement expenditures.

     Annualized to include interest on all investments, including those for mobile source controls.

-------
Resource  demand  projections  for  the  Reference  Scenario
indicate  increasing  requirements for virgin ore resources.
For example, U.S.  demand  for  iron  ore  increases  at  an
average annual rate of slightly over 2 percent per year over
the-  period,  with  higher  rates  during  the  1970 decade.
Similar demand patterns, but with slightly higher  rates  of
increase, are noted for both aluminum and copper ores.  This
usage reflects the growth pattern shown in Table 2 for total
output,  with the annual growth rates of the late 1970's two
times or more the rates for the early 1980's.  The  patterns
noted  for  these  metal  ores  are also found in the demand
statistics  for recycling of paper/paperboard,  aluminum  and
ferrous   metals.    Demand   for   recycled   aluminum   is
particularly  heavy  over  the  decade,  averaging  about  8
percent growth per year.

As  a  final  set  of  characterizations  of  the  Reference
Scenario, the following patterns can  be  noted  for  annual
levels   of  air   and  water  residuals  released  to  the
environment.

First, the  annual growth rates for all air-  and  water-borne
residuals   are   less   than  the economic growth rate and are
less than the manufacturing output growth rate.  Thus,  even
with  no improved treatment efficiencies past 1971, relative
improvement in residuals per dollar of output  produced  are
noted  for  all  major  residuals categories due to increasing
use of cleaner production technologies.  However, the change
is relatively small,   and  the  absolute  levels  of  annual
residual  loads   continue  to increase  for all air and water
residual categories throughout the decade.

Second, the decade projections also show that air  residuals
are   increasing   at   rates greater than the  water residuals.
To provide  greater detail  on  growth  rates by  generation
source   (i.e.,   industrial,  municipal,  transportation,  or
electric utilities),   Figures  1  and  2  are . provided   for
evaluation  and   comparison.   The  data   in Figures  1 and  2
demonstrate that although the growth  rates of air  residuals
connected   with   mobile"  sources  are  greater than those  for
stationary  sources,  the  growth rate of  air  residuals   from
any   source  is   consistently higher  than  the growth  rate of
water  residuals.

Finally, Table  3 presents  the change   in   stationary   source
treatment   efficiencies  from   1975   through   1985.   These
efficiencies  are calculated   as   gross residuals   less   net
residuals  divided by gross  residuals,  where:

   •   Gross  residuals  equal  the  residuals  that would occur  if
      there  were no end-of-process treatment  of  discharges.
                            4-15

-------
»  Net residuals equal the residuals  that  occur  due  to
   end-of-process   treatment   of   discharges   by  each
   industrial process.
                        4-16

-------
                  Figure  1.
Trends in Air Residuals in  Reference Scenario
JPP











                                            J1 T7
                                             YtM
                      4-17

-------
                          Figure 2.
Trends  in  Water Residuals In Reference  Scenario(1971-1985
                                               mion~tiu.li
                                                       t
                                               fl  n n
                                                 rft pi TiTrl'l
                            4-18

-------
                          Table 3.
     Relative Stationary Source Treatment Efficiencies
               of Selected Pollutants for the
                     Reference Scenario
       (Efficiencies in Percent of Residuals Removed)
                       1975        1980        1985

Air Residuals

Particulates           73.66       74.05       73.83
Sulfur Oxides          23.89       23.26       23.54
Nitrogen Oxides         0.23        0.24        0.26
Hydrocarbons           39.69       39.66       41.41
Carbon Monoxide        46.46       46.68       48.07

Water Residuals

Biochemical oxygen
  Demand               69.02       67.74       67.57
Suspended Solids       82.82       83.11       83.68
Dissolved Solids       31.10       32.43       34.57
Nutrients              35.42       38.97       40.88
In the case of air residuals, the treatment efficiencies are
relatively constant, suggesting only minor improvements from
switches  in industrial processes used for the  abatement  of
air   emissions.    On    the   other   hand,  the  treatment
efficiencies  for water   residuals  exhibit  small  increases
over  the.decade  (with the exception of BOD).  This suggests
that  industrial  sectors which   had   higher   efficiency
treatment processes  for water  residuals  as  of 1971 are
growing  faster  than  those   industrial  sectors  with  less
efficient processes.

in  summary,  environmental   forecasts  from  the  Reference
Scenario  behave as would be expected with the calibration of
macroeconomic indicators to a high-growth, high-productivity
set of assumptions.  Economic growth and resource usage  are
greatest  in the period 1975-80, with all annual growth rates
considerably  slowed in 1980-85.  Environmental residuals are
also  increasing,  -but the annual growth rates are less than
the annual economic growth rates.   Between  air  and  water
residuals,  the air residuals consistently show the greatest
annual growth rates.
                            4-19

-------
                COMPARISON OF THE REFERENCE
             AND REFERENCE ABATEMENT SCENARIOS
The Reference  .scenario  assumptions  were  changed  in  the
following  ways  to provide a scenario that approximated the
Reference Scenario, but which also included the effects  and
costs   of   Federal   air   and   water  pollution  control
regulations:

  1. All  Federally  mandated  treatment  efficiencies   and
     associated  cost  functions  for  control  processes  to
     achieve these efficiencies  were  introduced  into  the
     calculations,

  2. All forecast  capital  and  operation  and  maintenance
     (O&M)  pollution  control  costs were fed back into the
     economy as increased interindustry purchases and  labor
     requirements on an annual basis.

  3. The  additional  labor  force  required  for  pollution
     control   was   assumed  to  be  provided  by  reducing
     unemployment until the commonly accepted minimum  level
     of 4 percent was reached.  If in any year, unemployment
     under  abatement  conditions fell below 4 percent, then
     final demand was reduced through adjustment of Personal
     Disposal income until an unemployment rate equal to   or
     slightly greater than 4 percent was produced.

The  results  of  this new scenario, the Reference Abatement
scenario, are compared to those of the Reference Scenario  in
the analysis that follows.

Under the schedule of compliance  with  Federal  regulations
for  the  Reference  Abatement Scenario, some of the capital
expenditures for pollution control devices occur as early  as
1971; hence the 1975 data between the two scenarios  exhibit
some  differences.   Table 4, which is comparable to Table 2
for the Reference Scenario, presents summary statistics  for
the Reference Abatement Scenario.  The values of the various
statistics  for the years 1976 through 1985 provide a useful
means  of  comparing  relative  growth  rates  for  the  two
scenarios.   Note  that  the costs and additional industrial
output associated with compliance in the Reference Abatement
Scenario  act  as  a  stimulus  to  GNP,  total  output  and
employment,

In  the  period   1976-79,  since there was sufficiently high
unemployment, the additional labor force required  to  carry
out   the   mandated   pollution   abatement  activities   is
transferred from  idle resources, thus  resulting  in  a  net
                            4-20

-------
benefit  to the economy.  From 1980-85 however, the required
level of labor needed for pollution abatement is  in  excess
of  the  amount  available,  and  so labor resources must be
taken away from other competing needs.  Even in these years,
the fact that there are  some  unemployed  resources  before
abatement   controls   were  mandated  means  that  the  GNP
increases in all years.  Among the  industries  required  to
implement   abatement   technologies,   those   that  supply
abatement equipment and materials are  impacted  at  various
levels.   Although  all supplying industries are required to
shift revenues away from production to pollution control  in
their  processes,  some  receive  enough  orders  from other
industries to offset or more than offset the  intra-industry
shifts.   These  industries are net gainers  (i.e., platinum),
while    remaining   industries   are   net   losers   (i.e.,
agriculture).
                             4-21

-------
                          Table 4
General  Projections of  the Reference Abatement Scenario (S2),
                          1976-1985
#»
N>
 Statistics

 Population  (Millions)
 Labor Force (Millions)
 Unemployment Rate  (%)
 Disposable  Income
  Per Capita (1 ,OOO  1975

 Gross National  Product
  (Tri1 lion 1975 $)
 Personal Consuinpt ion
  Expenditures
 Investment
 Gov  Expenditures
  Federal
  Other

 Total Output
  (Tril11on 1975 $)
 Total Energy Use
  (Quadrillion Btu's)
  Natural Gas
  Petroleum
  Coal
  Electricity

U.S. Demand
  (Million  Metric Tons)
  Copper
  Iron
  A1um1num

Recycled Materials
  (Million  Metric Tons)
  Paper/Paperboard
  A1um1num
  Ferrous Metals
$)
1976

215.80
 95.40
  6.40

  5.62
         1 .59
                                                    1977

                                                    217.7O
                                                     97.OO
                                                      5.4O

                                                      5.98
                  1 .69
1978

219.8O
 98.60
  4.4O

  6.61
                           1 .80
1979     1980  1981  1982  1983  1984  1985

221.9O   224.10 226..4Q 228.70 231 .OO 23.3. 4O 235.7O
10O.20   1O1.8O 1O3.2O 104.50 105.70 .106.7O 107.70
  4.4O   4.6O 4.5O 4.4O 4.20 4.1O 4,1O

  7.02   7.48 7.73 8.O1 8.29 8.52 8.72
                                    1,91
0
o
o
0
o
2
82
19.
32.
4
25
3.
146.
5.
66.
6
1
38
..97
.28
.32
. 12
.20
.66
.81
.61
.65
.80
.77
.32
. 13
,81
.56
.23
.51
.81
1 .
0.
O.
0.
0,
2.
86.
19.
33,
5.
28.
3.
155.
6.
70.
6,
1
40
.03
.30
.34
. 12
.22
.86
.45
56
49
, 11
.29
.69
.72
33
,59
.66
.67
.85
1
0
O
0
0
3
89
20
34
5
30
3
155
6
73
7
1
41
. 12
..3.O
.35
. 12
.23
.04
.81
.06
.47
.25
.03
.86
.36
.60
.64
.20
.72
.96
1 .
0.
0.
O.
O.
3.
93.
2O.
35.
5.
31 .
4,
161 ,
7.
77
7.
1
43
19
33
36
12
24
24
37
56
59
46
76
,05
92
03
.31
.68
.90
.57
                                           2.02 2.09 2.16 42.23 2.30 2.37
                                           1.27 1.33
                                           O.35 O.36
                                           O.37 0.38
                                           0.12 0.13
                                           O.25 O.25 O.26 O.27 O.27 O.28
                                               .39 1.45 1.5O 1.56
                                              0.36 O.37 0.37 0.38
                                              O.39 O.4O 0.41 O.42
                                              0.13 0.13 0.14 0.14
                                           3.44 3.57 3.69 3.82 3.95 4.08

                                          96 .7899.9402 .9.1O6. 3O09 .9513.51
                                          21.0321.2721.4721.7222.O322.25
                                          36.6137.6638.6139.6240.6441.62
                                           5.66 5.78 5.89 6.O2 6.16 6.31
                                          33.4935.2237.0038.9541.1243.33
                                           4.21 4.27 4.34 4.41 4.47 4.53
                                           167.29 168.23 166.SO 167.25  168.04  169.77
                                           7.45 7.69 7.86 8.08 8.30 8.57
                                          81.1O83.6185.§088.4790.8492.97
                                           8.18 8.51 8.83 9.18 9.51 9.82
                                           2.1O 2.29 2.23 2.47 2.60 2.68
                                          45.1946.2947.3148.4O49.285O.06

-------
                                  Table 4.  (Continued)
              General  Projections of the Reference Abatement Scenario (S2),
                                       1976-1985
              Statistics
                                              1976
                                                       1977
                                                                1978
                                                                         1979
                                                                                  1980   1981   1982   1983   1984   1985
*>
I
to
W
Total Vehicle Kilometers
  (TM 11 ions)
  Auto
Total Freight Metric
  Ton-Kilometers
  (B111Ions)
  Truck
  Rail

Net A1r Residuals
  (Million
  Metric Tons)
  Part leulates
  Sulfur Oxides
  Nitrogen Oxides
  Hydrocarbons
  Carbon Monoxide

Net Water Residuals
  (Mi 111on
  Metric Tons)
  Biochemical Oxygen
     Demand
  Suspended Sol Ids
  Dissolved Solids
  Nutrients
1
1
3
0
1
12
19
18
1O
55
3
6
11
1
.62
.61
.66
.75
. 18
.68
.31
.59
.09
.76
. 18
.51
.48
. 14
1
1
3
0
1
8
14
19
S
52
2
4
11
1
.70
,68
.87
.81
.24
.29
.61
.81
.49
.6^
.75
.84
.49
.13
1 .
1 .
4.
0.
1.
8.
15.
2O.
9.
5O.
2.
2.
11.
1.
85
83
04
86
29
51
28
75
41
73
26
86
54
12
1 .
1 .
4.
0.
1 .
8.
15.
21 .
9.
47.
2.
2.
11.
1 .
93
92
24
9'1
34
85
94
46
15
35
23
87
94
13
                                                                                  2.03  2.11  2.19  2.27  2.35  2.41
                                                                                  2.02  2.O9  2.17  2.25  2.33  2.39
                                                                                  4.43  4.58 4.72 4.89  5.05  5.22
                                                                                  O.97  1.02 1.06 1.11  1.17  1.22
                                                                                  1.40  1.44 1.47 1.51  1.56  1.6O
 9.17 9.34 8.5O 7.66 6.86 5.87
16.6117.0317.3317.7218.1718.63
22.1922.6123.2523.8224.2924.83
 8.92 8.59 8.OO 7.38 6.86 6.29
43.8539.9535.1231.5227.6824.90
                                                                                 2.2O 2.O1  1.81  1.59  1.37  1.28
                                                                                 2.90 2.53  2.15  1.76  1.34  1.27
                                                                                 12.3211.391O.5O  9.72  9.03  9.31
                                                                                 1 . 13 1 . 13  1. 13  1 . 12  1 . 12  1 . 12
              Incremental
              A1r  Control  Costs
                (B111 Ion  1975  $)
                Investment'
                Annualized Costs
                  Capital*
                  O&M
                Capital  in Place
                Direct  Employment
                  (Thousands)
                                  6.38     8.32    1O.69     8.08   7.22 7.15 6.87 6.70 6.65 6.84

                                  7.38     8.59    1O.88    12.80  14.4715.8516.9517.7818.3618.72
                                  8.73     8.09     8.10     9.OO   9.6810.2210.6611.0711.4911.93
                                 37.64    44.22    53.69    6O.67  65.997O.4O73.8176.3578.2O79.54

                                 14       17       18       20     21 21 21  20 2O 2O

-------
                    Table 4. (Continued)
General Projections of the Reference Abatement Scenario (52),
                         1976-1985
Statistics

Incremental
Water Industrial Costs
  (Bill Ion 1975 $)
  Investment
  Annualized Costs
     Capital
     O&M
  Capital 1n Place
  Direct Employment
     (Thousands)
Incremental

Water Municipal Costs
  (Bill ion 1975 $)
  Investment
  Annualized Costs
     Capital
     O&M
  Capital in Place
  Direct Employment
     (Thousands)
1976
  3.55

  1.99
  3.64
 15. 12

114
  6.55

  2.27
  O.68
 20.63
 2O
1977
  5.67

  2.73
  4. SO
 2O.79

150
  8. 11

  3. 17
  0.93
 28.74
 27
                  1978
  3.25

  3. 15
  5.85
 23.98

183
  8. 13

  4.06
  1 .36
 36.88
 40
                                                           1979
                  198O  1981   1982   1983   1984   1985
                             5.05   6.38  5.76  6.97  5.31  1.36 1.64
  3-. 81
  8,31
4.64 5.39 6.30 6.99 7.15 7.35
6.74 7.OS 7.29 7.5910.7411.17
 28.97  35.294O.9947.9O53.1553.3855.88

198      211   222  229  238  352  367
  5.59   2.94 1.77 0.80 0.7O O.7O 0.53

  4.68   5.0O 5.20 5.28 5.36 5.44 5.5O
  1.61   1.76 1.84 1.89 1.93 1.97 2.0O
 42.47  45.4147,1747.9748.6749.3749.90
 48     52 54 56 57 58 59
  1   Includes state transportation control costs'and mobile source pollution abatement expenditures.

  2   AnnualIzed to Include interest on all Investments, Including those for mobile source controls.

-------
Table  5  provides  a  comparison  of  a  number of scenario
statistics from the Reference Abatement  Scenario  with  the
same  values developed in the Reference Scenario for each of
five years.  (This comparison uses the Reference Scenario as
a normalizing base,  i.e.  (S2-SD/S1.)   Table  6  presents
pollution  control  costs by type throughout the decade as a
percent of GNP.

When looked at in comparative terms, the costs of  pollution
control  are  relatively  small  for the Reference Abatement
Scenario.  Both GNP, as noted earlier,  and  the  output  of
total  goods  and  services  increase throughout the decade.
Moreover, the introduction  of  these  controls  (given  the
assumptions  stated)  is favorable for most factors of final
demand,  such  as  Federal  expenditures   and   investment.
Further, the change in production processes and the shift in
the mix of goods and services produced eventually results in
a lesser requirement for some of our natural resources, with
paper  and  iron  ore  being  noticeable  examples  by 1985.
However, during the phase of major new  capital  development
(period to 1980), these same resources (and others) actually
are used at higher rates, particularly during the early part
of  this  time period.  Finally, results in the reduction of
the air and water residuals released to the environment  are
reduced.    Except  for  nitrogen  oxides  (-8.66  percent),
nutrients  (-19.51 percent),  and  dissolved  .solids  (-37.72
percent),  these reductions are all greater than 60 percent.
Thus,  over  half  of  most  residuals   released   to   the
environment  without  pollution  control are captured in the
Reference Abatement Scenario.
                           4-25

-------
(O
0*
                                                     Table 5.
                               Comparison of the Macro-Statistics of the Reference
                             Abatement Scenario (52) and the Reference Scenario (51)
                                                [(S2-SO/S1 In X]
Statistic

Gross National Product
Disposable Income Per Capita
Total Employment
Federal Expenditures
Personal Consumption Expenditures
Total Output
Investment
Energy Use
Demand:  Iron
         A1um1num
Recycling:  Paper/Paperboard
            A1um1num
            Ferrous Metals
Vehicle Kilometers
Freight Metric Ton-Kilometers
Net Air Residuals:
  Partlculates
  Sulfur Oxides
  Nitrogen Oxides
  Hydrocarbons
  Carbon Monoxide
Net Water Residuals:
  Biochemical Oxygen Demand
 . Suspended Sol Ids
  Dissolved Solids
  Nutrients
                                                                    1975
                                                  1977
1980
                                                                                               1983   1985
1 .92
O
1 .99
0.24
0.53
2.27
7.26
3.78
3.99
3.38
O.67
3.39
3.23
O
3.41
41 . 15
32.67
O. 1O
13. SO
19. OO
11.72
14. 18
-O.91
-1 .97
1.68
O
1.8O
1.O7
O.25
2.01
5.24
3. 55
3.25
3. 01
0.63
3.01
2.76
0
2.96
-74 . 69
-63 . 36
-0.95
-23.63
-28.99
-38. O4
-52. O9
-8.58
-6. 2O
O.43
-O.82
O.46
2.24
0.41
O.71
2.44
3.37
O. 1O
0.97
-0.25
0.98
0.77
-0.82
1.82
-75. 5O
-62.36
-4.3O
-36 . 34
-5O.57
-57.14
-75. 4O
-13.41
-11.98
O.34 O.96
-0.34 -0.59
0.43 O.24
2.20 2.17
-O.O9 -O.21
O.59 O.37
1.08 O
3.71 4.13
-1 . 19 -1.73
O.37 -O.O6
-0.11 -0.21
0.37 -O.O6
O.12 -0.28
-O.34 -O.59
1.78 1.85
-8O. 83-86. 03
-61.69-61.54
-6.21 -8.56
-51 .24-60.52
-68.27-76.45
-71.26-78. 14
-85.85-9O. 17
-33.71-37.72
-16.62-19.47

-------
                          fable 6.
            Incremental Pollution Control costs
         as a Percentage of Reference Scenario GHP
                             1977  1980  1983  1985  1976-85

Air Stationary
Source Costs

  Annual Capital Cost        0.28  0.30  0.29  0.28    0.29
  O&M Cost                   0.26  0.28  0.25  0.24    0.26

Water industrial Costs

  Annual Capital Cost        0.16  0.23  0.31  0.31    0.25
  O&M Cost                   0.28  0.33  0.34  0.47    0.35

Water Municipal Costs

  Annual Capital Cost        0.19  0.25  0.24  0.24    0.23
  O&M Cost                   0.06  0.09  0.09  0.08    0.08
The effects on  environmental  residuals  in  the  Reference
Abatement   Scenario   are,   as   noted   above,  generally
substantial,  but  quite  different  patterns  and  relative
efficiencies  emerge  when  these  effects are compared with
those resulting from  the  1971 control  technologies  of  the
Reference  Scenario.   For  example, the air residuals shown in
Table 7 reflect this  differential effect:

  •  For   particulates  and  sulfur  oxides,  the  level  of
     maximum  efficiency  is  nearly  realized  by 1980 with
     minor changes  after that  time*   Since  the  primary
     emitters are stationary sources and existing plants are
     assumed   to  be in full  compliance  with  Federally
     mandated pollution control standards by 1980, this time
     pattern is expected.  Further small improvement can  be
     noted after  1980 for particulates; this is due  to the
     more  stringent regulations on new facilities.

  •  For nitrogen oxides, the relative levels  of  treatment
     are   so minimal  that the level of annual residuals from
     industries  increases  at  nine-tenths  the   rate   of
     economic  output.    About  60  percent  of all nitrogen
     oxide residuals  in   1985  are  released  by  stationary
     sources.    For   vehicle   emissions,   the   rate  of
     improvement  in  treatment  efficiencies  is   somewhat
                            4-27

-------
better,  but  still  so  marginal  that  an increase  in
annual levels of total nitrogen oxides released to  the.
air is noted.  Table 8 provides data-for nitrogen oxide
from  passenger  transportation,  showing  & 39 percent
reduction  in  emissions  per  Kilometer  in  1985    as
compared to the 1975 control levels.

For the final two air residual categories, hydrocarbons
and  carbon  monoxide,  significant   improvements    in
treatment  efficiencies  by  1985 are noted as shown  in
Table   8,   with   the   improvements   in   post-1980
efficiencies   continuing   to  be  significant.   This
effect, unliKe that seen for particulates,  is  because
the  chief emitters of hydrocarbons and carbon monoxide
are mobile  sources  of  considerable  vintage.   Since
retrofit  equipment  is  not  a  part  of  the  assumed
pollution,  controls,  the  steady  state  condition   of
almost  all automobiles having emission characteristics
similar to the roost stringent standards will not  occur
until  about  1995  when  most  of the 1975-and-earlier
vintage automobiles  will  have  been  retired.   Thus,
delays in meeting specific mobile source standards will
be  reflected  in higher annual emissions for these two
air residual categories for periods up to  two  decades
later.
                      4-28

-------
                           Table 7.
     Relative Stationary Source Treatment  Efficiencies of
Selected Pollutants for the  Reference and Reference Abatement Scenarios
        (EffIc'lendes in Percent of  Residuals Removed)
                                1975
                                                           1980
A1r Residuals

Partlculates
Sulfur Oxides
Nitrogen Oxides
Hydrocarbons
Carbon Monoxide
                        Reference
73.66
23.89
 0.23
39.69
46.46
           Reference
           Abatement
85.33
51 .24
 2.53
SO. 79
62. 14
                                                  Reference
74.05
23.26
 O.24
39.66
46.68
                          Reference
                          Abatement
                      1985

                          Reference
                      Reference Abatement
94.06
72,93
 5.64
59.30
72.75
73.83 96.96
23.54 72.27
 0,26  5,65
41.41 70.91
48.07 76.17
Water Residuals

Biochemical Oxygen
  Demand                69.O2       72.43
Suspended Sol Ids        82.82       85.78
Dissolved Solids        31.10       33.8O
Nutrients               35.42       37.26
                           67.74       86.17   67.57 92.91
                           83.11       96.07   83.68 98.50
                           32.43       43.84   34..S7 61.15
                           38.97       47.45   40.88 53.83
                              Table  8.
    Passenger Transportation Emission  Levels  for  the  Reference
                 and Reference Abatement  Scenarios
       (Metric Tons per Million Vehicle Kilometers Travelled)
   A1r  Residuals
                                   1975
                           Reference
                                       Reference
                                       Abatement
                                     1980           1985

                                         Reference     Reference
                             Reference   Abatement  Reference Abatement
   Partlculates
   Sulfur Oxides
   Nitrogen 'Oxides
   Hydrocarbons
   Carbon Monoxide
    0.22
    O.O8
    1.94
    2.65
   22.05
    0.18
    0.08
    1.82
    2.28
    17.91
    O.21
    0.08
    1.92
    2.21
   22.3O
    0. 16
    0.08
    1 .60
    1 .25
   10.48
    0.21
    0.08
    1.91
    2.13
   22.48
0. 14
O.08
1.11
0.52
3.65
                                             4-29

-------
The  water  residuals  of  the  Reference Abatement Scenario
shown in Table 7 exhibit the following patterns:

  •  For  BOD  and  total  suspended   solids,   significant
     improvement  occurs  throughout  the  decade, with high
     points coinciding with the regulatory years for BPT and
     BAT (1977 and 1983).  Since most suspended  solids  are
     treated  within  industrial  plants, the required high-
     efficiency level  for  industry  is  reflected  in  the
     overall  treatment  efficiency  of 96.1 percent in 1980
     and 98.5  percent  in  1985.   For  BOD,  however,  the
     existing pre-1971 BOD removal efficiencies at municipal
     plants result in an improvement of only 74 percent from
     1971  efficiencies  by  1985..   The  actual  treatment
     efficiency achieved by 1985 is 93 percent  of  the  BOD
     and  98.5  percent  of  the suspended solids that would
     have occurred if no treatment took place.

  •  For  total  dissolved  solids,  the  Federal   controls
     produce   some   relative   improvements  in  treatment
     efficiency by 1977, the BPT compliance year,  and  then
     increase  that  treatment efficiency by over 50 percent
     by 1985.  Even in 1985, however, the  actual  treatment
     efficiency is only about 61 percent.

  •  For  nutrients,  the  relative  treatment  efficiencies
     improve  from about 37 percent in 1975 to 54 percent in
     1985.  This improvement occurs primarily as a result of
     the growth in tertiary treatment by municipal plants.

Thus, it appears that the Reference Abatement  Scenario  has
positive impacts compared to the Reference Scenario for both
environmental  effects  and  effects on the general economy.
Areas that suffer adverse impacts do  exist  and  are  found
primarily as demand for higher resource usage.

In  energy  requirements,  the  Reference Abatement Scenario
generates an overall demand requiring a 3.4 percent increase
for 1980 and 4.1 percent  by  1985.   The  annual  rates  of
growth  compared  to  the Reference Scenario over the decade
are similar, as are demands  for  specific  energy  sources.
The reasons for the increased demand are both the additional
energy  requirements  resulting  from  the  generally higher
economic output associated with control device purchases and
the energy needed to operate these devices.

Iron, aluminum and copper usage also reflects the stimulated
manufacturing  output   levels,   as   does   recycling   of
paper/paperboard,  aluminum and ferrous materials.  However,
material resource usage decreases after  completion  of  the
major  pollution  capital investments while energy continues
                           4-30

-------
to  grow  due  to  operating  demands  from  the   pollution
equipment.

Finally,  the  comparison  of  the demand for transportation
reveals that passenger vehicle-kilometers, are slightly  less
in   the  Reference  Abatement  Scenario  after  1980.   The
increase in freight metric-ton Kilometers over the decade in
the Reference Abatement  Scenario  is,  however,  relatively
steady and reflects higher manufacturing shipments.

Prior  to  presenting  a detailed analysis of sector effects
for the Reference Case scenarios,  the  other  two  scenario
pairs  are  analyzed.   This will provide an appreciation of
the effects of abatement policies  under  changes  in  those
parts  of  the national economy that are outside the control
of environmental policy makers.
                COMPARATIVE ANALYSIS FOR THE
                 LOW-PRODUCTIVITY SCENARIOS

The Low Productivity Case scenarios represent a  low point on
the range of economic conditions; this allows for a  greater
appreciation   of   the   relative   impacts   of  abatement
regulations under  different economic  conditions.   The  two
scenarios are  labelled the Low Productivity Scenario and the
Low   Productivity  Abatement   Scenario.    The  principal
difference between the Reference Case scenarios  and the  Low
Productivity Case  scenarios is that the basic data for labor
productivity   in   each   industry  and the expenditures which
comprise the   GNP   elements  were  used  directly  from  the
INFORUM-supplied data base for the Low Productivity Scenario
and   the  Low  Productivity Abatement Scenario.   (INFORUM is
the interindustry, input-output forecasting model which  was
used  to  produce  economic forecasts for SEAS.   A summary of
this  model is  provided in Appendix A.)  Use of this  set  of
data  results in a  less optimistic economic forecast relative
to  the Reference  Scenario after 1977, as shown  in Figure 3.
In going from  the   Low   Productivity  Scenario   to  the  Low
Productivity   Abatement  Scenario, the same steps were taken
as in going  from the Reference  Scenario  to  the  Reference
Abatement Scenario.

A  summary  of the Low Productivity  Scenario results is
presented in Table 9.  Table  10  provides  a  comparison  of
these results  to the Reference Scenario, which also includes
no incremental pollution control costs or effects.  In terms
of  GNP,  the  Low  Productivity Scenario results  for 1975 are
greater than the projections  used  in the Reference Scenario.
By 1977, the two scenarios have nearly equal GNP's, and then
                            4-31

-------
the lower productivity assumptions rapidly reduce the  level
of  GNP  so  that by 1985 it is nearly 12 percent lover than
GNP in the Reference Scenario ($2.08 versus $2.36  trillion,
in constant 1975 dollars}.
                          4-32

-------
            Figure 3.
  Scenario Projections of GNP
(1971  Abatement Control Levels)
  76  77  78  79  80  81  92  63  84  85
                                   ENERGY CONSERVATION
                                   CASES,)

                                               
               4-33

-------
                                                     Table 9.
                            General  Projections of the Low Productivity  Scenario  (S3),
                                                    1976-1985
       Statistics
                                       1976
                                                1977
                                                         1978
                                                                  1979
                                                                           1980
                                                                                    1981
                                                                                             1982
                                                                                                      1983
                                                                                                               1984
                                                                                                                        1985
OJ
Population  (Millions)
Labor  Force  (Millions)
Unemployment Rate  (%)
Disposable  Income
  Per  Capita (l.OOO  1975 $)

Gross  National Product
  (Tril1 ion  1975 $)
  Personal Consumption
     Expenditures
  Investment
  Government Expenditures
     Federal
     Other

Total  Output
  (Tr1111on  1975 $)

Total  Energy Use
  (Quadrillion Btu's)
  Natural Gas
  Petroleum
  Coal
  Electricity

U.S. Demand
  (Million Metric Tons)
  Copper
  Iron
  Aluminum

Recycled Materials
  (Million Metric Tons)
  Paper/Paperboard
  Aluminum
  Ferrous Metals
                                       215.8O
                                        95. 4O
                                         7.90

                                         5.92
                                         1.6O
217.70
 97.0O
  7. 2O

  6.05
  1.66
219.80
 98.60
  6.10

  6.46
                                                           1.73
221.90
100.2O
  5.50

  6.57
                    1 .78
224. 10
1O1.80
  5.20

  6.76
                    1.84
226.4O
1O3.2O
  5.3O

  6.85
                    1.88
228.7O
1O4.5O
  4.90

  7.07
                    1.94
231.00
1O5.70
  4.7O

  7. 12
                    1.99
233.4O
1O6.70
  4.50

  7.26
                                                                 2.04
235.7O
107.70
  4.40

  7.33
                                                                 2.08
O.99
0.27
O.31
0.11
O.2O
2.68
81.28
19.43
31 .91
4.71
25.23
3.34
145.81
5.81
66.88
6.38
1.51
38.75
1.O3
0.28
O.32
O.11
O.21
2. SO
83.64
18.99
32.48
4.86
27.29
3.57
149.79
6.12
69.57
6.66
1.64
40. 15
1
O
O
0
0
2
85
19
33
4
28
3
143
6
71
7
1
40
.10
.28
.33
. 11
.22
.91
.62
. 15
.07
.86
.54
.63
.67
.21
.29
.02
.66
.60
1 .13
O.28
0.34
0.11
O.23
3. 01
87.46
19.20
33.59
4.93
29.73
3.67
146. SO
6.43
73.35
7.26
1 .80
41 .57
1
0
O
0
0
3
89
19
34
5
3O
3
149
6
75
7
1
42
. 17
.29
.35
.12
.23
. 12
.27
.28
.03
.02
.93
.73
.39
.65
.67
.52
.96
.61
1.21
O.30
0.35
0. 12
O.23
3. 2O
91 .45
19.33
34.74
5. 1O
32.28
3.75
149.3O
6.81
77.54
7.71
2. 14
43.50
1.25
O.31
0.36
O.12
0.24
3.32
94.23
19.52
35.59
S.25
33.87
3.88
151.09
7.O5
79.94
8.0O
2.09
44.75
1 .28
0.31
0.37
O. 13
O.24
3.4O
96.66
19.58
36.31
5.34
35.43
3.98
151 .94
7.25
81 .96
8. 19
2.33
45.76
1 .32
O.32
0.38
0. 13
O.25
3.50
99.36
19.70
37. 05
5.46
37. 15
4.06
153.31
7.46
84. OO
8.43
2.45
46. 6O
1 .36
O.33
0.38
0. 13
O.25
3.59
102. O4
19.77
37.77
5.56
38.95
4. 13
154.28
7.66
85.50
8.62
2.51
47. 18

-------
                                                 Table 9, (Continued)
                              General Projections of the Low Productivity Scenario (S3),
                                                      1976-1985
         Statistics
                                         1976
                                                  1977
                                                           1978
                                                                    1979
                                                                             198O
                                                                                      1981
                                                                                                1982
                                                                                                         1983
                                                                                                                  1984
                                                                                                                           1985
U>
Ul
Total Vehicle Kilometers
  (Trill ions)
  Auto
Total .Freight Metric
  Ton-K11ometers
  (Bill ions)
  Truck
  Rail

Net Air Residuals
  (Mill ion Metric Tons)
  Particulates
  Sulfur Oxides
  Nitrogen Oxides
  Hydrocarbons
  Carbon Monoxide

Net Water Residuals
  (Mill ion Metric Tons)
  Biochemical Oxygen
     Demand
  Suspended Sol ids
  01 solved Sol ids
  Nutrients

Incremental
Air Control Costs
  Investment1
  Annualized Cost
     Capital *
     O&M
  Capital in Place
  Direct Employment
1
1
3
0
1
31
37
19
12
72
4
9
12
1
.68
.67
.64
.75
. 17
. 16
.51
. 11
.52
.65
.30
.99
.40
. 19
1
1
3
O
1
32
39
2O
12
74
4
10
12
1
.71
.70
.76
.78
.20
.46
.96
.08
.49
.61
.45
.28
.61
.21
1.
1.
3.
O.
1.
33.
40.
20.
12.
77.
4.
10.
12.
1 .
81
79
85
81
22
O9
48
70
76
97
61
40
87
23
1
1
3
O
1
33
4O
21
12
78
4
io
12
1
.81
.79
.94
.85
.25
.81
.85
.02
.70
.68
.71
,62
.96
.25
1
1
4
O
1
34
41
21
12
SO
4
10
13
1
.84
.82
.03
.88
.27
.56
.28
.43
.81
.24
.84
.86
.07
.27
1
1
4
O
1
35
41
21.
12,
81 .
4.
11.
13.
1 .
.87
.85
. 14
.91
.29
.05
.38
.78
.94
.83
94
00
04
29
1
1
4
O
1
35
41
22
13
84
5
11
13
1
.93
.92
.28
.96
.33
.92
.99
.42
.29
.77
.08
.25
. 17
.32
1
1
4
1
1
36
42
22
13
86
5
11
13
1
.96
.94
.39
.CO
.36
.56
.32
.85
.44
.00
. 17
.41
. 15
.34
2
1
4
1
1
37
43
23
13.
88
5.
11 .
13,
1 .
-OO
.98
.52
.04
.39
.31
.OS
.46
.72
. 11
.29
6O
19
36
2.
2.
4.
1 .
1 .
38.
43.
24.
13.
89.
5.
1 1 .
13.
1 .
03
01
65
OS
42
03
8O
03
91
54
39
76
19
38
                                            O
                                            O
                                            0
                                            0
                                            0
                                            0
O
O
O
0
0
O
O
O
O
0
0
O
0
O
0
O
0
0
O
0
0
O
0
O
O
O
0
0
0
O
0
O
O
0
O
O
0
O
0
O
O
O
O
O
0
O
O
O
O
O
0
O
0
0

-------
                                                Table 9. (Continued)
                             General Projections of the Low Productivity Scenario (S3),
                                                     1976-1985
        Statistics
                                        1976
                                                  1977
                                                          1978
                                                                   1979
                                                                     1980
                                                                                     1981
                                                                                               1982
                                                                                                        1983
                                                                                                                 1984
                                                                                                                  1985
U)
tr>
 Incremental
 Water  Industrial Costs
   Investment
   AnnualIzed Costs
     Capital
     O&M
   Capital  In Place
   Direct Employment

-Incremental
 Water Municipal Costs
   Investment
   AnnualIzed Costs
     Capital
     O&M
   Capital  in Place
   Direct Employment
0
0
O
O
O
O
                                           0
                                           O
                                           O
                                           0
                                           O
                                           0
O
O
0
0
0
0
         O
         0
         0
         O
         O
         0
0
O
0
0
O
O
         0
         0
         0
         O
         O
         0
0
0
0
6
O
O
         0
         O
         0
         O
         O
         0
0
0.
6
O
O
0
         O
         O
         O
         O
         O
         0
O
O
O
O
O
O
         O
         O
         O
         O
         O
         0
0
O
O
O
O
0
         0
         O
         0
         O
         O
         0
0
O
0
0
O
O
         0
         O
         0
         0
         0
         0
0
0
0
0
0
0
         0
         0
         0
         O
         O
         0
0
O
O
0
0
0
         0
         O
         0
         O
         O
         0
             Includes s.tate transportation control costs and mobile source .pollutlon abatement  expenditures.
             Annual1zed to Include interest on all investments.  Including  those for mobile  source controls.

-------
The  impact of the lower productivity assumptions after 1977
is readily seen: with  unemployment  rates  consistent  with
those   of   the   Reference  .Scenario  across  the  decade,
considerable reductions in personal consumption expenditures
are required in order  to  maintain  full-supply  6NP.   The
historical  INFORUM  projections of productivity are greater
than the actual 1975 factors and are nearly  equal  to  1977
forecasts   for   the   Reference  Scenario.   The  greatest
divergence in forecasts for the two  scenarios  occurs  over
the period 1977-80, but significant change continues through
1985.    The   percentage   .differences   in   the  personal
consumption expenditures for 1980, 1983 and  1985  are  -7.8
percent,  -11.2  percent  and  -13.0  percent, respectively.
These changes, as well as those prior to 1980, parallel  the
changes  in  GNP  between  the  two  scenarios.   in further
comparing results from  the  two  scenarios,  the  drops  in
equipment  and  construction investment are greater than the
change in GNP in each, while total output parallels the  GNP
change.    The  impact  of  these  economic  differences  on
transportation  in  the   Low   Productivity   Scenario   is
significant,  with  the vehicle kilometers travelled reduced
by over 10 percent from 1980 to 1985.  The annual  reduction
in  freight-metric-ton-kilometers  for the period of 1977-85
is on the order of 1 percent.

The effects of the Low  Productivity  Scenario  on  material
usage,  as  measured  by U.S. demands for iron, aluminum and
copper, follow the economic trends for the  period  1980-85,
with  each  demand being down by about 10 percent during the
6-year period.  Demands for recycled materials, as  typified
by  aluminum,   paper products, and ferrous metals, also are
reduced.  The decrease in recycled aluminum  is  6  percent,
only three-fifths of the drop in demand for primary aluminum
ore.   For  recycled  paper  products, the drop in demand is
from 8.3 percent to 12.4 percent over the period 1980-85.

Energy  usage  also  shows  significant  reductions.   Total
usage, in quadrillion Btu's, drops from 93.6 to 89.3 in 1980
(4.6 percent drop) and from 109 to 102 (6.4 percent drop) in
1985 between the Reference Scenario and the Low Productivity
Scenario.    For   the   Low   Productivity   scenario,  the
contributions of coal and nuclear fuels for  electric  power
generation  by electric utilities- are abou.t equal, with each
providing 32 percent of the source energy.   Thus,  although
energy  demand  decreases'  from  the Reference Scenario, the
change is only about half that of the relative  decrease  in
the growth of the economy and other material resources.

The impact on the air and water environmental residuals from
the   Low  Productivity  Scenario  follows  the  changes  in
economic indicators for most  listed  residuals.   Table  11
                           4-3"?

-------
w
CO
                                                          Table 1O.
                                          Comparison of the Macro-Statistics of the
                                Low Productivity Scenario (S3) and the Reference Scenario (SJ_)
                                                      [(S3-S1)/S1 in %]
             Statistic
Gross National Product
Disposable Income Per Capita
Total Employment
Federal Expenditures
Personal Consumption Expenditures
Total Output
Investment
Energy Use
Demand:-Iron
        A1um1num
Recycling:  Paper/Paperboard
            Aluminum
            Ferrous Metals
Vehicle Kilometers Travelled
Freight Metric Ton-Kilometers
Net. Air Residuals:
  Particulates
  Sulfur Oxides
  Nit rogen Ox i des
  Hydrocarbons
  Carbon Monoxide
Net Water Residuals:
  Biochemical Oxygen Demand
  Suspended Sol ids
  Dissolved Sol ids
  Nutrients
                                                   1975
                                                            1977
                                                                     1980
                                                                              1983
                                                                                       1985
3.98
7,28
O.01
0.0
4.61
3.85
2.65
2. 10
3. 15
2.80
4.52
1 .79
1 .61
7.27
3.09
3. 18
2.49
4.01
5.41
S.43
2.77
2.70
4. 14
O.30
0.28
O.97
-O.04
0.0
0-95
0.15
-1 .50
0. 19
-0.67
-O.35
0.57
-0.17
-0.31
0.60
0.00
0.09
0.23
O.41
0.53
0.70
0.07
-O.26
O.28
-0.01
-8.39
-1O.39
-0.11
O.O
-7.77
-8.53
-13.47
-4.65
-10.78
-9.88
-8.29
-5.88
-5.3O
-10.24
-7.36
-7.63
-6.45
-7.54
-8.61
-'-1O.O5
-5.55
-7.72
-8. 19
-0.67
- 10 . 39
-14 .31
-0.20
O.O
-11 . 18
-10.30
-12.78
-5.70
-10.23
-9.97
-10.85
-5.77
-5.22
-14.47
-8.54
-8.50
-8.49
-1O.02
-11.23
-13.43
-6.76
-8.05
-10.29
-0.78
- 1 1 . 68
-16.43
-0. 10
O.O
-12.98
-11 .51
-12.78
-6.39
-10.69
-1O.6O
-12.38
-6. 19
-5.53
-16. 12
-9.36
-9.45
-9.58
-11 .51
-12.76
-15.31
-7.63
-8.75
-11 .73
-0.88

-------
shows  the relative levels of net residuals, with stationary
and mobile air residual emissions reported separately.
                         Table 11.
       Environmental Residuals from Low Productivity
         Scenario  (S3} as a Percentage of Reference
                   Scenario Residuals (SI)
                         (S3/S1 in %>
                          1977
        1980
       1983
       1985
Air Residuals
Stationary Sources

  Particulates
  Sulfur Oxides
  Nitrogen Oxides
  Hydrocarbons
  Carbon Monoxide

Air Residuals
Mobile  Sources

  Particulates
  Sulfur Oxides
  Nitrogen Oxides
  Hydrocarbons
  Carbon Monoxide
100
100
100
100
 99
100
100
100
101
101
92
94
94
93
91
92
93
91
91
90
92
92
92
92
91
92
92
90
89
87
91
90
90
91
90
91
90
88
87
85
 water  Residuals
   Biochemical
      Oxygen  Demand
   Suspended  Solids
   Dissolved  Solids
   Nutrients
100
100
100
100
94
92
92
99
93
92
90
99
92
91
88
99
 The  second  scenario  which  assumes    different    economic
 conditions, the Low Productivity Abatement  Scenario,  differs
 from  its  baseline,   the  Low Productivity Scenario,  in the
 same fashion as the  Abatement  Scenario differs   from  the
 Reference Scenario.  Thus,  a comparison  of  the statistics of
 the  Low  Productivity  Abatement Scenario  with those of the
 Low Productivity Scenario provides  an  impact  analysis  of
 Federal  pollution  control  laws and  regulations,  given the
 low growth economic conditions.
                            4-39

-------
Table  12  provides  the  general  statistics  for  the  Low
Productivity Abatement Scenario in a form comparable to that
used  for  the Reference Abatement Scenario in Table 4.  The
general comparative economic trends found for the  Reference
Abatement  Scenario  continue  for  this  scenario, with the
stimulus to economic output due to compliance  with  Federal
pollution   control   laws   and   regulations  in  evidence
throughout the decade, as shown in Table 13.  Through  1980,
there   is   sufficiently   high  unemployment  in  the  Low
Productivity Scenario so that  the  additional  labor  force
required  for  abatement  is  available.   After  that time,
however, small diversions of labor from competing sources of
employment are required.
                          4-40

-------
                         Table 12.
General Projections of the Low Productivity Abatement Scenario (S4),
                         1976-1985
Statistics

Population (Minions)
Labor Force (Millions)
Unemployment Rate (%)
Disposable Income
  Per Capita (1.OOO 1975 $)

Gross National Product
  (Trill1on 1975 $)
  Personal Consumption
     Expenditures
  Investment
  Government Expenditures
     Federal
     Other

Total Output
  (Trill ion 1975 $)

Total Energy Use
  (Quadrillion Btu's)
  Natural Gas
  Petroleum
  Coal
  Electricity

U.S. Demand
  (Million Metric Tons)
  Copper
  Iron
  A1 urn 1 num

Recycled Materials
  (Million Metric Tons)
  Paper/Paperboard
  A1urn1num
  Ferrous Metals
 1976

215.8O
 95.4O
  6.50

  5.91
  1 .65
 1977

217.7O
 97.0O
  5.40

  6. 13
           1 .72
 1978

219.8O
 98. SO
  4.60

  6,49
                    1 .77
                                                             1979
                                                                    1980 1981 1982 1983 1984 1985
221.9O 224.1O226.4O228.7O231.OO233 4O235.7O
1OO.20 1O1 .8O1O3.2O104.5O1O5.-7O106.701O7.7O
  4.40   4.5O  4.4O  4. 3O  4.3O  4.3O  4.2O

  6.61   6.75  6.92  7.O3  7.12  7.21  7.29
                    1.81   1.86  1.91  1.96 - 2.OO  2 .04  2 .09
1 .01
0.29
O.33
O. 12
O.21
2.76
84.59
2O. 11
33.35
4.90
26. 16
3.51
152.22
6.O4
68.23
6.47
1 .54
39.56
1.O5
0.30
O.34
0. 12
0.22
2.89
87. 19
19.75
33.81
5. 16
28.47
3.76
157. O3
6.4O
71 .03
6.77
1 .68
41 .03
1.11
O.29
0.35
O. 12
O.23
2.98
88.98
19.83
34.22
5.11
29.83
3.77
150. 18
6.41
72.36
7.09
1.69
41 .31
1. 14
O.30
0.35
O. 12
0.23
3.O7
9O.74
19.85
34.69
5.11
31 .08
3.76
149.48
6.55
74. OS
7.31
1 .82
42. 01
1.18 1.22 1.26 1.29 1.32 t-36
0.31 O.31 O.32 O.32 O.32 O.33
0.36 O.36 0:37 O.38. 0.39 O.39
O.12 0.13 0.13 O.13 Q.14' 0.14
O.23 0.24 0.24 O.25 6.25 O.26
3.16 3.26 3. 3S 3.43 3.52 3.61
92.44 95.07 t97.661O0.321O3.28l£>6V2t
19.87 20.O1 2O.11 20,2O 2O.3~6 42O.46
35.1O 35.95 36.76 37. 54 38.35 39,13
5.14 5.25 5.33 5.43 5.52: 5\62
32.33 33.86 35.46 37.15 39. OS 41. OO
3.78 3.83 3.94 4.O2 '4.O6 4.13
149.56150,42150. 1415O.i6615O. 761S1-.56
6.72 6.91 7. 1O 7.28 7.44 7.63
76. O1 78.25 8O.15 82.26 84. OS 85.68
7.53 7.78 8.OO 8,20 8.4O 8.60
1.98 2.16 2. 1O 2.34 2.45 2.52
42.85 43.87 44.93 45.96 46.72 47.35

-------
                   Table 12, (Continued)
General Projections of the Low Productivity Abatement Scenario (S4),
                         1976-1985
Statistics

Total Vehicle Kilometers
   (Trill ions)
   Auto
Total Freight Metric
Ton-K i1oroeters
   (Bill ions)
   Truck
   Rail

Net Air Residuals
   (Million Metric Tons)
   Particulates
   Sulfur Oxides
   Nitrogen Oxides
   Hydrocarbons
   Carbon Monoxide

Net Water Residuals
   (Mill1on Metric Tons)
   Biochemical Oxygen
     Demand
   Suspended Solids
  Dissolved Sol ids
  Nutrients

Incremental
Air Control Costs
   (Billion 19^5 $)
   Investment'
  Annual1zed Costs
     Capital'
     O&M
  Capital in Place
  Direct  Employment
     (Thousands)
                                  1976
                                           1977
                  1978
1979   198O 1981  1982  1983  1984  1985
1.70
1 .69
3.77
0.78
1.22
13. 18
19.87
19.31
10.49
58.55
3,24
6.7O
11 .91
1.14
1
1
3
0
1
8
14
20
9
53
2
4
11
1
.74
.72
.91
.82
.25
.33
.77
.08
.65
.58
.77
.87
.65
. 14
1
1
3
0
1
8
15
20
9
49
2
2
11
1
.81
.80
.98
.84
.27
.35
.07
.46
.27
.76
.24
.82
.36
.12
1
1
4
0
1
8
15
20
8
44
2
2
11
1
.82
.80
.05
.87
.28
.35
.30
.52
.71
.54
. 17
.77
.38
.12
1 .83
1 .82
4.12
0.90
1.30
8.44
15.53
20.62
8.24
39.85
2. 1O
2.73
11 ,4O
1.12
1 .89
1 .87
4.25
0.94
1.33
8.59
15.82
20.88
7.90
36.85
1.92
2.4O
10.47
1.12
1.92
1,91
4.37
0.98
1.36
7.81
16. OO
21.28
7.29
31. 'OS
1.72
2.04
9.58
1.12
1 .95
1.94
4,49
1.O2
1 .39
7.OO
16.20
21 .58
6.67
28.19
1.51
1.67
8.76
1.12
1 ,98
1.97
4,61
1.06
1 .42
6.13
16.48
21 .83
6.14
23.99
1.29
1 .29
8,05
1.12
2.01
2.00
4.74
1.11
1.45
5.27
16.77
22. 16
5.61
21.44
1. 19
1 .21
8.23
1.12
 8.28     9.06     9.91     6.53   6.37  6.54  6.68  6.78  6.76  6.66

 7.54     8.80    11.04    12.76  14.31 15.51 16.69 17.53 18.12 18.46
 8,80     8.25     8.2O     8.90   9.43  9,84 10.28 1O.7O 11.11 11.50
39.90    46.21    54.91    60.34  64.81 68.60 71.83 74.46 76.41 77.57

15       17       19       20     20  20  19  19  19  18

-------
                                 Table 12. (Continued)
              General Projections of the Low Productivity Abatement Scenario (54),
                                       1976-1985


              Statistics                        1976     1977     1978     1979   1980 1981 1982 1983 1984 1985

              Incremental
              Water Industrial Costs
                (B1111on  1975 $)
                Investment                       4.31     6.27     3.38     2.55   4.37  4.42  S.91  5.46  1.53  1.19
                Annual1zed Costs
**                  Capital                       2.O6     2.89     3.32     3.65   4.22  4.79  5.56  6.27  6.45  6.59
j,                  O&M                           3.75     5.O3     5.76     5.95   6.12  6.34  6.59  6.85  9.95 1O.29
W               Capital 1n Place                15.69    21.95    25.27    27.76  32.07 36.43 42.27 47.67 49.O6 5O.12
                Direct Employment
                   (Thousands)                 117      157      18O      186    192 199 2O6 215 328 339

              Incremental
              Water Municipal Costs
                (B111 ion  1975 $)
                Investment                       6.55     8.11     8.13     5.59   2.94   1.77  O.8O  O.7O  O.7O  0.53
                Annualized Costs
                   Capital                       2.28     3.18     4.07     4.69   5.01   5.21  5.30  5.37  5.45  5.51
                   O&M                           O.68     O.93     1.36     1.61   1.76   1.84   1.89  1.93  1.97  2.OO
                Capital in Place                2O.74    28.85    36.99    42.57  45.51 47.28  48.08  48.78  49.48 SO.O1
                Direct Employment
                   (Thousands)                  2O       28       40       48     52   54   56   57   58 59

                1  Includes state transportation control costs and mobile source pollution abatement expenditures.

                *  Annualized to Include  interest on all investments.  Including those  for mobile  source controls.

-------
                                                13.
I
rf»
tr-
                        Comparison of  the Macro-Statistics  of  the  Low
                 Productivity Abatement  Scenario  (S4) and the  Low  Productivity Scenario  (S3)
                                      [(S4-S3)/S3 1n X]
Statistic

Gross National Product
Disposable Income Per Capita
Total Employment
Federal Expenditures
Personal Consumption Expenditures
Total Output
Investment
Energy Use
Demand: Iron
        A1um1num
Recycl1ng:  Paper/Paperboard
            Aluminum
            Ferrous Metals
Vehicle Kilometers Travelled
Freight Metric Ton-Kilometers
Net A1r Residuals:
  PartIculates
  Sulfur Oxides
  Nitrogen Oxides
  Hydrocarbons
  Carbon Monoxide
Net Water Residuals:
  Biochemical Oxygen Demand
  Suspended Sol Ids
  Dissolved Sol Ids
  Nutrients
                                                    1975
                                                                1977
                                                                            198O
                                                                                      1983    1985















1 ,
0.
0.
0.
0.
2.
6.
3.
3.
3.
O.
2.
1 .
O.
3.
-41 .
-31 .

-
-
-
-


0.
13.
18.
11 .
14.
-0.
-1 .
89
07
94
23
56
24
99
76
86
27
68
03
66
07
49
74
87
00
63
96
81
24
97
97
2
1
1
1
1
3
7
4
4
4
1
2
2
1
4
-67
-63
-0
-22
.76
.29
.83
.07
. 16
.11
.45
.22
.83
.41
.65
.65
.20
.29
.OO
.07
.03
.03
.71
-28.06
-37
-52
-7
-6
.72
.62
.54
. 16
O
-o
0
2
O
1
2
3
0
1
0
0
.79
.18
.67
.22
. 13
.07
.46
.57
.12
.06
. 17
.57
O.35
-O
2
-77
-62
-3
-35
-50
-56
-74
-12
-11
.98
.25
.58
.37
.81
.66
.34
.54
.83
.77
.80
O
-0
O
2
O
O
1
3
-o
O
O
0
O
-0
2
-8O
-61
-S
-50
-67
-7O
-85
-33
-16
.60
.06
.44
.20
. 18
.85
.41
.78
.84
.52
.08
.39
.42
.06
.28
.85
.71
.57
.41
.22
.72
.36
.39
.38
O
-0
O
2
-O
0
-O
4
-1
-O
-0
0
o
-o
2
-86
-61
-7
-59
-76
-77
-89
-37
-19
.06
.63
.21
. 15
. 16
.39
.32
.08
.77
.29
.24
.07
.37
.63
.16
. 15
.72
.78
.68
.06
.SO
.69
.65
.20

-------
The relative impact of pollution  control  expenditures  for
the  Low  Productivity Abatement Scenario are shown in Table
14, which presents these costs as a percentage  of  the  Low
productivity   Scenario   GNP.   These  proportions  can  be
compared with similar data for the Reference Case  given  in
Table 6.
                         Table 14.
    incremental Pollution Control Costs as a Percentage
              of Low Productivity Scenario GNP
Air Stationary
Source Costs

  Annual Capital Cost
  O&M Cost

water Industrial Costs
                             1977  1980  1983  1985  1976-85
0.29  0.34  0.31  0.31   0.30
0.26  0.29  0.26  0.25   0.27
  Annual Capital Cost
  O&M Cost

Water Municipal Costs

  Annual Capital Cost
  O&M Cost
0.17  0.23  0.31  0.32   0.24
0.29  0.33  0.34  0.49   0.35
0.19  0.29  0.27  0.26  0.25
0.05  0.10  0.10  0.10  0.08
Comparing  the  statistics  of  Tables 6 and 14 demonstrates
that the relative level of impact at the macroeconomic level
is similar for the two cases..   Hence,  over  the  range  of
economic  growth  bounded  by these situations, the level of
direct economic  impact  of  pollution  control  legislation
appears  to  be  reasonably  constant.  The indirect impacts
also are similar in terms of increased employment levels for
each abatement scenario as  compared  to  its  non-abatement
scenario.

Tables  15  and  16  provide  aggregate  pollutant treatment
projections for the Low Productivity Abatement Scenario that
are comparable to the Reference Abatement Scenario values of
Tables 7 and 8.  As can be noted, the treatment efficiencies
are comparable, with consistent trends  for  all  residuals.
This suggests that the level of economic output has no major
effect on aggregate treatment levels.
                           4-45

-------
In  a similar vein, the changes in material  and energy  usage
between the non-abatement and the  abatement  scenarios  are
similar  to  the  economic patterns  for  each case.  Thus, in
terms  of  macroeconomic  impacts,    the  introduction   of
Federally  imposed  pollution  controls  produces comparable
effects for the high  economic  growth   Reference  Abatement
Scenario  and  the  low  economic  growth  Low Productivity
Abatement Scenario.
                           4-46

-------
                                    Table 15.
               Relative Stationary Source Treatment Efflciences of
                   Selected Pollutants for the Low Productivity
                     and Low Productivity Abatement Scenarios
                  (Efficiencies 1n Percent of  Residuals Removed)
**
-j
                                          1975
                                                                        1980
           A1r Residuals

           Partlculates
           Sulfur Oxides
           Nitrogen Oxides
           Hydrocarbons
           Carbon Monoxide

           Water  Residuals

           Biochemical Oxygen
             Demand
           Suspended Solids
           Dissolved Sol Ids
           Nutrients
Low
Productivity

73.6
23.8
O.2
39.3
461. 6
68.4
82.8
31 .0
35.9
Low
Productivity
Abatement
85.3
51.1
2.5
50.6
62.3
72.4
85.8
33.7
37.8
Low
Productivity

74.2
24. 0
O.2
4O.3
47.3
68.0
83.2
32.5
37.8
       1985

Low    Low    Low
Productivity Productivity Productivity
Abatement       Abatement
 94.1    73.8    97.0
 7.3.0    23.9    72.5
5.6   O.3   5.7
 59.5    42.3    71.2
 73.5    48.6    76.8
 86. 1
 96.0
 43.7
 46.3
67.9
83.7
35.0
39.2
92.9
98.4
61.4
52.3

-------
                                     Table 16.
            Passenger Transportation Emission Levels for the Low Productivity
                      and Low Productivity Abatement Scenarios
               (Metric Tons per Million Vehicle Kilometers Travelled)
I
*.
CD
            A1r Residuals

            PartIculates
            Sulfur Oxides
            Nitrogen Oxides
            Hydrocarbons
            Carbon Monoxide
        1975

Low
Productivity
    0.22
    O.O8
    1.94
    2.65
   22.05
                                                  Low
                                                  Productivity
                                                  Abatement
 0.18
 O.O8
 1.82
 2.28
17.92
                    198O

            LOW
            Productivity
 O.21
 O.O8
 1 .92
 2.21
22.29
                   1985

            Low    Low    Low
            Productivity Productivity Productivity
            Abatement       Abatement
0.16   0.21   0.14
0.08   O.O8   O.O8
t.60   1.91   1.11
1.25   2.13   0.53
 10.48    22.48   3.65

-------
                COMPARATIVE ANALYSIS FOR THE
               ENERGY CONSERVATION SCENARIOS
To further explore  the  possible  variations  in  pollution
control   costs   because  of  different  assumptions  about
conditions and policies in the future, a pair  of  scenarios
was constructed which approximated energy usage forecasts  in
the Federal Energy Administration's "Business-as-Usual-with-
Conservation"  scenario,  where the price of imported oil  is
$11 per barrel.  In this analysis, it was assumed that  this
reduction  in  energy use could be achieved by the following
actions:

     1. Reduced  household  energy  consumption  for  space-
        heating and cooling by using improved insulation and
        higher summer and lower winter thermostat settings.

     2. Reduced per capita gasoline  use  through  increased
        carpooling,  increased  use  of  mass  transit,  and
        improved auto fuel consumption efficiency.

     3. A reduction in  the  interindustry   fossil  fuel  use
        coefficients  (energy  input required to produce one
        unit of output)  for  energy-intensive  products   by
        substitution of less energy-intensive inputs.  These
        reductions  include:   shifts to returnable beverage
        containers, reductions  in  the  use  of  artificial
        fertilizers, reduced use of packaging materials, and
        some recycling  of energy-intensive  materials.

     4. Miscellaneous changes  to  reflect  improved  energy
        housekeeping activities in certain  industries.

The  first of  the Energy Conservation scenarios, without the
Federally  imposed pollution  controls,  is  denoted   as  the
Energy Scenario.   The second, which introduces the  effects
of pollution control in the same way as for  the  other  two
abatement  scenarios, is the Energy Abatement  Scenario.

A set of  output  statistics  for  the  Energy Scenario  is
provided in Table  17.   Some of the  major   economic   factors
are  compared  to Reference Scenario values  in ^able 18.  The
differences which occur are present even though'the   primary
 factors that   alter  GNP,  the   final  demand  accounts   of
personal consumption expenditures and Federal  expenditures,
were   held  at the  same  levels   for the  Reference  and the
Energy Scenarios   (and  also  were  held   constant  for  the
Reference  Abatement and Energy Abatement  Scenarios).  Thus,
 the  impacts are solely  a result of purchase changes   due   to
                            4-49

-------
energy   conservation  measures  introduced  in  the  Energy
Conservation case.
                           4-50

-------
                   Table 17.
Genera) Projections of the Energy Scenario (S5),
                   1976-198S
Statistics

Population (Millions)
Labor Force (Millions)
Unemployment Rate (54)
Disposable Income
  Per Capita (1,000 1975 $)

Gross National Product
  (Trillion 1975 $)
  Personal Consumption
     Expenditures
  Investment
  Government Expend1tures
     Federa1
     Other

Total Output
  (Trill ion 1975 $)
Total Energy Use
  (Quadrillion Btu's)
  Natural  Gas
  Petroleum
  Coal
  Electricity

U.S. Demand
  (Million Metric Tons)
  Copper
  Iron
  Aluminum

Recycled Materials
  (Million Metric Tons)
  Paper/Paperboard
  Aluminum
  Ferrous Metals
 1976

215. 8O
 95. 4O
  7.9O

  5.62
                             1.56
 1977

217. 7O
 97. OO
  6.9O

  5.99
                                      1.67
 1978

219. SO
 98. 6O
  5. SO

  6.61
                                               1.78
                                                       1979
                                                              198O 1981 1982 1983 1984 1985
0.97
0.26
0.32
0. 12
0.2O
2.61
76.55
18.81
28. 7O
4.59
24.45
3.18
141.37
5.65
65.78
6. 19
1.48
38.25
1.03
O.29
0.33
O. 12
0.21
2.81
79.36
18. 7O
29.24
4.89
26.53
3.53
150.67
6. 16
69.83
6.64
1.64
40.31
1.12
O.29
0.34
0. 12
O.22
3.OO
81.66
19.07
29.67
4.99
27.93
3.72
149.67
6.44
72.93
7.18
1.70
41.41
                                                      221.9O 224.1Q6.40228.7O231.OO233.4O235.70
                                                      1OO.2O 1O1.8O1O3.2O1O4.SO1O5.7O1O6.7O1O7.7O
                                                        5.2O   4.7O  5.1O  4.60  4.4O  4.3O  4.2O
                                                        7.O4
7.54  7.74  8.07  8.31  8.53  8.78
1.9O
1 . 19
0.32
O.35
O. 12
O.23
2.
1.
O.
O.
O.
O.
O2
28
35
36
12
24
2.
1.
0.
O.
0.
O.
08
33
35
37
12
25
2.
1.
O.
O.
O.
0.
16
39
36
38
13
25
2.
1 .
O.
0.
0.
O.
23
45
36
39
13
26
2..
1.
O.
0.
O.
O.
ao
51
37
40
13
27
2.37
1 .56
O.38
0.41
O.14
O.27
                                                        3.21    3.43  3.54  3.67  3.80  3.93  4.O5

                                                        84.26 86.8O 88.47 9O.31 92.14 94.OO 95.7O
                                                       19.43   19.79 19.88 2O.O6 2O.21 20.39 2O.53
                                                       3O.18   3O.61 3O.81 31.O2 31.24 31.44 31.57
                                                        5.24    5.48  5.57  5.66  5.76  5.88  6.OO
                                                       29.40   30.91 32.21 33.58 34.93 36.30 37.61
                                                        3.92    4.12   4.17   4.25   4.33   4.41   4.47
                                                      159.22  167.68167.16166.23166.54167.33168.34
                                                        6.92    7.41   7.56   7.69   7.86   8.O4  8.22
                                                       76.97   81.22  82.16 85.32 87.66 89.73 91.52
                                                        7.69    8.23   8.52  8.88  9.21  9.54  9.87
                                                        f.88    2.O9   2.27  2.19  2.41  2.52  2.57
                                                      43.23  45.10 45.98 46.93 47.88 48.60 49.17

-------
                              Table  17. (Continued)
                 General Projections of the Energy Scenario (55),
                                     1976-1985
U!
to
Statistics

Total Vehicle Kilometers
  (Trillions)
  Auto
Total Freight Metric
Ton-Kilometers
  (Bill Ions)
  Truck
  Rail

Net Air Residuals
  (Mill ion Metric Tons)
  Participates
  Sulfur Oxides
  Nitrogen Oxides
  Hydrocarbons
  Carbon Monoxide

Net Water Residuals
  (Ml 11 ion
  Metric Tons)
  Biochemical Oxygen
     Demand
  Suspended Solids
  Dissolved Solids
  Nutrients
                                             1976
                                                       1977
                                                               1978
                                                             1979   1980 1981 1982 1983 1984 1985
1 .49
1 .47
3.52
0.73
1 . 14
30.09
35.79
18. O4
11 .30
64,65
4.23
9.77
1 1 .99
1.19
1 .
1.
3.
O.
1 .
32.
38.
19.
11
67.
4.
10.
12.
1 .
54
53
77
79
,21
11
66
32
.49
,73
,45
31
47
21
1
1
3
0
1
33
39
2O
11
72
4
10
13
1
.66
.64
.94
.84
.26
.49
.76
.30
.94
.33
.69
.69
.04
.23
1 .73
1.71
4.16
0.90
1.32
34.37
41.01
21 .21
12.24
75.77
4.9O
11.23
13.57
1 .26
1 .82
1 .80
4.39
O.96
1.38
36.93
42.32
22.21
12.66
79.75
5.14
11.79
14. 10
1 .28
1.86
1.83
4.50
1.00
1.41
37. SO
42.39
22.63
12.76
81 .56
5.25
11 .95
14. 14
1 .30
1 .93
1.9O
4.64
1 .04
1 ,45
37.21
42.65
23.26
13.07
84.61
5.40
12. 14
14.26
1 .33
1 .99
1.96
4.79
1 .09
1 .48
37.93
42.92
23. 8O
13.29
86.86
5.53
12.34
14.35
1 .35
2.03
2.00
4.93
1.14
1.52
39.73
43.24
24.36
13.52
88.89
5.67
12.55
14.41
1 .37
2.08
2.05
5.08
1 . 19
1 .S6
4O.5O
43. 5O
24.93
13.76
91 .23
5.81
12.76
14.45
1 .40

-------
                   Table 17. (Continued)
      General Projections of the Energy Scenario (S5),
                         1976-1985
0
o
0
o
o
o
0
0
o
o
0
0
0
0
0
o
o
o
o
o
o
0
o
o
0
o
0
o
o
0
o
0
0
0
o
0
0
0
o
o
0
0
o
0
o
o
o
o
0
o
Statistics                         1976     1977     1978     1979   198O  1981  1982  1983  1984  1985

Incremental
A1r Control Costs
  (Billion 1975$)
  Investment'
  Annualized Costs
     Capital"
     OSM
  Capital  in Place
  Direct Employment
     (Thousands)

Incremental
Water Industrial Costs
  (Billion 1975 $)
  Investment
  Annual1zed Costs
     Capital
     OSM
  Capital  1n Place
  Direct Employment
     (Thousands)

Incremental
Water Municipal Costs
  (Bill ion 1975 $)
  Investment
  Annual1zed Costs
     Capital
     O&M
  Capital  m Place
  Direct Employment
     (Thousands)                      0        0        0        OOOOOOO

  '   Includes  state transporatlon control  costs and mobile source pollution abatement  expenditures,

  '   Annualized to include Interest on all  Investments,  Including those for mobile source controls.
0
0
0
o
0
0
o
o
o
o
0
o
o
o
0
0
0
0
0
0
o
o
o
0
o
o
0
0
0
0
o
o
0
o
0
o
o
0
o
o
o
0
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
0
o
o
0
o
o
0
o
o
0
0
o
0
0
0
0
o
0
0
0
o
o
0
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
0
o
o
o
o
0
o
o
0
o
o
o
0
0
o
o
o
0
o

-------
                         Table 18.
                 Summary of Major Economic
               Factors of the Energy Scenario
           as Compared to the -Reference Scenario

                 .1975     1977     1980     1983     1985

GHP
(Bill.ion 1975 $}
  Energy         1,470    1,669    2,020    2,227    2,370
  Reference      1,470    1,665    2,012    2,221    2,365
     Difference      0       +4       +8       +6        +5

Employment
(Millions)
  Energy            86.1     90.4     97.1     101.1     103.2
  Reference         86.1     90.3     96.8     100.9     103.1
     Difference      0       +0.1     +0.3     +0.2      +0.1

investment
(Billion 1975 $)
  Energy           221      285      345       362       377
  Reference        221      286      344       364       381
     Difference      0       -1         1       -2        -4

Net  Exports
(Billion 1975 $)
  Energy            10.5     11.3       8.6       6.2       1.2
  Reference         10.6       7.7       1.6     -2.6      -8.9
     Difference     -0.1       3.6       7.0       8.8      10.1
 It  can be seen that the  major factor in  raising  SNP  between
 the  Energy Scenario and the  Reference Scenario  is increased
 net exports and  that,   for  several  years,   the  level  of
 investment  expenditures  actually  declines   slightly.    To
 achieve increased net exports,   both imports  and  exports
 fall,  with imports decreasing at a faster rate.  Turning to
 total output,  for  most   years  the  output  of   the  Energy
 Scenario  is  about  0.1  to   0.3  percent  higher  than the
 Reference Scenario,- however,  the pattern is  erratic.   This
 induces  similar  increases in employment, as shown in Table
 18.

 To  analyze  changes  in  energy  and material   consumption
 between  the  two  scenarios, Table 19 provides  annual usage
 comparisons for  petroleum,  coal,  electricity,  iron  ore,
 aluminum, and copper.  (Note  that petroleum and  coal data in
                            4-54

-------
Table  19  include  use in generating electricity.  Table 17
figures do not include this factor in order to avoid double-
counting in energy accounting.).  The  trends  for  usage  of
these  forms of energy and materials are consistant with the
variations in  assumptions  for  the  scenarios.   Petroleum
demand,  coal  demand, and electricity demand for the Energy
Scenario decline in 1985 by approximately 21,  11,  and  8.5
percent,   respectively,  when  compared  to  the  Reference
Scenario.  Slight decreases in use  of  iron,  aluminum  and
copper  are  noted  with  no decline greater than 5 percent,
which is consistent with the variation in total output.
                            4-55

-------
                         Table 19.
           Comparison of Energy & Material Usage
         Between the Reference and Energy Scenarios
                 1975     1977     1980     1983     1985

Petroleum  (Btu's
Quadrillions)
  Energy         32.1     33.8     36.1     37.2     37.9
  Reference      34.3     37.2     41.4     45.0     47.6
     Difference  -2.2     -3.4     -5.3     -7.8     -9.7

Coal (Btu's
Quardrillions)
  Energy         13.8     16.6     17.7     17.6     17.6
  Reference      13.9     17.0     18.4     19.0     19.8
     Difference  -0.1     -0.4     -0.7     -1.4     -2.2

Electricity  (Btu's
Quadrillions)
  Energy         22.5     26.5     30.9     34.9     37.6
  Reference      22.8     27.3     32.1     37.1     41.1
     Difference  -0.3     -0.8     -1.2     -2.2     -3.5

iron Ore  (Million
Metric Tons)
  Energy         129      151      168      167      168
  Reference      129      151      167      169      173
     Difference   0        0-1-2       -5

Aluminum  (Million
Metric Tons)
  Energy          5.1      6.2      7.4      7.9      8.2
  Reference       5.1      6.2      7.4      8.0      8.6
     Difference      0        0        0     -0.1     -0.4

Copper (Million
Metric Tons)
  Energy          2.9      3.5      4.1      4.3      4.5
  Reference       2.9      3.5      4.1      4.4      4.5
     Difference      0        0        0-0.1        0
                            4-56

-------
As a final comparison of the effects of energy conservation,
Table 20  provides  the  level  of  environmental  residuals
produced  in  the Energy Scenario relative to those produced
in the Reference Scenario.
                         Table 20.
     Environmental Residuals from Energy Scenario (S5)
    as a Percentage of Reference Scenario Residuals (SI)
                        (S5/S1 in %>
Air Residuals
1975
1977
1980
1983
1985
Air Residuals
Stationary sources

  Particulates
  Sulfur Oxides
  Nitrogen Oxides
  Hydrocarbons
  Carbon Monoxide
  99
  98
  98
  95
  98
  99
  97
  97
  95
  99
  99
  96
  96
  92
  98
  98
  93
  93
  89
  96
  96
  89
  89
  87
  95
Air Residuals
Mobile Sources

  Particulates
  Sulfur Oxides
  Nitrogen oxides
  Hydrocarbons
  Carbon Monoxide
  95
  98
  95
  92
  92
  95
 101
  96
  91
  90
  95
 103
  96
  89
  88
  94
 104
  95
  87
  86
  95
 105
  94
  86
  85
Water Residuals
  Biochemical Oxygen
     Demand               100      100      100       100      99
  Suspended Solids        100      100      100       99      99
  Dissolved Solids        100      99      99       98      97
  Nutrients               100      100      100       100      100
 in  general,  for water   residuals,   little   impact   is  noted
 since  the  energy  conservation assumptions do not cause major
 variations  in  output   for  the industries that produce  the
 majority of   water  pollutants.   The  reduction   in  mobile
 source emissions  is consistent with  the major reduction in
 auto mileage and  concomitant small  increases in mass transit
 and small  decreases in  freight  transportation.
                            4-57

-------
The major impact of the Energy Scenario on residuals  is  in
stationary  source  air  emissions.  All five air residuals,
participates, sulfur oxides, nitrogen oxides,  hydrocarbons,
and  carbon  monoxide,  show significantly lover levels over
time.  The lesser reductions  for  particulates  and  carbon
monoxide are due to a mixed reaction in the output levels of
six major producing sectors.

In  summary,  the  Energy  Conservation Scenario assumptions
produce major effects on energy and material consumption and
on air pollution emissions when compared  to  the  Reference
Scenario.   Remaining  statistics for the two scenarios show
only minor effects when the two are compared.

The effects of the pollution control regulations  under  the
Energy   conservation   Case  assumptions  are  provided  by
comparing   the   Energy   Abatement   Scenario   with   its
predecessor,   the  Energy  Scenario.   The  general  output
statistics for the Energy Abatement Scenario  are  given  in
Table  21  while  Table  22  compares  the results of Energy
Abatement Scenario with those of the Energy Scenario.  As in
the other scenario pairs, the  scenario  that  includes  the
pollution  control  costs  and  purchases  generates  higher
employment, GNP and total output  for  all  forecast  years.
The  differences  are  greatest  for the years 1975 and 1977
when the available labor force is sufficient to provide  for
the   increased  resources  needed  for  abatement  controls
without   diverting   labor   from   competing    employment
opportunities.  By 1985, Energy Abatement Scenario forecasts
are  greater  than  those  of  the  Energy  Scenario by 0.16
percent  for GNP, 0.54 percent  for  total  output  and  0.26
percent  for total employment.

Table  23  presents  various  pollution  control  costs as a
percentage  of  Energy  Scenario   GNP.    Comparing   these
percentages  with  the  values given in Table 6 and fable 14
again reveals the relative  impact  insensitivity  over  the
range  of  assumptions provided in this macroeconomic/energy
analysis.
                           4-58

-------
                         Table 21.
 General Projections of the Energy Abatement Scenario (SB),
                         1976-1985
l*»
tn
Statistics

Population (Millions)
Labor Force (Millions)
Unemployment Rate (%)
Disposable Income
  Per Capita (1.0OO 1975 $)

Gross National  Product
  (Trill1on 1975 $)
  Personal Consumption
     Expendltures
  Investment
  Government Expenditures
     Federal
     Other

Total Output
  (TM11 ion 1975 $)

Total Energy Use
  (Quadrillion Btu's)
  Natural  Gas
  Petroleum
  Coal
  Electricity

U.S. Demand
  (Million Metric Tons)
  Copper
  Iron
  Aluminum

Recycled Materials
  (Million
  (Million Metric Tons)
  Paper/Paperboard
  A1urn1num
  Ferrous Matals
                                                 1976

                                                215.80
                                                 95.4O
                                                  6.3O

                                                  5.62
                                                  1.59
 1977

217.70
 97.00
  5.2O

  5.99
                                                           1.7O
 1978

219.8O
 98.6O
  4.0O

  6.53
                                                                    1 .81
                                                             1979
                                                                                   198O 1981  1982 1983 1984 1985
227.19 224.aO6.4O228.7O231.OO233.4O235.7O
1O0.2O 1O1.8O1O3.2O1O4.5O1O5.70106.7O1O7.7O
  4.1O   4.60  4.6O  4.5O  4.2O  4.OO  4.OO

  7.OO   7.46  7.69  8.OO  8.25  8.48  8.7O
                    1.91   2.O2  2.O9  2.16  2.23  2.30  2.37
O.97
0.27
O.32
O.12
O.2O
2.66
79.42
19.38
30. CO
4.78
25.26
3.30
145.45
5.81
66.59
6.23
1.51
38.79
1.03
0.30
0.34
0. 12
0.22
2.86
82.36
19.31
30.37
5. 12
27.57
3.67
155.58
6,34
7O.71
6.68
1.67
4O.81
1.12
O.30
O.35
0. 12
O.23
3.O6
85.52
19.76
30.88
5.24
29.27
3.85
155.71
6.63
73.84
7.23
1.73
42. 04
1.19
0.33
0.36
O. 12
0.24
3.24
87. 4O
20.05
31.21
5.41
30.73
4.O4
161.96
7,05
77.46
7.69
1.90
43.64
1.27 1.33 1.39 1.45 1.51 1.56
O.35 O.36 O.36 0.37 O.37 0.38
O.37 O.38 O.39 O.4O 0.41 O.42
O.12 0.13 0.13 0.13 0.14 O. 14
0.25 O.25 O.26 O.27 0.27 O.28
3.44 3.56 3.68 3.81 3.95 4.08
89.71 91.85 93.69 95.91 98.321OO.39
26.34 2O. 52 2O. 67 20.90 21. 2O 21.39
31.55 31.92 32.14 32 . 5O 32.86 33.11
5.57 5.67 5.73 5.84 5.95 6.08
32.25 33.74 35.15 36.67 38.31 39.81
4.18 4.23 4.3O 4.37 4.44 4.49
166.59166.43164.31164.42164,80165.95
7,44 7.61 7.72 7.88 8.O5 8.23
81.15 83.32 85.26 87. 7O 89.82 91.89
8.18 8.51 8.84 9.19 9.53 9.85
2. 1O 2.28 2. 2O 2.42 2.52 2.57
45.19 46.12 47.OO 47.97 48.72 49.34

-------
                                 Table 21.  (Continued)
               General  Projections of the Energy Abatement  Scenario  (56);
                                       1976-1985
s
Statistics

Total Vehicle Kilometers
  (Trillions)
  Auto
Total Freight Metric
Ton-K1lometers
  (B1111ons)
  Truck
  Rail

Net' Air Residuals
  (Million Metric Tons)
  Partlculates
  Sulfur Oxides
  Nitrogen Oxides
  Hydrocarbons
  Carbon Monoxide

Net Water Residuals
  (Mill Ion Metric Tons)
  Biochemical Oxvflen
     Demand
  Suspended Solids
  Dissolved Solids
  Nutrients

Incremental
Air Control Costs
  (Billion 197S $)
  Investment'
  AnnualIzed Costs
     Capital»
     O&M
  Capital  In Place
  Direct  Employment
     (Thousands)
                                                1976
                                                         1977
                                                                  1978
                                                                           1979    198O 1981 1982 1983 1984 1985
1
1
3
O
1
12
18
18
9
51
3
6
11
1
.49
.47
.63
.75
.17
.56
.82
,O1
.41
.43
.18
.50
.41
. 14
1 .
1 .
3.
0.
1.
8.
14.
19.
8.
48.
2.
4.
11 .
1.
54
53
89
81
25.
13
16
18
76
12
76
84
4O
14
1.
1.
4.
0.
1.
8.
14.
20.
8.
45.
2.
2.
11.
1.
64
62
O7
87
30
45
82
05
58
69
26
86
45
12
1
1
4
O
1
8
15
2O
8
42
2
2
11
1
.72
.70
.26
.92
.35
.74
.36
.66
.31
.80
.23
.88
.79
. 12
1
1
4
0
1
9
15
21
8
39
2
2
12
1
.SO
.78
.45
.97
.40
.03
.94
.30
.06
.79
.20
.89
. 14
. 13
1
1
4
1
1
9
16
21
7
35
2
2
11
1
.85
.82
.58
.02
.44
.19
.23
.59
.69
.89
.00
.52
. 17
. 13
1
1
4
1
1
8
16
22
7
31
1
2
1O
1
.92
.89
.71
.06
.47-
.33
.38
.06
.13
.65
.80
.15
.25
.13
1
1
4
1
1
7
16
22
6
28
1
1
9
1
.97
.94
.87
. 11
.51
.49
.60
.46
.56
.41
.59
.75
.44
. 12
2
1
5
1
.01
.98
.03
. 16
1,55
6
16
22
6
25
1
1
8
1
.59
.86
.75
.07
.05
.37
.33
.70
.12
2.O6
2. 02
5. 19
1 .21
1.59
5.67
17.05
23.04
5.58
22. 7O
1 .27
1 .26
8.9O
1 . 12
                                                6.31

                                                7.31
                                                8.72
                                               37.48

                                               14
 8.40

 8.58
 8.09
44. 14

17
10.82

10.96
 8.11
53.75

18
 8.18   7.12  7.O4  6.76  6.69  6.66  6.85
12.83
 8.97
60.82

2O
14.48 15.85 16.93 17.76 18.34 18.70
 9.67 1O.2O 1O.62 11.03 11.45 11.89
66.04 70.34 73.65 76.19 78.04 79.40
                                                                                 21  21  21
                                                                                              20  2O  19

-------
                            Table 21.  (Continued)
          General  Projections of  the Energy Abatement Scenario (S6).
                                  1976-1985


         Statistics                         1976     1977     1978     1979   198O 1981  1982 1983 1984 1985

         Incremental
         Water  Industrial  Costs
           (Bill ion  1975 $)
           Investment                        3.47     5.62     3-24     5.15   6.40  5.6O  6.65  5.18  1.3O  1.53
           Annual1zed  Costs
             Capital                        1.97     2.71     3.13     3.80   4.63  5.36  6.22  6.9O  7.OS  7.24
I             O&M                            3.63     4.89     5.85     6.32   6.71  7.O4  7.24  7.51 1O.67 11.1O
0}          Capital  1n  Place                 14.99    20.60    23.78    28.87  35.21 4O.75 47.35 52,46 53.63 55.O3
           Direct  Employment
             (Thousands)                  114      15O      183      198    21O 220 227  235 35O 365

         Incremental
         Water  Municipal Costs
           (Bill ion  1975 $)
           Investment                        6.55     8.11     8.13     5.59   2.94  1.77  O.8O  0.7O  O.7O  O.53
           Annual Ized  Costs
             Capital                        2.28     3.18     4.07     4.69   5.O1  5.21  5.30  5.37  5.45  5.51
             O&M                            0.68     0.93     1.36     1.61   1.76  1.84  1.89  1.93  1.97  2.0O
           Capital  1n  Place                 2O.74    28.85    36.99    42.57  45.51 47.28 48.O8 48.78 49.48 SO.01
           Direct  Employment
             (Thousands)                   2O      .28       40       43     52  54  56   57  58  59

           1  Includes-state transportation control  costs and mobile  source pollution abatement expenditures.

           '  Annual1zed to  Include Interest on all  Investments,  Including those for moblFe source  controFs.

-------
                                          Table 22.
                  Comparison of the Macro Statistics of the Energy Abatement
                          Scenario (S6) and the Energy Scenario (55)
                                      [(S6-S5)/S5 In %]

                 Statistic                          1975        1977        198O      1983   1985

                 Gross National Product             1.97        1.74        O.10      O.22   O. 16
                 Disposable Income Per Capita       O.OO        O.OO       -O.95     -O.82  -1.19
                 Total Employment                   2.O4        1.86        0.14      O.26   O.26
                 Federal  Expenditures               O.24        1.07        2.24      2.2O   2.17
                 Personal  Consumption Expenditures  0.59        O.33       -O.7O     -O.22  -O.12
                 Total Output                       2.33        2.O7        O.34      O.5O   O.54
I                Investment                         6.11        5.24        1.79      O.94   O.38
<*                Energy Use                         3.98        3.78        3.35      4.O9   4.89
                 Demand:   Iron                      3.99        3.26       -O.65     -1.27  -1.42
                          Aluminum                  3.42        3.O2        0.48      O.3O   O. 19
                 Recycling:   Paper/Paperboard       0.71        0.68       -O.64     -0.25  -O.15
                             Aluminum               2.13        1.18        0.22      O.22   O.21
                             Ferrous Metals         1.7O        1.46        O.19      O.18   O.35
                 Vehicle Kilometers Travelled       O.OO        O.OO       -O.95     -O.82  -1.23
                 Freight  Metric Ton-Kilometers      3.6O        3.O5        1.88      1.80   2.13
                 Net A1r  Residuals:
                   Partlculates                   -41.19      -74.69      -75.54    -8O.25 -86.OO
                   Sulfur  Oxides                  -32.67      -63.4O      -62.34    -61.32 -60.81
                   Nitrogen Oxides                 -1.63       -2.OO       -4.12     -7.8O  -7.61
                   Hydrocarbons                   -13.37      -23.93      -36.35    -5O.69 -59.48
                   Carbon  Monoxide                -19.05      -29.14      -50.11    -67.29 -75.12
                 Net Water Residuals:
                   Biochemical  Oxygen Demand      -11.70      -38.05      -57.26    -71.25 -78.O7
                   Suspended Solids               -14.15      -53.O7      -75.46    -85.83 -9O.11
                   Dissolved Solids                -O.85       -8.61      -13.88    -34.22 -38.38
                   Nutrients                       -1.96       -6.20      -11.99    -16.62 -19.45

-------
                         Table 23.
          Incremental Pollution control Costs as a
             Percentage of Energy Scenario GNP
                             1977  1980  1983  1985  1976-85

Air Stationary
Source Costs

  Annual Capital Cost        0.28  0.30  0.29  0.28    0.29
  O&M Cost                   0,26  0.28  0.25  0.24    0.26

Water Industrial Costs

  Annual Capital Cost        0.16  0.23  0.31  0.30    0.24
  O&M Cost                   0.28  0.33  0.34  0.47    0.35

Water Municipal Costss

  Annual Capital Cost        0.19  0.25  0.24  0.23    0.22
  O&M Cost                   0.05  0.09  0.09  0.08    0.07
The  effects  of  the  energy  conservation   assumptions  on
environmental  residuals  are  provided  as   annual   average
treatment efficiencies and emission  levels in Tables  24   and
25.   These  values  again   show  about  the  same  changes in
treatment efficiencies, although  the  changes  are slightly
different  here   than  in  the  Reference  Abatement  and  Low
Productivity Abatement Scenarios.  This  difference   results
primarily  from   the greater variability introduced into  the
interindustry  flows by the energy conservation measures.

Thus, for data concerning the  level  of economic activity  and
level of energy  usage in the three major scenario  pairs,  the
difference at  the macroeconomic level  between the  scenarios
without . abatement  effects  and those  with abatement  effects
appear quite similar.
                            4-63

-------
                         Table 24.
     Relative Stationary Source Treatment Efficiencies
of Selected Pollutants for the Energy and Energy Abatement Scenarios
       (Efficiencies In Percent of Residuals Removed)
                             1975
                                                           198O
                                                                           1985
Air Residuals

PartIculates
Sulfur Oxides
Nitrogen Oxides
Hydrocarbons
Carbon Monoxide

Water Residuals

Biochemical Oxygen
  Demand
Suspended Solids
Dissolved Sol.lds
Nutrients
                       Energy
73.6
23.5
 O.2
38.2
45.7
68.6
82.7
30.9
35.2
          Energy
          Abatement
85.3
51.0
 2.5
49.7
61.3
72.4
35.7
33.6
37.1
               Energy
73.7
23.2
 0.2
37.4
46.0
67.7
82.9
32.1
38.6
Energy Energy
Abatement Energy Ab«
94. 0
72.9
5.6
58.4
72.0
86.2
96.0
43.7
47. 0
72.9
23.8
0.3 5.
37.7
46.8
67.7
83.3
34.1
4O.O
96.8
72. 1
7
69.3
74.7
92.9
98.4
61,4
53.1

-------
•*»
I

-------
Chapter 4
Sectoral Analyses Results
In order  to  assess  the  impacts  of  pollution  abatement
activities  at a more detailed level than the macro-analysis
presented in Chapter 3, a sectoral level analysis of one  of
the three abatement scenarios is required.  In this chapter,
the Reference Abatement Scenario is analyzed at the sectoral
level  to  describe  these  micro-level  impacts.  Estimated
reductions in pollutant  residuals  for  industries,  mobile
sources,  municipal treatment, and Federal, state, and  local
governments, which are derived from the Reference  Abatement
Scenario  are  analyzed first.  Following this, the sectoral
costs forecast for various industries to comply with Federal
pollution control legislation are analyzed.
                ESTIMATING THE REDUCTION IN
                  AIR RESIDUAL GENERATION

The graphs in Figure 1 show the  impacts  of  the  Reference
Abatement  scenario  on generation of air residuals,  in the
graphs, the controlled  (net)  residual  emission  for  each
pollutant  in  1971  is  set  equal to 100 and  forecasts for
subsequent  years  are  indexed  to  the   1971    controlled
emissions.  Uncontrolled emissions are also shown  indexed  to
the   1971  controlled  emissions.   The  relative  difference
between the two plots indicates the overall effectiveness  of
pollution abatement technology for  each  pollutant   in  the
forecast year.  Controlled emissions are defined to be those
that  enter  the  receiving  media  (air,  water)  from  the
generating source after the abatement process is   completed.
The   relative  contribution to total controlled emissions  in
air by industrial/commercial sources, electric  utilities and
municipal treatment is shown by  the  distance  between  the
appropriately labeled curves on each graph.

Reduction   in   residuals   discharged   to.    the nation's
environment, as shown in Figure 1, is only a rough indicator
of environmental quality.  However, significant increases  or
decreases of the various types of emissions  are   indicative
of  probable  changes  in  ambient  trends.   Therefore, the
graphs  afford  a  measure  of  the  probable   environmental
quality so far as air is concerned.

The   ma)or  source  of  each air pollutant is illustrated  in
Figure 1.  Particulates and sulfur oxide emissions in  1971
result  primarily  from  activity  in the stationary  sources
                           4-66

-------
(industrial/commercial and  electric  utilities)  while  the
major  cause  of  hydrocarbons and carbon monoxide is mobile
sources  (transportation).   Nitrogen  oxide  emissions  are
approximately  equal  from  fixed and mobile sources in 1971
and are shown to be difficult to abate in both sources.
                            4-67

-------
                   Figure  1.
Trends  In Air  Residuals from  the Reference
              Abatement Scenario
                                                             H«lrWT»TTMI
                     "•Tiacror
                                                 SsSsSff;-^ ,;  • . 8SSST^T1UT1«
                     4-68

-------
For the major stationary-source residuals (particulates  and
sulfur  dioxide), decreasing emissions are shown until 1977.
The end of 1977 was chosen in the Reference  Case  scenarios
to be the date that full compliance to the Clean Air Act for
all  fixed  sources  occurs.   After 1977, the plots of both
sulfur oxide and particulate emissions  from  fixed  sources
level  until  1980  and  sulfur  oxides  even  shows  slight
increases to 1985.  This represents a. pattern  approximating
the   growth   in   economic  activity  without  significant
subsequent increases in pollution abatement efficiencies for
these  two  pollutants.    This   pattern   is   found   for
particulates from 1977-1980 and for sulfur oxides from 1977-
1985.   (There  is  a  slight dampening in the growth of the
emissions from these  sources  compared  with  the  economic
growth  over  the  1977-1980 or 1977-1985 period due to more
stringent controls on emissions from new-plants.)  The index
of emissions for particulates relative  to  the  1971  total
show  the  mobile sources share to be approximately constant
at  3  percent  from  1971  through  1985-  the  index   for
industrial/commercial  sectors  decreases from 84 percent  in
1971 to 16 percent in 1985; and the electric utilities index
declines sharply from 13 percent to 1 percent  by  .1977  and
then  becomes  fairly  constant.   The  relative indices for
sulfur  oxides  emissions  show  the  mobile  source   share
increasing from 2 percent in 1971 to 3 percent in 1985.  The
index  for  the  industrial/commercial source remains fairly
constant throughout the  interval,  decreasing  slightly   by
1977,  .while  the  electric  utilities  index decreases from
approximately 50 percent in 1971  to  about  25  percent   in
1985.

Turning  to  air  pollutants  where  mobile sources are most
important, the graph for  hydrocarbon  and  carbon  monoxide
emissions  both  show  a steady decrease to 1985.  Emissions
standards for both pollutants for automobiles are  scheduled
for  full  compliance  in  1978.  The steady decrease in the
graphs after that time is  due  to  phaseout  of  the  older
model-year  automobiles from vehicles still on the road that
occurs in each successive year since older  automobiles  are
not  as well controlled as new models.' This factor tends  to
offset any increases in stationary  source  emissions  after
1977,   which   result   fromx .growth  in  economic  output.
Uncontrolled hydrocarbon and carbon monoxide emissions  show
a  decrease  from  1971  to  1975", because older automobiles
(pre-1968 model years) have hydrocarbon and carbon  monoxide
emission factors approximately 120 percent larger than those
for  the  1971  model  year.  Many of these automobiles were
still in use in 1971  and  'are  phased  out  throughout  the
forecast  period.   This  effect  continues  after  1977 for
carbon monoxide due to the existence of more strict  control
                            4-69

-------
standards  after  that  time.   The  mobile sources  index of
hydrpcarbon.s.:decreases ferom 63 percent in  1971  to 20 percent
in 1985 while  the  index  for  hydrocarbon  emissions  'from
stationary  sources decreases from 37 percent to 25  percent.
Corresponding values  for  carbon  monoxide  are  85 to  25
percent and 15 to 9 percent.

Nitrogen  oxide  uncontrolled  emissions increase 57 percent
over the  course  of  the  forecast  period.    The   electric
utilities  index to 1971 controlled emissions increases from
29 to 61 percent, while the mobile  source index  increases
from   52   percent   to  65  percent;  the  remainder  from
industrial/commercial  sources  is  fairly constant.    The
forecast increase in nitrogen oxide controlled  emissions due
to   mobile  sources  is  probably  underestimated   by  this
forecast because it is assumed that the presently legislated
1978 standard will be met.  If the 1978 standard is  modified
or not met, which appears to be quite possible, the  increase
in nitrogen oxide emissions would be even  more  severe.

Table  1  shows  further  detail  concerning    the   largest
contributors to the industrial/commercial  share of emissions
for  air residuals after controls.  The combustion of fossil
fuels by 1985 causes the largest proportion of  both sulfur
oxide  and  nitrogen oxide emissions.  For particulates, the
greatest source by far of emissions  is  the  Crushed  Stone
subsector,   particularly   in  1980.   The  consumption  of
gasoline at service stations and the production and  use  of
solvent-based  paints dominate the generation of hydrocarbon
emissions in 1971 and increase their  shares  by  1985.   In
1985, the production and consumption of Solvent-Based Paints
yield  over 40 percent of the industrial/commercial  share of
hydrocarbons and about 25 percent of the   total hydrocarbon
emissions  from  all  sources.   Several sectors/subsectors,
such as Asphalt Production in  particulates  and  Crude  Oil
Refining  in  sulfur oxides, have large shares  of controlled
emissions in 197.1; however, because  of  improved  treatment
efficiencies, they maXe small contributions to  the aggregate
industrial/commercial residuals in 1985.

Differences   in  air  residuals  as  forecast  in   the  Low
Productivity Abatement and Energy  Abatement  Scenarios  are
presented  in  Table  2 as percent changes from the  forecast
for major polluting industries in  the  Reference  Abatement
Scenario.    For the Low Productivity Abatement  Scenario, one
might expect these differences to be on  the  order  of  the
percent  change in GNP, as shown at the bottom  of the table.
The general  tendency, however, is for residual  production to
change at lower rates than GNP, with the   notable  exception
of  the  industrial  and commercial use of fossil fuels.  As
expected, little  difference  is  seen  between the Energy
                            4-70

-------
Abatement  and  the Reference Abatement Scenarios other than
in the energy related  sectors,  where  significantly  lower
residuals are forecast for the Energy Abatement Scenario.
                            4-71

-------
                          Table 1.
         industrial/Commercial Net Air Residuals by
           Major contributing Sectors/Subsectors
                          Percent of Industrial and Elec.
                          Emissions from Reference
                          Abatement Scenario

Sectors/Subsectors        1971     1975     1980     1985
Particulates

Stone & Clay Products
  Crushed Stone           21.4     34.2     70.7     46.7

Electric utilities
  Elec. by Coal           12.9     12.7      4.3      7.9

Paving & Asphalt
  Asphalt                 11.2      8.5      1.4      1.0

Cement, Concrete, Gypsum
  Cement-Dry Grinding      8.6      7.2      1.4      0.3
  Cement-Wet Grinding      8.0      6.1      1.0      0.2

Steel                      6.5      5.4      2.7      3.9

Cement, Concrete, Gypsum
  Lime                     3.6      2.9      0.3      0.6

Industrial Combustion
  of Coal                  3.2      2.4      0.4      0.8

Sulfur Oxides

Electric Utilities
  Elec. by High Sulfur
     Coal                 46.9     42.6     26.5     24.1

Petroleum Refining
  Crude Oil Refining       7.6      4.6      0.6      0.7

Commercial/Institutional
  Use of Residual oil      3.8      5.4      7.8     11.8

Petroleum Refining-l'nd.
  Combustion of Oil        3.6      6.3     11.1     12.0
                           4-72

-------
                    Table 1. (Continued)
         Industrial/Commercial Net Air Residuals -by
           Major Contributing Sectors/Subsectors
Sectors/Subsectors

Crude Petro. Mat. Gas
  Sour Nat. Gas Proc.
     Plants

Electric Utilities
  Elec. by High Sulfur
     Residual Oil

  Elec. by £ow Sulfur
     Coal

Hitrogen Oxides

Electric Utilities
  Elec. by ,Coal
  Elec. by Gas
  Elec. by Oil

Petroleum Refining
  industrial Combustion
     of Oil

Hydrocarbons

Service Stations
  Gasoline consumption

Paints
  Solvent Base Paints
     Production

Open Burning

Solvent Based Paints
  Consumption

Petroleum Refining
  Crude Oil Refining
  Gasoline Production
Percent of Industrial and Elec.
Emissions from Reference
Abatement Scenario

1971     1975     1980     1985
 3.3
 3.3
 0.8
41.6
10.8
 8.9
 3.8
 1.9
 2.9
48.1
 8.1
11.4
 3.2
 10.1      10..6
 0.1
 2.2
50.7
 5.5
13.5
 2.5
 0.1
 2.5
 4.4     12.0     14.4
50.3
 5.5
14.7
 2.5
17.3     25.5     29.3     24.9



17.0     22.2     26.3     32.9

10.2      0        0        0
          9.8     11.1
 8.5
 6.8
 5.6
 7.0
 2.2
 5.7
 3.1
 8.5
                           4--73

-------
                    Table 1.  (Continued)
         Industrial/Cosusercial Net Air Residuals by
           Major Contributing Sectors/Subsect.ors
                          Percent of Industrial and Elec.
                          Emissions from Reference
                          Abatement Scenario

Sectors/Subsectors        1971     1975     1980     1985

Industrial Chemicals
  Ethylene Oxide           3.2      2.0      0.4      0.5
                          4-74

-------
                                              Table 2.
                             Percent Changes In Air Residuals from the
                            Major Polluting Industries for Alternative
                                 Abatement Scenarios Compared with
                                  the Reference Abatement Scenario
                                            Percent Difference from the Reference Abatement Scenario (S2)
Sectors/Subsectors

Par'tlculates

Stone & Clay Products
  Crushed Stone

Electric Ut1lItles
  Electricity by Coal

Paving & Asphalt
  Asphalt

Cement, Concrete,  Gypsum
  Cement-Dry Grinding
  Cement-Wet Grinding

Steel

Cement. Concrete,  Gypsum
  Ume
Industrial Combustion of Coal
  N.E.C.

Sulfur Oxides

Electric UtllItles
  Electricity by High Sulfur
     Coal
Low Productivity Abatement (S4)
1971     1975     198O     1985
     Energy Abatement (S6)
1971      1975     198O     1985
o.o
o.o
o.o
o.o
0.0
o.o
o.o
o.o
3. 1
2.O
2.8
3.4
3,4
2.O
3.2
4.4
-8
-5
-7
-8
-8
-10
-9
-8
.2
. 1
. 1
.9
.9
. 1
• O
.8
-9
-9
-8
-9
-9
-1O
-10
-12
. 1
. 1
.6
.6
.6
.2
.2
.3
0
O
O
O
0
O
0.
O,
.0
.0
.O
.O
.0
.O
.0
,o
-0
-1
-O
-O
-O
-O
-0
O
.2
.7
. 1
.2
,2
.2
.2
.O
-0.4
-5.5
-O.3
-O.5
-0.5
-O.7
-O.4
O.O
-O.3
-13.7
-O.2
-O.3
-0.3
-2.0
-1.3
0.2
                                    O.O
                                             2.0
                  -5.1
                                                               -9. 1
                                                                              O.O
                                                                                      -1 .7
                 -5.5    -13.7

-------
                                        Table 2. (Continued)
                             Percent Changes 1n Air Residuals from the
                            Major Polluting Industries for Alternative
                                 Abatement Scenarios Compared with
                                  the Reference Abatement Scenario
Sectors/Subsectors

Petroleum Refining
  Crude 011 Refining

Commercial/Institutional
  Use of Residual 011

Petroleum Refining
  Industrial Combustion of 011

Crude Petroleum, Natural Gas
  Sour Natural Gas Proc. Plants

Electric Ut111t1es
  Electricity by High Sulfur
     Residual 011

  Electricity by Low Sulfur Coal

Nitrogen Oxides

Electric Ut1l1tles
  Electricity by Coal
  Electricity by Gas
  Electricity by 011

Petroleum Ref1n1ny
  Industrial Combustion of Oil

Hydrocarbons

Service Stations
  Gasoline Consumption

Paints
  Solvent Base Paint Production
                                            Percent Difference from the Reference Abatement Scenario (S2)
                                   Low Productivity Abatement (S4)
O.O




O.O


0.0
2. 1
0.7
                                             3.9
-4.9
-2.1
                                                     -8. 1
                  -6.5
                  -2.9
                                                              -11 .7
                                              Energy Abatement (S6)
1971
O.O
O.O
O.O
0.0
0.0
O.O
0.0
0.0
O.O
1975
2. 1
4.6
2. 1
1.6
2.O
2.O
2.0
2.O
2.O
198O
-4
-8
-5
-3
-5
-5
-5
-4
-5
.9
. 1
.O
.5
. 1
. 1
.1
.9
. 1
1985
-6.
-13,
-6.
-5.
-9.
-9.
-9.
-8,
-9.
,5
.4
5
,6
. 1
, 1
.1
,7
, 1
1971
O.
O.
0.
0.
0.
O.
0.
0.
O.
O
O
O
0
0
0
0
O
O
1975
-7
O
-7
-O
-1
-1
-1
-1
-1
.4
.2
.4
.5
.7
.7
.7
.6
.7
198O
-7.4
O.O
-7.4
-3.4
-5.5
-5.5
-5.5
-5.4
-5.5
1985
-14.2
O.7
-14.2
-4.0
-13.7
-13.7
-13.7
-13.1
-13.7
O.O




O.O


0.0
                                         -7.4
-7.4    -14.2
                                -12.4    -24.4    -35.8
                                                                                       0.0
                                                                                                O.O
                                                                                                         0.4

-------
                                        Table 2.  (Continued)
                             Percent Changes 1n Air Residuals from the
                            Major Polluting Industries for Alternative
                                 Abatement Scenarios Compared with
                                  the Reference Abatement Scenario

                                            Percent Difference from the Reference Abatement Scenario (S2)

                                   Low Productivity Abatement (S4)                Energy Abatement (S6)

Sectors/Subsectors

Open Burning

Solvent Based Paints
  Consumption

Petroleum Refining
  Crude 011 Refining
  Gasoline Production

Industrial Chemicals
  Ethylene Oxide                    O.O      6.4     -1O.6     -13.5          O.O     O.O      0.1      -0.6
1971
O.O
O.O
0.0
O.O
1975
0.0
2.8
2. 1
0.7
198O
O.O
-5.3
-4.9
-2. 1
1985
O.O
-8.3
-6.5
-2.9
1971
0.0
O.O
O.O
O.O
1975
O.O
O. 1
-7.4
-12.4
198O
O.O
O. 1
-7.4
-24.4
1985
O.O
O.4
-14.2
-35.8

-------
                ESTIMATING THE REDUCTION IN
                 WATER RESIDUAL GENERATION
Figure  2  presents  graphs  for  water  residuals which are
similar to those in Figure 1.  The shape of the total  water
residual  curves  (see Figure 2) does not show any increases
after 1977 similar to  the  total  controlled  air  residual
curves for sulfur oxides.  (However, the controlled level of
nutrients  remains  approximately  the same after 1977 since
the increase in tertiary treatment of  municipal  sewage  is
only  sufficient  to  offset  the  increase  in uncontrolled
nutrients due to population growth.)  This is due  primarily
to  the phased abatement schedule for water effluents in the
1972 amendments.  The Reference Abatement  Scenario  assumes
that  BPT  is  operational  by  1977 and BAT is operating by
1983; therefore, there is a continual increase in most water
effluent removal efficiencies until 1983.   Other  than  the
change  from  the  sulfur  oxides  curve, the curves for the
total uncontrolled water residuals show  shapes  similar  to
the  remaining  air residual curves, responding to increases
in economic output and population.

Industrial/commercial  and   municipal   sewage   contribute
approximately  equal, but declining, shares to BOD effluents
through 1985.   All  three  sources,  industrial/commercial,
municipal  sewage,  and  electric  utilities,  contribute to
suspended    solids     emissions.      In     1971,     the
industrial/commercial  index was approximately 78 percent of
all  suspended  solids  emissions;   however,   this   index
diminishes  to  less  than  6  percent  by  1985  while  the
municipal sewage index changes only from 21 percent in  1971
to about 10 percent in 1985.
                           4-78

-------
            Figure 2.
Trends in water Residuals from the
   Reference Abatement Scenario
                4-79

-------
The  composition  of  dissolved  solids  emissions is almost
totally (85 percent) from industrial/commercial  sources  in
1971; by 1985 the industrial/commercial index has dropped to
50 percent while the electric utilities index has grown from
15   percent  to  30  percent,  primarily  due  to  electric
generation by coal.  Nutrients (composed  of  phosphate  and
nitrate  effluents)  are  almost  totally  due  to municipal
sources for all years and remain at  a  relatively  constant
level throughout the time period.

Table  3  shows  the  largest  economic sector and subsector
contributors to the industrial/commercial share of effluents
for water.  Municipal  sewage  treatment  is  excluded  from
consideration  in this table because residuals attributed to
this sector come from a variety of sources  in  addition  to
industrial  and  commercial  establishments.   For BOD, -Pulp
Mills are the major source of effluents in  1971.   However,
by 1985, Forestry and Fishery Prodjicts has the largest share
of  BOD effluents, reflecting the lesser degree of treatment
efficiency for this  sector.   Asphalt  production  and  the
Bauxite  Refining  process  were  the  largest  polluters of
suspended solids from industrial/commercial sources in 1971.
By 1985, however,  sectors/subsectors  with  less  efficient
control technologies, such as Forestry and Fishery Products,
Lime  production, and Bleached Kraft Pulp Mills, account for
almost half of the  effluent  while  suspended  solids  from
Asphalt  and  Bauxite  Refining  are  completely controlled.
Subsectors of the  Industrial  Chemicals  sector  yield  the
greatest  share  of  dissolved solids effluents prior to the
implementation of BAT in 1983.   Of  these  subsectors,  the
production of sodium carbonate by the Solvay process was the
largest  contributor  in  1971.   This  economic  production
process, however, is being replaced by a  competing  process
for  the  production of sodium carbonate, the Trona process.
The  Trona  process  yields  negligible   water   residuals-
therefore,  effluents  from  the  Sodium  Carbonate  process
decrease to almost  zero  in  1985.   In  contrast  to  this
pattern, the share  for Citric Acid production increases from
less    than    25   percent   to   over   50   percent   of
industrial/commercial suspended solids  effluents  over  the
period  because  the  production of Citric Acid increases to
double the 1971 value by 1985.

Table 4 presents the percent differences in water  residuals
forecast   for the major polluters of the Reference Abatement
Scenario   in  the   Low  Productivity  Abatement  and  Energy
Abatement  Scenarios  as  compared with water residuals from
those polluters found in the Reference  Abatement  Scenario.
The  same general trends between scenarios are evidenced for
water residual differences as for air residuals.  The trends
                            4-80

-------
for  the  Energy  Abatement  Scenario  are,  however,   less
pronounced  because  major  changes  in assumptions made for
this scenario impacted primarily  on  air  residuals  rather
than on water residuals.
                             4-81

-------
                          Table 3.
        Industrial/Commercial Net Water Residuals by
           Major Contributing Sectors/Subsectors
                             Percent of Industrial and
                             Elec. Emissions from
                             Reference Abatement Scenario

Sectors/Subsectors        1971     1977     1983     1985

Biochemical Oxygen Demand

Pulp Mills
  Kraft-Bleached          13.1     11.1      7.5      6.7

Plastic Materials &
Resins                     8.6     13.3     11.4      8.0

Forestry & Fishery
Products                   7.4     14.6     33.4     40.6
Pulp Mills
  Sulfite-Pulp             6.0      5.5      3.5      2.5

Pulp Mills
  Kraft-Unbleached         5.9      5.6      5.8      5.9

Suspended Solids

Paving & Asphalt
  Asphalt                 26.3     19.1      0        0

Aluminum
  Bauxite Refining        25.3     18.9      0        0

Steel                     13.5     12.4      7.5      3.7

Cement, Concrete, Gypsum
  Lime                     7.7      1.7      9.2     16.6

Pulp Mills
  Kraft-Bleached           4.7      7.0     13.0     13.5

Forestry & Fishery
Products                   4.2      9.7     19.7     17.1
                           4-82

-------
                    Table 3.  (Continued)
        Industrial/Commercial Het Water Residuals by
           Major Contributing Sectors/Subsectors
Sectors/Subsectors
                             Percent of industrial and
                             Elec, Emissions from
                             Reference Abatement Scenario
1971
1977
1983
1985
Dissolved Solids
Industrial Chemicals
  Sodium Carbonate-
  Solvay Process
  Citric Acid
39.0
23.0
29.8
27.2
 7.6
45.2
 0
50.6
Electric utilities
  Electricity by Coal     14.1

Industrial Chemicals
  Chlorine-Diaphragm
  Cell                     2.3
         24.2     31.8
                  34.9
          3.5
          1.5
                            4-83

-------
                                        Table 4
                      Percent Changes In Water Residuals from the
                      Major Polluting Industries for Alternative
                           Abatement Scenarios Compared with
                            the Reference Abatement Scenario
it*
CD
Sectors/Subsectors

Biochemical Oxygen Demand

Pulp Mil Is
  Kraft-Bleached

Plastic Materials & Resins

Forestry & Fishery
Products

Pulp Mills
  Sulf1te-Pulp

Pulp Mills
  Kraft-Unbleached

Suspended Sol Ids

Paving & Asphalt
  Asphalt

A1 urn 1 nuin
  Bauxite Refining
                                                       Percent Difference from the Reference Abatement  Scenario (S2)

                                                 Low Productivity Abatement (S4)        Energy Abatement (S6)

                                                 1971     1977     1983     1985       1971   1977  1983   198S
                                                  O.O

                                                  0.0


                                                  O.O


                                                  0.0


                                                  O.O




                                                  O.O


                                                  O.O
1 1     -9.0    -10.3     O.O O.6  -0.9  -1.6

1.3    -1O.7    -12.1     O.O  -O.2  -2.1  -2.8


1.4    -15.5    -17.5     O.O O.2  -O.3O.2
1.3
O.9
1 . 1
-8.5
-9.8     0.0 0.3 0.3 O.5
1.1     -9.O    -1O.3     O.O O.6  -O.9  -1.6
                        O.O O.O O  O
                                                                                     O.O 0.0 0  0

-------
                                 Table 4. (Continued)
                     Percent Changes  1n Water Residuals from the
                     Major Polluting  Industries for Alternative
                          Abatement Scenarios Compared with
                          the Reference Abatement Scenario
I
00
tn
             Sector s/Subsectors
             Cement, Concrete, Gypsum
               L1me

             Pulp Mills
               Kraf t -Unb 1 eached

             Forestry & Fishery
             Products
             Dissolved Solids

             Industrial Chemicals
               Sodium Carbonate-
               Sol vay Process
               Citric Add

             Electric Utll 1t1es
               Electricity by Coal

             Industrial Chemicals
               Chlorine-Diaphragm Cell
      Percent Difference from the Reference Abatement Scenario (52)

Low Productivity Abatement (S4)       Energy Abatement (56)

1971     1977     1983     1985      1971  1977  1883  1985

 O.O      O.5    -10-1    -1O.6     0.00.1  -O.9  -1.2
 O.O
 O.O
 O.O
 0.0
 O.O
 O.O
 0.0
1-1     -9.2    -1O.2
          1.1     -9.0    -1O.3
1.4    -15.5    -17.5
1.2
2.4
O.9
-10.3      0
-11.0     -13.9
 -7.5
-9.1
1.4    -10.3    -11.6
                   O.O O.O  -1,1   -1.3
                          O.O O.6  -0.9  -1.6
                  O.O O,2   -O.3 0.2
         O.O-O.1  -1.30
         O.O O.3 O.8 1.3
                                    0.0   -3.5   -9.5  -13.7
                                   O.O O.O   -1.O  -1.3

-------
                   ESTIMATING THE COST OF
                     POLLUTION CONTROL
Assuming  air  and water pollution controls, associated cost
functions, and the Reference  Case  growth  in  GNP,  direct
costs  of  pollution control for each industry sector can be
forecast using  SEAS.   Using  these  forecasts,  the  total
annual  costs  (annualized capital plus O&M) for the 1976-85
period for all industries will be:
  industrial Control Costs  (Billions 1975$)        $231.8
        Air Costs                                  $111.1
        Water Costs                                $120.7
The detailed distribution of these  costs  across   aggregate
industrial  sectors is shown in Table 5.  Note  that Electric
Power Plants must expend about a  fourth of the  air  pollution
costs.  Nearly another quarter of the air costs are borne  by
many different industries in order  to provide space heating,
with  Chemicals  and  Paper  being   the   major    aggregate
industries making this expenditure.

By  far  the  largest water pollution control expenditure  is
made by the Machinery and Equipment sector   (this  includes
the  aggregate  sectors  of electroplating,  fabricated  metal
products, and electrical and nonelectrical machinery).   This
sector  is  required  to  expend  over  50   percent  of all
industrial   water   pollution  control  expenditures.   The
Chemicals sector is the second  largest  spender   for  water
pollution   control   (in   particular,  Organic   Chemicals,
inorganic Chemicals, and Plastics and Synthetics),  and   will
be  required  to spend slightly over 16 percent of  the  total
industrial control costs for water  pollutants.

when air and water pollution control costs are  combined, the
preponderance of Machinery and  Equipment  expenditures for
water  pollution  control also maXe it the aggregate  sector,
expending over twice the amount   that  any   other   aggregate
sector  expends  for  total pollution control even though  no
air pollution control expenditures  are required.   The  share
of total pollution control equipment costs for  Machinery and
Equipment   is  29  percent.   Of  the  remaining   aggregate
sectors,  five show total pollution  control costs   in  excess
of  5  percent  of the national industrial pollution  control
costs: Electric Utilities  (14 percent); Other  (11   percent).
Pulp,  Paper,  Printing,  and  Lumber   (8  percent);  Ferrous
Metals  (8 percent); and Chemicals  (7  percent).    Together,
                            4-86

-------
these  six  aggregate  sectors  account  for  two-thirds  of
national industrial pollution control costs.
                             4-87

-------
                                         Table 5.
               Annual1zed National Control Costs for A1r and Water Pollution
               Abatement (excluding Transportation and Municipal Control Costs),  1976-1985
                              (In Millions of 1975 Dollars)
                                                  	AIR	
o>
00
Aggregated Industrial Sectors

Agr1cu1ture
Mining
Food Processing
Textiles
Pulp, Paper, Printing & Lumber
Chemicals
Petroleum & Rubber
Ferrous Metals
Nonferrous Metals
Stone, Clay, & Glass
Machinery & Equipment
Electric Utilities
Trade & Services
Other
Total
Costs

     0
   588
 3,629
   316
  ,864
  ,4O7
 6,280
11.885
 9,784
 6,317
 1,619
24,538
 3,622
24,237
                                               11,
                                                6,
% of
National
Costs

   0
   0.5
   3.3
   O.3
  10.7
   5.8
   5.7
  1O.7
   8.8
   5.7
   1 .5
  22. .1
   3.3
  21 .8

Total
Costs
291
O
6,203
642
7,887
19,732
2,692
7,486
1 ,506
502
65,795
7,455
O
525
-W«ICK 	 	 	 AiK « WAICK-
% Of % Of
National Total National
Costs Costs Costs
O.2 291 0.1
0 599 O.3
5.1 9 . 832 4 . 2
O.5 968 O.4
6.5 19,751 8,5
16.4 16, 139 6.9
2.2 8,972 3.9
6.2 19,371 8.3
1.3 1O.29O 4.4
O.4 6,819 3.0
54.5 67,414 29 . O
6.2 31,99313.7
O 3,622 1.6
0.4 24,762 1O. 6
               National  Totals
                                              111,O86
                                                          12O.716
                                         232,8O2

-------
To illustrate the components of the cost estimates for  each
industry,   two  aggregate  industrial  sectors  (Paper  and
Printing, and Ferrous Metals) may  be  examined  in  greater
detail.   Table 6 shows the cost sectors involved in each of
these aggregate sectors and their associated  air  pollution
abatement expenditures.  Note that Kraft Pulping contributes
more   than   85   percent  of  the  air  pollution  control
expenditures for the aggregate Paper  and  Printing  sector.
Similarly,  the  manufacture of iron and steel mill products
comprise the bulk of the Ferrous Metals expenditures for air
pollution control.
                          Table 6.
       Air Pollution Abatement Expenditure Detail for
                  Paper and Ferrous Metals
                             % of Total Annual Air
                             Expenditures  (1976-85

Pulp, Paper, Printing & Lumber    10.7
  Kraft Pulp                             9.3
  HSSC Pulp                              1.2
  Printing                               0.2
  Lumber                                 0.0

Ferrous Metals                    10.7
  Iron and Steel                         7.2
  iron Foundries                         2.3
  Steel Foundries                        0.6
  Ferroalloys                            0.7
Kraft Pulping expenditures for  air  pollution  control  are
calculated  using  11  industrial process segments while the
expenditures for iron and Steel manufacture  are  calculated
using  22  industrial process segments.  The 11 segments for
Kraft Pulping and their contribution to  the  Kraft  Pulping
total are shown in Table 7.
                            4-89

-------
                          Table 7.
            Air Pollution Cost Detail by Segment
                     for Kraft Pulping
                                   % of Total Annual
                                   Air Expenditures

Paper
  Kraft Pulping                       9-3
     Lime Kiln                              0.10
     Smelting Tank                          0.08
     Gas Incineration in
        Recovery Furnace                    0.10
     Gas Incineration in
        Lime Kiln                           0.10
     Boiler—suspended Particulates         0.28
     Boiler—sulfur Oxides                  3.53
     Recovery Furnace
        Scrubber                            0.03
        Black Liquor oxidation              0.28
        Replacement                         1.03
        Electrostatic Precipitator          0.57
     industrial Fuel combustion             3.20
Industry investment

The  difficulties  that  a  given  industry  faces in making
pollution  control  expenditures  are  dependent  upon  many
factors.  Two of these factors are the size of the pollution
control  expenditures as a percentage of total output by the
industry and the pollution control investment required as  a
percentage   of   the  total  expected  investment  by  that
industry.  Data for 31 aggregate industries concerning  each
of  these  factors  are  shown  in Tables 8 and 9.  Table 10
summarizes this data for air,  water,  and  total  pollution
control  expenditures  and  investments for the 31 aggregate
industries and also  ranks  the  industries  based  on  each
percentage.
                            4-90

-------
                                           Table 8.
                            Relative Impacts of  Required In-House
                         Pollution Abatement Expenditures,  1976-1985
                                       (Million  1975$)

                                                               Air
                                                                  Water Air & Water
it*
I
vo
Category

Agriculture
Mining
Natural Gas Processing
Meat & Poultry
Dairy
Canned & Frozen Food
Grain Milling &  Feed Mills
Beet & Cane Sugar
Textiles
Lumber & Wood Products
Furniture
Pulp & Paper
Builder's Paper
Print ing
Chemicals
Fertl11zers
Plastics & Synthetics
Petroleum & Asphalt
Paints
Rubber Products
Leather Tanning
Glass
Asbestos, Clay, Lime, &
  Concrete
Iron & Steel
Nonferrous Metals
Fabricated Metals &
  Electroplating
Output
1,260,713
225; 684
243,857
491.3O5
1 89 , 35O
226, 182
195,772
50,796
650,571
178, 63O
213,699
367,951
138,245
445,666
5O5 , 52O
52,841
223,432
629, 9S9
58,891
184,603
14,719
110,432
274,559
540,843
405,332
Total
Cost
0
165
423
O
O
0
3,629
O
316
0
1,849
9,904
O
111
5,275
512
501
6.28O
119
0
O
O
5,974
11,885
9,784
% of
Output
O
O.O7
0.17
O
0
O
1.85
O
0.05
0
0.86
2.69
0
O.O2
1 .04
O.97
O.22
1.OO
O.26
O
0
O
2,17
2.20
2.42
Total % of Total % of
Cost Output Cost Output
291 O.O2 291 O.O2
O O 165 O.O7
0
1,059
1,338
3,638
47
121
641
425
O
7,276
184
0
16,386
372
2,974
2,446
0
246
525
212
290
7,481
1.5O6
O 423 O.17
O.22 1.O59 O.22
O.71 1,338 O.71
1.61 3,638 1.61
O.02 3,675 1.88
0.24 121 O.24
O.1O 957 O.15
O.24 425 O.24
O 1,849 0.86
1.98 17,181 4.67
0.13 184 0.13
O 111 O.O2
3.24 21,661 4.29
O.7O 884 1.67
1.33 3,476 1 .56
O.39 8.725 1.38
O 119 0.26
O.13 246 O.13
3,57 525 3.57
O.19 212 O. 19
0.11 6,264 2.28
1.38 19,366 3.58
O.37 11.29O 2.79
                                              999,5O3
32,451
3,26  32,451   3.26

-------
I
VD
ro
                                        Table 8.  (continued)
                               Relative  Impacts of Required In-House
                           Pollution Abatement Expenditures,  1976-1985
                                          (Million 1975$)

                                                                 A1r
                   Category

                   Machinery
                   Transportation Equipment
                   Electric Utilities
                   Wholesale & Retail
                   Services
                   Other Industries
             Water Air & Water

Output
1,258,102
1.763.12O
792,675
4 . 72 1 , 246
S, 728, 522
.N.A i
Total
Cost
1, 148
471
24 . 538
3,317
3O5
24 .237
% Of
Output
O.O9
0.03
3. 1O
O.07
O.O1
N.A
Total % of Total . % of
Cost
21,710
11,634
7.458
0
O
O
Output Cost ^Outpi
1.73 22,858 1.82
O.67 12.1O5 O.7O
O.94 31,992 4.O4
O 3,317 O.O7
O 3OS O.O1
N.A 24.237 N.A
                   Totals
                                                     N.A 11O.743
N.A  12O.7O8   N.A 231,450 N.A

-------
*>
I
vo
                                          Table 9.
                      Relative Impacts of Required In-House Pollution
                              Abatement Investment,  1976-1985
                                      (Mill ion 1975  $)
Category

Agriculture
Mining
Natural Gas Processing
Meat & Poultry
Dairy
Canned & Frozen Pood
Grain Mill ing &
  Feed Mills
Beet & Cane Sugar
Textiles
Lumber & Wood
  Products
Furniture
Pulp & Paper
Bu11der's Paper
Printing
Chemicals
Pert111zers
Plastics 8, Synthetics
Petroleum & Asphalt
Paints
Rubber Products
Leather Tanning
Glass
Asbestos, Clay, Lime,
  & Concrete
Iron & Steel
Nonferrous Metals
Total
Air-
Abatement
Investment Investment %
75,569
33,392
21,736
6,998
5,558
1 1 , 236
6,642
4.O17
29,289
17,624
6,634
49.672
7,337
25,072
66 , 566
5,373
20,696
34,207
2,235
16.21O
4O9
8,484
18,513
56,016
28,061
O
134
51
O
O
O
1.O21
O
88
0
9O
2.O3O
O
22
1.O96
98
14O
1,121
12
O
O
O
628
2,019
1,157
O
O.40
O.24
0
O
0
15.37
O
O.3O
O
1.36
4.O9
O
O.O9
1.65
1.82
O.68
3.28
O.53
O
O
O
3.39
3.60
4.12
Water
Abatement
Total
Air & Water % Total
Investment % Investment Investment
112
O
O
492
516
1,740
13
31
378
71
O
5.O24
123
O
5,404
243
1.56O
1,670
0
13O
28O
1O2
91
2,321
224
0.15 112
O 134
O 51 O
7.O4 492
9.28 516
15.481,740
O. 191, 033
2.91 31
1 . 29 467
O.4O 71
O 9O 1
10.127,055
1.68 123
O 22 O
8.126.5O1
4 . 52 34O
7.541,699
4.882,791
0 12 0.
O.80 13O
68.43 28O
1.21 1O2
O.49 719
4. 144, 34O
0.801,381
O.15
O.4O
.24
7.O4
9.28
15.48
15.56
2.91
1.59
O.4O
.36
14. 2O
1 .68
.09
9,77
6.34
8.21
8. 16
53
0.8O
68.43
1.21
3.38
7.75
4.92

-------
I
vo
>*>
                                Table 9.  (continued)
                  Relative Impacts of Required In-House Pollution
                          Abatement Investment,  1976-1985
                                  (M1111on 1975  $)
Category

Fabricated Metals &
  Electroplating
Machinery
Transportation
  Equ1pment
Electric Utllitles
Wholesale & Retail
Services
Other Industries

Total
Investment
54.55O
61,358
101, 169
127,174
229,612
2O1.538
N.A
A1r
Abatement
Investment %
0 0
118 O.19
131 O.13
7 , 9O6 6 . 22
1 , 2O7 O . 53
80 0.04
4,411 N.A
                                                     Water
                                                     Abatement
                                                     Investment
                                                                  8,298
                                                                  7,317

                                                                  3,451
                                                                  5,376
                                                                      O
                                                                      0
                                                                      O
   Total
   Air & Water
    Investment
   % Total
   Investment
15.218,298
11.937,436
15.21
12. 12
 3.413,583    3.54
 4.233,282   10.44
  O1,207    O.53
  0 SO    0.04
N.A4.411   N.A
            Totals
                                      N.A
                                             23,560
                                                         N.A
                                                     44,967
N.A 68,529   N.A

-------
                                             Table  1O.
                    Ranking of Impacted Sectors by  Total Abatement Expenditures
                     as Percentages of Total Output and by Abatement  Investment
                             as Percentages of Other Planned Investment
                                            (1976-1985)'
                                                             Investment
*i>
en
Pulp & Paper
Chemicals
Electric Utilities
Iron & Steel
Leather Tanning
Fabricated Metals
  and Electroplating
Nonferrous Metals
Asbestos, Clay,
  Lime, and Concrete
Grain Milling & Feed Mills
Mach1nery
Fertl1izers
Canned & Frozen Food
Plastics & Synthetics
Petroleum & Asphalt
Furniture
Da i ry
Transportation Equipment
Paints
Beet & Cane Sugar
Lumber & Wood Products
Meat & Poultry
Glass
Natural Gas Processing
Textiles
Builder's Paper
Rubber Products
Air
Rank
4
9
2
5
-
-
3
6
1
17
8
-
11
7
10
-
18
12
-
-
-
-
16
15
-
-
5
4.
1 .
6.
3.


4.
3.
15.
0.
1 .
-
0.
3.
1 .
-
0.
0.

-
-
-
0.
0.
-
-
i
09
65
22
60


12
39 .
37
19
82

68
28
36

13
53




24
30


Water
Rank
5
7
12
13
1
3
19
21
23
4
11
2
8
1O
-
6
14
-
15
22
9
18
-
17
16
20
%
1O
8
4
4
68
15
0
0
0
11
4
15
7
4

9
3

2
0
7,
1

1.
1 .
0.

.12
. 12
.23
. 14
.43
.21
.80
.49
.19
.93
.52
.48
.54
.88

.28
.41

.91
.40
.04
.21

29
68
80
Both
Rank
5
8
7
12
1
4
16
15
2
6
14
3
1O
1 1
21
9
17
24
18
26
13
22
28
20
19
23
%
14
9
1O
7
68
15
4
5
15
12
6
15
8
8
1
9,
3.
O.
2.
O.
7.
1 .
O.
1.
1 .
0.
j
.20
.77
.44
.75
,43
.21
.92
.86
.56
.12
.34
.48
.21
. 16
.36
28
,54
,53
91
40
04
21
24
59
68
80
                                                                        Output

                                                                     Air  Water
                                                                  Rank Hank Rank
                                                                                                      Both
 22.6941,98  1 4.67
 71.04  33.24 2 4.29
 13.1O  9O.94 34.O4
 42.24  71.38 4 3.62
 -  -  13.58 5 3.58

 -  -  23.25 6 3.25
 32.4214O.37 7 2.79

 52.17210.11 8 2.28
 61.85230.02 9 1.88
14O.O9  51.73101.82
 9O.9711O.7O11 1.67
 - - 61.6112 1-61
12O.22  81.33131.56
 81.OO130.39141.38
1OO.86  - -15 0.86
 -  -1OO.7016 0.70
180.03120.6617 0.69
110.26 - -18 0.26
 -  -150.2419 0.24
 -  -160.2420 0.24
 -  -17O.2221  0.22
 -  -ISO.1922  0.19
t3O.17 - -23  O.17
170.05220.1O24 0.15
 -  -190.13250.13
 -  -200.1326  0.13

-------
I
vo
                   Table 1O. ("continued)
Ranking of Impacted Sectors by Total Abatement Expenditures
 as Percentages of Total Output and by Abatement Investment
         as Percentages of Other Planned Investment
                        (1976-1985)'
                                                     Investment
                                                                                    Output
Air
Rank
13
14
19
-
2O

%
0.
O.
0.
-
0.

1
53
40
O9

O4
Water
Rank %
'-
-
-
24 0.15
-
Both
Rank
25
27
30
29
31
Air
%
O.
O.
O.
O
0

.53
.40
.09
, 15
.04
Rank
150
16O
19O
Water

Bo
Rank Rank %
.07
.07
.03
- -24O,
200
.01
- -27
- -28
- -29
.O23O
- -31
O.
0.
O
.07
.07
.03
O.O2
O
.CM
            Wholesale & Retail
            M1n i ng
            Printing
            Agriculture
            Services

              This table, while analogous to Table 4 of the Executive Summary, does not include the adjustments
              to Industries where specific studies were undertaken at a later date.

-------
Of  the  31  industrial  sectors shown in Table 10, thirteen
require abatement  expenditures  for  both  air  and  water.
Industries  with high air pollution control costs often have
significant water pollution control costs as well.  However,
industries with high  water  pollution  expenditure  control
costs are less likely to also have air control expenditures.

Water   pollution   control  investments  dominate  the   air
pollution  equipment  investments,  similar  to  the   total
expenditure pollution control cost patterns discussed above.
Of  the  10  largest  investors,  four  have water pollution
control investments only, including three of the  top  four.
In the remaining six industries, three others  show pollution
control investments heavily weighted  towards water, two show
about  even splits between air and water, and  one is heavily
weighted towards air.  Finally, of the top  10  industries  for
air pollution  control investments, nine also must make water
pollution control investments; however/ only five of the  top
10 industries  for water pollution investment must also  make
air pollution  control investments.

Considering  air  expenditures,  the  Grain Milling and Feed
Mills  industry will have  to make a 15.4 percent  addition   to
total  expected investment during the  1976-85 period  if  it is
to  adequately control  air pollution. Other  industries with
large  air pollution investment requirements of greater  than
3 percent  of  other   investment requirements are: Electric
Utilities  (6.2 percent),  Monferrous   Metals  (4.1   percent),
Pulp   and   Paper 4.1 percent),  Iron  and  Steel 3.6  percent),
Asbestos,   Clay,  Lime,   and   Concrete  (3.4   percent),   and
Petroleum  and  Asphalt  (3.3 percent).

The   total   annual   air  pollution   control costs  during  the
 1976-85 period as percentages of- the total  output  value  for
each   sector   are  much  smaller than the above ratios.   The
 highest sectors for these annual cost ratios   are:   Electric
Utilities   (3.1  percent);  Pulp  and  Paper  (2.7 percent);
 Nonferrous Metals (2.4  percent); Asbestos,  Clay,  Lime,   and
 Concrete  (2.3  percent);  Iron and Steel (2.2 percent);  and
 Grain Milling and Feed  Mills (1.9  percent).    Because  some
 sectors  are  more  or  less capital-intensive than others in
 their  air  pollution  abatement   costs,   this   list   is
 significantly different from the previous list.

 Similar  percentages  concerning  water  pollution abatement
 investment to those presented for air pollution control  may
 be  calculated.   The  comparison of water pollution control
 investment to other planned investment yields the  following
 ranking for most heavily impacted industries:
                            4-97

-------
        Leather Tanning               68.43%
        Canned & Frozen Food          15.48%
        Fabricated Metals &
           Electroplating             15.21%
        Machinery                     11.93%
        Pulp & Paper                  10.12%
        Dairy                          9.28%
        Chemicals                      8.12%
        Plastics and Synthetics        7.54%
        Meat & Poultry                 7.04%
All other industries show percentages of less than 5 percent
for this statistic.

The  ratio  of total industrial plant expenditures for water
pollution control (not Including payments to  municipalities
for  water pollution control) to total output again are much
smaller percentages than those  for  investment.   The  most
highly impacted industries using this statistic are:
        Leather Tanning                3.58%
        Fabricated Metals &
           Electroplating              3.25%
        Chemicals                      3.24%
        Pulp & Paper                   1.98%
        Machinery                      1.73%
        Canned & Frozen Food           1.61%
All  other  industries  show  percentages  of   less than  1.5
percent.   As   for  air  pollution  control/  the   relative
capital-intensity  of  pollution  control  costs for various
industries causes the ranking of industries in  this list   to
shift  from the  order of the previous list.

A  final  consideration  in  impact  evaluation is the .total
impact of the combination of air and water pollution control
costs.  Altogether, nine aggregate industries   will  require
an  investment   level  for pollution control over the decade
that is more than 9 percent of other planned  investment   in
each industry:
                           4-98

-------
        Leather Tanning               68.43%
        Grain Milling & Feed Mills    15.56%
        Canned & Frozen Food          15.48%
        Fabricated Metals &
           Electroplating             15.21%
        Pulp & Paper                  14.20%
        Machinery                     12.12%
        Electric Utilities            10.44%
        Chemicals                      9.77%
        Dairy                          9.28%
Leather  Tanning  is  by  far  the  most  impacted  industry
according  to  this  statistic,   with   pollution   control
investments  equal to slightly more than two-thirds of other
planned investment over the decade.

All industries have a total  pollution  control  cost  as  a
percentage  of  sector output that is less than 5.0 percent.
The most heavily impacted are:
        Pulp & Paper                  4.67%
        Chemicals                     4.29%
        Electric Utilities            4.04%
        Iron & Steel                  3.62%
        Leather Tanning               3.58%
        Fabricated Metals &
           Electroplating             3.25%
        Nonferrous Metals             2.79%
        Asbestos, Clay, Lime, &
           Concrete                   2.42%
The other industries are impacted at less than 2 percent  of
their total decade output.
                           4-99

-------
Chapter 5
Estimating Pollution Control Costs
          COMPARISON OF SEAS INVESTMENT ESTIMATES
      FOR AIR POLLUTION CONTROL WITH ESTIMATES OF BEA
The   year-by-year   estimates   of  air  pollution  control
investment presented in Chapter 4, which  are  necessary   to
equip  over  half  of  the  existing  plants  with  required
pollution control devices by the beginning of  1976  and   to
equip  all  existing  plants with such devices by the end  of
1978, appear to be optimistic when compared with the  Bureau
of   Economic   Analysis  (BEA)  estimastes  of  actual  air
pollution investment expenditures in 1973 and  1974  and   of
planned  expenditures  for  1975..   Table  1 compares common
estimates for both studies, showing BEA estimates of  actual
air  pollution  investments  as  a  percentage  of  the SEAS
forecast of investments for the three years.
                          Table 1.
      Comparison of SEAS Forecast investments and BEA
        Estimates of Actual Air Pollution Investment
           Expenditures for 1973, 1974, and 1975
        {BEA estimates as a percent of SEAS Forecasts)
                    1973     1974     1975     1973-1975

All industries      105%      69%      38%        57%

Electric Utilities  182%     139%     123%       141%
Ferrous Metals       24%      16%      19%        19%
Nonferrous Metals   129%      49%      46%        63%
Stone, Clay, Glass   43%      47%      32%        39%
Food                 32%      17%      17%        20%
Paper                45%      49%      60%        52%
Chemicals           155%     105%     106%       118%
Petroleum           184%     142%     369%       144%
in analyzing Table 1, note that according to SEAS  forecasts
of  investments, industries in aggregate were spending about
the right amount in 1973  (as  estimated  by  BEA).   Ferrous
Metals;  Food;  stone,  Clay, and Glass; and Paper, however,
were well behind schedule even at this point.  By 1974,  the
                           4-1.00

-------
total  for  all  industries  had  slipped  behind  the  pace
estimated  by  SEAS  as  required  to  meet  the   pollution
standards.    Possibly  as  an  aftermath  of  the  economic
recession, attempts to  fight  Federal  regulations  in  the
courts,  or other factors, industries as a whole had dropped
to less than 70 percent of the expenditure level  needed  in
1974.   Ferrous  Metals and Food dropped even  further behind
their respective schedules than they were in 1973,  By 1975,
the expenditures planned by industries had dropped  to  only
slightly  above  a  third  of  the. amount needed to -meet the
expenditure schedule of the  Reference  Abatement  Scenario.
However,  three  industries   {Electric Utilities, Chemicals,
and Petroleum^ planned to install more  equipment  than  the
SEAS  investment  'schedule  estimated  as being  needed. ' For
example,  Petroleum  planned to  spend  at a  level three   and   a
half  times greater than estimates indicated would be  needed
by  1975   to   meet   the   compliance   schedules  discussed   in
Appendix  B.   A  fourth  sector,  Paper, does not achieve  the
required  investment pace  during  1973 through   1975,   but   it
does improve  its percentage over time,  in"  contrast  to these
 industries,   the  other   four  industries in  Table  1  exhibit
declining investment  schedule percentages over the  full  time
period   and   are  at   less  than  50  percent   of   required
 investment   by  1974.    These industries  are  Ferrous  Metals-
 Nonferrous Metals; Stone, Clay,  and Glass;  and Food.
                    ESTIMATING SIGNIFICANT
                 ENVIRONMENTAL CONTROL COSTS
 Four types of environmental control costs are  estimated  by
 SEAS.    These   types,  along  with  the  receiving  medium
 associated with each, ares

    *  industrial  (air and water)

    •  Mobile  sources  (air)

    »  Municipal  (water)

    •  Government  (air and  water)


  The  techniques  used  to -develop cost estimates   for  each  of
  these  types  are  .presented in  the  following discussion.
                             4-101

-------
Estimating Air and Water
Costs for industrial Sources

All  of  the  industrial  control  costs  estimated  by SEAS
(except for Electric Utilities) are endogenously determined.
These industrial costs are calculated using  characteristics
of  existing  plants  and  estimated  characteristics of new
plants to be built in response to overall economic  activity
forecast  by  the  SEAS economic projections.  Therefore,  if
one scenario has a 10 percent higher  GNP  than  another   by
1985,  it  will  consequently  forecast  more new plants and
higher pollution abatement costs.  This  factor  explains   a
great   deal   of  the  differences  between  the  Reference
Abatement Scenario costs and previous estimates by  EPA  and
other agencies.  In addition, the composition of, as well  as
the  amount  of,  GNP  growth  affects  the  industrial cost
estimates.  Further detail on the industrial cost estimation
techniques is provided in Appendix D.

Three  additional  types  of  environmental  control   costs
besides industrial costs are important.  These are the costs
associated  with  mobile  sources,  municipal treatment, and
governmental  expenditures.   These  costs  are   determined
outside  the  dynamics  of  the  SEAS  economic  forecasting
models, but are made consistent with the  results  of  these
models  and,  consequently,  the  industrial cost estimates.
For  example,  the  control  costs   associated   with   new
automobiles are very much dependent upon the forecast of new
car sales.  When national conditions change in such a way  as
to alter the baseline projection of new car sales from 1971
to 1985, the  inputs  to  the  mobile  source  control  cost
calculations are correspondingly adjusted.
Estimating  Air Costs
for Mobile  Sources

Mobile  source air pollution control  costs are  generated  as  a
result   of  emission standards  for  light-duty vehicles  (LDV),
heavy-duty  vehicles (HDV), and aircraft, plus  the  impact of
State   Transportation   Control Plans (TCP's).   The Clean Air
Act specifies national  standards for mobile source  emission
levels   for hydrocarbons,  carbon  monoxide,   and  nitrogen
oxides.

The costs to  reach  the  national  standards   for  emission
levels  by the target years contined  in  the Clean Air Act are
estimated   by  a  model that   ages   the  present   stock of
vehicles, year by year. The model takes  into account  new
vehicle sales,  which  are  based upon the GNP and personal
income  figures provided by the scenarios  discussed in  the
                            4-102

-------
macr©economic  analyses.   Calculated  mobile source control
costs for the entire stock of vehicles  are  then  fed  back
through  the  interindustry model.  For example, the capital
expenditures for automobile control devices are  treated  as
additional  expenditures  for  the  Motor Vehicles and Parts
sector   while   the   operation   and   maintenance   (O&M)
expenditures  are treated as additional expenditures for the
Auto Repair sector.

The mobile source costs  calculated  in  this  comprehensive
analysis  reflect  meeting the stringent standards (0.41 HC,
3.4   CO,   0.4   NOx)   and    subsequent    administrative
postponements.   Costs  presented in Section 2 were recently
updated to reflect further postponements proposed  in  Clean
Air Act amendments of Summer 1977.

Concentrations  of  carbon  monoxide  and  smog  (caused  by
hydrocarbons and nitrogen oxides reacting in  sunlight)  are
so   high  in  several  metropolitan  areas  that  even  the
stringent stationary source controls and the Federal  mobile
source   emission   standards   do   not   reduce  emissions
sufficiently to meet Federal ambient air quality  standards.
These  areas  have  developed  Transportation  Control Plans
(TCP's)  that  involve  combinations  of  additional  mobile
source   controls   (more   retrofit  devices  for  existing
vehicles, strong inspection and  maintenance  measures,  and
vapor control systems for gas stations).

The TCP costs (not adjusted to reflect savings from improved
fuel  economy)  are  estimated  to  be $0.7 billion over the
1976-85 period.  Most of these costs are for inspection  and
maintenance  of  automobiles  to insure that their pollution
control devices are operating at the  proper  effectiveness.
These  are expenditures made primarily by automobile owners.
However, increased engine maintenance results in significant
fuel  economy,  which   is  a  direct  economic  benefit   to
automobile  owners.  In offsetting the increased maintenance
costs with these fuel savings, only a small net  total  cost
of  $0.1  billion is left for TCP's over the 1976-85 period.
(Refer to  Section  2,  Transportation  Control  Plans,  for
further detail.)
Estimating Water Costs
for Municipal Treatment

Municipal  water pollution control expenditures comprise the
largest  single  category   of   water   pollution    control
expenditures.   Municipal  expenditures are.divided  into six
types:
                           4-103

-------
  •   Construction of  sewage  treatment  plants  to  provide
     secondary treatment

  •   Construction of  sewage  treatment  plants  to  provide
     tertiary   treatment   more  stringent  than  secondary
     treatment (removal of  phosphorus/  ammonia,  nitrates,
     and organic pollutants)

  •   Rehabilitation of old sewers

  •   Construction of new sewers

  •   correction of overflow from combined storm and sanitary
     sewers

  •   Provision for stormwater treatment

Federal funds spent for municipal treatment are : based  upon
past   levels   of  expenditures  and  the  present  funding
authority of $19.5 billion for municipal construction grants
to states.  State-local matching  capital  expenditures  are
expected  to  be  a  third of the Federal construction grant
(i.e., Federal funds  will  comprise  about  75  percent  of
construction expenditures).  Annualized capital expenditures
are  estimated  to be $46.0 billion over the 1976-85 period.
O&M expenditures to be made by state and  local  governments
are  estimated  to  be  $16.0  billion over the same period.
Very recent estimates (see Section 2) have slightly modified
these totals.
Estimating Air and water
Abatement Costs to Government

Estimates of governmental  expenditures  for  air  pollution
were  made  by  using  Office of Management and Budget  (OMB)
estimates of Federal expenditures and by  calculating   state
and   local expenditures through extrapolation of data for 15
sample states for which estimates of the costs of the   State
Implementation Plans were available.

The   governmental  water  control  costs exclude Federal and
state and  local  government  expenditures  for   municipal
treatment     (covered    elsewhere   under   the   Municipal
Expenditures title), but they do include expenditures for:

   •   Monitoring

   •   Technical assistance

   •   Grant assistance
                            4-104

-------
  «  Research

  •  Abatement at government-owned facilities.

The total governmental expenditure'for pollution control  is
estimated  to  be  over  $12 billion during the next decade.
The expenditure for any year is never as high to one percent
of  the  total  estimated  annual  non-defense  governmental
expenditure, during the 1976-85 period.
                ESTIMATING POLLUTION CONTROL
                        COST IMPACTS
Previous  estimates  of  the cost of air and water pollution
control by EPA have been presented in separate reports,   The
Cost  of ' Clean  Air  and  The Economics of Clean water.   in
these  reports,  costs  were  computed  separately    on    an
industry-by-industry basis for air and water and then summed
to  'arrive  at  a  total  pollution control cost for  air  and
water,  respectively.   The  two  reports,  however,   often
differed  in  such  assumptions  as the growth in industrial
capacity" which would be subject to "controls and the rate   of
interest.   in  addition,  no  estimates  were  developed in
either report on  the  combined  Impact  of  air  and water
pollution  control  expenditures  on the economy in terms of
increased  construction,  equipment   purchases,   operating
materials, energy demand, and employment.

For   this  report,  a  consistent  set  of  assumptions   was
developed and entered into SEAS  for the computation of  both
air   and  water  pollution control costs.   Impacts were  t'hen
estimated  through   the   feedback   of    abatement-related
purchases  to  t"he sectors that produce and sell those goods
in the national economic  forecasting model  of  SEAS.    These
feedbacks include direct  impacts on the demand  for abatement
equipment  and  materials  from supplying  industries,  as  well
as   on  abatement-related  employment•  for  - operation   and
maintenance    activities   in •   the  Industries  making   the
expenditures.  Additional  feedbacks were  used   to  estimate
the   indirect  effects  of   abatement   costs  oh the  capital
•required to  finance construction' and equipment purchases and
on the amount  of  energy consumed.  The  estimated direct   and
indirect    impacts   resulting    from   these   feedbacks   are
presented below.
                            4-105

-------
Capital and O&M impacts

Each air pollution device and each water  pollution  control
technology  has a capital and an O&M cost associated with it
which can be treated as purchases of goods and services from
selected sectors of the economy.   For  example,  the  three
principal  air  pollution  control  devices  for  industrial
sources - electrostatic precipitators (ESP), scrubbers,  and
fabric  filters  (baghouses)  -  have  the  capital  and O&M
feedback expenditure pattern shown in Table  2.   The  table
shows  that  for  every  $100  of  capital  expenditure  for
precipitators, $48.90 goes to the New  Construction  sector,
$19.00  goes  to the Other Fabricated Metal Products sector,
$10.00 goes to the Industrial Controls sector,  $8.00  going
to  the  Cement,  Concrete, Gypsum sector, and so on down to
$0.10 goes to the Paints Sector and to the Other  Stone  and
Clay  Products  sector.   Similarly,  for every $100 in non-
labor  O&M  spent  on   precipitators,   $56.70   goes   for
maintenance,  $42.80  goes for electricity and $.50 goes for
paint materials.

when the full set of feedback matrices shown in Table 2  are
examined,  one  can  get  an  a  priori  indication of which
industries will be impacted positively (via increased sales)
as a result  of  the  pollution  control  expenditures.   It
appears  that  New  and Maintenance Construction, as well as
Electric Utilities,  will  experience  significant  positive
impacts  as  a result of investment and O&M expenditures for
air pollution control.
                           4-106

-------
                                              Table 2.
                              Feedback Relationships  for Three Common
                                 A1r Pollution Control Technologies
Sectors

New Construction
Maintenance Construction
Industrial Chemicals
Cellulosic Fibers
Nonce1lulosic Fibers
Paints
Structural Clay Products
Cement, Concrete, Gypsum
Other Stone & Clay Prod(Asbestos)
Aluminum
Plumbing & Heating Equip
Structural Metal Products
Pipes,  Valves, Fittings
Other Fabricated Metal Prod
Material Handling Machinery
Pumps,  Compressors,  Blowers
Motors and Generators
Industrial Controls
Elec Lighting and Wiring Equip
Electric Uti1ities
Water and Sewer Services
                                   Precipitators
Capital

  48.9
   O. 1

   8.O
   0. 1
   0.5
   2.9
   4.7
   1 .O
  19.0
   1 .5
   1 .8
   O.B
  10.0
   1.0
                                            Non-Labor
                                               O&M
            56.7
             O.5
                                                           Wet Scrubbers
Capital

  52.0
   0. 1
   1 .O
   1 .7
   0. 1

   5.7
   3. 1
   3.5
  12.6
   3.0
   6.7
   1.6
   4.O
   4.9
                                 Non-Labor
                                    O&M
                                    28.7
                                     O. 1
                                     0.5
                                                                                   Fi1ters
Non-Labor
Capital
49.4

1.5
3.5
0. 1
1.2
7.3
0. 1
0.3
0.7
4.8
1.3
19.2
1.2
3.5
0.9
4.0
O&M

61. S
2.0
4.O
O.5












                                                  1.O
           42.8
                                   41.5
                                   29.2
                                                           32.0

-------
To examine the feedback impacts on the key sectors listed  in
Table 2, the output of those sectors for  several  years   is
compared for the Reference Case scenarios vith abatement and
without  abatement.   As  Table  3  shows, capital feedbacks
affect industries most heavily prior to  1985,  whereas  the
O&M  feedbacks  are  strongest  in  1980  and 1985 when most
plants will be in compliance with air and water regulations.
                          Table 3.
             Percent increase in Output with Addition of
                   Abatement to the Reference Case
Sectors                   1975        1980        1985

Nev cdnstruction          14.94        6.15        1.21
Maintenance Construction   3.02        3.06        2.92
Cement, Concrete, Gypsum  12.78        3.41        0.76
Plumbing & Heating Equip  11.46        0.59        0.72
Structural Metal Products  8.01        2.94        0.91
Pipes, Valves, Fittings   21.41       16.94        2.45
Other Fabricated Metal    22.64        2.67        0.79
Pumps Compressors,Blowers  7.33        0.71       -0.11
industrial Controls       22.34        1.13        0.40
Electric Utilities         3.17        3.80        3.20
Water and Sewer Services   2.25        3.57        2.98
These estimates should be  viewed  as  projections  of  what
would  have to happen if the assumptions about the timing of
pollution control expenditures specified in Appendix  B  are
accepted.   Specific  sectors of the economic system may not
actually  be  able  to  absorb  the  amount  and  timing  of
pollution  investment  shown  to  be  necessary  to meet the
compliance schedules with the control  procedures  discussed
in Sections Two and Three.
Employment impacts

By  the  year  1985,  the  level  of employment required for
pollution control activities of the nation's industries  and
municipal  waste  treatment  facilities  is estimated at 445
thousand employees.   The  breakdown  by  pollution  control
category is as follows:
                           4-108

-------
  Total Direct Pollution             Thousands of Workers
  Control Employment (1985)                 445.2
     Air Pollution Control                   19.5
     Water Pollution Control                425.7
        Municipal                            §3.2
        Industrial                          366.5
           Machinery, Equipment, &
              Fabricated Metals             220.1
           Organic Chemicals                 30.0
           Electroplating                    20.5
           Other                             95.9
To  provide  an  insight  to the buildup of employment being
used for operation  and  maintenance  of  pollution  control
equipment,  the O&M employment levels for selected years are
listed below:
Total O&M Employment         Thousands of workers

                            1977  1980  1983  1985

Industrial Air Pollution
     Control                16.5  21.0  20.3  19.5

Industrial water Pollution
     Control               150.3 211.1 237.9 366.5

Municipal water Pollution
     Control                27.6  52.1  57.2  59.2

TOTALS                     194.4 284.2 315.4 445.2
These  levels  of  employment  are  calculated  based  on  a
detailed   methodology   for   each  specific  industry  and
associated pollution control technologies that are operating
in that year.  For  each  technology,  data  concerning  the
amount  of each O&M dollar spent includes the fraction spent
for direct labor and the mean annual gross salary  required,
permitting determination of employment levels.

Other  effects  on  employment levels exist due to pollution
control actions besides  the  direct  effects  noted  above.
These  include  employment generated by purchases related to
pollution control  construction,  equipment  and  materials,
plus  general  impacts of the induced change in final demand
and industry demand mix on the GNP and  industrial  outputs.
For  example,  it was noted earlier that the introduction of
                           4-109

-------
pollution control equipment in  the  Reference  Case  caused
outputs  of some sectors (e.g., Machinery} to increase while
dampening the outputs of others.

TO assess  the  combined  direct  and  indirect  impacts  of
pollution  control on employment, changes in employment must
be  compared  to  those   for   direct   pollution   control
employment.   Total employment at the national level in 1985
is about 245,900 persons greater for abatement than  without
abatement,  but  445,200 workers of the total with abatement
are engaged in operating and maintaining  pollution  control
equipment.   Therefore,  about 199,200 fewer workers in 1985
are producing  output  that  contributes  to  GKP  based  on
present   definitions.   This  occurs  because  the  445,200
workers  who  are  working  toward  "producing   a   cleaner
environment"   are  not  counted  as  "producing  goods  and
services" as conventionally  defined  in  national  economic
accounts.

To   compare  direct  and  indirect  employment  impacts  of
pollution control  over  time,  Table  4  below  provides  a
listing  of  the  change in employment between the Reference
Scenario (Sl> and the Reference Abatement (S2) Scenario  for
selected years.
                          Table 4.
    Employment Changes. Resulting from Pollution Controls
                  (Thousands of workers)»
year             Total          Difference        Total o&M
              Employment         S2-S1         Pollution Cntrl
              Si      S2                         Employment

1977    90,266.4      91,892.2    1,625.8            194.4

1980    96,752.0      97,199.5      447.5            284.2

1983   100,893.5     101,328.7      435.2            315.4

1985   103,113.2     103,359.1      245.1            445.2

»S1 = Reference Scenario; S2 = Reference Abatement Scenario.
This  table  can  be  interpreted as follows: The difference
between the two  scenarios  reflects  the  change  in  total
                           4-110

-------
employment  due  to  the  impact of pollution control on the
general economy.  A comparison of these figures  with  those
shown in the last column indicates that the employment gains
directly  associated  with  pollution  control  dominate  or
exceed the more indirect employment  effects  in  the  later
years.   However,  pollution  control  capital  expenditures
stimulating  indirect  employment  are  the  primary  factor
causing increased total employment up to 1980.
Energy  impacts

The   direct  and   indirect   impacts   of   the   air   and  water
pollution  controls  on   energy   use   can   be   determined   by
comparing  the national energy consumption; (in  Btu's)  in 1985
in   the Reference  Abatement Scenario (when controls are  in
place)  with  the energy consumption in 1985 for the Reference
Scenario (with  approximately   the   same   1985  GNP  but   no
incremental  abatement controls  past  1971). This comparison,
presented  by  consumer  class in Table 5, reveals  that  total
consumption   increased   by   4.13 percent  with   increased
abatement  controls.   Almost half of tMs increase comes  in
the  use of energy by  electric utilities,  which shows  a net
increase of  5.40  percent.

Among  industrial energy users  in 1985, industrial Chemicals
accounted for the largest portion of  the  net  increase  of
3.57  percent.    Other   large   increases  in  energy use were
 registered  by  Steel,   Aluminum,  and  Petroleum.   Several
 industries    increased     their   electricity   consumption
 dramatically when pollution abatement  was  adopted  by  all
 industries.      For   example,    chemicals   increased   its
 electricity consumption by 89 perent,  Phosphate  Fertilizer
 by   71 percent,  Aluminum by 31 percent,  Steel by 19 percent,
 and  Plastics by 19 percent.
                             4-111

-------
                          Table 5
        increase in Energy consumption with Addition
             of Abatement to the Reference Case
  consumer       1985 Energy use*        Percent Change
    Class      (Trillions of Btu'sO      (S2-SD/S1 x 100
                 SI            S2

industrial      26,058.8    26,989.9           3.57

Transportation  24,635.8    25,669.6           4.20

Commercial       7,425.1     7,411.6          -0.19

Residential      9,779.5    10,108.3           3.36

Electric
  Utilities     41,110.2    43,328.7           5.40

TOTALS         109,009.3   113,507.4           4.13

      Reference Scenario,- S2 = Reference Abatement Scenario.
Ranking of Sectors by
Degree of Economic Change

A final measure of pollution control  cost  impacts  is  the
relative effects among economic sectors.  Economic data used
to   assess  these  impacts  include  outputs,  construction
expenditures, capital investments, and personal  consumption
expenditures.   changes in these data for various sectors in
going from the Reference Scenario to the Reference Abatement
Scenario are given in Table 6  for  the  forecast  years  of
1977, 1980, 1983, and 1985.

in   Table   6(A>,  the  10  industries  with  the  greatest
percentage increase in output when comparing  the  Reference
Abatement Scenario to the Reference Scenario are given.  The
different  impacts  of  capital investment and OfiM purchases
for pollution control during the four years can be noted  in
the  rankings  and the percentage changes.  For example, the
timing requirements for capital expenditures  for  pollution
control  equipment  are  evidenced  by  the New Construction
sector being stimulated by 13.0 percent  in  1977  and  then
dropping  to  6.2  percent in 1980, 3.3 percent in 1983, and
                           4-112

-------
1.2 percent in 1985.  A contrasting pattern is provided by a
major O&M materials supplier,  Industrial  Chemicals.   This
sector  is  ranked eighth in 1977 (9.9 percent) but rises to
third in 1980 (9.5 percentV, second in 1983   (9.4  percent),
and  first  in 1985 (10.2 percent).  Sectors  associated with
the extraction of energy  ores  and  sales  of  energy  show
trends  similar  to  Industrial  Chemicals.   Similarly, the
peaking and dropoff  in  ranking  of  equipment  fabrication
sectors  is  consistent  with  the  Hew  construction sector
pattern.  For example, note the values and ranks for  Pipes,
Valves  and .Fittings,  Special  industrial   Machinery,  and
Electric Lighting and Wiring Equipment.

The converse of positive  output  impacts  are  provided  in
Table  6(B),  which  shows  the six industries suffering the
greatest percentage decrease in outputs  for each year.   The
general  categories  impacted  are  mass  transit  equipment,
minor transportation equipment, and personal  clothing items.
The level of impact for these  sectors  is much less than  the
level  of impact  for stimulated industries.   During the  late
1970's, the greatest negative  impact  is  only one-third  of
the   tenth greatest positive impact.   For  1983,  the level of
negative impacts  for the  six industries  is much  higher   than
the   level found  in 1977  and 1980; yet even  then  the largest
negatively impacted industry is  impacted slightly  less   than
the tenth  largest positively impacted industry.

Turning  to  pollution  control cost  impacts  on construction,
Table 6(C) provides a ranking  of  the  construction  industries
that  are most  stimulated  or depressed for   the  four  years.
The   sector  of  Water  Systems   Construction is high-ranked
throughout  the period.  The increased demand for  energy  to
meet    pollution   control  standards  is  reflected  in  the
 increasing    demand   for   Gas    Utilities   and   Pipeline
Construction  and  Electric Utility Construction 'through 1985.
 The   early  combined   demand for air pollution and water BPT
pollution   controls  cause  Industrial  Construction  to  be
ranked  third   in 1977.  However, later  output decreases for
 some  industries cause  Industrial  Construction to show  minor
 declines  from 1980 on.  In addition, Telephone Construction
 is somewhat depressed  in  1980 and 1983.

 To  examine  the  positive  stimulus  on  capital  equipment
 investment,   Table 6(D) shows those industries with greatest
 percentage increases for capital investment.   The  highest-
 ranked  industries for each year are usually industries that
 would provide  equipment  and/or  maintenance  products  for
 pollution  control,   Therefore, for each of the  four years,
 equipment industries appear in the top four: Motor  Vehicles
 and Parts, and Hardware & Platings.
                            4-113

-------
 Finally,  Tables  6(E)  and  6(F) provide the major impacted
 sectors  in  terms  of   percentage   change   in   personal
 consumption   expenditures  (PCE).   Table  6
-------
                                      Table 6.
          Sectors Ranked by Greatest Percent Change in Economic Variables
            Between Reference Abatement Scenario and Reference Scenario
-1977
                     A. Greatest Percentage Increase In Output

                                 198O
                                                                  1983
1985
Pipes, Valves,
F i 1 1 1 ngs 19.3
Special Industrial
Machinery 15,3
l
i- Structural Clay
^ Products 13.7
New Construction 13.0
Other Fabricated
Metal Products 12.5
Cement , Concrete
Gypsum 12.1
Industrial Controls 11.9
Industrial Chemicals 9.9
Elec. Lighting
and Wiring 9. 1
Lumber and Wood
Products 7 .9
Pipes, Valves, Pipes, Valves,
Fittings 16.9 Fittings
Special Industrial Industrial
Machinery 12.1 Chemicals
Industrial Crude Petroleum
Chemicals 9.5 Natural Gas
Crude Petroleum Special Industrial
Natural Gas 6.5 Machinery
New Construction
Chemical Fert.
Mining
Auto Repair
Elec. Lighting
and Wiring
Natural Gas
Pipel ines
6.2 Auto Repair
5.6 Natural Gas
Chemical Fert.
5.6 Mining
5.5 Pipelines
Complete Guided
5.2 Missiles
Misc. Chemical
5 . 1 Products
Industrial
11.0 Chemicals
Crude Petrol eun
9.4 Natural Gas
7.3 Natural Gas
6.8 Auto Repair
Chemical Fert.
6.6 M i n 1 ng
6.1 Pipelines
Complete Guided
5.7 Missiles
5 . 7 Lead
Petroleum
4.6 Refining
Misc. Chemical
4.2 Products
                                                                                                            10.2
                                                                                                            8.O
                                                                                                            7.5
                                                                                                            7. 1
                                                                                                            6.3
                                                                                                            6.2
                                                                                                            4.4
                                                                                                            4,2
                                                                                                            4. 1
                                                                                                           4.0

-------
                                        Table 6.  (Continued)
                  Sectors Ranked by Greatest Percent Change 1n Economic Variables
                    Between Reference Abatement  Scenario and Reference Scenario
        1977
   B.  Greatest Percentage Decrease 1n Output (Continued)

                     1980                             1983
                                                                                                       1985
Cycles, Minor Trans.
Equ1pment              -1.0

Buses and Local
Transit                -0.8
Apparel                -O.8
Footwear               -O.7

Leather and Ind.
Leather Products       -O,4
Knitting               -O.4
              Construction, Mining
              Oil Field Machinery  -2.6
              Buses and Local
              Transit
                                                        -2.5
               Railroad  Equipment   -2.5

               Cycles, Minor Trans.
               Equipment           -2.1
               Apparel

               Uewelry  and
               Silverware
                                 -2.1
                                    -1.8
                                            Construction, Mining,
                                            Oil Field Machinery  -3.9

                                            Buses and Local
                                            Transit              -3.4

                                            Machine Tools,
                                            Metal Forming        -2.9
                                      Railroad Equipment   -2.3.

                                      Machine Tools,
                                      Me.tal Cutting        -1.8

                                      Cycles, Minor
                                      Trans, Equipment     -1.6
                                                                    Buses and Local
                                                                    Transit          -3.6

                                                                    Constr.,  Mining
                                                                    Oil Field Mach.   -3.4
                                      Apparel          -2.1

                                      Machine Tools,
                                      Metal Forming    -2.0

                                      Cycles, Minor
                                      Trans. Equip.     -1.6
                                                                              Footwear          -1.6
Sewer Systems


Water Systems

Gas Utilities and
P i pe 1 i nes

Industrial

Electric Utilities


Telephone
170.1


107. S


  9.2

  3.1

  2.7


  1.2
C. Greatest Percentage Changes in Construction Sectors

      Water Systems        58.5     Water Systems
      Sewer Systems

      Gas Utilities and
      Pipelines
                     39.1
Hotels, Motels, and
Dormitories           -0.1
                      6.2.

Electric Utilities    3.4

Te1ephone            -1.7

Stores, Restaurants,
and Garages


Industrial
Gas UtilIties and
Pipelines
Electric Utilities

Telephone

Industrial
23.6


 5.2


 2.9

-1.O

-2.1
Water Systems        17.O

Gas Utilities and
Pipelines             6.8
Electric Utilities     3.0

Industrial            -O.9

-------
                                                 Table 6,  (Continued)
                            Sectors Ranked by Greatest Percent Change In Economic Variables
                              Between Reference Abatement Scenario and Reference Scenario
                                       1977
                                                     198O
                                                                   1983
                                                                                1985
                                 D. Greatest Percentage Increase in Capital Investment
it*
i
          Hardware, Plating   161.5
          Engineering and
          Scientific Instru.

          Motor Vehicles and
          Parts

          Industrial
          Chemicals
          Trucking Services

          Auto Repair

          Petroleum Refining

          Natural Gas
 76.0
 71.8
                               66. 1
Hardware, Plating   129.5

Motor Vehicles and
Parts               114.3

Engineering and
Scientific Instru.  106.5
                                       Engineering and
                                       Scientific Instru.
         Canned and Frozen
         Foods                53.8
                                                                                          85.0
Hardware, Plating    83.1

Motor Vehicles and
Parts                58.1

Canned and Frozen
Foods                37.7
E. Greatest Percentage Increase in

 33.7    Trucking Services    46.6

  9.8    Auto Repair           9.1

  5.2    Petroleum Refining    5.3

  3.8    Natural  Gas           4.4
                          PCE (all  sectors >  1.OX)

                              Trucking Services     56.3

                              Auto  Repair           11.O

                              Petroleum Refining    6.4

                              Natural  Gas           5.O
                              Hardware, Plating    29.1

                              Motor Vehicles and
                              Parts                17.7
                                                                     Industrial
                                                                     Chemicals
                                                                                          14.3
                                                            Canned and Frozen
                                                            Foods                 13.4
                              Trucking Services    61.8

                              Auto Repair          12.O

                              Petroleum Refining    7.0

                              Natural  Gas           5.3

-------
                                               Table 6.   (Continued)
                          Sectors Ranked by Greatest Percent Change in Economic  Variables
                            Between Reference Abatement  Scenario and  Reference Scenario
                                     1977
                                                   1980
                                       1983
                                         1985
oo
        Rat 1 roads


        Buses & Local Trans. -2.7
F. Greatest Percentage Decrease in PCE (PCE for sector > 10OM$)

   -2.8    Buses & Local Trans. -4.6     Buses & Local Trans.  -5.9
           Non-Contpet 111 ve
           Imports
                     -3.1
Cycles, Minor Trans.
Equipment            -2.5
        Pottery
   -1.8
        Cycles, Minor Trans.
        Equipment            -1 .a
Pottery              -3.1

Cycles, Minor Trans.
        Glass
                             -1.0
           Equ1pment

           Apparel
                     -2.4

                     -2.1
Pottery


Footwear

Air!ines
-2.2


-1 .9

-1 .8
                                                            Buses & Local  Trans. -6.0
         Pottery
                     -2.6
Cycles, Minor Trans.
Equipment             -2.5
Apparel

Footwear
-2.2

-2.1

-------
                THE DYNAMIC NATURE OF TOTAL
               POLLUTION CONTROL  EXPENDITURES
Earlier in this analysis,  the  costs to control  air  and water
pollution were stated  in  terms of dollars  expended  over  a
relatively  short   time   period,   1976-1985.  The  amount and
timing  of  expenditures   during   the  next  10   years   is
important,  but the impression should not be left  that total
expenditures  decline radically  after  the  first   round  of
investments in pollution  equipment.

Figure  1  shows investment and total annual costs (annualized
capital plus  O&M)  for air and water pollution control in the
Reference Abatement  Scenario.   Although  the year-by-year
expenditures  are  assumptions,  the  general  trends  of  the
lines   are  reasonable  estimates of expenditures, given the
overall assumptions of the Reference Abatement Scenario.

Table  7  shows  the  annual   capital  and  O&M  expenditures
required  of  the  industrial sector  from  1972-1985.  Note  that
in   the   case  of  air  investment  expenditures,  Electric
Utilities and other industrial sources  demonstrate a peaking
of capital  expenditures during the  1973-78  period with  very
 small   annual increments to investment  expenditures by 1985.
 The total annual costs for stationary sources  also grow  and
 then  level  off   after   1980.    No  such  leveling  off  is
 witnessed for water pollution total  annual  costs,  but  this
 might  occur  just a  few  years beyond 1985  since effluent
 regulations  after  1983  may require   lower   increases  in
 pollution costs after 1985.
                             4-319

-------
          Air
                         Table  7.
                  industrial Sector Annual
              pollution Control Expenditures
                  (Billions 1975 Dollars)»
Water
                                              Total

Year
1972
1973
1974
1975
1976
1977
1978
1979
1980
1981
1982
1983
1984
1985
Annual.
Capital
0.5
1.3
2.5
3.6
4.0
4.7
5.5
5.9
6.1
6.3
6.5
6.5
6.6
6.7

O&M
0.4
1.0
1.8
2.8
3.5
4.1
4.6
5.0
5.2
5.3
5.3
5.3
5.3
5.3
Annual .
Capital
—
-
0.7
1.6
2.1
3.0
3.6
4.4
5.4
6.3
7.2
7.9
8.0
8.2

O&M
_
_
1.2
2.7
3.6
4.8
5.9
6.4
6.9
7.3
7.5
7.9
11.1
11.5
Annual .
Capital
0.5
1.3
3.2
5.2
6.1
7.7
9.1
10.3
11.5
12.6
13.6
14.4
14.7
14.9

O&M
0.4
1.0
3.0
5.5
7.1
8.9
10.4
11.4
12.1
12.6
12.9
13.2
16.4
16.8
Parts may  not  sum  to total  because of rounding.
                        4-120

-------
                  Figure 1.
Annual investments and Total Annual Costs for
  Air and Water Pollution Control,  1976-1985
                       4-121

-------
Considering  o&M  expenditures alone, these expenditures for
industries are approximately $16.8 billion by 1985  for  air
and  water  pollution control combined (see Table 7).  Water
O&M expenditures make up the largest part of this total,  69
percent.   The  industrial  sectors making the largest water
pollution control O&M expenditures in 1985 are:
                       O&M Expenses
                       (Billion 1975$)
               Percent of Total
               Industrial Water
                     O&M
  Machinery and
     Equipment              6.45
  Chemicalsfertilizers
     and Plastics           1.83
  Food Processing           0.77
  Ferrous Metals            0.68
  Pulp and Paper            0.61
                   55.9

                   15.8
                    6.7
                    5.9
                    5.3
A  great  part  of  these  water   pollution   control   o&M
expenditures  go  for  labor expenses.  This is not true for
air pollution control O&M expenditures however, as shown   in
Table 8.
                          Table 8.
            1985 O&M Expenditures and Direct Labor
                Requirements  for Pollution
                   Control by Industries
 Water Pollution  Control

 Air Pollution Control
O&M
(Billions
1975$)

   11.5

    5.3
Direct
Labor
(1,000's)

   389

    20
Employees
Million $

   33.83

    3.77
 Based  on these figures,  the  average  water  pollution  control
 O&M expenditures in 1985  are  stimulating  direct  employment
 of  33,830  jobs  per  billion  dollars  of  water pollution
 control O&M expenditure.   At  the same time, the average  air
 pollution  control  O&M expenditures  are creating  3,770 jobs
                            4-122

-------
per  billion  aollars   of   air   pollution   control   O&M
expenditures.  These figures give some idea of the potential
employment  impacts of O&M expenditures, which will continue
beyond 1985.
                             4-123

-------
Appendix A
The SEAS System
SEAS is a  system   of   interdependent  models  and   computer
programs  developed by EPA to assess the future economic and
environmental   consequences  of  Federal  pollution  control
policies.    Structurally,  the system consists of a number of
special-purpose models  linked   to   the   University   of
Maryland's   INFORUM,  an interindustry input-output  model of
the economy.   The  INFORUM model develops economic forecasts
through   1985   based  on alternative sets of demographic and
macroeconomic  assumptions specified by the user.  in  turn,
these  forecasts  form the basic economic inputs used  by the
other models in SEAS   to  develop  their  more  specialized
forecasts.

A  generalized  overview  of the SEAS system is presented in
Figure A-l.  AS indicated  by  the  dashed-lined box,  two
special-purpose SEAS   models  have  been  integrated  into a
common program with INFORUM: INSIDE, which provides  greater
detail    on  industrial  sector  output,  and  ABATE,  which
contains   cost   functions   for   abatement   technologies.
Together,   these  three  models  form  the national  economic
forecasting  program for the SEAS system.   This  program  is
fed   by   two data  bases: one contains economic and pollution
abatement costs data;  the other, data on commodity   relative
prices.    A   feedback  loop  between  the  national  economic
program   and  the   PRICES  model   allows   relative  price
adjustments   to be reflected in the SEAS economic forecasts.
The   final   output  file,  containing  annual  economic  and
abatement  cost  forecasts through 1985, provides input data
for  six  other  special-purpose  SEAS models:

   *   RESGEN  -  Estimates  the   annual  tonnage  of pollutant
      residuals from various industrial sources.

   •   PTRANS   -  Estimates   the   passenger   transportation
      activity  levels and residuals.

   •   FTRANS  - Estimates the freight transportation   activity
      levels  and residuals.

   •   ENERGY - Develops forecasts of  energy  consumption  by
      consumer class and fuel category.

   •   STOCKS  -  Provides   information  on  the   price  and
      availability of  critical  virgin stocks.

   •   SOLRECYC - Estimates  the  annual tonnage of solid  waste
      and recycled materials.
                             A-l

-------
Appendix A
The SEAS System
SEAS is a  system  of  interdependent  models  and  computer
programs  developed by EPA to assess the future economic and
environmental  consequences  of  Federal  pollution  control
policies.   Structurally, the system consists of a number of
special-purpose  models  linked   to   the   University   of
Maryland's  INFORUM,  an interindustry input-output model of
the economy.  The INFORUM model develops economic  forecasts
through  1985  based  on alternative sets of demographic and
macroeconomic assumptions specified by the user.   m  turn
these  forecasts  form the basic economic inputs used by the
other models in  SEAS  to  develop  their  more  specialized
forecasts.

A  generalized  overview  of the SEAS system is presented  in
Figure A-l.  As  indicated  by  the  da&hed-lined  box,  two
special-purpose  SEAS  models  have  been  integrated into a
common program with  INFORUM: INSIDE, which provides  greater
detail   on  industrial  sector  output,  and  ABATE,  which
contains   cost   functions   for   abatement   technologies.
Together,  these  three  models  form  the national economic
forecasting program  for the SEAS system.   This  program   is
fed   by  two data bases: one contains economic and pollution
abatement  costs data;  the other, data on commodity  relative
prices.    A  feedback   loop  between  the  national economic
program  and  the  PRICES  model   allows   relative   price
adjustments  to be reflected in the SEAS economic  forecasts.
The   final output   file,  containing  annual  economic   and
abatement  cost  forecasts through 1985, provides  input data
for  six  other special-purpose  SEAS models:

   •   RESGEN - Estimates   the   annual  tonnage  of  pollutant
      residuals  from  various  industrial sources.

   •   PTRANS  -  Estimates    the   passenger    transportation
      activity  levels and  residuals.

   •   FTRANS  - Estimates  the  freight  transportation activity
      levels  and  residuals.

   •   ENERGY  - Develops forecasts  of   energy   consumption   by
      consumer  class  and fuel  category.

   •   STOCKS   -   Provides   information  on   the   price    and
      availability of critical  virgin  stocks.

   •  SOLRECYC - Estimates the  annual  tonnage  of  solid   waste
      and recycled  materials.
                             A-l

-------
Summary  output   from   these   six  models,  as  well  as the
national  economic program,  is  then  collected  in  a  common
file for  the  production of  summary reports.
                          A-2

-------
              Figure A-l.
Generalized Flowchart for the Strategic
 Environmental Assessment System (SEAS}
      
-------
A  description  of  the major functions performed by each of
the SEAS models shown in  Figure  A-l  is  presented  below.
This discussion of SEAS models emphasizes the computation of
abatement costs and their associated economic feedbacks as a
subsystem of the overall model structure.
                 THE INTERINDUSTRY ECONOMIC
                 FORECASTING MODEL(INFORUM)
The  INFORUM  model is a 185-sector input-output model which
projects   future   economic   activity   using   structural
relationships  between  economic  and demographic variables.
These projections determine total demands for the outputs of
185 industrial sectors, and the model then  allocates  these
demands to the specific markets, or buying sectors, to which
these  products  are  sold.   Thus, the model differentiates
between   intermediate   demands    and    final    demands.
Intermediate   demands  are  generated  by  sales  from  one
industry  to  other  producing  industries.   Final  demands
consist   of   government   expenditures,  exports,  imports
(expressed as negative  exports),  purchases  by  consumers,
changes  in  inventories, and savings and investment.  These
final demand components make up what is commonly referred to
as the Gross National Product (GNP).

Figure A-2 displays a flow diagram  of  the  INFORUM  model.
The column of boxes on the far left of the diagram represent
factors which are specified outside the model.  The solution
procedure used is as detailed below.

A  trial value of disposable income is coupled with a set of
relative prices, allowing personal consumption  expenditures
to   be   calculated.   These  results,  combined  with  the
projections of households and interest rates,  are  used  to
determine  expenditures  for  certain types of construction.
Sales to construction investment by each industry  are  then
determined  by  applying  the  C-matrix  coefficients.  In a
similar manner, the sales by each industry to the government
categories are determined by setting assumptions  concerning
government  policy  and  defense planning into the G-matrix.
Outputs of previous  years  and  assumptions  regarding  the
costs of capital are used to forecast investment in producer
durable   equipment   and   industry-related   construction.
investment by industry is then determined by  running  these
forecasts  through  the  C-  and B-matrices.  This completes
determination of total final demands.
                            A-4

-------
The A-matrix of coefficients serves to convert  total  final
demands  to  total product outputs by individual industries.
Net imports and inventory  changes  for  each  industry  are
computed  simultaneously.   Labor  productivities  are  then
derived from  changes  in  output  and  capital  investment.
Employment  is determined by dividing the product outputs by
labor productivity,  if this result,  when  subtracted  from
labor  force  projections,  yields  a  level of unemployment
inconsistent with the specified input to  the  model   (i.e.,
less  than  4  percent),  the disposable income assumption is
modified  and  calculations  begin  anew.   otherwise,   the
outputs generated by the  model, coupled with the projections
of   factors  outside  the model,  are applied to forecast the
next year's economic activity.

For  most  scenarios  run  for  this report, official   government
forecasts  of  productivity and   unemployment  were used  in
place  of  those estimated by the  IKFORUM model   arid  supplied
by  the   university of Maryland.  These  higher productivity
 forecasts of  the Bureau of   Labor  Statistics   were  entered
 into  INFORUM  exogenously.   Personal disposable  income was
 then adjusted as necessary in   each  scenario  to   calibrate
 unemployment  to government forecasts.  For these  scenarios,
 INFORUM.was thus  used  to  compute  the  redistribution  of
 intermediate sales among industrial sectors required to meet
 the government projections.
                              A-5

-------
                        Figure  A-2.
Flow Diagram  of  the inforinn Model  with Solution Procedure
                          A-6

-------
                 THE SECTOR DISAGGREGATION
                       MODEL (INSIDE)
The  INSIDE  model  performs two important functions: (1) it
projects subindustry outputs at the level of detail required
for environmental assessment; and (2) it  forecasts  changes
in  industrial  growth  due  to  technological substitution.
INFORUM is an  economic  forecasting  model  which  was  not
specifically  designed to deal with environmental issues and
detail.  Hence, the different goods  and  services  produced
within  any  single  INFORUM  sector  may have significantly
different   pollution   or   demand   levels.     Similarly,
alternative  processes  may be available within a sector for
producing the same material or product.

Special equations, termed side equations, are introduced  by
the    INSIDE   model   to   enable   SEAS   to  account  for
environmentally-important  product  and  process  technology
details   not   available   directly  from  INFORUM.   These
equations disaggregate the annual sector outputs in  dollars
from INFORUM into annual outputs in physical units at a more.
detailed  subsector  level.   For example, there are several
hundred major chemicals embedded within  INFORUM  Sector  55,
which   projects   economic   activity   for  all  industrial
chemicals.   However,  the  manufacture   of   nitric   acid
generates   the  vast  majority  of  nitrogen oxide emissions
produced by this  industry.  About 80 percent of  the  nitric
acid   manufactured   is sold to  fertilizers and miscellaneous
chemicals,  whereas Sector  55  sells  over  50  percent  of  its
general  output  to plastics,  non-cellulosic  fibers,  cleaning
and  toilet preparations,  miscellaneous   chemicals,   and
paints.   As   a   result the  growth  rate  of nitric  acid  alone
does not parallel the aggregate growth   of  all   industrial
chemicals   in  Sector  55.    Thus,   relating   nitrogen  oxide
residual generation  to nitric acid  demand  in   other   sectors
rather  than   to the  aggregate growth  of  Sector  55 gives  a
more accurate  projection  of   nitrogen   oxide   emissions  and
control  costs.

Technological  substitutions  in SEAS are  treated  in INSIDE by
substitutions    occurring  among   two   to  four   alternative
materials,  processes,  or  products  within a  given  industry.
Examples  of   two-,   three-,   and  four-way substitutions are
presented  belows
                             A-7

-------
                         Table A-l.
       Example of Technological substitutions  in SEAS
Type of                               Alternative
Substitution     Commodity            Processes

2_way            Chlorine             <1>  Mercury Cell
                                      (2V  Diaphragm Cell

3-way            Steel                (i>  Electric Arc
                                      (2)  Basic Oxygen
                                      (3)  Open Hearth

4-way            Non-Nucleair          d)  Coal
                 Electric utilities   (2)  Oil
                                      (3)  Gas
                                      (4)  Other
The user specifies the substitution ratio for each material,
product, or process as the fraction of a commodity  produced
by each alternative process.  The rate of substitution based
upon these initial fractions is also determined through user
inputs.   Thus,  the  INSIDE, side equations can reflect the
growth of  the  diaphragm  cell  manufacturing  process  for
chlorine  at the expense of the market share for the mercury
cell process.
              THE ABATEMENT COST AND FEEDBACK
                       MODEL (ABATE)
The ABATE model  estimates  the  investment  costs  and  the
operation  and  maintenance  (O&M) costs associated with the
control of air  and  water  pollution  for  all  significant
polluting  industries.  It also provides feedback concerning
the consequent increases in capital investments,  employment
requirements,  consumption  levels,  and economic demands to
INFORUM.   The  INFORUM  model  then  uses  this   data   to
dynamically rebalance its forecasts of economic activity and
produce revised estimates of such macrostatistics as GNP and
unemployment,  as  well  as relative shifts in interindustry
demands and outputs.

The input data required by  the  ABATE  model  was  compiled
through  research into the technological control options and
                            A-8

-------
their associated costs to meet environmental standards.  The
data used in the model corresponds directly to the industry-
by-industry descriptions  of  abatement  activity  given  in
Sections  Two  and  Three  of this report.  Some of the more
important data inputs are discussed below:

  1. All Categories Except Municipal  Wastewater  Treatment.
The  following  data  was  developed  for input to the ABATE
model  for  all  cost  categories   other   than   municipal
wastewater treatment:

  a. An inventory of plants, including size distribution  of
     the  total capacity of the industry category for a base
     year,  was  developed  using   the   best   information
     available  from one or more of the following sources:

     •  Researcher files
     •  Trade associations
     •  Professional societies
     •  Directories of plants
     •  Periodic publications
     •  Government research documents.

   b. Capital  cost  functions  and  O&M cost   functions  were
     specified   for  each  standard   (State   Implementation
     Plans,   Best  Practicable  Technology,   Best   Available
     Technology,   and/or  New Source  Performance  Standards).
     These  functions  relate cost  to the  physical  measure   of
     plant   capacity   used  in  the   plant   inventory.    For
     industry  categories   involved    in   water    pollution
     abatement, cost   functions  were developed for both  the
      full  in-plant treatment  and  pretreatment options.

   c. For  each industry category,  capital and  O&M  costs   were
      allocated   as  purchases   from   INFORUM  sectors on  the
      basis  of the  technology  option(s) associated  with  the
      category.

   d.  The average life  of   the   abatement  equipment  and  a
      nominal  interest rate of  10 percent were specified for
      each industry category to enable the model to calculate
      annualized capital costs.

   e. Compliance years for each standard which applies to. the
      industry category and also the year after which all new
      plant  construction  starts  must   meet   New   Source
      Performance Standards were specified.

   f. The number of years over which capital expenditures for
      each  standard  are  expected  to  be  spread  and  the
                             A-9

-------
      fractions   of  expenditures  for  each of  these years were
      specified.

  g.  For industry categories   involved   in   water  pollution
      abatement,  the percent of  total capacity  in each plant
      capacity  class  for  each   industry which   discharges
      pretreated   wastewater   to   municipal   system   was
      specified.

  h.  Annual investments and OSM  costs for the control  of air
      emissions from mobile sources   and   electric  utilities
      were  entered  into  the  ABATE model  exogenously for
      computation  of  feedback   effects   and aggregate  air
      pollution abatement costs.

  i.  Pollution  control   costs   reflect   only    abatement
      equipment  and  O&M  expenditures in these simulations.
      Therefore, if a less polluting  production   process is
      adopted by an industry, a decrease  in pollution control
      costs results.

  2.  Municipal Wastewater  Treatment  Data.   The   following
data  were  developed  as  inputs  to  ABATE for  municipal
wastewater treatment (Municipal expenditures for  this report
were  exogeneously expressed based  on  projected  Government
appropriations  for  sewage treatment facilities.  The ABATE
model was thus not used to calculate  municipal  costs,  but
the   feedback  features  of  SEAS  were used to estimate the
economic, employment,  and energy impacts of  these costs.):

  &.  Population served and per capita  wastewater  flow  for
      each forecast year;

  b. Capital  and  O&M  cost  functions   for   primary   and
     secondary   treatment   and    the  cost  functions  for
     upgrading of secondary treatment;

  c. Percent of wastevater flow to each  treatment  type  and
     the average  treatment plant  size in each type;

  d. Percent of total  population  whose wastewater needs  are
     net  either   by replacement  of  previous treatment or by
     upgrading from  primary to secondary or   from  secondary
     to tertiary, by year-

  e. A similar collection of  factors, percentages   and  cost
     curves   for   interceptor   sewer  costs,  and  for combined
     sewer overflow  remedy  costs; and
    I
  f. The wastewater  flow generated by industies  which  divert
     their wastewater  to municipal facilities for  treatment.
                          A-10

-------
The ABATE cost model uses the two types  of  data  discussed
above  to  generate  aggregated  abatement  costs  for  each
industry  and  for  municipal  treatment  facilities  in   a
straightforward manner, as follows:

  1. Industrial Abatement Costs.  The model forecasts yearly
capacity for each industry  using  growth  rates   calculated
from  the  corresponding  INFORUM  sector  or   subsector and
initial plant capacity class  data.   The  new  capacity   is
distributed  among  the industry's plant capacity  classes  as
specified by the user.  Capital  costs   are  then   calculated
for the average plant in each plant  capacity class using the
appropriate cost function  (depending on the year and  whether
the  plant must meet New Source  Performance Standards).  The
model then sums costs across classes to get   total   capital
costs for the year.  For water  categories,  the model  derives
the  costs  using ,  both  the pretreatment  and  full treatment
cost functions, depending  on the  fraction of  capacity  in
each plant  size class  using municipal  facilities.  For  these
water   categories,  ABATE also  calculates  the  total volume  of
wastewater  discharged  to municipal facilities, which is used
to estimate  investment  recovery and  user  charges.    Finally,
the model  uses  equipment  life  and a 10 percent interest rate
to annualize  the  capital  costs.

ABATE   performs  a  similar  aggregation  of   O&M  costs for
 industries.   However,  for  existing plants, the  expenditures
do   not   begin  until  the  compliance  year  is  reached.
 Moreover,  the model need not keep track of O&M  expenditures
 spread  over  several years as it must do for capital costs.
 The O&M costs calculated by ABATE for  a given year create  a
 demand  for  resources  that  is reflected through feedbacks
 which modify the output  levels  for   the  affected  INFORUM
 sectors.   in  turn,  these  changed output levels result in
 different sector growth  rates,  from  which   the abatement
 costs are recalculated for that year.  ABATE  and  INFORUM  are
 self-correcting   as   they   use   growth  rates  which   are
 constantly being revised.

   2. Municipal Abatement Costs.  The   municipal   portion  of
 ABATE   calculates   costs   associated   with  building   and
 upgrading treatment  plants,   with  laying   interceptor   and
 collector  sewer  lines., and with  the  control  of the  combined
 sewer  overflow problem.   The   new  wastewater  flow needing
 treatment  in  any  year   is   based on incremental  flow from
 industrial dischargers to municipal systems  and that part of
 the non-indus.trial  flow that  needs  replacement or upgrading.
 This new  flow   is  allocated   to  treatment   type  (primary,
 secondary,   or   tertiary).    Average  plant sizes  by type  are
 then  used  to determine  the   number  of   new  plants  to  be
 constructed.    Capital    and   operating  cost  (minus  the
                             A-ll

-------
 operating cost of plants replaced)  functions  are  used  to
 determine  total  cost based on plants to be constructed and
 their average, size.  The amount of this cost to be fed  back
 into   INFORUM   is  adjusted  by  a  user-specified  factor
 indicating  the  proportion  of  this  total   not   already
 accounted  for in the INFORUM baseline.  A similar procedure
 is used to determine costs for interceptors and  collectors,
 and for correction of combined sewer overflow through use of
 incremental cost functions for these categories.

 Annualized  costs  for  municipal  wastewater  treatment are
 partially allocated back to an industrial source based  upon
 the  fraction of total wastewater flow it contributes.  This
 fraction is applied against the O&M  charges  for  municipal
 treatment  to  yield  user  charges.   Municipal  investment
 recovery is computed by applying this  fraction  to  capital
 costs,;  with payment in equal annual installments over a 30-
 year period  with  no  interest  applied.   Calculations  of
 abatement expenditures for sewers and for the combined sewer
 overflow  (eso)   problem  is  similar except that population
 needing  sewers   is  distributed  among  city   sizes,   and
 population  needing  CSO  correction  is   distributed   among
 population  groups.    Hence,  ABATE  aggregate   costs   are
 computed  by  city  size  and  by population group to  obtain
 total   expenditures  for  correcting  the  sewer   and  'CSO
 problems,  respectively.

 For  the  pollution  abatement scenarios run for this report,
 annual  investments  in municipal  sewage  treatment   facilities
 were exogenousl-y  specified,   based on  the total  projected
 funds available  from Federal,  state,  and  local   governments.
 The computations  of  annualized municipal  treatment  costs and
 user, charges  were   thus  constrained by  anticipated funding
 limitations.
                   THE RELATIVE COMMODITY
                    PRICE MODEL (PRICES)
The SEAS PRICES model, also adopted from the  University  of
Maryland,  provides  INFORUM with relative indexes of prices
among commodities.  Two runs of INFORUM  for  each  scenario
are required to make use of the PRICES model.  The first run
of  INFORUM  produces  a  different  distribution  of inter-
industry sales than that assumed in  creating  the  original
set  of  price  indexes.   The  PRICES  model is then run to
generate a modified set of relative prices  to  be  used  by
INFORUM.   The  model  modifies  prices  of output from each
sector based on time-lagged constant-price  output  for  the
                           A-12

-------
sector,  lagged  unit  material costs, and lagged unit labor
costs.   Abatement impacts on  prices  are  included'  in  the
modifications as well as the impact of the redistribution-of
sales.   Once the modified prices are determined, the INFORUM
model is then rerun to provide a new forecast of the economy
which takes into account the modified prices.
                THE INDUSTRIAL ENVIRONMENTAL
                  RESIDUALS MODEL  {RESGEN)
RESGEN  estimates   the   annual   national  pollutant  residuals
associated  with  industrial  production,  municipal  treatment,
and   electric  utility   processes for  six media:  air,  water,
solid waste,  le'achates,  pesticides,  and radiation.   It  does
not   estimate  motor vehicle' emissions,  storm water run-off
residuals,  6r  emissions  from honpoint  sources  of  pollution
 (which   consists  of residuals  associated  with  land  use
activities,'  such  as  agriculture,   forestry,  mining   and
drilling,   and  construction).'  Resi'duals  for  these three
 types of pollution are  currently estimated outside  of  SEAS
 except   for  motor  vehicle emissions, which are forecast by
 PTRANS  and FTRANS.   For  all  other  significant  polluting
 industries  and  utilities,  RESGEN  initially forecasts the
 gross pollutant emissions that would occur from each  if  no
 abatement   activity  had  occurred  pursuant  to  the  1970
 Amendments to the Clean Air Act or the  1972  Amendments  to
 the  Federal water Pollution Control Act.  Then it estimates
 primary net residuals, assuming  that some  specified level of
 pollution  abatement activity  (including none) is  occurring.
 The  difference  between gross residuals and net residuals  for
 each industry  is  the  captured  residuals,  which  include
 recyclable wastes.   RESGEN   also  generates  estimates  of
 significant   secondary   residuals  produced  by the  pollution
 treatment  processes themselves.   (See  Figure A-3.)
                             A-13

-------
             Figure  A-3.
RESGEH Estimation Process Flowchart
                                CAPTURED
                               RESIDUALS
INDUSTRIAL
PROCESS
GROSS
RESIDUALS
TREATMENT
PROCESS
.-.PRIMARY NET
RESIDUALS
                          SECONDARY RESIDUALS
                          CREATED BY TREATMENT
                          (E.G., SLUDGES)
             A-14

-------
As in the case of ABATE,  the  input  data  used  by  RESGEfl
corresponds  directly  to the pollution emissions reductions
discussed in the industry  summaries  in  Sections  Two  and
Three for and water residuals.  The primary data consists of
gross   residual   coefficients   for  specified  years  and
associated fractions of  total  wasteload  treated,  average
removal efficiencies, and rates at which waste materials are
recycled  or converted to secondary residuals as percentages
of captured residuals.
                 THE TRANSPORTATION MODELS
                    (PTRANS AND FTRANS)
The two transportation models, PTRANS and PTRANS, use annual
forecasts of vehicle miles  travelled  by  automobile,  bus,
truck, rail, commuter rail-; and airplane to estimate the air
pollution emissions for passenger and freight transportation
vehicles  in  six  residual categories: hydrocarbons, carbon
monoxide,  nitrogen  oxides,  sulfur   oxides,   lead,   and
particulates.

For  a  given  calendar  year,  the  PTRANS  model  uses the
disposable income forecast from INFORUM and  the  population
forecast  to  determine  the  number  of new vehicles on the
road,  it uses data-from the  1974  National  Transportation
Study for vehicle miles travelled by transportation mode and
occupancy  ratios  to  distribute  the  VMT  forecast  among
intracity (auto, bus, rapid transit, railroad) and intercity
(auto, air, bus, railroad) transportation  modes.   Then  it
uses EPA emissions factors to forecast net residuals for the
year.   In  the  case  of  automobiles, PTRANS also utilizes
input data indicating the distribution of cars on  the  road
by model year to forecast these residuals.

Freight  ton-mile  projections  are  computed  by the FTRANS
model by applying INFORUM growth rates for  freight  sectors
to   base   year  data  for  freight  ton-miles  drawn  from
Department of  Transportation  studies.   Modal  splits  and
weight loading factors are then applied to develop forecasts
of vehicle miles travelled for trucks, rail, water, air, and
pipelines.    Pollutant  emissions  are  then  estimated  by
applying emission factors  to  each  freight  transportation
mode.  Again, these emissions represent net residuals.
                           A-15

-------
                 THE  ENERGY  USE MODEL  (ENERGY)
 ENERGY  estimates  energy  use  by  consumer  class  (industrial,
 commercial, residential,   transportation,   electric   utility
 consumption,  ana  elec.tricity generation) and  fuel  category
 based  on  INFORUM  annual  output   forecasts   for   the   185
 economic  sectors.   For each  fuel category, it  also reports
 whether the fuel is used for combustion or as a  raw  material
 feedstock by the  consumer  class.   The . model  provides   a
 detailed accounting of all fuel usage in quadrillions  (10*s)
 of Btu's based on the interindustry relationships in INFORUM
 at the time the sector output  forecasts are made.

 .Because the energy forecasts are based on the INFORUM annual
 outputs,  any  supply  constraints  caused by relative price
 adjustments are introduced into the forecasts.   The  relative
 price .adjustments might  have  resulted ,frojn  .changed  fuel
 stock  levels  (STOCKS,  model)  or  from pollution abatement
 feedback into IBFORUM (ABATE model).    Consequently,   ENERGY
 is  sensitive  to a wide range of conservation and abatement
 assumptions.
                THE STOCKS RESERVES AND PRICES
                        MODEL (STOCKS)
 The   STOCKS  model   in   SEAS   provides  information  on  raw
 material   sources,   reserve  levels,  and relative production
 costs .under  alternative   assumptions   regarding   import,
 export,   and inventory  levels.   The mod,el maintains accounts
 for  both  domestic and world-wide reserves as  a  function  of
 relative    production    prices.    Currently,   twelve  stock
 categories  are  included, of which six are fuels and six  are
 non-fuel    minerals.    Overrides  for prices,   investments,
 imports,  and exports concerning  these stocks   are  generated
 by   STOCKS   as  optional   feedbacks to the national economic
 models.
               THE SOLID WASTE AND RECYCLING
                      MODEL (SOLRECYC)
The SEAS SOLRECYC model  estimates  the  annual  tonnage  of
solid  waste  generated  from  non-industrial  sources   the
expected proportional use of various disposal  methods'  and
the  costs  associated with each disposal method.  The'model
                           A-16

-------
also projects estimated levels of recycling, which  are  fed
to the STOCKS model for adjustment of raw material demands.
               THE SUMMARY REPORT GENERATORS
              (POSTCOMP, INFRPT AND CLEANSUM)
As  shown  in Figure A-l, each of the special-purpose models
discussed above produces its ovn detailed output report.  In
addition to these detailed reports, summary data from  these
models,  as  well as from the national economic program, are
collected in a common data file for  production  of  summary
reports.   Three  types  of  report  generators were used to
assist in the assessment of pollution control impacts:

  •  POSTCOMP,  which  provides  annual  data   values   and
     annualized    percentage    changes   for   significant
     parameters  from  every  SEAS   model,   as   well   as
     comparative indexes for pollutant residuals produced by
     each of up to four scenarios;

  •  INFRPT,   which   provides    comparative    percentage
     differences  and  sector  rankings  in INFORUM economic
     results for selected scenario pairs,- and

  •  CLEANSUM, which provides  annual  abatement  costs  and
     residuals for each SEAS economic sector.

Run  books for the seven scenarios described in this Section
are maintained on file at EPA.  These books contain both the
detailed model  outputs  as  well  as  the  summary  reports
produced for each scenario.
                            A-17

-------
Appendix B
Scenario Assumptions
                     REFERENCE SCENARIO
The  comparative  scenario approach of Section Four requires
that  a  set  of  assumptions  constituting  a  baseline  or
Reference  Scenario,  be  developed and used for comparative
analysis of  scenarios.   The  consequences  of  alternative
assumptions  concerning  public  policy can then be measured
against  this  baseline.   The  purpose  of  the   Reference
Scenario  is thus to establish a useful benchmark of  general
assumptions for comparative  analysis-  it is not intended  to
provide predictions of the most probable future.

The   Reference   Scenario    for   this study   is  based  on
assumptions about   future  trends   and policies   from  1976
through  1985.   These   assumptions,   in   general, represent
official   forecasts  of  the  future   made  by  appropriate
government     agencies     in   their    specific   areas  of
responsibility (e.g.,  population growth by the Bureau of  the
Census).   Table B-l  presents the   government   agencies  from
which  forecasts  were   obtained.   Where  appropriate, values
 for  these  forecasts  are  also given-.
                              B-l

-------
                          Table  B-l.
                Reference Scenario Assumptions
 Assumption

 Population-Series  E
 Projections
 (Millions of  People)

 Labor Force
 (Millions of  People)
Labor Productivity
Gross National Product
(Trillions of 1975
Dollars)
Forecast Time Period
Unemployment Rate in
1985 (Full Employment
Economy)

Federal Expenditures in
1980 and 1985 Excluding
Transfers and Pollution
Control Programs
(Millions 1975 Dollars)

Federal Expenditures
for Pollution
Control
 Government
 Agency

 Department  of
 Commerce, Bureau
 of  the  Census

 Department  of  Labor,
 Bureau  of Labor
 Statistics

 Bureau  of Labor
 Statistics

 Ford/Council of
 Economic Advisors
 (1975-1980)
 Bureau  of Labor
 Statistics
 (1980-1985)
EPA
Bureau of Labor
Statistics
Department of
Commerce, Bureau
of Economic Analysis
EPA
 values

 1975-213.9
 1980-224.1
 1985-235.7

 1975- 93.8
 1980-101.8
 1985-107.7

 varies by
 Industry

 1975-1.47
 1976-1.57
 1977-1.69
 1978-1.81
 1979-1.85
 1980-1.99
 1985-2.40

 1/1/76-
 12/31/85

 4.0 to
 4.5%
1980-156,400
1985-173,400
                            B-2

-------
The GNP and unemployment rate  estimates  selected  for  the
Reference  Scenario  are  intended  to represent the current
best estimates of what can be  achieved  nationally  between
1975  and  1985,  through  a  combination  of  public sector
monetary ana fiscal policies.  The Reference Scenario target
objectives for the GNP and its components for  1975  through
1985  represent  a  combination  of  the Council of Economic
Advisors (CEA) and U.S.  Office  of  Management  and  Budget
(OMB) forecasts for the period of 1975 through 1980, and the
Bureau  of  Labor Statistics  (BLS) projected economic growth
for the 1981-1985 period, as  contained in The  Structure  of
the U.S. Economy in 1980 and  1985 (U.S. Department of Labor,
Bureau   of   Labor  Statistics,  Bulletin  1831,  op.cit.K
Assumptions about labor force and  labor  productivity  used
are those contained in the BLS projections with the greatest
long-run  likelihood  based   upon  GNP  supply-oriented   (or
potential-GNP) concepts.  These projections are  used  since
they   are   tempered   by    personal  income,  demand,  and
demogr.aphic change considerations.

A  steadily declining unemployment rate through the  forecast
period  is  required  to  be  consistent  with  both the GNP
forecasts and assumptions about labor  force and productivity
for the Reference  Scenario.   The   unemployment  rate  thus
declines  monotonically  over the period  from the high rates
of the mid-1970's to a rate  between  4.0 and 4.5  percent   in
the   mid-1980's.    The   annual  changes   in  productivity
presented  in  the Reference Scenario  are those assumed  in  the
BLS projections  (Structure o_f the U.S^ Economy in   1980   and
1985,  op.cit..  Chapters  1  and  2 and  Appendix A).  These
assumptions concerning  GNP,  the  labor   force,  and   labor
productivity   replace,   for   the  Reference   scenario,  those
originally  used  in the  INFORUM projections  (Almon,  et  al.f
1985;   Interindustry   Forecasts  of   the   American  Economy.
 The Reference Scenario assumptions also include the  setting
 of Federal expenditures for non-pollution-control activities
 in 1975 dollars (excluding transfers) at $156,400 million in
 1980 ($106,060 million and $50,340 million, defense and non-
 defense,   respectively)   and   $173,400  million  in  1985
 ($115,200 million and  $58,200  million,  defense  and  non-
 defense,  respectively), vith interpolation used to generate
 forecasts for  intervening  years.   In  addition,  personal
 disposable  income  per capita is adjusted to produce, using
 INFORUM, the desired GNP and unemployment targets  specified
 above.

 The  Reference Scenario represents a calibration of the SEAS
 system to the assumed GNP projections and unemployment rates
                             B-3

-------
in the absence of pollution control expenditures induced  by
Federal  legislation.   This does not mean that there are no
pollution control  expenditures  implied  in  the  Reference
Scenario  because  there  are  substantial  levels  of  such
investments which would  have  been  incurred  even  in  the
absence  of  federally  legislated  abatement policies.  The
levels for these  expenditures  were  taken  from  forecasts
developed by EPA.

The  Reference  Scenario  is  intended to reflect neither an
unusually high energy consumption rate  nor  an  unrealistic
energy   conservation   effort.    The   energy  consumption
assumptions contained in the Federal Energy Administration's
Project  Independence report  for  the  "Business  as  Usual"
case,  with  oil  at  $7  per  barrel, were thus used in the
Scenario.  The assumptions are summarized in  Table  B-2  in
terms  of  the  projected  total gross consumption of energy
resources in trillions of Btu's by fuel source.
                          Table  B-2.
                  United  States  Total  Gross
               Consumption of  Energy Resources
    (Business-as-Usual  Without Conservation - $7/Bbl  Oil)1
 Fuel             1972       -1977        1980        1985

 Coal             12,495      16,854      18,074      19,888
 Petroleum        32,966      37,813      41,595      47,918
 Natural Gas      23,125      21,558      22,934      23,947
 Nuclear Power       576       2,830       4,842      12,509
 Other             2,946       3,543       4,014       4,797

 Totals           72,108      82,598      91,459     109,059

 Source: Project independence Report F  Federal Energy
         Administration, Appendix Al,  p.37, November 1974.

 * Data shown is in trillions of Btu's.
                             B-4

-------
                REFERENCE ABATEMENT SCENARIO

The Reference Abatement Scenario differs from the  Reference
Scenario  in  that  it  includes  among  its assumptions the
incremental pollution control practices,  along  with  their
attendant  employment,  costs,  and  effects  on  residuals,
necessary to achieve compliance  with  Federal  legislation.
(Municipal  costs  are  based  on  available Federal subsidy
funds rather than compliance  regulations  for  purposes  of
this   report.)   Most  of  the  unit  cost  data  used  for
calculation of these costs in SEAS was provided in  constant
1973 dollars.  Since the INFORUM data is currently expressed
in  constant 1971 dollars, it was necessary to first deflate
the abatement cost input values from 1973 to  1971  dollars,
and  then  to  inflate  the  computed  results  back to 1975
dollars for presentation in this report.  The deflation  and
inflation  factors  used for these purposes are presented in
Table B-3.

Abatement costs are computed and analyzed in terms of annual
investment, annual  0&M  costs,  annualized  capital  costs,
capital-in-place,  and  number of employees directly engaged
in pollution control activities.   Total  annual  costs  are
computed  as  the  sum  of  annual  O&M costs and annualized
capital costs.  The annualized capital costs are derived  by
applying to the annual investment amounts a capital recovery
factor of:
                      N
                  U+i) -  1
 where   "i"   is   the   annual   interest   rate   expressed   as  a
 fraction  and "N"  is  the life  of  the  abatement  equipment in
 years.    For these  calculations,  a  nominal  interest  rate of
 10 percent  is  assumed   for   both  the   private  and  public
 sectors and abatement equipment  life varies  with  the  type of
 control technology being applied.
                             B-5

-------
                                       Table B-3
                      Summary of Inflation and Deflation Factors'

              Type of                                              Capital'          O&M*
              Abatement Cost         Sources                    1973-71  1971-75   1973-71 1971-7S

              Water                  Engineering News Record    0.879    1.33O     0..898  1.295

              AHr-Electrostatic      Joy Manufacturing Co.,     O.7O8    2.136     O.9O9  1.718
              Predpltator           Nelson Electricity
..                                    Cost Index
CD
os             Air-Bu1lding           Chemical Engineering       0.943    1.541     O.9O9  1.718
              Evacuation             Plant Cost Index,
                                     Nelson Electricity
                                     Cost Index

              Air-Fuel Switching,    Chemical Engineering-      O.943    1.541     O.892  2.138
              Afterburners,          Plant Cost Index, Nelson
              Incinerators           Fuel Cost Index

              A1r-All Other          Chemical Engineering       O.943     1.541     O.939  1.533
              Equipment              Plant Cost Index. Nelson
                                     Operating Cost Index

              1 A General GNP Inflation Rate of 1.311 was used to convert GNP estimates from
                1971 to 1975 dollars (Source: Bureau of Labor Statistics)

              * Deflation factors are for" 1973 to  1971 dollars and  Inflation  factors  are  for
                1971 to 1975 dollars.

-------
Federal  expenditures and non-defense Federal employment are
both incremented in  the  Reference  Abatement  Scenario  to
account  for Federally funded pollution control programs and
activities.   These  increments,  which  are  added  to  the
corresponding   values  from  the  Reference  Scenario,  are
presented in Table B-4.
                         Table B-4.
   Federal Expenditure and Employment Increments for the
                Reference Abatement Scenario
                                               1985

Federal Expenditure Increment
  Non-Defense (Millions of 1975 Dollars}     +2,564
  Defense (Millions of 1975 Dollars)           +384
Federal Employment increment
  (Millions of People)                         +0.2
Unemployment rates were calibrated in the Reference Scenario
to near  full-employment levels of 4.0 to 4.5 percent  during
the   1980's.   The  addition of pollution control investment
capital, employment, and Federal expenditures tends to drive
unemployment below these levels.  When this occurs, the   per
capita   disposable  income  is  constrained in the Reference
Abatement Scenario to reflect a typical inflation  dampening
fiscal   policy.   The  scenario  is  then  run  again  until
unemployment is equal to or greater than 4.0 percent.

The Reference Abatement Scenario assumes that all sources of
pollution   will   fully  comply  with  the  EPA   and   state
regulations and  guidelines  developed  in  response to  the
Clean Air Act of  1970 and the 1972 Amendments to the Federal
Water   Pollution  Control   Act.    Detailed   assumptions
concerning  such compliance may be found in Section Two (Air)
and Section Three (Water) of this report.
                  LOW  PRODUCTIVITY SCENARIOS
 The   Lov.'   Productivity    and  Low  productivity  Abatement
 Scenarios differ  from their Reference Case  counterparts  in
 that  they make use of the  productivity  functions and growth
                            B-7

-------
assumptions •••contained in the INFORUM model  as obtained   from
the  university  of  Maryland.   Compared with  the Reference
Scenarios; this reflects  a  slowing  down  of  productivity
because  of  shifts toward service  industries in  the pattern
of ftnal demand/and because of a lessening of  the  rate  of
productivity  increase  in  other industries.   GNP estimates
for the Low productivity Scenario which  correspond to   these
assumptions  are  shown  in  Table  B-5 and  are  compared with
those for the Reference Scenario.
                         Table B-5.
            Comparison of GNP Estimates  for the
          LOW Productivity and Reference Scenarios
               (In Trillions of 1975 Dollars)
                    Low Productivity     Reference Case
                          GNP                 <3NP

     1975                 1.53                1.47
     1977                 1.67                1.67
     1980                 1.84                2.01
     1983                 1.99                2.22
     1985                 2.09                2.36
                ENERGY CONSERVATION SCENARIO
The two Energy  conservation   scenarios  approximate  energy
usage    forecasts    contained   in   the   Federal   Energy
Administration's-  ."Buslness-as-Usual   With   Conservation"
scenario  where  the   import  price of oil is $11 per barrel.
(See Appendix Al, page 46  of  the  November  1974  Project
Independence   Report.) The   energy consumption estimates in
the Energy and Energy  Abatement  Scenarios each reflect a net
reduction of  approximately  13  quadrillion  Btu's  compared
with  their  corresponding  Reference  Case  scenarios.   The
following types of changes were  Introduced to achieve  these
energy savings:

  1. A reduction in  the  household  consumption  of  fossil
     fuels for air   conditioning  and  heating to simulate
     raising   the  thermostat  setting  in  the  summer   and
     lowering it in the winter.

  2. A reduction in personal   consumption  expenditures   for
     gasoline  to  simulate   increased  carpooling  (with an
                           B-8

-------
  automobile occupancy ratio of 1.96 persons per  vehicle
  as  compared  to  the Reference Case occupancy ratio  of
  1.56).   increased  shifts  to  mass  transit  are  also
  included  for  the  Energy  Case scenarios, such as the
  modal  split comparison between the Reference and Energy
  Scenarios for 1985 shown below:
   Intracity         Reference         Energy

    Auto             0.9070           0.8690
    Bus               0.0230           0.0610
    Rapid             0.0350           0.0350
    Rail             0.0350           0.0350

   Intercity         Reference         Energy

    Auto             0.8650           0.8250
    Air               0.0950           0.0950
    Bus               0.0300           0.0500
    Rail             0.0100           0.0300
3. A  reduction  in  the  interindustry  fossil   fuel   use
   coefficients    for    energy-intensive     inputs     by
   substitution  of  less   energy-intensive   industries.
   These  measures  include:  shifts to returnable beverage
   containers,  reductions  in  the  use   of    artificial
   fertilizers,  reduced  use  of packaging materials, and
   some recycling of energy-intensive materials.

4. Miscellaneous  changes  to  reflect   improved  energy
   housekeeping activities by various industries.
                          B-9

-------
Appendix C.
Impact of increased Federal
Grants for Municipal
Wastewater Treatment
A companion scenario to the Reference Abatement Scenario was
constructed  which  continued  the Federal grant program for
municipal wastevater treatment plants through 1977-85.   The
comparative  Federal  outlay  data for this scenario and the
Reference Abatement Scenario  is provided  in  Table  3-14   of
Section Three.  This scenario is identified as the Municipal
Scenario  {or Scenario 2A).

Table  C-l  provides  a  summary  of  relative macroeconomic
impacts   of  the  Municipal   Scenario  as compared  to  the
Reference  Abatement  Scenario;  the primary statistics show
only small  differences  between  the  two  scenarios.   The
additional funds  injected  into an economy operating at  full-
supply-GNP  require that the  disposable  income per  capita  be
reduced  from 1980 to 1985  on  the  order  of  0.34  percent,
which  reduces  personal consumption expenditures  on  the  order
of  0.31  percent.   The   major  large   changes  occur  where
expected, in state and local  health  and  welfare  expenditures
growing  by 12.00  percent   in  1985   and   stimulating  public
construction by 10.54 percent in 1985.   Net water  residuals,
except  for  dissolved solids, decline by over  30  percent  by
1980,  with a continuing  increase in  the  efficiency treatment
of  suspended  solids  and  nutrients   over   the   decade.    This
reflects  the   continuing   upgrading of  municipal  wastewater
treatment plants.
                             C-l

-------
                                            Table C-1,
                       Comparison of the Macro-Statistics of the Municipal
                     Scenario (SA) and the Reference Abatement Scenario (S2)
                                        [(S2A~S2)/S2 1n %$

                   Statistic                          1977        1980        1983      1985

                   Gross National Product             O.O3        O.11        O.25      O.O9
                   Disposable Income Per Capita       O.OO       -0.51       -O.56     -0.34
<|>                  Federal Expenditures               O.OO        O.OO        O.OO      O.OO
(vj                  Personal Consumption Expenditures  O.OO       -O.36       -0.44     -0.31
                   Total Output                       O.O3        0.14        0.28      0.08
                   Investment                         O.02        0.11        O.25     -O.O3
                   State & Local Health & Welfare     O.1O        3.19        9.43     12.OO
                   Public Construction                O.G9       13.54       20.14     10.54
                   Net Water Residuals
                     Biochemical Oxygen Demand      -30.63      -31.48      -32.72    -31.21
                     Suspended Sol ids               -14.59      -22.59      -33.64    -42.99
                     Dissolved Solids                 O.02        0.01        0.15      0.15
                     Nutrients                      -14.98      -32.16      -51.1O    -64.71
                   Water Municipal Costs
                     Annual1zed Costs
                        Capital                       1.93       3O.31       94.49    124.19
                        O&M                           1.50       31.96       95.71    125.45
                     Capital in Place                 1.93       3O.31       94.49    124.19
                     Direct Employment                1.48       31.96       95.7O    125.47

-------
Appendix D,
Estimating the Cost For
industries to control
Pollution
                COST ESTIMATION METHODOLOGY
Industrial  facilities are  required
pollution   emissions  if   they  are
Implementation  Plan  (SIP)  or  by
Performance Standards
are  obliged by   the
      to  control  their  air
      so regulated by a State
       Federal   New   Source
Under the SIP program/ states
                      {NSPS).
                       Clean Air Act to specify the emission
controls required by each industrial sector to  achieve  the
Federal  ambient air quality standards throughout the state.
Thus, significant interregional differences in treatment may
exist due to  existing  ambient  air  quality  at  the  time
regulations  are implemented in each state.  For new plants,
interregional treatment is  more  nearly  identical  because
Federal  Air  NSPS's  apply  to  plants built or extensively
modified  after  the  particular  NSPS  guideline  for  that
industry is promulgated.  As of August 1975, NSPS's had been
published  for  17  industries.  The NSPS allowable emission
levels are usually more stringent than  those  for  existing
sources;  hence,  quite  often unit control costs for plants
regulated by NSPS are greater, than  for plants  regulated  by
SIP's.

The  deadline   for  meeting  the Federal ambient air quality
standards was July 1, 1975.  Industries have  not  yet  made
the  expenditures  necessary  to  achieve   their part of  the
emissions reduction  required  to   meet  ambient  standards.
Industries  are continuing  to install air  pollution abating
equipment, however, and  for  the purposes of this report,   it
was  assumed that the required air  abating  investment needed
by 1978  will be made by  the  end  of  1978,  when  the   final
series  of   standards is  to  be met.   It  is  also  assumed that
BPT  standards  for water  pollution control   will  be  met   in
1977,   and that BAT standards  compliance will  be achieved in
19831

Seventy-two   industrial   sectors  have  significant   control
costs   for   either  or  both air  and water  pollution  control.
The   number   of  sectors  within  each  aggregate    industry
classification  is  shown in Table  D-l.
                              D-l

-------
                         Table D-l.
      Distribution of Industrial Cost-Control Sectors
Aggregate industry

Agriculture
Mining
Food Processing
Textiles
Paper * Lumoer
Chemicals
Petroleum
Rubber
Ferrous Metals
Nonferrous Metals
Stone, Clay, Glass
Machinery & Equipment
Electric Utilities
Trade & Services
Miscellaneous

Total
Total
Industrial
Sectors

    1
    3
    9
    2
    6
   12
    3
    I
    4
    9
    8
    5
    1
    2
    6

   72
Air      Water
Cost     cost
Sedtors • Sectors
  0
  3
  1
  0
  2
  6
  3
  0
  4
  8
  5
  1
  1
  2
  5

 41
 1
 0
 8
 2
 5
^6
 1
 1
 2
 7
 5
 4
 1
 0
 1

44
 But   this   listing  does  not  provide a  good  appreciation for
 the  detail  at  which the abatement  cost  estimates  are   made.
 For   example,  the steel-maXing industry,  for purposes  of air
 pollution control, is  a single item under Ferrous Metals  in
 the   above  table.  However, 22 different  industrial  segments
 are  actually defined,  each with  its  own  cost  curve  for
 capital  expenditure  and O&M  as a function of plant size.
 There are 497  industrial  segments  within  the  72  industrial
 cost-control  sectors   for which  air or  water control costs
 are  estimated.
                     INDUSTRIAL SEGMENTS:
             MODEL PLANTS, UNIT COSTS AND GROWTH
 In order to calculate pollution  control  costs,  industries
 are   represented  by  "segments"  and  "model  plants".   A
 "segment" is all or a  portion  of  an  industry  that  has:
 (1) the  same  production  process,  (2) the  same pollution
 control  technology,  and  (3) the  same  pollution  control
                             D-2

-------
standards.   For  example, the Kraft Paper Industry is dealt
with for purposes of air pollution control costs in terms of
10  different  segments.   These  segments  are   shown   in
Table D-2.   "Model  plants"  are  the  building blocks of a
segment; that is, a segment's  capacity  for  production  is
comprised  of  capacity  within a number of model plant size
groupings that are classified as either "existing" or  "new"
(new  facilities  are  those constructed after the date when
the clean Air Act or Clean  Water  Act  first  affects  that
industry).  For example, Segment 7 for Kraft Paper (Smelting
TanKs)  has  three  model  plant  sizes (454, 907, and 1,361
units of  production per day).  There are existing  facilities
in all  three size groupings, but, during the 1976-85 period,
new facilities are expected to be built in only  the  middle-
size class.
                              D-3

-------
                          Table D-2.
          Kraft  Paper  Industry Segment  Definitions
Process

1.  Power
    Boiler

2.  Boiler
3.  Recovery
    Furnace

4.  Recovery
    Furnace

5.  Recovery
    Furnace

6.  Recovery
    Furnace

7.  Smelting
    Tank

8.  Lime Kiln
9,  Stock
    Washer

10. Evaporator
Control
Technology

Electrostatic
Precipitators

Double Alkali
Scrubber

Electrostatic
Precipitators

Venturi Scrubber
Recovery Furnace
Replacement

Black Liquor
Oxidation

Orifice Scrubber
Venturi Scrubber
Incinerate in
Recovery Furnace

Incinerate in
Lime Kiln
Pollution
Standard

Federal
Particulates

Federal
Sulfur Dioxide

Washington/Oregon
Particulates

Washington/Oregon
Particulates

Washington/Oregon
Total Reduced Sulfur

Washington/Oregon
Total Reduced Sulfur

Washington/Oregon
Particulates

Washington/Oregon
Particulates

Washington/Oregon
Total Reduced Sulfur

Washington/Oregon
Total Reduced Sulfur
The  cost  of  controlling  air  pollution  from  industrial
sources  is  estimated  for  model  plants.   All   existing
capacity  is expressed in terms of the model plants, and all
new growth in capacity is also expressed in terms  of  these
model  plants.   For  examplet  existing  plants  which  are
classified into the smallest model plant (size grouping)  in
Segment  7 for Kraft Paper (454 units of production per day)
are assumed to spend, on the average, as  much  for  capital
equipment  to  control  each  residual as the 454-unit model
plant.
                            D-4

-------
To calculate industrial costs  of  pollution  control,  each
segment has a capital cost equation and an O&M cost equation
that  states dollar costs as a function of plant capacity or
water  use,  based  on  the  model  plants.   The  air  cost
equations  are derived from individual studies funded by EPA
{see Section Two) and the water costs are obtained from  the
EPA Development Documents (see Section Three).

Each  industrial  segment  is associated with one of the 185
industrial aggregate sectors of the INFORUM  economic  model
via  a  side  equation.   These  sectors  and  corresponding
detailed subsectors of SEAS are shown in Tables 0-3 and D-4,
respectively.   Due  to  this  association,  the  growth  of
capacity  or  water  use  (and  the  accompanying  growth in
abatement costs) in  each  segment  is  dependent  upon  the
dynamics  of  the  interindustry  model.   Thus,  if  a user
decreases the personal consumption purchases of automobiles/
then the direct and indirect effects of  this  reduction  in
car  sales will ripple throughout the system.  The abatement
costs for steel industries, aluminum  industries  and  other
industries   indirectly  impacted  by the change in car sales
will  be  calculated.   in  the  same   manner,   additional
purchases  by a sector required  for pollution control can be
imposed  and  the  specific  direct  and  indirect   impacts
determined.
                             D-5

-------
        Table D-3.
The 185 Sectors of INFORUM
JfC
1
4
t
10
It
14
1*
U
I*
II

34
IT
*0
41
44
41
JJ
Sf
SI

44
• 7
TO
n
Tl
ff
•1
•>
II
tl
94
9 j
100
101
1»»
IK
ill
111
III
111

11T
110
111

lit
141
141
141
IS1
IS4
UT
111
144
lit
111
ITS
IT!
Ul
114
TO* NANC1
DAIRY PAP* PRODUCTS
COTTON
FRUIT. VECCTAH.ES, OTH CHOPS
AC*, FOPtSTRV • FISH StRVICP
OTHCP WJH-* ERROUS ORES
STONE ANO CLAT •UNIM
MINTENANCt CONSTRUCTION
OTHER OIONANCC
CANNED ANO FROIfN POOOI
SUGAR
SOTT 01 INKS ANO FLAVORINGS
TMACCO PRODUCT:
• IIC IEITUES
HOUSfKHC TEXTILES
NIILHOPK ANO WOO PROCUCTS
OTHER FURNITURE
PAPER PRODUCTS* NEC
NfHSPAPEU
iNousTPtAi CHPIICALS
OTHFP PRINTING, PUtllSHINe
"JIC CHEMtAl HOOUCTJ
CILllllOilC PlinS
CLEANING AtO TOILET MOO.
Ftltl OIL
PUIIC* PRODUCTS
"OOTWAFtEXC. RUSMRt
StKUCTUIAL CLAY P*10UCTS
OTHPP STCKt • CUA.Y **COUCTS
LUO
OTM PRIM NO*-*** HEtALS
NON-*« CASTING AW «C«CINC
•PLUNIIHC AND HtATtNS EQUIP*
NETAL STAKMNGS
PIPES, VALVCS. PITTING!
PARN »ACHt»FRY
PAtHINC TOOLS, NETAL CUTTING
SPtCIAL IhluSTItAt lACHINfRT
PPHPP TR4N(N|S5ION EOUIPNfNT
OTHIA OFPICI HACMtNERV
CLPCTING
ELECTRIC UTILITIES
HHCKVUt Ts
FAINTS
PAVING ANO tSPHtlT
HISC PLASTIC PPOCHKTS
OTHd LCATHPR PROOUCT1
POTTBWT
STCCl
1TNC
OTH NCM-PER ROLL » 01 AH
KPTAL CANS
STnjCTUMl "CTAl PROOUCTS
CUTLEVY* HANO TOnLSt HAROHR
OTH F4MICATED 1FTAL PRWHKTT
cmsTP., niNmc, ctl MSLO «
MACHINE TOOLS, HETAL FCROINB
PU1PS, CTNPRISS9AS, ILOHERS
INDUSTRIAL PATIF'nS
SCRVIC1 |NOUST«f OACHtNEtY
TRANSrOKNERS Al>0 SHITCHCEAR
HEL01NG APP, CPAPHtTf PROO
RA9IO AMD TV RRCCIVING
ELECTRONIC CONPWCHTS
«-»AY, ElEC E>UIP>KEC
AIRCRAFT
SHIP AND «OAT HIUOINO
TIAILER COACHES
OPTICAL . OPHTHALMIC GOODS
HATCHES AID CLOCKS
OFMCt SUPPL1IS
IUSCS ANO LOCAL TRANSIT
At Al 1N1S
TclCPHON* ANO T*Lt9APH
R!TAIl TUOE
CHHER-OCCUPIEO DHELIINCS
PERSOKAL ANO (EPAtR SC'VICEl
AUTO REPAIR
PRtVATP SCHOOLS ANO NP<1
M) OEF'N
lUSINESS TRAVEUOUXNTI
CCNPUTm' KENTALS40UNNYI
1
4
t
11
IS
11
21
24
IT
10
)J
>4
}t
42
41
41
SI
54
ST
10
41
44
4t
Tl
T5
Tl
II
14
IT
to
9)
94
tt
101
IDS
101
til
114
11 T
UD
121
124
I2t
Ul
111

141
144
I4>
ISO
lil
IM

Ul
141
17
IT
IT
tl
11

MAT ANIMU. OTH LIVESTK
IOIACCO
NO OEP'H
COPPE* Ollf
CRUOC PfTROlEUH, NAT. 411
HFK CONSTRUCTION
ANNUNIT10N
DAIRY PRODUCTS
IA«fRV PROOUCTS
ALCOHOLIC LEVERAGES
DISC POOO PRODUCTS
FLOOR COVERING!
IFF ARIL
VENEPft ANO PLYHOOO
HOUSEHOLO PURNITURf
FAPC« ANO PAPERWARO HILLS
FAPC»OA*0 CONMINtRS
MOKS
CONNCtClAL PRINTING
FESTICIOCS • AORIC. CHIN.
iTNTHITIC RUISI*
DRUGS
FITROLEUN REPINING
TIRES ANO INNER TUIES
LEATHER ' 1NO LTHR PROO
GLASS
CENENT. CONCRETti GYPSUH
COFPW
ALUNINUH
•ON-rCMOUS HIRC ORAHIN*
•ETAl lARRHS ANO ORUNS
SCRCH KACH1NE PRODUCTS
KISC FAHICATEO HI*E PRODUCT
EWJtWS ANO TUR8INES
HATfRIALS HANDLING NACH
9THPR NFYAl WORKING NACHIN.ER
MIL ANO ROLLER SEARINGS
COF*UTE*I ANO RfLATtO NACHIN
KACHINE SHOP PA4DUCTS
"*OTORS ANO GENERATORS
HOUSEHOLD APPLIANCES
PHONOGRAPH RECOOOS
(ATTVIES
TRUCK. IUS. TRAILER tOOIIS
AIRCPAPT ENGINES
•AllftOAO EWIFKENT
fNCR. • SCIENTIFIC INSTR.
MEDICAL ANO SURGICAL IMSTft.
JEHELXY AND SILVERHAM
NI3C HANUFACTURING. NEC
TRUCKING
PIPELINES
RADIO ANO TV IROAOCASTING
IAN«S. OtCIT ACEN., 1AOKEU
REAL ESTATE
AUSINCSS SERVICES
•OVIES AND ANUSCKENT
POST OFFICE
il ' IOC ELECTRIC UTILITIES
OFFICE SUPPLIES IOUNNYI

             D-6

-------
                                Table  D-4.
                     The   Subsectors   of  SEAS
SVMttTO* «•«»
    i  tttr c»iai rrauiTt
    >  MUT
      cou/iMMcTte cnn  MCU
      SUWKI
      COM
      COW-SB
      MTV*M Ul Ml
      901* "« cu »ociu
      nmnutt net
      «f 0 «f« •"TC-MOCIIIPM
      C3»l«» SUUCfHCIUDUiM
      H.V11 »IHiCOTT»« CHMSt
      ICi C«f»« ( **0
t> >«
n  I
tl  >
II 11
«»  t
H  *
W  »
it  t
it  1   INOUIT COKtUST OP OH
M  *  inui.smcM t emit*
l» n  crw wt HILL im
» 10  C«IC SUCM - CITSmU**
>»  1   I10UJT CCWMBt Of OIL
»  t  »O»'« »•••!£ >1» H   IM irHitOr.TMII «f -COt TDK
If  I   WOV KOU*IK
M II  RKIf r«B« P1**t94-mTMCftC$
f  t   iHtwjt co-wusi or on
M II
» I*
It IT
M 10
» »
» ft
»» M
» »
>» >»
>t i*
*^ Tl
»»  I
n It
tl  1
tl  *
tl  T
                                         i cam
                                         I trnti
                                         I WlCIMl  51»«C«
                                         < IOHL S0111 «MTC CfWlW
       PCHTM*rTl*tTOl
       ttmint os I at
       HMVUM! OXIDt
       CMO»tne
       naruMC KID
       rtHiiu" otoirot
       «err-K»»oe or
       rOHWIlO€l UTi-drm nio<-iimpi
       SUtfVtIC ACIA-SUL^IA
       IIITWTt f«IH.IIf«
       Hlflt 1u»t'rH03rxlTC
       IMOUST CCHUSI 3> COM.
       CMWI KiCK ,
       MTWMH.OKIC 
19  t
M 11
       .
Of N DIWIIK i ivrarul
luoriu - "(" «n c»n«.i
iua**cr CMC mmw;
tuMAcr "("iic-.^sruLi
C3M. CLlMtO t OtliO
COM-10» «TU £11  *
CHUOt Oil OOWtllC K»OHUCT»
CTHtl KIT Cll r,"X(SV HMtS
••«  KftT
routrm MOCCUIM '
1.0  "ociisiw
turn*    •••'..
cMNfo < mom SOMOD
CCM
CITHUJ
moult r omuir t». H»T ou
                                            CUM
                                            CMC tucw - nautc
                                                  '
                                                      T0*« TA«!t OVMXC
                                            mm r>H 'tMi»-»o-\  .
                                            *OMssivf >n o«r noc KIUS
                                            »in '>nic         '
«T  »
»T  t
M >l
«7 >t
«T IT
M  I
»  1
51  t
M  t
»» u
31 19
99 It
99 II
99 »
99 IT
99 »
99 3t
99 *r
99 to
99 71
»» 10
jt 3J
•»i  i
tl  9
tl  t
I'lOUtT COI^USf OF (ItL
iutrirt - rvcr
»Ul» f»0« Mttll "»€•
u»r - uittittHfo   '
^liSC - CtCSS RCCCVfVT
tip?* *o««o *ft05 ««ttf nr
WIIOI1C.M»U     r
IWIHT COXUSt Of <1>T CU
«0]
   It
   IT
   tt
t  91
I ,9t
I  >l
19 I
19 t
It I
II I
I) JO

14 1
19 I
n t
tt t
tt t
tt 90
It I
19  1
>9 •
H la
n ii
it i
II JO
ti  i
ti  >
   It
   Tl
59  1
99  t
99  T
99 10
St II
9t It
9* »
9» II
n it
9> It
» II
99 19
                                                                                       91UOCI  INCINIMTIOM
                                           1MIMMIIOX 0> 101.10 Htlll
                                           MMICINt.  InCIMItAflOII
                                           OTHCft OTfN OU«» t iAHOf til
                                           UHOHMOVHO COM. «llil"l«
                                           tOM-9TMH«IIC >0fl*
                                           ClUk-KOT ClIVIKttM-MOT 00*
                                           1HOUIT COKtUSt Of MT CM
                                           ocmtsTic NIT Oil Mooucrion
                                           istFtrat •
                                           •to "i»r n
      nlCH MOCItllXC
      MTU>U> NOC«9iO CMEfU
      c4*Mtotf^oeM rnuiTtveoSfNtc
      TOMIOtt
      moujT catsuit o> COAL
      CO«H nKllNO
      COM «t HIUIW
      ItfT SUCM
      i nous i cowusr Of COAL
      *mtn on Mocictlteri «int
      W»CN Mill FUliH-COTTOll.lYH
      «»« iTtKKiTOri»tN OTt-oOX
      ntct nfiHC.curit »IMTIM
      KHtt FttK
      tmtn Mooucrs
      IHOVST CO->«UST or xa cu •
      •IK - mr
      PULf . OtHCM
      MIC - SODIU*
      OtHfK utTI »rt*
      »>n - M itsrt
      ihcust cn««un or colt
      «CFt«lOI»10J
      cirnic icia
      •nine twronrot
CX.W •ITI-IIT»II' MOI-«UtIlf
SM.FURIC                *
          «nj>,ii«f:
 iwtar ccmusi o> OIL
 M.UNINUH- «Jtf*ri  .
 xnMQCm r(tolW*0!«m>A<:il CILL
19 J*  inDIU* U«»01»IS-SOtV»» MOC
>9 tl  SULUt CITK-I1TM OIOI-I11IN
11  1  PHOSPHATE FI*Tlll»»
                         HAHtl
tl
41
            .
       INOU&T COMBUST 0* NAT 6AS
       CALCIUM CH.O>IOi
                                    D-7

-------
Table D-4. (Continued)
The Subsectors of SEAS
41 tO FOT4SSIUM SULFA7I
41 11, SOB1U1* HCTU.
41 14 8TMYiE«/«nFYUM
*l It Kiln. ATSI
41 24 iEMtENe
41 30 •TX-HTM9 TFEAT, PYXOLTCIS
42 2 FHtNdlC RESINS
4t 5 u>» DENSITY FCLTETWLfm
41 1 SYNTHETIC RU8BE*
49 2 INOUST CPHBUST Or Oil
4T t SOAFS *HQ OMERCENTS
48 JO HI 0 S3UI8LC HI1T TAAOI WU
4t » SOLVENT 8AS« FAINT INOUSTRIL
4* > INDUS? ciHeusT IF HAT us
44 4 CASCLIHf FROOUCT ION
» 12 1WIHC PLANTS
*« 19 FEnccHfiiCRACRiiic.No LUSSSI
71 t MWALt
71 2 LATEX MANUFACTURE
Tt 11 arm.' TAKNING
7» 34 HASR ReNOvtD/cmqra TAILING
79 37 SWE HAIR/VEGETABLE
71 i MESSED < M.OUN eu»
7i 11 nwT GLASS
T» it <-n«=t snucTWAL CI»Y MLHS
it i mousr ecKKitr o« HIT us
«l to CEHENT - wr mminc
82 t CIUSHE0 JTOIt
» 2 IIIOUST CCKBU3T or alt
41 3 S»e»l PWDUCTlO«l
41 • STEM FOUNDRIES
Cl 11 8*11C OTY FURN-ISTEfiR. F*CIL
• 1 14 HFC7 4*C-f«X ^CUNDKY **QO
» JI OTHfl' ftWattlCT. "UMttCeS
u 40 sisrr rxv;H luftrctc-to C^O^H
82 41 H6CT A«C PtttNilC^-m C«0«rH
4S.44 IK(r< •(MNDMr - CUPOLA
u 4* Fen-OAuar "oo.-icf uiBsn
VFH
i» » co'PEn SKeirmc
•« » m
19 1 LUO
•4 t HIC
«> i Mtntm ftrtHion
•i 31 stcanjutT «.u>tNu*
«T JA MIBturo HKlOt
«• i »E^rLt. itm
ii 4 MKavtese
i» 2 mouir COHIUST OF OIL
140 1 tlKTtlCITV » COM.
140 « rtKTIIC17T 11 VUCUU fUfl
UQ si ctect ev HIGH sutruft coiv
140 J* UECT FT HTM
140 17 CUC7 tr HtTWM. CM
142 i scuAce stu&^r inciHFFATiox
142 >t OFVi aUMIIINC
142 14 DH-S!7i IHCtNEU710K
142 17 KO OEFiN
14S 10 C»AI« ^»10-5H4tL RURAL FAClt
17» 31 Mt Ct.EAH-PFTIt1t.EUP SQtvEnTS
17» 1 IM9US7 fM«US7-l«7 CAS N.C.C
ir« 4 coiwenc'iHSTirur VSE-HAT CAJ
17« •> OTHIF KOUSnitl. USE
41 It .SOPIUH CHUVI10C
41 1* SODtun SllICATC
41 17 HI AM1AUC1
4i 20 AHWtIA
41 21 irtm.tlil!
4t 11 ITI-SOI* turii F*OK utranun
42 3 NTIOH
42 4 HIOH OtNSITT FOtYtTHTU'C
44 1 *AT(n
49 9 INDUS! COKtUST OF Mt CIS
W I S4U KADf FAtHTS
41 It SOLVENT SiSI FAINT TKAOtULC
4* t 110UST COMUST OF COAL
H 4 »UM OIL nfFimne
4« )l IfFIHEIttES U/««C«]HO
49 34 LUBC OltfCftACKtNO FE7JU]CK«KI
72 1 I!«ES »M> IK1O TU9CS
79 1 LEinten TANM1WG
79 32 FULF HA(M/CM40Mt TAHNIHC
79 39 FUtF. SAVC H*tA.CM»OHf *NO TAN
71 t >!BE»GLASS < INSULATKni
78 4 CLASS CONTAINERS
7* 1 ST4UC7UIAL CtAT F^OOUCTS
11 1 1HOUST COHftUST OF COAt.
It 4 CtlOIT
it 11 c(ni!XT - our OINOIW
U ' SAW) ANO MAVEl
» J INOUST coHigsr OF NAT CAS
81 4 FCMtALLOY FDCOUCT1DN
11 * KTAl/COIL SUMAC- C3AT1HO
81 32 ELFCT AIC lrrfL-UTE«. 'AC.
81 39 07MSK UON FOUNOKr FU««1CES
U 38 f.SMtt CaKtNC
13 tl 9ASIC OXTCN FU»NAC-C«1«TH
11 4« il*CT AIC (UHW.CE-CIOWTH
•3 47 IftON FCUNO^V - CLECT iHC
83 70 FERROALLOY FROO* • CSF
41 82 FriLft2!m
84 90 FMKAAY COPFEK
84 91 HYDRONETALlUaCr
84 ri SEC 8F.ASS t »«Wf-SS«ITH
89 10 »I»A«Y LFAD
84 30 F«IXA»Y I1NC
87 2 ALUItNLM
17 >2 HAIL-KFIOLH.T FFIICCSS
87 19 NO«U01TAL JOMHBB1O
•« 2 HSUCUAV
21 1 HOHC AFFLIAHCES-SUtFACr COAT
» 1 tNOUST CONBUS7 OF KA7 CAS
40 2 ELfCT«IC!TY »Y OIL
40 5 fLfCTMClTY »Y NY0*.0 t OTHfK
40 32 UFC1-OUmL»T.'fSIDUAl OIL
40 33 EL^CT BY LM^
40 38 £LECT BY CFOTHEHMAl,HrO«0
42 2 TOTAL SOI 10 MASTS C€K£!UftON
42 32 OF£*< OUMFINC C LANDFILL
42 39 LANDFILL - FROM Alft CONTROLS
42 38 NO OJF'N
t> 31 C1A1K HAHD-rtRXIHAL FUtl
70 t ORY CLEANING
Tl t WttUST COmuST Of COAV. H.I.I
79 4 RESIDENTIAL USE-HAT CAS
7» 7 CQIfCRC/INSTlTUT US^-31t
71 30 COWtfRC/IHSTITUT USC**ES Oil
41 12 S001IW ftICmiMAT«
M 19 300IUN SULFATE
41 11 ISOFHROFAMOt
41 21 WTHANX
41 24 FRaFYLCXI
42 1 FOLYXKW CHLMIOS
42 FOLTSTYROf
42 FOtVFWFYLENt
49 INOUST CON8UST OP COAL
49 FOLYESTER FKCRS
41 IKOUSIItlM. FAt«T9>N.(.C.
»8 3 H2C SOLUILE FAINT tHOUSTR tAl
44 [MUST CONBUST Of OIL
41 JET FUCl FROOUCYIOft
41 3 CRACK IKCIHO FETRO OR LU8CSI
M I INTE,CRAriCllACKtLU«EiFETROCHI
73 RUaWk RECLAIHIHC
79 1 CHROME rANXINC
T9 3 SAVE H4t«/CK«OKe TAW1HC
79 14 HAitt REHOYC&/TANN90
71 FLAT CLASS
78 3 FLAT! CLASS
19 i FCRIOOIC MLN U/FLASHINQ
81 1HDUS7 CON4UST OF OTL
11 LIKI
1 AUES70S FROOUCrS
« IHOUST CON8UST OF COAL
8 IRON FOUNDRY FROOUCTIOH
I COAL INTO COHINC
1 3 OFEM HEARTH FURt-IMTtC. MC.
1 3 CUFOLA FURNACE
•1 3 SUBNEHCEB ARC FIMNACt
U 3 tYFHOOXT COX IKS
•J 4 HO OEf 'U
• 14 NO DEF1^
81 48 FERROALLOY FROO.-FAB. F1LTJR
81 80 FINISHIW QFOArtOXS
81 81 SINTERING
84 11 SeCONOAH COFFER
84 34 SHELTIHG H/ROASKK
84.72 SEC BRASS < BRON2£-KO GRQUTH
83 11 SECONOAM LEAS
84 It SECOKOART tlHC
87 10 FR1HARY ALUNINUN
87 33 ALCOA FROCESS
87 14 VERTICAL iOM«6e»S
44 1 UAANIUN
111 1 INOUST COHBUST OF COAL
131 4 FOTOR VEH.FA%TS-SURFAC& COAT
140 3 EXFCTRKITY 9Y CAS
40 30 ELECT BY LOU SUL'UR COAL
40 11 ELECT BY HIGH SULFUR RGS OIL
40 34 ELECT BY CASIMEO COAL
40 31 ELECT BY HUNICIPAL KASTC
7 30 INCINERATION OF SOLID HASTE
Z 33 MUNtCtFM. INCINCfUTlOH
i 34 OTHER OPEN OUfF & LANDFILL
$ I CRAIN HANOL1NG
332 C»AIK HATO-TEM »CILIIHLAN9
9 30 PRY CLEAN-SYNTHETIC SOLVENTS
1 2 1NDUST CW5UST OF OK N.E.C.
174 9 RESIDENT USE-OIST1LLATE OIL
174 k ' COMNERC/USTtTur USE-COAL
17* 11 COHReR/t*STITUT USE-OUT OIL
        D-8

-------
                                  TECHNICAL REPORT DATA
                           {Please read Instructions on the reverse before completing)
 REPORT NO
  EPA 600/5-79-010
             3, RECIPIENT'S ACCESSION NO,
 TITLE AND SUBTITLE
  Resources and Pollution Control:
  Demonstration of  a  Comprehensive Assessment
             5. REPORT DATE
                September  1979
             6. PERFORMING ORGANIZATION CODE
 AUTHOR(S)
                                                           8. PERFORMING ORGANIZATION REPORT NO.
 PERFORMING ORGANIZATION NAME AND ADDRESS
U.S. Environmental Protection Agency
Office  of  Research and Development
Office  of  Environmental Processes  & Effects Res.
Washington,  B.C. 20460
             10. PROGRAM ELEMENT NO.
             11. CONTRACT/GRANT NO.
      (RD-682)    68-01-2816;   68-01-2825;
                 68-01-2826;   68-01-2828
2. SPONSORING AGENCY NAME AND ADDRESS
U.S.  Environmental Protection  Agency
Office  of  Research and Development
Office  of  Environmental Processes & Effects Res. RD-682
Washington,  D.C. 20460
             13. TYPE OF REPORT AND PERIOD COVERED
                    Final
             14. SPONSORING AGENCY CODE

                 EPA 600/16
5. SUPPLEMENTARY NOTES
6. ABSTRACT


       The purpose of this  project was to develop  and demonstrate a methodology for
   simultaneously projecting  future pollution control costs for all economic  activi-
   ties subject to Federal  regulations, which utilized consistent assumptions
   relating to official Federal projections of the state of the Nation's  economy.
   To  assure valid simulation of the impacts of  the regulations, the projection model
   was developed with a scale of sectoral detail that allowed analysis of each industry-
   specific effluent or emission regulation in effect at the time (nearly 400 sectors).
   Further, the secondary effects of pollution control expenditures on the economy
   were simulated.  This report demonstrates the utility of the methodology for the
   intended analyses.
7,
                               KEY WORDS AND DOCUMENT ANALYSIS
                 DESCRIPTORS
b.IDENTIFIERS/OPEN ENDED TERMS  C. COSATI Field/Group
   Costs, Water Pollution Control,
   Cost Comparisons,  Economics,
                               05/E
18. DISTRIBUTION STATEMENT

    Unlimited
19, SECURITY CLASS (ThisReport)
     Unclassified
                                                                         21. NO. OF PAGES
20. SECURITY CLASS (Thispage)
     Unclassified
                           22. PRICE
EPA Form2220-1 (Rev. 4-77)   PREVIOUS eoiTION is OBSOLETE

-------
                                                       INSTRUCTIONS

  1.   REPORT NUMBER
       Insert the EPA report number as it appears on the cover of the publication.

  2.   LEAVE BLANK

  3.   RECIPIENTS ACCESSION NUMBER
       Reserved for use by each report recipient.

       TITLE AND SUBTITLE
       Itle should indicate dearly and briefly the subject coverage of the report, and be displayed prominently. Set subtitle, if used, in smaller
        pe or otherwise subordinate it to main title. When a report is prepared in more than one volume, repeat the primary title, add volume
         mber and include subtitle for the specific title.

  5.   REPORT DATE
       Each report shall carry a date indicating at leas! month and year. Indicate the basis on which it was selected (e.g.. date of issue, date of
       .;. oval, date of preparation,  etc.).

  6.   PERFORMING ORGANIZATION CODE
       Leave blank.

  7.   AUTHOR(S)
       Give name(s) in conventional order (John R. Doe, J. Robert Doc, etc.).  List author's affiliation if it differs from the performing organi
       zation.

  8.   PERFORMING ORGANIZATION REPORT NUMBER
       Insert if performing organization wishes to assign this number.

  9.   PERFORMING ORGANIZATION NAME AND ADDRESS
       Give name, street, city, state, and ZIP code. List no more than two levels of an organizational hirearchy.

  10.  PROGRAM ELEMENT NUMBER
       Use the program element number under which the report was prepared. Subordinate numbers may be included in parentheses.

  11.  CONTRACT/GRANT NUMBER
       Insert contract or grant number under which report was prepared.

  12.  SPONSORING AGENCY NAME AND ADDRESS
       Include ZIP code.

  13.  TYPE OF REPORT AND PERIOD COVERED
       Indicate interim final, etc., and if applicable, dates covered.

  14.  SPONSORING AGENCY CODE
       Insert appropriate code.

  15.  SUPPLEMENTARY NOTES
       Enter information not included elsewhere but useful, such as: Prepared in cooperation with, Translation of, Presented'at conference of,
       To be published in, Supersedes, Supplements, etc.

  16.  ABSTRACT
       Include a brief ^200 words or  less) factual summary of the most significant information contained in the report. If the report Contains a
       significant bibliography or literature survey, mention it here.

  17.  KEY WORDS AND DOCUMENT ANALYSIS
       (a) DESCRIPTORS - Select from the Thesaurus of Engineering and Scientific Terms the proper authorized terms that identify the major
       concept of the research and are sufficiently specific and precise to be used as index entries for cataloging.

       (b) IDENTIFIERS AND OPEN-ENDED TERMS - Use identifiers for project names, code names, equipment designators, etc.  Use open-
       ended terms written in descriptor form for those subjects  for which no descriptor exists.

       (c) COSATI HELD GROUP - Field and group assignments are to be taken from the 1965 COSATI Subject Category List. Since the ma-
       jority of documents are multidisciplinary in nature, the Primary Field/Group assignment(s) will be specific discipline, area of human
       endeavor, or type  of physical  object. The application(s) will be cross-referenced with secondary Field/Group assignments that will follow
       the, primary posting(s).

  18.  DISTRIBUTION STATEMENT
       Denote releasability to the  public or limitation for reasons older than security for example "Release Unlimited."  Cite any availability to
       the public, with address and price.

  19. & 20. SECURITY CLASSIFICATION
       DO NOT submit classified reports to the National Technical Information service.

  21.  NUMBER OF PAGES
       Insert the total number of pages, including this one and unnumbered pages, but exclude distribution list, if any.

  22.  PRICE
       Insert the price set by the National Technical Ir j'ormation Service or the Government Printing Office, if known.
EPA Form 2220-1 (Rov. 4-77) (Reverse)


                                                                           allS. GOVERNMENT PRINTING OFFICE: 1979  306-319/«663 1-3

-------
Postage and Fees Paid
Environmental Protection Agency
EPA-335
                               Special
                               Fourth-Class
                               Rate
                               Book
United States
Environmental Protection
Agency
Washington DC 20460
Official Business
Penalty for Private Use $300

-------